re PR target/69140 (stack alignment + O1 breaks with Microsoft ABI)
[gcc.git] / gcc / dwarf2out.c
1 /* Output Dwarf2 format symbol table information from GCC.
2 Copyright (C) 1992-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 Contributed by Gary Funck (gary@intrepid.com).
4 Derived from DWARF 1 implementation of Ron Guilmette (rfg@monkeys.com).
5 Extensively modified by Jason Merrill (jason@cygnus.com).
6
7 This file is part of GCC.
8
9 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
10 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
11 Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option) any later
12 version.
13
14 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
15 WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
16 FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
17 for more details.
18
19 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
20 along with GCC; see the file COPYING3. If not see
21 <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
22
23 /* TODO: Emit .debug_line header even when there are no functions, since
24 the file numbers are used by .debug_info. Alternately, leave
25 out locations for types and decls.
26 Avoid talking about ctors and op= for PODs.
27 Factor out common prologue sequences into multiple CIEs. */
28
29 /* The first part of this file deals with the DWARF 2 frame unwind
30 information, which is also used by the GCC efficient exception handling
31 mechanism. The second part, controlled only by an #ifdef
32 DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO, deals with the other DWARF 2 debugging
33 information. */
34
35 /* DWARF2 Abbreviation Glossary:
36
37 CFA = Canonical Frame Address
38 a fixed address on the stack which identifies a call frame.
39 We define it to be the value of SP just before the call insn.
40 The CFA register and offset, which may change during the course
41 of the function, are used to calculate its value at runtime.
42
43 CFI = Call Frame Instruction
44 an instruction for the DWARF2 abstract machine
45
46 CIE = Common Information Entry
47 information describing information common to one or more FDEs
48
49 DIE = Debugging Information Entry
50
51 FDE = Frame Description Entry
52 information describing the stack call frame, in particular,
53 how to restore registers
54
55 DW_CFA_... = DWARF2 CFA call frame instruction
56 DW_TAG_... = DWARF2 DIE tag */
57
58 #include "config.h"
59 #include "system.h"
60 #include "coretypes.h"
61 #include "target.h"
62 #include "function.h"
63 #include "rtl.h"
64 #include "tree.h"
65 #include "tm_p.h"
66 #include "stringpool.h"
67 #include "insn-config.h"
68 #include "ira.h"
69 #include "cgraph.h"
70 #include "diagnostic.h"
71 #include "fold-const.h"
72 #include "stor-layout.h"
73 #include "varasm.h"
74 #include "version.h"
75 #include "flags.h"
76 #include "rtlhash.h"
77 #include "reload.h"
78 #include "output.h"
79 #include "expr.h"
80 #include "dwarf2out.h"
81 #include "dwarf2asm.h"
82 #include "toplev.h"
83 #include "md5.h"
84 #include "tree-pretty-print.h"
85 #include "debug.h"
86 #include "common/common-target.h"
87 #include "langhooks.h"
88 #include "lra.h"
89 #include "dumpfile.h"
90 #include "opts.h"
91 #include "tree-dfa.h"
92 #include "gdb/gdb-index.h"
93 #include "rtl-iter.h"
94
95 static void dwarf2out_source_line (unsigned int, const char *, int, bool);
96 static rtx_insn *last_var_location_insn;
97 static rtx_insn *cached_next_real_insn;
98 static void dwarf2out_decl (tree);
99
100 #ifndef XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
101 #define XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO 0
102 #endif
103
104 #ifndef HAVE_XCOFF_DWARF_EXTRAS
105 #define HAVE_XCOFF_DWARF_EXTRAS 0
106 #endif
107
108 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
109 int vms_file_stats_name (const char *, long long *, long *, char *, int *);
110
111 /* Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the directory specifications
112 which are output in the debug info should end with a separator. */
113 #define DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR 1
114 /* Define this macro to evaluate to a nonzero value if GCC should refrain
115 from generating indirect strings in DWARF2 debug information, for instance
116 if your target is stuck with an old version of GDB that is unable to
117 process them properly or uses VMS Debug. */
118 #define DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET 1
119 #else
120 #define DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR 0
121 #define DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET 0
122 #endif
123
124 /* ??? Poison these here until it can be done generically. They've been
125 totally replaced in this file; make sure it stays that way. */
126 #undef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
127 #undef DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
128 #if (GCC_VERSION >= 3000)
129 #pragma GCC poison DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
130 #endif
131
132 /* The size of the target's pointer type. */
133 #ifndef PTR_SIZE
134 #define PTR_SIZE (POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT)
135 #endif
136
137 /* Array of RTXes referenced by the debugging information, which therefore
138 must be kept around forever. */
139 static GTY(()) vec<rtx, va_gc> *used_rtx_array;
140
141 /* A pointer to the base of a list of incomplete types which might be
142 completed at some later time. incomplete_types_list needs to be a
143 vec<tree, va_gc> *because we want to tell the garbage collector about
144 it. */
145 static GTY(()) vec<tree, va_gc> *incomplete_types;
146
147 /* A pointer to the base of a table of references to declaration
148 scopes. This table is a display which tracks the nesting
149 of declaration scopes at the current scope and containing
150 scopes. This table is used to find the proper place to
151 define type declaration DIE's. */
152 static GTY(()) vec<tree, va_gc> *decl_scope_table;
153
154 /* Pointers to various DWARF2 sections. */
155 static GTY(()) section *debug_info_section;
156 static GTY(()) section *debug_skeleton_info_section;
157 static GTY(()) section *debug_abbrev_section;
158 static GTY(()) section *debug_skeleton_abbrev_section;
159 static GTY(()) section *debug_aranges_section;
160 static GTY(()) section *debug_addr_section;
161 static GTY(()) section *debug_macinfo_section;
162 static GTY(()) section *debug_line_section;
163 static GTY(()) section *debug_skeleton_line_section;
164 static GTY(()) section *debug_loc_section;
165 static GTY(()) section *debug_pubnames_section;
166 static GTY(()) section *debug_pubtypes_section;
167 static GTY(()) section *debug_str_section;
168 static GTY(()) section *debug_str_dwo_section;
169 static GTY(()) section *debug_str_offsets_section;
170 static GTY(()) section *debug_ranges_section;
171 static GTY(()) section *debug_frame_section;
172
173 /* Maximum size (in bytes) of an artificially generated label. */
174 #define MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES 30
175
176 /* According to the (draft) DWARF 3 specification, the initial length
177 should either be 4 or 12 bytes. When it's 12 bytes, the first 4
178 bytes are 0xffffffff, followed by the length stored in the next 8
179 bytes.
180
181 However, the SGI/MIPS ABI uses an initial length which is equal to
182 DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE. It is defined (elsewhere) accordingly. */
183
184 #ifndef DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE
185 #define DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? 4 : 12)
186 #endif
187
188 /* Round SIZE up to the nearest BOUNDARY. */
189 #define DWARF_ROUND(SIZE,BOUNDARY) \
190 ((((SIZE) + (BOUNDARY) - 1) / (BOUNDARY)) * (BOUNDARY))
191
192 /* CIE identifier. */
193 #if HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64
194 #define DWARF_CIE_ID \
195 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? DW_CIE_ID : DW64_CIE_ID)
196 #else
197 #define DWARF_CIE_ID DW_CIE_ID
198 #endif
199
200
201 /* A vector for a table that contains frame description
202 information for each routine. */
203 #define NOT_INDEXED (-1U)
204 #define NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED (-2U)
205
206 static GTY(()) vec<dw_fde_ref, va_gc> *fde_vec;
207
208 struct GTY((for_user)) indirect_string_node {
209 const char *str;
210 unsigned int refcount;
211 enum dwarf_form form;
212 char *label;
213 unsigned int index;
214 };
215
216 struct indirect_string_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<indirect_string_node>
217 {
218 typedef const char *compare_type;
219
220 static hashval_t hash (indirect_string_node *);
221 static bool equal (indirect_string_node *, const char *);
222 };
223
224 static GTY (()) hash_table<indirect_string_hasher> *debug_str_hash;
225
226 /* With split_debug_info, both the comp_dir and dwo_name go in the
227 main object file, rather than the dwo, similar to the force_direct
228 parameter elsewhere but with additional complications:
229
230 1) The string is needed in both the main object file and the dwo.
231 That is, the comp_dir and dwo_name will appear in both places.
232
233 2) Strings can use three forms: DW_FORM_string, DW_FORM_strp or
234 DW_FORM_GNU_str_index.
235
236 3) GCC chooses the form to use late, depending on the size and
237 reference count.
238
239 Rather than forcing the all debug string handling functions and
240 callers to deal with these complications, simply use a separate,
241 special-cased string table for any attribute that should go in the
242 main object file. This limits the complexity to just the places
243 that need it. */
244
245 static GTY (()) hash_table<indirect_string_hasher> *skeleton_debug_str_hash;
246
247 static GTY(()) int dw2_string_counter;
248
249 /* True if the compilation unit places functions in more than one section. */
250 static GTY(()) bool have_multiple_function_sections = false;
251
252 /* Whether the default text and cold text sections have been used at all. */
253
254 static GTY(()) bool text_section_used = false;
255 static GTY(()) bool cold_text_section_used = false;
256
257 /* The default cold text section. */
258 static GTY(()) section *cold_text_section;
259
260 /* The DIE for C++14 'auto' in a function return type. */
261 static GTY(()) dw_die_ref auto_die;
262
263 /* The DIE for C++14 'decltype(auto)' in a function return type. */
264 static GTY(()) dw_die_ref decltype_auto_die;
265
266 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file. */
267
268 static char *stripattributes (const char *);
269 static void output_call_frame_info (int);
270 static void dwarf2out_note_section_used (void);
271
272 /* Personality decl of current unit. Used only when assembler does not support
273 personality CFI. */
274 static GTY(()) rtx current_unit_personality;
275
276 /* Data and reference forms for relocatable data. */
277 #define DW_FORM_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_data8 : DW_FORM_data4)
278 #define DW_FORM_ref (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_ref8 : DW_FORM_ref4)
279
280 #ifndef DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION
281 #define DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION ".debug_frame"
282 #endif
283
284 #ifndef FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL
285 #define FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL "LFB"
286 #endif
287
288 #ifndef FUNC_END_LABEL
289 #define FUNC_END_LABEL "LFE"
290 #endif
291
292 #ifndef PROLOGUE_END_LABEL
293 #define PROLOGUE_END_LABEL "LPE"
294 #endif
295
296 #ifndef EPILOGUE_BEGIN_LABEL
297 #define EPILOGUE_BEGIN_LABEL "LEB"
298 #endif
299
300 #ifndef FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL
301 #define FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL "Lframe"
302 #endif
303 #define CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL "LSCIE"
304 #define CIE_END_LABEL "LECIE"
305 #define FDE_LABEL "LSFDE"
306 #define FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL "LASFDE"
307 #define FDE_END_LABEL "LEFDE"
308 #define LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL "LSLT"
309 #define LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL "LELT"
310 #define LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL "LASLTP"
311 #define LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL "LELTP"
312 #define DIE_LABEL_PREFIX "DW"
313 \f
314 /* Match the base name of a file to the base name of a compilation unit. */
315
316 static int
317 matches_main_base (const char *path)
318 {
319 /* Cache the last query. */
320 static const char *last_path = NULL;
321 static int last_match = 0;
322 if (path != last_path)
323 {
324 const char *base;
325 int length = base_of_path (path, &base);
326 last_path = path;
327 last_match = (length == main_input_baselength
328 && memcmp (base, main_input_basename, length) == 0);
329 }
330 return last_match;
331 }
332
333 #ifdef DEBUG_DEBUG_STRUCT
334
335 static int
336 dump_struct_debug (tree type, enum debug_info_usage usage,
337 enum debug_struct_file criterion, int generic,
338 int matches, int result)
339 {
340 /* Find the type name. */
341 tree type_decl = TYPE_STUB_DECL (type);
342 tree t = type_decl;
343 const char *name = 0;
344 if (TREE_CODE (t) == TYPE_DECL)
345 t = DECL_NAME (t);
346 if (t)
347 name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (t);
348
349 fprintf (stderr, " struct %d %s %s %s %s %d %p %s\n",
350 criterion,
351 DECL_IN_SYSTEM_HEADER (type_decl) ? "sys" : "usr",
352 matches ? "bas" : "hdr",
353 generic ? "gen" : "ord",
354 usage == DINFO_USAGE_DFN ? ";" :
355 usage == DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE ? "." : "*",
356 result,
357 (void*) type_decl, name);
358 return result;
359 }
360 #define DUMP_GSTRUCT(type, usage, criterion, generic, matches, result) \
361 dump_struct_debug (type, usage, criterion, generic, matches, result)
362
363 #else
364
365 #define DUMP_GSTRUCT(type, usage, criterion, generic, matches, result) \
366 (result)
367
368 #endif
369
370 /* Get the number of HOST_WIDE_INTs needed to represent the precision
371 of the number. Some constants have a large uniform precision, so
372 we get the precision needed for the actual value of the number. */
373
374 static unsigned int
375 get_full_len (const wide_int &op)
376 {
377 int prec = wi::min_precision (op, UNSIGNED);
378 return ((prec + HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 1)
379 / HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT);
380 }
381
382 static bool
383 should_emit_struct_debug (tree type, enum debug_info_usage usage)
384 {
385 enum debug_struct_file criterion;
386 tree type_decl;
387 bool generic = lang_hooks.types.generic_p (type);
388
389 if (generic)
390 criterion = debug_struct_generic[usage];
391 else
392 criterion = debug_struct_ordinary[usage];
393
394 if (criterion == DINFO_STRUCT_FILE_NONE)
395 return DUMP_GSTRUCT (type, usage, criterion, generic, false, false);
396 if (criterion == DINFO_STRUCT_FILE_ANY)
397 return DUMP_GSTRUCT (type, usage, criterion, generic, false, true);
398
399 type_decl = TYPE_STUB_DECL (TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type));
400
401 if (type_decl != NULL)
402 {
403 if (criterion == DINFO_STRUCT_FILE_SYS && DECL_IN_SYSTEM_HEADER (type_decl))
404 return DUMP_GSTRUCT (type, usage, criterion, generic, false, true);
405
406 if (matches_main_base (DECL_SOURCE_FILE (type_decl)))
407 return DUMP_GSTRUCT (type, usage, criterion, generic, true, true);
408 }
409
410 return DUMP_GSTRUCT (type, usage, criterion, generic, false, false);
411 }
412 \f
413 /* Return a pointer to a copy of the section string name S with all
414 attributes stripped off, and an asterisk prepended (for assemble_name). */
415
416 static inline char *
417 stripattributes (const char *s)
418 {
419 char *stripped = XNEWVEC (char, strlen (s) + 2);
420 char *p = stripped;
421
422 *p++ = '*';
423
424 while (*s && *s != ',')
425 *p++ = *s++;
426
427 *p = '\0';
428 return stripped;
429 }
430
431 /* Switch [BACK] to eh_frame_section. If we don't have an eh_frame_section,
432 switch to the data section instead, and write out a synthetic start label
433 for collect2 the first time around. */
434
435 static void
436 switch_to_eh_frame_section (bool back ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
437 {
438 if (eh_frame_section == 0)
439 {
440 int flags;
441
442 if (EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY)
443 {
444 int fde_encoding;
445 int per_encoding;
446 int lsda_encoding;
447
448 fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1,
449 /*global=*/0);
450 per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2,
451 /*global=*/1);
452 lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0,
453 /*global=*/0);
454 flags = ((! flag_pic
455 || ((fde_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
456 && (fde_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
457 && (per_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
458 && (per_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
459 && (lsda_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
460 && (lsda_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned))
461 ? 0 : SECTION_WRITE);
462 }
463 else
464 flags = SECTION_WRITE;
465
466 #ifdef EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
467 eh_frame_section = get_section (EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME, flags, NULL);
468 #else
469 eh_frame_section = ((flags == SECTION_WRITE)
470 ? data_section : readonly_data_section);
471 #endif /* EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME */
472 }
473
474 switch_to_section (eh_frame_section);
475
476 #ifdef EH_FRAME_THROUGH_COLLECT2
477 /* We have no special eh_frame section. Emit special labels to guide
478 collect2. */
479 if (!back)
480 {
481 tree label = get_file_function_name ("F");
482 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
483 targetm.asm_out.globalize_label (asm_out_file,
484 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
485 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
486 }
487 #endif
488 }
489
490 /* Switch [BACK] to the eh or debug frame table section, depending on
491 FOR_EH. */
492
493 static void
494 switch_to_frame_table_section (int for_eh, bool back)
495 {
496 if (for_eh)
497 switch_to_eh_frame_section (back);
498 else
499 {
500 if (!debug_frame_section)
501 debug_frame_section = get_section (DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION,
502 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
503 switch_to_section (debug_frame_section);
504 }
505 }
506
507 /* Describe for the GTY machinery what parts of dw_cfi_oprnd1 are used. */
508
509 enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
510 dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)
511 {
512 switch (cfi)
513 {
514 case DW_CFA_nop:
515 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
516 case DW_CFA_remember_state:
517 case DW_CFA_restore_state:
518 return dw_cfi_oprnd_unused;
519
520 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
521 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
522 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
523 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
524 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
525 return dw_cfi_oprnd_addr;
526
527 case DW_CFA_offset:
528 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
529 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
530 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
531 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
532 case DW_CFA_restore:
533 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
534 case DW_CFA_undefined:
535 case DW_CFA_same_value:
536 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
537 case DW_CFA_register:
538 case DW_CFA_expression:
539 return dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num;
540
541 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
542 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
543 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
544 return dw_cfi_oprnd_offset;
545
546 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
547 return dw_cfi_oprnd_loc;
548
549 default:
550 gcc_unreachable ();
551 }
552 }
553
554 /* Describe for the GTY machinery what parts of dw_cfi_oprnd2 are used. */
555
556 enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
557 dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)
558 {
559 switch (cfi)
560 {
561 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
562 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
563 case DW_CFA_offset:
564 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
565 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
566 return dw_cfi_oprnd_offset;
567
568 case DW_CFA_register:
569 return dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num;
570
571 case DW_CFA_expression:
572 return dw_cfi_oprnd_loc;
573
574 default:
575 return dw_cfi_oprnd_unused;
576 }
577 }
578
579 /* Output one FDE. */
580
581 static void
582 output_fde (dw_fde_ref fde, bool for_eh, bool second,
583 char *section_start_label, int fde_encoding, char *augmentation,
584 bool any_lsda_needed, int lsda_encoding)
585 {
586 const char *begin, *end;
587 static unsigned int j;
588 char l1[20], l2[20];
589
590 targetm.asm_out.emit_unwind_label (asm_out_file, fde->decl, for_eh,
591 /* empty */ 0);
592 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, FDE_LABEL,
593 for_eh + j);
594 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh + j);
595 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, FDE_END_LABEL, for_eh + j);
596 if (!XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO || for_eh)
597 {
598 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 && !for_eh)
599 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff, "Initial length escape value"
600 " indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
601 dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
602 "FDE Length");
603 }
604 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
605
606 if (for_eh)
607 dw2_asm_output_delta (4, l1, section_start_label, "FDE CIE offset");
608 else
609 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, section_start_label,
610 debug_frame_section, "FDE CIE offset");
611
612 begin = second ? fde->dw_fde_second_begin : fde->dw_fde_begin;
613 end = second ? fde->dw_fde_second_end : fde->dw_fde_end;
614
615 if (for_eh)
616 {
617 rtx sym_ref = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, begin);
618 SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (sym_ref) |= SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
619 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (fde_encoding, sym_ref, false,
620 "FDE initial location");
621 dw2_asm_output_delta (size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding),
622 end, begin, "FDE address range");
623 }
624 else
625 {
626 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, begin, "FDE initial location");
627 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, end, begin, "FDE address range");
628 }
629
630 if (augmentation[0])
631 {
632 if (any_lsda_needed)
633 {
634 int size = size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding);
635
636 if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
637 {
638 int offset = ( 4 /* Length */
639 + 4 /* CIE offset */
640 + 2 * size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding)
641 + 1 /* Augmentation size */ );
642 int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
643
644 size += pad;
645 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (size) == 1);
646 }
647
648 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, "Augmentation size");
649
650 if (fde->uses_eh_lsda)
651 {
652 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, second ? "LLSDAC" : "LLSDA",
653 fde->funcdef_number);
654 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (lsda_encoding,
655 gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, l1),
656 false,
657 "Language Specific Data Area");
658 }
659 else
660 {
661 if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
662 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
663 dw2_asm_output_data (size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding), 0,
664 "Language Specific Data Area (none)");
665 }
666 }
667 else
668 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, "Augmentation size");
669 }
670
671 /* Loop through the Call Frame Instructions associated with this FDE. */
672 fde->dw_fde_current_label = begin;
673 {
674 size_t from, until, i;
675
676 from = 0;
677 until = vec_safe_length (fde->dw_fde_cfi);
678
679 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin == NULL)
680 ;
681 else if (!second)
682 until = fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi_index;
683 else
684 from = fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi_index;
685
686 for (i = from; i < until; i++)
687 output_cfi ((*fde->dw_fde_cfi)[i], fde, for_eh);
688 }
689
690 /* If we are to emit a ref/link from function bodies to their frame tables,
691 do it now. This is typically performed to make sure that tables
692 associated with functions are dragged with them and not discarded in
693 garbage collecting links. We need to do this on a per function basis to
694 cope with -ffunction-sections. */
695
696 #ifdef ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF
697 /* Switch to the function section, emit the ref to the tables, and
698 switch *back* into the table section. */
699 switch_to_section (function_section (fde->decl));
700 ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (section_start_label);
701 switch_to_frame_table_section (for_eh, true);
702 #endif
703
704 /* Pad the FDE out to an address sized boundary. */
705 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
706 floor_log2 ((for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)));
707 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
708
709 j += 2;
710 }
711
712 /* Return true if frame description entry FDE is needed for EH. */
713
714 static bool
715 fde_needed_for_eh_p (dw_fde_ref fde)
716 {
717 if (flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables)
718 return true;
719
720 if (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO && DECL_WEAK (fde->decl))
721 return true;
722
723 if (fde->uses_eh_lsda)
724 return true;
725
726 /* If exceptions are enabled, we have collected nothrow info. */
727 if (flag_exceptions && (fde->all_throwers_are_sibcalls || fde->nothrow))
728 return false;
729
730 return true;
731 }
732
733 /* Output the call frame information used to record information
734 that relates to calculating the frame pointer, and records the
735 location of saved registers. */
736
737 static void
738 output_call_frame_info (int for_eh)
739 {
740 unsigned int i;
741 dw_fde_ref fde;
742 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
743 char l1[20], l2[20], section_start_label[20];
744 bool any_lsda_needed = false;
745 char augmentation[6];
746 int augmentation_size;
747 int fde_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
748 int per_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
749 int lsda_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
750 int return_reg;
751 rtx personality = NULL;
752 int dw_cie_version;
753
754 /* Don't emit a CIE if there won't be any FDEs. */
755 if (!fde_vec)
756 return;
757
758 /* Nothing to do if the assembler's doing it all. */
759 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
760 return;
761
762 /* If we don't have any functions we'll want to unwind out of, don't emit
763 any EH unwind information. If we make FDEs linkonce, we may have to
764 emit an empty label for an FDE that wouldn't otherwise be emitted. We
765 want to avoid having an FDE kept around when the function it refers to
766 is discarded. Example where this matters: a primary function template
767 in C++ requires EH information, an explicit specialization doesn't. */
768 if (for_eh)
769 {
770 bool any_eh_needed = false;
771
772 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*fde_vec, i, fde)
773 {
774 if (fde->uses_eh_lsda)
775 any_eh_needed = any_lsda_needed = true;
776 else if (fde_needed_for_eh_p (fde))
777 any_eh_needed = true;
778 else if (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO)
779 targetm.asm_out.emit_unwind_label (asm_out_file, fde->decl, 1, 1);
780 }
781
782 if (!any_eh_needed)
783 return;
784 }
785
786 /* We're going to be generating comments, so turn on app. */
787 if (flag_debug_asm)
788 app_enable ();
789
790 /* Switch to the proper frame section, first time. */
791 switch_to_frame_table_section (for_eh, false);
792
793 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (section_start_label, FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL, for_eh);
794 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, section_start_label);
795
796 /* Output the CIE. */
797 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh);
798 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, CIE_END_LABEL, for_eh);
799 if (!XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO || for_eh)
800 {
801 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 && !for_eh)
802 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
803 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
804 dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
805 "Length of Common Information Entry");
806 }
807 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
808
809 /* Now that the CIE pointer is PC-relative for EH,
810 use 0 to identify the CIE. */
811 dw2_asm_output_data ((for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE),
812 (for_eh ? 0 : DWARF_CIE_ID),
813 "CIE Identifier Tag");
814
815 /* Use the CIE version 3 for DWARF3; allow DWARF2 to continue to
816 use CIE version 1, unless that would produce incorrect results
817 due to overflowing the return register column. */
818 return_reg = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, for_eh);
819 dw_cie_version = 1;
820 if (return_reg >= 256 || dwarf_version > 2)
821 dw_cie_version = 3;
822 dw2_asm_output_data (1, dw_cie_version, "CIE Version");
823
824 augmentation[0] = 0;
825 augmentation_size = 0;
826
827 personality = current_unit_personality;
828 if (for_eh)
829 {
830 char *p;
831
832 /* Augmentation:
833 z Indicates that a uleb128 is present to size the
834 augmentation section.
835 L Indicates the encoding (and thus presence) of
836 an LSDA pointer in the FDE augmentation.
837 R Indicates a non-default pointer encoding for
838 FDE code pointers.
839 P Indicates the presence of an encoding + language
840 personality routine in the CIE augmentation. */
841
842 fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1, /*global=*/0);
843 per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2, /*global=*/1);
844 lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0, /*global=*/0);
845
846 p = augmentation + 1;
847 if (personality)
848 {
849 *p++ = 'P';
850 augmentation_size += 1 + size_of_encoded_value (per_encoding);
851 assemble_external_libcall (personality);
852 }
853 if (any_lsda_needed)
854 {
855 *p++ = 'L';
856 augmentation_size += 1;
857 }
858 if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
859 {
860 *p++ = 'R';
861 augmentation_size += 1;
862 }
863 if (p > augmentation + 1)
864 {
865 augmentation[0] = 'z';
866 *p = '\0';
867 }
868
869 /* Ug. Some platforms can't do unaligned dynamic relocations at all. */
870 if (personality && per_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
871 {
872 int offset = ( 4 /* Length */
873 + 4 /* CIE Id */
874 + 1 /* CIE version */
875 + strlen (augmentation) + 1 /* Augmentation */
876 + size_of_uleb128 (1) /* Code alignment */
877 + size_of_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT)
878 + 1 /* RA column */
879 + 1 /* Augmentation size */
880 + 1 /* Personality encoding */ );
881 int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
882
883 augmentation_size += pad;
884
885 /* Augmentations should be small, so there's scarce need to
886 iterate for a solution. Die if we exceed one uleb128 byte. */
887 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (augmentation_size) == 1);
888 }
889 }
890
891 dw2_asm_output_nstring (augmentation, -1, "CIE Augmentation");
892 if (dw_cie_version >= 4)
893 {
894 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "CIE Address Size");
895 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "CIE Segment Size");
896 }
897 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, "CIE Code Alignment Factor");
898 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT,
899 "CIE Data Alignment Factor");
900
901 if (dw_cie_version == 1)
902 dw2_asm_output_data (1, return_reg, "CIE RA Column");
903 else
904 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (return_reg, "CIE RA Column");
905
906 if (augmentation[0])
907 {
908 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (augmentation_size, "Augmentation size");
909 if (personality)
910 {
911 dw2_asm_output_data (1, per_encoding, "Personality (%s)",
912 eh_data_format_name (per_encoding));
913 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (per_encoding,
914 personality,
915 true, NULL);
916 }
917
918 if (any_lsda_needed)
919 dw2_asm_output_data (1, lsda_encoding, "LSDA Encoding (%s)",
920 eh_data_format_name (lsda_encoding));
921
922 if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
923 dw2_asm_output_data (1, fde_encoding, "FDE Encoding (%s)",
924 eh_data_format_name (fde_encoding));
925 }
926
927 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*cie_cfi_vec, i, cfi)
928 output_cfi (cfi, NULL, for_eh);
929
930 /* Pad the CIE out to an address sized boundary. */
931 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
932 floor_log2 (for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE));
933 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
934
935 /* Loop through all of the FDE's. */
936 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*fde_vec, i, fde)
937 {
938 unsigned int k;
939
940 /* Don't emit EH unwind info for leaf functions that don't need it. */
941 if (for_eh && !fde_needed_for_eh_p (fde))
942 continue;
943
944 for (k = 0; k < (fde->dw_fde_second_begin ? 2 : 1); k++)
945 output_fde (fde, for_eh, k, section_start_label, fde_encoding,
946 augmentation, any_lsda_needed, lsda_encoding);
947 }
948
949 if (for_eh && targetm.terminate_dw2_eh_frame_info)
950 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0, "End of Table");
951
952 /* Turn off app to make assembly quicker. */
953 if (flag_debug_asm)
954 app_disable ();
955 }
956
957 /* Emit .cfi_startproc and .cfi_personality/.cfi_lsda if needed. */
958
959 static void
960 dwarf2out_do_cfi_startproc (bool second)
961 {
962 int enc;
963 rtx ref;
964 rtx personality = get_personality_function (current_function_decl);
965
966 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_startproc\n");
967
968 if (personality)
969 {
970 enc = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2, /*global=*/1);
971 ref = personality;
972
973 /* ??? The GAS support isn't entirely consistent. We have to
974 handle indirect support ourselves, but PC-relative is done
975 in the assembler. Further, the assembler can't handle any
976 of the weirder relocation types. */
977 if (enc & DW_EH_PE_indirect)
978 ref = dw2_force_const_mem (ref, true);
979
980 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_personality %#x,", enc);
981 output_addr_const (asm_out_file, ref);
982 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
983 }
984
985 if (crtl->uses_eh_lsda)
986 {
987 char lab[20];
988
989 enc = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0, /*global=*/0);
990 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (lab, second ? "LLSDAC" : "LLSDA",
991 current_function_funcdef_no);
992 ref = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, lab);
993 SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (ref) = SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
994
995 if (enc & DW_EH_PE_indirect)
996 ref = dw2_force_const_mem (ref, true);
997
998 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_lsda %#x,", enc);
999 output_addr_const (asm_out_file, ref);
1000 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
1001 }
1002 }
1003
1004 /* Allocate CURRENT_FDE. Immediately initialize all we can, noting that
1005 this allocation may be done before pass_final. */
1006
1007 dw_fde_ref
1008 dwarf2out_alloc_current_fde (void)
1009 {
1010 dw_fde_ref fde;
1011
1012 fde = ggc_cleared_alloc<dw_fde_node> ();
1013 fde->decl = current_function_decl;
1014 fde->funcdef_number = current_function_funcdef_no;
1015 fde->fde_index = vec_safe_length (fde_vec);
1016 fde->all_throwers_are_sibcalls = crtl->all_throwers_are_sibcalls;
1017 fde->uses_eh_lsda = crtl->uses_eh_lsda;
1018 fde->nothrow = crtl->nothrow;
1019 fde->drap_reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
1020 fde->vdrap_reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
1021
1022 /* Record the FDE associated with this function. */
1023 cfun->fde = fde;
1024 vec_safe_push (fde_vec, fde);
1025
1026 return fde;
1027 }
1028
1029 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of a function, before
1030 the prologue. */
1031
1032 void
1033 dwarf2out_begin_prologue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1034 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1035 {
1036 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
1037 char * dup_label;
1038 dw_fde_ref fde;
1039 section *fnsec;
1040 bool do_frame;
1041
1042 current_function_func_begin_label = NULL;
1043
1044 do_frame = dwarf2out_do_frame ();
1045
1046 /* ??? current_function_func_begin_label is also used by except.c for
1047 call-site information. We must emit this label if it might be used. */
1048 if (!do_frame
1049 && (!flag_exceptions
1050 || targetm_common.except_unwind_info (&global_options) == UI_SJLJ))
1051 return;
1052
1053 fnsec = function_section (current_function_decl);
1054 switch_to_section (fnsec);
1055 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
1056 current_function_funcdef_no);
1057 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
1058 current_function_funcdef_no);
1059 dup_label = xstrdup (label);
1060 current_function_func_begin_label = dup_label;
1061
1062 /* We can elide the fde allocation if we're not emitting debug info. */
1063 if (!do_frame)
1064 return;
1065
1066 /* Cater to the various TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK implementations that
1067 emit insns as rtx but bypass the bulk of rest_of_compilation, which
1068 would include pass_dwarf2_frame. If we've not created the FDE yet,
1069 do so now. */
1070 fde = cfun->fde;
1071 if (fde == NULL)
1072 fde = dwarf2out_alloc_current_fde ();
1073
1074 /* Initialize the bits of CURRENT_FDE that were not available earlier. */
1075 fde->dw_fde_begin = dup_label;
1076 fde->dw_fde_current_label = dup_label;
1077 fde->in_std_section = (fnsec == text_section
1078 || (cold_text_section && fnsec == cold_text_section));
1079
1080 /* We only want to output line number information for the genuine dwarf2
1081 prologue case, not the eh frame case. */
1082 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
1083 if (file)
1084 dwarf2out_source_line (line, file, 0, true);
1085 #endif
1086
1087 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
1088 dwarf2out_do_cfi_startproc (false);
1089 else
1090 {
1091 rtx personality = get_personality_function (current_function_decl);
1092 if (!current_unit_personality)
1093 current_unit_personality = personality;
1094
1095 /* We cannot keep a current personality per function as without CFI
1096 asm, at the point where we emit the CFI data, there is no current
1097 function anymore. */
1098 if (personality && current_unit_personality != personality)
1099 sorry ("multiple EH personalities are supported only with assemblers "
1100 "supporting .cfi_personality directive");
1101 }
1102 }
1103
1104 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the end of the generated code
1105 for a function prologue. This gets called *after* the prologue code has
1106 been generated. */
1107
1108 void
1109 dwarf2out_vms_end_prologue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1110 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1111 {
1112 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
1113
1114 /* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
1115 function. */
1116 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, PROLOGUE_END_LABEL,
1117 current_function_funcdef_no);
1118 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, PROLOGUE_END_LABEL,
1119 current_function_funcdef_no);
1120 cfun->fde->dw_fde_vms_end_prologue = xstrdup (label);
1121 }
1122
1123 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of the generated code
1124 for a function epilogue. This gets called *before* the prologue code has
1125 been generated. */
1126
1127 void
1128 dwarf2out_vms_begin_epilogue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1129 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1130 {
1131 dw_fde_ref fde = cfun->fde;
1132 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
1133
1134 if (fde->dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue)
1135 return;
1136
1137 /* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
1138 function. */
1139 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, EPILOGUE_BEGIN_LABEL,
1140 current_function_funcdef_no);
1141 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, EPILOGUE_BEGIN_LABEL,
1142 current_function_funcdef_no);
1143 fde->dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue = xstrdup (label);
1144 }
1145
1146 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the absolute end of the generated code
1147 for a function definition. This gets called *after* the epilogue code has
1148 been generated. */
1149
1150 void
1151 dwarf2out_end_epilogue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1152 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1153 {
1154 dw_fde_ref fde;
1155 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
1156
1157 last_var_location_insn = NULL;
1158 cached_next_real_insn = NULL;
1159
1160 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
1161 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_endproc\n");
1162
1163 /* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
1164 function. */
1165 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_END_LABEL,
1166 current_function_funcdef_no);
1167 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
1168 fde = cfun->fde;
1169 gcc_assert (fde != NULL);
1170 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin == NULL)
1171 fde->dw_fde_end = xstrdup (label);
1172 }
1173
1174 void
1175 dwarf2out_frame_finish (void)
1176 {
1177 /* Output call frame information. */
1178 if (targetm.debug_unwind_info () == UI_DWARF2)
1179 output_call_frame_info (0);
1180
1181 /* Output another copy for the unwinder. */
1182 if ((flag_unwind_tables || flag_exceptions)
1183 && targetm_common.except_unwind_info (&global_options) == UI_DWARF2)
1184 output_call_frame_info (1);
1185 }
1186
1187 /* Note that the current function section is being used for code. */
1188
1189 static void
1190 dwarf2out_note_section_used (void)
1191 {
1192 section *sec = current_function_section ();
1193 if (sec == text_section)
1194 text_section_used = true;
1195 else if (sec == cold_text_section)
1196 cold_text_section_used = true;
1197 }
1198
1199 static void var_location_switch_text_section (void);
1200 static void set_cur_line_info_table (section *);
1201
1202 void
1203 dwarf2out_switch_text_section (void)
1204 {
1205 section *sect;
1206 dw_fde_ref fde = cfun->fde;
1207
1208 gcc_assert (cfun && fde && fde->dw_fde_second_begin == NULL);
1209
1210 if (!in_cold_section_p)
1211 {
1212 fde->dw_fde_end = crtl->subsections.cold_section_end_label;
1213 fde->dw_fde_second_begin = crtl->subsections.hot_section_label;
1214 fde->dw_fde_second_end = crtl->subsections.hot_section_end_label;
1215 }
1216 else
1217 {
1218 fde->dw_fde_end = crtl->subsections.hot_section_end_label;
1219 fde->dw_fde_second_begin = crtl->subsections.cold_section_label;
1220 fde->dw_fde_second_end = crtl->subsections.cold_section_end_label;
1221 }
1222 have_multiple_function_sections = true;
1223
1224 /* There is no need to mark used sections when not debugging. */
1225 if (cold_text_section != NULL)
1226 dwarf2out_note_section_used ();
1227
1228 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
1229 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_endproc\n");
1230
1231 /* Now do the real section switch. */
1232 sect = current_function_section ();
1233 switch_to_section (sect);
1234
1235 fde->second_in_std_section
1236 = (sect == text_section
1237 || (cold_text_section && sect == cold_text_section));
1238
1239 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
1240 dwarf2out_do_cfi_startproc (true);
1241
1242 var_location_switch_text_section ();
1243
1244 if (cold_text_section != NULL)
1245 set_cur_line_info_table (sect);
1246 }
1247 \f
1248 /* And now, the subset of the debugging information support code necessary
1249 for emitting location expressions. */
1250
1251 /* Data about a single source file. */
1252 struct GTY((for_user)) dwarf_file_data {
1253 const char * filename;
1254 int emitted_number;
1255 };
1256
1257 /* Describe an entry into the .debug_addr section. */
1258
1259 enum ate_kind {
1260 ate_kind_rtx,
1261 ate_kind_rtx_dtprel,
1262 ate_kind_label
1263 };
1264
1265 struct GTY((for_user)) addr_table_entry {
1266 enum ate_kind kind;
1267 unsigned int refcount;
1268 unsigned int index;
1269 union addr_table_entry_struct_union
1270 {
1271 rtx GTY ((tag ("0"))) rtl;
1272 char * GTY ((tag ("1"))) label;
1273 }
1274 GTY ((desc ("%1.kind"))) addr;
1275 };
1276
1277 /* Location lists are ranges + location descriptions for that range,
1278 so you can track variables that are in different places over
1279 their entire life. */
1280 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_loc_list_struct {
1281 dw_loc_list_ref dw_loc_next;
1282 const char *begin; /* Label and addr_entry for start of range */
1283 addr_table_entry *begin_entry;
1284 const char *end; /* Label for end of range */
1285 char *ll_symbol; /* Label for beginning of location list.
1286 Only on head of list */
1287 const char *section; /* Section this loclist is relative to */
1288 dw_loc_descr_ref expr;
1289 hashval_t hash;
1290 /* True if all addresses in this and subsequent lists are known to be
1291 resolved. */
1292 bool resolved_addr;
1293 /* True if this list has been replaced by dw_loc_next. */
1294 bool replaced;
1295 bool emitted;
1296 /* True if the range should be emitted even if begin and end
1297 are the same. */
1298 bool force;
1299 } dw_loc_list_node;
1300
1301 static dw_loc_descr_ref int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT);
1302 static dw_loc_descr_ref uint_loc_descriptor (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
1303
1304 /* Convert a DWARF stack opcode into its string name. */
1305
1306 static const char *
1307 dwarf_stack_op_name (unsigned int op)
1308 {
1309 const char *name = get_DW_OP_name (op);
1310
1311 if (name != NULL)
1312 return name;
1313
1314 return "OP_<unknown>";
1315 }
1316
1317 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated location description. Location
1318 descriptions are simple expression terms that can be strung
1319 together to form more complicated location (address) descriptions. */
1320
1321 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
1322 new_loc_descr (enum dwarf_location_atom op, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd1,
1323 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd2)
1324 {
1325 dw_loc_descr_ref descr = ggc_cleared_alloc<dw_loc_descr_node> ();
1326
1327 descr->dw_loc_opc = op;
1328 #if ENABLE_CHECKING
1329 descr->dw_loc_frame_offset = -1;
1330 #endif
1331 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
1332 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry = NULL;
1333 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned = oprnd1;
1334 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
1335 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_entry = NULL;
1336 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_unsigned = oprnd2;
1337
1338 return descr;
1339 }
1340
1341 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated location description for
1342 REG and OFFSET. */
1343
1344 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
1345 new_reg_loc_descr (unsigned int reg, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1346 {
1347 if (reg <= 31)
1348 return new_loc_descr ((enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_breg0 + reg),
1349 offset, 0);
1350 else
1351 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, reg, offset);
1352 }
1353
1354 /* Add a location description term to a location description expression. */
1355
1356 static inline void
1357 add_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, dw_loc_descr_ref descr)
1358 {
1359 dw_loc_descr_ref *d;
1360
1361 /* Find the end of the chain. */
1362 for (d = list_head; (*d) != NULL; d = &(*d)->dw_loc_next)
1363 ;
1364
1365 *d = descr;
1366 }
1367
1368 /* Compare two location operands for exact equality. */
1369
1370 static bool
1371 dw_val_equal_p (dw_val_node *a, dw_val_node *b)
1372 {
1373 if (a->val_class != b->val_class)
1374 return false;
1375 switch (a->val_class)
1376 {
1377 case dw_val_class_none:
1378 return true;
1379 case dw_val_class_addr:
1380 return rtx_equal_p (a->v.val_addr, b->v.val_addr);
1381
1382 case dw_val_class_offset:
1383 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
1384 case dw_val_class_const:
1385 case dw_val_class_range_list:
1386 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
1387 case dw_val_class_macptr:
1388 /* These are all HOST_WIDE_INT, signed or unsigned. */
1389 return a->v.val_unsigned == b->v.val_unsigned;
1390
1391 case dw_val_class_loc:
1392 return a->v.val_loc == b->v.val_loc;
1393 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
1394 return a->v.val_loc_list == b->v.val_loc_list;
1395 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
1396 return a->v.val_die_ref.die == b->v.val_die_ref.die;
1397 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
1398 return a->v.val_fde_index == b->v.val_fde_index;
1399 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
1400 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
1401 return strcmp (a->v.val_lbl_id, b->v.val_lbl_id) == 0;
1402 case dw_val_class_str:
1403 return a->v.val_str == b->v.val_str;
1404 case dw_val_class_flag:
1405 return a->v.val_flag == b->v.val_flag;
1406 case dw_val_class_file:
1407 return a->v.val_file == b->v.val_file;
1408 case dw_val_class_decl_ref:
1409 return a->v.val_decl_ref == b->v.val_decl_ref;
1410
1411 case dw_val_class_const_double:
1412 return (a->v.val_double.high == b->v.val_double.high
1413 && a->v.val_double.low == b->v.val_double.low);
1414
1415 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
1416 return *a->v.val_wide == *b->v.val_wide;
1417
1418 case dw_val_class_vec:
1419 {
1420 size_t a_len = a->v.val_vec.elt_size * a->v.val_vec.length;
1421 size_t b_len = b->v.val_vec.elt_size * b->v.val_vec.length;
1422
1423 return (a_len == b_len
1424 && !memcmp (a->v.val_vec.array, b->v.val_vec.array, a_len));
1425 }
1426
1427 case dw_val_class_data8:
1428 return memcmp (a->v.val_data8, b->v.val_data8, 8) == 0;
1429
1430 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
1431 return (!strcmp (a->v.val_vms_delta.lbl1, b->v.val_vms_delta.lbl1)
1432 && !strcmp (a->v.val_vms_delta.lbl1, b->v.val_vms_delta.lbl1));
1433
1434 case dw_val_class_discr_value:
1435 return (a->v.val_discr_value.pos == b->v.val_discr_value.pos
1436 && a->v.val_discr_value.v.uval == b->v.val_discr_value.v.uval);
1437 case dw_val_class_discr_list:
1438 /* It makes no sense comparing two discriminant value lists. */
1439 return false;
1440 }
1441 gcc_unreachable ();
1442 }
1443
1444 /* Compare two location atoms for exact equality. */
1445
1446 static bool
1447 loc_descr_equal_p_1 (dw_loc_descr_ref a, dw_loc_descr_ref b)
1448 {
1449 if (a->dw_loc_opc != b->dw_loc_opc)
1450 return false;
1451
1452 /* ??? This is only ever set for DW_OP_constNu, for N equal to the
1453 address size, but since we always allocate cleared storage it
1454 should be zero for other types of locations. */
1455 if (a->dtprel != b->dtprel)
1456 return false;
1457
1458 return (dw_val_equal_p (&a->dw_loc_oprnd1, &b->dw_loc_oprnd1)
1459 && dw_val_equal_p (&a->dw_loc_oprnd2, &b->dw_loc_oprnd2));
1460 }
1461
1462 /* Compare two complete location expressions for exact equality. */
1463
1464 bool
1465 loc_descr_equal_p (dw_loc_descr_ref a, dw_loc_descr_ref b)
1466 {
1467 while (1)
1468 {
1469 if (a == b)
1470 return true;
1471 if (a == NULL || b == NULL)
1472 return false;
1473 if (!loc_descr_equal_p_1 (a, b))
1474 return false;
1475
1476 a = a->dw_loc_next;
1477 b = b->dw_loc_next;
1478 }
1479 }
1480
1481
1482 /* Add a constant OFFSET to a location expression. */
1483
1484 static void
1485 loc_descr_plus_const (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1486 {
1487 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
1488 HOST_WIDE_INT *p;
1489
1490 gcc_assert (*list_head != NULL);
1491
1492 if (!offset)
1493 return;
1494
1495 /* Find the end of the chain. */
1496 for (loc = *list_head; loc->dw_loc_next != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
1497 ;
1498
1499 p = NULL;
1500 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_fbreg
1501 || (loc->dw_loc_opc >= DW_OP_breg0 && loc->dw_loc_opc <= DW_OP_breg31))
1502 p = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
1503 else if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bregx)
1504 p = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int;
1505
1506 /* If the last operation is fbreg, breg{0..31,x}, optimize by adjusting its
1507 offset. Don't optimize if an signed integer overflow would happen. */
1508 if (p != NULL
1509 && ((offset > 0 && *p <= INTTYPE_MAXIMUM (HOST_WIDE_INT) - offset)
1510 || (offset < 0 && *p >= INTTYPE_MINIMUM (HOST_WIDE_INT) - offset)))
1511 *p += offset;
1512
1513 else if (offset > 0)
1514 loc->dw_loc_next = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, offset, 0);
1515
1516 else
1517 {
1518 loc->dw_loc_next = int_loc_descriptor (-offset);
1519 add_loc_descr (&loc->dw_loc_next, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
1520 }
1521 }
1522
1523 /* Add a constant OFFSET to a location list. */
1524
1525 static void
1526 loc_list_plus_const (dw_loc_list_ref list_head, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1527 {
1528 dw_loc_list_ref d;
1529 for (d = list_head; d != NULL; d = d->dw_loc_next)
1530 loc_descr_plus_const (&d->expr, offset);
1531 }
1532
1533 #define DWARF_REF_SIZE \
1534 (dwarf_version == 2 ? DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
1535
1536 static unsigned long int get_base_type_offset (dw_die_ref);
1537
1538 /* Return the size of a location descriptor. */
1539
1540 static unsigned long
1541 size_of_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
1542 {
1543 unsigned long size = 1;
1544
1545 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
1546 {
1547 case DW_OP_addr:
1548 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
1549 break;
1550 case DW_OP_GNU_addr_index:
1551 case DW_OP_GNU_const_index:
1552 gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry->index != NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
1553 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry->index);
1554 break;
1555 case DW_OP_const1u:
1556 case DW_OP_const1s:
1557 size += 1;
1558 break;
1559 case DW_OP_const2u:
1560 case DW_OP_const2s:
1561 size += 2;
1562 break;
1563 case DW_OP_const4u:
1564 case DW_OP_const4s:
1565 size += 4;
1566 break;
1567 case DW_OP_const8u:
1568 case DW_OP_const8s:
1569 size += 8;
1570 break;
1571 case DW_OP_constu:
1572 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1573 break;
1574 case DW_OP_consts:
1575 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
1576 break;
1577 case DW_OP_pick:
1578 size += 1;
1579 break;
1580 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
1581 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1582 break;
1583 case DW_OP_skip:
1584 case DW_OP_bra:
1585 size += 2;
1586 break;
1587 case DW_OP_breg0:
1588 case DW_OP_breg1:
1589 case DW_OP_breg2:
1590 case DW_OP_breg3:
1591 case DW_OP_breg4:
1592 case DW_OP_breg5:
1593 case DW_OP_breg6:
1594 case DW_OP_breg7:
1595 case DW_OP_breg8:
1596 case DW_OP_breg9:
1597 case DW_OP_breg10:
1598 case DW_OP_breg11:
1599 case DW_OP_breg12:
1600 case DW_OP_breg13:
1601 case DW_OP_breg14:
1602 case DW_OP_breg15:
1603 case DW_OP_breg16:
1604 case DW_OP_breg17:
1605 case DW_OP_breg18:
1606 case DW_OP_breg19:
1607 case DW_OP_breg20:
1608 case DW_OP_breg21:
1609 case DW_OP_breg22:
1610 case DW_OP_breg23:
1611 case DW_OP_breg24:
1612 case DW_OP_breg25:
1613 case DW_OP_breg26:
1614 case DW_OP_breg27:
1615 case DW_OP_breg28:
1616 case DW_OP_breg29:
1617 case DW_OP_breg30:
1618 case DW_OP_breg31:
1619 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
1620 break;
1621 case DW_OP_regx:
1622 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1623 break;
1624 case DW_OP_fbreg:
1625 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
1626 break;
1627 case DW_OP_bregx:
1628 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1629 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int);
1630 break;
1631 case DW_OP_piece:
1632 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1633 break;
1634 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
1635 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1636 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_unsigned);
1637 break;
1638 case DW_OP_deref_size:
1639 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
1640 size += 1;
1641 break;
1642 case DW_OP_call2:
1643 size += 2;
1644 break;
1645 case DW_OP_call4:
1646 size += 4;
1647 break;
1648 case DW_OP_call_ref:
1649 size += DWARF_REF_SIZE;
1650 break;
1651 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
1652 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned)
1653 + loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned;
1654 break;
1655 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
1656 size += DWARF_REF_SIZE + size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int);
1657 break;
1658 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
1659 {
1660 unsigned long op_size = size_of_locs (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc);
1661 size += size_of_uleb128 (op_size) + op_size;
1662 break;
1663 }
1664 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
1665 {
1666 unsigned long o
1667 = get_base_type_offset (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die);
1668 size += size_of_uleb128 (o) + 1;
1669 switch (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class)
1670 {
1671 case dw_val_class_vec:
1672 size += loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length
1673 * loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size;
1674 break;
1675 case dw_val_class_const:
1676 size += HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / BITS_PER_UNIT;
1677 break;
1678 case dw_val_class_const_double:
1679 size += HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT / BITS_PER_UNIT;
1680 break;
1681 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
1682 size += (get_full_len (*loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_wide)
1683 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / BITS_PER_UNIT);
1684 break;
1685 default:
1686 gcc_unreachable ();
1687 }
1688 break;
1689 }
1690 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
1691 {
1692 unsigned long o
1693 = get_base_type_offset (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die);
1694 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned)
1695 + size_of_uleb128 (o);
1696 }
1697 break;
1698 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
1699 {
1700 unsigned long o
1701 = get_base_type_offset (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die);
1702 size += 1 + size_of_uleb128 (o);
1703 }
1704 break;
1705 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
1706 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
1707 if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
1708 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
1709 else
1710 {
1711 unsigned long o
1712 = get_base_type_offset (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die);
1713 size += size_of_uleb128 (o);
1714 }
1715 break;
1716 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
1717 size += 4;
1718 break;
1719 default:
1720 break;
1721 }
1722
1723 return size;
1724 }
1725
1726 /* Return the size of a series of location descriptors. */
1727
1728 unsigned long
1729 size_of_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
1730 {
1731 dw_loc_descr_ref l;
1732 unsigned long size;
1733
1734 /* If there are no skip or bra opcodes, don't fill in the dw_loc_addr
1735 field, to avoid writing to a PCH file. */
1736 for (size = 0, l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
1737 {
1738 if (l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_skip || l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bra)
1739 break;
1740 size += size_of_loc_descr (l);
1741 }
1742 if (! l)
1743 return size;
1744
1745 for (size = 0, l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
1746 {
1747 l->dw_loc_addr = size;
1748 size += size_of_loc_descr (l);
1749 }
1750
1751 return size;
1752 }
1753
1754 /* Return the size of the value in a DW_AT_discr_value attribute. */
1755
1756 static int
1757 size_of_discr_value (dw_discr_value *discr_value)
1758 {
1759 if (discr_value->pos)
1760 return size_of_uleb128 (discr_value->v.uval);
1761 else
1762 return size_of_sleb128 (discr_value->v.sval);
1763 }
1764
1765 /* Return the size of the value in a DW_discr_list attribute. */
1766
1767 static int
1768 size_of_discr_list (dw_discr_list_ref discr_list)
1769 {
1770 int size = 0;
1771
1772 for (dw_discr_list_ref list = discr_list;
1773 list != NULL;
1774 list = list->dw_discr_next)
1775 {
1776 /* One byte for the discriminant value descriptor, and then one or two
1777 LEB128 numbers, depending on whether it's a single case label or a
1778 range label. */
1779 size += 1;
1780 size += size_of_discr_value (&list->dw_discr_lower_bound);
1781 if (list->dw_discr_range != 0)
1782 size += size_of_discr_value (&list->dw_discr_upper_bound);
1783 }
1784 return size;
1785 }
1786
1787 static HOST_WIDE_INT extract_int (const unsigned char *, unsigned);
1788 static void get_ref_die_offset_label (char *, dw_die_ref);
1789 static unsigned long int get_ref_die_offset (dw_die_ref);
1790
1791 /* Output location description stack opcode's operands (if any).
1792 The for_eh_or_skip parameter controls whether register numbers are
1793 converted using DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT, which is needed in the case that
1794 hard reg numbers have been processed via DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i.e. for unwind
1795 info). This should be suppressed for the cases that have not been converted
1796 (i.e. symbolic debug info), by setting the parameter < 0. See PR47324. */
1797
1798 static void
1799 output_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, int for_eh_or_skip)
1800 {
1801 dw_val_ref val1 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1;
1802 dw_val_ref val2 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2;
1803
1804 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
1805 {
1806 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
1807 case DW_OP_const2u:
1808 case DW_OP_const2s:
1809 dw2_asm_output_data (2, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
1810 break;
1811 case DW_OP_const4u:
1812 if (loc->dtprel)
1813 {
1814 gcc_assert (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel);
1815 targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file, 4,
1816 val1->v.val_addr);
1817 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
1818 break;
1819 }
1820 /* FALLTHRU */
1821 case DW_OP_const4s:
1822 dw2_asm_output_data (4, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
1823 break;
1824 case DW_OP_const8u:
1825 if (loc->dtprel)
1826 {
1827 gcc_assert (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel);
1828 targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file, 8,
1829 val1->v.val_addr);
1830 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
1831 break;
1832 }
1833 /* FALLTHRU */
1834 case DW_OP_const8s:
1835 gcc_assert (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64);
1836 dw2_asm_output_data (8, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
1837 break;
1838 case DW_OP_skip:
1839 case DW_OP_bra:
1840 {
1841 int offset;
1842
1843 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
1844 offset = val1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr - (loc->dw_loc_addr + 3);
1845
1846 dw2_asm_output_data (2, offset, NULL);
1847 }
1848 break;
1849 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
1850 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
1851 switch (val2->val_class)
1852 {
1853 case dw_val_class_const:
1854 dw2_asm_output_data (val1->v.val_unsigned, val2->v.val_int, NULL);
1855 break;
1856 case dw_val_class_vec:
1857 {
1858 unsigned int elt_size = val2->v.val_vec.elt_size;
1859 unsigned int len = val2->v.val_vec.length;
1860 unsigned int i;
1861 unsigned char *p;
1862
1863 if (elt_size > sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
1864 {
1865 elt_size /= 2;
1866 len *= 2;
1867 }
1868 for (i = 0, p = val2->v.val_vec.array;
1869 i < len;
1870 i++, p += elt_size)
1871 dw2_asm_output_data (elt_size, extract_int (p, elt_size),
1872 "fp or vector constant word %u", i);
1873 }
1874 break;
1875 case dw_val_class_const_double:
1876 {
1877 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first, second;
1878
1879 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
1880 {
1881 first = val2->v.val_double.high;
1882 second = val2->v.val_double.low;
1883 }
1884 else
1885 {
1886 first = val2->v.val_double.low;
1887 second = val2->v.val_double.high;
1888 }
1889 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
1890 first, NULL);
1891 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
1892 second, NULL);
1893 }
1894 break;
1895 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
1896 {
1897 int i;
1898 int len = get_full_len (*val2->v.val_wide);
1899 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
1900 for (i = len - 1; i >= 0; --i)
1901 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
1902 val2->v.val_wide->elt (i), NULL);
1903 else
1904 for (i = 0; i < len; ++i)
1905 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
1906 val2->v.val_wide->elt (i), NULL);
1907 }
1908 break;
1909 case dw_val_class_addr:
1910 gcc_assert (val1->v.val_unsigned == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
1911 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, val2->v.val_addr, NULL);
1912 break;
1913 default:
1914 gcc_unreachable ();
1915 }
1916 break;
1917 #else
1918 case DW_OP_const2u:
1919 case DW_OP_const2s:
1920 case DW_OP_const4u:
1921 case DW_OP_const4s:
1922 case DW_OP_const8u:
1923 case DW_OP_const8s:
1924 case DW_OP_skip:
1925 case DW_OP_bra:
1926 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
1927 /* We currently don't make any attempt to make sure these are
1928 aligned properly like we do for the main unwind info, so
1929 don't support emitting things larger than a byte if we're
1930 only doing unwinding. */
1931 gcc_unreachable ();
1932 #endif
1933 case DW_OP_const1u:
1934 case DW_OP_const1s:
1935 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
1936 break;
1937 case DW_OP_constu:
1938 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
1939 break;
1940 case DW_OP_consts:
1941 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
1942 break;
1943 case DW_OP_pick:
1944 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
1945 break;
1946 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
1947 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
1948 break;
1949 case DW_OP_breg0:
1950 case DW_OP_breg1:
1951 case DW_OP_breg2:
1952 case DW_OP_breg3:
1953 case DW_OP_breg4:
1954 case DW_OP_breg5:
1955 case DW_OP_breg6:
1956 case DW_OP_breg7:
1957 case DW_OP_breg8:
1958 case DW_OP_breg9:
1959 case DW_OP_breg10:
1960 case DW_OP_breg11:
1961 case DW_OP_breg12:
1962 case DW_OP_breg13:
1963 case DW_OP_breg14:
1964 case DW_OP_breg15:
1965 case DW_OP_breg16:
1966 case DW_OP_breg17:
1967 case DW_OP_breg18:
1968 case DW_OP_breg19:
1969 case DW_OP_breg20:
1970 case DW_OP_breg21:
1971 case DW_OP_breg22:
1972 case DW_OP_breg23:
1973 case DW_OP_breg24:
1974 case DW_OP_breg25:
1975 case DW_OP_breg26:
1976 case DW_OP_breg27:
1977 case DW_OP_breg28:
1978 case DW_OP_breg29:
1979 case DW_OP_breg30:
1980 case DW_OP_breg31:
1981 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
1982 break;
1983 case DW_OP_regx:
1984 {
1985 unsigned r = val1->v.val_unsigned;
1986 if (for_eh_or_skip >= 0)
1987 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, for_eh_or_skip);
1988 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (r)
1989 == size_of_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned));
1990 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
1991 }
1992 break;
1993 case DW_OP_fbreg:
1994 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
1995 break;
1996 case DW_OP_bregx:
1997 {
1998 unsigned r = val1->v.val_unsigned;
1999 if (for_eh_or_skip >= 0)
2000 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, for_eh_or_skip);
2001 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (r)
2002 == size_of_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned));
2003 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2004 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val2->v.val_int, NULL);
2005 }
2006 break;
2007 case DW_OP_piece:
2008 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2009 break;
2010 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
2011 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2012 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val2->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2013 break;
2014 case DW_OP_deref_size:
2015 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
2016 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2017 break;
2018
2019 case DW_OP_addr:
2020 if (loc->dtprel)
2021 {
2022 if (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
2023 {
2024 targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file,
2025 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2026 val1->v.val_addr);
2027 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
2028 }
2029 else
2030 gcc_unreachable ();
2031 }
2032 else
2033 {
2034 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
2035 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, val1->v.val_addr, NULL);
2036 #else
2037 gcc_unreachable ();
2038 #endif
2039 }
2040 break;
2041
2042 case DW_OP_GNU_addr_index:
2043 case DW_OP_GNU_const_index:
2044 gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry->index != NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
2045 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry->index,
2046 "(index into .debug_addr)");
2047 break;
2048
2049 case DW_OP_call2:
2050 case DW_OP_call4:
2051 {
2052 unsigned long die_offset
2053 = get_ref_die_offset (val1->v.val_die_ref.die);
2054 /* Make sure the offset has been computed and that we can encode it as
2055 an operand. */
2056 gcc_assert (die_offset > 0
2057 && die_offset <= (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_call2)
2058 ? 0xffff
2059 : 0xffffffff);
2060 dw2_asm_output_data ((loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_call2) ? 2 : 4,
2061 die_offset, NULL);
2062 }
2063 break;
2064
2065 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
2066 {
2067 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES
2068 + HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / 2 + 2];
2069 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref);
2070 get_ref_die_offset_label (label, val1->v.val_die_ref.die);
2071 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_REF_SIZE, label, debug_info_section, NULL);
2072 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val2->v.val_int, NULL);
2073 }
2074 break;
2075
2076 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
2077 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size_of_locs (val1->v.val_loc), NULL);
2078 output_loc_sequence (val1->v.val_loc, for_eh_or_skip);
2079 break;
2080
2081 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
2082 {
2083 unsigned long o = get_base_type_offset (val1->v.val_die_ref.die), l;
2084 gcc_assert (o);
2085 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (o, NULL);
2086 switch (val2->val_class)
2087 {
2088 case dw_val_class_const:
2089 l = HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
2090 dw2_asm_output_data (1, l, NULL);
2091 dw2_asm_output_data (l, val2->v.val_int, NULL);
2092 break;
2093 case dw_val_class_vec:
2094 {
2095 unsigned int elt_size = val2->v.val_vec.elt_size;
2096 unsigned int len = val2->v.val_vec.length;
2097 unsigned int i;
2098 unsigned char *p;
2099
2100 l = len * elt_size;
2101 dw2_asm_output_data (1, l, NULL);
2102 if (elt_size > sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
2103 {
2104 elt_size /= 2;
2105 len *= 2;
2106 }
2107 for (i = 0, p = val2->v.val_vec.array;
2108 i < len;
2109 i++, p += elt_size)
2110 dw2_asm_output_data (elt_size, extract_int (p, elt_size),
2111 "fp or vector constant word %u", i);
2112 }
2113 break;
2114 case dw_val_class_const_double:
2115 {
2116 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first, second;
2117 l = HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
2118
2119 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 2 * l, NULL);
2120 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
2121 {
2122 first = val2->v.val_double.high;
2123 second = val2->v.val_double.low;
2124 }
2125 else
2126 {
2127 first = val2->v.val_double.low;
2128 second = val2->v.val_double.high;
2129 }
2130 dw2_asm_output_data (l, first, NULL);
2131 dw2_asm_output_data (l, second, NULL);
2132 }
2133 break;
2134 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
2135 {
2136 int i;
2137 int len = get_full_len (*val2->v.val_wide);
2138 l = HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
2139
2140 dw2_asm_output_data (1, len * l, NULL);
2141 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
2142 for (i = len - 1; i >= 0; --i)
2143 dw2_asm_output_data (l, val2->v.val_wide->elt (i), NULL);
2144 else
2145 for (i = 0; i < len; ++i)
2146 dw2_asm_output_data (l, val2->v.val_wide->elt (i), NULL);
2147 }
2148 break;
2149 default:
2150 gcc_unreachable ();
2151 }
2152 }
2153 break;
2154 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
2155 {
2156 unsigned r = val1->v.val_unsigned;
2157 unsigned long o = get_base_type_offset (val2->v.val_die_ref.die);
2158 gcc_assert (o);
2159 if (for_eh_or_skip >= 0)
2160 {
2161 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, for_eh_or_skip);
2162 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (r)
2163 == size_of_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned));
2164 }
2165 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2166 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (o, NULL);
2167 }
2168 break;
2169 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
2170 {
2171 unsigned long o = get_base_type_offset (val2->v.val_die_ref.die);
2172 gcc_assert (o);
2173 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
2174 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (o, NULL);
2175 }
2176 break;
2177 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
2178 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
2179 if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
2180 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
2181 else
2182 {
2183 unsigned long o = get_base_type_offset (val1->v.val_die_ref.die);
2184 gcc_assert (o);
2185 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (o, NULL);
2186 }
2187 break;
2188
2189 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
2190 {
2191 unsigned long o;
2192 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref);
2193 o = get_ref_die_offset (val1->v.val_die_ref.die);
2194 dw2_asm_output_data (4, o, NULL);
2195 }
2196 break;
2197
2198 default:
2199 /* Other codes have no operands. */
2200 break;
2201 }
2202 }
2203
2204 /* Output a sequence of location operations.
2205 The for_eh_or_skip parameter controls whether register numbers are
2206 converted using DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT, which is needed in the case that
2207 hard reg numbers have been processed via DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i.e. for unwind
2208 info). This should be suppressed for the cases that have not been converted
2209 (i.e. symbolic debug info), by setting the parameter < 0. See PR47324. */
2210
2211 void
2212 output_loc_sequence (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, int for_eh_or_skip)
2213 {
2214 for (; loc != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
2215 {
2216 enum dwarf_location_atom opc = loc->dw_loc_opc;
2217 /* Output the opcode. */
2218 if (for_eh_or_skip >= 0
2219 && opc >= DW_OP_breg0 && opc <= DW_OP_breg31)
2220 {
2221 unsigned r = (opc - DW_OP_breg0);
2222 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, for_eh_or_skip);
2223 gcc_assert (r <= 31);
2224 opc = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_breg0 + r);
2225 }
2226 else if (for_eh_or_skip >= 0
2227 && opc >= DW_OP_reg0 && opc <= DW_OP_reg31)
2228 {
2229 unsigned r = (opc - DW_OP_reg0);
2230 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, for_eh_or_skip);
2231 gcc_assert (r <= 31);
2232 opc = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_reg0 + r);
2233 }
2234
2235 dw2_asm_output_data (1, opc,
2236 "%s", dwarf_stack_op_name (opc));
2237
2238 /* Output the operand(s) (if any). */
2239 output_loc_operands (loc, for_eh_or_skip);
2240 }
2241 }
2242
2243 /* Output location description stack opcode's operands (if any).
2244 The output is single bytes on a line, suitable for .cfi_escape. */
2245
2246 static void
2247 output_loc_operands_raw (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
2248 {
2249 dw_val_ref val1 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1;
2250 dw_val_ref val2 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2;
2251
2252 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
2253 {
2254 case DW_OP_addr:
2255 case DW_OP_GNU_addr_index:
2256 case DW_OP_GNU_const_index:
2257 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
2258 /* We cannot output addresses in .cfi_escape, only bytes. */
2259 gcc_unreachable ();
2260
2261 case DW_OP_const1u:
2262 case DW_OP_const1s:
2263 case DW_OP_pick:
2264 case DW_OP_deref_size:
2265 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
2266 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2267 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (1, val1->v.val_int);
2268 break;
2269
2270 case DW_OP_const2u:
2271 case DW_OP_const2s:
2272 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2273 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (2, val1->v.val_int);
2274 break;
2275
2276 case DW_OP_const4u:
2277 case DW_OP_const4s:
2278 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2279 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (4, val1->v.val_int);
2280 break;
2281
2282 case DW_OP_const8u:
2283 case DW_OP_const8s:
2284 gcc_assert (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64);
2285 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2286 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (8, val1->v.val_int);
2287 break;
2288
2289 case DW_OP_skip:
2290 case DW_OP_bra:
2291 {
2292 int offset;
2293
2294 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
2295 offset = val1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr - (loc->dw_loc_addr + 3);
2296
2297 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2298 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (2, offset);
2299 }
2300 break;
2301
2302 case DW_OP_regx:
2303 {
2304 unsigned r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (val1->v.val_unsigned, 1);
2305 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (r)
2306 == size_of_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned));
2307 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2308 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (r);
2309 }
2310 break;
2311
2312 case DW_OP_constu:
2313 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
2314 case DW_OP_piece:
2315 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2316 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (val1->v.val_unsigned);
2317 break;
2318
2319 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
2320 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2321 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (val1->v.val_unsigned);
2322 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (val2->v.val_unsigned);
2323 break;
2324
2325 case DW_OP_consts:
2326 case DW_OP_breg0:
2327 case DW_OP_breg1:
2328 case DW_OP_breg2:
2329 case DW_OP_breg3:
2330 case DW_OP_breg4:
2331 case DW_OP_breg5:
2332 case DW_OP_breg6:
2333 case DW_OP_breg7:
2334 case DW_OP_breg8:
2335 case DW_OP_breg9:
2336 case DW_OP_breg10:
2337 case DW_OP_breg11:
2338 case DW_OP_breg12:
2339 case DW_OP_breg13:
2340 case DW_OP_breg14:
2341 case DW_OP_breg15:
2342 case DW_OP_breg16:
2343 case DW_OP_breg17:
2344 case DW_OP_breg18:
2345 case DW_OP_breg19:
2346 case DW_OP_breg20:
2347 case DW_OP_breg21:
2348 case DW_OP_breg22:
2349 case DW_OP_breg23:
2350 case DW_OP_breg24:
2351 case DW_OP_breg25:
2352 case DW_OP_breg26:
2353 case DW_OP_breg27:
2354 case DW_OP_breg28:
2355 case DW_OP_breg29:
2356 case DW_OP_breg30:
2357 case DW_OP_breg31:
2358 case DW_OP_fbreg:
2359 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2360 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128_raw (val1->v.val_int);
2361 break;
2362
2363 case DW_OP_bregx:
2364 {
2365 unsigned r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (val1->v.val_unsigned, 1);
2366 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (r)
2367 == size_of_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned));
2368 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2369 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (r);
2370 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2371 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128_raw (val2->v.val_int);
2372 }
2373 break;
2374
2375 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
2376 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
2377 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
2378 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
2379 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
2380 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
2381 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
2382 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
2383 gcc_unreachable ();
2384 break;
2385
2386 default:
2387 /* Other codes have no operands. */
2388 break;
2389 }
2390 }
2391
2392 void
2393 output_loc_sequence_raw (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
2394 {
2395 while (1)
2396 {
2397 enum dwarf_location_atom opc = loc->dw_loc_opc;
2398 /* Output the opcode. */
2399 if (opc >= DW_OP_breg0 && opc <= DW_OP_breg31)
2400 {
2401 unsigned r = (opc - DW_OP_breg0);
2402 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, 1);
2403 gcc_assert (r <= 31);
2404 opc = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_breg0 + r);
2405 }
2406 else if (opc >= DW_OP_reg0 && opc <= DW_OP_reg31)
2407 {
2408 unsigned r = (opc - DW_OP_reg0);
2409 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, 1);
2410 gcc_assert (r <= 31);
2411 opc = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_reg0 + r);
2412 }
2413 /* Output the opcode. */
2414 fprintf (asm_out_file, "%#x", opc);
2415 output_loc_operands_raw (loc);
2416
2417 if (!loc->dw_loc_next)
2418 break;
2419 loc = loc->dw_loc_next;
2420
2421 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
2422 }
2423 }
2424
2425 /* This function builds a dwarf location descriptor sequence from a
2426 dw_cfa_location, adding the given OFFSET to the result of the
2427 expression. */
2428
2429 struct dw_loc_descr_node *
2430 build_cfa_loc (dw_cfa_location *cfa, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
2431 {
2432 struct dw_loc_descr_node *head, *tmp;
2433
2434 offset += cfa->offset;
2435
2436 if (cfa->indirect)
2437 {
2438 head = new_reg_loc_descr (cfa->reg, cfa->base_offset);
2439 head->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
2440 head->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry = NULL;
2441 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
2442 add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
2443 if (offset != 0)
2444 {
2445 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, offset, 0);
2446 add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
2447 }
2448 }
2449 else
2450 head = new_reg_loc_descr (cfa->reg, offset);
2451
2452 return head;
2453 }
2454
2455 /* This function builds a dwarf location descriptor sequence for
2456 the address at OFFSET from the CFA when stack is aligned to
2457 ALIGNMENT byte. */
2458
2459 struct dw_loc_descr_node *
2460 build_cfa_aligned_loc (dw_cfa_location *cfa,
2461 HOST_WIDE_INT offset, HOST_WIDE_INT alignment)
2462 {
2463 struct dw_loc_descr_node *head;
2464 unsigned int dwarf_fp
2465 = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
2466
2467 /* When CFA is defined as FP+OFFSET, emulate stack alignment. */
2468 if (cfa->reg == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM && cfa->indirect == 0)
2469 {
2470 head = new_reg_loc_descr (dwarf_fp, 0);
2471 add_loc_descr (&head, int_loc_descriptor (alignment));
2472 add_loc_descr (&head, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
2473 loc_descr_plus_const (&head, offset);
2474 }
2475 else
2476 head = new_reg_loc_descr (dwarf_fp, offset);
2477 return head;
2478 }
2479 \f
2480 /* And now, the support for symbolic debugging information. */
2481
2482 /* .debug_str support. */
2483
2484 static void dwarf2out_init (const char *);
2485 static void dwarf2out_finish (const char *);
2486 static void dwarf2out_early_finish (void);
2487 static void dwarf2out_assembly_start (void);
2488 static void dwarf2out_define (unsigned int, const char *);
2489 static void dwarf2out_undef (unsigned int, const char *);
2490 static void dwarf2out_start_source_file (unsigned, const char *);
2491 static void dwarf2out_end_source_file (unsigned);
2492 static void dwarf2out_function_decl (tree);
2493 static void dwarf2out_begin_block (unsigned, unsigned);
2494 static void dwarf2out_end_block (unsigned, unsigned);
2495 static bool dwarf2out_ignore_block (const_tree);
2496 static void dwarf2out_early_global_decl (tree);
2497 static void dwarf2out_late_global_decl (tree);
2498 static void dwarf2out_type_decl (tree, int);
2499 static void dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl (tree, tree, tree, bool);
2500 static void dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (tree, tree, tree,
2501 dw_die_ref);
2502 static void dwarf2out_abstract_function (tree);
2503 static void dwarf2out_var_location (rtx_insn *);
2504 static void dwarf2out_size_function (tree);
2505 static void dwarf2out_begin_function (tree);
2506 static void dwarf2out_end_function (unsigned int);
2507 static void dwarf2out_register_main_translation_unit (tree unit);
2508 static void dwarf2out_set_name (tree, tree);
2509
2510 /* The debug hooks structure. */
2511
2512 const struct gcc_debug_hooks dwarf2_debug_hooks =
2513 {
2514 dwarf2out_init,
2515 dwarf2out_finish,
2516 dwarf2out_early_finish,
2517 dwarf2out_assembly_start,
2518 dwarf2out_define,
2519 dwarf2out_undef,
2520 dwarf2out_start_source_file,
2521 dwarf2out_end_source_file,
2522 dwarf2out_begin_block,
2523 dwarf2out_end_block,
2524 dwarf2out_ignore_block,
2525 dwarf2out_source_line,
2526 dwarf2out_begin_prologue,
2527 #if VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
2528 dwarf2out_vms_end_prologue,
2529 dwarf2out_vms_begin_epilogue,
2530 #else
2531 debug_nothing_int_charstar,
2532 debug_nothing_int_charstar,
2533 #endif
2534 dwarf2out_end_epilogue,
2535 dwarf2out_begin_function,
2536 dwarf2out_end_function, /* end_function */
2537 dwarf2out_register_main_translation_unit,
2538 dwarf2out_function_decl, /* function_decl */
2539 dwarf2out_early_global_decl,
2540 dwarf2out_late_global_decl,
2541 dwarf2out_type_decl, /* type_decl */
2542 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl,
2543 debug_nothing_tree, /* deferred_inline_function */
2544 /* The DWARF 2 backend tries to reduce debugging bloat by not
2545 emitting the abstract description of inline functions until
2546 something tries to reference them. */
2547 dwarf2out_abstract_function, /* outlining_inline_function */
2548 debug_nothing_rtx_code_label, /* label */
2549 debug_nothing_int, /* handle_pch */
2550 dwarf2out_var_location,
2551 dwarf2out_size_function, /* size_function */
2552 dwarf2out_switch_text_section,
2553 dwarf2out_set_name,
2554 1, /* start_end_main_source_file */
2555 TYPE_SYMTAB_IS_DIE /* tree_type_symtab_field */
2556 };
2557
2558 const struct gcc_debug_hooks dwarf2_lineno_debug_hooks =
2559 {
2560 dwarf2out_init,
2561 debug_nothing_charstar,
2562 debug_nothing_void,
2563 debug_nothing_void,
2564 debug_nothing_int_charstar,
2565 debug_nothing_int_charstar,
2566 debug_nothing_int_charstar,
2567 debug_nothing_int,
2568 debug_nothing_int_int, /* begin_block */
2569 debug_nothing_int_int, /* end_block */
2570 debug_true_const_tree, /* ignore_block */
2571 dwarf2out_source_line, /* source_line */
2572 debug_nothing_int_charstar, /* begin_prologue */
2573 debug_nothing_int_charstar, /* end_prologue */
2574 debug_nothing_int_charstar, /* begin_epilogue */
2575 debug_nothing_int_charstar, /* end_epilogue */
2576 debug_nothing_tree, /* begin_function */
2577 debug_nothing_int, /* end_function */
2578 debug_nothing_tree, /* register_main_translation_unit */
2579 debug_nothing_tree, /* function_decl */
2580 debug_nothing_tree, /* early_global_decl */
2581 debug_nothing_tree, /* late_global_decl */
2582 debug_nothing_tree_int, /* type_decl */
2583 debug_nothing_tree_tree_tree_bool, /* imported_module_or_decl */
2584 debug_nothing_tree, /* deferred_inline_function */
2585 debug_nothing_tree, /* outlining_inline_function */
2586 debug_nothing_rtx_code_label, /* label */
2587 debug_nothing_int, /* handle_pch */
2588 debug_nothing_rtx_insn, /* var_location */
2589 debug_nothing_tree, /* size_function */
2590 debug_nothing_void, /* switch_text_section */
2591 debug_nothing_tree_tree, /* set_name */
2592 0, /* start_end_main_source_file */
2593 TYPE_SYMTAB_IS_ADDRESS /* tree_type_symtab_field */
2594 };
2595 \f
2596 /* NOTE: In the comments in this file, many references are made to
2597 "Debugging Information Entries". This term is abbreviated as `DIE'
2598 throughout the remainder of this file. */
2599
2600 /* An internal representation of the DWARF output is built, and then
2601 walked to generate the DWARF debugging info. The walk of the internal
2602 representation is done after the entire program has been compiled.
2603 The types below are used to describe the internal representation. */
2604
2605 /* Whether to put type DIEs into their own section .debug_types instead
2606 of making them part of the .debug_info section. Only supported for
2607 Dwarf V4 or higher and the user didn't disable them through
2608 -fno-debug-types-section. It is more efficient to put them in a
2609 separate comdat sections since the linker will then be able to
2610 remove duplicates. But not all tools support .debug_types sections
2611 yet. */
2612
2613 #define use_debug_types (dwarf_version >= 4 && flag_debug_types_section)
2614
2615 /* Various DIE's use offsets relative to the beginning of the
2616 .debug_info section to refer to each other. */
2617
2618 typedef long int dw_offset;
2619
2620 struct comdat_type_node;
2621
2622 /* The entries in the line_info table more-or-less mirror the opcodes
2623 that are used in the real dwarf line table. Arrays of these entries
2624 are collected per section when DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO is not
2625 supported. */
2626
2627 enum dw_line_info_opcode {
2628 /* Emit DW_LNE_set_address; the operand is the label index. */
2629 LI_set_address,
2630
2631 /* Emit a row to the matrix with the given line. This may be done
2632 via any combination of DW_LNS_copy, DW_LNS_advance_line, and
2633 special opcodes. */
2634 LI_set_line,
2635
2636 /* Emit a DW_LNS_set_file. */
2637 LI_set_file,
2638
2639 /* Emit a DW_LNS_set_column. */
2640 LI_set_column,
2641
2642 /* Emit a DW_LNS_negate_stmt; the operand is ignored. */
2643 LI_negate_stmt,
2644
2645 /* Emit a DW_LNS_set_prologue_end/epilogue_begin; the operand is ignored. */
2646 LI_set_prologue_end,
2647 LI_set_epilogue_begin,
2648
2649 /* Emit a DW_LNE_set_discriminator. */
2650 LI_set_discriminator
2651 };
2652
2653 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_line_info_struct {
2654 enum dw_line_info_opcode opcode;
2655 unsigned int val;
2656 } dw_line_info_entry;
2657
2658
2659 struct GTY(()) dw_line_info_table {
2660 /* The label that marks the end of this section. */
2661 const char *end_label;
2662
2663 /* The values for the last row of the matrix, as collected in the table.
2664 These are used to minimize the changes to the next row. */
2665 unsigned int file_num;
2666 unsigned int line_num;
2667 unsigned int column_num;
2668 int discrim_num;
2669 bool is_stmt;
2670 bool in_use;
2671
2672 vec<dw_line_info_entry, va_gc> *entries;
2673 };
2674
2675
2676 /* Each DIE attribute has a field specifying the attribute kind,
2677 a link to the next attribute in the chain, and an attribute value.
2678 Attributes are typically linked below the DIE they modify. */
2679
2680 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_attr_struct {
2681 enum dwarf_attribute dw_attr;
2682 dw_val_node dw_attr_val;
2683 }
2684 dw_attr_node;
2685
2686
2687 /* The Debugging Information Entry (DIE) structure. DIEs form a tree.
2688 The children of each node form a circular list linked by
2689 die_sib. die_child points to the node *before* the "first" child node. */
2690
2691 typedef struct GTY((chain_circular ("%h.die_sib"), for_user)) die_struct {
2692 union die_symbol_or_type_node
2693 {
2694 const char * GTY ((tag ("0"))) die_symbol;
2695 comdat_type_node *GTY ((tag ("1"))) die_type_node;
2696 }
2697 GTY ((desc ("%0.comdat_type_p"))) die_id;
2698 vec<dw_attr_node, va_gc> *die_attr;
2699 dw_die_ref die_parent;
2700 dw_die_ref die_child;
2701 dw_die_ref die_sib;
2702 dw_die_ref die_definition; /* ref from a specification to its definition */
2703 dw_offset die_offset;
2704 unsigned long die_abbrev;
2705 int die_mark;
2706 unsigned int decl_id;
2707 enum dwarf_tag die_tag;
2708 /* Die is used and must not be pruned as unused. */
2709 BOOL_BITFIELD die_perennial_p : 1;
2710 BOOL_BITFIELD comdat_type_p : 1; /* DIE has a type signature */
2711 /* Lots of spare bits. */
2712 }
2713 die_node;
2714
2715 /* Set to TRUE while dwarf2out_early_global_decl is running. */
2716 static bool early_dwarf;
2717 struct set_early_dwarf {
2718 bool saved;
2719 set_early_dwarf () : saved(early_dwarf) { early_dwarf = true; }
2720 ~set_early_dwarf () { early_dwarf = saved; }
2721 };
2722
2723 /* Evaluate 'expr' while 'c' is set to each child of DIE in order. */
2724 #define FOR_EACH_CHILD(die, c, expr) do { \
2725 c = die->die_child; \
2726 if (c) do { \
2727 c = c->die_sib; \
2728 expr; \
2729 } while (c != die->die_child); \
2730 } while (0)
2731
2732 /* The pubname structure */
2733
2734 typedef struct GTY(()) pubname_struct {
2735 dw_die_ref die;
2736 const char *name;
2737 }
2738 pubname_entry;
2739
2740
2741 struct GTY(()) dw_ranges {
2742 /* If this is positive, it's a block number, otherwise it's a
2743 bitwise-negated index into dw_ranges_by_label. */
2744 int num;
2745 };
2746
2747 /* A structure to hold a macinfo entry. */
2748
2749 typedef struct GTY(()) macinfo_struct {
2750 unsigned char code;
2751 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT lineno;
2752 const char *info;
2753 }
2754 macinfo_entry;
2755
2756
2757 struct GTY(()) dw_ranges_by_label {
2758 const char *begin;
2759 const char *end;
2760 };
2761
2762 /* The comdat type node structure. */
2763 struct GTY(()) comdat_type_node
2764 {
2765 dw_die_ref root_die;
2766 dw_die_ref type_die;
2767 dw_die_ref skeleton_die;
2768 char signature[DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE];
2769 comdat_type_node *next;
2770 };
2771
2772 /* A list of DIEs for which we can't determine ancestry (parent_die
2773 field) just yet. Later in dwarf2out_finish we will fill in the
2774 missing bits. */
2775 typedef struct GTY(()) limbo_die_struct {
2776 dw_die_ref die;
2777 /* The tree for which this DIE was created. We use this to
2778 determine ancestry later. */
2779 tree created_for;
2780 struct limbo_die_struct *next;
2781 }
2782 limbo_die_node;
2783
2784 typedef struct skeleton_chain_struct
2785 {
2786 dw_die_ref old_die;
2787 dw_die_ref new_die;
2788 struct skeleton_chain_struct *parent;
2789 }
2790 skeleton_chain_node;
2791
2792 /* Define a macro which returns nonzero for a TYPE_DECL which was
2793 implicitly generated for a type.
2794
2795 Note that, unlike the C front-end (which generates a NULL named
2796 TYPE_DECL node for each complete tagged type, each array type,
2797 and each function type node created) the C++ front-end generates
2798 a _named_ TYPE_DECL node for each tagged type node created.
2799 These TYPE_DECLs have DECL_ARTIFICIAL set, so we know not to
2800 generate a DW_TAG_typedef DIE for them. Likewise with the Ada
2801 front-end, but for each type, tagged or not. */
2802
2803 #define TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB(decl) \
2804 (DECL_NAME (decl) == NULL_TREE \
2805 || (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl) \
2806 && ((decl == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl))) \
2807 /* This is necessary for stub decls that \
2808 appear in nested inline functions. */ \
2809 || (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) != NULL_TREE \
2810 && (decl_ultimate_origin (decl) \
2811 == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl)))))))
2812
2813 /* Information concerning the compilation unit's programming
2814 language, and compiler version. */
2815
2816 /* Fixed size portion of the DWARF compilation unit header. */
2817 #define DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE \
2818 (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 3)
2819
2820 /* Fixed size portion of the DWARF comdat type unit header. */
2821 #define DWARF_COMDAT_TYPE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE \
2822 (DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE + DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE \
2823 + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
2824
2825 /* Fixed size portion of public names info. */
2826 #define DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE (2 * DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 2)
2827
2828 /* Fixed size portion of the address range info. */
2829 #define DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE \
2830 (DWARF_ROUND (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, \
2831 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
2832 - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE)
2833
2834 /* Size of padding portion in the address range info. It must be
2835 aligned to twice the pointer size. */
2836 #define DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE \
2837 (DWARF_ROUND (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, \
2838 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
2839 - (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4))
2840
2841 /* Use assembler line directives if available. */
2842 #ifndef DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
2843 #ifdef HAVE_AS_DWARF2_DEBUG_LINE
2844 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 1
2845 #else
2846 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 0
2847 #endif
2848 #endif
2849
2850 /* Minimum line offset in a special line info. opcode.
2851 This value was chosen to give a reasonable range of values. */
2852 #define DWARF_LINE_BASE -10
2853
2854 /* First special line opcode - leave room for the standard opcodes. */
2855 #define DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE ((int)DW_LNS_set_isa + 1)
2856
2857 /* Range of line offsets in a special line info. opcode. */
2858 #define DWARF_LINE_RANGE (254-DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE+1)
2859
2860 /* Flag that indicates the initial value of the is_stmt_start flag.
2861 In the present implementation, we do not mark any lines as
2862 the beginning of a source statement, because that information
2863 is not made available by the GCC front-end. */
2864 #define DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START 1
2865
2866 /* Maximum number of operations per instruction bundle. */
2867 #ifndef DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_MAX_OPS_PER_INSN
2868 #define DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_MAX_OPS_PER_INSN 1
2869 #endif
2870
2871 /* This location is used by calc_die_sizes() to keep track
2872 the offset of each DIE within the .debug_info section. */
2873 static unsigned long next_die_offset;
2874
2875 /* Record the root of the DIE's built for the current compilation unit. */
2876 static GTY(()) dw_die_ref single_comp_unit_die;
2877
2878 /* A list of type DIEs that have been separated into comdat sections. */
2879 static GTY(()) comdat_type_node *comdat_type_list;
2880
2881 /* A list of DIEs with a NULL parent waiting to be relocated. */
2882 static GTY(()) limbo_die_node *limbo_die_list;
2883
2884 /* A list of DIEs for which we may have to generate
2885 DW_AT_{,MIPS_}linkage_name once their DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAMEs are set. */
2886 static GTY(()) limbo_die_node *deferred_asm_name;
2887
2888 struct dwarf_file_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<dwarf_file_data>
2889 {
2890 typedef const char *compare_type;
2891
2892 static hashval_t hash (dwarf_file_data *);
2893 static bool equal (dwarf_file_data *, const char *);
2894 };
2895
2896 /* Filenames referenced by this compilation unit. */
2897 static GTY(()) hash_table<dwarf_file_hasher> *file_table;
2898
2899 struct decl_die_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<die_node>
2900 {
2901 typedef tree compare_type;
2902
2903 static hashval_t hash (die_node *);
2904 static bool equal (die_node *, tree);
2905 };
2906 /* A hash table of references to DIE's that describe declarations.
2907 The key is a DECL_UID() which is a unique number identifying each decl. */
2908 static GTY (()) hash_table<decl_die_hasher> *decl_die_table;
2909
2910 struct block_die_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<die_struct>
2911 {
2912 static hashval_t hash (die_struct *);
2913 static bool equal (die_struct *, die_struct *);
2914 };
2915
2916 /* A hash table of references to DIE's that describe COMMON blocks.
2917 The key is DECL_UID() ^ die_parent. */
2918 static GTY (()) hash_table<block_die_hasher> *common_block_die_table;
2919
2920 typedef struct GTY(()) die_arg_entry_struct {
2921 dw_die_ref die;
2922 tree arg;
2923 } die_arg_entry;
2924
2925
2926 /* Node of the variable location list. */
2927 struct GTY ((chain_next ("%h.next"))) var_loc_node {
2928 /* Either NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION, or, for SRA optimized variables,
2929 EXPR_LIST chain. For small bitsizes, bitsize is encoded
2930 in mode of the EXPR_LIST node and first EXPR_LIST operand
2931 is either NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION for a piece with a known
2932 location or NULL for padding. For larger bitsizes,
2933 mode is 0 and first operand is a CONCAT with bitsize
2934 as first CONCAT operand and NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION resp.
2935 NULL as second operand. */
2936 rtx GTY (()) loc;
2937 const char * GTY (()) label;
2938 struct var_loc_node * GTY (()) next;
2939 };
2940
2941 /* Variable location list. */
2942 struct GTY ((for_user)) var_loc_list_def {
2943 struct var_loc_node * GTY (()) first;
2944
2945 /* Pointer to the last but one or last element of the
2946 chained list. If the list is empty, both first and
2947 last are NULL, if the list contains just one node
2948 or the last node certainly is not redundant, it points
2949 to the last node, otherwise points to the last but one.
2950 Do not mark it for GC because it is marked through the chain. */
2951 struct var_loc_node * GTY ((skip ("%h"))) last;
2952
2953 /* Pointer to the last element before section switch,
2954 if NULL, either sections weren't switched or first
2955 is after section switch. */
2956 struct var_loc_node * GTY ((skip ("%h"))) last_before_switch;
2957
2958 /* DECL_UID of the variable decl. */
2959 unsigned int decl_id;
2960 };
2961 typedef struct var_loc_list_def var_loc_list;
2962
2963 /* Call argument location list. */
2964 struct GTY ((chain_next ("%h.next"))) call_arg_loc_node {
2965 rtx GTY (()) call_arg_loc_note;
2966 const char * GTY (()) label;
2967 tree GTY (()) block;
2968 bool tail_call_p;
2969 rtx GTY (()) symbol_ref;
2970 struct call_arg_loc_node * GTY (()) next;
2971 };
2972
2973
2974 struct decl_loc_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<var_loc_list>
2975 {
2976 typedef const_tree compare_type;
2977
2978 static hashval_t hash (var_loc_list *);
2979 static bool equal (var_loc_list *, const_tree);
2980 };
2981
2982 /* Table of decl location linked lists. */
2983 static GTY (()) hash_table<decl_loc_hasher> *decl_loc_table;
2984
2985 /* Head and tail of call_arg_loc chain. */
2986 static GTY (()) struct call_arg_loc_node *call_arg_locations;
2987 static struct call_arg_loc_node *call_arg_loc_last;
2988
2989 /* Number of call sites in the current function. */
2990 static int call_site_count = -1;
2991 /* Number of tail call sites in the current function. */
2992 static int tail_call_site_count = -1;
2993
2994 /* A cached location list. */
2995 struct GTY ((for_user)) cached_dw_loc_list_def {
2996 /* The DECL_UID of the decl that this entry describes. */
2997 unsigned int decl_id;
2998
2999 /* The cached location list. */
3000 dw_loc_list_ref loc_list;
3001 };
3002 typedef struct cached_dw_loc_list_def cached_dw_loc_list;
3003
3004 struct dw_loc_list_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<cached_dw_loc_list>
3005 {
3006
3007 typedef const_tree compare_type;
3008
3009 static hashval_t hash (cached_dw_loc_list *);
3010 static bool equal (cached_dw_loc_list *, const_tree);
3011 };
3012
3013 /* Table of cached location lists. */
3014 static GTY (()) hash_table<dw_loc_list_hasher> *cached_dw_loc_list_table;
3015
3016 /* A pointer to the base of a list of references to DIE's that
3017 are uniquely identified by their tag, presence/absence of
3018 children DIE's, and list of attribute/value pairs. */
3019 static GTY((length ("abbrev_die_table_allocated")))
3020 dw_die_ref *abbrev_die_table;
3021
3022 /* Number of elements currently allocated for abbrev_die_table. */
3023 static GTY(()) unsigned abbrev_die_table_allocated;
3024
3025 /* Number of elements in abbrev_die_table currently in use. */
3026 static GTY(()) unsigned abbrev_die_table_in_use;
3027
3028 /* A hash map to remember the stack usage for DWARF procedures. The value
3029 stored is the stack size difference between before the DWARF procedure
3030 invokation and after it returned. In other words, for a DWARF procedure
3031 that consumes N stack slots and that pushes M ones, this stores M - N. */
3032 static hash_map<dw_die_ref, int> *dwarf_proc_stack_usage_map;
3033
3034 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3035 abbrev_die_table. */
3036 #define ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT 256
3037
3038 /* A global counter for generating labels for line number data. */
3039 static unsigned int line_info_label_num;
3040
3041 /* The current table to which we should emit line number information
3042 for the current function. This will be set up at the beginning of
3043 assembly for the function. */
3044 static dw_line_info_table *cur_line_info_table;
3045
3046 /* The two default tables of line number info. */
3047 static GTY(()) dw_line_info_table *text_section_line_info;
3048 static GTY(()) dw_line_info_table *cold_text_section_line_info;
3049
3050 /* The set of all non-default tables of line number info. */
3051 static GTY(()) vec<dw_line_info_table *, va_gc> *separate_line_info;
3052
3053 /* A flag to tell pubnames/types export if there is an info section to
3054 refer to. */
3055 static bool info_section_emitted;
3056
3057 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of publicly
3058 accessible names. */
3059 static GTY (()) vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *pubname_table;
3060
3061 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of publicly
3062 accessible types. */
3063 static GTY (()) vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *pubtype_table;
3064
3065 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of macro
3066 defines/undefines (and file start/end markers). */
3067 static GTY (()) vec<macinfo_entry, va_gc> *macinfo_table;
3068
3069 /* True if .debug_macinfo or .debug_macros section is going to be
3070 emitted. */
3071 #define have_macinfo \
3072 ((!XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO || HAVE_XCOFF_DWARF_EXTRAS) \
3073 && debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE \
3074 && !macinfo_table->is_empty ())
3075
3076 /* Array of dies for which we should generate .debug_ranges info. */
3077 static GTY ((length ("ranges_table_allocated"))) dw_ranges *ranges_table;
3078
3079 /* Number of elements currently allocated for ranges_table. */
3080 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_table_allocated;
3081
3082 /* Number of elements in ranges_table currently in use. */
3083 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_table_in_use;
3084
3085 /* Array of pairs of labels referenced in ranges_table. */
3086 static GTY ((length ("ranges_by_label_allocated")))
3087 dw_ranges_by_label *ranges_by_label;
3088
3089 /* Number of elements currently allocated for ranges_by_label. */
3090 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_by_label_allocated;
3091
3092 /* Number of elements in ranges_by_label currently in use. */
3093 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_by_label_in_use;
3094
3095 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3096 ranges_table. */
3097 #define RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
3098
3099 /* Whether we have location lists that need outputting */
3100 static GTY(()) bool have_location_lists;
3101
3102 /* Unique label counter. */
3103 static GTY(()) unsigned int loclabel_num;
3104
3105 /* Unique label counter for point-of-call tables. */
3106 static GTY(()) unsigned int poc_label_num;
3107
3108 /* The last file entry emitted by maybe_emit_file(). */
3109 static GTY(()) struct dwarf_file_data * last_emitted_file;
3110
3111 /* Number of internal labels generated by gen_internal_sym(). */
3112 static GTY(()) int label_num;
3113
3114 static GTY(()) vec<die_arg_entry, va_gc> *tmpl_value_parm_die_table;
3115
3116 /* Instances of generic types for which we need to generate debug
3117 info that describe their generic parameters and arguments. That
3118 generation needs to happen once all types are properly laid out so
3119 we do it at the end of compilation. */
3120 static GTY(()) vec<tree, va_gc> *generic_type_instances;
3121
3122 /* Offset from the "steady-state frame pointer" to the frame base,
3123 within the current function. */
3124 static HOST_WIDE_INT frame_pointer_fb_offset;
3125 static bool frame_pointer_fb_offset_valid;
3126
3127 static vec<dw_die_ref> base_types;
3128
3129 /* Flags to represent a set of attribute classes for attributes that represent
3130 a scalar value (bounds, pointers, ...). */
3131 enum dw_scalar_form
3132 {
3133 dw_scalar_form_constant = 0x01,
3134 dw_scalar_form_exprloc = 0x02,
3135 dw_scalar_form_reference = 0x04
3136 };
3137
3138 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file. */
3139
3140 static int is_pseudo_reg (const_rtx);
3141 static tree type_main_variant (tree);
3142 static int is_tagged_type (const_tree);
3143 static const char *dwarf_tag_name (unsigned);
3144 static const char *dwarf_attr_name (unsigned);
3145 static const char *dwarf_form_name (unsigned);
3146 static tree decl_ultimate_origin (const_tree);
3147 static tree decl_class_context (tree);
3148 static void add_dwarf_attr (dw_die_ref, dw_attr_node *);
3149 static inline enum dw_val_class AT_class (dw_attr_node *);
3150 static inline unsigned int AT_index (dw_attr_node *);
3151 static void add_AT_flag (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned);
3152 static inline unsigned AT_flag (dw_attr_node *);
3153 static void add_AT_int (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, HOST_WIDE_INT);
3154 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT AT_int (dw_attr_node *);
3155 static void add_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
3156 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT AT_unsigned (dw_attr_node *);
3157 static void add_AT_double (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3158 HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
3159 static inline void add_AT_vec (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned int,
3160 unsigned int, unsigned char *);
3161 static void add_AT_data8 (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned char *);
3162 static void add_AT_string (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
3163 static inline const char *AT_string (dw_attr_node *);
3164 static enum dwarf_form AT_string_form (dw_attr_node *);
3165 static void add_AT_die_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, dw_die_ref);
3166 static void add_AT_specification (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
3167 static inline dw_die_ref AT_ref (dw_attr_node *);
3168 static inline int AT_ref_external (dw_attr_node *);
3169 static inline void set_AT_ref_external (dw_attr_node *, int);
3170 static void add_AT_fde_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned);
3171 static void add_AT_loc (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, dw_loc_descr_ref);
3172 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref AT_loc (dw_attr_node *);
3173 static void add_AT_loc_list (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3174 dw_loc_list_ref);
3175 static inline dw_loc_list_ref AT_loc_list (dw_attr_node *);
3176 static addr_table_entry *add_addr_table_entry (void *, enum ate_kind);
3177 static void remove_addr_table_entry (addr_table_entry *);
3178 static void add_AT_addr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, rtx, bool);
3179 static inline rtx AT_addr (dw_attr_node *);
3180 static void add_AT_lbl_id (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
3181 static void add_AT_lineptr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
3182 static void add_AT_macptr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
3183 static void add_AT_offset (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3184 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
3185 static void add_AT_range_list (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3186 unsigned long, bool);
3187 static inline const char *AT_lbl (dw_attr_node *);
3188 static dw_attr_node *get_AT (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3189 static const char *get_AT_low_pc (dw_die_ref);
3190 static const char *get_AT_hi_pc (dw_die_ref);
3191 static const char *get_AT_string (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3192 static int get_AT_flag (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3193 static unsigned get_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3194 static inline dw_die_ref get_AT_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3195 static bool is_cxx (void);
3196 static bool is_fortran (void);
3197 static bool is_ada (void);
3198 static bool remove_AT (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
3199 static void remove_child_TAG (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_tag);
3200 static void add_child_die (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
3201 static dw_die_ref new_die (enum dwarf_tag, dw_die_ref, tree);
3202 static dw_die_ref lookup_type_die (tree);
3203 static dw_die_ref strip_naming_typedef (tree, dw_die_ref);
3204 static dw_die_ref lookup_type_die_strip_naming_typedef (tree);
3205 static void equate_type_number_to_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3206 static dw_die_ref lookup_decl_die (tree);
3207 static var_loc_list *lookup_decl_loc (const_tree);
3208 static void equate_decl_number_to_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3209 static struct var_loc_node *add_var_loc_to_decl (tree, rtx, const char *);
3210 static void print_spaces (FILE *);
3211 static void print_die (dw_die_ref, FILE *);
3212 static dw_die_ref push_new_compile_unit (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
3213 static dw_die_ref pop_compile_unit (dw_die_ref);
3214 static void loc_checksum (dw_loc_descr_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
3215 static void attr_checksum (dw_attr_node *, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
3216 static void die_checksum (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
3217 static void checksum_sleb128 (HOST_WIDE_INT, struct md5_ctx *);
3218 static void checksum_uleb128 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, struct md5_ctx *);
3219 static void loc_checksum_ordered (dw_loc_descr_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
3220 static void attr_checksum_ordered (enum dwarf_tag, dw_attr_node *,
3221 struct md5_ctx *, int *);
3222 struct checksum_attributes;
3223 static void collect_checksum_attributes (struct checksum_attributes *, dw_die_ref);
3224 static void die_checksum_ordered (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
3225 static void checksum_die_context (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
3226 static void generate_type_signature (dw_die_ref, comdat_type_node *);
3227 static int same_loc_p (dw_loc_descr_ref, dw_loc_descr_ref, int *);
3228 static int same_dw_val_p (const dw_val_node *, const dw_val_node *, int *);
3229 static int same_attr_p (dw_attr_node *, dw_attr_node *, int *);
3230 static int same_die_p (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref, int *);
3231 static int same_die_p_wrap (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
3232 static void compute_section_prefix (dw_die_ref);
3233 static int is_type_die (dw_die_ref);
3234 static int is_comdat_die (dw_die_ref);
3235 static int is_symbol_die (dw_die_ref);
3236 static inline bool is_template_instantiation (dw_die_ref);
3237 static void assign_symbol_names (dw_die_ref);
3238 static void break_out_includes (dw_die_ref);
3239 static int is_declaration_die (dw_die_ref);
3240 static int should_move_die_to_comdat (dw_die_ref);
3241 static dw_die_ref clone_as_declaration (dw_die_ref);
3242 static dw_die_ref clone_die (dw_die_ref);
3243 static dw_die_ref clone_tree (dw_die_ref);
3244 static dw_die_ref copy_declaration_context (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
3245 static void generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (skeleton_chain_node *);
3246 static void generate_skeleton_bottom_up (skeleton_chain_node *);
3247 static dw_die_ref generate_skeleton (dw_die_ref);
3248 static dw_die_ref remove_child_or_replace_with_skeleton (dw_die_ref,
3249 dw_die_ref,
3250 dw_die_ref);
3251 static void break_out_comdat_types (dw_die_ref);
3252 static void copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (dw_die_ref);
3253
3254 static void add_sibling_attributes (dw_die_ref);
3255 static void output_location_lists (dw_die_ref);
3256 static int constant_size (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
3257 static unsigned long size_of_die (dw_die_ref);
3258 static void calc_die_sizes (dw_die_ref);
3259 static void calc_base_type_die_sizes (void);
3260 static void mark_dies (dw_die_ref);
3261 static void unmark_dies (dw_die_ref);
3262 static void unmark_all_dies (dw_die_ref);
3263 static unsigned long size_of_pubnames (vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *);
3264 static unsigned long size_of_aranges (void);
3265 static enum dwarf_form value_format (dw_attr_node *);
3266 static void output_value_format (dw_attr_node *);
3267 static void output_abbrev_section (void);
3268 static void output_die_abbrevs (unsigned long, dw_die_ref);
3269 static void output_die_symbol (dw_die_ref);
3270 static void output_die (dw_die_ref);
3271 static void output_compilation_unit_header (void);
3272 static void output_comp_unit (dw_die_ref, int);
3273 static void output_comdat_type_unit (comdat_type_node *);
3274 static const char *dwarf2_name (tree, int);
3275 static void add_pubname (tree, dw_die_ref);
3276 static void add_enumerator_pubname (const char *, dw_die_ref);
3277 static void add_pubname_string (const char *, dw_die_ref);
3278 static void add_pubtype (tree, dw_die_ref);
3279 static void output_pubnames (vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *);
3280 static void output_aranges (void);
3281 static unsigned int add_ranges_num (int);
3282 static unsigned int add_ranges (const_tree);
3283 static void add_ranges_by_labels (dw_die_ref, const char *, const char *,
3284 bool *, bool);
3285 static void output_ranges (void);
3286 static dw_line_info_table *new_line_info_table (void);
3287 static void output_line_info (bool);
3288 static void output_file_names (void);
3289 static dw_die_ref base_type_die (tree);
3290 static int is_base_type (tree);
3291 static dw_die_ref subrange_type_die (tree, tree, tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
3292 static int decl_quals (const_tree);
3293 static dw_die_ref modified_type_die (tree, int, dw_die_ref);
3294 static dw_die_ref generic_parameter_die (tree, tree, bool, dw_die_ref);
3295 static dw_die_ref template_parameter_pack_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
3296 static int type_is_enum (const_tree);
3297 static unsigned int dbx_reg_number (const_rtx);
3298 static void add_loc_descr_op_piece (dw_loc_descr_ref *, int);
3299 static dw_loc_descr_ref reg_loc_descriptor (rtx, enum var_init_status);
3300 static dw_loc_descr_ref one_reg_loc_descriptor (unsigned int,
3301 enum var_init_status);
3302 static dw_loc_descr_ref multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtx, rtx,
3303 enum var_init_status);
3304 static dw_loc_descr_ref based_loc_descr (rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT,
3305 enum var_init_status);
3306 static int is_based_loc (const_rtx);
3307 static bool resolve_one_addr (rtx *);
3308 static dw_loc_descr_ref concat_loc_descriptor (rtx, rtx,
3309 enum var_init_status);
3310 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor (rtx, machine_mode mode,
3311 enum var_init_status);
3312 struct loc_descr_context;
3313 static void add_loc_descr_to_each (dw_loc_list_ref list, dw_loc_descr_ref ref);
3314 static void add_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref *ret, dw_loc_list_ref list);
3315 static dw_loc_list_ref loc_list_from_tree (tree, int,
3316 const struct loc_descr_context *);
3317 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree, int,
3318 const struct loc_descr_context *);
3319 static HOST_WIDE_INT ceiling (HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned int);
3320 static tree field_type (const_tree);
3321 static unsigned int simple_type_align_in_bits (const_tree);
3322 static unsigned int simple_decl_align_in_bits (const_tree);
3323 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT simple_type_size_in_bits (const_tree);
3324 struct vlr_context;
3325 static dw_loc_descr_ref field_byte_offset (const_tree, struct vlr_context *,
3326 HOST_WIDE_INT *);
3327 static void add_AT_location_description (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3328 dw_loc_list_ref);
3329 static void add_data_member_location_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree,
3330 struct vlr_context *);
3331 static bool add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, rtx);
3332 static void insert_int (HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned, unsigned char *);
3333 static void insert_wide_int (const wide_int &, unsigned char *, int);
3334 static void insert_float (const_rtx, unsigned char *);
3335 static rtx rtl_for_decl_location (tree);
3336 static bool add_location_or_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree, bool);
3337 static bool tree_add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3338 static bool tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (dw_die_ref, tree);
3339 static void add_name_attribute (dw_die_ref, const char *);
3340 static void add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree, dw_die_ref);
3341 static void add_comp_dir_attribute (dw_die_ref);
3342 static void add_scalar_info (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, tree, int,
3343 const struct loc_descr_context *);
3344 static void add_bound_info (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, tree,
3345 const struct loc_descr_context *);
3346 static void add_subscript_info (dw_die_ref, tree, bool);
3347 static void add_byte_size_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3348 static inline void add_bit_offset_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree,
3349 struct vlr_context *);
3350 static void add_bit_size_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3351 static void add_prototyped_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3352 static dw_die_ref add_abstract_origin_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3353 static void add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3354 static void add_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref, tree);
3355 static void add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref, tree);
3356 static void add_discr_value (dw_die_ref, dw_discr_value *);
3357 static void add_discr_list (dw_die_ref, dw_discr_list_ref);
3358 static inline dw_discr_list_ref AT_discr_list (dw_attr_node *);
3359 static void push_decl_scope (tree);
3360 static void pop_decl_scope (void);
3361 static dw_die_ref scope_die_for (tree, dw_die_ref);
3362 static inline int local_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
3363 static inline int class_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
3364 static inline int class_or_namespace_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
3365 static void add_type_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree, int, dw_die_ref);
3366 static void add_calling_convention_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
3367 static const char *type_tag (const_tree);
3368 static tree member_declared_type (const_tree);
3369 #if 0
3370 static const char *decl_start_label (tree);
3371 #endif
3372 static void gen_array_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3373 static void gen_descr_array_type_die (tree, struct array_descr_info *, dw_die_ref);
3374 #if 0
3375 static void gen_entry_point_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3376 #endif
3377 static dw_die_ref gen_enumeration_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3378 static dw_die_ref gen_formal_parameter_die (tree, tree, bool, dw_die_ref);
3379 static dw_die_ref gen_formal_parameter_pack_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref, tree*);
3380 static void gen_unspecified_parameters_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3381 static void gen_formal_types_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3382 static void gen_subprogram_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3383 static void gen_variable_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
3384 static void gen_const_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3385 static void gen_label_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3386 static void gen_lexical_block_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3387 static void gen_inlined_subroutine_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3388 static void gen_field_die (tree, struct vlr_context *, dw_die_ref);
3389 static void gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3390 static dw_die_ref gen_compile_unit_die (const char *);
3391 static void gen_inheritance_die (tree, tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
3392 static void gen_member_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3393 static void gen_struct_or_union_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref,
3394 enum debug_info_usage);
3395 static void gen_subroutine_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3396 static void gen_typedef_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3397 static void gen_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3398 static void gen_block_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3399 static void decls_for_scope (tree, dw_die_ref);
3400 static bool is_naming_typedef_decl (const_tree);
3401 static inline dw_die_ref get_context_die (tree);
3402 static void gen_namespace_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
3403 static dw_die_ref gen_namelist_decl (tree, dw_die_ref, tree);
3404 static dw_die_ref gen_decl_die (tree, tree, struct vlr_context *, dw_die_ref);
3405 static dw_die_ref force_decl_die (tree);
3406 static dw_die_ref force_type_die (tree);
3407 static dw_die_ref setup_namespace_context (tree, dw_die_ref);
3408 static dw_die_ref declare_in_namespace (tree, dw_die_ref);
3409 static struct dwarf_file_data * lookup_filename (const char *);
3410 static void retry_incomplete_types (void);
3411 static void gen_type_die_for_member (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
3412 static void gen_generic_params_dies (tree);
3413 static void gen_tagged_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref, enum debug_info_usage);
3414 static void gen_type_die_with_usage (tree, dw_die_ref, enum debug_info_usage);
3415 static void splice_child_die (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
3416 static int file_info_cmp (const void *, const void *);
3417 static dw_loc_list_ref new_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref, const char *,
3418 const char *, const char *);
3419 static void output_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref);
3420 static char *gen_internal_sym (const char *);
3421 static bool want_pubnames (void);
3422
3423 static void prune_unmark_dies (dw_die_ref);
3424 static void prune_unused_types_mark_generic_parms_dies (dw_die_ref);
3425 static void prune_unused_types_mark (dw_die_ref, int);
3426 static void prune_unused_types_walk (dw_die_ref);
3427 static void prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (dw_die_ref);
3428 static void prune_unused_types_prune (dw_die_ref);
3429 static void prune_unused_types (void);
3430 static int maybe_emit_file (struct dwarf_file_data *fd);
3431 static inline const char *AT_vms_delta1 (dw_attr_node *);
3432 static inline const char *AT_vms_delta2 (dw_attr_node *);
3433 static inline void add_AT_vms_delta (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
3434 const char *, const char *);
3435 static void append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table (dw_die_ref, tree);
3436 static void gen_remaining_tmpl_value_param_die_attribute (void);
3437 static bool generic_type_p (tree);
3438 static void schedule_generic_params_dies_gen (tree t);
3439 static void gen_scheduled_generic_parms_dies (void);
3440
3441 static const char *comp_dir_string (void);
3442
3443 static void hash_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref, inchash::hash &);
3444
3445 /* enum for tracking thread-local variables whose address is really an offset
3446 relative to the TLS pointer, which will need link-time relocation, but will
3447 not need relocation by the DWARF consumer. */
3448
3449 enum dtprel_bool
3450 {
3451 dtprel_false = 0,
3452 dtprel_true = 1
3453 };
3454
3455 /* Return the operator to use for an address of a variable. For dtprel_true, we
3456 use DW_OP_const*. For regular variables, which need both link-time
3457 relocation and consumer-level relocation (e.g., to account for shared objects
3458 loaded at a random address), we use DW_OP_addr*. */
3459
3460 static inline enum dwarf_location_atom
3461 dw_addr_op (enum dtprel_bool dtprel)
3462 {
3463 if (dtprel == dtprel_true)
3464 return (dwarf_split_debug_info ? DW_OP_GNU_const_index
3465 : (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE == 4 ? DW_OP_const4u : DW_OP_const8u));
3466 else
3467 return dwarf_split_debug_info ? DW_OP_GNU_addr_index : DW_OP_addr;
3468 }
3469
3470 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated address location description. If
3471 dwarf_split_debug_info is true, then record the address with the appropriate
3472 relocation. */
3473 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
3474 new_addr_loc_descr (rtx addr, enum dtprel_bool dtprel)
3475 {
3476 dw_loc_descr_ref ref = new_loc_descr (dw_addr_op (dtprel), 0, 0);
3477
3478 ref->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
3479 ref->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = addr;
3480 ref->dtprel = dtprel;
3481 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
3482 ref->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry
3483 = add_addr_table_entry (addr,
3484 dtprel ? ate_kind_rtx_dtprel : ate_kind_rtx);
3485 else
3486 ref->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry = NULL;
3487
3488 return ref;
3489 }
3490
3491 /* Section names used to hold DWARF debugging information. */
3492
3493 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION
3494 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION ".debug_info"
3495 #endif
3496 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_INFO_SECTION
3497 #define DEBUG_DWO_INFO_SECTION ".debug_info.dwo"
3498 #endif
3499 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION
3500 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION ".debug_abbrev"
3501 #endif
3502 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_ABBREV_SECTION
3503 #define DEBUG_DWO_ABBREV_SECTION ".debug_abbrev.dwo"
3504 #endif
3505 #ifndef DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION
3506 #define DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION ".debug_aranges"
3507 #endif
3508 #ifndef DEBUG_ADDR_SECTION
3509 #define DEBUG_ADDR_SECTION ".debug_addr"
3510 #endif
3511 #ifndef DEBUG_NORM_MACINFO_SECTION
3512 #define DEBUG_NORM_MACINFO_SECTION ".debug_macinfo"
3513 #endif
3514 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_MACINFO_SECTION
3515 #define DEBUG_DWO_MACINFO_SECTION ".debug_macinfo.dwo"
3516 #endif
3517 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION
3518 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION \
3519 (!dwarf_split_debug_info \
3520 ? (DEBUG_NORM_MACINFO_SECTION) : (DEBUG_DWO_MACINFO_SECTION))
3521 #endif
3522 #ifndef DEBUG_NORM_MACRO_SECTION
3523 #define DEBUG_NORM_MACRO_SECTION ".debug_macro"
3524 #endif
3525 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_MACRO_SECTION
3526 #define DEBUG_DWO_MACRO_SECTION ".debug_macro.dwo"
3527 #endif
3528 #ifndef DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION
3529 #define DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION \
3530 (!dwarf_split_debug_info \
3531 ? (DEBUG_NORM_MACRO_SECTION) : (DEBUG_DWO_MACRO_SECTION))
3532 #endif
3533 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION
3534 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION ".debug_line"
3535 #endif
3536 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_LINE_SECTION
3537 #define DEBUG_DWO_LINE_SECTION ".debug_line.dwo"
3538 #endif
3539 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION
3540 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION ".debug_loc"
3541 #endif
3542 #ifndef DEBUG_DWO_LOC_SECTION
3543 #define DEBUG_DWO_LOC_SECTION ".debug_loc.dwo"
3544 #endif
3545 #ifndef DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION
3546 #define DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION \
3547 ((debug_generate_pub_sections == 2) \
3548 ? ".debug_gnu_pubnames" : ".debug_pubnames")
3549 #endif
3550 #ifndef DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION
3551 #define DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION \
3552 ((debug_generate_pub_sections == 2) \
3553 ? ".debug_gnu_pubtypes" : ".debug_pubtypes")
3554 #endif
3555 #define DEBUG_NORM_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION ".debug_str_offsets"
3556 #define DEBUG_DWO_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION ".debug_str_offsets.dwo"
3557 #ifndef DEBUG_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION
3558 #define DEBUG_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION \
3559 (!dwarf_split_debug_info \
3560 ? (DEBUG_NORM_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION) : (DEBUG_DWO_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION))
3561 #endif
3562 #ifndef DEBUG_STR_DWO_SECTION
3563 #define DEBUG_STR_DWO_SECTION ".debug_str.dwo"
3564 #endif
3565 #ifndef DEBUG_STR_SECTION
3566 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION ".debug_str"
3567 #endif
3568 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION
3569 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION ".debug_ranges"
3570 #endif
3571
3572 /* Standard ELF section names for compiled code and data. */
3573 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_NAME
3574 #define TEXT_SECTION_NAME ".text"
3575 #endif
3576
3577 /* Section flags for .debug_macinfo/.debug_macro section. */
3578 #define DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION_FLAGS \
3579 (dwarf_split_debug_info ? SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE : SECTION_DEBUG)
3580
3581 /* Section flags for .debug_str section. */
3582 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS \
3583 (HAVE_GAS_SHF_MERGE && flag_merge_debug_strings \
3584 ? SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_MERGE | SECTION_STRINGS | 1 \
3585 : SECTION_DEBUG)
3586
3587 /* Section flags for .debug_str.dwo section. */
3588 #define DEBUG_STR_DWO_SECTION_FLAGS (SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE)
3589
3590 /* Labels we insert at beginning sections we can reference instead of
3591 the section names themselves. */
3592
3593 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
3594 #define TEXT_SECTION_LABEL "Ltext"
3595 #endif
3596 #ifndef COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
3597 #define COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL "Ltext_cold"
3598 #endif
3599 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL
3600 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_line"
3601 #endif
3602 #ifndef DEBUG_SKELETON_LINE_SECTION_LABEL
3603 #define DEBUG_SKELETON_LINE_SECTION_LABEL "Lskeleton_debug_line"
3604 #endif
3605 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL
3606 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_info"
3607 #endif
3608 #ifndef DEBUG_SKELETON_INFO_SECTION_LABEL
3609 #define DEBUG_SKELETON_INFO_SECTION_LABEL "Lskeleton_debug_info"
3610 #endif
3611 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL
3612 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_abbrev"
3613 #endif
3614 #ifndef DEBUG_SKELETON_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL
3615 #define DEBUG_SKELETON_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL "Lskeleton_debug_abbrev"
3616 #endif
3617 #ifndef DEBUG_ADDR_SECTION_LABEL
3618 #define DEBUG_ADDR_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_addr"
3619 #endif
3620 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL
3621 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_loc"
3622 #endif
3623 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL
3624 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_ranges"
3625 #endif
3626 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL
3627 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_macinfo"
3628 #endif
3629 #ifndef DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION_LABEL
3630 #define DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_macro"
3631 #endif
3632 #define SKELETON_COMP_DIE_ABBREV 1
3633 #define SKELETON_TYPE_DIE_ABBREV 2
3634
3635 /* Definitions of defaults for formats and names of various special
3636 (artificial) labels which may be generated within this file (when the -g
3637 options is used and DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO is in effect.
3638 If necessary, these may be overridden from within the tm.h file, but
3639 typically, overriding these defaults is unnecessary. */
3640
3641 static char text_end_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3642 static char text_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3643 static char cold_text_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3644 static char cold_end_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3645 static char abbrev_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3646 static char debug_info_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3647 static char debug_skeleton_info_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3648 static char debug_skeleton_abbrev_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3649 static char debug_line_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3650 static char debug_addr_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3651 static char debug_skeleton_line_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3652 static char macinfo_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3653 static char loc_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3654 static char ranges_section_label[2 * MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3655
3656 #ifndef TEXT_END_LABEL
3657 #define TEXT_END_LABEL "Letext"
3658 #endif
3659 #ifndef COLD_END_LABEL
3660 #define COLD_END_LABEL "Letext_cold"
3661 #endif
3662 #ifndef BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL
3663 #define BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL "LBB"
3664 #endif
3665 #ifndef BLOCK_END_LABEL
3666 #define BLOCK_END_LABEL "LBE"
3667 #endif
3668 #ifndef LINE_CODE_LABEL
3669 #define LINE_CODE_LABEL "LM"
3670 #endif
3671
3672 \f
3673 /* Return the root of the DIE's built for the current compilation unit. */
3674 static dw_die_ref
3675 comp_unit_die (void)
3676 {
3677 if (!single_comp_unit_die)
3678 single_comp_unit_die = gen_compile_unit_die (NULL);
3679 return single_comp_unit_die;
3680 }
3681
3682 /* We allow a language front-end to designate a function that is to be
3683 called to "demangle" any name before it is put into a DIE. */
3684
3685 static const char *(*demangle_name_func) (const char *);
3686
3687 void
3688 dwarf2out_set_demangle_name_func (const char *(*func) (const char *))
3689 {
3690 demangle_name_func = func;
3691 }
3692
3693 /* Test if rtl node points to a pseudo register. */
3694
3695 static inline int
3696 is_pseudo_reg (const_rtx rtl)
3697 {
3698 return ((REG_P (rtl) && REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
3699 || (GET_CODE (rtl) == SUBREG
3700 && REGNO (SUBREG_REG (rtl)) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER));
3701 }
3702
3703 /* Return a reference to a type, with its const and volatile qualifiers
3704 removed. */
3705
3706 static inline tree
3707 type_main_variant (tree type)
3708 {
3709 type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
3710
3711 /* ??? There really should be only one main variant among any group of
3712 variants of a given type (and all of the MAIN_VARIANT values for all
3713 members of the group should point to that one type) but sometimes the C
3714 front-end messes this up for array types, so we work around that bug
3715 here. */
3716 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
3717 while (type != TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type))
3718 type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
3719
3720 return type;
3721 }
3722
3723 /* Return nonzero if the given type node represents a tagged type. */
3724
3725 static inline int
3726 is_tagged_type (const_tree type)
3727 {
3728 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
3729
3730 return (code == RECORD_TYPE || code == UNION_TYPE
3731 || code == QUAL_UNION_TYPE || code == ENUMERAL_TYPE);
3732 }
3733
3734 /* Set label to debug_info_section_label + die_offset of a DIE reference. */
3735
3736 static void
3737 get_ref_die_offset_label (char *label, dw_die_ref ref)
3738 {
3739 sprintf (label, "%s+%ld", debug_info_section_label, ref->die_offset);
3740 }
3741
3742 /* Return die_offset of a DIE reference to a base type. */
3743
3744 static unsigned long int
3745 get_base_type_offset (dw_die_ref ref)
3746 {
3747 if (ref->die_offset)
3748 return ref->die_offset;
3749 if (comp_unit_die ()->die_abbrev)
3750 {
3751 calc_base_type_die_sizes ();
3752 gcc_assert (ref->die_offset);
3753 }
3754 return ref->die_offset;
3755 }
3756
3757 /* Return die_offset of a DIE reference other than base type. */
3758
3759 static unsigned long int
3760 get_ref_die_offset (dw_die_ref ref)
3761 {
3762 gcc_assert (ref->die_offset);
3763 return ref->die_offset;
3764 }
3765
3766 /* Convert a DIE tag into its string name. */
3767
3768 static const char *
3769 dwarf_tag_name (unsigned int tag)
3770 {
3771 const char *name = get_DW_TAG_name (tag);
3772
3773 if (name != NULL)
3774 return name;
3775
3776 return "DW_TAG_<unknown>";
3777 }
3778
3779 /* Convert a DWARF attribute code into its string name. */
3780
3781 static const char *
3782 dwarf_attr_name (unsigned int attr)
3783 {
3784 const char *name;
3785
3786 switch (attr)
3787 {
3788 #if VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
3789 case DW_AT_HP_prologue:
3790 return "DW_AT_HP_prologue";
3791 #else
3792 case DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor:
3793 return "DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor";
3794 #endif
3795
3796 #if VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
3797 case DW_AT_HP_epilogue:
3798 return "DW_AT_HP_epilogue";
3799 #else
3800 case DW_AT_MIPS_stride:
3801 return "DW_AT_MIPS_stride";
3802 #endif
3803 }
3804
3805 name = get_DW_AT_name (attr);
3806
3807 if (name != NULL)
3808 return name;
3809
3810 return "DW_AT_<unknown>";
3811 }
3812
3813 /* Convert a DWARF value form code into its string name. */
3814
3815 static const char *
3816 dwarf_form_name (unsigned int form)
3817 {
3818 const char *name = get_DW_FORM_name (form);
3819
3820 if (name != NULL)
3821 return name;
3822
3823 return "DW_FORM_<unknown>";
3824 }
3825 \f
3826 /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of a decl. The decl may be an inlined
3827 instance of an inlined instance of a decl which is local to an inline
3828 function, so we have to trace all of the way back through the origin chain
3829 to find out what sort of node actually served as the original seed for the
3830 given block. */
3831
3832 static tree
3833 decl_ultimate_origin (const_tree decl)
3834 {
3835 if (!CODE_CONTAINS_STRUCT (TREE_CODE (decl), TS_DECL_COMMON))
3836 return NULL_TREE;
3837
3838 /* DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN can point to itself; ignore that if
3839 we're trying to output the abstract instance of this function. */
3840 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == decl)
3841 return NULL_TREE;
3842
3843 /* Since the DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for a DECL is supposed to be the
3844 most distant ancestor, this should never happen. */
3845 gcc_assert (!DECL_FROM_INLINE (DECL_ORIGIN (decl)));
3846
3847 return DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl);
3848 }
3849
3850 /* Get the class to which DECL belongs, if any. In g++, the DECL_CONTEXT
3851 of a virtual function may refer to a base class, so we check the 'this'
3852 parameter. */
3853
3854 static tree
3855 decl_class_context (tree decl)
3856 {
3857 tree context = NULL_TREE;
3858
3859 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FUNCTION_DECL || ! DECL_VINDEX (decl))
3860 context = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
3861 else
3862 context = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT
3863 (TREE_TYPE (TREE_VALUE (TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (decl)))));
3864
3865 if (context && !TYPE_P (context))
3866 context = NULL_TREE;
3867
3868 return context;
3869 }
3870 \f
3871 /* Add an attribute/value pair to a DIE. */
3872
3873 static inline void
3874 add_dwarf_attr (dw_die_ref die, dw_attr_node *attr)
3875 {
3876 /* Maybe this should be an assert? */
3877 if (die == NULL)
3878 return;
3879
3880 vec_safe_reserve (die->die_attr, 1);
3881 vec_safe_push (die->die_attr, *attr);
3882 }
3883
3884 static inline enum dw_val_class
3885 AT_class (dw_attr_node *a)
3886 {
3887 return a->dw_attr_val.val_class;
3888 }
3889
3890 /* Return the index for any attribute that will be referenced with a
3891 DW_FORM_GNU_addr_index or DW_FORM_GNU_str_index. String indices
3892 are stored in dw_attr_val.v.val_str for reference counting
3893 pruning. */
3894
3895 static inline unsigned int
3896 AT_index (dw_attr_node *a)
3897 {
3898 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
3899 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->index;
3900 else if (a->dw_attr_val.val_entry != NULL)
3901 return a->dw_attr_val.val_entry->index;
3902 return NOT_INDEXED;
3903 }
3904
3905 /* Add a flag value attribute to a DIE. */
3906
3907 static inline void
3908 add_AT_flag (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, unsigned int flag)
3909 {
3910 dw_attr_node attr;
3911
3912 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
3913 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_flag;
3914 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
3915 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_flag = flag;
3916 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
3917 }
3918
3919 static inline unsigned
3920 AT_flag (dw_attr_node *a)
3921 {
3922 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_flag);
3923 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag;
3924 }
3925
3926 /* Add a signed integer attribute value to a DIE. */
3927
3928 static inline void
3929 add_AT_int (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, HOST_WIDE_INT int_val)
3930 {
3931 dw_attr_node attr;
3932
3933 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
3934 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
3935 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
3936 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_int = int_val;
3937 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
3938 }
3939
3940 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
3941 AT_int (dw_attr_node *a)
3942 {
3943 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_const);
3944 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_int;
3945 }
3946
3947 /* Add an unsigned integer attribute value to a DIE. */
3948
3949 static inline void
3950 add_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
3951 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT unsigned_val)
3952 {
3953 dw_attr_node attr;
3954
3955 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
3956 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
3957 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
3958 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned = unsigned_val;
3959 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
3960 }
3961
3962 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
3963 AT_unsigned (dw_attr_node *a)
3964 {
3965 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_unsigned_const);
3966 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned;
3967 }
3968
3969 /* Add an unsigned wide integer attribute value to a DIE. */
3970
3971 static inline void
3972 add_AT_wide (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
3973 const wide_int& w)
3974 {
3975 dw_attr_node attr;
3976
3977 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
3978 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_wide_int;
3979 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
3980 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_wide = ggc_alloc<wide_int> ();
3981 *attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_wide = w;
3982 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
3983 }
3984
3985 /* Add an unsigned double integer attribute value to a DIE. */
3986
3987 static inline void
3988 add_AT_double (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
3989 HOST_WIDE_INT high, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT low)
3990 {
3991 dw_attr_node attr;
3992
3993 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
3994 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_const_double;
3995 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
3996 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_double.high = high;
3997 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_double.low = low;
3998 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
3999 }
4000
4001 /* Add a floating point attribute value to a DIE and return it. */
4002
4003 static inline void
4004 add_AT_vec (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4005 unsigned int length, unsigned int elt_size, unsigned char *array)
4006 {
4007 dw_attr_node attr;
4008
4009 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4010 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
4011 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4012 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length = length;
4013 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size = elt_size;
4014 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array = array;
4015 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4016 }
4017
4018 /* Add an 8-byte data attribute value to a DIE. */
4019
4020 static inline void
4021 add_AT_data8 (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4022 unsigned char data8[8])
4023 {
4024 dw_attr_node attr;
4025
4026 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4027 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_data8;
4028 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4029 memcpy (attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_data8, data8, 8);
4030 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4031 }
4032
4033 /* Add DW_AT_low_pc and DW_AT_high_pc to a DIE. When using
4034 dwarf_split_debug_info, address attributes in dies destined for the
4035 final executable have force_direct set to avoid using indexed
4036 references. */
4037
4038 static inline void
4039 add_AT_low_high_pc (dw_die_ref die, const char *lbl_low, const char *lbl_high,
4040 bool force_direct)
4041 {
4042 dw_attr_node attr;
4043 char * lbl_id;
4044
4045 lbl_id = xstrdup (lbl_low);
4046 attr.dw_attr = DW_AT_low_pc;
4047 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lbl_id;
4048 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = lbl_id;
4049 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && !force_direct)
4050 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry
4051 = add_addr_table_entry (lbl_id, ate_kind_label);
4052 else
4053 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4054 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4055
4056 attr.dw_attr = DW_AT_high_pc;
4057 if (dwarf_version < 4)
4058 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lbl_id;
4059 else
4060 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_high_pc;
4061 lbl_id = xstrdup (lbl_high);
4062 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = lbl_id;
4063 if (attr.dw_attr_val.val_class == dw_val_class_lbl_id
4064 && dwarf_split_debug_info && !force_direct)
4065 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry
4066 = add_addr_table_entry (lbl_id, ate_kind_label);
4067 else
4068 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4069 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4070 }
4071
4072 /* Hash and equality functions for debug_str_hash. */
4073
4074 hashval_t
4075 indirect_string_hasher::hash (indirect_string_node *x)
4076 {
4077 return htab_hash_string (x->str);
4078 }
4079
4080 bool
4081 indirect_string_hasher::equal (indirect_string_node *x1, const char *x2)
4082 {
4083 return strcmp (x1->str, x2) == 0;
4084 }
4085
4086 /* Add STR to the given string hash table. */
4087
4088 static struct indirect_string_node *
4089 find_AT_string_in_table (const char *str,
4090 hash_table<indirect_string_hasher> *table)
4091 {
4092 struct indirect_string_node *node;
4093
4094 indirect_string_node **slot
4095 = table->find_slot_with_hash (str, htab_hash_string (str), INSERT);
4096 if (*slot == NULL)
4097 {
4098 node = ggc_cleared_alloc<indirect_string_node> ();
4099 node->str = ggc_strdup (str);
4100 *slot = node;
4101 }
4102 else
4103 node = *slot;
4104
4105 node->refcount++;
4106 return node;
4107 }
4108
4109 /* Add STR to the indirect string hash table. */
4110
4111 static struct indirect_string_node *
4112 find_AT_string (const char *str)
4113 {
4114 if (! debug_str_hash)
4115 debug_str_hash = hash_table<indirect_string_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
4116
4117 return find_AT_string_in_table (str, debug_str_hash);
4118 }
4119
4120 /* Add a string attribute value to a DIE. */
4121
4122 static inline void
4123 add_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, const char *str)
4124 {
4125 dw_attr_node attr;
4126 struct indirect_string_node *node;
4127
4128 node = find_AT_string (str);
4129
4130 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4131 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_str;
4132 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4133 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
4134 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4135 }
4136
4137 static inline const char *
4138 AT_string (dw_attr_node *a)
4139 {
4140 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str);
4141 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->str;
4142 }
4143
4144 /* Call this function directly to bypass AT_string_form's logic to put
4145 the string inline in the die. */
4146
4147 static void
4148 set_indirect_string (struct indirect_string_node *node)
4149 {
4150 char label[32];
4151 /* Already indirect is a no op. */
4152 if (node->form == DW_FORM_strp || node->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index)
4153 {
4154 gcc_assert (node->label);
4155 return;
4156 }
4157 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LASF", dw2_string_counter);
4158 ++dw2_string_counter;
4159 node->label = xstrdup (label);
4160
4161 if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
4162 {
4163 node->form = DW_FORM_strp;
4164 node->index = NOT_INDEXED;
4165 }
4166 else
4167 {
4168 node->form = DW_FORM_GNU_str_index;
4169 node->index = NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED;
4170 }
4171 }
4172
4173 /* Find out whether a string should be output inline in DIE
4174 or out-of-line in .debug_str section. */
4175
4176 static enum dwarf_form
4177 find_string_form (struct indirect_string_node *node)
4178 {
4179 unsigned int len;
4180
4181 if (node->form)
4182 return node->form;
4183
4184 len = strlen (node->str) + 1;
4185
4186 /* If the string is shorter or equal to the size of the reference, it is
4187 always better to put it inline. */
4188 if (len <= DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE || node->refcount == 0)
4189 return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
4190
4191 /* If we cannot expect the linker to merge strings in .debug_str
4192 section, only put it into .debug_str if it is worth even in this
4193 single module. */
4194 if (DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET
4195 || ((debug_str_section->common.flags & SECTION_MERGE) == 0
4196 && (len - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE) * node->refcount <= len))
4197 return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
4198
4199 set_indirect_string (node);
4200
4201 return node->form;
4202 }
4203
4204 /* Find out whether the string referenced from the attribute should be
4205 output inline in DIE or out-of-line in .debug_str section. */
4206
4207 static enum dwarf_form
4208 AT_string_form (dw_attr_node *a)
4209 {
4210 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str);
4211 return find_string_form (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str);
4212 }
4213
4214 /* Add a DIE reference attribute value to a DIE. */
4215
4216 static inline void
4217 add_AT_die_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_die_ref targ_die)
4218 {
4219 dw_attr_node attr;
4220 gcc_checking_assert (targ_die != NULL);
4221
4222 /* With LTO we can end up trying to reference something we didn't create
4223 a DIE for. Avoid crashing later on a NULL referenced DIE. */
4224 if (targ_die == NULL)
4225 return;
4226
4227 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4228 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
4229 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4230 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = targ_die;
4231 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
4232 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4233 }
4234
4235 /* Change DIE reference REF to point to NEW_DIE instead. */
4236
4237 static inline void
4238 change_AT_die_ref (dw_attr_node *ref, dw_die_ref new_die)
4239 {
4240 gcc_assert (ref->dw_attr_val.val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref);
4241 ref->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = new_die;
4242 ref->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
4243 }
4244
4245 /* Add an AT_specification attribute to a DIE, and also make the back
4246 pointer from the specification to the definition. */
4247
4248 static inline void
4249 add_AT_specification (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref targ_die)
4250 {
4251 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_specification, targ_die);
4252 gcc_assert (!targ_die->die_definition);
4253 targ_die->die_definition = die;
4254 }
4255
4256 static inline dw_die_ref
4257 AT_ref (dw_attr_node *a)
4258 {
4259 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref);
4260 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die;
4261 }
4262
4263 static inline int
4264 AT_ref_external (dw_attr_node *a)
4265 {
4266 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
4267 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external;
4268
4269 return 0;
4270 }
4271
4272 static inline void
4273 set_AT_ref_external (dw_attr_node *a, int i)
4274 {
4275 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref);
4276 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = i;
4277 }
4278
4279 /* Add an FDE reference attribute value to a DIE. */
4280
4281 static inline void
4282 add_AT_fde_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, unsigned int targ_fde)
4283 {
4284 dw_attr_node attr;
4285
4286 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4287 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_fde_ref;
4288 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4289 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index = targ_fde;
4290 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4291 }
4292
4293 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE. */
4294
4295 static inline void
4296 add_AT_loc (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
4297 {
4298 dw_attr_node attr;
4299
4300 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4301 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
4302 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4303 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_loc = loc;
4304 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4305 }
4306
4307 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
4308 AT_loc (dw_attr_node *a)
4309 {
4310 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc);
4311 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc;
4312 }
4313
4314 static inline void
4315 add_AT_loc_list (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_loc_list_ref loc_list)
4316 {
4317 dw_attr_node attr;
4318
4319 if (XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO && !HAVE_XCOFF_DWARF_EXTRAS)
4320 return;
4321
4322 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4323 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc_list;
4324 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4325 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list = loc_list;
4326 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4327 have_location_lists = true;
4328 }
4329
4330 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
4331 AT_loc_list (dw_attr_node *a)
4332 {
4333 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list);
4334 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list;
4335 }
4336
4337 static inline dw_loc_list_ref *
4338 AT_loc_list_ptr (dw_attr_node *a)
4339 {
4340 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list);
4341 return &a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list;
4342 }
4343
4344 struct addr_hasher : ggc_ptr_hash<addr_table_entry>
4345 {
4346 static hashval_t hash (addr_table_entry *);
4347 static bool equal (addr_table_entry *, addr_table_entry *);
4348 };
4349
4350 /* Table of entries into the .debug_addr section. */
4351
4352 static GTY (()) hash_table<addr_hasher> *addr_index_table;
4353
4354 /* Hash an address_table_entry. */
4355
4356 hashval_t
4357 addr_hasher::hash (addr_table_entry *a)
4358 {
4359 inchash::hash hstate;
4360 switch (a->kind)
4361 {
4362 case ate_kind_rtx:
4363 hstate.add_int (0);
4364 break;
4365 case ate_kind_rtx_dtprel:
4366 hstate.add_int (1);
4367 break;
4368 case ate_kind_label:
4369 return htab_hash_string (a->addr.label);
4370 default:
4371 gcc_unreachable ();
4372 }
4373 inchash::add_rtx (a->addr.rtl, hstate);
4374 return hstate.end ();
4375 }
4376
4377 /* Determine equality for two address_table_entries. */
4378
4379 bool
4380 addr_hasher::equal (addr_table_entry *a1, addr_table_entry *a2)
4381 {
4382 if (a1->kind != a2->kind)
4383 return 0;
4384 switch (a1->kind)
4385 {
4386 case ate_kind_rtx:
4387 case ate_kind_rtx_dtprel:
4388 return rtx_equal_p (a1->addr.rtl, a2->addr.rtl);
4389 case ate_kind_label:
4390 return strcmp (a1->addr.label, a2->addr.label) == 0;
4391 default:
4392 gcc_unreachable ();
4393 }
4394 }
4395
4396 /* Initialize an addr_table_entry. */
4397
4398 void
4399 init_addr_table_entry (addr_table_entry *e, enum ate_kind kind, void *addr)
4400 {
4401 e->kind = kind;
4402 switch (kind)
4403 {
4404 case ate_kind_rtx:
4405 case ate_kind_rtx_dtprel:
4406 e->addr.rtl = (rtx) addr;
4407 break;
4408 case ate_kind_label:
4409 e->addr.label = (char *) addr;
4410 break;
4411 }
4412 e->refcount = 0;
4413 e->index = NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED;
4414 }
4415
4416 /* Add attr to the address table entry to the table. Defer setting an
4417 index until output time. */
4418
4419 static addr_table_entry *
4420 add_addr_table_entry (void *addr, enum ate_kind kind)
4421 {
4422 addr_table_entry *node;
4423 addr_table_entry finder;
4424
4425 gcc_assert (dwarf_split_debug_info);
4426 if (! addr_index_table)
4427 addr_index_table = hash_table<addr_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
4428 init_addr_table_entry (&finder, kind, addr);
4429 addr_table_entry **slot = addr_index_table->find_slot (&finder, INSERT);
4430
4431 if (*slot == HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
4432 {
4433 node = ggc_cleared_alloc<addr_table_entry> ();
4434 init_addr_table_entry (node, kind, addr);
4435 *slot = node;
4436 }
4437 else
4438 node = *slot;
4439
4440 node->refcount++;
4441 return node;
4442 }
4443
4444 /* Remove an entry from the addr table by decrementing its refcount.
4445 Strictly, decrementing the refcount would be enough, but the
4446 assertion that the entry is actually in the table has found
4447 bugs. */
4448
4449 static void
4450 remove_addr_table_entry (addr_table_entry *entry)
4451 {
4452 gcc_assert (dwarf_split_debug_info && addr_index_table);
4453 /* After an index is assigned, the table is frozen. */
4454 gcc_assert (entry->refcount > 0 && entry->index == NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
4455 entry->refcount--;
4456 }
4457
4458 /* Given a location list, remove all addresses it refers to from the
4459 address_table. */
4460
4461 static void
4462 remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (dw_loc_descr_ref descr)
4463 {
4464 for (; descr; descr = descr->dw_loc_next)
4465 if (descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry != NULL)
4466 {
4467 gcc_assert (descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry->index == NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
4468 remove_addr_table_entry (descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry);
4469 }
4470 }
4471
4472 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
4473 htab_traverse. Assign an addr_table_entry its index. All entries
4474 must be collected into the table when this function is called,
4475 because the indexing code relies on htab_traverse to traverse nodes
4476 in the same order for each run. */
4477
4478 int
4479 index_addr_table_entry (addr_table_entry **h, unsigned int *index)
4480 {
4481 addr_table_entry *node = *h;
4482
4483 /* Don't index unreferenced nodes. */
4484 if (node->refcount == 0)
4485 return 1;
4486
4487 gcc_assert (node->index == NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
4488 node->index = *index;
4489 *index += 1;
4490
4491 return 1;
4492 }
4493
4494 /* Add an address constant attribute value to a DIE. When using
4495 dwarf_split_debug_info, address attributes in dies destined for the
4496 final executable should be direct references--setting the parameter
4497 force_direct ensures this behavior. */
4498
4499 static inline void
4500 add_AT_addr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, rtx addr,
4501 bool force_direct)
4502 {
4503 dw_attr_node attr;
4504
4505 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4506 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
4507 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_addr = addr;
4508 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && !force_direct)
4509 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = add_addr_table_entry (addr, ate_kind_rtx);
4510 else
4511 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4512 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4513 }
4514
4515 /* Get the RTX from to an address DIE attribute. */
4516
4517 static inline rtx
4518 AT_addr (dw_attr_node *a)
4519 {
4520 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_addr);
4521 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr;
4522 }
4523
4524 /* Add a file attribute value to a DIE. */
4525
4526 static inline void
4527 add_AT_file (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4528 struct dwarf_file_data *fd)
4529 {
4530 dw_attr_node attr;
4531
4532 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4533 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_file;
4534 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4535 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_file = fd;
4536 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4537 }
4538
4539 /* Get the dwarf_file_data from a file DIE attribute. */
4540
4541 static inline struct dwarf_file_data *
4542 AT_file (dw_attr_node *a)
4543 {
4544 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_file);
4545 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file;
4546 }
4547
4548 /* Add a vms delta attribute value to a DIE. */
4549
4550 static inline void
4551 add_AT_vms_delta (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4552 const char *lbl1, const char *lbl2)
4553 {
4554 dw_attr_node attr;
4555
4556 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4557 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_vms_delta;
4558 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4559 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vms_delta.lbl1 = xstrdup (lbl1);
4560 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vms_delta.lbl2 = xstrdup (lbl2);
4561 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4562 }
4563
4564 /* Add a label identifier attribute value to a DIE. */
4565
4566 static inline void
4567 add_AT_lbl_id (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4568 const char *lbl_id)
4569 {
4570 dw_attr_node attr;
4571
4572 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4573 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lbl_id;
4574 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4575 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (lbl_id);
4576 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
4577 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry
4578 = add_addr_table_entry (attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id,
4579 ate_kind_label);
4580 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4581 }
4582
4583 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE, an offset into the
4584 debug_line section. */
4585
4586 static inline void
4587 add_AT_lineptr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4588 const char *label)
4589 {
4590 dw_attr_node attr;
4591
4592 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4593 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lineptr;
4594 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4595 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
4596 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4597 }
4598
4599 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE, an offset into the
4600 debug_macinfo section. */
4601
4602 static inline void
4603 add_AT_macptr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4604 const char *label)
4605 {
4606 dw_attr_node attr;
4607
4608 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4609 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_macptr;
4610 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4611 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
4612 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4613 }
4614
4615 /* Add an offset attribute value to a DIE. */
4616
4617 static inline void
4618 add_AT_offset (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4619 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
4620 {
4621 dw_attr_node attr;
4622
4623 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4624 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_offset;
4625 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
4626 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
4627 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4628 }
4629
4630 /* Add a range_list attribute value to a DIE. When using
4631 dwarf_split_debug_info, address attributes in dies destined for the
4632 final executable should be direct references--setting the parameter
4633 force_direct ensures this behavior. */
4634
4635 #define UNRELOCATED_OFFSET ((addr_table_entry *) 1)
4636 #define RELOCATED_OFFSET (NULL)
4637
4638 static void
4639 add_AT_range_list (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4640 long unsigned int offset, bool force_direct)
4641 {
4642 dw_attr_node attr;
4643
4644 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4645 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_range_list;
4646 /* For the range_list attribute, use val_entry to store whether the
4647 offset should follow split-debug-info or normal semantics. This
4648 value is read in output_range_list_offset. */
4649 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && !force_direct)
4650 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = UNRELOCATED_OFFSET;
4651 else
4652 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = RELOCATED_OFFSET;
4653 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
4654 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4655 }
4656
4657 /* Return the start label of a delta attribute. */
4658
4659 static inline const char *
4660 AT_vms_delta1 (dw_attr_node *a)
4661 {
4662 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_vms_delta));
4663 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vms_delta.lbl1;
4664 }
4665
4666 /* Return the end label of a delta attribute. */
4667
4668 static inline const char *
4669 AT_vms_delta2 (dw_attr_node *a)
4670 {
4671 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_vms_delta));
4672 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vms_delta.lbl2;
4673 }
4674
4675 static inline const char *
4676 AT_lbl (dw_attr_node *a)
4677 {
4678 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lbl_id
4679 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lineptr
4680 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_macptr
4681 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_high_pc));
4682 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id;
4683 }
4684
4685 /* Get the attribute of type attr_kind. */
4686
4687 static dw_attr_node *
4688 get_AT (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
4689 {
4690 dw_attr_node *a;
4691 unsigned ix;
4692 dw_die_ref spec = NULL;
4693
4694 if (! die)
4695 return NULL;
4696
4697 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
4698 if (a->dw_attr == attr_kind)
4699 return a;
4700 else if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_specification
4701 || a->dw_attr == DW_AT_abstract_origin)
4702 spec = AT_ref (a);
4703
4704 if (spec)
4705 return get_AT (spec, attr_kind);
4706
4707 return NULL;
4708 }
4709
4710 /* Returns the parent of the declaration of DIE. */
4711
4712 static dw_die_ref
4713 get_die_parent (dw_die_ref die)
4714 {
4715 dw_die_ref t;
4716
4717 if (!die)
4718 return NULL;
4719
4720 if ((t = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin))
4721 || (t = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification)))
4722 die = t;
4723
4724 return die->die_parent;
4725 }
4726
4727 /* Return the "low pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
4728 DIE. Return null if the "low pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
4729 cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier. */
4730
4731 static inline const char *
4732 get_AT_low_pc (dw_die_ref die)
4733 {
4734 dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_low_pc);
4735
4736 return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
4737 }
4738
4739 /* Return the "high pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
4740 DIE. Return null if the "high pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
4741 cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier. */
4742
4743 static inline const char *
4744 get_AT_hi_pc (dw_die_ref die)
4745 {
4746 dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_high_pc);
4747
4748 return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
4749 }
4750
4751 /* Return the value of the string attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or
4752 NULL if it is not present. */
4753
4754 static inline const char *
4755 get_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
4756 {
4757 dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
4758
4759 return a ? AT_string (a) : NULL;
4760 }
4761
4762 /* Return the value of the flag attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or -1
4763 if it is not present. */
4764
4765 static inline int
4766 get_AT_flag (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
4767 {
4768 dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
4769
4770 return a ? AT_flag (a) : 0;
4771 }
4772
4773 /* Return the value of the unsigned attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or 0
4774 if it is not present. */
4775
4776 static inline unsigned
4777 get_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
4778 {
4779 dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
4780
4781 return a ? AT_unsigned (a) : 0;
4782 }
4783
4784 static inline dw_die_ref
4785 get_AT_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
4786 {
4787 dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
4788
4789 return a ? AT_ref (a) : NULL;
4790 }
4791
4792 static inline struct dwarf_file_data *
4793 get_AT_file (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
4794 {
4795 dw_attr_node *a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
4796
4797 return a ? AT_file (a) : NULL;
4798 }
4799
4800 /* Return TRUE if the language is C++. */
4801
4802 static inline bool
4803 is_cxx (void)
4804 {
4805 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language);
4806
4807 return (lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus || lang == DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus
4808 || lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_11 || lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_14);
4809 }
4810
4811 /* Return TRUE if the language is Java. */
4812
4813 static inline bool
4814 is_java (void)
4815 {
4816 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language);
4817
4818 return lang == DW_LANG_Java;
4819 }
4820
4821 /* Return TRUE if the language is Fortran. */
4822
4823 static inline bool
4824 is_fortran (void)
4825 {
4826 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language);
4827
4828 return (lang == DW_LANG_Fortran77
4829 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran90
4830 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran95
4831 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran03
4832 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran08);
4833 }
4834
4835 /* Return TRUE if the language is Ada. */
4836
4837 static inline bool
4838 is_ada (void)
4839 {
4840 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language);
4841
4842 return lang == DW_LANG_Ada95 || lang == DW_LANG_Ada83;
4843 }
4844
4845 /* Remove the specified attribute if present. Return TRUE if removal
4846 was successful. */
4847
4848 static bool
4849 remove_AT (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
4850 {
4851 dw_attr_node *a;
4852 unsigned ix;
4853
4854 if (! die)
4855 return false;
4856
4857 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
4858 if (a->dw_attr == attr_kind)
4859 {
4860 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
4861 if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount)
4862 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount--;
4863
4864 /* vec::ordered_remove should help reduce the number of abbrevs
4865 that are needed. */
4866 die->die_attr->ordered_remove (ix);
4867 return true;
4868 }
4869 return false;
4870 }
4871
4872 /* Remove CHILD from its parent. PREV must have the property that
4873 PREV->DIE_SIB == CHILD. Does not alter CHILD. */
4874
4875 static void
4876 remove_child_with_prev (dw_die_ref child, dw_die_ref prev)
4877 {
4878 gcc_assert (child->die_parent == prev->die_parent);
4879 gcc_assert (prev->die_sib == child);
4880 if (prev == child)
4881 {
4882 gcc_assert (child->die_parent->die_child == child);
4883 prev = NULL;
4884 }
4885 else
4886 prev->die_sib = child->die_sib;
4887 if (child->die_parent->die_child == child)
4888 child->die_parent->die_child = prev;
4889 }
4890
4891 /* Replace OLD_CHILD with NEW_CHILD. PREV must have the property that
4892 PREV->DIE_SIB == OLD_CHILD. Does not alter OLD_CHILD. */
4893
4894 static void
4895 replace_child (dw_die_ref old_child, dw_die_ref new_child, dw_die_ref prev)
4896 {
4897 dw_die_ref parent = old_child->die_parent;
4898
4899 gcc_assert (parent == prev->die_parent);
4900 gcc_assert (prev->die_sib == old_child);
4901
4902 new_child->die_parent = parent;
4903 if (prev == old_child)
4904 {
4905 gcc_assert (parent->die_child == old_child);
4906 new_child->die_sib = new_child;
4907 }
4908 else
4909 {
4910 prev->die_sib = new_child;
4911 new_child->die_sib = old_child->die_sib;
4912 }
4913 if (old_child->die_parent->die_child == old_child)
4914 old_child->die_parent->die_child = new_child;
4915 }
4916
4917 /* Move all children from OLD_PARENT to NEW_PARENT. */
4918
4919 static void
4920 move_all_children (dw_die_ref old_parent, dw_die_ref new_parent)
4921 {
4922 dw_die_ref c;
4923 new_parent->die_child = old_parent->die_child;
4924 old_parent->die_child = NULL;
4925 FOR_EACH_CHILD (new_parent, c, c->die_parent = new_parent);
4926 }
4927
4928 /* Remove child DIE whose die_tag is TAG. Do nothing if no child
4929 matches TAG. */
4930
4931 static void
4932 remove_child_TAG (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_tag tag)
4933 {
4934 dw_die_ref c;
4935
4936 c = die->die_child;
4937 if (c) do {
4938 dw_die_ref prev = c;
4939 c = c->die_sib;
4940 while (c->die_tag == tag)
4941 {
4942 remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
4943 c->die_parent = NULL;
4944 /* Might have removed every child. */
4945 if (c == c->die_sib)
4946 return;
4947 c = c->die_sib;
4948 }
4949 } while (c != die->die_child);
4950 }
4951
4952 /* Add a CHILD_DIE as the last child of DIE. */
4953
4954 static void
4955 add_child_die (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref child_die)
4956 {
4957 /* FIXME this should probably be an assert. */
4958 if (! die || ! child_die)
4959 return;
4960 gcc_assert (die != child_die);
4961
4962 child_die->die_parent = die;
4963 if (die->die_child)
4964 {
4965 child_die->die_sib = die->die_child->die_sib;
4966 die->die_child->die_sib = child_die;
4967 }
4968 else
4969 child_die->die_sib = child_die;
4970 die->die_child = child_die;
4971 }
4972
4973 /* Unassociate CHILD from its parent, and make its parent be
4974 NEW_PARENT. */
4975
4976 static void
4977 reparent_child (dw_die_ref child, dw_die_ref new_parent)
4978 {
4979 for (dw_die_ref p = child->die_parent->die_child; ; p = p->die_sib)
4980 if (p->die_sib == child)
4981 {
4982 remove_child_with_prev (child, p);
4983 break;
4984 }
4985 add_child_die (new_parent, child);
4986 }
4987
4988 /* Move CHILD, which must be a child of PARENT or the DIE for which PARENT
4989 is the specification, to the end of PARENT's list of children.
4990 This is done by removing and re-adding it. */
4991
4992 static void
4993 splice_child_die (dw_die_ref parent, dw_die_ref child)
4994 {
4995 /* We want the declaration DIE from inside the class, not the
4996 specification DIE at toplevel. */
4997 if (child->die_parent != parent)
4998 {
4999 dw_die_ref tmp = get_AT_ref (child, DW_AT_specification);
5000
5001 if (tmp)
5002 child = tmp;
5003 }
5004
5005 gcc_assert (child->die_parent == parent
5006 || (child->die_parent
5007 == get_AT_ref (parent, DW_AT_specification)));
5008
5009 reparent_child (child, parent);
5010 }
5011
5012 /* Create and return a new die with a parent of PARENT_DIE. If
5013 PARENT_DIE is NULL, the new DIE is placed in limbo and an
5014 associated tree T must be supplied to determine parenthood
5015 later. */
5016
5017 static inline dw_die_ref
5018 new_die (enum dwarf_tag tag_value, dw_die_ref parent_die, tree t)
5019 {
5020 dw_die_ref die = ggc_cleared_alloc<die_node> ();
5021
5022 die->die_tag = tag_value;
5023
5024 if (parent_die != NULL)
5025 add_child_die (parent_die, die);
5026 else
5027 {
5028 limbo_die_node *limbo_node;
5029
5030 /* No DIEs created after early dwarf should end up in limbo,
5031 because the limbo list should not persist past LTO
5032 streaming. */
5033 if (tag_value != DW_TAG_compile_unit
5034 /* These are allowed because they're generated while
5035 breaking out COMDAT units late. */
5036 && tag_value != DW_TAG_type_unit
5037 && !early_dwarf
5038 /* Allow nested functions to live in limbo because they will
5039 only temporarily live there, as decls_for_scope will fix
5040 them up. */
5041 && (TREE_CODE (t) != FUNCTION_DECL
5042 || !decl_function_context (t))
5043 /* Same as nested functions above but for types. Types that
5044 are local to a function will be fixed in
5045 decls_for_scope. */
5046 && (!RECORD_OR_UNION_TYPE_P (t)
5047 || !TYPE_CONTEXT (t)
5048 || TREE_CODE (TYPE_CONTEXT (t)) != FUNCTION_DECL)
5049 /* FIXME debug-early: Allow late limbo DIE creation for LTO,
5050 especially in the ltrans stage, but once we implement LTO
5051 dwarf streaming, we should remove this exception. */
5052 && !in_lto_p)
5053 {
5054 fprintf (stderr, "symbol ended up in limbo too late:");
5055 debug_generic_stmt (t);
5056 gcc_unreachable ();
5057 }
5058
5059 limbo_node = ggc_cleared_alloc<limbo_die_node> ();
5060 limbo_node->die = die;
5061 limbo_node->created_for = t;
5062 limbo_node->next = limbo_die_list;
5063 limbo_die_list = limbo_node;
5064 }
5065
5066 return die;
5067 }
5068
5069 /* Return the DIE associated with the given type specifier. */
5070
5071 static inline dw_die_ref
5072 lookup_type_die (tree type)
5073 {
5074 return TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type);
5075 }
5076
5077 /* Given a TYPE_DIE representing the type TYPE, if TYPE is an
5078 anonymous type named by the typedef TYPE_DIE, return the DIE of the
5079 anonymous type instead the one of the naming typedef. */
5080
5081 static inline dw_die_ref
5082 strip_naming_typedef (tree type, dw_die_ref type_die)
5083 {
5084 if (type
5085 && TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
5086 && type_die
5087 && type_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_typedef
5088 && is_naming_typedef_decl (TYPE_NAME (type)))
5089 type_die = get_AT_ref (type_die, DW_AT_type);
5090 return type_die;
5091 }
5092
5093 /* Like lookup_type_die, but if type is an anonymous type named by a
5094 typedef[1], return the DIE of the anonymous type instead the one of
5095 the naming typedef. This is because in gen_typedef_die, we did
5096 equate the anonymous struct named by the typedef with the DIE of
5097 the naming typedef. So by default, lookup_type_die on an anonymous
5098 struct yields the DIE of the naming typedef.
5099
5100 [1]: Read the comment of is_naming_typedef_decl to learn about what
5101 a naming typedef is. */
5102
5103 static inline dw_die_ref
5104 lookup_type_die_strip_naming_typedef (tree type)
5105 {
5106 dw_die_ref die = lookup_type_die (type);
5107 return strip_naming_typedef (type, die);
5108 }
5109
5110 /* Equate a DIE to a given type specifier. */
5111
5112 static inline void
5113 equate_type_number_to_die (tree type, dw_die_ref type_die)
5114 {
5115 TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type) = type_die;
5116 }
5117
5118 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a die_struct). */
5119
5120 inline hashval_t
5121 decl_die_hasher::hash (die_node *x)
5122 {
5123 return (hashval_t) x->decl_id;
5124 }
5125
5126 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of die_struct X is the same as UID of decl *Y. */
5127
5128 inline bool
5129 decl_die_hasher::equal (die_node *x, tree y)
5130 {
5131 return (x->decl_id == DECL_UID (y));
5132 }
5133
5134 /* Return the DIE associated with a given declaration. */
5135
5136 static inline dw_die_ref
5137 lookup_decl_die (tree decl)
5138 {
5139 return decl_die_table->find_with_hash (decl, DECL_UID (decl));
5140 }
5141
5142 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a var_loc_list). */
5143
5144 inline hashval_t
5145 decl_loc_hasher::hash (var_loc_list *x)
5146 {
5147 return (hashval_t) x->decl_id;
5148 }
5149
5150 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of var_loc_list X is the same as
5151 UID of decl *Y. */
5152
5153 inline bool
5154 decl_loc_hasher::equal (var_loc_list *x, const_tree y)
5155 {
5156 return (x->decl_id == DECL_UID (y));
5157 }
5158
5159 /* Return the var_loc list associated with a given declaration. */
5160
5161 static inline var_loc_list *
5162 lookup_decl_loc (const_tree decl)
5163 {
5164 if (!decl_loc_table)
5165 return NULL;
5166 return decl_loc_table->find_with_hash (decl, DECL_UID (decl));
5167 }
5168
5169 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a cached_dw_loc_list_list). */
5170
5171 inline hashval_t
5172 dw_loc_list_hasher::hash (cached_dw_loc_list *x)
5173 {
5174 return (hashval_t) x->decl_id;
5175 }
5176
5177 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of cached_dw_loc_list X is the same as
5178 UID of decl *Y. */
5179
5180 inline bool
5181 dw_loc_list_hasher::equal (cached_dw_loc_list *x, const_tree y)
5182 {
5183 return (x->decl_id == DECL_UID (y));
5184 }
5185
5186 /* Equate a DIE to a particular declaration. */
5187
5188 static void
5189 equate_decl_number_to_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref decl_die)
5190 {
5191 unsigned int decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
5192
5193 *decl_die_table->find_slot_with_hash (decl, decl_id, INSERT) = decl_die;
5194 decl_die->decl_id = decl_id;
5195 }
5196
5197 /* Return how many bits covers PIECE EXPR_LIST. */
5198
5199 static HOST_WIDE_INT
5200 decl_piece_bitsize (rtx piece)
5201 {
5202 int ret = (int) GET_MODE (piece);
5203 if (ret)
5204 return ret;
5205 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (piece, 0)) == CONCAT
5206 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (XEXP (piece, 0), 0)));
5207 return INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (piece, 0), 0));
5208 }
5209
5210 /* Return pointer to the location of location note in PIECE EXPR_LIST. */
5211
5212 static rtx *
5213 decl_piece_varloc_ptr (rtx piece)
5214 {
5215 if ((int) GET_MODE (piece))
5216 return &XEXP (piece, 0);
5217 else
5218 return &XEXP (XEXP (piece, 0), 1);
5219 }
5220
5221 /* Create an EXPR_LIST for location note LOC_NOTE covering BITSIZE bits.
5222 Next is the chain of following piece nodes. */
5223
5224 static rtx_expr_list *
5225 decl_piece_node (rtx loc_note, HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, rtx next)
5226 {
5227 if (bitsize > 0 && bitsize <= (int) MAX_MACHINE_MODE)
5228 return alloc_EXPR_LIST (bitsize, loc_note, next);
5229 else
5230 return alloc_EXPR_LIST (0, gen_rtx_CONCAT (VOIDmode,
5231 GEN_INT (bitsize),
5232 loc_note), next);
5233 }
5234
5235 /* Return rtx that should be stored into loc field for
5236 LOC_NOTE and BITPOS/BITSIZE. */
5237
5238 static rtx
5239 construct_piece_list (rtx loc_note, HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos,
5240 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize)
5241 {
5242 if (bitsize != -1)
5243 {
5244 loc_note = decl_piece_node (loc_note, bitsize, NULL_RTX);
5245 if (bitpos != 0)
5246 loc_note = decl_piece_node (NULL_RTX, bitpos, loc_note);
5247 }
5248 return loc_note;
5249 }
5250
5251 /* This function either modifies location piece list *DEST in
5252 place (if SRC and INNER is NULL), or copies location piece list
5253 *SRC to *DEST while modifying it. Location BITPOS is modified
5254 to contain LOC_NOTE, any pieces overlapping it are removed resp.
5255 not copied and if needed some padding around it is added.
5256 When modifying in place, DEST should point to EXPR_LIST where
5257 earlier pieces cover PIECE_BITPOS bits, when copying SRC points
5258 to the start of the whole list and INNER points to the EXPR_LIST
5259 where earlier pieces cover PIECE_BITPOS bits. */
5260
5261 static void
5262 adjust_piece_list (rtx *dest, rtx *src, rtx *inner,
5263 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos, HOST_WIDE_INT piece_bitpos,
5264 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, rtx loc_note)
5265 {
5266 HOST_WIDE_INT diff;
5267 bool copy = inner != NULL;
5268
5269 if (copy)
5270 {
5271 /* First copy all nodes preceding the current bitpos. */
5272 while (src != inner)
5273 {
5274 *dest = decl_piece_node (*decl_piece_varloc_ptr (*src),
5275 decl_piece_bitsize (*src), NULL_RTX);
5276 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
5277 src = &XEXP (*src, 1);
5278 }
5279 }
5280 /* Add padding if needed. */
5281 if (bitpos != piece_bitpos)
5282 {
5283 *dest = decl_piece_node (NULL_RTX, bitpos - piece_bitpos,
5284 copy ? NULL_RTX : *dest);
5285 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
5286 }
5287 else if (*dest && decl_piece_bitsize (*dest) == bitsize)
5288 {
5289 gcc_assert (!copy);
5290 /* A piece with correct bitpos and bitsize already exist,
5291 just update the location for it and return. */
5292 *decl_piece_varloc_ptr (*dest) = loc_note;
5293 return;
5294 }
5295 /* Add the piece that changed. */
5296 *dest = decl_piece_node (loc_note, bitsize, copy ? NULL_RTX : *dest);
5297 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
5298 /* Skip over pieces that overlap it. */
5299 diff = bitpos - piece_bitpos + bitsize;
5300 if (!copy)
5301 src = dest;
5302 while (diff > 0 && *src)
5303 {
5304 rtx piece = *src;
5305 diff -= decl_piece_bitsize (piece);
5306 if (copy)
5307 src = &XEXP (piece, 1);
5308 else
5309 {
5310 *src = XEXP (piece, 1);
5311 free_EXPR_LIST_node (piece);
5312 }
5313 }
5314 /* Add padding if needed. */
5315 if (diff < 0 && *src)
5316 {
5317 if (!copy)
5318 dest = src;
5319 *dest = decl_piece_node (NULL_RTX, -diff, copy ? NULL_RTX : *dest);
5320 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
5321 }
5322 if (!copy)
5323 return;
5324 /* Finally copy all nodes following it. */
5325 while (*src)
5326 {
5327 *dest = decl_piece_node (*decl_piece_varloc_ptr (*src),
5328 decl_piece_bitsize (*src), NULL_RTX);
5329 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
5330 src = &XEXP (*src, 1);
5331 }
5332 }
5333
5334 /* Add a variable location node to the linked list for DECL. */
5335
5336 static struct var_loc_node *
5337 add_var_loc_to_decl (tree decl, rtx loc_note, const char *label)
5338 {
5339 unsigned int decl_id;
5340 var_loc_list *temp;
5341 struct var_loc_node *loc = NULL;
5342 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize = -1, bitpos = -1;
5343
5344 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
5345 && DECL_HAS_DEBUG_EXPR_P (decl))
5346 {
5347 tree realdecl = DECL_DEBUG_EXPR (decl);
5348 if (handled_component_p (realdecl)
5349 || (TREE_CODE (realdecl) == MEM_REF
5350 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (realdecl, 0)) == ADDR_EXPR))
5351 {
5352 HOST_WIDE_INT maxsize;
5353 bool reverse;
5354 tree innerdecl
5355 = get_ref_base_and_extent (realdecl, &bitpos, &bitsize, &maxsize,
5356 &reverse);
5357 if (!DECL_P (innerdecl)
5358 || DECL_IGNORED_P (innerdecl)
5359 || TREE_STATIC (innerdecl)
5360 || bitsize <= 0
5361 || bitpos + bitsize > 256
5362 || bitsize != maxsize)
5363 return NULL;
5364 decl = innerdecl;
5365 }
5366 }
5367
5368 decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
5369 var_loc_list **slot
5370 = decl_loc_table->find_slot_with_hash (decl, decl_id, INSERT);
5371 if (*slot == NULL)
5372 {
5373 temp = ggc_cleared_alloc<var_loc_list> ();
5374 temp->decl_id = decl_id;
5375 *slot = temp;
5376 }
5377 else
5378 temp = *slot;
5379
5380 /* For PARM_DECLs try to keep around the original incoming value,
5381 even if that means we'll emit a zero-range .debug_loc entry. */
5382 if (temp->last
5383 && temp->first == temp->last
5384 && TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL
5385 && NOTE_P (temp->first->loc)
5386 && NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (temp->first->loc) == decl
5387 && DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl)
5388 && NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (temp->first->loc)
5389 && GET_CODE (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (temp->first->loc))
5390 == GET_CODE (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
5391 && prev_real_insn (temp->first->loc) == NULL_RTX
5392 && (bitsize != -1
5393 || !rtx_equal_p (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (temp->first->loc),
5394 NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc_note))
5395 || (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (temp->first->loc)
5396 != NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc_note))))
5397 {
5398 loc = ggc_cleared_alloc<var_loc_node> ();
5399 temp->first->next = loc;
5400 temp->last = loc;
5401 loc->loc = construct_piece_list (loc_note, bitpos, bitsize);
5402 }
5403 else if (temp->last)
5404 {
5405 struct var_loc_node *last = temp->last, *unused = NULL;
5406 rtx *piece_loc = NULL, last_loc_note;
5407 HOST_WIDE_INT piece_bitpos = 0;
5408 if (last->next)
5409 {
5410 last = last->next;
5411 gcc_assert (last->next == NULL);
5412 }
5413 if (bitsize != -1 && GET_CODE (last->loc) == EXPR_LIST)
5414 {
5415 piece_loc = &last->loc;
5416 do
5417 {
5418 HOST_WIDE_INT cur_bitsize = decl_piece_bitsize (*piece_loc);
5419 if (piece_bitpos + cur_bitsize > bitpos)
5420 break;
5421 piece_bitpos += cur_bitsize;
5422 piece_loc = &XEXP (*piece_loc, 1);
5423 }
5424 while (*piece_loc);
5425 }
5426 /* TEMP->LAST here is either pointer to the last but one or
5427 last element in the chained list, LAST is pointer to the
5428 last element. */
5429 if (label && strcmp (last->label, label) == 0)
5430 {
5431 /* For SRA optimized variables if there weren't any real
5432 insns since last note, just modify the last node. */
5433 if (piece_loc != NULL)
5434 {
5435 adjust_piece_list (piece_loc, NULL, NULL,
5436 bitpos, piece_bitpos, bitsize, loc_note);
5437 return NULL;
5438 }
5439 /* If the last note doesn't cover any instructions, remove it. */
5440 if (temp->last != last)
5441 {
5442 temp->last->next = NULL;
5443 unused = last;
5444 last = temp->last;
5445 gcc_assert (strcmp (last->label, label) != 0);
5446 }
5447 else
5448 {
5449 gcc_assert (temp->first == temp->last
5450 || (temp->first->next == temp->last
5451 && TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL));
5452 memset (temp->last, '\0', sizeof (*temp->last));
5453 temp->last->loc = construct_piece_list (loc_note, bitpos, bitsize);
5454 return temp->last;
5455 }
5456 }
5457 if (bitsize == -1 && NOTE_P (last->loc))
5458 last_loc_note = last->loc;
5459 else if (piece_loc != NULL
5460 && *piece_loc != NULL_RTX
5461 && piece_bitpos == bitpos
5462 && decl_piece_bitsize (*piece_loc) == bitsize)
5463 last_loc_note = *decl_piece_varloc_ptr (*piece_loc);
5464 else
5465 last_loc_note = NULL_RTX;
5466 /* If the current location is the same as the end of the list,
5467 and either both or neither of the locations is uninitialized,
5468 we have nothing to do. */
5469 if (last_loc_note == NULL_RTX
5470 || (!rtx_equal_p (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (last_loc_note),
5471 NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc_note)))
5472 || ((NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (last_loc_note)
5473 != NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc_note))
5474 && ((NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (last_loc_note)
5475 == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
5476 || (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc_note)
5477 == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED))))
5478 {
5479 /* Add LOC to the end of list and update LAST. If the last
5480 element of the list has been removed above, reuse its
5481 memory for the new node, otherwise allocate a new one. */
5482 if (unused)
5483 {
5484 loc = unused;
5485 memset (loc, '\0', sizeof (*loc));
5486 }
5487 else
5488 loc = ggc_cleared_alloc<var_loc_node> ();
5489 if (bitsize == -1 || piece_loc == NULL)
5490 loc->loc = construct_piece_list (loc_note, bitpos, bitsize);
5491 else
5492 adjust_piece_list (&loc->loc, &last->loc, piece_loc,
5493 bitpos, piece_bitpos, bitsize, loc_note);
5494 last->next = loc;
5495 /* Ensure TEMP->LAST will point either to the new last but one
5496 element of the chain, or to the last element in it. */
5497 if (last != temp->last)
5498 temp->last = last;
5499 }
5500 else if (unused)
5501 ggc_free (unused);
5502 }
5503 else
5504 {
5505 loc = ggc_cleared_alloc<var_loc_node> ();
5506 temp->first = loc;
5507 temp->last = loc;
5508 loc->loc = construct_piece_list (loc_note, bitpos, bitsize);
5509 }
5510 return loc;
5511 }
5512 \f
5513 /* Keep track of the number of spaces used to indent the
5514 output of the debugging routines that print the structure of
5515 the DIE internal representation. */
5516 static int print_indent;
5517
5518 /* Indent the line the number of spaces given by print_indent. */
5519
5520 static inline void
5521 print_spaces (FILE *outfile)
5522 {
5523 fprintf (outfile, "%*s", print_indent, "");
5524 }
5525
5526 /* Print a type signature in hex. */
5527
5528 static inline void
5529 print_signature (FILE *outfile, char *sig)
5530 {
5531 int i;
5532
5533 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
5534 fprintf (outfile, "%02x", sig[i] & 0xff);
5535 }
5536
5537 static inline void
5538 print_discr_value (FILE *outfile, dw_discr_value *discr_value)
5539 {
5540 if (discr_value->pos)
5541 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED, discr_value->v.sval);
5542 else
5543 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, discr_value->v.uval);
5544 }
5545
5546 static void print_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref, FILE *);
5547
5548 /* Print the value associated to the VAL DWARF value node to OUTFILE. If
5549 RECURSE, output location descriptor operations. */
5550
5551 static void
5552 print_dw_val (dw_val_node *val, bool recurse, FILE *outfile)
5553 {
5554 switch (val->val_class)
5555 {
5556 case dw_val_class_addr:
5557 fprintf (outfile, "address");
5558 break;
5559 case dw_val_class_offset:
5560 fprintf (outfile, "offset");
5561 break;
5562 case dw_val_class_loc:
5563 fprintf (outfile, "location descriptor");
5564 if (val->v.val_loc == NULL)
5565 fprintf (outfile, " -> <null>\n");
5566 else if (recurse)
5567 {
5568 fprintf (outfile, ":\n");
5569 print_indent += 4;
5570 print_loc_descr (val->v.val_loc, outfile);
5571 print_indent -= 4;
5572 }
5573 else
5574 fprintf (outfile, " (%p)\n", (void *) val->v.val_loc);
5575 break;
5576 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
5577 fprintf (outfile, "location list -> label:%s",
5578 val->v.val_loc_list->ll_symbol);
5579 break;
5580 case dw_val_class_range_list:
5581 fprintf (outfile, "range list");
5582 break;
5583 case dw_val_class_const:
5584 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, val->v.val_int);
5585 break;
5586 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
5587 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED, val->v.val_unsigned);
5588 break;
5589 case dw_val_class_const_double:
5590 fprintf (outfile, "constant (" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC","\
5591 HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED")",
5592 val->v.val_double.high,
5593 val->v.val_double.low);
5594 break;
5595 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
5596 {
5597 int i = val->v.val_wide->get_len ();
5598 fprintf (outfile, "constant (");
5599 gcc_assert (i > 0);
5600 if (val->v.val_wide->elt (i - 1) == 0)
5601 fprintf (outfile, "0x");
5602 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX,
5603 val->v.val_wide->elt (--i));
5604 while (--i >= 0)
5605 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_PADDED_HEX,
5606 val->v.val_wide->elt (i));
5607 fprintf (outfile, ")");
5608 break;
5609 }
5610 case dw_val_class_vec:
5611 fprintf (outfile, "floating-point or vector constant");
5612 break;
5613 case dw_val_class_flag:
5614 fprintf (outfile, "%u", val->v.val_flag);
5615 break;
5616 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
5617 if (val->v.val_die_ref.die != NULL)
5618 {
5619 dw_die_ref die = val->v.val_die_ref.die;
5620
5621 if (die->comdat_type_p)
5622 {
5623 fprintf (outfile, "die -> signature: ");
5624 print_signature (outfile,
5625 die->die_id.die_type_node->signature);
5626 }
5627 else if (die->die_id.die_symbol)
5628 fprintf (outfile, "die -> label: %s", die->die_id.die_symbol);
5629 else
5630 fprintf (outfile, "die -> %ld", die->die_offset);
5631 fprintf (outfile, " (%p)", (void *) die);
5632 }
5633 else
5634 fprintf (outfile, "die -> <null>");
5635 break;
5636 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
5637 fprintf (outfile, "delta: @slotcount(%s-%s)",
5638 val->v.val_vms_delta.lbl2, val->v.val_vms_delta.lbl1);
5639 break;
5640 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
5641 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
5642 case dw_val_class_macptr:
5643 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
5644 fprintf (outfile, "label: %s", val->v.val_lbl_id);
5645 break;
5646 case dw_val_class_str:
5647 if (val->v.val_str->str != NULL)
5648 fprintf (outfile, "\"%s\"", val->v.val_str->str);
5649 else
5650 fprintf (outfile, "<null>");
5651 break;
5652 case dw_val_class_file:
5653 fprintf (outfile, "\"%s\" (%d)", val->v.val_file->filename,
5654 val->v.val_file->emitted_number);
5655 break;
5656 case dw_val_class_data8:
5657 {
5658 int i;
5659
5660 for (i = 0; i < 8; i++)
5661 fprintf (outfile, "%02x", val->v.val_data8[i]);
5662 break;
5663 }
5664 case dw_val_class_discr_value:
5665 print_discr_value (outfile, &val->v.val_discr_value);
5666 break;
5667 case dw_val_class_discr_list:
5668 for (dw_discr_list_ref node = val->v.val_discr_list;
5669 node != NULL;
5670 node = node->dw_discr_next)
5671 {
5672 if (node->dw_discr_range)
5673 {
5674 fprintf (outfile, " .. ");
5675 print_discr_value (outfile, &node->dw_discr_lower_bound);
5676 print_discr_value (outfile, &node->dw_discr_upper_bound);
5677 }
5678 else
5679 print_discr_value (outfile, &node->dw_discr_lower_bound);
5680
5681 if (node->dw_discr_next != NULL)
5682 fprintf (outfile, " | ");
5683 }
5684 default:
5685 break;
5686 }
5687 }
5688
5689 /* Likewise, for a DIE attribute. */
5690
5691 static void
5692 print_attribute (dw_attr_node *a, bool recurse, FILE *outfile)
5693 {
5694 print_dw_val (&a->dw_attr_val, recurse, outfile);
5695 }
5696
5697
5698 /* Print the list of operands in the LOC location description to OUTFILE. This
5699 routine is a debugging aid only. */
5700
5701 static void
5702 print_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, FILE *outfile)
5703 {
5704 dw_loc_descr_ref l = loc;
5705
5706 if (loc == NULL)
5707 {
5708 print_spaces (outfile);
5709 fprintf (outfile, "<null>\n");
5710 return;
5711 }
5712
5713 for (l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
5714 {
5715 print_spaces (outfile);
5716 fprintf (outfile, "(%p) %s",
5717 (void *) l,
5718 dwarf_stack_op_name (l->dw_loc_opc));
5719 if (l->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class != dw_val_class_none)
5720 {
5721 fprintf (outfile, " ");
5722 print_dw_val (&l->dw_loc_oprnd1, false, outfile);
5723 }
5724 if (l->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class != dw_val_class_none)
5725 {
5726 fprintf (outfile, ", ");
5727 print_dw_val (&l->dw_loc_oprnd2, false, outfile);
5728 }
5729 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
5730 }
5731 }
5732
5733 /* Print the information associated with a given DIE, and its children.
5734 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
5735
5736 static void
5737 print_die (dw_die_ref die, FILE *outfile)
5738 {
5739 dw_attr_node *a;
5740 dw_die_ref c;
5741 unsigned ix;
5742
5743 print_spaces (outfile);
5744 fprintf (outfile, "DIE %4ld: %s (%p)\n",
5745 die->die_offset, dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag),
5746 (void*) die);
5747 print_spaces (outfile);
5748 fprintf (outfile, " abbrev id: %lu", die->die_abbrev);
5749 fprintf (outfile, " offset: %ld", die->die_offset);
5750 fprintf (outfile, " mark: %d\n", die->die_mark);
5751
5752 if (die->comdat_type_p)
5753 {
5754 print_spaces (outfile);
5755 fprintf (outfile, " signature: ");
5756 print_signature (outfile, die->die_id.die_type_node->signature);
5757 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
5758 }
5759
5760 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
5761 {
5762 print_spaces (outfile);
5763 fprintf (outfile, " %s: ", dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr));
5764
5765 print_attribute (a, true, outfile);
5766 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
5767 }
5768
5769 if (die->die_child != NULL)
5770 {
5771 print_indent += 4;
5772 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, print_die (c, outfile));
5773 print_indent -= 4;
5774 }
5775 if (print_indent == 0)
5776 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
5777 }
5778
5779 /* Print the list of operations in the LOC location description. */
5780
5781 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
5782 debug_dwarf_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
5783 {
5784 print_loc_descr (loc, stderr);
5785 }
5786
5787 /* Print the information collected for a given DIE. */
5788
5789 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
5790 debug_dwarf_die (dw_die_ref die)
5791 {
5792 print_die (die, stderr);
5793 }
5794
5795 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
5796 debug (die_struct &ref)
5797 {
5798 print_die (&ref, stderr);
5799 }
5800
5801 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
5802 debug (die_struct *ptr)
5803 {
5804 if (ptr)
5805 debug (*ptr);
5806 else
5807 fprintf (stderr, "<nil>\n");
5808 }
5809
5810
5811 /* Print all DWARF information collected for the compilation unit.
5812 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
5813
5814 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
5815 debug_dwarf (void)
5816 {
5817 print_indent = 0;
5818 print_die (comp_unit_die (), stderr);
5819 }
5820
5821 /* Sanity checks on DIEs. */
5822
5823 static void
5824 check_die (dw_die_ref die)
5825 {
5826 unsigned ix;
5827 dw_attr_node *a;
5828 bool inline_found = false;
5829 int n_location = 0, n_low_pc = 0, n_high_pc = 0, n_artificial = 0;
5830 int n_decl_line = 0, n_decl_file = 0;
5831 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
5832 {
5833 switch (a->dw_attr)
5834 {
5835 case DW_AT_inline:
5836 if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned)
5837 inline_found = true;
5838 break;
5839 case DW_AT_location:
5840 ++n_location;
5841 break;
5842 case DW_AT_low_pc:
5843 ++n_low_pc;
5844 break;
5845 case DW_AT_high_pc:
5846 ++n_high_pc;
5847 break;
5848 case DW_AT_artificial:
5849 ++n_artificial;
5850 break;
5851 case DW_AT_decl_line:
5852 ++n_decl_line;
5853 break;
5854 case DW_AT_decl_file:
5855 ++n_decl_file;
5856 break;
5857 default:
5858 break;
5859 }
5860 }
5861 if (n_location > 1 || n_low_pc > 1 || n_high_pc > 1 || n_artificial > 1
5862 || n_decl_line > 1 || n_decl_file > 1)
5863 {
5864 fprintf (stderr, "Duplicate attributes in DIE:\n");
5865 debug_dwarf_die (die);
5866 gcc_unreachable ();
5867 }
5868 if (inline_found)
5869 {
5870 /* A debugging information entry that is a member of an abstract
5871 instance tree [that has DW_AT_inline] should not contain any
5872 attributes which describe aspects of the subroutine which vary
5873 between distinct inlined expansions or distinct out-of-line
5874 expansions. */
5875 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
5876 gcc_assert (a->dw_attr != DW_AT_low_pc
5877 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_high_pc
5878 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_location
5879 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_frame_base
5880 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_GNU_all_call_sites);
5881 }
5882 }
5883 \f
5884 /* Start a new compilation unit DIE for an include file. OLD_UNIT is the CU
5885 for the enclosing include file, if any. BINCL_DIE is the DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL
5886 DIE that marks the start of the DIEs for this include file. */
5887
5888 static dw_die_ref
5889 push_new_compile_unit (dw_die_ref old_unit, dw_die_ref bincl_die)
5890 {
5891 const char *filename = get_AT_string (bincl_die, DW_AT_name);
5892 dw_die_ref new_unit = gen_compile_unit_die (filename);
5893
5894 new_unit->die_sib = old_unit;
5895 return new_unit;
5896 }
5897
5898 /* Close an include-file CU and reopen the enclosing one. */
5899
5900 static dw_die_ref
5901 pop_compile_unit (dw_die_ref old_unit)
5902 {
5903 dw_die_ref new_unit = old_unit->die_sib;
5904
5905 old_unit->die_sib = NULL;
5906 return new_unit;
5907 }
5908
5909 #define CHECKSUM(FOO) md5_process_bytes (&(FOO), sizeof (FOO), ctx)
5910 #define CHECKSUM_BLOCK(FOO, SIZE) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), (SIZE), ctx)
5911 #define CHECKSUM_STRING(FOO) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), strlen (FOO), ctx)
5912
5913 /* Calculate the checksum of a location expression. */
5914
5915 static inline void
5916 loc_checksum (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
5917 {
5918 int tem;
5919 inchash::hash hstate;
5920 hashval_t hash;
5921
5922 tem = (loc->dtprel << 8) | ((unsigned int) loc->dw_loc_opc);
5923 CHECKSUM (tem);
5924 hash_loc_operands (loc, hstate);
5925 hash = hstate.end();
5926 CHECKSUM (hash);
5927 }
5928
5929 /* Calculate the checksum of an attribute. */
5930
5931 static void
5932 attr_checksum (dw_attr_node *at, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
5933 {
5934 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
5935 rtx r;
5936
5937 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr);
5938
5939 /* We don't care that this was compiled with a different compiler
5940 snapshot; if the output is the same, that's what matters. */
5941 if (at->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
5942 return;
5943
5944 switch (AT_class (at))
5945 {
5946 case dw_val_class_const:
5947 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_int);
5948 break;
5949 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
5950 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned);
5951 break;
5952 case dw_val_class_const_double:
5953 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_double);
5954 break;
5955 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
5956 CHECKSUM_BLOCK (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide->get_val (),
5957 get_full_len (*at->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide)
5958 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR);
5959 break;
5960 case dw_val_class_vec:
5961 CHECKSUM_BLOCK (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array,
5962 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
5963 * at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size));
5964 break;
5965 case dw_val_class_flag:
5966 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag);
5967 break;
5968 case dw_val_class_str:
5969 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (at));
5970 break;
5971
5972 case dw_val_class_addr:
5973 r = AT_addr (at);
5974 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (r) == SYMBOL_REF);
5975 CHECKSUM_STRING (XSTR (r, 0));
5976 break;
5977
5978 case dw_val_class_offset:
5979 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
5980 break;
5981
5982 case dw_val_class_loc:
5983 for (loc = AT_loc (at); loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
5984 loc_checksum (loc, ctx);
5985 break;
5986
5987 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
5988 die_checksum (AT_ref (at), ctx, mark);
5989 break;
5990
5991 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
5992 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
5993 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
5994 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
5995 case dw_val_class_macptr:
5996 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
5997 break;
5998
5999 case dw_val_class_file:
6000 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_file (at)->filename);
6001 break;
6002
6003 case dw_val_class_data8:
6004 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_data8);
6005 break;
6006
6007 default:
6008 break;
6009 }
6010 }
6011
6012 /* Calculate the checksum of a DIE. */
6013
6014 static void
6015 die_checksum (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
6016 {
6017 dw_die_ref c;
6018 dw_attr_node *a;
6019 unsigned ix;
6020
6021 /* To avoid infinite recursion. */
6022 if (die->die_mark)
6023 {
6024 CHECKSUM (die->die_mark);
6025 return;
6026 }
6027 die->die_mark = ++(*mark);
6028
6029 CHECKSUM (die->die_tag);
6030
6031 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
6032 attr_checksum (a, ctx, mark);
6033
6034 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, die_checksum (c, ctx, mark));
6035 }
6036
6037 #undef CHECKSUM
6038 #undef CHECKSUM_BLOCK
6039 #undef CHECKSUM_STRING
6040
6041 /* For DWARF-4 types, include the trailing NULL when checksumming strings. */
6042 #define CHECKSUM(FOO) md5_process_bytes (&(FOO), sizeof (FOO), ctx)
6043 #define CHECKSUM_BLOCK(FOO, SIZE) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), (SIZE), ctx)
6044 #define CHECKSUM_STRING(FOO) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), strlen (FOO) + 1, ctx)
6045 #define CHECKSUM_SLEB128(FOO) checksum_sleb128 ((FOO), ctx)
6046 #define CHECKSUM_ULEB128(FOO) checksum_uleb128 ((FOO), ctx)
6047 #define CHECKSUM_ATTR(FOO) \
6048 if (FOO) attr_checksum_ordered (die->die_tag, (FOO), ctx, mark)
6049
6050 /* Calculate the checksum of a number in signed LEB128 format. */
6051
6052 static void
6053 checksum_sleb128 (HOST_WIDE_INT value, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
6054 {
6055 unsigned char byte;
6056 bool more;
6057
6058 while (1)
6059 {
6060 byte = (value & 0x7f);
6061 value >>= 7;
6062 more = !((value == 0 && (byte & 0x40) == 0)
6063 || (value == -1 && (byte & 0x40) != 0));
6064 if (more)
6065 byte |= 0x80;
6066 CHECKSUM (byte);
6067 if (!more)
6068 break;
6069 }
6070 }
6071
6072 /* Calculate the checksum of a number in unsigned LEB128 format. */
6073
6074 static void
6075 checksum_uleb128 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT value, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
6076 {
6077 while (1)
6078 {
6079 unsigned char byte = (value & 0x7f);
6080 value >>= 7;
6081 if (value != 0)
6082 /* More bytes to follow. */
6083 byte |= 0x80;
6084 CHECKSUM (byte);
6085 if (value == 0)
6086 break;
6087 }
6088 }
6089
6090 /* Checksum the context of the DIE. This adds the names of any
6091 surrounding namespaces or structures to the checksum. */
6092
6093 static void
6094 checksum_die_context (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
6095 {
6096 const char *name;
6097 dw_die_ref spec;
6098 int tag = die->die_tag;
6099
6100 if (tag != DW_TAG_namespace
6101 && tag != DW_TAG_structure_type
6102 && tag != DW_TAG_class_type)
6103 return;
6104
6105 name = get_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name);
6106
6107 spec = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
6108 if (spec != NULL)
6109 die = spec;
6110
6111 if (die->die_parent != NULL)
6112 checksum_die_context (die->die_parent, ctx);
6113
6114 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('C');
6115 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (tag);
6116 if (name != NULL)
6117 CHECKSUM_STRING (name);
6118 }
6119
6120 /* Calculate the checksum of a location expression. */
6121
6122 static inline void
6123 loc_checksum_ordered (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
6124 {
6125 /* Special case for lone DW_OP_plus_uconst: checksum as if the location
6126 were emitted as a DW_FORM_sdata instead of a location expression. */
6127 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_plus_uconst && loc->dw_loc_next == NULL)
6128 {
6129 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
6130 CHECKSUM_SLEB128 ((HOST_WIDE_INT) loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
6131 return;
6132 }
6133
6134 /* Otherwise, just checksum the raw location expression. */
6135 while (loc != NULL)
6136 {
6137 inchash::hash hstate;
6138 hashval_t hash;
6139
6140 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (loc->dtprel);
6141 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (loc->dw_loc_opc);
6142 hash_loc_operands (loc, hstate);
6143 hash = hstate.end ();
6144 CHECKSUM (hash);
6145 loc = loc->dw_loc_next;
6146 }
6147 }
6148
6149 /* Calculate the checksum of an attribute. */
6150
6151 static void
6152 attr_checksum_ordered (enum dwarf_tag tag, dw_attr_node *at,
6153 struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
6154 {
6155 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
6156 rtx r;
6157
6158 if (AT_class (at) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
6159 {
6160 dw_die_ref target_die = AT_ref (at);
6161
6162 /* For pointer and reference types, we checksum only the (qualified)
6163 name of the target type (if there is a name). For friend entries,
6164 we checksum only the (qualified) name of the target type or function.
6165 This allows the checksum to remain the same whether the target type
6166 is complete or not. */
6167 if ((at->dw_attr == DW_AT_type
6168 && (tag == DW_TAG_pointer_type
6169 || tag == DW_TAG_reference_type
6170 || tag == DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type
6171 || tag == DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type))
6172 || (at->dw_attr == DW_AT_friend
6173 && tag == DW_TAG_friend))
6174 {
6175 dw_attr_node *name_attr = get_AT (target_die, DW_AT_name);
6176
6177 if (name_attr != NULL)
6178 {
6179 dw_die_ref decl = get_AT_ref (target_die, DW_AT_specification);
6180
6181 if (decl == NULL)
6182 decl = target_die;
6183 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('N');
6184 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
6185 if (decl->die_parent != NULL)
6186 checksum_die_context (decl->die_parent, ctx);
6187 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('E');
6188 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (name_attr));
6189 return;
6190 }
6191 }
6192
6193 /* For all other references to another DIE, we check to see if the
6194 target DIE has already been visited. If it has, we emit a
6195 backward reference; if not, we descend recursively. */
6196 if (target_die->die_mark > 0)
6197 {
6198 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('R');
6199 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
6200 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (target_die->die_mark);
6201 }
6202 else
6203 {
6204 dw_die_ref decl = get_AT_ref (target_die, DW_AT_specification);
6205
6206 if (decl == NULL)
6207 decl = target_die;
6208 target_die->die_mark = ++(*mark);
6209 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('T');
6210 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
6211 if (decl->die_parent != NULL)
6212 checksum_die_context (decl->die_parent, ctx);
6213 die_checksum_ordered (target_die, ctx, mark);
6214 }
6215 return;
6216 }
6217
6218 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('A');
6219 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
6220
6221 switch (AT_class (at))
6222 {
6223 case dw_val_class_const:
6224 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
6225 CHECKSUM_SLEB128 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_int);
6226 break;
6227
6228 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6229 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
6230 CHECKSUM_SLEB128 ((int) at->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned);
6231 break;
6232
6233 case dw_val_class_const_double:
6234 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_block);
6235 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (sizeof (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_double));
6236 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_double);
6237 break;
6238
6239 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
6240 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_block);
6241 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (get_full_len (*at->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide)
6242 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / BITS_PER_UNIT);
6243 CHECKSUM_BLOCK (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide->get_val (),
6244 get_full_len (*at->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide)
6245 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR);
6246 break;
6247
6248 case dw_val_class_vec:
6249 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_block);
6250 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
6251 * at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size);
6252 CHECKSUM_BLOCK (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array,
6253 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
6254 * at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size));
6255 break;
6256
6257 case dw_val_class_flag:
6258 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_flag);
6259 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag ? 1 : 0);
6260 break;
6261
6262 case dw_val_class_str:
6263 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_string);
6264 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (at));
6265 break;
6266
6267 case dw_val_class_addr:
6268 r = AT_addr (at);
6269 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (r) == SYMBOL_REF);
6270 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_string);
6271 CHECKSUM_STRING (XSTR (r, 0));
6272 break;
6273
6274 case dw_val_class_offset:
6275 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
6276 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
6277 break;
6278
6279 case dw_val_class_loc:
6280 for (loc = AT_loc (at); loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
6281 loc_checksum_ordered (loc, ctx);
6282 break;
6283
6284 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
6285 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6286 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
6287 case dw_val_class_macptr:
6288 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
6289 break;
6290
6291 case dw_val_class_file:
6292 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_string);
6293 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_file (at)->filename);
6294 break;
6295
6296 case dw_val_class_data8:
6297 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_data8);
6298 break;
6299
6300 default:
6301 break;
6302 }
6303 }
6304
6305 struct checksum_attributes
6306 {
6307 dw_attr_node *at_name;
6308 dw_attr_node *at_type;
6309 dw_attr_node *at_friend;
6310 dw_attr_node *at_accessibility;
6311 dw_attr_node *at_address_class;
6312 dw_attr_node *at_allocated;
6313 dw_attr_node *at_artificial;
6314 dw_attr_node *at_associated;
6315 dw_attr_node *at_binary_scale;
6316 dw_attr_node *at_bit_offset;
6317 dw_attr_node *at_bit_size;
6318 dw_attr_node *at_bit_stride;
6319 dw_attr_node *at_byte_size;
6320 dw_attr_node *at_byte_stride;
6321 dw_attr_node *at_const_value;
6322 dw_attr_node *at_containing_type;
6323 dw_attr_node *at_count;
6324 dw_attr_node *at_data_location;
6325 dw_attr_node *at_data_member_location;
6326 dw_attr_node *at_decimal_scale;
6327 dw_attr_node *at_decimal_sign;
6328 dw_attr_node *at_default_value;
6329 dw_attr_node *at_digit_count;
6330 dw_attr_node *at_discr;
6331 dw_attr_node *at_discr_list;
6332 dw_attr_node *at_discr_value;
6333 dw_attr_node *at_encoding;
6334 dw_attr_node *at_endianity;
6335 dw_attr_node *at_explicit;
6336 dw_attr_node *at_is_optional;
6337 dw_attr_node *at_location;
6338 dw_attr_node *at_lower_bound;
6339 dw_attr_node *at_mutable;
6340 dw_attr_node *at_ordering;
6341 dw_attr_node *at_picture_string;
6342 dw_attr_node *at_prototyped;
6343 dw_attr_node *at_small;
6344 dw_attr_node *at_segment;
6345 dw_attr_node *at_string_length;
6346 dw_attr_node *at_threads_scaled;
6347 dw_attr_node *at_upper_bound;
6348 dw_attr_node *at_use_location;
6349 dw_attr_node *at_use_UTF8;
6350 dw_attr_node *at_variable_parameter;
6351 dw_attr_node *at_virtuality;
6352 dw_attr_node *at_visibility;
6353 dw_attr_node *at_vtable_elem_location;
6354 };
6355
6356 /* Collect the attributes that we will want to use for the checksum. */
6357
6358 static void
6359 collect_checksum_attributes (struct checksum_attributes *attrs, dw_die_ref die)
6360 {
6361 dw_attr_node *a;
6362 unsigned ix;
6363
6364 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
6365 {
6366 switch (a->dw_attr)
6367 {
6368 case DW_AT_name:
6369 attrs->at_name = a;
6370 break;
6371 case DW_AT_type:
6372 attrs->at_type = a;
6373 break;
6374 case DW_AT_friend:
6375 attrs->at_friend = a;
6376 break;
6377 case DW_AT_accessibility:
6378 attrs->at_accessibility = a;
6379 break;
6380 case DW_AT_address_class:
6381 attrs->at_address_class = a;
6382 break;
6383 case DW_AT_allocated:
6384 attrs->at_allocated = a;
6385 break;
6386 case DW_AT_artificial:
6387 attrs->at_artificial = a;
6388 break;
6389 case DW_AT_associated:
6390 attrs->at_associated = a;
6391 break;
6392 case DW_AT_binary_scale:
6393 attrs->at_binary_scale = a;
6394 break;
6395 case DW_AT_bit_offset:
6396 attrs->at_bit_offset = a;
6397 break;
6398 case DW_AT_bit_size:
6399 attrs->at_bit_size = a;
6400 break;
6401 case DW_AT_bit_stride:
6402 attrs->at_bit_stride = a;
6403 break;
6404 case DW_AT_byte_size:
6405 attrs->at_byte_size = a;
6406 break;
6407 case DW_AT_byte_stride:
6408 attrs->at_byte_stride = a;
6409 break;
6410 case DW_AT_const_value:
6411 attrs->at_const_value = a;
6412 break;
6413 case DW_AT_containing_type:
6414 attrs->at_containing_type = a;
6415 break;
6416 case DW_AT_count:
6417 attrs->at_count = a;
6418 break;
6419 case DW_AT_data_location:
6420 attrs->at_data_location = a;
6421 break;
6422 case DW_AT_data_member_location:
6423 attrs->at_data_member_location = a;
6424 break;
6425 case DW_AT_decimal_scale:
6426 attrs->at_decimal_scale = a;
6427 break;
6428 case DW_AT_decimal_sign:
6429 attrs->at_decimal_sign = a;
6430 break;
6431 case DW_AT_default_value:
6432 attrs->at_default_value = a;
6433 break;
6434 case DW_AT_digit_count:
6435 attrs->at_digit_count = a;
6436 break;
6437 case DW_AT_discr:
6438 attrs->at_discr = a;
6439 break;
6440 case DW_AT_discr_list:
6441 attrs->at_discr_list = a;
6442 break;
6443 case DW_AT_discr_value:
6444 attrs->at_discr_value = a;
6445 break;
6446 case DW_AT_encoding:
6447 attrs->at_encoding = a;
6448 break;
6449 case DW_AT_endianity:
6450 attrs->at_endianity = a;
6451 break;
6452 case DW_AT_explicit:
6453 attrs->at_explicit = a;
6454 break;
6455 case DW_AT_is_optional:
6456 attrs->at_is_optional = a;
6457 break;
6458 case DW_AT_location:
6459 attrs->at_location = a;
6460 break;
6461 case DW_AT_lower_bound:
6462 attrs->at_lower_bound = a;
6463 break;
6464 case DW_AT_mutable:
6465 attrs->at_mutable = a;
6466 break;
6467 case DW_AT_ordering:
6468 attrs->at_ordering = a;
6469 break;
6470 case DW_AT_picture_string:
6471 attrs->at_picture_string = a;
6472 break;
6473 case DW_AT_prototyped:
6474 attrs->at_prototyped = a;
6475 break;
6476 case DW_AT_small:
6477 attrs->at_small = a;
6478 break;
6479 case DW_AT_segment:
6480 attrs->at_segment = a;
6481 break;
6482 case DW_AT_string_length:
6483 attrs->at_string_length = a;
6484 break;
6485 case DW_AT_threads_scaled:
6486 attrs->at_threads_scaled = a;
6487 break;
6488 case DW_AT_upper_bound:
6489 attrs->at_upper_bound = a;
6490 break;
6491 case DW_AT_use_location:
6492 attrs->at_use_location = a;
6493 break;
6494 case DW_AT_use_UTF8:
6495 attrs->at_use_UTF8 = a;
6496 break;
6497 case DW_AT_variable_parameter:
6498 attrs->at_variable_parameter = a;
6499 break;
6500 case DW_AT_virtuality:
6501 attrs->at_virtuality = a;
6502 break;
6503 case DW_AT_visibility:
6504 attrs->at_visibility = a;
6505 break;
6506 case DW_AT_vtable_elem_location:
6507 attrs->at_vtable_elem_location = a;
6508 break;
6509 default:
6510 break;
6511 }
6512 }
6513 }
6514
6515 /* Calculate the checksum of a DIE, using an ordered subset of attributes. */
6516
6517 static void
6518 die_checksum_ordered (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
6519 {
6520 dw_die_ref c;
6521 dw_die_ref decl;
6522 struct checksum_attributes attrs;
6523
6524 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('D');
6525 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (die->die_tag);
6526
6527 memset (&attrs, 0, sizeof (attrs));
6528
6529 decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
6530 if (decl != NULL)
6531 collect_checksum_attributes (&attrs, decl);
6532 collect_checksum_attributes (&attrs, die);
6533
6534 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_name);
6535 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_accessibility);
6536 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_address_class);
6537 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_allocated);
6538 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_artificial);
6539 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_associated);
6540 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_binary_scale);
6541 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_bit_offset);
6542 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_bit_size);
6543 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_bit_stride);
6544 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_byte_size);
6545 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_byte_stride);
6546 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_const_value);
6547 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_containing_type);
6548 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_count);
6549 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_data_location);
6550 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_data_member_location);
6551 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_decimal_scale);
6552 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_decimal_sign);
6553 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_default_value);
6554 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_digit_count);
6555 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_discr);
6556 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_discr_list);
6557 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_discr_value);
6558 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_encoding);
6559 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_endianity);
6560 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_explicit);
6561 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_is_optional);
6562 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_location);
6563 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_lower_bound);
6564 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_mutable);
6565 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_ordering);
6566 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_picture_string);
6567 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_prototyped);
6568 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_small);
6569 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_segment);
6570 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_string_length);
6571 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_threads_scaled);
6572 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_upper_bound);
6573 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_use_location);
6574 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_use_UTF8);
6575 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_variable_parameter);
6576 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_virtuality);
6577 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_visibility);
6578 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_vtable_elem_location);
6579 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_type);
6580 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_friend);
6581
6582 /* Checksum the child DIEs. */
6583 c = die->die_child;
6584 if (c) do {
6585 dw_attr_node *name_attr;
6586
6587 c = c->die_sib;
6588 name_attr = get_AT (c, DW_AT_name);
6589 if (is_template_instantiation (c))
6590 {
6591 /* Ignore instantiations of member type and function templates. */
6592 }
6593 else if (name_attr != NULL
6594 && (is_type_die (c) || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram))
6595 {
6596 /* Use a shallow checksum for named nested types and member
6597 functions. */
6598 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('S');
6599 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (c->die_tag);
6600 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (name_attr));
6601 }
6602 else
6603 {
6604 /* Use a deep checksum for other children. */
6605 /* Mark this DIE so it gets processed when unmarking. */
6606 if (c->die_mark == 0)
6607 c->die_mark = -1;
6608 die_checksum_ordered (c, ctx, mark);
6609 }
6610 } while (c != die->die_child);
6611
6612 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (0);
6613 }
6614
6615 /* Add a type name and tag to a hash. */
6616 static void
6617 die_odr_checksum (int tag, const char *name, md5_ctx *ctx)
6618 {
6619 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (tag);
6620 CHECKSUM_STRING (name);
6621 }
6622
6623 #undef CHECKSUM
6624 #undef CHECKSUM_STRING
6625 #undef CHECKSUM_ATTR
6626 #undef CHECKSUM_LEB128
6627 #undef CHECKSUM_ULEB128
6628
6629 /* Generate the type signature for DIE. This is computed by generating an
6630 MD5 checksum over the DIE's tag, its relevant attributes, and its
6631 children. Attributes that are references to other DIEs are processed
6632 by recursion, using the MARK field to prevent infinite recursion.
6633 If the DIE is nested inside a namespace or another type, we also
6634 need to include that context in the signature. The lower 64 bits
6635 of the resulting MD5 checksum comprise the signature. */
6636
6637 static void
6638 generate_type_signature (dw_die_ref die, comdat_type_node *type_node)
6639 {
6640 int mark;
6641 const char *name;
6642 unsigned char checksum[16];
6643 struct md5_ctx ctx;
6644 dw_die_ref decl;
6645 dw_die_ref parent;
6646
6647 name = get_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name);
6648 decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
6649 parent = get_die_parent (die);
6650
6651 /* First, compute a signature for just the type name (and its surrounding
6652 context, if any. This is stored in the type unit DIE for link-time
6653 ODR (one-definition rule) checking. */
6654
6655 if (is_cxx () && name != NULL)
6656 {
6657 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
6658
6659 /* Checksum the names of surrounding namespaces and structures. */
6660 if (parent != NULL)
6661 checksum_die_context (parent, &ctx);
6662
6663 /* Checksum the current DIE. */
6664 die_odr_checksum (die->die_tag, name, &ctx);
6665 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
6666
6667 add_AT_data8 (type_node->root_die, DW_AT_GNU_odr_signature, &checksum[8]);
6668 }
6669
6670 /* Next, compute the complete type signature. */
6671
6672 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
6673 mark = 1;
6674 die->die_mark = mark;
6675
6676 /* Checksum the names of surrounding namespaces and structures. */
6677 if (parent != NULL)
6678 checksum_die_context (parent, &ctx);
6679
6680 /* Checksum the DIE and its children. */
6681 die_checksum_ordered (die, &ctx, &mark);
6682 unmark_all_dies (die);
6683 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
6684
6685 /* Store the signature in the type node and link the type DIE and the
6686 type node together. */
6687 memcpy (type_node->signature, &checksum[16 - DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE],
6688 DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE);
6689 die->comdat_type_p = true;
6690 die->die_id.die_type_node = type_node;
6691 type_node->type_die = die;
6692
6693 /* If the DIE is a specification, link its declaration to the type node
6694 as well. */
6695 if (decl != NULL)
6696 {
6697 decl->comdat_type_p = true;
6698 decl->die_id.die_type_node = type_node;
6699 }
6700 }
6701
6702 /* Do the location expressions look same? */
6703 static inline int
6704 same_loc_p (dw_loc_descr_ref loc1, dw_loc_descr_ref loc2, int *mark)
6705 {
6706 return loc1->dw_loc_opc == loc2->dw_loc_opc
6707 && same_dw_val_p (&loc1->dw_loc_oprnd1, &loc2->dw_loc_oprnd1, mark)
6708 && same_dw_val_p (&loc1->dw_loc_oprnd2, &loc2->dw_loc_oprnd2, mark);
6709 }
6710
6711 /* Do the values look the same? */
6712 static int
6713 same_dw_val_p (const dw_val_node *v1, const dw_val_node *v2, int *mark)
6714 {
6715 dw_loc_descr_ref loc1, loc2;
6716 rtx r1, r2;
6717
6718 if (v1->val_class != v2->val_class)
6719 return 0;
6720
6721 switch (v1->val_class)
6722 {
6723 case dw_val_class_const:
6724 return v1->v.val_int == v2->v.val_int;
6725 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6726 return v1->v.val_unsigned == v2->v.val_unsigned;
6727 case dw_val_class_const_double:
6728 return v1->v.val_double.high == v2->v.val_double.high
6729 && v1->v.val_double.low == v2->v.val_double.low;
6730 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
6731 return *v1->v.val_wide == *v2->v.val_wide;
6732 case dw_val_class_vec:
6733 if (v1->v.val_vec.length != v2->v.val_vec.length
6734 || v1->v.val_vec.elt_size != v2->v.val_vec.elt_size)
6735 return 0;
6736 if (memcmp (v1->v.val_vec.array, v2->v.val_vec.array,
6737 v1->v.val_vec.length * v1->v.val_vec.elt_size))
6738 return 0;
6739 return 1;
6740 case dw_val_class_flag:
6741 return v1->v.val_flag == v2->v.val_flag;
6742 case dw_val_class_str:
6743 return !strcmp (v1->v.val_str->str, v2->v.val_str->str);
6744
6745 case dw_val_class_addr:
6746 r1 = v1->v.val_addr;
6747 r2 = v2->v.val_addr;
6748 if (GET_CODE (r1) != GET_CODE (r2))
6749 return 0;
6750 return !rtx_equal_p (r1, r2);
6751
6752 case dw_val_class_offset:
6753 return v1->v.val_offset == v2->v.val_offset;
6754
6755 case dw_val_class_loc:
6756 for (loc1 = v1->v.val_loc, loc2 = v2->v.val_loc;
6757 loc1 && loc2;
6758 loc1 = loc1->dw_loc_next, loc2 = loc2->dw_loc_next)
6759 if (!same_loc_p (loc1, loc2, mark))
6760 return 0;
6761 return !loc1 && !loc2;
6762
6763 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
6764 return same_die_p (v1->v.val_die_ref.die, v2->v.val_die_ref.die, mark);
6765
6766 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
6767 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
6768 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6769 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
6770 case dw_val_class_macptr:
6771 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
6772 return 1;
6773
6774 case dw_val_class_file:
6775 return v1->v.val_file == v2->v.val_file;
6776
6777 case dw_val_class_data8:
6778 return !memcmp (v1->v.val_data8, v2->v.val_data8, 8);
6779
6780 default:
6781 return 1;
6782 }
6783 }
6784
6785 /* Do the attributes look the same? */
6786
6787 static int
6788 same_attr_p (dw_attr_node *at1, dw_attr_node *at2, int *mark)
6789 {
6790 if (at1->dw_attr != at2->dw_attr)
6791 return 0;
6792
6793 /* We don't care that this was compiled with a different compiler
6794 snapshot; if the output is the same, that's what matters. */
6795 if (at1->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
6796 return 1;
6797
6798 return same_dw_val_p (&at1->dw_attr_val, &at2->dw_attr_val, mark);
6799 }
6800
6801 /* Do the dies look the same? */
6802
6803 static int
6804 same_die_p (dw_die_ref die1, dw_die_ref die2, int *mark)
6805 {
6806 dw_die_ref c1, c2;
6807 dw_attr_node *a1;
6808 unsigned ix;
6809
6810 /* To avoid infinite recursion. */
6811 if (die1->die_mark)
6812 return die1->die_mark == die2->die_mark;
6813 die1->die_mark = die2->die_mark = ++(*mark);
6814
6815 if (die1->die_tag != die2->die_tag)
6816 return 0;
6817
6818 if (vec_safe_length (die1->die_attr) != vec_safe_length (die2->die_attr))
6819 return 0;
6820
6821 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die1->die_attr, ix, a1)
6822 if (!same_attr_p (a1, &(*die2->die_attr)[ix], mark))
6823 return 0;
6824
6825 c1 = die1->die_child;
6826 c2 = die2->die_child;
6827 if (! c1)
6828 {
6829 if (c2)
6830 return 0;
6831 }
6832 else
6833 for (;;)
6834 {
6835 if (!same_die_p (c1, c2, mark))
6836 return 0;
6837 c1 = c1->die_sib;
6838 c2 = c2->die_sib;
6839 if (c1 == die1->die_child)
6840 {
6841 if (c2 == die2->die_child)
6842 break;
6843 else
6844 return 0;
6845 }
6846 }
6847
6848 return 1;
6849 }
6850
6851 /* Do the dies look the same? Wrapper around same_die_p. */
6852
6853 static int
6854 same_die_p_wrap (dw_die_ref die1, dw_die_ref die2)
6855 {
6856 int mark = 0;
6857 int ret = same_die_p (die1, die2, &mark);
6858
6859 unmark_all_dies (die1);
6860 unmark_all_dies (die2);
6861
6862 return ret;
6863 }
6864
6865 /* The prefix to attach to symbols on DIEs in the current comdat debug
6866 info section. */
6867 static const char *comdat_symbol_id;
6868
6869 /* The index of the current symbol within the current comdat CU. */
6870 static unsigned int comdat_symbol_number;
6871
6872 /* Calculate the MD5 checksum of the compilation unit DIE UNIT_DIE and its
6873 children, and set comdat_symbol_id accordingly. */
6874
6875 static void
6876 compute_section_prefix (dw_die_ref unit_die)
6877 {
6878 const char *die_name = get_AT_string (unit_die, DW_AT_name);
6879 const char *base = die_name ? lbasename (die_name) : "anonymous";
6880 char *name = XALLOCAVEC (char, strlen (base) + 64);
6881 char *p;
6882 int i, mark;
6883 unsigned char checksum[16];
6884 struct md5_ctx ctx;
6885
6886 /* Compute the checksum of the DIE, then append part of it as hex digits to
6887 the name filename of the unit. */
6888
6889 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
6890 mark = 0;
6891 die_checksum (unit_die, &ctx, &mark);
6892 unmark_all_dies (unit_die);
6893 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
6894
6895 sprintf (name, "%s.", base);
6896 clean_symbol_name (name);
6897
6898 p = name + strlen (name);
6899 for (i = 0; i < 4; i++)
6900 {
6901 sprintf (p, "%.2x", checksum[i]);
6902 p += 2;
6903 }
6904
6905 comdat_symbol_id = unit_die->die_id.die_symbol = xstrdup (name);
6906 comdat_symbol_number = 0;
6907 }
6908
6909 /* Returns nonzero if DIE represents a type, in the sense of TYPE_P. */
6910
6911 static int
6912 is_type_die (dw_die_ref die)
6913 {
6914 switch (die->die_tag)
6915 {
6916 case DW_TAG_array_type:
6917 case DW_TAG_class_type:
6918 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
6919 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
6920 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
6921 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
6922 case DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type:
6923 case DW_TAG_string_type:
6924 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
6925 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
6926 case DW_TAG_union_type:
6927 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
6928 case DW_TAG_set_type:
6929 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
6930 case DW_TAG_base_type:
6931 case DW_TAG_const_type:
6932 case DW_TAG_file_type:
6933 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
6934 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
6935 case DW_TAG_typedef:
6936 return 1;
6937 default:
6938 return 0;
6939 }
6940 }
6941
6942 /* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that should go into a COMDAT CU.
6943 Basically, we want to choose the bits that are likely to be shared between
6944 compilations (types) and leave out the bits that are specific to individual
6945 compilations (functions). */
6946
6947 static int
6948 is_comdat_die (dw_die_ref c)
6949 {
6950 /* I think we want to leave base types and __vtbl_ptr_type in the main CU, as
6951 we do for stabs. The advantage is a greater likelihood of sharing between
6952 objects that don't include headers in the same order (and therefore would
6953 put the base types in a different comdat). jason 8/28/00 */
6954
6955 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type)
6956 return 0;
6957
6958 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_pointer_type
6959 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_reference_type
6960 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type
6961 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_const_type
6962 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_volatile_type)
6963 {
6964 dw_die_ref t = get_AT_ref (c, DW_AT_type);
6965
6966 return t ? is_comdat_die (t) : 0;
6967 }
6968
6969 return is_type_die (c);
6970 }
6971
6972 /* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that might be referred to from another
6973 compilation unit. */
6974
6975 static int
6976 is_symbol_die (dw_die_ref c)
6977 {
6978 return (is_type_die (c)
6979 || is_declaration_die (c)
6980 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace
6981 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_module);
6982 }
6983
6984 /* Returns true iff C is a compile-unit DIE. */
6985
6986 static inline bool
6987 is_cu_die (dw_die_ref c)
6988 {
6989 return c && c->die_tag == DW_TAG_compile_unit;
6990 }
6991
6992 /* Returns true iff C is a unit DIE of some sort. */
6993
6994 static inline bool
6995 is_unit_die (dw_die_ref c)
6996 {
6997 return c && (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_compile_unit
6998 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_partial_unit
6999 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_type_unit);
7000 }
7001
7002 /* Returns true iff C is a namespace DIE. */
7003
7004 static inline bool
7005 is_namespace_die (dw_die_ref c)
7006 {
7007 return c && c->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace;
7008 }
7009
7010 /* Returns true iff C is a class or structure DIE. */
7011
7012 static inline bool
7013 is_class_die (dw_die_ref c)
7014 {
7015 return c && (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type
7016 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_structure_type);
7017 }
7018
7019 /* Return non-zero if this DIE is a template parameter. */
7020
7021 static inline bool
7022 is_template_parameter (dw_die_ref die)
7023 {
7024 switch (die->die_tag)
7025 {
7026 case DW_TAG_template_type_param:
7027 case DW_TAG_template_value_param:
7028 case DW_TAG_GNU_template_template_param:
7029 case DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack:
7030 return true;
7031 default:
7032 return false;
7033 }
7034 }
7035
7036 /* Return non-zero if this DIE represents a template instantiation. */
7037
7038 static inline bool
7039 is_template_instantiation (dw_die_ref die)
7040 {
7041 dw_die_ref c;
7042
7043 if (!is_type_die (die) && die->die_tag != DW_TAG_subprogram)
7044 return false;
7045 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, if (is_template_parameter (c)) return true);
7046 return false;
7047 }
7048
7049 static char *
7050 gen_internal_sym (const char *prefix)
7051 {
7052 char buf[256];
7053
7054 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (buf, prefix, label_num++);
7055 return xstrdup (buf);
7056 }
7057
7058 /* Assign symbols to all worthy DIEs under DIE. */
7059
7060 static void
7061 assign_symbol_names (dw_die_ref die)
7062 {
7063 dw_die_ref c;
7064
7065 if (is_symbol_die (die) && !die->comdat_type_p)
7066 {
7067 if (comdat_symbol_id)
7068 {
7069 char *p = XALLOCAVEC (char, strlen (comdat_symbol_id) + 64);
7070
7071 sprintf (p, "%s.%s.%x", DIE_LABEL_PREFIX,
7072 comdat_symbol_id, comdat_symbol_number++);
7073 die->die_id.die_symbol = xstrdup (p);
7074 }
7075 else
7076 die->die_id.die_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LDIE");
7077 }
7078
7079 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, assign_symbol_names (c));
7080 }
7081
7082 struct cu_hash_table_entry
7083 {
7084 dw_die_ref cu;
7085 unsigned min_comdat_num, max_comdat_num;
7086 struct cu_hash_table_entry *next;
7087 };
7088
7089 /* Helpers to manipulate hash table of CUs. */
7090
7091 struct cu_hash_table_entry_hasher : pointer_hash <cu_hash_table_entry>
7092 {
7093 typedef die_struct *compare_type;
7094 static inline hashval_t hash (const cu_hash_table_entry *);
7095 static inline bool equal (const cu_hash_table_entry *, const die_struct *);
7096 static inline void remove (cu_hash_table_entry *);
7097 };
7098
7099 inline hashval_t
7100 cu_hash_table_entry_hasher::hash (const cu_hash_table_entry *entry)
7101 {
7102 return htab_hash_string (entry->cu->die_id.die_symbol);
7103 }
7104
7105 inline bool
7106 cu_hash_table_entry_hasher::equal (const cu_hash_table_entry *entry1,
7107 const die_struct *entry2)
7108 {
7109 return !strcmp (entry1->cu->die_id.die_symbol, entry2->die_id.die_symbol);
7110 }
7111
7112 inline void
7113 cu_hash_table_entry_hasher::remove (cu_hash_table_entry *entry)
7114 {
7115 struct cu_hash_table_entry *next;
7116
7117 while (entry)
7118 {
7119 next = entry->next;
7120 free (entry);
7121 entry = next;
7122 }
7123 }
7124
7125 typedef hash_table<cu_hash_table_entry_hasher> cu_hash_type;
7126
7127 /* Check whether we have already seen this CU and set up SYM_NUM
7128 accordingly. */
7129 static int
7130 check_duplicate_cu (dw_die_ref cu, cu_hash_type *htable, unsigned int *sym_num)
7131 {
7132 struct cu_hash_table_entry dummy;
7133 struct cu_hash_table_entry **slot, *entry, *last = &dummy;
7134
7135 dummy.max_comdat_num = 0;
7136
7137 slot = htable->find_slot_with_hash (cu,
7138 htab_hash_string (cu->die_id.die_symbol),
7139 INSERT);
7140 entry = *slot;
7141
7142 for (; entry; last = entry, entry = entry->next)
7143 {
7144 if (same_die_p_wrap (cu, entry->cu))
7145 break;
7146 }
7147
7148 if (entry)
7149 {
7150 *sym_num = entry->min_comdat_num;
7151 return 1;
7152 }
7153
7154 entry = XCNEW (struct cu_hash_table_entry);
7155 entry->cu = cu;
7156 entry->min_comdat_num = *sym_num = last->max_comdat_num;
7157 entry->next = *slot;
7158 *slot = entry;
7159
7160 return 0;
7161 }
7162
7163 /* Record SYM_NUM to record of CU in HTABLE. */
7164 static void
7165 record_comdat_symbol_number (dw_die_ref cu, cu_hash_type *htable,
7166 unsigned int sym_num)
7167 {
7168 struct cu_hash_table_entry **slot, *entry;
7169
7170 slot = htable->find_slot_with_hash (cu,
7171 htab_hash_string (cu->die_id.die_symbol),
7172 NO_INSERT);
7173 entry = *slot;
7174
7175 entry->max_comdat_num = sym_num;
7176 }
7177
7178 /* Traverse the DIE (which is always comp_unit_die), and set up
7179 additional compilation units for each of the include files we see
7180 bracketed by BINCL/EINCL. */
7181
7182 static void
7183 break_out_includes (dw_die_ref die)
7184 {
7185 dw_die_ref c;
7186 dw_die_ref unit = NULL;
7187 limbo_die_node *node, **pnode;
7188
7189 c = die->die_child;
7190 if (c) do {
7191 dw_die_ref prev = c;
7192 c = c->die_sib;
7193 while (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL
7194 || (unit && is_comdat_die (c)))
7195 {
7196 dw_die_ref next = c->die_sib;
7197
7198 /* This DIE is for a secondary CU; remove it from the main one. */
7199 remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
7200
7201 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL)
7202 unit = push_new_compile_unit (unit, c);
7203 else if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL)
7204 unit = pop_compile_unit (unit);
7205 else
7206 add_child_die (unit, c);
7207 c = next;
7208 if (c == die->die_child)
7209 break;
7210 }
7211 } while (c != die->die_child);
7212
7213 #if 0
7214 /* We can only use this in debugging, since the frontend doesn't check
7215 to make sure that we leave every include file we enter. */
7216 gcc_assert (!unit);
7217 #endif
7218
7219 assign_symbol_names (die);
7220 cu_hash_type cu_hash_table (10);
7221 for (node = limbo_die_list, pnode = &limbo_die_list;
7222 node;
7223 node = node->next)
7224 {
7225 int is_dupl;
7226
7227 compute_section_prefix (node->die);
7228 is_dupl = check_duplicate_cu (node->die, &cu_hash_table,
7229 &comdat_symbol_number);
7230 assign_symbol_names (node->die);
7231 if (is_dupl)
7232 *pnode = node->next;
7233 else
7234 {
7235 pnode = &node->next;
7236 record_comdat_symbol_number (node->die, &cu_hash_table,
7237 comdat_symbol_number);
7238 }
7239 }
7240 }
7241
7242 /* Return non-zero if this DIE is a declaration. */
7243
7244 static int
7245 is_declaration_die (dw_die_ref die)
7246 {
7247 dw_attr_node *a;
7248 unsigned ix;
7249
7250 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
7251 if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_declaration)
7252 return 1;
7253
7254 return 0;
7255 }
7256
7257 /* Return non-zero if this DIE is nested inside a subprogram. */
7258
7259 static int
7260 is_nested_in_subprogram (dw_die_ref die)
7261 {
7262 dw_die_ref decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
7263
7264 if (decl == NULL)
7265 decl = die;
7266 return local_scope_p (decl);
7267 }
7268
7269 /* Return non-zero if this DIE contains a defining declaration of a
7270 subprogram. */
7271
7272 static int
7273 contains_subprogram_definition (dw_die_ref die)
7274 {
7275 dw_die_ref c;
7276
7277 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram && ! is_declaration_die (die))
7278 return 1;
7279 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, if (contains_subprogram_definition (c)) return 1);
7280 return 0;
7281 }
7282
7283 /* Return non-zero if this is a type DIE that should be moved to a
7284 COMDAT .debug_types section. */
7285
7286 static int
7287 should_move_die_to_comdat (dw_die_ref die)
7288 {
7289 switch (die->die_tag)
7290 {
7291 case DW_TAG_class_type:
7292 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
7293 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
7294 case DW_TAG_union_type:
7295 /* Don't move declarations, inlined instances, types nested in a
7296 subprogram, or types that contain subprogram definitions. */
7297 if (is_declaration_die (die)
7298 || get_AT (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin)
7299 || is_nested_in_subprogram (die)
7300 || contains_subprogram_definition (die))
7301 return 0;
7302 return 1;
7303 case DW_TAG_array_type:
7304 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
7305 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
7306 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
7307 case DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type:
7308 case DW_TAG_string_type:
7309 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
7310 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
7311 case DW_TAG_set_type:
7312 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
7313 case DW_TAG_base_type:
7314 case DW_TAG_const_type:
7315 case DW_TAG_file_type:
7316 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
7317 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
7318 case DW_TAG_typedef:
7319 default:
7320 return 0;
7321 }
7322 }
7323
7324 /* Make a clone of DIE. */
7325
7326 static dw_die_ref
7327 clone_die (dw_die_ref die)
7328 {
7329 dw_die_ref clone;
7330 dw_attr_node *a;
7331 unsigned ix;
7332
7333 clone = ggc_cleared_alloc<die_node> ();
7334 clone->die_tag = die->die_tag;
7335
7336 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
7337 add_dwarf_attr (clone, a);
7338
7339 return clone;
7340 }
7341
7342 /* Make a clone of the tree rooted at DIE. */
7343
7344 static dw_die_ref
7345 clone_tree (dw_die_ref die)
7346 {
7347 dw_die_ref c;
7348 dw_die_ref clone = clone_die (die);
7349
7350 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, add_child_die (clone, clone_tree (c)));
7351
7352 return clone;
7353 }
7354
7355 /* Make a clone of DIE as a declaration. */
7356
7357 static dw_die_ref
7358 clone_as_declaration (dw_die_ref die)
7359 {
7360 dw_die_ref clone;
7361 dw_die_ref decl;
7362 dw_attr_node *a;
7363 unsigned ix;
7364
7365 /* If the DIE is already a declaration, just clone it. */
7366 if (is_declaration_die (die))
7367 return clone_die (die);
7368
7369 /* If the DIE is a specification, just clone its declaration DIE. */
7370 decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
7371 if (decl != NULL)
7372 {
7373 clone = clone_die (decl);
7374 if (die->comdat_type_p)
7375 add_AT_die_ref (clone, DW_AT_signature, die);
7376 return clone;
7377 }
7378
7379 clone = ggc_cleared_alloc<die_node> ();
7380 clone->die_tag = die->die_tag;
7381
7382 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
7383 {
7384 /* We don't want to copy over all attributes.
7385 For example we don't want DW_AT_byte_size because otherwise we will no
7386 longer have a declaration and GDB will treat it as a definition. */
7387
7388 switch (a->dw_attr)
7389 {
7390 case DW_AT_abstract_origin:
7391 case DW_AT_artificial:
7392 case DW_AT_containing_type:
7393 case DW_AT_external:
7394 case DW_AT_name:
7395 case DW_AT_type:
7396 case DW_AT_virtuality:
7397 case DW_AT_linkage_name:
7398 case DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name:
7399 add_dwarf_attr (clone, a);
7400 break;
7401 case DW_AT_byte_size:
7402 default:
7403 break;
7404 }
7405 }
7406
7407 if (die->comdat_type_p)
7408 add_AT_die_ref (clone, DW_AT_signature, die);
7409
7410 add_AT_flag (clone, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
7411 return clone;
7412 }
7413
7414
7415 /* Structure to map a DIE in one CU to its copy in a comdat type unit. */
7416
7417 struct decl_table_entry
7418 {
7419 dw_die_ref orig;
7420 dw_die_ref copy;
7421 };
7422
7423 /* Helpers to manipulate hash table of copied declarations. */
7424
7425 /* Hashtable helpers. */
7426
7427 struct decl_table_entry_hasher : free_ptr_hash <decl_table_entry>
7428 {
7429 typedef die_struct *compare_type;
7430 static inline hashval_t hash (const decl_table_entry *);
7431 static inline bool equal (const decl_table_entry *, const die_struct *);
7432 };
7433
7434 inline hashval_t
7435 decl_table_entry_hasher::hash (const decl_table_entry *entry)
7436 {
7437 return htab_hash_pointer (entry->orig);
7438 }
7439
7440 inline bool
7441 decl_table_entry_hasher::equal (const decl_table_entry *entry1,
7442 const die_struct *entry2)
7443 {
7444 return entry1->orig == entry2;
7445 }
7446
7447 typedef hash_table<decl_table_entry_hasher> decl_hash_type;
7448
7449 /* Copy DIE and its ancestors, up to, but not including, the compile unit
7450 or type unit entry, to a new tree. Adds the new tree to UNIT and returns
7451 a pointer to the copy of DIE. If DECL_TABLE is provided, it is used
7452 to check if the ancestor has already been copied into UNIT. */
7453
7454 static dw_die_ref
7455 copy_ancestor_tree (dw_die_ref unit, dw_die_ref die,
7456 decl_hash_type *decl_table)
7457 {
7458 dw_die_ref parent = die->die_parent;
7459 dw_die_ref new_parent = unit;
7460 dw_die_ref copy;
7461 decl_table_entry **slot = NULL;
7462 struct decl_table_entry *entry = NULL;
7463
7464 if (decl_table)
7465 {
7466 /* Check if the entry has already been copied to UNIT. */
7467 slot = decl_table->find_slot_with_hash (die, htab_hash_pointer (die),
7468 INSERT);
7469 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
7470 {
7471 entry = *slot;
7472 return entry->copy;
7473 }
7474
7475 /* Record in DECL_TABLE that DIE has been copied to UNIT. */
7476 entry = XCNEW (struct decl_table_entry);
7477 entry->orig = die;
7478 entry->copy = NULL;
7479 *slot = entry;
7480 }
7481
7482 if (parent != NULL)
7483 {
7484 dw_die_ref spec = get_AT_ref (parent, DW_AT_specification);
7485 if (spec != NULL)
7486 parent = spec;
7487 if (!is_unit_die (parent))
7488 new_parent = copy_ancestor_tree (unit, parent, decl_table);
7489 }
7490
7491 copy = clone_as_declaration (die);
7492 add_child_die (new_parent, copy);
7493
7494 if (decl_table)
7495 {
7496 /* Record the pointer to the copy. */
7497 entry->copy = copy;
7498 }
7499
7500 return copy;
7501 }
7502 /* Copy the declaration context to the new type unit DIE. This includes
7503 any surrounding namespace or type declarations. If the DIE has an
7504 AT_specification attribute, it also includes attributes and children
7505 attached to the specification, and returns a pointer to the original
7506 parent of the declaration DIE. Returns NULL otherwise. */
7507
7508 static dw_die_ref
7509 copy_declaration_context (dw_die_ref unit, dw_die_ref die)
7510 {
7511 dw_die_ref decl;
7512 dw_die_ref new_decl;
7513 dw_die_ref orig_parent = NULL;
7514
7515 decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
7516 if (decl == NULL)
7517 decl = die;
7518 else
7519 {
7520 unsigned ix;
7521 dw_die_ref c;
7522 dw_attr_node *a;
7523
7524 /* The original DIE will be changed to a declaration, and must
7525 be moved to be a child of the original declaration DIE. */
7526 orig_parent = decl->die_parent;
7527
7528 /* Copy the type node pointer from the new DIE to the original
7529 declaration DIE so we can forward references later. */
7530 decl->comdat_type_p = true;
7531 decl->die_id.die_type_node = die->die_id.die_type_node;
7532
7533 remove_AT (die, DW_AT_specification);
7534
7535 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (decl->die_attr, ix, a)
7536 {
7537 if (a->dw_attr != DW_AT_name
7538 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_declaration
7539 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_external)
7540 add_dwarf_attr (die, a);
7541 }
7542
7543 FOR_EACH_CHILD (decl, c, add_child_die (die, clone_tree (c)));
7544 }
7545
7546 if (decl->die_parent != NULL
7547 && !is_unit_die (decl->die_parent))
7548 {
7549 new_decl = copy_ancestor_tree (unit, decl, NULL);
7550 if (new_decl != NULL)
7551 {
7552 remove_AT (new_decl, DW_AT_signature);
7553 add_AT_specification (die, new_decl);
7554 }
7555 }
7556
7557 return orig_parent;
7558 }
7559
7560 /* Generate the skeleton ancestor tree for the given NODE, then clone
7561 the DIE and add the clone into the tree. */
7562
7563 static void
7564 generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (skeleton_chain_node *node)
7565 {
7566 if (node->new_die != NULL)
7567 return;
7568
7569 node->new_die = clone_as_declaration (node->old_die);
7570
7571 if (node->parent != NULL)
7572 {
7573 generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (node->parent);
7574 add_child_die (node->parent->new_die, node->new_die);
7575 }
7576 }
7577
7578 /* Generate a skeleton tree of DIEs containing any declarations that are
7579 found in the original tree. We traverse the tree looking for declaration
7580 DIEs, and construct the skeleton from the bottom up whenever we find one. */
7581
7582 static void
7583 generate_skeleton_bottom_up (skeleton_chain_node *parent)
7584 {
7585 skeleton_chain_node node;
7586 dw_die_ref c;
7587 dw_die_ref first;
7588 dw_die_ref prev = NULL;
7589 dw_die_ref next = NULL;
7590
7591 node.parent = parent;
7592
7593 first = c = parent->old_die->die_child;
7594 if (c)
7595 next = c->die_sib;
7596 if (c) do {
7597 if (prev == NULL || prev->die_sib == c)
7598 prev = c;
7599 c = next;
7600 next = (c == first ? NULL : c->die_sib);
7601 node.old_die = c;
7602 node.new_die = NULL;
7603 if (is_declaration_die (c))
7604 {
7605 if (is_template_instantiation (c))
7606 {
7607 /* Instantiated templates do not need to be cloned into the
7608 type unit. Just move the DIE and its children back to
7609 the skeleton tree (in the main CU). */
7610 remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
7611 add_child_die (parent->new_die, c);
7612 c = prev;
7613 }
7614 else
7615 {
7616 /* Clone the existing DIE, move the original to the skeleton
7617 tree (which is in the main CU), and put the clone, with
7618 all the original's children, where the original came from
7619 (which is about to be moved to the type unit). */
7620 dw_die_ref clone = clone_die (c);
7621 move_all_children (c, clone);
7622
7623 /* If the original has a DW_AT_object_pointer attribute,
7624 it would now point to a child DIE just moved to the
7625 cloned tree, so we need to remove that attribute from
7626 the original. */
7627 remove_AT (c, DW_AT_object_pointer);
7628
7629 replace_child (c, clone, prev);
7630 generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (parent);
7631 add_child_die (parent->new_die, c);
7632 node.new_die = c;
7633 c = clone;
7634 }
7635 }
7636 generate_skeleton_bottom_up (&node);
7637 } while (next != NULL);
7638 }
7639
7640 /* Wrapper function for generate_skeleton_bottom_up. */
7641
7642 static dw_die_ref
7643 generate_skeleton (dw_die_ref die)
7644 {
7645 skeleton_chain_node node;
7646
7647 node.old_die = die;
7648 node.new_die = NULL;
7649 node.parent = NULL;
7650
7651 /* If this type definition is nested inside another type,
7652 and is not an instantiation of a template, always leave
7653 at least a declaration in its place. */
7654 if (die->die_parent != NULL
7655 && is_type_die (die->die_parent)
7656 && !is_template_instantiation (die))
7657 node.new_die = clone_as_declaration (die);
7658
7659 generate_skeleton_bottom_up (&node);
7660 return node.new_die;
7661 }
7662
7663 /* Remove the CHILD DIE from its parent, possibly replacing it with a cloned
7664 declaration. The original DIE is moved to a new compile unit so that
7665 existing references to it follow it to the new location. If any of the
7666 original DIE's descendants is a declaration, we need to replace the
7667 original DIE with a skeleton tree and move the declarations back into the
7668 skeleton tree. */
7669
7670 static dw_die_ref
7671 remove_child_or_replace_with_skeleton (dw_die_ref unit, dw_die_ref child,
7672 dw_die_ref prev)
7673 {
7674 dw_die_ref skeleton, orig_parent;
7675
7676 /* Copy the declaration context to the type unit DIE. If the returned
7677 ORIG_PARENT is not NULL, the skeleton needs to be added as a child of
7678 that DIE. */
7679 orig_parent = copy_declaration_context (unit, child);
7680
7681 skeleton = generate_skeleton (child);
7682 if (skeleton == NULL)
7683 remove_child_with_prev (child, prev);
7684 else
7685 {
7686 skeleton->comdat_type_p = true;
7687 skeleton->die_id.die_type_node = child->die_id.die_type_node;
7688
7689 /* If the original DIE was a specification, we need to put
7690 the skeleton under the parent DIE of the declaration.
7691 This leaves the original declaration in the tree, but
7692 it will be pruned later since there are no longer any
7693 references to it. */
7694 if (orig_parent != NULL)
7695 {
7696 remove_child_with_prev (child, prev);
7697 add_child_die (orig_parent, skeleton);
7698 }
7699 else
7700 replace_child (child, skeleton, prev);
7701 }
7702
7703 return skeleton;
7704 }
7705
7706 static void
7707 copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_attrs (dw_die_ref die,
7708 comdat_type_node *type_node,
7709 hash_map<dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref> &copied_dwarf_procs);
7710
7711 /* Helper for copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_dies. Make a copy of the DIE DWARF
7712 procedure, put it under TYPE_NODE and return the copy. Continue looking for
7713 DWARF procedure references in the DW_AT_location attribute. */
7714
7715 static dw_die_ref
7716 copy_dwarf_procedure (dw_die_ref die,
7717 comdat_type_node *type_node,
7718 hash_map<dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref> &copied_dwarf_procs)
7719 {
7720 /* We do this for COMDAT section, which is DWARFv4 specific, so
7721 DWARF procedure are always DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure DIEs (unlike
7722 DW_TAG_variable in DWARFv3). */
7723 gcc_assert (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure);
7724
7725 /* DWARF procedures are not supposed to have children... */
7726 gcc_assert (die->die_child == NULL);
7727
7728 /* ... and they are supposed to have only one attribute: DW_AT_location. */
7729 gcc_assert (vec_safe_length (die->die_attr) == 1
7730 && ((*die->die_attr)[0].dw_attr == DW_AT_location));
7731
7732 /* Do not copy more than once DWARF procedures. */
7733 bool existed;
7734 dw_die_ref &die_copy = copied_dwarf_procs.get_or_insert (die, &existed);
7735 if (existed)
7736 return die_copy;
7737
7738 die_copy = clone_die (die);
7739 add_child_die (type_node->root_die, die_copy);
7740 copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_attrs (die_copy, type_node, copied_dwarf_procs);
7741 return die_copy;
7742 }
7743
7744 /* Helper for copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_dies. Look for references to DWARF
7745 procedures in DIE's attributes. */
7746
7747 static void
7748 copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_attrs (dw_die_ref die,
7749 comdat_type_node *type_node,
7750 hash_map<dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref> &copied_dwarf_procs)
7751 {
7752 dw_attr_node *a;
7753 unsigned i;
7754
7755 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, i, a)
7756 {
7757 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
7758
7759 if (a->dw_attr_val.val_class != dw_val_class_loc)
7760 continue;
7761
7762 for (loc = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
7763 {
7764 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
7765 {
7766 case DW_OP_call2:
7767 case DW_OP_call4:
7768 case DW_OP_call_ref:
7769 gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class
7770 == dw_val_class_die_ref);
7771 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die
7772 = copy_dwarf_procedure (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die,
7773 type_node,
7774 copied_dwarf_procs);
7775
7776 default:
7777 break;
7778 }
7779 }
7780 }
7781 }
7782
7783 /* Copy DWARF procedures that are referenced by the DIE tree to TREE_NODE and
7784 rewrite references to point to the copies.
7785
7786 References are looked for in DIE's attributes and recursively in all its
7787 children attributes that are location descriptions. COPIED_DWARF_PROCS is a
7788 mapping from old DWARF procedures to their copy. It is used not to copy
7789 twice the same DWARF procedure under TYPE_NODE. */
7790
7791 static void
7792 copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_dies (dw_die_ref die,
7793 comdat_type_node *type_node,
7794 hash_map<dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref> &copied_dwarf_procs)
7795 {
7796 dw_die_ref c;
7797
7798 copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_attrs (die, type_node, copied_dwarf_procs);
7799 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_dies (c,
7800 type_node,
7801 copied_dwarf_procs));
7802 }
7803
7804 /* Traverse the DIE and set up additional .debug_types sections for each
7805 type worthy of being placed in a COMDAT section. */
7806
7807 static void
7808 break_out_comdat_types (dw_die_ref die)
7809 {
7810 dw_die_ref c;
7811 dw_die_ref first;
7812 dw_die_ref prev = NULL;
7813 dw_die_ref next = NULL;
7814 dw_die_ref unit = NULL;
7815
7816 first = c = die->die_child;
7817 if (c)
7818 next = c->die_sib;
7819 if (c) do {
7820 if (prev == NULL || prev->die_sib == c)
7821 prev = c;
7822 c = next;
7823 next = (c == first ? NULL : c->die_sib);
7824 if (should_move_die_to_comdat (c))
7825 {
7826 dw_die_ref replacement;
7827 comdat_type_node *type_node;
7828
7829 /* Break out nested types into their own type units. */
7830 break_out_comdat_types (c);
7831
7832 /* Create a new type unit DIE as the root for the new tree, and
7833 add it to the list of comdat types. */
7834 unit = new_die (DW_TAG_type_unit, NULL, NULL);
7835 add_AT_unsigned (unit, DW_AT_language,
7836 get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language));
7837 type_node = ggc_cleared_alloc<comdat_type_node> ();
7838 type_node->root_die = unit;
7839 type_node->next = comdat_type_list;
7840 comdat_type_list = type_node;
7841
7842 /* Generate the type signature. */
7843 generate_type_signature (c, type_node);
7844
7845 /* Copy the declaration context, attributes, and children of the
7846 declaration into the new type unit DIE, then remove this DIE
7847 from the main CU (or replace it with a skeleton if necessary). */
7848 replacement = remove_child_or_replace_with_skeleton (unit, c, prev);
7849 type_node->skeleton_die = replacement;
7850
7851 /* Add the DIE to the new compunit. */
7852 add_child_die (unit, c);
7853
7854 /* Types can reference DWARF procedures for type size or data location
7855 expressions. Calls in DWARF expressions cannot target procedures
7856 that are not in the same section. So we must copy DWARF procedures
7857 along with this type and then rewrite references to them. */
7858 hash_map<dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref> copied_dwarf_procs;
7859 copy_dwarf_procs_ref_in_dies (c, type_node, copied_dwarf_procs);
7860
7861 if (replacement != NULL)
7862 c = replacement;
7863 }
7864 else if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace
7865 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type
7866 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_structure_type
7867 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_union_type)
7868 {
7869 /* Look for nested types that can be broken out. */
7870 break_out_comdat_types (c);
7871 }
7872 } while (next != NULL);
7873 }
7874
7875 /* Like clone_tree, but copy DW_TAG_subprogram DIEs as declarations.
7876 Enter all the cloned children into the hash table decl_table. */
7877
7878 static dw_die_ref
7879 clone_tree_partial (dw_die_ref die, decl_hash_type *decl_table)
7880 {
7881 dw_die_ref c;
7882 dw_die_ref clone;
7883 struct decl_table_entry *entry;
7884 decl_table_entry **slot;
7885
7886 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
7887 clone = clone_as_declaration (die);
7888 else
7889 clone = clone_die (die);
7890
7891 slot = decl_table->find_slot_with_hash (die,
7892 htab_hash_pointer (die), INSERT);
7893
7894 /* Assert that DIE isn't in the hash table yet. If it would be there
7895 before, the ancestors would be necessarily there as well, therefore
7896 clone_tree_partial wouldn't be called. */
7897 gcc_assert (*slot == HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY);
7898
7899 entry = XCNEW (struct decl_table_entry);
7900 entry->orig = die;
7901 entry->copy = clone;
7902 *slot = entry;
7903
7904 if (die->die_tag != DW_TAG_subprogram)
7905 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c,
7906 add_child_die (clone, clone_tree_partial (c, decl_table)));
7907
7908 return clone;
7909 }
7910
7911 /* Walk the DIE and its children, looking for references to incomplete
7912 or trivial types that are unmarked (i.e., that are not in the current
7913 type_unit). */
7914
7915 static void
7916 copy_decls_walk (dw_die_ref unit, dw_die_ref die, decl_hash_type *decl_table)
7917 {
7918 dw_die_ref c;
7919 dw_attr_node *a;
7920 unsigned ix;
7921
7922 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
7923 {
7924 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
7925 {
7926 dw_die_ref targ = AT_ref (a);
7927 decl_table_entry **slot;
7928 struct decl_table_entry *entry;
7929
7930 if (targ->die_mark != 0 || targ->comdat_type_p)
7931 continue;
7932
7933 slot = decl_table->find_slot_with_hash (targ,
7934 htab_hash_pointer (targ),
7935 INSERT);
7936
7937 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
7938 {
7939 /* TARG has already been copied, so we just need to
7940 modify the reference to point to the copy. */
7941 entry = *slot;
7942 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = entry->copy;
7943 }
7944 else
7945 {
7946 dw_die_ref parent = unit;
7947 dw_die_ref copy = clone_die (targ);
7948
7949 /* Record in DECL_TABLE that TARG has been copied.
7950 Need to do this now, before the recursive call,
7951 because DECL_TABLE may be expanded and SLOT
7952 would no longer be a valid pointer. */
7953 entry = XCNEW (struct decl_table_entry);
7954 entry->orig = targ;
7955 entry->copy = copy;
7956 *slot = entry;
7957
7958 /* If TARG is not a declaration DIE, we need to copy its
7959 children. */
7960 if (!is_declaration_die (targ))
7961 {
7962 FOR_EACH_CHILD (
7963 targ, c,
7964 add_child_die (copy,
7965 clone_tree_partial (c, decl_table)));
7966 }
7967
7968 /* Make sure the cloned tree is marked as part of the
7969 type unit. */
7970 mark_dies (copy);
7971
7972 /* If TARG has surrounding context, copy its ancestor tree
7973 into the new type unit. */
7974 if (targ->die_parent != NULL
7975 && !is_unit_die (targ->die_parent))
7976 parent = copy_ancestor_tree (unit, targ->die_parent,
7977 decl_table);
7978
7979 add_child_die (parent, copy);
7980 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = copy;
7981
7982 /* Make sure the newly-copied DIE is walked. If it was
7983 installed in a previously-added context, it won't
7984 get visited otherwise. */
7985 if (parent != unit)
7986 {
7987 /* Find the highest point of the newly-added tree,
7988 mark each node along the way, and walk from there. */
7989 parent->die_mark = 1;
7990 while (parent->die_parent
7991 && parent->die_parent->die_mark == 0)
7992 {
7993 parent = parent->die_parent;
7994 parent->die_mark = 1;
7995 }
7996 copy_decls_walk (unit, parent, decl_table);
7997 }
7998 }
7999 }
8000 }
8001
8002 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, copy_decls_walk (unit, c, decl_table));
8003 }
8004
8005 /* Copy declarations for "unworthy" types into the new comdat section.
8006 Incomplete types, modified types, and certain other types aren't broken
8007 out into comdat sections of their own, so they don't have a signature,
8008 and we need to copy the declaration into the same section so that we
8009 don't have an external reference. */
8010
8011 static void
8012 copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (dw_die_ref unit)
8013 {
8014 mark_dies (unit);
8015 decl_hash_type decl_table (10);
8016 copy_decls_walk (unit, unit, &decl_table);
8017 unmark_dies (unit);
8018 }
8019
8020 /* Traverse the DIE and add a sibling attribute if it may have the
8021 effect of speeding up access to siblings. To save some space,
8022 avoid generating sibling attributes for DIE's without children. */
8023
8024 static void
8025 add_sibling_attributes (dw_die_ref die)
8026 {
8027 dw_die_ref c;
8028
8029 if (! die->die_child)
8030 return;
8031
8032 if (die->die_parent && die != die->die_parent->die_child)
8033 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_sibling, die->die_sib);
8034
8035 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, add_sibling_attributes (c));
8036 }
8037
8038 /* Output all location lists for the DIE and its children. */
8039
8040 static void
8041 output_location_lists (dw_die_ref die)
8042 {
8043 dw_die_ref c;
8044 dw_attr_node *a;
8045 unsigned ix;
8046
8047 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8048 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
8049 output_loc_list (AT_loc_list (a));
8050
8051 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, output_location_lists (c));
8052 }
8053
8054 /* We want to limit the number of external references, because they are
8055 larger than local references: a relocation takes multiple words, and
8056 even a sig8 reference is always eight bytes, whereas a local reference
8057 can be as small as one byte (though DW_FORM_ref is usually 4 in GCC).
8058 So if we encounter multiple external references to the same type DIE, we
8059 make a local typedef stub for it and redirect all references there.
8060
8061 This is the element of the hash table for keeping track of these
8062 references. */
8063
8064 struct external_ref
8065 {
8066 dw_die_ref type;
8067 dw_die_ref stub;
8068 unsigned n_refs;
8069 };
8070
8071 /* Hashtable helpers. */
8072
8073 struct external_ref_hasher : free_ptr_hash <external_ref>
8074 {
8075 static inline hashval_t hash (const external_ref *);
8076 static inline bool equal (const external_ref *, const external_ref *);
8077 };
8078
8079 inline hashval_t
8080 external_ref_hasher::hash (const external_ref *r)
8081 {
8082 dw_die_ref die = r->type;
8083 hashval_t h = 0;
8084
8085 /* We can't use the address of the DIE for hashing, because
8086 that will make the order of the stub DIEs non-deterministic. */
8087 if (! die->comdat_type_p)
8088 /* We have a symbol; use it to compute a hash. */
8089 h = htab_hash_string (die->die_id.die_symbol);
8090 else
8091 {
8092 /* We have a type signature; use a subset of the bits as the hash.
8093 The 8-byte signature is at least as large as hashval_t. */
8094 comdat_type_node *type_node = die->die_id.die_type_node;
8095 memcpy (&h, type_node->signature, sizeof (h));
8096 }
8097 return h;
8098 }
8099
8100 inline bool
8101 external_ref_hasher::equal (const external_ref *r1, const external_ref *r2)
8102 {
8103 return r1->type == r2->type;
8104 }
8105
8106 typedef hash_table<external_ref_hasher> external_ref_hash_type;
8107
8108 /* Return a pointer to the external_ref for references to DIE. */
8109
8110 static struct external_ref *
8111 lookup_external_ref (external_ref_hash_type *map, dw_die_ref die)
8112 {
8113 struct external_ref ref, *ref_p;
8114 external_ref **slot;
8115
8116 ref.type = die;
8117 slot = map->find_slot (&ref, INSERT);
8118 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
8119 return *slot;
8120
8121 ref_p = XCNEW (struct external_ref);
8122 ref_p->type = die;
8123 *slot = ref_p;
8124 return ref_p;
8125 }
8126
8127 /* Subroutine of optimize_external_refs, below.
8128
8129 If we see a type skeleton, record it as our stub. If we see external
8130 references, remember how many we've seen. */
8131
8132 static void
8133 optimize_external_refs_1 (dw_die_ref die, external_ref_hash_type *map)
8134 {
8135 dw_die_ref c;
8136 dw_attr_node *a;
8137 unsigned ix;
8138 struct external_ref *ref_p;
8139
8140 if (is_type_die (die)
8141 && (c = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_signature)))
8142 {
8143 /* This is a local skeleton; use it for local references. */
8144 ref_p = lookup_external_ref (map, c);
8145 ref_p->stub = die;
8146 }
8147
8148 /* Scan the DIE references, and remember any that refer to DIEs from
8149 other CUs (i.e. those which are not marked). */
8150 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8151 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref
8152 && (c = AT_ref (a))->die_mark == 0
8153 && is_type_die (c))
8154 {
8155 ref_p = lookup_external_ref (map, c);
8156 ref_p->n_refs++;
8157 }
8158
8159 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, optimize_external_refs_1 (c, map));
8160 }
8161
8162 /* htab_traverse callback function for optimize_external_refs, below. SLOT
8163 points to an external_ref, DATA is the CU we're processing. If we don't
8164 already have a local stub, and we have multiple refs, build a stub. */
8165
8166 int
8167 dwarf2_build_local_stub (external_ref **slot, dw_die_ref data)
8168 {
8169 struct external_ref *ref_p = *slot;
8170
8171 if (ref_p->stub == NULL && ref_p->n_refs > 1 && !dwarf_strict)
8172 {
8173 /* We have multiple references to this type, so build a small stub.
8174 Both of these forms are a bit dodgy from the perspective of the
8175 DWARF standard, since technically they should have names. */
8176 dw_die_ref cu = data;
8177 dw_die_ref type = ref_p->type;
8178 dw_die_ref stub = NULL;
8179
8180 if (type->comdat_type_p)
8181 {
8182 /* If we refer to this type via sig8, use AT_signature. */
8183 stub = new_die (type->die_tag, cu, NULL_TREE);
8184 add_AT_die_ref (stub, DW_AT_signature, type);
8185 }
8186 else
8187 {
8188 /* Otherwise, use a typedef with no name. */
8189 stub = new_die (DW_TAG_typedef, cu, NULL_TREE);
8190 add_AT_die_ref (stub, DW_AT_type, type);
8191 }
8192
8193 stub->die_mark++;
8194 ref_p->stub = stub;
8195 }
8196 return 1;
8197 }
8198
8199 /* DIE is a unit; look through all the DIE references to see if there are
8200 any external references to types, and if so, create local stubs for
8201 them which will be applied in build_abbrev_table. This is useful because
8202 references to local DIEs are smaller. */
8203
8204 static external_ref_hash_type *
8205 optimize_external_refs (dw_die_ref die)
8206 {
8207 external_ref_hash_type *map = new external_ref_hash_type (10);
8208 optimize_external_refs_1 (die, map);
8209 map->traverse <dw_die_ref, dwarf2_build_local_stub> (die);
8210 return map;
8211 }
8212
8213 /* The format of each DIE (and its attribute value pairs) is encoded in an
8214 abbreviation table. This routine builds the abbreviation table and assigns
8215 a unique abbreviation id for each abbreviation entry. The children of each
8216 die are visited recursively. */
8217
8218 static void
8219 build_abbrev_table (dw_die_ref die, external_ref_hash_type *extern_map)
8220 {
8221 unsigned long abbrev_id;
8222 unsigned int n_alloc;
8223 dw_die_ref c;
8224 dw_attr_node *a;
8225 unsigned ix;
8226
8227 /* Scan the DIE references, and replace any that refer to
8228 DIEs from other CUs (i.e. those which are not marked) with
8229 the local stubs we built in optimize_external_refs. */
8230 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8231 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref
8232 && (c = AT_ref (a))->die_mark == 0)
8233 {
8234 struct external_ref *ref_p;
8235 gcc_assert (AT_ref (a)->comdat_type_p || AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_symbol);
8236
8237 ref_p = lookup_external_ref (extern_map, c);
8238 if (ref_p->stub && ref_p->stub != die)
8239 change_AT_die_ref (a, ref_p->stub);
8240 else
8241 /* We aren't changing this reference, so mark it external. */
8242 set_AT_ref_external (a, 1);
8243 }
8244
8245 for (abbrev_id = 1; abbrev_id < abbrev_die_table_in_use; ++abbrev_id)
8246 {
8247 dw_die_ref abbrev = abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id];
8248 dw_attr_node *die_a, *abbrev_a;
8249 unsigned ix;
8250 bool ok = true;
8251
8252 if (abbrev->die_tag != die->die_tag)
8253 continue;
8254 if ((abbrev->die_child != NULL) != (die->die_child != NULL))
8255 continue;
8256
8257 if (vec_safe_length (abbrev->die_attr) != vec_safe_length (die->die_attr))
8258 continue;
8259
8260 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, die_a)
8261 {
8262 abbrev_a = &(*abbrev->die_attr)[ix];
8263 if ((abbrev_a->dw_attr != die_a->dw_attr)
8264 || (value_format (abbrev_a) != value_format (die_a)))
8265 {
8266 ok = false;
8267 break;
8268 }
8269 }
8270 if (ok)
8271 break;
8272 }
8273
8274 if (abbrev_id >= abbrev_die_table_in_use)
8275 {
8276 if (abbrev_die_table_in_use >= abbrev_die_table_allocated)
8277 {
8278 n_alloc = abbrev_die_table_allocated + ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
8279 abbrev_die_table = GGC_RESIZEVEC (dw_die_ref, abbrev_die_table,
8280 n_alloc);
8281
8282 memset (&abbrev_die_table[abbrev_die_table_allocated], 0,
8283 (n_alloc - abbrev_die_table_allocated) * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
8284 abbrev_die_table_allocated = n_alloc;
8285 }
8286
8287 ++abbrev_die_table_in_use;
8288 abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id] = die;
8289 }
8290
8291 die->die_abbrev = abbrev_id;
8292 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, build_abbrev_table (c, extern_map));
8293 }
8294 \f
8295 /* Return the power-of-two number of bytes necessary to represent VALUE. */
8296
8297 static int
8298 constant_size (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT value)
8299 {
8300 int log;
8301
8302 if (value == 0)
8303 log = 0;
8304 else
8305 log = floor_log2 (value);
8306
8307 log = log / 8;
8308 log = 1 << (floor_log2 (log) + 1);
8309
8310 return log;
8311 }
8312
8313 /* Return the size of a DIE as it is represented in the
8314 .debug_info section. */
8315
8316 static unsigned long
8317 size_of_die (dw_die_ref die)
8318 {
8319 unsigned long size = 0;
8320 dw_attr_node *a;
8321 unsigned ix;
8322 enum dwarf_form form;
8323
8324 size += size_of_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev);
8325 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8326 {
8327 switch (AT_class (a))
8328 {
8329 case dw_val_class_addr:
8330 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && AT_index (a) != NOT_INDEXED)
8331 {
8332 gcc_assert (AT_index (a) != NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
8333 size += size_of_uleb128 (AT_index (a));
8334 }
8335 else
8336 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
8337 break;
8338 case dw_val_class_offset:
8339 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
8340 break;
8341 case dw_val_class_loc:
8342 {
8343 unsigned long lsize = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
8344
8345 /* Block length. */
8346 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
8347 size += size_of_uleb128 (lsize);
8348 else
8349 size += constant_size (lsize);
8350 size += lsize;
8351 }
8352 break;
8353 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
8354 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && AT_index (a) != NOT_INDEXED)
8355 {
8356 gcc_assert (AT_index (a) != NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
8357 size += size_of_uleb128 (AT_index (a));
8358 }
8359 else
8360 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
8361 break;
8362 case dw_val_class_range_list:
8363 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
8364 break;
8365 case dw_val_class_const:
8366 size += size_of_sleb128 (AT_int (a));
8367 break;
8368 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
8369 {
8370 int csize = constant_size (AT_unsigned (a));
8371 if (dwarf_version == 3
8372 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_data_member_location
8373 && csize >= 4)
8374 size += size_of_uleb128 (AT_unsigned (a));
8375 else
8376 size += csize;
8377 }
8378 break;
8379 case dw_val_class_const_double:
8380 size += HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
8381 if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64)
8382 size++; /* block */
8383 break;
8384 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
8385 size += (get_full_len (*a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide)
8386 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR);
8387 if (get_full_len (*a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide) * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
8388 > 64)
8389 size++; /* block */
8390 break;
8391 case dw_val_class_vec:
8392 size += constant_size (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
8393 * a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size)
8394 + a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
8395 * a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size; /* block */
8396 break;
8397 case dw_val_class_flag:
8398 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
8399 /* Currently all add_AT_flag calls pass in 1 as last argument,
8400 so DW_FORM_flag_present can be used. If that ever changes,
8401 we'll need to use DW_FORM_flag and have some optimization
8402 in build_abbrev_table that will change those to
8403 DW_FORM_flag_present if it is set to 1 in all DIEs using
8404 the same abbrev entry. */
8405 gcc_assert (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag == 1);
8406 else
8407 size += 1;
8408 break;
8409 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
8410 if (AT_ref_external (a))
8411 {
8412 /* In DWARF4, we use DW_FORM_ref_sig8; for earlier versions
8413 we use DW_FORM_ref_addr. In DWARF2, DW_FORM_ref_addr
8414 is sized by target address length, whereas in DWARF3
8415 it's always sized as an offset. */
8416 if (use_debug_types)
8417 size += DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE;
8418 else if (dwarf_version == 2)
8419 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
8420 else
8421 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
8422 }
8423 else
8424 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
8425 break;
8426 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
8427 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
8428 break;
8429 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
8430 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && AT_index (a) != NOT_INDEXED)
8431 {
8432 gcc_assert (AT_index (a) != NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
8433 size += size_of_uleb128 (AT_index (a));
8434 }
8435 else
8436 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
8437 break;
8438 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
8439 case dw_val_class_macptr:
8440 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
8441 break;
8442 case dw_val_class_str:
8443 form = AT_string_form (a);
8444 if (form == DW_FORM_strp)
8445 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
8446 else if (form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index)
8447 size += size_of_uleb128 (AT_index (a));
8448 else
8449 size += strlen (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->str) + 1;
8450 break;
8451 case dw_val_class_file:
8452 size += constant_size (maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file));
8453 break;
8454 case dw_val_class_data8:
8455 size += 8;
8456 break;
8457 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
8458 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
8459 break;
8460 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
8461 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
8462 break;
8463 case dw_val_class_discr_value:
8464 size += size_of_discr_value (&a->dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_value);
8465 break;
8466 case dw_val_class_discr_list:
8467 {
8468 unsigned block_size = size_of_discr_list (AT_discr_list (a));
8469
8470 /* This is a block, so we have the block length and then its
8471 data. */
8472 size += constant_size (block_size) + block_size;
8473 }
8474 break;
8475 default:
8476 gcc_unreachable ();
8477 }
8478 }
8479
8480 return size;
8481 }
8482
8483 /* Size the debugging information associated with a given DIE. Visits the
8484 DIE's children recursively. Updates the global variable next_die_offset, on
8485 each time through. Uses the current value of next_die_offset to update the
8486 die_offset field in each DIE. */
8487
8488 static void
8489 calc_die_sizes (dw_die_ref die)
8490 {
8491 dw_die_ref c;
8492
8493 gcc_assert (die->die_offset == 0
8494 || (unsigned long int) die->die_offset == next_die_offset);
8495 die->die_offset = next_die_offset;
8496 next_die_offset += size_of_die (die);
8497
8498 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, calc_die_sizes (c));
8499
8500 if (die->die_child != NULL)
8501 /* Count the null byte used to terminate sibling lists. */
8502 next_die_offset += 1;
8503 }
8504
8505 /* Size just the base type children at the start of the CU.
8506 This is needed because build_abbrev needs to size locs
8507 and sizing of type based stack ops needs to know die_offset
8508 values for the base types. */
8509
8510 static void
8511 calc_base_type_die_sizes (void)
8512 {
8513 unsigned long die_offset = DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE;
8514 unsigned int i;
8515 dw_die_ref base_type;
8516 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
8517 dw_die_ref prev = comp_unit_die ()->die_child;
8518 #endif
8519
8520 die_offset += size_of_die (comp_unit_die ());
8521 for (i = 0; base_types.iterate (i, &base_type); i++)
8522 {
8523 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
8524 gcc_assert (base_type->die_offset == 0
8525 && prev->die_sib == base_type
8526 && base_type->die_child == NULL
8527 && base_type->die_abbrev);
8528 prev = base_type;
8529 #endif
8530 base_type->die_offset = die_offset;
8531 die_offset += size_of_die (base_type);
8532 }
8533 }
8534
8535 /* Set the marks for a die and its children. We do this so
8536 that we know whether or not a reference needs to use FORM_ref_addr; only
8537 DIEs in the same CU will be marked. We used to clear out the offset
8538 and use that as the flag, but ran into ordering problems. */
8539
8540 static void
8541 mark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
8542 {
8543 dw_die_ref c;
8544
8545 gcc_assert (!die->die_mark);
8546
8547 die->die_mark = 1;
8548 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, mark_dies (c));
8549 }
8550
8551 /* Clear the marks for a die and its children. */
8552
8553 static void
8554 unmark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
8555 {
8556 dw_die_ref c;
8557
8558 if (! use_debug_types)
8559 gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
8560
8561 die->die_mark = 0;
8562 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, unmark_dies (c));
8563 }
8564
8565 /* Clear the marks for a die, its children and referred dies. */
8566
8567 static void
8568 unmark_all_dies (dw_die_ref die)
8569 {
8570 dw_die_ref c;
8571 dw_attr_node *a;
8572 unsigned ix;
8573
8574 if (!die->die_mark)
8575 return;
8576 die->die_mark = 0;
8577
8578 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, unmark_all_dies (c));
8579
8580 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
8581 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
8582 unmark_all_dies (AT_ref (a));
8583 }
8584
8585 /* Calculate if the entry should appear in the final output file. It may be
8586 from a pruned a type. */
8587
8588 static bool
8589 include_pubname_in_output (vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *table, pubname_entry *p)
8590 {
8591 /* By limiting gnu pubnames to definitions only, gold can generate a
8592 gdb index without entries for declarations, which don't include
8593 enough information to be useful. */
8594 if (debug_generate_pub_sections == 2 && is_declaration_die (p->die))
8595 return false;
8596
8597 if (table == pubname_table)
8598 {
8599 /* Enumerator names are part of the pubname table, but the
8600 parent DW_TAG_enumeration_type die may have been pruned.
8601 Don't output them if that is the case. */
8602 if (p->die->die_tag == DW_TAG_enumerator &&
8603 (p->die->die_parent == NULL
8604 || !p->die->die_parent->die_perennial_p))
8605 return false;
8606
8607 /* Everything else in the pubname table is included. */
8608 return true;
8609 }
8610
8611 /* The pubtypes table shouldn't include types that have been
8612 pruned. */
8613 return (p->die->die_offset != 0
8614 || !flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types);
8615 }
8616
8617 /* Return the size of the .debug_pubnames or .debug_pubtypes table
8618 generated for the compilation unit. */
8619
8620 static unsigned long
8621 size_of_pubnames (vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *names)
8622 {
8623 unsigned long size;
8624 unsigned i;
8625 pubname_entry *p;
8626 int space_for_flags = (debug_generate_pub_sections == 2) ? 1 : 0;
8627
8628 size = DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE;
8629 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*names, i, p)
8630 if (include_pubname_in_output (names, p))
8631 size += strlen (p->name) + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 1 + space_for_flags;
8632
8633 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
8634 return size;
8635 }
8636
8637 /* Return the size of the information in the .debug_aranges section. */
8638
8639 static unsigned long
8640 size_of_aranges (void)
8641 {
8642 unsigned long size;
8643
8644 size = DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE;
8645
8646 /* Count the address/length pair for this compilation unit. */
8647 if (text_section_used)
8648 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
8649 if (cold_text_section_used)
8650 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
8651 if (have_multiple_function_sections)
8652 {
8653 unsigned fde_idx;
8654 dw_fde_ref fde;
8655
8656 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*fde_vec, fde_idx, fde)
8657 {
8658 if (DECL_IGNORED_P (fde->decl))
8659 continue;
8660 if (!fde->in_std_section)
8661 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
8662 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin && !fde->second_in_std_section)
8663 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
8664 }
8665 }
8666
8667 /* Count the two zero words used to terminated the address range table. */
8668 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
8669 return size;
8670 }
8671 \f
8672 /* Select the encoding of an attribute value. */
8673
8674 static enum dwarf_form
8675 value_format (dw_attr_node *a)
8676 {
8677 switch (AT_class (a))
8678 {
8679 case dw_val_class_addr:
8680 /* Only very few attributes allow DW_FORM_addr. */
8681 switch (a->dw_attr)
8682 {
8683 case DW_AT_low_pc:
8684 case DW_AT_high_pc:
8685 case DW_AT_entry_pc:
8686 case DW_AT_trampoline:
8687 return (AT_index (a) == NOT_INDEXED
8688 ? DW_FORM_addr : DW_FORM_GNU_addr_index);
8689 default:
8690 break;
8691 }
8692 switch (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
8693 {
8694 case 1:
8695 return DW_FORM_data1;
8696 case 2:
8697 return DW_FORM_data2;
8698 case 4:
8699 return DW_FORM_data4;
8700 case 8:
8701 return DW_FORM_data8;
8702 default:
8703 gcc_unreachable ();
8704 }
8705 case dw_val_class_range_list:
8706 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
8707 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
8708 return DW_FORM_sec_offset;
8709 /* FALLTHRU */
8710 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
8711 case dw_val_class_offset:
8712 switch (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
8713 {
8714 case 4:
8715 return DW_FORM_data4;
8716 case 8:
8717 return DW_FORM_data8;
8718 default:
8719 gcc_unreachable ();
8720 }
8721 case dw_val_class_loc:
8722 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
8723 return DW_FORM_exprloc;
8724 switch (constant_size (size_of_locs (AT_loc (a))))
8725 {
8726 case 1:
8727 return DW_FORM_block1;
8728 case 2:
8729 return DW_FORM_block2;
8730 case 4:
8731 return DW_FORM_block4;
8732 default:
8733 gcc_unreachable ();
8734 }
8735 case dw_val_class_const:
8736 return DW_FORM_sdata;
8737 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
8738 switch (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a)))
8739 {
8740 case 1:
8741 return DW_FORM_data1;
8742 case 2:
8743 return DW_FORM_data2;
8744 case 4:
8745 /* In DWARF3 DW_AT_data_member_location with
8746 DW_FORM_data4 or DW_FORM_data8 is a loclistptr, not
8747 constant, so we need to use DW_FORM_udata if we need
8748 a large constant. */
8749 if (dwarf_version == 3 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_data_member_location)
8750 return DW_FORM_udata;
8751 return DW_FORM_data4;
8752 case 8:
8753 if (dwarf_version == 3 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_data_member_location)
8754 return DW_FORM_udata;
8755 return DW_FORM_data8;
8756 default:
8757 gcc_unreachable ();
8758 }
8759 case dw_val_class_const_double:
8760 switch (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
8761 {
8762 case 8:
8763 return DW_FORM_data2;
8764 case 16:
8765 return DW_FORM_data4;
8766 case 32:
8767 return DW_FORM_data8;
8768 case 64:
8769 default:
8770 return DW_FORM_block1;
8771 }
8772 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
8773 switch (get_full_len (*a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide) * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
8774 {
8775 case 8:
8776 return DW_FORM_data1;
8777 case 16:
8778 return DW_FORM_data2;
8779 case 32:
8780 return DW_FORM_data4;
8781 case 64:
8782 return DW_FORM_data8;
8783 default:
8784 return DW_FORM_block1;
8785 }
8786 case dw_val_class_vec:
8787 switch (constant_size (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
8788 * a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size))
8789 {
8790 case 1:
8791 return DW_FORM_block1;
8792 case 2:
8793 return DW_FORM_block2;
8794 case 4:
8795 return DW_FORM_block4;
8796 default:
8797 gcc_unreachable ();
8798 }
8799 case dw_val_class_flag:
8800 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
8801 {
8802 /* Currently all add_AT_flag calls pass in 1 as last argument,
8803 so DW_FORM_flag_present can be used. If that ever changes,
8804 we'll need to use DW_FORM_flag and have some optimization
8805 in build_abbrev_table that will change those to
8806 DW_FORM_flag_present if it is set to 1 in all DIEs using
8807 the same abbrev entry. */
8808 gcc_assert (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag == 1);
8809 return DW_FORM_flag_present;
8810 }
8811 return DW_FORM_flag;
8812 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
8813 if (AT_ref_external (a))
8814 return use_debug_types ? DW_FORM_ref_sig8 : DW_FORM_ref_addr;
8815 else
8816 return DW_FORM_ref;
8817 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
8818 return DW_FORM_data;
8819 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
8820 return (AT_index (a) == NOT_INDEXED
8821 ? DW_FORM_addr : DW_FORM_GNU_addr_index);
8822 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
8823 case dw_val_class_macptr:
8824 return dwarf_version >= 4 ? DW_FORM_sec_offset : DW_FORM_data;
8825 case dw_val_class_str:
8826 return AT_string_form (a);
8827 case dw_val_class_file:
8828 switch (constant_size (maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file)))
8829 {
8830 case 1:
8831 return DW_FORM_data1;
8832 case 2:
8833 return DW_FORM_data2;
8834 case 4:
8835 return DW_FORM_data4;
8836 default:
8837 gcc_unreachable ();
8838 }
8839
8840 case dw_val_class_data8:
8841 return DW_FORM_data8;
8842
8843 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
8844 switch (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
8845 {
8846 case 1:
8847 return DW_FORM_data1;
8848 case 2:
8849 return DW_FORM_data2;
8850 case 4:
8851 return DW_FORM_data4;
8852 case 8:
8853 return DW_FORM_data8;
8854 default:
8855 gcc_unreachable ();
8856 }
8857
8858 case dw_val_class_discr_value:
8859 return (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_value.pos
8860 ? DW_FORM_udata
8861 : DW_FORM_sdata);
8862 case dw_val_class_discr_list:
8863 switch (constant_size (size_of_discr_list (AT_discr_list (a))))
8864 {
8865 case 1:
8866 return DW_FORM_block1;
8867 case 2:
8868 return DW_FORM_block2;
8869 case 4:
8870 return DW_FORM_block4;
8871 default:
8872 gcc_unreachable ();
8873 }
8874
8875 default:
8876 gcc_unreachable ();
8877 }
8878 }
8879
8880 /* Output the encoding of an attribute value. */
8881
8882 static void
8883 output_value_format (dw_attr_node *a)
8884 {
8885 enum dwarf_form form = value_format (a);
8886
8887 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (form, "(%s)", dwarf_form_name (form));
8888 }
8889
8890 /* Given a die and id, produce the appropriate abbreviations. */
8891
8892 static void
8893 output_die_abbrevs (unsigned long abbrev_id, dw_die_ref abbrev)
8894 {
8895 unsigned ix;
8896 dw_attr_node *a_attr;
8897
8898 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev_id, "(abbrev code)");
8899 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev->die_tag, "(TAG: %s)",
8900 dwarf_tag_name (abbrev->die_tag));
8901
8902 if (abbrev->die_child != NULL)
8903 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_yes, "DW_children_yes");
8904 else
8905 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_no, "DW_children_no");
8906
8907 for (ix = 0; vec_safe_iterate (abbrev->die_attr, ix, &a_attr); ix++)
8908 {
8909 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (a_attr->dw_attr, "(%s)",
8910 dwarf_attr_name (a_attr->dw_attr));
8911 output_value_format (a_attr);
8912 }
8913
8914 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
8915 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
8916 }
8917
8918
8919 /* Output the .debug_abbrev section which defines the DIE abbreviation
8920 table. */
8921
8922 static void
8923 output_abbrev_section (void)
8924 {
8925 unsigned long abbrev_id;
8926
8927 for (abbrev_id = 1; abbrev_id < abbrev_die_table_in_use; ++abbrev_id)
8928 output_die_abbrevs (abbrev_id, abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id]);
8929
8930 /* Terminate the table. */
8931 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
8932 }
8933
8934 /* Output a symbol we can use to refer to this DIE from another CU. */
8935
8936 static inline void
8937 output_die_symbol (dw_die_ref die)
8938 {
8939 const char *sym = die->die_id.die_symbol;
8940
8941 gcc_assert (!die->comdat_type_p);
8942
8943 if (sym == 0)
8944 return;
8945
8946 if (strncmp (sym, DIE_LABEL_PREFIX, sizeof (DIE_LABEL_PREFIX) - 1) == 0)
8947 /* We make these global, not weak; if the target doesn't support
8948 .linkonce, it doesn't support combining the sections, so debugging
8949 will break. */
8950 targetm.asm_out.globalize_label (asm_out_file, sym);
8951
8952 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, sym);
8953 }
8954
8955 /* Return a new location list, given the begin and end range, and the
8956 expression. */
8957
8958 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
8959 new_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref expr, const char *begin, const char *end,
8960 const char *section)
8961 {
8962 dw_loc_list_ref retlist = ggc_cleared_alloc<dw_loc_list_node> ();
8963
8964 retlist->begin = begin;
8965 retlist->begin_entry = NULL;
8966 retlist->end = end;
8967 retlist->expr = expr;
8968 retlist->section = section;
8969
8970 return retlist;
8971 }
8972
8973 /* Generate a new internal symbol for this location list node, if it
8974 hasn't got one yet. */
8975
8976 static inline void
8977 gen_llsym (dw_loc_list_ref list)
8978 {
8979 gcc_assert (!list->ll_symbol);
8980 list->ll_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LLST");
8981 }
8982
8983 /* Output the location list given to us. */
8984
8985 static void
8986 output_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref list_head)
8987 {
8988 dw_loc_list_ref curr = list_head;
8989
8990 if (list_head->emitted)
8991 return;
8992 list_head->emitted = true;
8993
8994 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, list_head->ll_symbol);
8995
8996 /* Walk the location list, and output each range + expression. */
8997 for (curr = list_head; curr != NULL; curr = curr->dw_loc_next)
8998 {
8999 unsigned long size;
9000 /* Don't output an entry that starts and ends at the same address. */
9001 if (strcmp (curr->begin, curr->end) == 0 && !curr->force)
9002 continue;
9003 size = size_of_locs (curr->expr);
9004 /* If the expression is too large, drop it on the floor. We could
9005 perhaps put it into DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure and refer to that
9006 in the expression, but >= 64KB expressions for a single value
9007 in a single range are unlikely very useful. */
9008 if (size > 0xffff)
9009 continue;
9010 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
9011 {
9012 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_GNU_start_length_entry,
9013 "Location list start/length entry (%s)",
9014 list_head->ll_symbol);
9015 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (curr->begin_entry->index,
9016 "Location list range start index (%s)",
9017 curr->begin);
9018 /* The length field is 4 bytes. If we ever need to support
9019 an 8-byte length, we can add a new DW_LLE code or fall back
9020 to DW_LLE_GNU_start_end_entry. */
9021 dw2_asm_output_delta (4, curr->end, curr->begin,
9022 "Location list range length (%s)",
9023 list_head->ll_symbol);
9024 }
9025 else if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
9026 {
9027 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin, curr->section,
9028 "Location list begin address (%s)",
9029 list_head->ll_symbol);
9030 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end, curr->section,
9031 "Location list end address (%s)",
9032 list_head->ll_symbol);
9033 }
9034 else
9035 {
9036 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin,
9037 "Location list begin address (%s)",
9038 list_head->ll_symbol);
9039 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end,
9040 "Location list end address (%s)",
9041 list_head->ll_symbol);
9042 }
9043
9044 /* Output the block length for this list of location operations. */
9045 gcc_assert (size <= 0xffff);
9046 dw2_asm_output_data (2, size, "%s", "Location expression size");
9047
9048 output_loc_sequence (curr->expr, -1);
9049 }
9050
9051 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
9052 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LLE_GNU_end_of_list_entry,
9053 "Location list terminator (%s)",
9054 list_head->ll_symbol);
9055 else
9056 {
9057 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0,
9058 "Location list terminator begin (%s)",
9059 list_head->ll_symbol);
9060 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0,
9061 "Location list terminator end (%s)",
9062 list_head->ll_symbol);
9063 }
9064 }
9065
9066 /* Output a range_list offset into the debug_range section. Emit a
9067 relocated reference if val_entry is NULL, otherwise, emit an
9068 indirect reference. */
9069
9070 static void
9071 output_range_list_offset (dw_attr_node *a)
9072 {
9073 const char *name = dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr);
9074
9075 if (a->dw_attr_val.val_entry == RELOCATED_OFFSET)
9076 {
9077 char *p = strchr (ranges_section_label, '\0');
9078 sprintf (p, "+" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
9079 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, ranges_section_label,
9080 debug_ranges_section, "%s", name);
9081 *p = '\0';
9082 }
9083 else
9084 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset,
9085 "%s (offset from %s)", name, ranges_section_label);
9086 }
9087
9088 /* Output the offset into the debug_loc section. */
9089
9090 static void
9091 output_loc_list_offset (dw_attr_node *a)
9092 {
9093 char *sym = AT_loc_list (a)->ll_symbol;
9094
9095 gcc_assert (sym);
9096 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
9097 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, sym, loc_section_label,
9098 "%s", dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr));
9099 else
9100 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, sym, debug_loc_section,
9101 "%s", dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr));
9102 }
9103
9104 /* Output an attribute's index or value appropriately. */
9105
9106 static void
9107 output_attr_index_or_value (dw_attr_node *a)
9108 {
9109 const char *name = dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr);
9110
9111 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && AT_index (a) != NOT_INDEXED)
9112 {
9113 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (AT_index (a), "%s", name);
9114 return;
9115 }
9116 switch (AT_class (a))
9117 {
9118 case dw_val_class_addr:
9119 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_addr (a), "%s", name);
9120 break;
9121 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
9122 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
9123 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_lbl (a), "%s", name);
9124 break;
9125 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
9126 output_loc_list_offset (a);
9127 break;
9128 default:
9129 gcc_unreachable ();
9130 }
9131 }
9132
9133 /* Output a type signature. */
9134
9135 static inline void
9136 output_signature (const char *sig, const char *name)
9137 {
9138 int i;
9139
9140 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
9141 dw2_asm_output_data (1, sig[i], i == 0 ? "%s" : NULL, name);
9142 }
9143
9144 /* Output a discriminant value. */
9145
9146 static inline void
9147 output_discr_value (dw_discr_value *discr_value, const char *name)
9148 {
9149 if (discr_value->pos)
9150 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (discr_value->v.uval, "%s", name);
9151 else
9152 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (discr_value->v.sval, "%s", name);
9153 }
9154
9155 /* Output the DIE and its attributes. Called recursively to generate
9156 the definitions of each child DIE. */
9157
9158 static void
9159 output_die (dw_die_ref die)
9160 {
9161 dw_attr_node *a;
9162 dw_die_ref c;
9163 unsigned long size;
9164 unsigned ix;
9165
9166 /* If someone in another CU might refer to us, set up a symbol for
9167 them to point to. */
9168 if (! die->comdat_type_p && die->die_id.die_symbol)
9169 output_die_symbol (die);
9170
9171 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev, "(DIE (%#lx) %s)",
9172 (unsigned long)die->die_offset,
9173 dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag));
9174
9175 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
9176 {
9177 const char *name = dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr);
9178
9179 switch (AT_class (a))
9180 {
9181 case dw_val_class_addr:
9182 output_attr_index_or_value (a);
9183 break;
9184
9185 case dw_val_class_offset:
9186 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset,
9187 "%s", name);
9188 break;
9189
9190 case dw_val_class_range_list:
9191 output_range_list_offset (a);
9192 break;
9193
9194 case dw_val_class_loc:
9195 size = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
9196
9197 /* Output the block length for this list of location operations. */
9198 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
9199 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, "%s", name);
9200 else
9201 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (size), size, "%s", name);
9202
9203 output_loc_sequence (AT_loc (a), -1);
9204 break;
9205
9206 case dw_val_class_const:
9207 /* ??? It would be slightly more efficient to use a scheme like is
9208 used for unsigned constants below, but gdb 4.x does not sign
9209 extend. Gdb 5.x does sign extend. */
9210 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (AT_int (a), "%s", name);
9211 break;
9212
9213 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
9214 {
9215 int csize = constant_size (AT_unsigned (a));
9216 if (dwarf_version == 3
9217 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_data_member_location
9218 && csize >= 4)
9219 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (AT_unsigned (a), "%s", name);
9220 else
9221 dw2_asm_output_data (csize, AT_unsigned (a), "%s", name);
9222 }
9223 break;
9224
9225 case dw_val_class_const_double:
9226 {
9227 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first, second;
9228
9229 if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64)
9230 dw2_asm_output_data (1,
9231 HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT
9232 / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
9233 NULL);
9234
9235 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
9236 {
9237 first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.high;
9238 second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.low;
9239 }
9240 else
9241 {
9242 first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.low;
9243 second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.high;
9244 }
9245
9246 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
9247 first, "%s", name);
9248 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
9249 second, NULL);
9250 }
9251 break;
9252
9253 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
9254 {
9255 int i;
9256 int len = get_full_len (*a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide);
9257 int l = HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
9258 if (len * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT > 64)
9259 dw2_asm_output_data (1, get_full_len (*a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide) * l,
9260 NULL);
9261
9262 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
9263 for (i = len - 1; i >= 0; --i)
9264 {
9265 dw2_asm_output_data (l, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide->elt (i),
9266 "%s", name);
9267 name = "";
9268 }
9269 else
9270 for (i = 0; i < len; ++i)
9271 {
9272 dw2_asm_output_data (l, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_wide->elt (i),
9273 "%s", name);
9274 name = "";
9275 }
9276 }
9277 break;
9278
9279 case dw_val_class_vec:
9280 {
9281 unsigned int elt_size = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size;
9282 unsigned int len = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length;
9283 unsigned int i;
9284 unsigned char *p;
9285
9286 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (len * elt_size),
9287 len * elt_size, "%s", name);
9288 if (elt_size > sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
9289 {
9290 elt_size /= 2;
9291 len *= 2;
9292 }
9293 for (i = 0, p = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array;
9294 i < len;
9295 i++, p += elt_size)
9296 dw2_asm_output_data (elt_size, extract_int (p, elt_size),
9297 "fp or vector constant word %u", i);
9298 break;
9299 }
9300
9301 case dw_val_class_flag:
9302 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
9303 {
9304 /* Currently all add_AT_flag calls pass in 1 as last argument,
9305 so DW_FORM_flag_present can be used. If that ever changes,
9306 we'll need to use DW_FORM_flag and have some optimization
9307 in build_abbrev_table that will change those to
9308 DW_FORM_flag_present if it is set to 1 in all DIEs using
9309 the same abbrev entry. */
9310 gcc_assert (AT_flag (a) == 1);
9311 if (flag_debug_asm)
9312 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t\t\t%s %s\n",
9313 ASM_COMMENT_START, name);
9314 break;
9315 }
9316 dw2_asm_output_data (1, AT_flag (a), "%s", name);
9317 break;
9318
9319 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
9320 output_attr_index_or_value (a);
9321 break;
9322
9323 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
9324 if (AT_ref_external (a))
9325 {
9326 if (AT_ref (a)->comdat_type_p)
9327 {
9328 comdat_type_node *type_node =
9329 AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_type_node;
9330
9331 gcc_assert (type_node);
9332 output_signature (type_node->signature, name);
9333 }
9334 else
9335 {
9336 const char *sym = AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_symbol;
9337 int size;
9338
9339 gcc_assert (sym);
9340 /* In DWARF2, DW_FORM_ref_addr is sized by target address
9341 length, whereas in DWARF3 it's always sized as an
9342 offset. */
9343 if (dwarf_version == 2)
9344 size = DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
9345 else
9346 size = DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9347 dw2_asm_output_offset (size, sym, debug_info_section, "%s",
9348 name);
9349 }
9350 }
9351 else
9352 {
9353 gcc_assert (AT_ref (a)->die_offset);
9354 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_ref (a)->die_offset,
9355 "%s", name);
9356 }
9357 break;
9358
9359 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
9360 {
9361 char l1[20];
9362
9363 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_LABEL,
9364 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index * 2);
9365 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l1, debug_frame_section,
9366 "%s", name);
9367 }
9368 break;
9369
9370 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
9371 #ifdef ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_VMS_DELTA
9372 dw2_asm_output_vms_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
9373 AT_vms_delta2 (a), AT_vms_delta1 (a),
9374 "%s", name);
9375 #else
9376 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
9377 AT_vms_delta2 (a), AT_vms_delta1 (a),
9378 "%s", name);
9379 #endif
9380 break;
9381
9382 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
9383 output_attr_index_or_value (a);
9384 break;
9385
9386 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
9387 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
9388 debug_line_section, "%s", name);
9389 break;
9390
9391 case dw_val_class_macptr:
9392 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
9393 debug_macinfo_section, "%s", name);
9394 break;
9395
9396 case dw_val_class_str:
9397 if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->form == DW_FORM_strp)
9398 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
9399 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->label,
9400 debug_str_section,
9401 "%s: \"%s\"", name, AT_string (a));
9402 else if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index)
9403 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (AT_index (a),
9404 "%s: \"%s\"", name, AT_string (a));
9405 else
9406 dw2_asm_output_nstring (AT_string (a), -1, "%s", name);
9407 break;
9408
9409 case dw_val_class_file:
9410 {
9411 int f = maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file);
9412
9413 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (f), f, "%s (%s)", name,
9414 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file->filename);
9415 break;
9416 }
9417
9418 case dw_val_class_data8:
9419 {
9420 int i;
9421
9422 for (i = 0; i < 8; i++)
9423 dw2_asm_output_data (1, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_data8[i],
9424 i == 0 ? "%s" : NULL, name);
9425 break;
9426 }
9427
9428 case dw_val_class_high_pc:
9429 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
9430 get_AT_low_pc (die), "DW_AT_high_pc");
9431 break;
9432
9433 case dw_val_class_discr_value:
9434 output_discr_value (&a->dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_value, name);
9435 break;
9436
9437 case dw_val_class_discr_list:
9438 {
9439 dw_discr_list_ref list = AT_discr_list (a);
9440 const int size = size_of_discr_list (list);
9441
9442 /* This is a block, so output its length first. */
9443 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (size), size,
9444 "%s: block size", name);
9445
9446 for (; list != NULL; list = list->dw_discr_next)
9447 {
9448 /* One byte for the discriminant value descriptor, and then as
9449 many LEB128 numbers as required. */
9450 if (list->dw_discr_range)
9451 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_DSC_range,
9452 "%s: DW_DSC_range", name);
9453 else
9454 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_DSC_label,
9455 "%s: DW_DSC_label", name);
9456
9457 output_discr_value (&list->dw_discr_lower_bound, name);
9458 if (list->dw_discr_range)
9459 output_discr_value (&list->dw_discr_upper_bound, name);
9460 }
9461 break;
9462 }
9463
9464 default:
9465 gcc_unreachable ();
9466 }
9467 }
9468
9469 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, output_die (c));
9470
9471 /* Add null byte to terminate sibling list. */
9472 if (die->die_child != NULL)
9473 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "end of children of DIE %#lx",
9474 (unsigned long) die->die_offset);
9475 }
9476
9477 /* Output the compilation unit that appears at the beginning of the
9478 .debug_info section, and precedes the DIE descriptions. */
9479
9480 static void
9481 output_compilation_unit_header (void)
9482 {
9483 /* We don't support actual DWARFv5 units yet, we just use some
9484 DWARFv5 draft DIE tags in DWARFv4 format. */
9485 int ver = dwarf_version < 5 ? dwarf_version : 4;
9486
9487 if (!XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO)
9488 {
9489 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
9490 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
9491 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
9492 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
9493 next_die_offset - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE,
9494 "Length of Compilation Unit Info");
9495 }
9496
9497 dw2_asm_output_data (2, ver, "DWARF version number");
9498 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, abbrev_section_label,
9499 debug_abbrev_section,
9500 "Offset Into Abbrev. Section");
9501 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
9502 }
9503
9504 /* Output the compilation unit DIE and its children. */
9505
9506 static void
9507 output_comp_unit (dw_die_ref die, int output_if_empty)
9508 {
9509 const char *secname, *oldsym;
9510 char *tmp;
9511
9512 /* Unless we are outputting main CU, we may throw away empty ones. */
9513 if (!output_if_empty && die->die_child == NULL)
9514 return;
9515
9516 /* Even if there are no children of this DIE, we must output the information
9517 about the compilation unit. Otherwise, on an empty translation unit, we
9518 will generate a present, but empty, .debug_info section. IRIX 6.5 `nm'
9519 will then complain when examining the file. First mark all the DIEs in
9520 this CU so we know which get local refs. */
9521 mark_dies (die);
9522
9523 external_ref_hash_type *extern_map = optimize_external_refs (die);
9524
9525 build_abbrev_table (die, extern_map);
9526
9527 delete extern_map;
9528
9529 /* Initialize the beginning DIE offset - and calculate sizes/offsets. */
9530 next_die_offset = DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE;
9531 calc_die_sizes (die);
9532
9533 oldsym = die->die_id.die_symbol;
9534 if (oldsym)
9535 {
9536 tmp = XALLOCAVEC (char, strlen (oldsym) + 24);
9537
9538 sprintf (tmp, ".gnu.linkonce.wi.%s", oldsym);
9539 secname = tmp;
9540 die->die_id.die_symbol = NULL;
9541 switch_to_section (get_section (secname, SECTION_DEBUG, NULL));
9542 }
9543 else
9544 {
9545 switch_to_section (debug_info_section);
9546 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_info_section_label);
9547 info_section_emitted = true;
9548 }
9549
9550 /* Output debugging information. */
9551 output_compilation_unit_header ();
9552 output_die (die);
9553
9554 /* Leave the marks on the main CU, so we can check them in
9555 output_pubnames. */
9556 if (oldsym)
9557 {
9558 unmark_dies (die);
9559 die->die_id.die_symbol = oldsym;
9560 }
9561 }
9562
9563 /* Whether to generate the DWARF accelerator tables in .debug_pubnames
9564 and .debug_pubtypes. This is configured per-target, but can be
9565 overridden by the -gpubnames or -gno-pubnames options. */
9566
9567 static inline bool
9568 want_pubnames (void)
9569 {
9570 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
9571 return false;
9572 if (debug_generate_pub_sections != -1)
9573 return debug_generate_pub_sections;
9574 return targetm.want_debug_pub_sections;
9575 }
9576
9577 /* Add the DW_AT_GNU_pubnames and DW_AT_GNU_pubtypes attributes. */
9578
9579 static void
9580 add_AT_pubnames (dw_die_ref die)
9581 {
9582 if (want_pubnames ())
9583 add_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_GNU_pubnames, 1);
9584 }
9585
9586 /* Add a string attribute value to a skeleton DIE. */
9587
9588 static inline void
9589 add_skeleton_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
9590 const char *str)
9591 {
9592 dw_attr_node attr;
9593 struct indirect_string_node *node;
9594
9595 if (! skeleton_debug_str_hash)
9596 skeleton_debug_str_hash
9597 = hash_table<indirect_string_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
9598
9599 node = find_AT_string_in_table (str, skeleton_debug_str_hash);
9600 find_string_form (node);
9601 if (node->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index)
9602 node->form = DW_FORM_strp;
9603
9604 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
9605 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_str;
9606 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
9607 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
9608 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
9609 }
9610
9611 /* Helper function to generate top-level dies for skeleton debug_info and
9612 debug_types. */
9613
9614 static void
9615 add_top_level_skeleton_die_attrs (dw_die_ref die)
9616 {
9617 const char *dwo_file_name = concat (aux_base_name, ".dwo", NULL);
9618 const char *comp_dir = comp_dir_string ();
9619
9620 add_skeleton_AT_string (die, DW_AT_GNU_dwo_name, dwo_file_name);
9621 if (comp_dir != NULL)
9622 add_skeleton_AT_string (die, DW_AT_comp_dir, comp_dir);
9623 add_AT_pubnames (die);
9624 add_AT_lineptr (die, DW_AT_GNU_addr_base, debug_addr_section_label);
9625 }
9626
9627 /* Output skeleton debug sections that point to the dwo file. */
9628
9629 static void
9630 output_skeleton_debug_sections (dw_die_ref comp_unit)
9631 {
9632 /* We don't support actual DWARFv5 units yet, we just use some
9633 DWARFv5 draft DIE tags in DWARFv4 format. */
9634 int ver = dwarf_version < 5 ? dwarf_version : 4;
9635
9636 /* These attributes will be found in the full debug_info section. */
9637 remove_AT (comp_unit, DW_AT_producer);
9638 remove_AT (comp_unit, DW_AT_language);
9639
9640 switch_to_section (debug_skeleton_info_section);
9641 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_skeleton_info_section_label);
9642
9643 /* Produce the skeleton compilation-unit header. This one differs enough from
9644 a normal CU header that it's better not to call output_compilation_unit
9645 header. */
9646 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
9647 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
9648 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
9649
9650 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
9651 DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE
9652 - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE
9653 + size_of_die (comp_unit),
9654 "Length of Compilation Unit Info");
9655 dw2_asm_output_data (2, ver, "DWARF version number");
9656 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_skeleton_abbrev_section_label,
9657 debug_abbrev_section,
9658 "Offset Into Abbrev. Section");
9659 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
9660
9661 comp_unit->die_abbrev = SKELETON_COMP_DIE_ABBREV;
9662 output_die (comp_unit);
9663
9664 /* Build the skeleton debug_abbrev section. */
9665 switch_to_section (debug_skeleton_abbrev_section);
9666 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_skeleton_abbrev_section_label);
9667
9668 output_die_abbrevs (SKELETON_COMP_DIE_ABBREV, comp_unit);
9669
9670 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "end of skeleton .debug_abbrev");
9671 }
9672
9673 /* Output a comdat type unit DIE and its children. */
9674
9675 static void
9676 output_comdat_type_unit (comdat_type_node *node)
9677 {
9678 const char *secname;
9679 char *tmp;
9680 int i;
9681 #if defined (OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF)
9682 tree comdat_key;
9683 #endif
9684
9685 /* First mark all the DIEs in this CU so we know which get local refs. */
9686 mark_dies (node->root_die);
9687
9688 external_ref_hash_type *extern_map = optimize_external_refs (node->root_die);
9689
9690 build_abbrev_table (node->root_die, extern_map);
9691
9692 delete extern_map;
9693 extern_map = NULL;
9694
9695 /* Initialize the beginning DIE offset - and calculate sizes/offsets. */
9696 next_die_offset = DWARF_COMDAT_TYPE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE;
9697 calc_die_sizes (node->root_die);
9698
9699 #if defined (OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF)
9700 if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
9701 secname = ".debug_types";
9702 else
9703 secname = ".debug_types.dwo";
9704
9705 tmp = XALLOCAVEC (char, 4 + DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE * 2);
9706 sprintf (tmp, "wt.");
9707 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
9708 sprintf (tmp + 3 + i * 2, "%02x", node->signature[i] & 0xff);
9709 comdat_key = get_identifier (tmp);
9710 targetm.asm_out.named_section (secname,
9711 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_LINKONCE,
9712 comdat_key);
9713 #else
9714 tmp = XALLOCAVEC (char, 18 + DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE * 2);
9715 sprintf (tmp, ".gnu.linkonce.wt.");
9716 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
9717 sprintf (tmp + 17 + i * 2, "%02x", node->signature[i] & 0xff);
9718 secname = tmp;
9719 switch_to_section (get_section (secname, SECTION_DEBUG, NULL));
9720 #endif
9721
9722 /* Output debugging information. */
9723 output_compilation_unit_header ();
9724 output_signature (node->signature, "Type Signature");
9725 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, node->type_die->die_offset,
9726 "Offset to Type DIE");
9727 output_die (node->root_die);
9728
9729 unmark_dies (node->root_die);
9730 }
9731
9732 /* Return the DWARF2/3 pubname associated with a decl. */
9733
9734 static const char *
9735 dwarf2_name (tree decl, int scope)
9736 {
9737 if (DECL_NAMELESS (decl))
9738 return NULL;
9739 return lang_hooks.dwarf_name (decl, scope ? 1 : 0);
9740 }
9741
9742 /* Add a new entry to .debug_pubnames if appropriate. */
9743
9744 static void
9745 add_pubname_string (const char *str, dw_die_ref die)
9746 {
9747 pubname_entry e;
9748
9749 e.die = die;
9750 e.name = xstrdup (str);
9751 vec_safe_push (pubname_table, e);
9752 }
9753
9754 static void
9755 add_pubname (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
9756 {
9757 if (!want_pubnames ())
9758 return;
9759
9760 /* Don't add items to the table when we expect that the consumer will have
9761 just read the enclosing die. For example, if the consumer is looking at a
9762 class_member, it will either be inside the class already, or will have just
9763 looked up the class to find the member. Either way, searching the class is
9764 faster than searching the index. */
9765 if ((TREE_PUBLIC (decl) && !class_scope_p (die->die_parent))
9766 || is_cu_die (die->die_parent) || is_namespace_die (die->die_parent))
9767 {
9768 const char *name = dwarf2_name (decl, 1);
9769
9770 if (name)
9771 add_pubname_string (name, die);
9772 }
9773 }
9774
9775 /* Add an enumerator to the pubnames section. */
9776
9777 static void
9778 add_enumerator_pubname (const char *scope_name, dw_die_ref die)
9779 {
9780 pubname_entry e;
9781
9782 gcc_assert (scope_name);
9783 e.name = concat (scope_name, get_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name), NULL);
9784 e.die = die;
9785 vec_safe_push (pubname_table, e);
9786 }
9787
9788 /* Add a new entry to .debug_pubtypes if appropriate. */
9789
9790 static void
9791 add_pubtype (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
9792 {
9793 pubname_entry e;
9794
9795 if (!want_pubnames ())
9796 return;
9797
9798 if ((TREE_PUBLIC (decl)
9799 || is_cu_die (die->die_parent) || is_namespace_die (die->die_parent))
9800 && (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_typedef || COMPLETE_TYPE_P (decl)))
9801 {
9802 tree scope = NULL;
9803 const char *scope_name = "";
9804 const char *sep = is_cxx () ? "::" : ".";
9805 const char *name;
9806
9807 scope = TYPE_P (decl) ? TYPE_CONTEXT (decl) : NULL;
9808 if (scope && TREE_CODE (scope) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
9809 {
9810 scope_name = lang_hooks.dwarf_name (scope, 1);
9811 if (scope_name != NULL && scope_name[0] != '\0')
9812 scope_name = concat (scope_name, sep, NULL);
9813 else
9814 scope_name = "";
9815 }
9816
9817 if (TYPE_P (decl))
9818 name = type_tag (decl);
9819 else
9820 name = lang_hooks.dwarf_name (decl, 1);
9821
9822 /* If we don't have a name for the type, there's no point in adding
9823 it to the table. */
9824 if (name != NULL && name[0] != '\0')
9825 {
9826 e.die = die;
9827 e.name = concat (scope_name, name, NULL);
9828 vec_safe_push (pubtype_table, e);
9829 }
9830
9831 /* Although it might be more consistent to add the pubinfo for the
9832 enumerators as their dies are created, they should only be added if the
9833 enum type meets the criteria above. So rather than re-check the parent
9834 enum type whenever an enumerator die is created, just output them all
9835 here. This isn't protected by the name conditional because anonymous
9836 enums don't have names. */
9837 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_enumeration_type)
9838 {
9839 dw_die_ref c;
9840
9841 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, add_enumerator_pubname (scope_name, c));
9842 }
9843 }
9844 }
9845
9846 /* Output a single entry in the pubnames table. */
9847
9848 static void
9849 output_pubname (dw_offset die_offset, pubname_entry *entry)
9850 {
9851 dw_die_ref die = entry->die;
9852 int is_static = get_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_external) ? 0 : 1;
9853
9854 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, die_offset, "DIE offset");
9855
9856 if (debug_generate_pub_sections == 2)
9857 {
9858 /* This logic follows gdb's method for determining the value of the flag
9859 byte. */
9860 uint32_t flags = GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_NONE;
9861 switch (die->die_tag)
9862 {
9863 case DW_TAG_typedef:
9864 case DW_TAG_base_type:
9865 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
9866 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags, GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_TYPE);
9867 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_STATIC_SET_VALUE(flags, 1);
9868 break;
9869 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
9870 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags,
9871 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_VARIABLE);
9872 if (!is_cxx () && !is_java ())
9873 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_STATIC_SET_VALUE(flags, 1);
9874 break;
9875 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
9876 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags,
9877 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_FUNCTION);
9878 if (!is_ada ())
9879 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_STATIC_SET_VALUE(flags, is_static);
9880 break;
9881 case DW_TAG_constant:
9882 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags,
9883 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_VARIABLE);
9884 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_STATIC_SET_VALUE(flags, is_static);
9885 break;
9886 case DW_TAG_variable:
9887 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags,
9888 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_VARIABLE);
9889 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_STATIC_SET_VALUE(flags, is_static);
9890 break;
9891 case DW_TAG_namespace:
9892 case DW_TAG_imported_declaration:
9893 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags, GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_TYPE);
9894 break;
9895 case DW_TAG_class_type:
9896 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
9897 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
9898 case DW_TAG_union_type:
9899 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
9900 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_SET_VALUE(flags, GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_KIND_TYPE);
9901 if (!is_cxx () && !is_java ())
9902 GDB_INDEX_SYMBOL_STATIC_SET_VALUE(flags, 1);
9903 break;
9904 default:
9905 /* An unusual tag. Leave the flag-byte empty. */
9906 break;
9907 }
9908 dw2_asm_output_data (1, flags >> GDB_INDEX_CU_BITSIZE,
9909 "GDB-index flags");
9910 }
9911
9912 dw2_asm_output_nstring (entry->name, -1, "external name");
9913 }
9914
9915
9916 /* Output the public names table used to speed up access to externally
9917 visible names; or the public types table used to find type definitions. */
9918
9919 static void
9920 output_pubnames (vec<pubname_entry, va_gc> *names)
9921 {
9922 unsigned i;
9923 unsigned long pubnames_length = size_of_pubnames (names);
9924 pubname_entry *pub;
9925
9926 if (!XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO)
9927 {
9928 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
9929 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
9930 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
9931 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pubnames_length,
9932 "Pub Info Length");
9933 }
9934
9935 /* Version number for pubnames/pubtypes is independent of dwarf version. */
9936 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 2, "DWARF Version");
9937
9938 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
9939 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_skeleton_info_section_label,
9940 debug_skeleton_info_section,
9941 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
9942 else
9943 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
9944 debug_info_section,
9945 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
9946 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, next_die_offset,
9947 "Compilation Unit Length");
9948
9949 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*names, i, pub)
9950 {
9951 if (include_pubname_in_output (names, pub))
9952 {
9953 dw_offset die_offset = pub->die->die_offset;
9954
9955 /* We shouldn't see pubnames for DIEs outside of the main CU. */
9956 if (names == pubname_table && pub->die->die_tag != DW_TAG_enumerator)
9957 gcc_assert (pub->die->die_mark);
9958
9959 /* If we're putting types in their own .debug_types sections,
9960 the .debug_pubtypes table will still point to the compile
9961 unit (not the type unit), so we want to use the offset of
9962 the skeleton DIE (if there is one). */
9963 if (pub->die->comdat_type_p && names == pubtype_table)
9964 {
9965 comdat_type_node *type_node = pub->die->die_id.die_type_node;
9966
9967 if (type_node != NULL)
9968 die_offset = (type_node->skeleton_die != NULL
9969 ? type_node->skeleton_die->die_offset
9970 : comp_unit_die ()->die_offset);
9971 }
9972
9973 output_pubname (die_offset, pub);
9974 }
9975 }
9976
9977 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, 0, NULL);
9978 }
9979
9980 /* Output public names and types tables if necessary. */
9981
9982 static void
9983 output_pubtables (void)
9984 {
9985 if (!want_pubnames () || !info_section_emitted)
9986 return;
9987
9988 switch_to_section (debug_pubnames_section);
9989 output_pubnames (pubname_table);
9990 /* ??? Only defined by DWARF3, but emitted by Darwin for DWARF2.
9991 It shouldn't hurt to emit it always, since pure DWARF2 consumers
9992 simply won't look for the section. */
9993 switch_to_section (debug_pubtypes_section);
9994 output_pubnames (pubtype_table);
9995 }
9996
9997
9998 /* Output the information that goes into the .debug_aranges table.
9999 Namely, define the beginning and ending address range of the
10000 text section generated for this compilation unit. */
10001
10002 static void
10003 output_aranges (void)
10004 {
10005 unsigned i;
10006 unsigned long aranges_length = size_of_aranges ();
10007
10008 if (!XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO)
10009 {
10010 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
10011 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
10012 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
10013 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, aranges_length,
10014 "Length of Address Ranges Info");
10015 }
10016
10017 /* Version number for aranges is still 2, even up to DWARF5. */
10018 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 2, "DWARF Version");
10019 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
10020 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_skeleton_info_section_label,
10021 debug_skeleton_info_section,
10022 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
10023 else
10024 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
10025 debug_info_section,
10026 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
10027 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Size of Address");
10028 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Size of Segment Descriptor");
10029
10030 /* We need to align to twice the pointer size here. */
10031 if (DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE)
10032 {
10033 /* Pad using a 2 byte words so that padding is correct for any
10034 pointer size. */
10035 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, "Pad to %d byte boundary",
10036 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
10037 for (i = 2; i < (unsigned) DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE; i += 2)
10038 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, NULL);
10039 }
10040
10041 /* It is necessary not to output these entries if the sections were
10042 not used; if the sections were not used, the length will be 0 and
10043 the address may end up as 0 if the section is discarded by ld
10044 --gc-sections, leaving an invalid (0, 0) entry that can be
10045 confused with the terminator. */
10046 if (text_section_used)
10047 {
10048 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_section_label, "Address");
10049 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_end_label,
10050 text_section_label, "Length");
10051 }
10052 if (cold_text_section_used)
10053 {
10054 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, cold_text_section_label,
10055 "Address");
10056 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, cold_end_label,
10057 cold_text_section_label, "Length");
10058 }
10059
10060 if (have_multiple_function_sections)
10061 {
10062 unsigned fde_idx;
10063 dw_fde_ref fde;
10064
10065 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*fde_vec, fde_idx, fde)
10066 {
10067 if (DECL_IGNORED_P (fde->decl))
10068 continue;
10069 if (!fde->in_std_section)
10070 {
10071 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_begin,
10072 "Address");
10073 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_end,
10074 fde->dw_fde_begin, "Length");
10075 }
10076 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin && !fde->second_in_std_section)
10077 {
10078 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_second_begin,
10079 "Address");
10080 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_second_end,
10081 fde->dw_fde_second_begin, "Length");
10082 }
10083 }
10084 }
10085
10086 /* Output the terminator words. */
10087 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
10088 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
10089 }
10090
10091 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges. Return the offset at which it
10092 was placed. */
10093
10094 static unsigned int
10095 add_ranges_num (int num)
10096 {
10097 unsigned int in_use = ranges_table_in_use;
10098
10099 if (in_use == ranges_table_allocated)
10100 {
10101 ranges_table_allocated += RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT;
10102 ranges_table = GGC_RESIZEVEC (dw_ranges, ranges_table,
10103 ranges_table_allocated);
10104 memset (ranges_table + ranges_table_in_use, 0,
10105 RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_ranges));
10106 }
10107
10108 ranges_table[in_use].num = num;
10109 ranges_table_in_use = in_use + 1;
10110
10111 return in_use * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
10112 }
10113
10114 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges corresponding to a block, or a
10115 range terminator if BLOCK is NULL. */
10116
10117 static unsigned int
10118 add_ranges (const_tree block)
10119 {
10120 return add_ranges_num (block ? BLOCK_NUMBER (block) : 0);
10121 }
10122
10123 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges corresponding to a pair of labels.
10124 When using dwarf_split_debug_info, address attributes in dies destined
10125 for the final executable should be direct references--setting the
10126 parameter force_direct ensures this behavior. */
10127
10128 static void
10129 add_ranges_by_labels (dw_die_ref die, const char *begin, const char *end,
10130 bool *added, bool force_direct)
10131 {
10132 unsigned int in_use = ranges_by_label_in_use;
10133 unsigned int offset;
10134
10135 if (in_use == ranges_by_label_allocated)
10136 {
10137 ranges_by_label_allocated += RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT;
10138 ranges_by_label = GGC_RESIZEVEC (dw_ranges_by_label, ranges_by_label,
10139 ranges_by_label_allocated);
10140 memset (ranges_by_label + ranges_by_label_in_use, 0,
10141 RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_ranges_by_label));
10142 }
10143
10144 ranges_by_label[in_use].begin = begin;
10145 ranges_by_label[in_use].end = end;
10146 ranges_by_label_in_use = in_use + 1;
10147
10148 offset = add_ranges_num (-(int)in_use - 1);
10149 if (!*added)
10150 {
10151 add_AT_range_list (die, DW_AT_ranges, offset, force_direct);
10152 *added = true;
10153 }
10154 }
10155
10156 static void
10157 output_ranges (void)
10158 {
10159 unsigned i;
10160 static const char *const start_fmt = "Offset %#x";
10161 const char *fmt = start_fmt;
10162
10163 for (i = 0; i < ranges_table_in_use; i++)
10164 {
10165 int block_num = ranges_table[i].num;
10166
10167 if (block_num > 0)
10168 {
10169 char blabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
10170 char elabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
10171
10172 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (blabel, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, block_num);
10173 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (elabel, BLOCK_END_LABEL, block_num);
10174
10175 /* If all code is in the text section, then the compilation
10176 unit base address defaults to DW_AT_low_pc, which is the
10177 base of the text section. */
10178 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
10179 {
10180 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
10181 text_section_label,
10182 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
10183 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel,
10184 text_section_label, NULL);
10185 }
10186
10187 /* Otherwise, the compilation unit base address is zero,
10188 which allows us to use absolute addresses, and not worry
10189 about whether the target supports cross-section
10190 arithmetic. */
10191 else
10192 {
10193 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
10194 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
10195 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel, NULL);
10196 }
10197
10198 fmt = NULL;
10199 }
10200
10201 /* Negative block_num stands for an index into ranges_by_label. */
10202 else if (block_num < 0)
10203 {
10204 int lab_idx = - block_num - 1;
10205
10206 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
10207 {
10208 gcc_unreachable ();
10209 #if 0
10210 /* If we ever use add_ranges_by_labels () for a single
10211 function section, all we have to do is to take out
10212 the #if 0 above. */
10213 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
10214 ranges_by_label[lab_idx].begin,
10215 text_section_label,
10216 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
10217 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
10218 ranges_by_label[lab_idx].end,
10219 text_section_label, NULL);
10220 #endif
10221 }
10222 else
10223 {
10224 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
10225 ranges_by_label[lab_idx].begin,
10226 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
10227 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
10228 ranges_by_label[lab_idx].end,
10229 NULL);
10230 }
10231 }
10232 else
10233 {
10234 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
10235 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
10236 fmt = start_fmt;
10237 }
10238 }
10239 }
10240
10241 /* Data structure containing information about input files. */
10242 struct file_info
10243 {
10244 const char *path; /* Complete file name. */
10245 const char *fname; /* File name part. */
10246 int length; /* Length of entire string. */
10247 struct dwarf_file_data * file_idx; /* Index in input file table. */
10248 int dir_idx; /* Index in directory table. */
10249 };
10250
10251 /* Data structure containing information about directories with source
10252 files. */
10253 struct dir_info
10254 {
10255 const char *path; /* Path including directory name. */
10256 int length; /* Path length. */
10257 int prefix; /* Index of directory entry which is a prefix. */
10258 int count; /* Number of files in this directory. */
10259 int dir_idx; /* Index of directory used as base. */
10260 };
10261
10262 /* Callback function for file_info comparison. We sort by looking at
10263 the directories in the path. */
10264
10265 static int
10266 file_info_cmp (const void *p1, const void *p2)
10267 {
10268 const struct file_info *const s1 = (const struct file_info *) p1;
10269 const struct file_info *const s2 = (const struct file_info *) p2;
10270 const unsigned char *cp1;
10271 const unsigned char *cp2;
10272
10273 /* Take care of file names without directories. We need to make sure that
10274 we return consistent values to qsort since some will get confused if
10275 we return the same value when identical operands are passed in opposite
10276 orders. So if neither has a directory, return 0 and otherwise return
10277 1 or -1 depending on which one has the directory. */
10278 if ((s1->path == s1->fname || s2->path == s2->fname))
10279 return (s2->path == s2->fname) - (s1->path == s1->fname);
10280
10281 cp1 = (const unsigned char *) s1->path;
10282 cp2 = (const unsigned char *) s2->path;
10283
10284 while (1)
10285 {
10286 ++cp1;
10287 ++cp2;
10288 /* Reached the end of the first path? If so, handle like above. */
10289 if ((cp1 == (const unsigned char *) s1->fname)
10290 || (cp2 == (const unsigned char *) s2->fname))
10291 return ((cp2 == (const unsigned char *) s2->fname)
10292 - (cp1 == (const unsigned char *) s1->fname));
10293
10294 /* Character of current path component the same? */
10295 else if (*cp1 != *cp2)
10296 return *cp1 - *cp2;
10297 }
10298 }
10299
10300 struct file_name_acquire_data
10301 {
10302 struct file_info *files;
10303 int used_files;
10304 int max_files;
10305 };
10306
10307 /* Traversal function for the hash table. */
10308
10309 int
10310 file_name_acquire (dwarf_file_data **slot, file_name_acquire_data *fnad)
10311 {
10312 struct dwarf_file_data *d = *slot;
10313 struct file_info *fi;
10314 const char *f;
10315
10316 gcc_assert (fnad->max_files >= d->emitted_number);
10317
10318 if (! d->emitted_number)
10319 return 1;
10320
10321 gcc_assert (fnad->max_files != fnad->used_files);
10322
10323 fi = fnad->files + fnad->used_files++;
10324
10325 /* Skip all leading "./". */
10326 f = d->filename;
10327 while (f[0] == '.' && IS_DIR_SEPARATOR (f[1]))
10328 f += 2;
10329
10330 /* Create a new array entry. */
10331 fi->path = f;
10332 fi->length = strlen (f);
10333 fi->file_idx = d;
10334
10335 /* Search for the file name part. */
10336 f = strrchr (f, DIR_SEPARATOR);
10337 #if defined (DIR_SEPARATOR_2)
10338 {
10339 char *g = strrchr (fi->path, DIR_SEPARATOR_2);
10340
10341 if (g != NULL)
10342 {
10343 if (f == NULL || f < g)
10344 f = g;
10345 }
10346 }
10347 #endif
10348
10349 fi->fname = f == NULL ? fi->path : f + 1;
10350 return 1;
10351 }
10352
10353 /* Output the directory table and the file name table. We try to minimize
10354 the total amount of memory needed. A heuristic is used to avoid large
10355 slowdowns with many input files. */
10356
10357 static void
10358 output_file_names (void)
10359 {
10360 struct file_name_acquire_data fnad;
10361 int numfiles;
10362 struct file_info *files;
10363 struct dir_info *dirs;
10364 int *saved;
10365 int *savehere;
10366 int *backmap;
10367 int ndirs;
10368 int idx_offset;
10369 int i;
10370
10371 if (!last_emitted_file)
10372 {
10373 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
10374 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
10375 return;
10376 }
10377
10378 numfiles = last_emitted_file->emitted_number;
10379
10380 /* Allocate the various arrays we need. */
10381 files = XALLOCAVEC (struct file_info, numfiles);
10382 dirs = XALLOCAVEC (struct dir_info, numfiles);
10383
10384 fnad.files = files;
10385 fnad.used_files = 0;
10386 fnad.max_files = numfiles;
10387 file_table->traverse<file_name_acquire_data *, file_name_acquire> (&fnad);
10388 gcc_assert (fnad.used_files == fnad.max_files);
10389
10390 qsort (files, numfiles, sizeof (files[0]), file_info_cmp);
10391
10392 /* Find all the different directories used. */
10393 dirs[0].path = files[0].path;
10394 dirs[0].length = files[0].fname - files[0].path;
10395 dirs[0].prefix = -1;
10396 dirs[0].count = 1;
10397 dirs[0].dir_idx = 0;
10398 files[0].dir_idx = 0;
10399 ndirs = 1;
10400
10401 for (i = 1; i < numfiles; i++)
10402 if (files[i].fname - files[i].path == dirs[ndirs - 1].length
10403 && memcmp (dirs[ndirs - 1].path, files[i].path,
10404 dirs[ndirs - 1].length) == 0)
10405 {
10406 /* Same directory as last entry. */
10407 files[i].dir_idx = ndirs - 1;
10408 ++dirs[ndirs - 1].count;
10409 }
10410 else
10411 {
10412 int j;
10413
10414 /* This is a new directory. */
10415 dirs[ndirs].path = files[i].path;
10416 dirs[ndirs].length = files[i].fname - files[i].path;
10417 dirs[ndirs].count = 1;
10418 dirs[ndirs].dir_idx = ndirs;
10419 files[i].dir_idx = ndirs;
10420
10421 /* Search for a prefix. */
10422 dirs[ndirs].prefix = -1;
10423 for (j = 0; j < ndirs; j++)
10424 if (dirs[j].length < dirs[ndirs].length
10425 && dirs[j].length > 1
10426 && (dirs[ndirs].prefix == -1
10427 || dirs[j].length > dirs[dirs[ndirs].prefix].length)
10428 && memcmp (dirs[j].path, dirs[ndirs].path, dirs[j].length) == 0)
10429 dirs[ndirs].prefix = j;
10430
10431 ++ndirs;
10432 }
10433
10434 /* Now to the actual work. We have to find a subset of the directories which
10435 allow expressing the file name using references to the directory table
10436 with the least amount of characters. We do not do an exhaustive search
10437 where we would have to check out every combination of every single
10438 possible prefix. Instead we use a heuristic which provides nearly optimal
10439 results in most cases and never is much off. */
10440 saved = XALLOCAVEC (int, ndirs);
10441 savehere = XALLOCAVEC (int, ndirs);
10442
10443 memset (saved, '\0', ndirs * sizeof (saved[0]));
10444 for (i = 0; i < ndirs; i++)
10445 {
10446 int j;
10447 int total;
10448
10449 /* We can always save some space for the current directory. But this
10450 does not mean it will be enough to justify adding the directory. */
10451 savehere[i] = dirs[i].length;
10452 total = (savehere[i] - saved[i]) * dirs[i].count;
10453
10454 for (j = i + 1; j < ndirs; j++)
10455 {
10456 savehere[j] = 0;
10457 if (saved[j] < dirs[i].length)
10458 {
10459 /* Determine whether the dirs[i] path is a prefix of the
10460 dirs[j] path. */
10461 int k;
10462
10463 k = dirs[j].prefix;
10464 while (k != -1 && k != (int) i)
10465 k = dirs[k].prefix;
10466
10467 if (k == (int) i)
10468 {
10469 /* Yes it is. We can possibly save some memory by
10470 writing the filenames in dirs[j] relative to
10471 dirs[i]. */
10472 savehere[j] = dirs[i].length;
10473 total += (savehere[j] - saved[j]) * dirs[j].count;
10474 }
10475 }
10476 }
10477
10478 /* Check whether we can save enough to justify adding the dirs[i]
10479 directory. */
10480 if (total > dirs[i].length + 1)
10481 {
10482 /* It's worthwhile adding. */
10483 for (j = i; j < ndirs; j++)
10484 if (savehere[j] > 0)
10485 {
10486 /* Remember how much we saved for this directory so far. */
10487 saved[j] = savehere[j];
10488
10489 /* Remember the prefix directory. */
10490 dirs[j].dir_idx = i;
10491 }
10492 }
10493 }
10494
10495 /* Emit the directory name table. */
10496 idx_offset = dirs[0].length > 0 ? 1 : 0;
10497 for (i = 1 - idx_offset; i < ndirs; i++)
10498 dw2_asm_output_nstring (dirs[i].path,
10499 dirs[i].length
10500 - !DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR,
10501 "Directory Entry: %#x", i + idx_offset);
10502
10503 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
10504
10505 /* We have to emit them in the order of emitted_number since that's
10506 used in the debug info generation. To do this efficiently we
10507 generate a back-mapping of the indices first. */
10508 backmap = XALLOCAVEC (int, numfiles);
10509 for (i = 0; i < numfiles; i++)
10510 backmap[files[i].file_idx->emitted_number - 1] = i;
10511
10512 /* Now write all the file names. */
10513 for (i = 0; i < numfiles; i++)
10514 {
10515 int file_idx = backmap[i];
10516 int dir_idx = dirs[files[file_idx].dir_idx].dir_idx;
10517
10518 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
10519 #define MAX_VMS_VERSION_LEN 6 /* ";32768" */
10520
10521 /* Setting these fields can lead to debugger miscomparisons,
10522 but VMS Debug requires them to be set correctly. */
10523
10524 int ver;
10525 long long cdt;
10526 long siz;
10527 int maxfilelen = strlen (files[file_idx].path)
10528 + dirs[dir_idx].length
10529 + MAX_VMS_VERSION_LEN + 1;
10530 char *filebuf = XALLOCAVEC (char, maxfilelen);
10531
10532 vms_file_stats_name (files[file_idx].path, 0, 0, 0, &ver);
10533 snprintf (filebuf, maxfilelen, "%s;%d",
10534 files[file_idx].path + dirs[dir_idx].length, ver);
10535
10536 dw2_asm_output_nstring
10537 (filebuf, -1, "File Entry: %#x", (unsigned) i + 1);
10538
10539 /* Include directory index. */
10540 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (dir_idx + idx_offset, NULL);
10541
10542 /* Modification time. */
10543 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128
10544 ((vms_file_stats_name (files[file_idx].path, &cdt, 0, 0, 0) == 0)
10545 ? cdt : 0,
10546 NULL);
10547
10548 /* File length in bytes. */
10549 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128
10550 ((vms_file_stats_name (files[file_idx].path, 0, &siz, 0, 0) == 0)
10551 ? siz : 0,
10552 NULL);
10553 #else
10554 dw2_asm_output_nstring (files[file_idx].path + dirs[dir_idx].length, -1,
10555 "File Entry: %#x", (unsigned) i + 1);
10556
10557 /* Include directory index. */
10558 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (dir_idx + idx_offset, NULL);
10559
10560 /* Modification time. */
10561 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
10562
10563 /* File length in bytes. */
10564 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
10565 #endif /* VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO */
10566 }
10567
10568 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
10569 }
10570
10571
10572 /* Output one line number table into the .debug_line section. */
10573
10574 static void
10575 output_one_line_info_table (dw_line_info_table *table)
10576 {
10577 char line_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
10578 unsigned int current_line = 1;
10579 bool current_is_stmt = DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START;
10580 dw_line_info_entry *ent;
10581 size_t i;
10582
10583 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (table->entries, i, ent)
10584 {
10585 switch (ent->opcode)
10586 {
10587 case LI_set_address:
10588 /* ??? Unfortunately, we have little choice here currently, and
10589 must always use the most general form. GCC does not know the
10590 address delta itself, so we can't use DW_LNS_advance_pc. Many
10591 ports do have length attributes which will give an upper bound
10592 on the address range. We could perhaps use length attributes
10593 to determine when it is safe to use DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc. */
10594 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, LINE_CODE_LABEL, ent->val);
10595
10596 /* This can handle any delta. This takes
10597 4+DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE bytes. */
10598 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "set address %s", line_label);
10599 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
10600 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
10601 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
10602 break;
10603
10604 case LI_set_line:
10605 if (ent->val == current_line)
10606 {
10607 /* We still need to start a new row, so output a copy insn. */
10608 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy,
10609 "copy line %u", current_line);
10610 }
10611 else
10612 {
10613 int line_offset = ent->val - current_line;
10614 int line_delta = line_offset - DWARF_LINE_BASE;
10615
10616 current_line = ent->val;
10617 if (line_delta >= 0 && line_delta < (DWARF_LINE_RANGE - 1))
10618 {
10619 /* This can handle deltas from -10 to 234, using the current
10620 definitions of DWARF_LINE_BASE and DWARF_LINE_RANGE.
10621 This takes 1 byte. */
10622 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE + line_delta,
10623 "line %u", current_line);
10624 }
10625 else
10626 {
10627 /* This can handle any delta. This takes at least 4 bytes,
10628 depending on the value being encoded. */
10629 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_advance_line,
10630 "advance to line %u", current_line);
10631 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (line_offset, NULL);
10632 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, NULL);
10633 }
10634 }
10635 break;
10636
10637 case LI_set_file:
10638 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_file, "set file %u", ent->val);
10639 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ent->val, "%u", ent->val);
10640 break;
10641
10642 case LI_set_column:
10643 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_column, "column %u", ent->val);
10644 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ent->val, "%u", ent->val);
10645 break;
10646
10647 case LI_negate_stmt:
10648 current_is_stmt = !current_is_stmt;
10649 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_negate_stmt,
10650 "is_stmt %d", current_is_stmt);
10651 break;
10652
10653 case LI_set_prologue_end:
10654 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_prologue_end,
10655 "set prologue end");
10656 break;
10657
10658 case LI_set_epilogue_begin:
10659 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_epilogue_begin,
10660 "set epilogue begin");
10661 break;
10662
10663 case LI_set_discriminator:
10664 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "discriminator %u", ent->val);
10665 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + size_of_uleb128 (ent->val), NULL);
10666 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_discriminator, NULL);
10667 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ent->val, NULL);
10668 break;
10669 }
10670 }
10671
10672 /* Emit debug info for the address of the end of the table. */
10673 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "set address %s", table->end_label);
10674 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
10675 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
10676 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, table->end_label, NULL);
10677
10678 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "end sequence");
10679 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, NULL);
10680 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_end_sequence, NULL);
10681 }
10682
10683 /* Output the source line number correspondence information. This
10684 information goes into the .debug_line section. */
10685
10686 static void
10687 output_line_info (bool prologue_only)
10688 {
10689 char l1[20], l2[20], p1[20], p2[20];
10690 /* We don't support DWARFv5 line tables yet. */
10691 int ver = dwarf_version < 5 ? dwarf_version : 4;
10692 bool saw_one = false;
10693 int opc;
10694
10695 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL, 0);
10696 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL, 0);
10697 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p1, LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL, 0);
10698 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p2, LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL, 0);
10699
10700 if (!XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO)
10701 {
10702 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
10703 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
10704 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
10705 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
10706 "Length of Source Line Info");
10707 }
10708
10709 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
10710
10711 dw2_asm_output_data (2, ver, "DWARF Version");
10712 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, p2, p1, "Prolog Length");
10713 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p1);
10714
10715 /* Define the architecture-dependent minimum instruction length (in bytes).
10716 In this implementation of DWARF, this field is used for information
10717 purposes only. Since GCC generates assembly language, we have no
10718 a priori knowledge of how many instruction bytes are generated for each
10719 source line, and therefore can use only the DW_LNE_set_address and
10720 DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc line information commands. Accordingly, we fix
10721 this as '1', which is "correct enough" for all architectures,
10722 and don't let the target override. */
10723 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 1, "Minimum Instruction Length");
10724
10725 if (ver >= 4)
10726 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_MAX_OPS_PER_INSN,
10727 "Maximum Operations Per Instruction");
10728 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START,
10729 "Default is_stmt_start flag");
10730 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_BASE,
10731 "Line Base Value (Special Opcodes)");
10732 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_RANGE,
10733 "Line Range Value (Special Opcodes)");
10734 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE,
10735 "Special Opcode Base");
10736
10737 for (opc = 1; opc < DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE; opc++)
10738 {
10739 int n_op_args;
10740 switch (opc)
10741 {
10742 case DW_LNS_advance_pc:
10743 case DW_LNS_advance_line:
10744 case DW_LNS_set_file:
10745 case DW_LNS_set_column:
10746 case DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc:
10747 case DW_LNS_set_isa:
10748 n_op_args = 1;
10749 break;
10750 default:
10751 n_op_args = 0;
10752 break;
10753 }
10754
10755 dw2_asm_output_data (1, n_op_args, "opcode: %#x has %d args",
10756 opc, n_op_args);
10757 }
10758
10759 /* Write out the information about the files we use. */
10760 output_file_names ();
10761 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p2);
10762 if (prologue_only)
10763 {
10764 /* Output the marker for the end of the line number info. */
10765 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
10766 return;
10767 }
10768
10769 if (separate_line_info)
10770 {
10771 dw_line_info_table *table;
10772 size_t i;
10773
10774 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*separate_line_info, i, table)
10775 if (table->in_use)
10776 {
10777 output_one_line_info_table (table);
10778 saw_one = true;
10779 }
10780 }
10781 if (cold_text_section_line_info && cold_text_section_line_info->in_use)
10782 {
10783 output_one_line_info_table (cold_text_section_line_info);
10784 saw_one = true;
10785 }
10786
10787 /* ??? Some Darwin linkers crash on a .debug_line section with no
10788 sequences. Further, merely a DW_LNE_end_sequence entry is not
10789 sufficient -- the address column must also be initialized.
10790 Make sure to output at least one set_address/end_sequence pair,
10791 choosing .text since that section is always present. */
10792 if (text_section_line_info->in_use || !saw_one)
10793 output_one_line_info_table (text_section_line_info);
10794
10795 /* Output the marker for the end of the line number info. */
10796 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
10797 }
10798 \f
10799 /* Given a pointer to a tree node for some base type, return a pointer to
10800 a DIE that describes the given type.
10801
10802 This routine must only be called for GCC type nodes that correspond to
10803 Dwarf base (fundamental) types. */
10804
10805 static dw_die_ref
10806 base_type_die (tree type)
10807 {
10808 dw_die_ref base_type_result;
10809 enum dwarf_type encoding;
10810 bool fpt_used = false;
10811 struct fixed_point_type_info fpt_info;
10812 tree type_bias = NULL_TREE;
10813
10814 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK || TREE_CODE (type) == VOID_TYPE)
10815 return 0;
10816
10817 /* If this is a subtype that should not be emitted as a subrange type,
10818 use the base type. See subrange_type_for_debug_p. */
10819 if (TREE_CODE (type) == INTEGER_TYPE && TREE_TYPE (type) != NULL_TREE)
10820 type = TREE_TYPE (type);
10821
10822 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
10823 {
10824 case INTEGER_TYPE:
10825 if ((dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
10826 && TYPE_NAME (type)
10827 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
10828 && DECL_IS_BUILTIN (TYPE_NAME (type))
10829 && DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type)))
10830 {
10831 const char *name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type)));
10832 if (strcmp (name, "char16_t") == 0
10833 || strcmp (name, "char32_t") == 0)
10834 {
10835 encoding = DW_ATE_UTF;
10836 break;
10837 }
10838 }
10839 if ((dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
10840 && lang_hooks.types.get_fixed_point_type_info)
10841 {
10842 memset (&fpt_info, 0, sizeof (fpt_info));
10843 if (lang_hooks.types.get_fixed_point_type_info (type, &fpt_info))
10844 {
10845 fpt_used = true;
10846 encoding = ((TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
10847 ? DW_ATE_unsigned_fixed
10848 : DW_ATE_signed_fixed);
10849 break;
10850 }
10851 }
10852 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type))
10853 {
10854 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
10855 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned_char;
10856 else
10857 encoding = DW_ATE_signed_char;
10858 }
10859 else if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
10860 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned;
10861 else
10862 encoding = DW_ATE_signed;
10863
10864 if (!dwarf_strict
10865 && lang_hooks.types.get_type_bias)
10866 type_bias = lang_hooks.types.get_type_bias (type);
10867 break;
10868
10869 case REAL_TYPE:
10870 if (DECIMAL_FLOAT_MODE_P (TYPE_MODE (type)))
10871 {
10872 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
10873 encoding = DW_ATE_decimal_float;
10874 else
10875 encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
10876 }
10877 else
10878 encoding = DW_ATE_float;
10879 break;
10880
10881 case FIXED_POINT_TYPE:
10882 if (!(dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
10883 encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
10884 else if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
10885 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned_fixed;
10886 else
10887 encoding = DW_ATE_signed_fixed;
10888 break;
10889
10890 /* Dwarf2 doesn't know anything about complex ints, so use
10891 a user defined type for it. */
10892 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
10893 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == REAL_TYPE)
10894 encoding = DW_ATE_complex_float;
10895 else
10896 encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
10897 break;
10898
10899 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
10900 /* GNU FORTRAN/Ada/C++ BOOLEAN type. */
10901 encoding = DW_ATE_boolean;
10902 break;
10903
10904 default:
10905 /* No other TREE_CODEs are Dwarf fundamental types. */
10906 gcc_unreachable ();
10907 }
10908
10909 base_type_result = new_die (DW_TAG_base_type, comp_unit_die (), type);
10910
10911 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_byte_size,
10912 int_size_in_bytes (type));
10913 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_encoding, encoding);
10914
10915 if (fpt_used)
10916 {
10917 switch (fpt_info.scale_factor_kind)
10918 {
10919 case fixed_point_scale_factor_binary:
10920 add_AT_int (base_type_result, DW_AT_binary_scale,
10921 fpt_info.scale_factor.binary);
10922 break;
10923
10924 case fixed_point_scale_factor_decimal:
10925 add_AT_int (base_type_result, DW_AT_decimal_scale,
10926 fpt_info.scale_factor.decimal);
10927 break;
10928
10929 case fixed_point_scale_factor_arbitrary:
10930 /* Arbitrary scale factors cannot be described in standard DWARF,
10931 yet. */
10932 if (!dwarf_strict)
10933 {
10934 /* Describe the scale factor as a rational constant. */
10935 const dw_die_ref scale_factor
10936 = new_die (DW_TAG_constant, comp_unit_die (), type);
10937
10938 add_AT_unsigned (scale_factor, DW_AT_GNU_numerator,
10939 fpt_info.scale_factor.arbitrary.numerator);
10940 add_AT_int (scale_factor, DW_AT_GNU_denominator,
10941 fpt_info.scale_factor.arbitrary.denominator);
10942
10943 add_AT_die_ref (base_type_result, DW_AT_small, scale_factor);
10944 }
10945 break;
10946
10947 default:
10948 gcc_unreachable ();
10949 }
10950 }
10951 if (type_bias != NULL)
10952 add_scalar_info (base_type_result, DW_AT_GNU_bias, type_bias,
10953 dw_scalar_form_constant
10954 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
10955 | dw_scalar_form_reference,
10956 NULL);
10957 add_pubtype (type, base_type_result);
10958
10959 return base_type_result;
10960 }
10961
10962 /* A C++ function with deduced return type can have a TEMPLATE_TYPE_PARM
10963 named 'auto' in its type: return true for it, false otherwise. */
10964
10965 static inline bool
10966 is_cxx_auto (tree type)
10967 {
10968 if (is_cxx ())
10969 {
10970 tree name = TYPE_IDENTIFIER (type);
10971 if (name == get_identifier ("auto")
10972 || name == get_identifier ("decltype(auto)"))
10973 return true;
10974 }
10975 return false;
10976 }
10977
10978 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return nonzero if the
10979 given input type is a Dwarf "fundamental" type. Otherwise return null. */
10980
10981 static inline int
10982 is_base_type (tree type)
10983 {
10984 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
10985 {
10986 case ERROR_MARK:
10987 case VOID_TYPE:
10988 case INTEGER_TYPE:
10989 case REAL_TYPE:
10990 case FIXED_POINT_TYPE:
10991 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
10992 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
10993 case POINTER_BOUNDS_TYPE:
10994 return 1;
10995
10996 case ARRAY_TYPE:
10997 case RECORD_TYPE:
10998 case UNION_TYPE:
10999 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
11000 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
11001 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
11002 case METHOD_TYPE:
11003 case POINTER_TYPE:
11004 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
11005 case NULLPTR_TYPE:
11006 case OFFSET_TYPE:
11007 case LANG_TYPE:
11008 case VECTOR_TYPE:
11009 return 0;
11010
11011 default:
11012 if (is_cxx_auto (type))
11013 return 0;
11014 gcc_unreachable ();
11015 }
11016
11017 return 0;
11018 }
11019
11020 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, assumed to be some kind of a ..._TYPE
11021 node, return the size in bits for the type if it is a constant, or else
11022 return the alignment for the type if the type's size is not constant, or
11023 else return BITS_PER_WORD if the type actually turns out to be an
11024 ERROR_MARK node. */
11025
11026 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
11027 simple_type_size_in_bits (const_tree type)
11028 {
11029 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
11030 return BITS_PER_WORD;
11031 else if (TYPE_SIZE (type) == NULL_TREE)
11032 return 0;
11033 else if (tree_fits_uhwi_p (TYPE_SIZE (type)))
11034 return tree_to_uhwi (TYPE_SIZE (type));
11035 else
11036 return TYPE_ALIGN (type);
11037 }
11038
11039 /* Similarly, but return an offset_int instead of UHWI. */
11040
11041 static inline offset_int
11042 offset_int_type_size_in_bits (const_tree type)
11043 {
11044 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
11045 return BITS_PER_WORD;
11046 else if (TYPE_SIZE (type) == NULL_TREE)
11047 return 0;
11048 else if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (type)) == INTEGER_CST)
11049 return wi::to_offset (TYPE_SIZE (type));
11050 else
11051 return TYPE_ALIGN (type);
11052 }
11053
11054 /* Given a pointer to a tree node for a subrange type, return a pointer
11055 to a DIE that describes the given type. */
11056
11057 static dw_die_ref
11058 subrange_type_die (tree type, tree low, tree high, tree bias,
11059 dw_die_ref context_die)
11060 {
11061 dw_die_ref subrange_die;
11062 const HOST_WIDE_INT size_in_bytes = int_size_in_bytes (type);
11063
11064 if (context_die == NULL)
11065 context_die = comp_unit_die ();
11066
11067 subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, context_die, type);
11068
11069 if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (type)) != size_in_bytes)
11070 {
11071 /* The size of the subrange type and its base type do not match,
11072 so we need to generate a size attribute for the subrange type. */
11073 add_AT_unsigned (subrange_die, DW_AT_byte_size, size_in_bytes);
11074 }
11075
11076 if (low)
11077 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, low, NULL);
11078 if (high)
11079 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound, high, NULL);
11080 if (bias && !dwarf_strict)
11081 add_scalar_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_GNU_bias, bias,
11082 dw_scalar_form_constant
11083 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
11084 | dw_scalar_form_reference,
11085 NULL);
11086
11087 return subrange_die;
11088 }
11089
11090 /* Returns the (const and/or volatile) cv_qualifiers associated with
11091 the decl node. This will normally be augmented with the
11092 cv_qualifiers of the underlying type in add_type_attribute. */
11093
11094 static int
11095 decl_quals (const_tree decl)
11096 {
11097 return ((TREE_READONLY (decl)
11098 ? TYPE_QUAL_CONST : TYPE_UNQUALIFIED)
11099 | (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl)
11100 ? TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE : TYPE_UNQUALIFIED));
11101 }
11102
11103 /* Determine the TYPE whose qualifiers match the largest strict subset
11104 of the given TYPE_QUALS, and return its qualifiers. Ignore all
11105 qualifiers outside QUAL_MASK. */
11106
11107 static int
11108 get_nearest_type_subqualifiers (tree type, int type_quals, int qual_mask)
11109 {
11110 tree t;
11111 int best_rank = 0, best_qual = 0, max_rank;
11112
11113 type_quals &= qual_mask;
11114 max_rank = popcount_hwi (type_quals) - 1;
11115
11116 for (t = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type); t && best_rank < max_rank;
11117 t = TYPE_NEXT_VARIANT (t))
11118 {
11119 int q = TYPE_QUALS (t) & qual_mask;
11120
11121 if ((q & type_quals) == q && q != type_quals
11122 && check_base_type (t, type))
11123 {
11124 int rank = popcount_hwi (q);
11125
11126 if (rank > best_rank)
11127 {
11128 best_rank = rank;
11129 best_qual = q;
11130 }
11131 }
11132 }
11133
11134 return best_qual;
11135 }
11136
11137 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return a debugging
11138 entry that chains various modifiers in front of the given type. */
11139
11140 static dw_die_ref
11141 modified_type_die (tree type, int cv_quals, dw_die_ref context_die)
11142 {
11143 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
11144 dw_die_ref mod_type_die;
11145 dw_die_ref sub_die = NULL;
11146 tree item_type = NULL;
11147 tree qualified_type;
11148 tree name, low, high;
11149 dw_die_ref mod_scope;
11150 /* Only these cv-qualifiers are currently handled. */
11151 const int cv_qual_mask = (TYPE_QUAL_CONST | TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE
11152 | TYPE_QUAL_RESTRICT | TYPE_QUAL_ATOMIC);
11153
11154 if (code == ERROR_MARK)
11155 return NULL;
11156
11157 if (lang_hooks.types.get_debug_type)
11158 {
11159 tree debug_type = lang_hooks.types.get_debug_type (type);
11160
11161 if (debug_type != NULL_TREE && debug_type != type)
11162 return modified_type_die (debug_type, cv_quals, context_die);
11163 }
11164
11165 cv_quals &= cv_qual_mask;
11166
11167 /* Don't emit DW_TAG_restrict_type for DWARFv2, since it is a type
11168 tag modifier (and not an attribute) old consumers won't be able
11169 to handle it. */
11170 if (dwarf_version < 3)
11171 cv_quals &= ~TYPE_QUAL_RESTRICT;
11172
11173 /* Likewise for DW_TAG_atomic_type for DWARFv5. */
11174 if (dwarf_version < 5)
11175 cv_quals &= ~TYPE_QUAL_ATOMIC;
11176
11177 /* See if we already have the appropriately qualified variant of
11178 this type. */
11179 qualified_type = get_qualified_type (type, cv_quals);
11180
11181 if (qualified_type == sizetype
11182 && TYPE_NAME (qualified_type)
11183 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (qualified_type)) == TYPE_DECL)
11184 {
11185 tree t = TREE_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (qualified_type));
11186
11187 gcc_checking_assert (TREE_CODE (t) == INTEGER_TYPE
11188 && TYPE_PRECISION (t)
11189 == TYPE_PRECISION (qualified_type)
11190 && TYPE_UNSIGNED (t)
11191 == TYPE_UNSIGNED (qualified_type));
11192 qualified_type = t;
11193 }
11194
11195 /* If we do, then we can just use its DIE, if it exists. */
11196 if (qualified_type)
11197 {
11198 mod_type_die = lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
11199 if (mod_type_die)
11200 return mod_type_die;
11201 }
11202
11203 name = qualified_type ? TYPE_NAME (qualified_type) : NULL;
11204
11205 /* Handle C typedef types. */
11206 if (name && TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name)
11207 && !DECL_ARTIFICIAL (name))
11208 {
11209 tree dtype = TREE_TYPE (name);
11210
11211 if (qualified_type == dtype)
11212 {
11213 /* For a named type, use the typedef. */
11214 gen_type_die (qualified_type, context_die);
11215 return lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
11216 }
11217 else
11218 {
11219 int dquals = TYPE_QUALS_NO_ADDR_SPACE (dtype);
11220 dquals &= cv_qual_mask;
11221 if ((dquals & ~cv_quals) != TYPE_UNQUALIFIED
11222 || (cv_quals == dquals && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name) != type))
11223 /* cv-unqualified version of named type. Just use
11224 the unnamed type to which it refers. */
11225 return modified_type_die (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name),
11226 cv_quals, context_die);
11227 /* Else cv-qualified version of named type; fall through. */
11228 }
11229 }
11230
11231 mod_scope = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
11232
11233 if (cv_quals)
11234 {
11235 struct qual_info { int q; enum dwarf_tag t; };
11236 static const struct qual_info qual_info[] =
11237 {
11238 { TYPE_QUAL_ATOMIC, DW_TAG_atomic_type },
11239 { TYPE_QUAL_RESTRICT, DW_TAG_restrict_type },
11240 { TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE, DW_TAG_volatile_type },
11241 { TYPE_QUAL_CONST, DW_TAG_const_type },
11242 };
11243 int sub_quals;
11244 unsigned i;
11245
11246 /* Determine a lesser qualified type that most closely matches
11247 this one. Then generate DW_TAG_* entries for the remaining
11248 qualifiers. */
11249 sub_quals = get_nearest_type_subqualifiers (type, cv_quals,
11250 cv_qual_mask);
11251 mod_type_die = modified_type_die (type, sub_quals, context_die);
11252
11253 for (i = 0; i < sizeof (qual_info) / sizeof (qual_info[0]); i++)
11254 if (qual_info[i].q & cv_quals & ~sub_quals)
11255 {
11256 dw_die_ref d = new_die (qual_info[i].t, mod_scope, type);
11257 if (mod_type_die)
11258 add_AT_die_ref (d, DW_AT_type, mod_type_die);
11259 mod_type_die = d;
11260 }
11261 }
11262 else if (code == POINTER_TYPE || code == REFERENCE_TYPE)
11263 {
11264 dwarf_tag tag = DW_TAG_pointer_type;
11265 if (code == REFERENCE_TYPE)
11266 {
11267 if (TYPE_REF_IS_RVALUE (type) && dwarf_version >= 4)
11268 tag = DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type;
11269 else
11270 tag = DW_TAG_reference_type;
11271 }
11272 mod_type_die = new_die (tag, mod_scope, type);
11273
11274 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size,
11275 simple_type_size_in_bits (type) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
11276 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
11277
11278 addr_space_t as = TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (item_type);
11279 if (!ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC_P (as))
11280 {
11281 int action = targetm.addr_space.debug (as);
11282 if (action >= 0)
11283 {
11284 /* Positive values indicate an address_class. */
11285 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_address_class, action);
11286 }
11287 else
11288 {
11289 /* Negative values indicate an (inverted) segment base reg. */
11290 dw_loc_descr_ref d
11291 = one_reg_loc_descriptor (~action, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
11292 add_AT_loc (mod_type_die, DW_AT_segment, d);
11293 }
11294 }
11295 }
11296 else if (code == INTEGER_TYPE
11297 && TREE_TYPE (type) != NULL_TREE
11298 && subrange_type_for_debug_p (type, &low, &high))
11299 {
11300 tree bias = NULL_TREE;
11301 if (lang_hooks.types.get_type_bias)
11302 bias = lang_hooks.types.get_type_bias (type);
11303 mod_type_die = subrange_type_die (type, low, high, bias, context_die);
11304 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
11305 }
11306 else if (is_base_type (type))
11307 mod_type_die = base_type_die (type);
11308 else
11309 {
11310 gen_type_die (type, context_die);
11311
11312 /* We have to get the type_main_variant here (and pass that to the
11313 `lookup_type_die' routine) because the ..._TYPE node we have
11314 might simply be a *copy* of some original type node (where the
11315 copy was created to help us keep track of typedef names) and
11316 that copy might have a different TYPE_UID from the original
11317 ..._TYPE node. */
11318 if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE)
11319 return lookup_type_die (type_main_variant (type));
11320 else
11321 /* Vectors have the debugging information in the type,
11322 not the main variant. */
11323 return lookup_type_die (type);
11324 }
11325
11326 /* Builtin types don't have a DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE. For those,
11327 don't output a DW_TAG_typedef, since there isn't one in the
11328 user's program; just attach a DW_AT_name to the type.
11329 Don't attach a DW_AT_name to DW_TAG_const_type or DW_TAG_volatile_type
11330 if the base type already has the same name. */
11331 if (name
11332 && ((TREE_CODE (name) != TYPE_DECL
11333 && (qualified_type == TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type)
11334 || (cv_quals == TYPE_UNQUALIFIED)))
11335 || (TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL
11336 && TREE_TYPE (name) == qualified_type
11337 && DECL_NAME (name))))
11338 {
11339 if (TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL)
11340 /* Could just call add_name_and_src_coords_attributes here,
11341 but since this is a builtin type it doesn't have any
11342 useful source coordinates anyway. */
11343 name = DECL_NAME (name);
11344 add_name_attribute (mod_type_die, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
11345 }
11346 /* This probably indicates a bug. */
11347 else if (mod_type_die && mod_type_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type)
11348 {
11349 name = TYPE_IDENTIFIER (type);
11350 add_name_attribute (mod_type_die,
11351 name ? IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name) : "__unknown__");
11352 }
11353
11354 if (qualified_type)
11355 equate_type_number_to_die (qualified_type, mod_type_die);
11356
11357 if (item_type)
11358 /* We must do this after the equate_type_number_to_die call, in case
11359 this is a recursive type. This ensures that the modified_type_die
11360 recursion will terminate even if the type is recursive. Recursive
11361 types are possible in Ada. */
11362 sub_die = modified_type_die (item_type,
11363 TYPE_QUALS_NO_ADDR_SPACE (item_type),
11364 context_die);
11365
11366 if (sub_die != NULL)
11367 add_AT_die_ref (mod_type_die, DW_AT_type, sub_die);
11368
11369 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (mod_type_die, type, context_die);
11370 if (TYPE_ARTIFICIAL (type))
11371 add_AT_flag (mod_type_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
11372
11373 return mod_type_die;
11374 }
11375
11376 /* Generate DIEs for the generic parameters of T.
11377 T must be either a generic type or a generic function.
11378 See http://gcc.gnu.org/wiki/TemplateParmsDwarf for more. */
11379
11380 static void
11381 gen_generic_params_dies (tree t)
11382 {
11383 tree parms, args;
11384 int parms_num, i;
11385 dw_die_ref die = NULL;
11386 int non_default;
11387
11388 if (!t || (TYPE_P (t) && !COMPLETE_TYPE_P (t)))
11389 return;
11390
11391 if (TYPE_P (t))
11392 die = lookup_type_die (t);
11393 else if (DECL_P (t))
11394 die = lookup_decl_die (t);
11395
11396 gcc_assert (die);
11397
11398 parms = lang_hooks.get_innermost_generic_parms (t);
11399 if (!parms)
11400 /* T has no generic parameter. It means T is neither a generic type
11401 or function. End of story. */
11402 return;
11403
11404 parms_num = TREE_VEC_LENGTH (parms);
11405 args = lang_hooks.get_innermost_generic_args (t);
11406 if (TREE_CHAIN (args) && TREE_CODE (TREE_CHAIN (args)) == INTEGER_CST)
11407 non_default = int_cst_value (TREE_CHAIN (args));
11408 else
11409 non_default = TREE_VEC_LENGTH (args);
11410 for (i = 0; i < parms_num; i++)
11411 {
11412 tree parm, arg, arg_pack_elems;
11413 dw_die_ref parm_die;
11414
11415 parm = TREE_VEC_ELT (parms, i);
11416 arg = TREE_VEC_ELT (args, i);
11417 arg_pack_elems = lang_hooks.types.get_argument_pack_elems (arg);
11418 gcc_assert (parm && TREE_VALUE (parm) && arg);
11419
11420 if (parm && TREE_VALUE (parm) && arg)
11421 {
11422 /* If PARM represents a template parameter pack,
11423 emit a DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack DIE, followed
11424 by DW_TAG_template_*_parameter DIEs for the argument
11425 pack elements of ARG. Note that ARG would then be
11426 an argument pack. */
11427 if (arg_pack_elems)
11428 parm_die = template_parameter_pack_die (TREE_VALUE (parm),
11429 arg_pack_elems,
11430 die);
11431 else
11432 parm_die = generic_parameter_die (TREE_VALUE (parm), arg,
11433 true /* emit name */, die);
11434 if (i >= non_default)
11435 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_default_value, 1);
11436 }
11437 }
11438 }
11439
11440 /* Create and return a DIE for PARM which should be
11441 the representation of a generic type parameter.
11442 For instance, in the C++ front end, PARM would be a template parameter.
11443 ARG is the argument to PARM.
11444 EMIT_NAME_P if tree, the DIE will have DW_AT_name attribute set to the
11445 name of the PARM.
11446 PARENT_DIE is the parent DIE which the new created DIE should be added to,
11447 as a child node. */
11448
11449 static dw_die_ref
11450 generic_parameter_die (tree parm, tree arg,
11451 bool emit_name_p,
11452 dw_die_ref parent_die)
11453 {
11454 dw_die_ref tmpl_die = NULL;
11455 const char *name = NULL;
11456
11457 if (!parm || !DECL_NAME (parm) || !arg)
11458 return NULL;
11459
11460 /* We support non-type generic parameters and arguments,
11461 type generic parameters and arguments, as well as
11462 generic generic parameters (a.k.a. template template parameters in C++)
11463 and arguments. */
11464 if (TREE_CODE (parm) == PARM_DECL)
11465 /* PARM is a nontype generic parameter */
11466 tmpl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_template_value_param, parent_die, parm);
11467 else if (TREE_CODE (parm) == TYPE_DECL)
11468 /* PARM is a type generic parameter. */
11469 tmpl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_template_type_param, parent_die, parm);
11470 else if (lang_hooks.decls.generic_generic_parameter_decl_p (parm))
11471 /* PARM is a generic generic parameter.
11472 Its DIE is a GNU extension. It shall have a
11473 DW_AT_name attribute to represent the name of the template template
11474 parameter, and a DW_AT_GNU_template_name attribute to represent the
11475 name of the template template argument. */
11476 tmpl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_template_template_param,
11477 parent_die, parm);
11478 else
11479 gcc_unreachable ();
11480
11481 if (tmpl_die)
11482 {
11483 tree tmpl_type;
11484
11485 /* If PARM is a generic parameter pack, it means we are
11486 emitting debug info for a template argument pack element.
11487 In other terms, ARG is a template argument pack element.
11488 In that case, we don't emit any DW_AT_name attribute for
11489 the die. */
11490 if (emit_name_p)
11491 {
11492 name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (parm));
11493 gcc_assert (name);
11494 add_AT_string (tmpl_die, DW_AT_name, name);
11495 }
11496
11497 if (!lang_hooks.decls.generic_generic_parameter_decl_p (parm))
11498 {
11499 /* DWARF3, 5.6.8 says if PARM is a non-type generic parameter
11500 TMPL_DIE should have a child DW_AT_type attribute that is set
11501 to the type of the argument to PARM, which is ARG.
11502 If PARM is a type generic parameter, TMPL_DIE should have a
11503 child DW_AT_type that is set to ARG. */
11504 tmpl_type = TYPE_P (arg) ? arg : TREE_TYPE (arg);
11505 add_type_attribute (tmpl_die, tmpl_type,
11506 (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (tmpl_type)
11507 ? TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE : TYPE_UNQUALIFIED),
11508 parent_die);
11509 }
11510 else
11511 {
11512 /* So TMPL_DIE is a DIE representing a
11513 a generic generic template parameter, a.k.a template template
11514 parameter in C++ and arg is a template. */
11515
11516 /* The DW_AT_GNU_template_name attribute of the DIE must be set
11517 to the name of the argument. */
11518 name = dwarf2_name (TYPE_P (arg) ? TYPE_NAME (arg) : arg, 1);
11519 if (name)
11520 add_AT_string (tmpl_die, DW_AT_GNU_template_name, name);
11521 }
11522
11523 if (TREE_CODE (parm) == PARM_DECL)
11524 /* So PARM is a non-type generic parameter.
11525 DWARF3 5.6.8 says we must set a DW_AT_const_value child
11526 attribute of TMPL_DIE which value represents the value
11527 of ARG.
11528 We must be careful here:
11529 The value of ARG might reference some function decls.
11530 We might currently be emitting debug info for a generic
11531 type and types are emitted before function decls, we don't
11532 know if the function decls referenced by ARG will actually be
11533 emitted after cgraph computations.
11534 So must defer the generation of the DW_AT_const_value to
11535 after cgraph is ready. */
11536 append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table (tmpl_die, arg);
11537 }
11538
11539 return tmpl_die;
11540 }
11541
11542 /* Generate and return a DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack DIE representing.
11543 PARM_PACK must be a template parameter pack. The returned DIE
11544 will be child DIE of PARENT_DIE. */
11545
11546 static dw_die_ref
11547 template_parameter_pack_die (tree parm_pack,
11548 tree parm_pack_args,
11549 dw_die_ref parent_die)
11550 {
11551 dw_die_ref die;
11552 int j;
11553
11554 gcc_assert (parent_die && parm_pack);
11555
11556 die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack, parent_die, parm_pack);
11557 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (die, parm_pack);
11558 for (j = 0; j < TREE_VEC_LENGTH (parm_pack_args); j++)
11559 generic_parameter_die (parm_pack,
11560 TREE_VEC_ELT (parm_pack_args, j),
11561 false /* Don't emit DW_AT_name */,
11562 die);
11563 return die;
11564 }
11565
11566 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return true if it is
11567 an enumerated type. */
11568
11569 static inline int
11570 type_is_enum (const_tree type)
11571 {
11572 return TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE;
11573 }
11574
11575 /* Return the DBX register number described by a given RTL node. */
11576
11577 static unsigned int
11578 dbx_reg_number (const_rtx rtl)
11579 {
11580 unsigned regno = REGNO (rtl);
11581
11582 gcc_assert (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
11583
11584 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
11585 if (crtl->uses_only_leaf_regs)
11586 {
11587 int leaf_reg = LEAF_REG_REMAP (regno);
11588 if (leaf_reg != -1)
11589 regno = (unsigned) leaf_reg;
11590 }
11591 #endif
11592
11593 regno = DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (regno);
11594 gcc_assert (regno != INVALID_REGNUM);
11595 return regno;
11596 }
11597
11598 /* Optionally add a DW_OP_piece term to a location description expression.
11599 DW_OP_piece is only added if the location description expression already
11600 doesn't end with DW_OP_piece. */
11601
11602 static void
11603 add_loc_descr_op_piece (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, int size)
11604 {
11605 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
11606
11607 if (*list_head != NULL)
11608 {
11609 /* Find the end of the chain. */
11610 for (loc = *list_head; loc->dw_loc_next != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
11611 ;
11612
11613 if (loc->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_piece)
11614 loc->dw_loc_next = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, size, 0);
11615 }
11616 }
11617
11618 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register or
11619 zero if there is none. */
11620
11621 static dw_loc_descr_ref
11622 reg_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, enum var_init_status initialized)
11623 {
11624 rtx regs;
11625
11626 if (REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
11627 return 0;
11628
11629 /* We only use "frame base" when we're sure we're talking about the
11630 post-prologue local stack frame. We do this by *not* running
11631 register elimination until this point, and recognizing the special
11632 argument pointer and soft frame pointer rtx's.
11633 Use DW_OP_fbreg offset DW_OP_stack_value in this case. */
11634 if ((rtl == arg_pointer_rtx || rtl == frame_pointer_rtx)
11635 && eliminate_regs (rtl, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX) != rtl)
11636 {
11637 dw_loc_descr_ref result = NULL;
11638
11639 if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
11640 {
11641 result = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, GET_MODE (rtl), VOIDmode,
11642 initialized);
11643 if (result)
11644 add_loc_descr (&result,
11645 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
11646 }
11647 return result;
11648 }
11649
11650 regs = targetm.dwarf_register_span (rtl);
11651
11652 if (REG_NREGS (rtl) > 1 || regs)
11653 return multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtl, regs, initialized);
11654 else
11655 {
11656 unsigned int dbx_regnum = dbx_reg_number (rtl);
11657 if (dbx_regnum == IGNORED_DWARF_REGNUM)
11658 return 0;
11659 return one_reg_loc_descriptor (dbx_regnum, initialized);
11660 }
11661 }
11662
11663 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register for
11664 a given hard register number. */
11665
11666 static dw_loc_descr_ref
11667 one_reg_loc_descriptor (unsigned int regno, enum var_init_status initialized)
11668 {
11669 dw_loc_descr_ref reg_loc_descr;
11670
11671 if (regno <= 31)
11672 reg_loc_descr
11673 = new_loc_descr ((enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_reg0 + regno), 0, 0);
11674 else
11675 reg_loc_descr = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx, regno, 0);
11676
11677 if (initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
11678 add_loc_descr (&reg_loc_descr, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
11679
11680 return reg_loc_descr;
11681 }
11682
11683 /* Given an RTL of a register, return a location descriptor that
11684 designates a value that spans more than one register. */
11685
11686 static dw_loc_descr_ref
11687 multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, rtx regs,
11688 enum var_init_status initialized)
11689 {
11690 int size, i;
11691 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
11692
11693 /* Simple, contiguous registers. */
11694 if (regs == NULL_RTX)
11695 {
11696 unsigned reg = REGNO (rtl);
11697 int nregs;
11698
11699 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
11700 if (crtl->uses_only_leaf_regs)
11701 {
11702 int leaf_reg = LEAF_REG_REMAP (reg);
11703 if (leaf_reg != -1)
11704 reg = (unsigned) leaf_reg;
11705 }
11706 #endif
11707
11708 gcc_assert ((unsigned) DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (reg) == dbx_reg_number (rtl));
11709 nregs = REG_NREGS (rtl);
11710
11711 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) / nregs;
11712
11713 loc_result = NULL;
11714 while (nregs--)
11715 {
11716 dw_loc_descr_ref t;
11717
11718 t = one_reg_loc_descriptor (DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (reg),
11719 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
11720 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, t);
11721 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, size);
11722 ++reg;
11723 }
11724 return loc_result;
11725 }
11726
11727 /* Now onto stupid register sets in non contiguous locations. */
11728
11729 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (regs) == PARALLEL);
11730
11731 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XVECEXP (regs, 0, 0)));
11732 loc_result = NULL;
11733
11734 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (regs, 0); ++i)
11735 {
11736 dw_loc_descr_ref t;
11737
11738 t = one_reg_loc_descriptor (dbx_reg_number (XVECEXP (regs, 0, i)),
11739 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
11740 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, t);
11741 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, size);
11742 }
11743
11744 if (loc_result && initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
11745 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
11746 return loc_result;
11747 }
11748
11749 static unsigned long size_of_int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT);
11750
11751 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a constant i,
11752 as a compound operation from constant (i >> shift), constant shift
11753 and DW_OP_shl. */
11754
11755 static dw_loc_descr_ref
11756 int_shift_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT i, int shift)
11757 {
11758 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = int_loc_descriptor (i >> shift);
11759 add_loc_descr (&ret, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
11760 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
11761 return ret;
11762 }
11763
11764 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a constant. */
11765
11766 static dw_loc_descr_ref
11767 int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT i)
11768 {
11769 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
11770
11771 /* Pick the smallest representation of a constant, rather than just
11772 defaulting to the LEB encoding. */
11773 if (i >= 0)
11774 {
11775 int clz = clz_hwi (i);
11776 int ctz = ctz_hwi (i);
11777 if (i <= 31)
11778 op = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_lit0 + i);
11779 else if (i <= 0xff)
11780 op = DW_OP_const1u;
11781 else if (i <= 0xffff)
11782 op = DW_OP_const2u;
11783 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 5
11784 && clz + 5 + 255 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
11785 /* DW_OP_litX DW_OP_litY DW_OP_shl takes just 3 bytes and
11786 DW_OP_litX DW_OP_const1u Y DW_OP_shl takes just 4 bytes,
11787 while DW_OP_const4u is 5 bytes. */
11788 return int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - clz - 5);
11789 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 8
11790 && clz + 8 + 31 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
11791 /* DW_OP_const1u X DW_OP_litY DW_OP_shl takes just 4 bytes,
11792 while DW_OP_const4u is 5 bytes. */
11793 return int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - clz - 8);
11794 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32 || i <= 0xffffffff)
11795 op = DW_OP_const4u;
11796 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 8
11797 && clz + 8 + 255 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
11798 /* DW_OP_const1u X DW_OP_const1u Y DW_OP_shl takes just 5 bytes,
11799 while DW_OP_constu of constant >= 0x100000000 takes at least
11800 6 bytes. */
11801 return int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - clz - 8);
11802 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 16
11803 && clz + 16 + (size_of_uleb128 (i) > 5 ? 255 : 31)
11804 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
11805 /* DW_OP_const2u X DW_OP_litY DW_OP_shl takes just 5 bytes,
11806 DW_OP_const2u X DW_OP_const1u Y DW_OP_shl takes 6 bytes,
11807 while DW_OP_constu takes in this case at least 6 bytes. */
11808 return int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - clz - 16);
11809 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 32
11810 && clz + 32 + 31 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
11811 && size_of_uleb128 (i) > 6)
11812 /* DW_OP_const4u X DW_OP_litY DW_OP_shl takes just 7 bytes. */
11813 return int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - clz - 32);
11814 else
11815 op = DW_OP_constu;
11816 }
11817 else
11818 {
11819 if (i >= -0x80)
11820 op = DW_OP_const1s;
11821 else if (i >= -0x8000)
11822 op = DW_OP_const2s;
11823 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32 || i >= -0x80000000)
11824 {
11825 if (size_of_int_loc_descriptor (i) < 5)
11826 {
11827 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = int_loc_descriptor (-i);
11828 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_neg, 0, 0));
11829 return ret;
11830 }
11831 op = DW_OP_const4s;
11832 }
11833 else
11834 {
11835 if (size_of_int_loc_descriptor (i)
11836 < (unsigned long) 1 + size_of_sleb128 (i))
11837 {
11838 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = int_loc_descriptor (-i);
11839 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_neg, 0, 0));
11840 return ret;
11841 }
11842 op = DW_OP_consts;
11843 }
11844 }
11845
11846 return new_loc_descr (op, i, 0);
11847 }
11848
11849 /* Likewise, for unsigned constants. */
11850
11851 static dw_loc_descr_ref
11852 uint_loc_descriptor (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT i)
11853 {
11854 const unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT max_int = INTTYPE_MAXIMUM (HOST_WIDE_INT);
11855 const unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT max_uint
11856 = INTTYPE_MAXIMUM (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
11857
11858 /* If possible, use the clever signed constants handling. */
11859 if (i <= max_int)
11860 return int_loc_descriptor ((HOST_WIDE_INT) i);
11861
11862 /* Here, we are left with positive numbers that cannot be represented as
11863 HOST_WIDE_INT, i.e.:
11864 max (HOST_WIDE_INT) < i <= max (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT)
11865
11866 Using DW_OP_const4/8/./u operation to encode them consumes a lot of bytes
11867 whereas may be better to output a negative integer: thanks to integer
11868 wrapping, we know that:
11869 x = x - 2 ** DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
11870 = x - 2 * (max (HOST_WIDE_INT) + 1)
11871 So numbers close to max (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) could be represented as
11872 small negative integers. Let's try that in cases it will clearly improve
11873 the encoding: there is no gain turning DW_OP_const4u into
11874 DW_OP_const4s. */
11875 if (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 8 == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
11876 && ((DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE == 4 && i > max_uint - 0x8000)
11877 || (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE == 8 && i > max_uint - 0x80000000)))
11878 {
11879 const unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first_shift = i - max_int - 1;
11880
11881 /* Now, -1 < first_shift <= max (HOST_WIDE_INT)
11882 i.e. 0 <= first_shift <= max (HOST_WIDE_INT). */
11883 const HOST_WIDE_INT second_shift
11884 = (HOST_WIDE_INT) first_shift - (HOST_WIDE_INT) max_int - 1;
11885
11886 /* So we finally have:
11887 -max (HOST_WIDE_INT) - 1 <= second_shift <= -1.
11888 i.e. min (HOST_WIDE_INT) <= second_shift < 0. */
11889 return int_loc_descriptor (second_shift);
11890 }
11891
11892 /* Last chance: fallback to a simple constant operation. */
11893 return new_loc_descr
11894 ((HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32 || i <= 0xffffffff)
11895 ? DW_OP_const4u
11896 : DW_OP_const8u,
11897 i, 0);
11898 }
11899
11900 /* Generate and return a location description that computes the unsigned
11901 comparison of the two stack top entries (a OP b where b is the top-most
11902 entry and a is the second one). The KIND of comparison can be LT_EXPR,
11903 LE_EXPR, GT_EXPR or GE_EXPR. */
11904
11905 static dw_loc_descr_ref
11906 uint_comparison_loc_list (enum tree_code kind)
11907 {
11908 enum dwarf_location_atom op, flip_op;
11909 dw_loc_descr_ref ret, bra_node, jmp_node, tmp;
11910
11911 switch (kind)
11912 {
11913 case LT_EXPR:
11914 op = DW_OP_lt;
11915 break;
11916 case LE_EXPR:
11917 op = DW_OP_le;
11918 break;
11919 case GT_EXPR:
11920 op = DW_OP_gt;
11921 break;
11922 case GE_EXPR:
11923 op = DW_OP_ge;
11924 break;
11925 default:
11926 gcc_unreachable ();
11927 }
11928
11929 bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
11930 jmp_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
11931
11932 /* Until DWARFv4, operations all work on signed integers. It is nevertheless
11933 possible to perform unsigned comparisons: we just have to distinguish
11934 three cases:
11935
11936 1. when a and b have the same sign (as signed integers); then we should
11937 return: a OP(signed) b;
11938
11939 2. when a is a negative signed integer while b is a positive one, then a
11940 is a greater unsigned integer than b; likewise when a and b's roles
11941 are flipped.
11942
11943 So first, compare the sign of the two operands. */
11944 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0);
11945 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
11946 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_xor, 0, 0));
11947 /* If they have different signs (i.e. they have different sign bits), then
11948 the stack top value has now the sign bit set and thus it's smaller than
11949 zero. */
11950 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_lit0, 0, 0));
11951 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_lt, 0, 0));
11952 add_loc_descr (&ret, bra_node);
11953
11954 /* We are in case 1. At this point, we know both operands have the same
11955 sign, to it's safe to use the built-in signed comparison. */
11956 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
11957 add_loc_descr (&ret, jmp_node);
11958
11959 /* We are in case 2. Here, we know both operands do not have the same sign,
11960 so we have to flip the signed comparison. */
11961 flip_op = (kind == LT_EXPR || kind == LE_EXPR) ? DW_OP_gt : DW_OP_lt;
11962 tmp = new_loc_descr (flip_op, 0, 0);
11963 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
11964 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = tmp;
11965 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
11966
11967 /* This dummy operation is necessary to make the two branches join. */
11968 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_nop, 0, 0);
11969 jmp_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
11970 jmp_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = tmp;
11971 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
11972
11973 return ret;
11974 }
11975
11976 /* Likewise, but takes the location description lists (might be destructive on
11977 them). Return NULL if either is NULL or if concatenation fails. */
11978
11979 static dw_loc_list_ref
11980 loc_list_from_uint_comparison (dw_loc_list_ref left, dw_loc_list_ref right,
11981 enum tree_code kind)
11982 {
11983 if (left == NULL || right == NULL)
11984 return NULL;
11985
11986 add_loc_list (&left, right);
11987 if (left == NULL)
11988 return NULL;
11989
11990 add_loc_descr_to_each (left, uint_comparison_loc_list (kind));
11991 return left;
11992 }
11993
11994 /* Return size_of_locs (int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, shift))
11995 without actually allocating it. */
11996
11997 static unsigned long
11998 size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT i, int shift)
11999 {
12000 return size_of_int_loc_descriptor (i >> shift)
12001 + size_of_int_loc_descriptor (shift)
12002 + 1;
12003 }
12004
12005 /* Return size_of_locs (int_loc_descriptor (i)) without
12006 actually allocating it. */
12007
12008 static unsigned long
12009 size_of_int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT i)
12010 {
12011 unsigned long s;
12012
12013 if (i >= 0)
12014 {
12015 int clz, ctz;
12016 if (i <= 31)
12017 return 1;
12018 else if (i <= 0xff)
12019 return 2;
12020 else if (i <= 0xffff)
12021 return 3;
12022 clz = clz_hwi (i);
12023 ctz = ctz_hwi (i);
12024 if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 5
12025 && clz + 5 + 255 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
12026 return size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
12027 - clz - 5);
12028 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 8
12029 && clz + 8 + 31 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
12030 return size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
12031 - clz - 8);
12032 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32 || i <= 0xffffffff)
12033 return 5;
12034 s = size_of_uleb128 ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) i);
12035 if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 8
12036 && clz + 8 + 255 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
12037 return size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
12038 - clz - 8);
12039 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 16
12040 && clz + 16 + (s > 5 ? 255 : 31) >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
12041 return size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
12042 - clz - 16);
12043 else if (clz + ctz >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 32
12044 && clz + 32 + 31 >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
12045 && s > 6)
12046 return size_of_int_shift_loc_descriptor (i, HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
12047 - clz - 32);
12048 else
12049 return 1 + s;
12050 }
12051 else
12052 {
12053 if (i >= -0x80)
12054 return 2;
12055 else if (i >= -0x8000)
12056 return 3;
12057 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32 || i >= -0x80000000)
12058 {
12059 if (-(unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) i != (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) i)
12060 {
12061 s = size_of_int_loc_descriptor (-i) + 1;
12062 if (s < 5)
12063 return s;
12064 }
12065 return 5;
12066 }
12067 else
12068 {
12069 unsigned long r = 1 + size_of_sleb128 (i);
12070 if (-(unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) i != (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) i)
12071 {
12072 s = size_of_int_loc_descriptor (-i) + 1;
12073 if (s < r)
12074 return s;
12075 }
12076 return r;
12077 }
12078 }
12079 }
12080
12081 /* Return loc description representing "address" of integer value.
12082 This can appear only as toplevel expression. */
12083
12084 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12085 address_of_int_loc_descriptor (int size, HOST_WIDE_INT i)
12086 {
12087 int litsize;
12088 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
12089
12090 if (!(dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
12091 return NULL;
12092
12093 litsize = size_of_int_loc_descriptor (i);
12094 /* Determine if DW_OP_stack_value or DW_OP_implicit_value
12095 is more compact. For DW_OP_stack_value we need:
12096 litsize + 1 (DW_OP_stack_value)
12097 and for DW_OP_implicit_value:
12098 1 (DW_OP_implicit_value) + 1 (length) + size. */
12099 if ((int) DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE >= size && litsize + 1 <= 1 + 1 + size)
12100 {
12101 loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (i);
12102 add_loc_descr (&loc_result,
12103 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
12104 return loc_result;
12105 }
12106
12107 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value,
12108 size, 0);
12109 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
12110 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int = i;
12111 return loc_result;
12112 }
12113
12114 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a base+offset location. */
12115
12116 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12117 based_loc_descr (rtx reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset,
12118 enum var_init_status initialized)
12119 {
12120 unsigned int regno;
12121 dw_loc_descr_ref result;
12122 dw_fde_ref fde = cfun->fde;
12123
12124 /* We only use "frame base" when we're sure we're talking about the
12125 post-prologue local stack frame. We do this by *not* running
12126 register elimination until this point, and recognizing the special
12127 argument pointer and soft frame pointer rtx's. */
12128 if (reg == arg_pointer_rtx || reg == frame_pointer_rtx)
12129 {
12130 rtx elim = (ira_use_lra_p
12131 ? lra_eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX)
12132 : eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX));
12133
12134 if (elim != reg)
12135 {
12136 if (GET_CODE (elim) == PLUS)
12137 {
12138 offset += INTVAL (XEXP (elim, 1));
12139 elim = XEXP (elim, 0);
12140 }
12141 gcc_assert ((SUPPORTS_STACK_ALIGNMENT
12142 && (elim == hard_frame_pointer_rtx
12143 || elim == stack_pointer_rtx))
12144 || elim == (frame_pointer_needed
12145 ? hard_frame_pointer_rtx
12146 : stack_pointer_rtx));
12147
12148 /* If drap register is used to align stack, use frame
12149 pointer + offset to access stack variables. If stack
12150 is aligned without drap, use stack pointer + offset to
12151 access stack variables. */
12152 if (crtl->stack_realign_tried
12153 && reg == frame_pointer_rtx)
12154 {
12155 int base_reg
12156 = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM ((fde && fde->drap_reg != INVALID_REGNUM)
12157 ? HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
12158 : REGNO (elim));
12159 return new_reg_loc_descr (base_reg, offset);
12160 }
12161
12162 gcc_assert (frame_pointer_fb_offset_valid);
12163 offset += frame_pointer_fb_offset;
12164 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_fbreg, offset, 0);
12165 }
12166 }
12167
12168 regno = REGNO (reg);
12169 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
12170 if (crtl->uses_only_leaf_regs)
12171 {
12172 int leaf_reg = LEAF_REG_REMAP (regno);
12173 if (leaf_reg != -1)
12174 regno = (unsigned) leaf_reg;
12175 }
12176 #endif
12177 regno = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (regno);
12178
12179 if (!optimize && fde
12180 && (fde->drap_reg == regno || fde->vdrap_reg == regno))
12181 {
12182 /* Use cfa+offset to represent the location of arguments passed
12183 on the stack when drap is used to align stack.
12184 Only do this when not optimizing, for optimized code var-tracking
12185 is supposed to track where the arguments live and the register
12186 used as vdrap or drap in some spot might be used for something
12187 else in other part of the routine. */
12188 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_fbreg, offset, 0);
12189 }
12190
12191 if (regno <= 31)
12192 result = new_loc_descr ((enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_breg0 + regno),
12193 offset, 0);
12194 else
12195 result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, regno, offset);
12196
12197 if (initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
12198 add_loc_descr (&result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
12199
12200 return result;
12201 }
12202
12203 /* Return true if this RTL expression describes a base+offset calculation. */
12204
12205 static inline int
12206 is_based_loc (const_rtx rtl)
12207 {
12208 return (GET_CODE (rtl) == PLUS
12209 && ((REG_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
12210 && REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
12211 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))));
12212 }
12213
12214 /* Try to handle TLS MEMs, for which mem_loc_descriptor on XEXP (mem, 0)
12215 failed. */
12216
12217 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12218 tls_mem_loc_descriptor (rtx mem)
12219 {
12220 tree base;
12221 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result;
12222
12223 if (MEM_EXPR (mem) == NULL_TREE || !MEM_OFFSET_KNOWN_P (mem))
12224 return NULL;
12225
12226 base = get_base_address (MEM_EXPR (mem));
12227 if (base == NULL
12228 || TREE_CODE (base) != VAR_DECL
12229 || !DECL_THREAD_LOCAL_P (base))
12230 return NULL;
12231
12232 loc_result = loc_descriptor_from_tree (MEM_EXPR (mem), 1, NULL);
12233 if (loc_result == NULL)
12234 return NULL;
12235
12236 if (MEM_OFFSET (mem))
12237 loc_descr_plus_const (&loc_result, MEM_OFFSET (mem));
12238
12239 return loc_result;
12240 }
12241
12242 /* Output debug info about reason why we failed to expand expression as dwarf
12243 expression. */
12244
12245 static void
12246 expansion_failed (tree expr, rtx rtl, char const *reason)
12247 {
12248 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
12249 {
12250 fprintf (dump_file, "Failed to expand as dwarf: ");
12251 if (expr)
12252 print_generic_expr (dump_file, expr, dump_flags);
12253 if (rtl)
12254 {
12255 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
12256 print_rtl (dump_file, rtl);
12257 }
12258 fprintf (dump_file, "\nReason: %s\n", reason);
12259 }
12260 }
12261
12262 /* Helper function for const_ok_for_output. */
12263
12264 static bool
12265 const_ok_for_output_1 (rtx rtl)
12266 {
12267 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == UNSPEC)
12268 {
12269 /* If delegitimize_address couldn't do anything with the UNSPEC, assume
12270 we can't express it in the debug info. */
12271 /* Don't complain about TLS UNSPECs, those are just too hard to
12272 delegitimize. Note this could be a non-decl SYMBOL_REF such as
12273 one in a constant pool entry, so testing SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL
12274 rather than DECL_THREAD_LOCAL_P is not just an optimization. */
12275 if (flag_checking
12276 && (XVECLEN (rtl, 0) == 0
12277 || GET_CODE (XVECEXP (rtl, 0, 0)) != SYMBOL_REF
12278 || SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (XVECEXP (rtl, 0, 0)) == TLS_MODEL_NONE))
12279 inform (current_function_decl
12280 ? DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (current_function_decl)
12281 : UNKNOWN_LOCATION,
12282 #if NUM_UNSPEC_VALUES > 0
12283 "non-delegitimized UNSPEC %s (%d) found in variable location",
12284 ((XINT (rtl, 1) >= 0 && XINT (rtl, 1) < NUM_UNSPEC_VALUES)
12285 ? unspec_strings[XINT (rtl, 1)] : "unknown"),
12286 XINT (rtl, 1));
12287 #else
12288 "non-delegitimized UNSPEC %d found in variable location",
12289 XINT (rtl, 1));
12290 #endif
12291 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
12292 "UNSPEC hasn't been delegitimized.\n");
12293 return false;
12294 }
12295
12296 if (targetm.const_not_ok_for_debug_p (rtl))
12297 {
12298 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
12299 "Expression rejected for debug by the backend.\n");
12300 return false;
12301 }
12302
12303 /* FIXME: Refer to PR60655. It is possible for simplification
12304 of rtl expressions in var tracking to produce such expressions.
12305 We should really identify / validate expressions
12306 enclosed in CONST that can be handled by assemblers on various
12307 targets and only handle legitimate cases here. */
12308 if (GET_CODE (rtl) != SYMBOL_REF)
12309 {
12310 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == NOT)
12311 return false;
12312 return true;
12313 }
12314
12315 if (CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (rtl))
12316 {
12317 bool marked;
12318 get_pool_constant_mark (rtl, &marked);
12319 /* If all references to this pool constant were optimized away,
12320 it was not output and thus we can't represent it. */
12321 if (!marked)
12322 {
12323 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
12324 "Constant was removed from constant pool.\n");
12325 return false;
12326 }
12327 }
12328
12329 if (SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (rtl) != TLS_MODEL_NONE)
12330 return false;
12331
12332 /* Avoid references to external symbols in debug info, on several targets
12333 the linker might even refuse to link when linking a shared library,
12334 and in many other cases the relocations for .debug_info/.debug_loc are
12335 dropped, so the address becomes zero anyway. Hidden symbols, guaranteed
12336 to be defined within the same shared library or executable are fine. */
12337 if (SYMBOL_REF_EXTERNAL_P (rtl))
12338 {
12339 tree decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl);
12340
12341 if (decl == NULL || !targetm.binds_local_p (decl))
12342 {
12343 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
12344 "Symbol not defined in current TU.\n");
12345 return false;
12346 }
12347 }
12348
12349 return true;
12350 }
12351
12352 /* Return true if constant RTL can be emitted in DW_OP_addr or
12353 DW_AT_const_value. TLS SYMBOL_REFs, external SYMBOL_REFs or
12354 non-marked constant pool SYMBOL_REFs can't be referenced in it. */
12355
12356 static bool
12357 const_ok_for_output (rtx rtl)
12358 {
12359 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF)
12360 return const_ok_for_output_1 (rtl);
12361
12362 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST)
12363 {
12364 subrtx_var_iterator::array_type array;
12365 FOR_EACH_SUBRTX_VAR (iter, array, XEXP (rtl, 0), ALL)
12366 if (!const_ok_for_output_1 (*iter))
12367 return false;
12368 return true;
12369 }
12370
12371 return true;
12372 }
12373
12374 /* Return a reference to DW_TAG_base_type corresponding to MODE and UNSIGNEDP
12375 if possible, NULL otherwise. */
12376
12377 static dw_die_ref
12378 base_type_for_mode (machine_mode mode, bool unsignedp)
12379 {
12380 dw_die_ref type_die;
12381 tree type = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode (mode, unsignedp);
12382
12383 if (type == NULL)
12384 return NULL;
12385 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
12386 {
12387 case INTEGER_TYPE:
12388 case REAL_TYPE:
12389 break;
12390 default:
12391 return NULL;
12392 }
12393 type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
12394 if (!type_die)
12395 type_die = modified_type_die (type, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, comp_unit_die ());
12396 if (type_die == NULL || type_die->die_tag != DW_TAG_base_type)
12397 return NULL;
12398 return type_die;
12399 }
12400
12401 /* For OP descriptor assumed to be in unsigned MODE, convert it to a unsigned
12402 type matching MODE, or, if MODE is narrower than or as wide as
12403 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, untyped. Return NULL if the conversion is not
12404 possible. */
12405
12406 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12407 convert_descriptor_to_mode (machine_mode mode, dw_loc_descr_ref op)
12408 {
12409 machine_mode outer_mode = mode;
12410 dw_die_ref type_die;
12411 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
12412
12413 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
12414 {
12415 add_loc_descr (&op, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0));
12416 return op;
12417 }
12418 type_die = base_type_for_mode (outer_mode, 1);
12419 if (type_die == NULL)
12420 return NULL;
12421 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
12422 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
12423 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
12424 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
12425 add_loc_descr (&op, cvt);
12426 return op;
12427 }
12428
12429 /* Return location descriptor for comparison OP with operands OP0 and OP1. */
12430
12431 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12432 compare_loc_descriptor (enum dwarf_location_atom op, dw_loc_descr_ref op0,
12433 dw_loc_descr_ref op1)
12434 {
12435 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = op0;
12436 add_loc_descr (&ret, op1);
12437 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
12438 if (STORE_FLAG_VALUE != 1)
12439 {
12440 add_loc_descr (&ret, int_loc_descriptor (STORE_FLAG_VALUE));
12441 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_mul, 0, 0));
12442 }
12443 return ret;
12444 }
12445
12446 /* Return location descriptor for signed comparison OP RTL. */
12447
12448 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12449 scompare_loc_descriptor (enum dwarf_location_atom op, rtx rtl,
12450 machine_mode mem_mode)
12451 {
12452 machine_mode op_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0));
12453 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1;
12454 int shift;
12455
12456 if (op_mode == VOIDmode)
12457 op_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 1));
12458 if (op_mode == VOIDmode)
12459 return NULL;
12460
12461 if (dwarf_strict
12462 && (GET_MODE_CLASS (op_mode) != MODE_INT
12463 || GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE))
12464 return NULL;
12465
12466 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), op_mode, mem_mode,
12467 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12468 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), op_mode, mem_mode,
12469 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12470
12471 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL)
12472 return NULL;
12473
12474 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (op_mode) != MODE_INT
12475 || GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode) == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
12476 return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
12477
12478 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
12479 {
12480 dw_die_ref type_die = base_type_for_mode (op_mode, 0);
12481 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
12482
12483 if (type_die == NULL)
12484 return NULL;
12485 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
12486 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
12487 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
12488 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
12489 add_loc_descr (&op0, cvt);
12490 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
12491 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
12492 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
12493 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
12494 add_loc_descr (&op1, cvt);
12495 return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
12496 }
12497
12498 shift = (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE - GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode)) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
12499 /* For eq/ne, if the operands are known to be zero-extended,
12500 there is no need to do the fancy shifting up. */
12501 if (op == DW_OP_eq || op == DW_OP_ne)
12502 {
12503 dw_loc_descr_ref last0, last1;
12504 for (last0 = op0; last0->dw_loc_next != NULL; last0 = last0->dw_loc_next)
12505 ;
12506 for (last1 = op1; last1->dw_loc_next != NULL; last1 = last1->dw_loc_next)
12507 ;
12508 /* deref_size zero extends, and for constants we can check
12509 whether they are zero extended or not. */
12510 if (((last0->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_deref_size
12511 && last0->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int <= GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode))
12512 || (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
12513 && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 0))
12514 == (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 0)) & GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode))))
12515 && ((last1->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_deref_size
12516 && last1->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int <= GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode))
12517 || (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1))
12518 && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1))
12519 == (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) & GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode)))))
12520 return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
12521
12522 /* EQ/NE comparison against constant in narrower type than
12523 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE can be performed either as
12524 DW_OP_const1u <shift> DW_OP_shl DW_OP_const* <cst << shift>
12525 DW_OP_{eq,ne}
12526 or
12527 DW_OP_const*u <mode_mask> DW_OP_and DW_OP_const* <cst & mode_mask>
12528 DW_OP_{eq,ne}. Pick whatever is shorter. */
12529 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1))
12530 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (op_mode) < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
12531 && (size_of_int_loc_descriptor (shift) + 1
12532 + size_of_int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) << shift)
12533 >= size_of_int_loc_descriptor (GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode)) + 1
12534 + size_of_int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1))
12535 & GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode))))
12536 {
12537 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode)));
12538 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
12539 op1 = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1))
12540 & GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode));
12541 return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
12542 }
12543 }
12544 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
12545 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
12546 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
12547 op1 = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) << shift);
12548 else
12549 {
12550 add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
12551 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
12552 }
12553 return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
12554 }
12555
12556 /* Return location descriptor for unsigned comparison OP RTL. */
12557
12558 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12559 ucompare_loc_descriptor (enum dwarf_location_atom op, rtx rtl,
12560 machine_mode mem_mode)
12561 {
12562 machine_mode op_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0));
12563 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1;
12564
12565 if (op_mode == VOIDmode)
12566 op_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 1));
12567 if (op_mode == VOIDmode)
12568 return NULL;
12569 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (op_mode) != MODE_INT)
12570 return NULL;
12571
12572 if (dwarf_strict && GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
12573 return NULL;
12574
12575 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), op_mode, mem_mode,
12576 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12577 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), op_mode, mem_mode,
12578 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12579
12580 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL)
12581 return NULL;
12582
12583 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
12584 {
12585 HOST_WIDE_INT mask = GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode);
12586 dw_loc_descr_ref last0, last1;
12587 for (last0 = op0; last0->dw_loc_next != NULL; last0 = last0->dw_loc_next)
12588 ;
12589 for (last1 = op1; last1->dw_loc_next != NULL; last1 = last1->dw_loc_next)
12590 ;
12591 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
12592 op0 = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 0)) & mask);
12593 /* deref_size zero extends, so no need to mask it again. */
12594 else if (last0->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_deref_size
12595 || last0->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int > GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode))
12596 {
12597 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
12598 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
12599 }
12600 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
12601 op1 = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) & mask);
12602 /* deref_size zero extends, so no need to mask it again. */
12603 else if (last1->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_deref_size
12604 || last1->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int > GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode))
12605 {
12606 add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
12607 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
12608 }
12609 }
12610 else if (GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode) == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
12611 {
12612 HOST_WIDE_INT bias = 1;
12613 bias <<= (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * BITS_PER_UNIT - 1);
12614 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bias, 0));
12615 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
12616 op1 = int_loc_descriptor ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) bias
12617 + INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
12618 else
12619 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
12620 bias, 0));
12621 }
12622 return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
12623 }
12624
12625 /* Return location descriptor for {U,S}{MIN,MAX}. */
12626
12627 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12628 minmax_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, machine_mode mode,
12629 machine_mode mem_mode)
12630 {
12631 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
12632 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1, ret;
12633 dw_loc_descr_ref bra_node, drop_node;
12634
12635 if (dwarf_strict
12636 && (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT
12637 || GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE))
12638 return NULL;
12639
12640 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
12641 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12642 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
12643 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12644
12645 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL)
12646 return NULL;
12647
12648 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0));
12649 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
12650 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
12651 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == UMIN || GET_CODE (rtl) == UMAX)
12652 {
12653 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
12654 {
12655 HOST_WIDE_INT mask = GET_MODE_MASK (mode);
12656 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
12657 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
12658 add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
12659 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
12660 }
12661 else if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
12662 {
12663 HOST_WIDE_INT bias = 1;
12664 bias <<= (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * BITS_PER_UNIT - 1);
12665 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bias, 0));
12666 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bias, 0));
12667 }
12668 }
12669 else if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
12670 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
12671 {
12672 int shift = (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE - GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
12673 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
12674 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
12675 add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
12676 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
12677 }
12678 else if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
12679 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
12680 {
12681 dw_die_ref type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode, 0);
12682 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
12683 if (type_die == NULL)
12684 return NULL;
12685 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
12686 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
12687 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
12688 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
12689 add_loc_descr (&op0, cvt);
12690 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
12691 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
12692 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
12693 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
12694 add_loc_descr (&op1, cvt);
12695 }
12696
12697 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SMIN || GET_CODE (rtl) == UMIN)
12698 op = DW_OP_lt;
12699 else
12700 op = DW_OP_gt;
12701 ret = op0;
12702 add_loc_descr (&ret, op1);
12703 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
12704 bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
12705 add_loc_descr (&ret, bra_node);
12706 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
12707 drop_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
12708 add_loc_descr (&ret, drop_node);
12709 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
12710 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = drop_node;
12711 if ((GET_CODE (rtl) == SMIN || GET_CODE (rtl) == SMAX)
12712 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
12713 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
12714 ret = convert_descriptor_to_mode (mode, ret);
12715 return ret;
12716 }
12717
12718 /* Helper function for mem_loc_descriptor. Perform OP binary op,
12719 but after converting arguments to type_die, afterwards
12720 convert back to unsigned. */
12721
12722 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12723 typed_binop (enum dwarf_location_atom op, rtx rtl, dw_die_ref type_die,
12724 machine_mode mode, machine_mode mem_mode)
12725 {
12726 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt, op0, op1;
12727
12728 if (type_die == NULL)
12729 return NULL;
12730 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
12731 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12732 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
12733 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12734 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL)
12735 return NULL;
12736 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
12737 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
12738 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
12739 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
12740 add_loc_descr (&op0, cvt);
12741 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
12742 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
12743 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
12744 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
12745 add_loc_descr (&op1, cvt);
12746 add_loc_descr (&op0, op1);
12747 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
12748 return convert_descriptor_to_mode (mode, op0);
12749 }
12750
12751 /* CLZ (where constV is CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO computed value,
12752 const0 is DW_OP_lit0 or corresponding typed constant,
12753 const1 is DW_OP_lit1 or corresponding typed constant
12754 and constMSB is constant with just the MSB bit set
12755 for the mode):
12756 DW_OP_dup DW_OP_bra <L1> DW_OP_drop constV DW_OP_skip <L4>
12757 L1: const0 DW_OP_swap
12758 L2: DW_OP_dup constMSB DW_OP_and DW_OP_bra <L3> const1 DW_OP_shl
12759 DW_OP_swap DW_OP_plus_uconst <1> DW_OP_swap DW_OP_skip <L2>
12760 L3: DW_OP_drop
12761 L4: DW_OP_nop
12762
12763 CTZ is similar:
12764 DW_OP_dup DW_OP_bra <L1> DW_OP_drop constV DW_OP_skip <L4>
12765 L1: const0 DW_OP_swap
12766 L2: DW_OP_dup const1 DW_OP_and DW_OP_bra <L3> const1 DW_OP_shr
12767 DW_OP_swap DW_OP_plus_uconst <1> DW_OP_swap DW_OP_skip <L2>
12768 L3: DW_OP_drop
12769 L4: DW_OP_nop
12770
12771 FFS is similar:
12772 DW_OP_dup DW_OP_bra <L1> DW_OP_drop const0 DW_OP_skip <L4>
12773 L1: const1 DW_OP_swap
12774 L2: DW_OP_dup const1 DW_OP_and DW_OP_bra <L3> const1 DW_OP_shr
12775 DW_OP_swap DW_OP_plus_uconst <1> DW_OP_swap DW_OP_skip <L2>
12776 L3: DW_OP_drop
12777 L4: DW_OP_nop */
12778
12779 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12780 clz_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, machine_mode mode,
12781 machine_mode mem_mode)
12782 {
12783 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, ret, tmp;
12784 HOST_WIDE_INT valv;
12785 dw_loc_descr_ref l1jump, l1label;
12786 dw_loc_descr_ref l2jump, l2label;
12787 dw_loc_descr_ref l3jump, l3label;
12788 dw_loc_descr_ref l4jump, l4label;
12789 rtx msb;
12790
12791 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT
12792 || GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != mode)
12793 return NULL;
12794
12795 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
12796 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12797 if (op0 == NULL)
12798 return NULL;
12799 ret = op0;
12800 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CLZ)
12801 {
12802 if (!CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (mode, valv))
12803 valv = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
12804 }
12805 else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == FFS)
12806 valv = 0;
12807 else if (!CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (mode, valv))
12808 valv = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
12809 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0));
12810 l1jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
12811 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1jump);
12812 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0));
12813 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (valv), mode, mem_mode,
12814 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12815 if (tmp == NULL)
12816 return NULL;
12817 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
12818 l4jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
12819 add_loc_descr (&ret, l4jump);
12820 l1label = mem_loc_descriptor (GET_CODE (rtl) == FFS
12821 ? const1_rtx : const0_rtx,
12822 mode, mem_mode,
12823 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12824 if (l1label == NULL)
12825 return NULL;
12826 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1label);
12827 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
12828 l2label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0);
12829 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2label);
12830 if (GET_CODE (rtl) != CLZ)
12831 msb = const1_rtx;
12832 else if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
12833 msb = GEN_INT ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1
12834 << (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) - 1));
12835 else
12836 msb = immed_wide_int_const
12837 (wi::set_bit_in_zero (GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode) - 1,
12838 GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode)), mode);
12839 if (GET_CODE (msb) == CONST_INT && INTVAL (msb) < 0)
12840 tmp = new_loc_descr (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
12841 ? DW_OP_const4u : HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 64
12842 ? DW_OP_const8u : DW_OP_constu, INTVAL (msb), 0);
12843 else
12844 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (msb, mode, mem_mode,
12845 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12846 if (tmp == NULL)
12847 return NULL;
12848 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
12849 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
12850 l3jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
12851 add_loc_descr (&ret, l3jump);
12852 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const1_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
12853 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12854 if (tmp == NULL)
12855 return NULL;
12856 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
12857 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (GET_CODE (rtl) == CLZ
12858 ? DW_OP_shl : DW_OP_shr, 0, 0));
12859 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
12860 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, 1, 0));
12861 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
12862 l2jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
12863 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2jump);
12864 l3label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
12865 add_loc_descr (&ret, l3label);
12866 l4label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_nop, 0, 0);
12867 add_loc_descr (&ret, l4label);
12868 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
12869 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l1label;
12870 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
12871 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l2label;
12872 l3jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
12873 l3jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l3label;
12874 l4jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
12875 l4jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l4label;
12876 return ret;
12877 }
12878
12879 /* POPCOUNT (const0 is DW_OP_lit0 or corresponding typed constant,
12880 const1 is DW_OP_lit1 or corresponding typed constant):
12881 const0 DW_OP_swap
12882 L1: DW_OP_dup DW_OP_bra <L2> DW_OP_dup DW_OP_rot const1 DW_OP_and
12883 DW_OP_plus DW_OP_swap const1 DW_OP_shr DW_OP_skip <L1>
12884 L2: DW_OP_drop
12885
12886 PARITY is similar:
12887 L1: DW_OP_dup DW_OP_bra <L2> DW_OP_dup DW_OP_rot const1 DW_OP_and
12888 DW_OP_xor DW_OP_swap const1 DW_OP_shr DW_OP_skip <L1>
12889 L2: DW_OP_drop */
12890
12891 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12892 popcount_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, machine_mode mode,
12893 machine_mode mem_mode)
12894 {
12895 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, ret, tmp;
12896 dw_loc_descr_ref l1jump, l1label;
12897 dw_loc_descr_ref l2jump, l2label;
12898
12899 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT
12900 || GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != mode)
12901 return NULL;
12902
12903 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
12904 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12905 if (op0 == NULL)
12906 return NULL;
12907 ret = op0;
12908 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const0_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
12909 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12910 if (tmp == NULL)
12911 return NULL;
12912 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
12913 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
12914 l1label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0);
12915 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1label);
12916 l2jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
12917 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2jump);
12918 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0));
12919 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_rot, 0, 0));
12920 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const1_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
12921 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12922 if (tmp == NULL)
12923 return NULL;
12924 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
12925 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
12926 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (GET_CODE (rtl) == POPCOUNT
12927 ? DW_OP_plus : DW_OP_xor, 0, 0));
12928 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
12929 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const1_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
12930 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12931 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
12932 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shr, 0, 0));
12933 l1jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
12934 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1jump);
12935 l2label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
12936 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2label);
12937 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
12938 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l1label;
12939 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
12940 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l2label;
12941 return ret;
12942 }
12943
12944 /* BSWAP (constS is initial shift count, either 56 or 24):
12945 constS const0
12946 L1: DW_OP_pick <2> constS DW_OP_pick <3> DW_OP_minus DW_OP_shr
12947 const255 DW_OP_and DW_OP_pick <2> DW_OP_shl DW_OP_or
12948 DW_OP_swap DW_OP_dup const0 DW_OP_eq DW_OP_bra <L2> const8
12949 DW_OP_minus DW_OP_swap DW_OP_skip <L1>
12950 L2: DW_OP_drop DW_OP_swap DW_OP_drop */
12951
12952 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12953 bswap_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, machine_mode mode,
12954 machine_mode mem_mode)
12955 {
12956 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, ret, tmp;
12957 dw_loc_descr_ref l1jump, l1label;
12958 dw_loc_descr_ref l2jump, l2label;
12959
12960 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT
12961 || BITS_PER_UNIT != 8
12962 || (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) != 32
12963 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) != 64))
12964 return NULL;
12965
12966 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
12967 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12968 if (op0 == NULL)
12969 return NULL;
12970
12971 ret = op0;
12972 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) - 8),
12973 mode, mem_mode,
12974 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12975 if (tmp == NULL)
12976 return NULL;
12977 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
12978 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const0_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
12979 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12980 if (tmp == NULL)
12981 return NULL;
12982 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
12983 l1label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_pick, 2, 0);
12984 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1label);
12985 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) - 8),
12986 mode, mem_mode,
12987 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12988 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
12989 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_pick, 3, 0));
12990 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
12991 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shr, 0, 0));
12992 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (255), mode, mem_mode,
12993 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12994 if (tmp == NULL)
12995 return NULL;
12996 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
12997 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
12998 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_pick, 2, 0));
12999 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
13000 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_or, 0, 0));
13001 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
13002 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0));
13003 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const0_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
13004 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13005 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
13006 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_eq, 0, 0));
13007 l2jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
13008 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2jump);
13009 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (8), mode, mem_mode,
13010 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13011 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
13012 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
13013 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
13014 l1jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
13015 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1jump);
13016 l2label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
13017 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2label);
13018 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
13019 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0));
13020 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
13021 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l1label;
13022 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
13023 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l2label;
13024 return ret;
13025 }
13026
13027 /* ROTATE (constMASK is mode mask, BITSIZE is bitsize of mode):
13028 DW_OP_over DW_OP_over DW_OP_shl [ constMASK DW_OP_and ] DW_OP_rot
13029 [ DW_OP_swap constMASK DW_OP_and DW_OP_swap ] DW_OP_neg
13030 DW_OP_plus_uconst <BITSIZE> DW_OP_shr DW_OP_or
13031
13032 ROTATERT is similar:
13033 DW_OP_over DW_OP_over DW_OP_neg DW_OP_plus_uconst <BITSIZE>
13034 DW_OP_shl [ constMASK DW_OP_and ] DW_OP_rot
13035 [ DW_OP_swap constMASK DW_OP_and DW_OP_swap ] DW_OP_shr DW_OP_or */
13036
13037 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13038 rotate_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, machine_mode mode,
13039 machine_mode mem_mode)
13040 {
13041 rtx rtlop1 = XEXP (rtl, 1);
13042 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1, ret, mask[2] = { NULL, NULL };
13043 int i;
13044
13045 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT)
13046 return NULL;
13047
13048 if (GET_MODE (rtlop1) != VOIDmode
13049 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (rtlop1)) < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode))
13050 rtlop1 = gen_rtx_ZERO_EXTEND (mode, rtlop1);
13051 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
13052 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13053 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (rtlop1, mode, mem_mode,
13054 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13055 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL)
13056 return NULL;
13057 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13058 for (i = 0; i < 2; i++)
13059 {
13060 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
13061 mask[i] = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (GET_MODE_MASK (mode)),
13062 mode, mem_mode,
13063 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13064 else if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
13065 mask[i] = new_loc_descr (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
13066 ? DW_OP_const4u
13067 : HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 64
13068 ? DW_OP_const8u : DW_OP_constu,
13069 GET_MODE_MASK (mode), 0);
13070 else
13071 mask[i] = NULL;
13072 if (mask[i] == NULL)
13073 return NULL;
13074 add_loc_descr (&mask[i], new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
13075 }
13076 ret = op0;
13077 add_loc_descr (&ret, op1);
13078 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
13079 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
13080 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == ROTATERT)
13081 {
13082 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_neg, 0, 0));
13083 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
13084 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode), 0));
13085 }
13086 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
13087 if (mask[0] != NULL)
13088 add_loc_descr (&ret, mask[0]);
13089 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_rot, 0, 0));
13090 if (mask[1] != NULL)
13091 {
13092 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
13093 add_loc_descr (&ret, mask[1]);
13094 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
13095 }
13096 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == ROTATE)
13097 {
13098 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_neg, 0, 0));
13099 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
13100 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode), 0));
13101 }
13102 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shr, 0, 0));
13103 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_or, 0, 0));
13104 return ret;
13105 }
13106
13107 /* Helper function for mem_loc_descriptor. Return DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref
13108 for DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF RTL. */
13109
13110 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13111 parameter_ref_descriptor (rtx rtl)
13112 {
13113 dw_loc_descr_ref ret;
13114 dw_die_ref ref;
13115
13116 if (dwarf_strict)
13117 return NULL;
13118 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF_DECL (rtl)) == PARM_DECL);
13119 ref = lookup_decl_die (DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF_DECL (rtl));
13120 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref, 0, 0);
13121 if (ref)
13122 {
13123 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
13124 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
13125 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
13126 }
13127 else
13128 {
13129 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_decl_ref;
13130 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref = DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF_DECL (rtl);
13131 }
13132 return ret;
13133 }
13134
13135 /* The following routine converts the RTL for a variable or parameter
13136 (resident in memory) into an equivalent Dwarf representation of a
13137 mechanism for getting the address of that same variable onto the top of a
13138 hypothetical "address evaluation" stack.
13139
13140 When creating memory location descriptors, we are effectively transforming
13141 the RTL for a memory-resident object into its Dwarf postfix expression
13142 equivalent. This routine recursively descends an RTL tree, turning
13143 it into Dwarf postfix code as it goes.
13144
13145 MODE is the mode that should be assumed for the rtl if it is VOIDmode.
13146
13147 MEM_MODE is the mode of the memory reference, needed to handle some
13148 autoincrement addressing modes.
13149
13150 Return 0 if we can't represent the location. */
13151
13152 dw_loc_descr_ref
13153 mem_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, machine_mode mode,
13154 machine_mode mem_mode,
13155 enum var_init_status initialized)
13156 {
13157 dw_loc_descr_ref mem_loc_result = NULL;
13158 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
13159 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1;
13160 rtx inner = NULL_RTX;
13161
13162 if (mode == VOIDmode)
13163 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
13164
13165 /* Note that for a dynamically sized array, the location we will generate a
13166 description of here will be the lowest numbered location which is
13167 actually within the array. That's *not* necessarily the same as the
13168 zeroth element of the array. */
13169
13170 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
13171
13172 if (mode != GET_MODE (rtl) && GET_MODE (rtl) != VOIDmode)
13173 return NULL;
13174
13175 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
13176 {
13177 case POST_INC:
13178 case POST_DEC:
13179 case POST_MODIFY:
13180 return mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode, initialized);
13181
13182 case SUBREG:
13183 /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
13184 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
13185 up an entire register. For now, just assume that it is
13186 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
13187 contains the given subreg. */
13188 if (!subreg_lowpart_p (rtl))
13189 break;
13190 inner = SUBREG_REG (rtl);
13191 case TRUNCATE:
13192 if (inner == NULL_RTX)
13193 inner = XEXP (rtl, 0);
13194 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
13195 && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (inner)) == MODE_INT
13196 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
13197 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
13198 || (mode == Pmode && mem_mode != VOIDmode)
13199 #endif
13200 )
13201 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (inner)) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13202 {
13203 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (inner,
13204 GET_MODE (inner),
13205 mem_mode, initialized);
13206 break;
13207 }
13208 if (dwarf_strict)
13209 break;
13210 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (inner)))
13211 break;
13212 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) != GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (inner))
13213 && (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT
13214 || GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (inner)) != MODE_INT))
13215 break;
13216 else
13217 {
13218 dw_die_ref type_die;
13219 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
13220
13221 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (inner,
13222 GET_MODE (inner),
13223 mem_mode, initialized);
13224 if (mem_loc_result == NULL)
13225 break;
13226 type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode,
13227 GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT);
13228 if (type_die == NULL)
13229 {
13230 mem_loc_result = NULL;
13231 break;
13232 }
13233 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)
13234 != GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (inner)))
13235 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
13236 else
13237 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret, 0, 0);
13238 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
13239 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
13240 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
13241 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, cvt);
13242 }
13243 break;
13244
13245 case REG:
13246 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT
13247 || (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
13248 && rtl != arg_pointer_rtx
13249 && rtl != frame_pointer_rtx
13250 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
13251 && (mode != Pmode || mem_mode == VOIDmode)
13252 #endif
13253 ))
13254 {
13255 dw_die_ref type_die;
13256 unsigned int dbx_regnum;
13257
13258 if (dwarf_strict)
13259 break;
13260 if (REGNO (rtl) > FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
13261 break;
13262 type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode,
13263 GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT);
13264 if (type_die == NULL)
13265 break;
13266
13267 dbx_regnum = dbx_reg_number (rtl);
13268 if (dbx_regnum == IGNORED_DWARF_REGNUM)
13269 break;
13270 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_regval_type,
13271 dbx_regnum, 0);
13272 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
13273 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
13274 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
13275 break;
13276 }
13277 /* Whenever a register number forms a part of the description of the
13278 method for calculating the (dynamic) address of a memory resident
13279 object, DWARF rules require the register number be referred to as
13280 a "base register". This distinction is not based in any way upon
13281 what category of register the hardware believes the given register
13282 belongs to. This is strictly DWARF terminology we're dealing with
13283 here. Note that in cases where the location of a memory-resident
13284 data object could be expressed as: OP_ADD (OP_BASEREG (basereg),
13285 OP_CONST (0)) the actual DWARF location descriptor that we generate
13286 may just be OP_BASEREG (basereg). This may look deceptively like
13287 the object in question was allocated to a register (rather than in
13288 memory) so DWARF consumers need to be aware of the subtle
13289 distinction between OP_REG and OP_BASEREG. */
13290 if (REGNO (rtl) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
13291 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (rtl, 0, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13292 else if (stack_realign_drap
13293 && crtl->drap_reg
13294 && crtl->args.internal_arg_pointer == rtl
13295 && REGNO (crtl->drap_reg) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
13296 {
13297 /* If RTL is internal_arg_pointer, which has been optimized
13298 out, use DRAP instead. */
13299 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (crtl->drap_reg, 0,
13300 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13301 }
13302 break;
13303
13304 case SIGN_EXTEND:
13305 case ZERO_EXTEND:
13306 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT)
13307 break;
13308 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)),
13309 mem_mode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13310 if (op0 == 0)
13311 break;
13312 else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == ZERO_EXTEND
13313 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
13314 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
13315 < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
13316 /* If DW_OP_const{1,2,4}u won't be used, it is shorter
13317 to expand zero extend as two shifts instead of
13318 masking. */
13319 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0))) <= 4)
13320 {
13321 machine_mode imode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0));
13322 mem_loc_result = op0;
13323 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
13324 int_loc_descriptor (GET_MODE_MASK (imode)));
13325 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
13326 }
13327 else if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13328 {
13329 int shift = DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
13330 - GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)));
13331 shift *= BITS_PER_UNIT;
13332 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SIGN_EXTEND)
13333 op = DW_OP_shra;
13334 else
13335 op = DW_OP_shr;
13336 mem_loc_result = op0;
13337 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
13338 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
13339 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
13340 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
13341 }
13342 else if (!dwarf_strict)
13343 {
13344 dw_die_ref type_die1, type_die2;
13345 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
13346
13347 type_die1 = base_type_for_mode (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)),
13348 GET_CODE (rtl) == ZERO_EXTEND);
13349 if (type_die1 == NULL)
13350 break;
13351 type_die2 = base_type_for_mode (mode, 1);
13352 if (type_die2 == NULL)
13353 break;
13354 mem_loc_result = op0;
13355 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
13356 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
13357 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die1;
13358 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
13359 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, cvt);
13360 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
13361 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
13362 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die2;
13363 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
13364 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, cvt);
13365 }
13366 break;
13367
13368 case MEM:
13369 {
13370 rtx new_rtl = avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl);
13371 if (new_rtl != rtl)
13372 {
13373 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (new_rtl, mode, mem_mode,
13374 initialized);
13375 if (mem_loc_result != NULL)
13376 return mem_loc_result;
13377 }
13378 }
13379 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0),
13380 get_address_mode (rtl), mode,
13381 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13382 if (mem_loc_result == NULL)
13383 mem_loc_result = tls_mem_loc_descriptor (rtl);
13384 if (mem_loc_result != NULL)
13385 {
13386 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
13387 || GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT)
13388 {
13389 dw_die_ref type_die;
13390 dw_loc_descr_ref deref;
13391
13392 if (dwarf_strict)
13393 return NULL;
13394 type_die
13395 = base_type_for_mode (mode, GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT);
13396 if (type_die == NULL)
13397 return NULL;
13398 deref = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_deref_type,
13399 GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), 0);
13400 deref->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
13401 deref->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
13402 deref->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
13403 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, deref);
13404 }
13405 else if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13406 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0));
13407 else
13408 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
13409 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref_size,
13410 GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), 0));
13411 }
13412 break;
13413
13414 case LO_SUM:
13415 return mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode, initialized);
13416
13417 case LABEL_REF:
13418 /* Some ports can transform a symbol ref into a label ref, because
13419 the symbol ref is too far away and has to be dumped into a constant
13420 pool. */
13421 case CONST:
13422 case SYMBOL_REF:
13423 if ((GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT
13424 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_PARTIAL_INT)
13425 || (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
13426 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
13427 && (mode != Pmode || mem_mode == VOIDmode)
13428 #endif
13429 ))
13430 break;
13431 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF
13432 && SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (rtl) != TLS_MODEL_NONE)
13433 {
13434 dw_loc_descr_ref temp;
13435
13436 /* If this is not defined, we have no way to emit the data. */
13437 if (!targetm.have_tls || !targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
13438 break;
13439
13440 temp = new_addr_loc_descr (rtl, dtprel_true);
13441
13442 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address, 0, 0);
13443 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, temp);
13444
13445 break;
13446 }
13447
13448 if (!const_ok_for_output (rtl))
13449 {
13450 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST)
13451 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
13452 initialized);
13453 break;
13454 }
13455
13456 symref:
13457 mem_loc_result = new_addr_loc_descr (rtl, dtprel_false);
13458 vec_safe_push (used_rtx_array, rtl);
13459 break;
13460
13461 case CONCAT:
13462 case CONCATN:
13463 case VAR_LOCATION:
13464 case DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR:
13465 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
13466 "CONCAT/CONCATN/VAR_LOCATION is handled only by loc_descriptor");
13467 return 0;
13468
13469 case ENTRY_VALUE:
13470 if (dwarf_strict)
13471 return NULL;
13472 if (REG_P (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl)))
13473 {
13474 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT
13475 || GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13476 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl), mode,
13477 VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13478 else
13479 {
13480 unsigned int dbx_regnum = dbx_reg_number (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl));
13481 if (dbx_regnum == IGNORED_DWARF_REGNUM)
13482 return NULL;
13483 op0 = one_reg_loc_descriptor (dbx_regnum,
13484 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13485 }
13486 }
13487 else if (MEM_P (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl))
13488 && REG_P (XEXP (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl), 0)))
13489 {
13490 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl), mode,
13491 VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13492 if (op0 && op0->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_fbreg)
13493 return NULL;
13494 }
13495 else
13496 gcc_unreachable ();
13497 if (op0 == NULL)
13498 return NULL;
13499 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_entry_value, 0, 0);
13500 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
13501 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = op0;
13502 break;
13503
13504 case DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF:
13505 mem_loc_result = parameter_ref_descriptor (rtl);
13506 break;
13507
13508 case PRE_MODIFY:
13509 /* Extract the PLUS expression nested inside and fall into
13510 PLUS code below. */
13511 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
13512 goto plus;
13513
13514 case PRE_INC:
13515 case PRE_DEC:
13516 /* Turn these into a PLUS expression and fall into the PLUS code
13517 below. */
13518 rtl = gen_rtx_PLUS (mode, XEXP (rtl, 0),
13519 gen_int_mode (GET_CODE (rtl) == PRE_INC
13520 ? GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mem_mode)
13521 : -GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mem_mode),
13522 mode));
13523
13524 /* ... fall through ... */
13525
13526 case PLUS:
13527 plus:
13528 if (is_based_loc (rtl)
13529 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
13530 || XEXP (rtl, 0) == arg_pointer_rtx
13531 || XEXP (rtl, 0) == frame_pointer_rtx)
13532 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT)
13533 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (XEXP (rtl, 0),
13534 INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)),
13535 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13536 else
13537 {
13538 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
13539 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13540 if (mem_loc_result == 0)
13541 break;
13542
13543 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1))
13544 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13545 loc_descr_plus_const (&mem_loc_result, INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
13546 else
13547 {
13548 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
13549 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13550 if (op1 == 0)
13551 return NULL;
13552 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
13553 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
13554 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
13555 }
13556 }
13557 break;
13558
13559 /* If a pseudo-reg is optimized away, it is possible for it to
13560 be replaced with a MEM containing a multiply or shift. */
13561 case MINUS:
13562 op = DW_OP_minus;
13563 goto do_binop;
13564
13565 case MULT:
13566 op = DW_OP_mul;
13567 goto do_binop;
13568
13569 case DIV:
13570 if (!dwarf_strict
13571 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
13572 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13573 {
13574 mem_loc_result = typed_binop (DW_OP_div, rtl,
13575 base_type_for_mode (mode, 0),
13576 mode, mem_mode);
13577 break;
13578 }
13579 op = DW_OP_div;
13580 goto do_binop;
13581
13582 case UMOD:
13583 op = DW_OP_mod;
13584 goto do_binop;
13585
13586 case ASHIFT:
13587 op = DW_OP_shl;
13588 goto do_shift;
13589
13590 case ASHIFTRT:
13591 op = DW_OP_shra;
13592 goto do_shift;
13593
13594 case LSHIFTRT:
13595 op = DW_OP_shr;
13596 goto do_shift;
13597
13598 do_shift:
13599 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT)
13600 break;
13601 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
13602 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13603 {
13604 rtx rtlop1 = XEXP (rtl, 1);
13605 if (GET_MODE (rtlop1) != VOIDmode
13606 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (rtlop1))
13607 < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode))
13608 rtlop1 = gen_rtx_ZERO_EXTEND (mode, rtlop1);
13609 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (rtlop1, mode, mem_mode,
13610 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13611 }
13612
13613 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
13614 break;
13615
13616 mem_loc_result = op0;
13617 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
13618 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
13619 break;
13620
13621 case AND:
13622 op = DW_OP_and;
13623 goto do_binop;
13624
13625 case IOR:
13626 op = DW_OP_or;
13627 goto do_binop;
13628
13629 case XOR:
13630 op = DW_OP_xor;
13631 goto do_binop;
13632
13633 do_binop:
13634 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
13635 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13636 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
13637 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13638
13639 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
13640 break;
13641
13642 mem_loc_result = op0;
13643 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
13644 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
13645 break;
13646
13647 case MOD:
13648 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE && !dwarf_strict)
13649 {
13650 mem_loc_result = typed_binop (DW_OP_mod, rtl,
13651 base_type_for_mode (mode, 0),
13652 mode, mem_mode);
13653 break;
13654 }
13655
13656 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
13657 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13658 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
13659 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13660
13661 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
13662 break;
13663
13664 mem_loc_result = op0;
13665 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
13666 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
13667 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
13668 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_div, 0, 0));
13669 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_mul, 0, 0));
13670 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
13671 break;
13672
13673 case UDIV:
13674 if (!dwarf_strict && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT)
13675 {
13676 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13677 {
13678 op = DW_OP_div;
13679 goto do_binop;
13680 }
13681 mem_loc_result = typed_binop (DW_OP_div, rtl,
13682 base_type_for_mode (mode, 1),
13683 mode, mem_mode);
13684 }
13685 break;
13686
13687 case NOT:
13688 op = DW_OP_not;
13689 goto do_unop;
13690
13691 case ABS:
13692 op = DW_OP_abs;
13693 goto do_unop;
13694
13695 case NEG:
13696 op = DW_OP_neg;
13697 goto do_unop;
13698
13699 do_unop:
13700 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
13701 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13702
13703 if (op0 == 0)
13704 break;
13705
13706 mem_loc_result = op0;
13707 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
13708 break;
13709
13710 case CONST_INT:
13711 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
13712 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
13713 || (mode == Pmode
13714 && mem_mode != VOIDmode
13715 && trunc_int_for_mode (INTVAL (rtl), ptr_mode) == INTVAL (rtl))
13716 #endif
13717 )
13718 {
13719 mem_loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (rtl));
13720 break;
13721 }
13722 if (!dwarf_strict
13723 && (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
13724 || GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) == HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT))
13725 {
13726 dw_die_ref type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode, 1);
13727 machine_mode amode;
13728 if (type_die == NULL)
13729 return NULL;
13730 amode = mode_for_size (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * BITS_PER_UNIT,
13731 MODE_INT, 0);
13732 if (INTVAL (rtl) >= 0
13733 && amode != BLKmode
13734 && trunc_int_for_mode (INTVAL (rtl), amode) == INTVAL (rtl)
13735 /* const DW_OP_GNU_convert <XXX> vs.
13736 DW_OP_GNU_const_type <XXX, 1, const>. */
13737 && size_of_int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (rtl)) + 1 + 1
13738 < (unsigned long) 1 + 1 + 1 + GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
13739 {
13740 mem_loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (rtl));
13741 op0 = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
13742 op0->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
13743 op0->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
13744 op0->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
13745 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op0);
13746 return mem_loc_result;
13747 }
13748 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_const_type, 0,
13749 INTVAL (rtl));
13750 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
13751 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
13752 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
13753 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
13754 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
13755 else
13756 {
13757 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class
13758 = dw_val_class_const_double;
13759 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_double
13760 = double_int::from_shwi (INTVAL (rtl));
13761 }
13762 }
13763 break;
13764
13765 case CONST_DOUBLE:
13766 if (!dwarf_strict)
13767 {
13768 dw_die_ref type_die;
13769
13770 /* Note that if TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT == 0, a
13771 CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either a large integer
13772 or a floating-point constant. If TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT != 0,
13773 the value is always a floating point constant.
13774
13775 When it is an integer, a CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever
13776 the constant requires 2 HWIs to be adequately represented.
13777 We output CONST_DOUBLEs as blocks. */
13778 if (mode == VOIDmode
13779 || (GET_MODE (rtl) == VOIDmode
13780 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) != HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT))
13781 break;
13782 type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode,
13783 GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT);
13784 if (type_die == NULL)
13785 return NULL;
13786 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_const_type, 0, 0);
13787 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
13788 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
13789 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
13790 #if TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT == 0
13791 if (!SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (mode))
13792 {
13793 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class
13794 = dw_val_class_const_double;
13795 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_double
13796 = rtx_to_double_int (rtl);
13797 }
13798 else
13799 #endif
13800 {
13801 unsigned int length = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
13802 unsigned char *array = ggc_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (length);
13803
13804 insert_float (rtl, array);
13805 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
13806 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length = length / 4;
13807 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size = 4;
13808 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.array = array;
13809 }
13810 }
13811 break;
13812
13813 case CONST_WIDE_INT:
13814 if (!dwarf_strict)
13815 {
13816 dw_die_ref type_die;
13817
13818 type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode,
13819 GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT);
13820 if (type_die == NULL)
13821 return NULL;
13822 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_const_type, 0, 0);
13823 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
13824 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
13825 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
13826 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class
13827 = dw_val_class_wide_int;
13828 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_wide = ggc_alloc<wide_int> ();
13829 *mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_wide = std::make_pair (rtl, mode);
13830 }
13831 break;
13832
13833 case EQ:
13834 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_eq, rtl, mem_mode);
13835 break;
13836
13837 case GE:
13838 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_ge, rtl, mem_mode);
13839 break;
13840
13841 case GT:
13842 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_gt, rtl, mem_mode);
13843 break;
13844
13845 case LE:
13846 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_le, rtl, mem_mode);
13847 break;
13848
13849 case LT:
13850 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_lt, rtl, mem_mode);
13851 break;
13852
13853 case NE:
13854 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_ne, rtl, mem_mode);
13855 break;
13856
13857 case GEU:
13858 mem_loc_result = ucompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_ge, rtl, mem_mode);
13859 break;
13860
13861 case GTU:
13862 mem_loc_result = ucompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_gt, rtl, mem_mode);
13863 break;
13864
13865 case LEU:
13866 mem_loc_result = ucompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_le, rtl, mem_mode);
13867 break;
13868
13869 case LTU:
13870 mem_loc_result = ucompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_lt, rtl, mem_mode);
13871 break;
13872
13873 case UMIN:
13874 case UMAX:
13875 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT)
13876 break;
13877 /* FALLTHRU */
13878 case SMIN:
13879 case SMAX:
13880 mem_loc_result = minmax_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, mem_mode);
13881 break;
13882
13883 case ZERO_EXTRACT:
13884 case SIGN_EXTRACT:
13885 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1))
13886 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 2))
13887 && ((unsigned) INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1))
13888 + (unsigned) INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 2))
13889 <= GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode))
13890 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
13891 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
13892 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0))) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13893 {
13894 int shift, size;
13895 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)),
13896 mem_mode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13897 if (op0 == 0)
13898 break;
13899 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SIGN_EXTRACT)
13900 op = DW_OP_shra;
13901 else
13902 op = DW_OP_shr;
13903 mem_loc_result = op0;
13904 size = INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1));
13905 shift = INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 2));
13906 if (BITS_BIG_ENDIAN)
13907 shift = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
13908 - shift - size;
13909 if (shift + size != (int) DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13910 {
13911 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
13912 int_loc_descriptor (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
13913 - shift - size));
13914 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
13915 }
13916 if (size != (int) DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13917 {
13918 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
13919 int_loc_descriptor (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE - size));
13920 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
13921 }
13922 }
13923 break;
13924
13925 case IF_THEN_ELSE:
13926 {
13927 dw_loc_descr_ref op2, bra_node, drop_node;
13928 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0),
13929 GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == VOIDmode
13930 ? word_mode : GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)),
13931 mem_mode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13932 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
13933 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13934 op2 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 2), mode, mem_mode,
13935 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13936 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL || op2 == NULL)
13937 break;
13938
13939 mem_loc_result = op1;
13940 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op2);
13941 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op0);
13942 bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
13943 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, bra_node);
13944 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
13945 drop_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
13946 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, drop_node);
13947 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
13948 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = drop_node;
13949 }
13950 break;
13951
13952 case FLOAT_EXTEND:
13953 case FLOAT_TRUNCATE:
13954 case FLOAT:
13955 case UNSIGNED_FLOAT:
13956 case FIX:
13957 case UNSIGNED_FIX:
13958 if (!dwarf_strict)
13959 {
13960 dw_die_ref type_die;
13961 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
13962
13963 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)),
13964 mem_mode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13965 if (op0 == NULL)
13966 break;
13967 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0))) == MODE_INT
13968 && (GET_CODE (rtl) == FLOAT
13969 || GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
13970 <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE))
13971 {
13972 type_die = base_type_for_mode (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)),
13973 GET_CODE (rtl) == UNSIGNED_FLOAT);
13974 if (type_die == NULL)
13975 break;
13976 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
13977 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
13978 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
13979 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
13980 add_loc_descr (&op0, cvt);
13981 }
13982 type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode, GET_CODE (rtl) == UNSIGNED_FIX);
13983 if (type_die == NULL)
13984 break;
13985 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
13986 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
13987 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
13988 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
13989 add_loc_descr (&op0, cvt);
13990 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
13991 && (GET_CODE (rtl) == FIX
13992 || GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE))
13993 {
13994 op0 = convert_descriptor_to_mode (mode, op0);
13995 if (op0 == NULL)
13996 break;
13997 }
13998 mem_loc_result = op0;
13999 }
14000 break;
14001
14002 case CLZ:
14003 case CTZ:
14004 case FFS:
14005 mem_loc_result = clz_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, mem_mode);
14006 break;
14007
14008 case POPCOUNT:
14009 case PARITY:
14010 mem_loc_result = popcount_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, mem_mode);
14011 break;
14012
14013 case BSWAP:
14014 mem_loc_result = bswap_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, mem_mode);
14015 break;
14016
14017 case ROTATE:
14018 case ROTATERT:
14019 mem_loc_result = rotate_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, mem_mode);
14020 break;
14021
14022 case COMPARE:
14023 /* In theory, we could implement the above. */
14024 /* DWARF cannot represent the unsigned compare operations
14025 natively. */
14026 case SS_MULT:
14027 case US_MULT:
14028 case SS_DIV:
14029 case US_DIV:
14030 case SS_PLUS:
14031 case US_PLUS:
14032 case SS_MINUS:
14033 case US_MINUS:
14034 case SS_NEG:
14035 case US_NEG:
14036 case SS_ABS:
14037 case SS_ASHIFT:
14038 case US_ASHIFT:
14039 case SS_TRUNCATE:
14040 case US_TRUNCATE:
14041 case UNORDERED:
14042 case ORDERED:
14043 case UNEQ:
14044 case UNGE:
14045 case UNGT:
14046 case UNLE:
14047 case UNLT:
14048 case LTGT:
14049 case FRACT_CONVERT:
14050 case UNSIGNED_FRACT_CONVERT:
14051 case SAT_FRACT:
14052 case UNSIGNED_SAT_FRACT:
14053 case SQRT:
14054 case ASM_OPERANDS:
14055 case VEC_MERGE:
14056 case VEC_SELECT:
14057 case VEC_CONCAT:
14058 case VEC_DUPLICATE:
14059 case UNSPEC:
14060 case HIGH:
14061 case FMA:
14062 case STRICT_LOW_PART:
14063 case CONST_VECTOR:
14064 case CONST_FIXED:
14065 case CLRSB:
14066 case CLOBBER:
14067 /* If delegitimize_address couldn't do anything with the UNSPEC, we
14068 can't express it in the debug info. This can happen e.g. with some
14069 TLS UNSPECs. */
14070 break;
14071
14072 case CONST_STRING:
14073 resolve_one_addr (&rtl);
14074 goto symref;
14075
14076 default:
14077 if (flag_checking)
14078 {
14079 print_rtl (stderr, rtl);
14080 gcc_unreachable ();
14081 }
14082 break;
14083 }
14084
14085 if (mem_loc_result && initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
14086 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
14087
14088 return mem_loc_result;
14089 }
14090
14091 /* Return a descriptor that describes the concatenation of two locations.
14092 This is typically a complex variable. */
14093
14094 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14095 concat_loc_descriptor (rtx x0, rtx x1, enum var_init_status initialized)
14096 {
14097 dw_loc_descr_ref cc_loc_result = NULL;
14098 dw_loc_descr_ref x0_ref
14099 = loc_descriptor (x0, VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14100 dw_loc_descr_ref x1_ref
14101 = loc_descriptor (x1, VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14102
14103 if (x0_ref == 0 || x1_ref == 0)
14104 return 0;
14105
14106 cc_loc_result = x0_ref;
14107 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x0)));
14108
14109 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, x1_ref);
14110 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x1)));
14111
14112 if (initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
14113 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
14114
14115 return cc_loc_result;
14116 }
14117
14118 /* Return a descriptor that describes the concatenation of N
14119 locations. */
14120
14121 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14122 concatn_loc_descriptor (rtx concatn, enum var_init_status initialized)
14123 {
14124 unsigned int i;
14125 dw_loc_descr_ref cc_loc_result = NULL;
14126 unsigned int n = XVECLEN (concatn, 0);
14127
14128 for (i = 0; i < n; ++i)
14129 {
14130 dw_loc_descr_ref ref;
14131 rtx x = XVECEXP (concatn, 0, i);
14132
14133 ref = loc_descriptor (x, VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14134 if (ref == NULL)
14135 return NULL;
14136
14137 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, ref);
14138 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x)));
14139 }
14140
14141 if (cc_loc_result && initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
14142 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
14143
14144 return cc_loc_result;
14145 }
14146
14147 /* Helper function for loc_descriptor. Return DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer
14148 for DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR RTL. */
14149
14150 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14151 implicit_ptr_descriptor (rtx rtl, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
14152 {
14153 dw_loc_descr_ref ret;
14154 dw_die_ref ref;
14155
14156 if (dwarf_strict)
14157 return NULL;
14158 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl)) == VAR_DECL
14159 || TREE_CODE (DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl)) == PARM_DECL
14160 || TREE_CODE (DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl)) == RESULT_DECL);
14161 ref = lookup_decl_die (DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl));
14162 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer, 0, offset);
14163 ret->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
14164 if (ref)
14165 {
14166 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14167 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
14168 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14169 }
14170 else
14171 {
14172 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_decl_ref;
14173 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref = DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl);
14174 }
14175 return ret;
14176 }
14177
14178 /* Output a proper Dwarf location descriptor for a variable or parameter
14179 which is either allocated in a register or in a memory location. For a
14180 register, we just generate an OP_REG and the register number. For a
14181 memory location we provide a Dwarf postfix expression describing how to
14182 generate the (dynamic) address of the object onto the address stack.
14183
14184 MODE is mode of the decl if this loc_descriptor is going to be used in
14185 .debug_loc section where DW_OP_stack_value and DW_OP_implicit_value are
14186 allowed, VOIDmode otherwise.
14187
14188 If we don't know how to describe it, return 0. */
14189
14190 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14191 loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, machine_mode mode,
14192 enum var_init_status initialized)
14193 {
14194 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
14195
14196 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
14197 {
14198 case SUBREG:
14199 /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
14200 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
14201 up an entire register. For now, just assume that it is
14202 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
14203 contains the given subreg. */
14204 if (REG_P (SUBREG_REG (rtl)) && subreg_lowpart_p (rtl))
14205 loc_result = loc_descriptor (SUBREG_REG (rtl),
14206 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (rtl)), initialized);
14207 else
14208 goto do_default;
14209 break;
14210
14211 case REG:
14212 loc_result = reg_loc_descriptor (rtl, initialized);
14213 break;
14214
14215 case MEM:
14216 loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), get_address_mode (rtl),
14217 GET_MODE (rtl), initialized);
14218 if (loc_result == NULL)
14219 loc_result = tls_mem_loc_descriptor (rtl);
14220 if (loc_result == NULL)
14221 {
14222 rtx new_rtl = avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl);
14223 if (new_rtl != rtl)
14224 loc_result = loc_descriptor (new_rtl, mode, initialized);
14225 }
14226 break;
14227
14228 case CONCAT:
14229 loc_result = concat_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), XEXP (rtl, 1),
14230 initialized);
14231 break;
14232
14233 case CONCATN:
14234 loc_result = concatn_loc_descriptor (rtl, initialized);
14235 break;
14236
14237 case VAR_LOCATION:
14238 /* Single part. */
14239 if (GET_CODE (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (rtl)) != PARALLEL)
14240 {
14241 rtx loc = PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (rtl);
14242 if (GET_CODE (loc) == EXPR_LIST)
14243 loc = XEXP (loc, 0);
14244 loc_result = loc_descriptor (loc, mode, initialized);
14245 break;
14246 }
14247
14248 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
14249 /* FALLTHRU */
14250
14251 case PARALLEL:
14252 {
14253 rtvec par_elems = XVEC (rtl, 0);
14254 int num_elem = GET_NUM_ELEM (par_elems);
14255 machine_mode mode;
14256 int i;
14257
14258 /* Create the first one, so we have something to add to. */
14259 loc_result = loc_descriptor (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, 0), 0),
14260 VOIDmode, initialized);
14261 if (loc_result == NULL)
14262 return NULL;
14263 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, 0), 0));
14264 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
14265 for (i = 1; i < num_elem; i++)
14266 {
14267 dw_loc_descr_ref temp;
14268
14269 temp = loc_descriptor (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, i), 0),
14270 VOIDmode, initialized);
14271 if (temp == NULL)
14272 return NULL;
14273 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, temp);
14274 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, i), 0));
14275 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
14276 }
14277 }
14278 break;
14279
14280 case CONST_INT:
14281 if (mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode)
14282 loc_result = address_of_int_loc_descriptor (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode),
14283 INTVAL (rtl));
14284 break;
14285
14286 case CONST_DOUBLE:
14287 if (mode == VOIDmode)
14288 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
14289
14290 if (mode != VOIDmode && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
14291 {
14292 gcc_assert (mode == GET_MODE (rtl) || VOIDmode == GET_MODE (rtl));
14293
14294 /* Note that a CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either an integer
14295 or a floating-point constant. A CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever
14296 the constant requires more than one word in order to be
14297 adequately represented. We output CONST_DOUBLEs as blocks. */
14298 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value,
14299 GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), 0);
14300 #if TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT == 0
14301 if (!SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (mode))
14302 {
14303 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_const_double;
14304 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_double
14305 = rtx_to_double_int (rtl);
14306 }
14307 else
14308 #endif
14309 {
14310 unsigned int length = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
14311 unsigned char *array = ggc_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (length);
14312
14313 insert_float (rtl, array);
14314 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
14315 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length = length / 4;
14316 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size = 4;
14317 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.array = array;
14318 }
14319 }
14320 break;
14321
14322 case CONST_WIDE_INT:
14323 if (mode == VOIDmode)
14324 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
14325
14326 if (mode != VOIDmode && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
14327 {
14328 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value,
14329 GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), 0);
14330 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_wide_int;
14331 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_wide = ggc_alloc<wide_int> ();
14332 *loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_wide = std::make_pair (rtl, mode);
14333 }
14334 break;
14335
14336 case CONST_VECTOR:
14337 if (mode == VOIDmode)
14338 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
14339
14340 if (mode != VOIDmode && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
14341 {
14342 unsigned int elt_size = GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl));
14343 unsigned int length = CONST_VECTOR_NUNITS (rtl);
14344 unsigned char *array
14345 = ggc_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (length * elt_size);
14346 unsigned int i;
14347 unsigned char *p;
14348 machine_mode imode = GET_MODE_INNER (mode);
14349
14350 gcc_assert (mode == GET_MODE (rtl) || VOIDmode == GET_MODE (rtl));
14351 switch (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode))
14352 {
14353 case MODE_VECTOR_INT:
14354 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
14355 {
14356 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
14357 insert_wide_int (std::make_pair (elt, imode), p, elt_size);
14358 }
14359 break;
14360
14361 case MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT:
14362 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
14363 {
14364 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
14365 insert_float (elt, p);
14366 }
14367 break;
14368
14369 default:
14370 gcc_unreachable ();
14371 }
14372
14373 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value,
14374 length * elt_size, 0);
14375 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
14376 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length = length;
14377 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size = elt_size;
14378 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.array = array;
14379 }
14380 break;
14381
14382 case CONST:
14383 if (mode == VOIDmode
14384 || CONST_SCALAR_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
14385 || CONST_DOUBLE_AS_FLOAT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
14386 || GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == CONST_VECTOR)
14387 {
14388 loc_result = loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, initialized);
14389 break;
14390 }
14391 /* FALLTHROUGH */
14392 case SYMBOL_REF:
14393 if (!const_ok_for_output (rtl))
14394 break;
14395 case LABEL_REF:
14396 if (mode != VOIDmode && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
14397 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
14398 {
14399 loc_result = new_addr_loc_descr (rtl, dtprel_false);
14400 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
14401 vec_safe_push (used_rtx_array, rtl);
14402 }
14403 break;
14404
14405 case DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR:
14406 loc_result = implicit_ptr_descriptor (rtl, 0);
14407 break;
14408
14409 case PLUS:
14410 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR
14411 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
14412 {
14413 loc_result
14414 = implicit_ptr_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
14415 break;
14416 }
14417 /* FALLTHRU */
14418 do_default:
14419 default:
14420 if ((GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT && GET_MODE (rtl) == mode
14421 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
14422 && dwarf_version >= 4)
14423 || (!dwarf_strict && mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode))
14424 {
14425 /* Value expression. */
14426 loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, VOIDmode, initialized);
14427 if (loc_result)
14428 add_loc_descr (&loc_result,
14429 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
14430 }
14431 break;
14432 }
14433
14434 return loc_result;
14435 }
14436
14437 /* We need to figure out what section we should use as the base for the
14438 address ranges where a given location is valid.
14439 1. If this particular DECL has a section associated with it, use that.
14440 2. If this function has a section associated with it, use that.
14441 3. Otherwise, use the text section.
14442 XXX: If you split a variable across multiple sections, we won't notice. */
14443
14444 static const char *
14445 secname_for_decl (const_tree decl)
14446 {
14447 const char *secname;
14448
14449 if (VAR_OR_FUNCTION_DECL_P (decl)
14450 && (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) || TREE_PUBLIC (decl) || TREE_STATIC (decl))
14451 && DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl))
14452 secname = DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl);
14453 else if (current_function_decl && DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl))
14454 secname = DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl);
14455 else if (cfun && in_cold_section_p)
14456 secname = crtl->subsections.cold_section_label;
14457 else
14458 secname = text_section_label;
14459
14460 return secname;
14461 }
14462
14463 /* Return true when DECL_BY_REFERENCE is defined and set for DECL. */
14464
14465 static bool
14466 decl_by_reference_p (tree decl)
14467 {
14468 return ((TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == RESULT_DECL
14469 || TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL)
14470 && DECL_BY_REFERENCE (decl));
14471 }
14472
14473 /* Helper function for dw_loc_list. Compute proper Dwarf location descriptor
14474 for VARLOC. */
14475
14476 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14477 dw_loc_list_1 (tree loc, rtx varloc, int want_address,
14478 enum var_init_status initialized)
14479 {
14480 int have_address = 0;
14481 dw_loc_descr_ref descr;
14482 machine_mode mode;
14483
14484 if (want_address != 2)
14485 {
14486 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (varloc) == VAR_LOCATION);
14487 /* Single part. */
14488 if (GET_CODE (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (varloc)) != PARALLEL)
14489 {
14490 varloc = PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (varloc);
14491 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == EXPR_LIST)
14492 varloc = XEXP (varloc, 0);
14493 mode = GET_MODE (varloc);
14494 if (MEM_P (varloc))
14495 {
14496 rtx addr = XEXP (varloc, 0);
14497 descr = mem_loc_descriptor (addr, get_address_mode (varloc),
14498 mode, initialized);
14499 if (descr)
14500 have_address = 1;
14501 else
14502 {
14503 rtx x = avoid_constant_pool_reference (varloc);
14504 if (x != varloc)
14505 descr = mem_loc_descriptor (x, mode, VOIDmode,
14506 initialized);
14507 }
14508 }
14509 else
14510 descr = mem_loc_descriptor (varloc, mode, VOIDmode, initialized);
14511 }
14512 else
14513 return 0;
14514 }
14515 else
14516 {
14517 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == VAR_LOCATION)
14518 mode = DECL_MODE (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (varloc));
14519 else
14520 mode = DECL_MODE (loc);
14521 descr = loc_descriptor (varloc, mode, initialized);
14522 have_address = 1;
14523 }
14524
14525 if (!descr)
14526 return 0;
14527
14528 if (want_address == 2 && !have_address
14529 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
14530 {
14531 if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14532 {
14533 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
14534 "DWARF address size mismatch");
14535 return 0;
14536 }
14537 add_loc_descr (&descr, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
14538 have_address = 1;
14539 }
14540 /* Show if we can't fill the request for an address. */
14541 if (want_address && !have_address)
14542 {
14543 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
14544 "Want address and only have value");
14545 return 0;
14546 }
14547
14548 /* If we've got an address and don't want one, dereference. */
14549 if (!want_address && have_address)
14550 {
14551 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc));
14552 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
14553
14554 if (size > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE || size == -1)
14555 {
14556 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
14557 "DWARF address size mismatch");
14558 return 0;
14559 }
14560 else if (size == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14561 op = DW_OP_deref;
14562 else
14563 op = DW_OP_deref_size;
14564
14565 add_loc_descr (&descr, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
14566 }
14567
14568 return descr;
14569 }
14570
14571 /* Create a DW_OP_piece or DW_OP_bit_piece for bitsize, or return NULL
14572 if it is not possible. */
14573
14574 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14575 new_loc_descr_op_bit_piece (HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
14576 {
14577 if ((bitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0 && offset == 0)
14578 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, bitsize / BITS_PER_UNIT, 0);
14579 else if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
14580 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bit_piece, bitsize, offset);
14581 else
14582 return NULL;
14583 }
14584
14585 /* Helper function for dw_loc_list. Compute proper Dwarf location descriptor
14586 for VAR_LOC_NOTE for variable DECL that has been optimized by SRA. */
14587
14588 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14589 dw_sra_loc_expr (tree decl, rtx loc)
14590 {
14591 rtx p;
14592 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT padsize = 0;
14593 dw_loc_descr_ref descr, *descr_tail;
14594 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT decl_size;
14595 rtx varloc;
14596 enum var_init_status initialized;
14597
14598 if (DECL_SIZE (decl) == NULL
14599 || !tree_fits_uhwi_p (DECL_SIZE (decl)))
14600 return NULL;
14601
14602 decl_size = tree_to_uhwi (DECL_SIZE (decl));
14603 descr = NULL;
14604 descr_tail = &descr;
14605
14606 for (p = loc; p; p = XEXP (p, 1))
14607 {
14608 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize = decl_piece_bitsize (p);
14609 rtx loc_note = *decl_piece_varloc_ptr (p);
14610 dw_loc_descr_ref cur_descr;
14611 dw_loc_descr_ref *tail, last = NULL;
14612 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT opsize = 0;
14613
14614 if (loc_note == NULL_RTX
14615 || NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc_note) == NULL_RTX)
14616 {
14617 padsize += bitsize;
14618 continue;
14619 }
14620 initialized = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc_note);
14621 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (loc_note);
14622 cur_descr = dw_loc_list_1 (decl, varloc, 2, initialized);
14623 if (cur_descr == NULL)
14624 {
14625 padsize += bitsize;
14626 continue;
14627 }
14628
14629 /* Check that cur_descr either doesn't use
14630 DW_OP_*piece operations, or their sum is equal
14631 to bitsize. Otherwise we can't embed it. */
14632 for (tail = &cur_descr; *tail != NULL;
14633 tail = &(*tail)->dw_loc_next)
14634 if ((*tail)->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_piece)
14635 {
14636 opsize += (*tail)->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned
14637 * BITS_PER_UNIT;
14638 last = *tail;
14639 }
14640 else if ((*tail)->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bit_piece)
14641 {
14642 opsize += (*tail)->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned;
14643 last = *tail;
14644 }
14645
14646 if (last != NULL && opsize != bitsize)
14647 {
14648 padsize += bitsize;
14649 /* Discard the current piece of the descriptor and release any
14650 addr_table entries it uses. */
14651 remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (cur_descr);
14652 continue;
14653 }
14654
14655 /* If there is a hole, add DW_OP_*piece after empty DWARF
14656 expression, which means that those bits are optimized out. */
14657 if (padsize)
14658 {
14659 if (padsize > decl_size)
14660 {
14661 remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (cur_descr);
14662 goto discard_descr;
14663 }
14664 decl_size -= padsize;
14665 *descr_tail = new_loc_descr_op_bit_piece (padsize, 0);
14666 if (*descr_tail == NULL)
14667 {
14668 remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (cur_descr);
14669 goto discard_descr;
14670 }
14671 descr_tail = &(*descr_tail)->dw_loc_next;
14672 padsize = 0;
14673 }
14674 *descr_tail = cur_descr;
14675 descr_tail = tail;
14676 if (bitsize > decl_size)
14677 goto discard_descr;
14678 decl_size -= bitsize;
14679 if (last == NULL)
14680 {
14681 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
14682 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == VAR_LOCATION
14683 && GET_CODE (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (varloc)) != PARALLEL)
14684 {
14685 varloc = PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (varloc);
14686 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == EXPR_LIST)
14687 varloc = XEXP (varloc, 0);
14688 }
14689 do
14690 {
14691 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == CONST
14692 || GET_CODE (varloc) == SIGN_EXTEND
14693 || GET_CODE (varloc) == ZERO_EXTEND)
14694 varloc = XEXP (varloc, 0);
14695 else if (GET_CODE (varloc) == SUBREG)
14696 varloc = SUBREG_REG (varloc);
14697 else
14698 break;
14699 }
14700 while (1);
14701 /* DW_OP_bit_size offset should be zero for register
14702 or implicit location descriptions and empty location
14703 descriptions, but for memory addresses needs big endian
14704 adjustment. */
14705 if (MEM_P (varloc))
14706 {
14707 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT memsize
14708 = MEM_SIZE (varloc) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
14709 if (memsize != bitsize)
14710 {
14711 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN != WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
14712 && (memsize > BITS_PER_WORD || bitsize > BITS_PER_WORD))
14713 goto discard_descr;
14714 if (memsize < bitsize)
14715 goto discard_descr;
14716 if (BITS_BIG_ENDIAN)
14717 offset = memsize - bitsize;
14718 }
14719 }
14720
14721 *descr_tail = new_loc_descr_op_bit_piece (bitsize, offset);
14722 if (*descr_tail == NULL)
14723 goto discard_descr;
14724 descr_tail = &(*descr_tail)->dw_loc_next;
14725 }
14726 }
14727
14728 /* If there were any non-empty expressions, add padding till the end of
14729 the decl. */
14730 if (descr != NULL && decl_size != 0)
14731 {
14732 *descr_tail = new_loc_descr_op_bit_piece (decl_size, 0);
14733 if (*descr_tail == NULL)
14734 goto discard_descr;
14735 }
14736 return descr;
14737
14738 discard_descr:
14739 /* Discard the descriptor and release any addr_table entries it uses. */
14740 remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (descr);
14741 return NULL;
14742 }
14743
14744 /* Return the dwarf representation of the location list LOC_LIST of
14745 DECL. WANT_ADDRESS has the same meaning as in loc_list_from_tree
14746 function. */
14747
14748 static dw_loc_list_ref
14749 dw_loc_list (var_loc_list *loc_list, tree decl, int want_address)
14750 {
14751 const char *endname, *secname;
14752 rtx varloc;
14753 enum var_init_status initialized;
14754 struct var_loc_node *node;
14755 dw_loc_descr_ref descr;
14756 char label_id[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
14757 dw_loc_list_ref list = NULL;
14758 dw_loc_list_ref *listp = &list;
14759
14760 /* Now that we know what section we are using for a base,
14761 actually construct the list of locations.
14762 The first location information is what is passed to the
14763 function that creates the location list, and the remaining
14764 locations just get added on to that list.
14765 Note that we only know the start address for a location
14766 (IE location changes), so to build the range, we use
14767 the range [current location start, next location start].
14768 This means we have to special case the last node, and generate
14769 a range of [last location start, end of function label]. */
14770
14771 secname = secname_for_decl (decl);
14772
14773 for (node = loc_list->first; node; node = node->next)
14774 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == EXPR_LIST
14775 || NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node->loc) != NULL_RTX)
14776 {
14777 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == EXPR_LIST)
14778 {
14779 /* This requires DW_OP_{,bit_}piece, which is not usable
14780 inside DWARF expressions. */
14781 if (want_address != 2)
14782 continue;
14783 descr = dw_sra_loc_expr (decl, node->loc);
14784 if (descr == NULL)
14785 continue;
14786 }
14787 else
14788 {
14789 initialized = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (node->loc);
14790 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->loc);
14791 descr = dw_loc_list_1 (decl, varloc, want_address, initialized);
14792 }
14793 if (descr)
14794 {
14795 bool range_across_switch = false;
14796 /* If section switch happens in between node->label
14797 and node->next->label (or end of function) and
14798 we can't emit it as a single entry list,
14799 emit two ranges, first one ending at the end
14800 of first partition and second one starting at the
14801 beginning of second partition. */
14802 if (node == loc_list->last_before_switch
14803 && (node != loc_list->first || loc_list->first->next)
14804 && current_function_decl)
14805 {
14806 endname = cfun->fde->dw_fde_end;
14807 range_across_switch = true;
14808 }
14809 /* The variable has a location between NODE->LABEL and
14810 NODE->NEXT->LABEL. */
14811 else if (node->next)
14812 endname = node->next->label;
14813 /* If the variable has a location at the last label
14814 it keeps its location until the end of function. */
14815 else if (!current_function_decl)
14816 endname = text_end_label;
14817 else
14818 {
14819 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_END_LABEL,
14820 current_function_funcdef_no);
14821 endname = ggc_strdup (label_id);
14822 }
14823
14824 *listp = new_loc_list (descr, node->label, endname, secname);
14825 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL
14826 && node == loc_list->first
14827 && NOTE_P (node->loc)
14828 && strcmp (node->label, endname) == 0)
14829 (*listp)->force = true;
14830 listp = &(*listp)->dw_loc_next;
14831
14832 if (range_across_switch)
14833 {
14834 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == EXPR_LIST)
14835 descr = dw_sra_loc_expr (decl, node->loc);
14836 else
14837 {
14838 initialized = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (node->loc);
14839 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->loc);
14840 descr = dw_loc_list_1 (decl, varloc, want_address,
14841 initialized);
14842 }
14843 gcc_assert (descr);
14844 /* The variable has a location between NODE->LABEL and
14845 NODE->NEXT->LABEL. */
14846 if (node->next)
14847 endname = node->next->label;
14848 else
14849 endname = cfun->fde->dw_fde_second_end;
14850 *listp = new_loc_list (descr,
14851 cfun->fde->dw_fde_second_begin,
14852 endname, secname);
14853 listp = &(*listp)->dw_loc_next;
14854 }
14855 }
14856 }
14857
14858 /* Try to avoid the overhead of a location list emitting a location
14859 expression instead, but only if we didn't have more than one
14860 location entry in the first place. If some entries were not
14861 representable, we don't want to pretend a single entry that was
14862 applies to the entire scope in which the variable is
14863 available. */
14864 if (list && loc_list->first->next)
14865 gen_llsym (list);
14866
14867 return list;
14868 }
14869
14870 /* Return if the loc_list has only single element and thus can be represented
14871 as location description. */
14872
14873 static bool
14874 single_element_loc_list_p (dw_loc_list_ref list)
14875 {
14876 gcc_assert (!list->dw_loc_next || list->ll_symbol);
14877 return !list->ll_symbol;
14878 }
14879
14880 /* To each location in list LIST add loc descr REF. */
14881
14882 static void
14883 add_loc_descr_to_each (dw_loc_list_ref list, dw_loc_descr_ref ref)
14884 {
14885 dw_loc_descr_ref copy;
14886 add_loc_descr (&list->expr, ref);
14887 list = list->dw_loc_next;
14888 while (list)
14889 {
14890 copy = ggc_alloc<dw_loc_descr_node> ();
14891 memcpy (copy, ref, sizeof (dw_loc_descr_node));
14892 add_loc_descr (&list->expr, copy);
14893 while (copy->dw_loc_next)
14894 {
14895 dw_loc_descr_ref new_copy = ggc_alloc<dw_loc_descr_node> ();
14896 memcpy (new_copy, copy->dw_loc_next, sizeof (dw_loc_descr_node));
14897 copy->dw_loc_next = new_copy;
14898 copy = new_copy;
14899 }
14900 list = list->dw_loc_next;
14901 }
14902 }
14903
14904 /* Given two lists RET and LIST
14905 produce location list that is result of adding expression in LIST
14906 to expression in RET on each position in program.
14907 Might be destructive on both RET and LIST.
14908
14909 TODO: We handle only simple cases of RET or LIST having at most one
14910 element. General case would inolve sorting the lists in program order
14911 and merging them that will need some additional work.
14912 Adding that will improve quality of debug info especially for SRA-ed
14913 structures. */
14914
14915 static void
14916 add_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref *ret, dw_loc_list_ref list)
14917 {
14918 if (!list)
14919 return;
14920 if (!*ret)
14921 {
14922 *ret = list;
14923 return;
14924 }
14925 if (!list->dw_loc_next)
14926 {
14927 add_loc_descr_to_each (*ret, list->expr);
14928 return;
14929 }
14930 if (!(*ret)->dw_loc_next)
14931 {
14932 add_loc_descr_to_each (list, (*ret)->expr);
14933 *ret = list;
14934 return;
14935 }
14936 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, NULL_RTX,
14937 "Don't know how to merge two non-trivial"
14938 " location lists.\n");
14939 *ret = NULL;
14940 return;
14941 }
14942
14943 /* LOC is constant expression. Try a luck, look it up in constant
14944 pool and return its loc_descr of its address. */
14945
14946 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14947 cst_pool_loc_descr (tree loc)
14948 {
14949 /* Get an RTL for this, if something has been emitted. */
14950 rtx rtl = lookup_constant_def (loc);
14951
14952 if (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl))
14953 {
14954 gcc_assert (!rtl);
14955 return 0;
14956 }
14957 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == SYMBOL_REF);
14958
14959 /* TODO: We might get more coverage if we was actually delaying expansion
14960 of all expressions till end of compilation when constant pools are fully
14961 populated. */
14962 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (rtl, 0))))
14963 {
14964 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
14965 "CST value in contant pool but not marked.");
14966 return 0;
14967 }
14968 return mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), get_address_mode (rtl),
14969 GET_MODE (rtl), VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14970 }
14971
14972 /* Return dw_loc_list representing address of addr_expr LOC
14973 by looking for inner INDIRECT_REF expression and turning
14974 it into simple arithmetics.
14975
14976 See loc_list_from_tree for the meaning of CONTEXT. */
14977
14978 static dw_loc_list_ref
14979 loc_list_for_address_of_addr_expr_of_indirect_ref (tree loc, bool toplev,
14980 const loc_descr_context *context)
14981 {
14982 tree obj, offset;
14983 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos, bytepos;
14984 machine_mode mode;
14985 int unsignedp, reversep, volatilep = 0;
14986 dw_loc_list_ref list_ret = NULL, list_ret1 = NULL;
14987
14988 obj = get_inner_reference (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0),
14989 &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode,
14990 &unsignedp, &reversep, &volatilep, false);
14991 STRIP_NOPS (obj);
14992 if (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT)
14993 {
14994 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "bitfield access");
14995 return 0;
14996 }
14997 if (!INDIRECT_REF_P (obj))
14998 {
14999 expansion_failed (obj,
15000 NULL_RTX, "no indirect ref in inner refrence");
15001 return 0;
15002 }
15003 if (!offset && !bitpos)
15004 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (obj, 0), toplev ? 2 : 1,
15005 context);
15006 else if (toplev
15007 && int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
15008 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
15009 {
15010 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (obj, 0), 0, context);
15011 if (!list_ret)
15012 return 0;
15013 if (offset)
15014 {
15015 /* Variable offset. */
15016 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree (offset, 0, context);
15017 if (list_ret1 == 0)
15018 return 0;
15019 add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
15020 if (!list_ret)
15021 return 0;
15022 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
15023 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
15024 }
15025 bytepos = bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
15026 if (bytepos > 0)
15027 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
15028 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
15029 bytepos, 0));
15030 else if (bytepos < 0)
15031 loc_list_plus_const (list_ret, bytepos);
15032 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
15033 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
15034 }
15035 return list_ret;
15036 }
15037
15038 /* Set LOC to the next operation that is not a DW_OP_nop operation. In the case
15039 all operations from LOC are nops, move to the last one. Insert in NOPS all
15040 operations that are skipped. */
15041
15042 static void
15043 loc_descr_to_next_no_nop (dw_loc_descr_ref &loc,
15044 hash_set<dw_loc_descr_ref> &nops)
15045 {
15046 while (loc->dw_loc_next != NULL && loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_nop)
15047 {
15048 nops.add (loc);
15049 loc = loc->dw_loc_next;
15050 }
15051 }
15052
15053 /* Helper for loc_descr_without_nops: free the location description operation
15054 P. */
15055
15056 bool
15057 free_loc_descr (const dw_loc_descr_ref &loc, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
15058 {
15059 ggc_free (loc);
15060 return true;
15061 }
15062
15063 /* Remove all DW_OP_nop operations from LOC except, if it exists, the one that
15064 finishes LOC. */
15065
15066 static void
15067 loc_descr_without_nops (dw_loc_descr_ref &loc)
15068 {
15069 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_nop && loc->dw_loc_next == NULL)
15070 return;
15071
15072 /* Set of all DW_OP_nop operations we remove. */
15073 hash_set<dw_loc_descr_ref> nops;
15074
15075 /* First, strip all prefix NOP operations in order to keep the head of the
15076 operations list. */
15077 loc_descr_to_next_no_nop (loc, nops);
15078
15079 for (dw_loc_descr_ref cur = loc; cur != NULL;)
15080 {
15081 /* For control flow operations: strip "prefix" nops in destination
15082 labels. */
15083 if (cur->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_loc)
15084 loc_descr_to_next_no_nop (cur->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc, nops);
15085 if (cur->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class == dw_val_class_loc)
15086 loc_descr_to_next_no_nop (cur->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_loc, nops);
15087
15088 /* Do the same for the operations that follow, then move to the next
15089 iteration. */
15090 if (cur->dw_loc_next != NULL)
15091 loc_descr_to_next_no_nop (cur->dw_loc_next, nops);
15092 cur = cur->dw_loc_next;
15093 }
15094
15095 nops.traverse<void *, free_loc_descr> (NULL);
15096 }
15097
15098
15099 struct dwarf_procedure_info;
15100
15101 /* Helper structure for location descriptions generation. */
15102 struct loc_descr_context
15103 {
15104 /* The type that is implicitly referenced by DW_OP_push_object_address, or
15105 NULL_TREE if DW_OP_push_object_address in invalid for this location
15106 description. This is used when processing PLACEHOLDER_EXPR nodes. */
15107 tree context_type;
15108 /* The ..._DECL node that should be translated as a
15109 DW_OP_push_object_address operation. */
15110 tree base_decl;
15111 /* Information about the DWARF procedure we are currently generating. NULL if
15112 we are not generating a DWARF procedure. */
15113 struct dwarf_procedure_info *dpi;
15114 };
15115
15116 /* DWARF procedures generation
15117
15118 DWARF expressions (aka. location descriptions) are used to encode variable
15119 things such as sizes or offsets. Such computations can have redundant parts
15120 that can be factorized in order to reduce the size of the output debug
15121 information. This is the whole point of DWARF procedures.
15122
15123 Thanks to stor-layout.c, size and offset expressions in GENERIC trees are
15124 already factorized into functions ("size functions") in order to handle very
15125 big and complex types. Such functions are quite simple: they have integral
15126 arguments, they return an integral result and their body contains only a
15127 return statement with arithmetic expressions. This is the only kind of
15128 function we are interested in translating into DWARF procedures, here.
15129
15130 DWARF expressions and DWARF procedure are executed using a stack, so we have
15131 to define some calling convention for them to interact. Let's say that:
15132
15133 - Before calling a DWARF procedure, DWARF expressions must push on the stack
15134 all arguments in reverse order (right-to-left) so that when the DWARF
15135 procedure execution starts, the first argument is the top of the stack.
15136
15137 - Then, when returning, the DWARF procedure must have consumed all arguments
15138 on the stack, must have pushed the result and touched nothing else.
15139
15140 - Each integral argument and the result are integral types can be hold in a
15141 single stack slot.
15142
15143 - We call "frame offset" the number of stack slots that are "under DWARF
15144 procedure control": it includes the arguments slots, the temporaries and
15145 the result slot. Thus, it is equal to the number of arguments when the
15146 procedure execution starts and must be equal to one (the result) when it
15147 returns. */
15148
15149 /* Helper structure used when generating operations for a DWARF procedure. */
15150 struct dwarf_procedure_info
15151 {
15152 /* The FUNCTION_DECL node corresponding to the DWARF procedure that is
15153 currently translated. */
15154 tree fndecl;
15155 /* The number of arguments FNDECL takes. */
15156 unsigned args_count;
15157 };
15158
15159 /* Return a pointer to a newly created DIE node for a DWARF procedure. Add
15160 LOCATION as its DW_AT_location attribute. If FNDECL is not NULL_TREE,
15161 equate it to this DIE. */
15162
15163 static dw_die_ref
15164 new_dwarf_proc_die (dw_loc_descr_ref location, tree fndecl,
15165 dw_die_ref parent_die)
15166 {
15167 const bool dwarf_proc_supported = dwarf_version >= 4;
15168 dw_die_ref dwarf_proc_die;
15169
15170 if ((dwarf_version < 3 && dwarf_strict)
15171 || location == NULL)
15172 return NULL;
15173
15174 dwarf_proc_die = new_die (dwarf_proc_supported
15175 ? DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure
15176 : DW_TAG_variable,
15177 parent_die,
15178 fndecl);
15179 if (fndecl)
15180 equate_decl_number_to_die (fndecl, dwarf_proc_die);
15181 if (!dwarf_proc_supported)
15182 add_AT_flag (dwarf_proc_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
15183 add_AT_loc (dwarf_proc_die, DW_AT_location, location);
15184 return dwarf_proc_die;
15185 }
15186
15187 /* Return whether TYPE is a supported type as a DWARF procedure argument
15188 type or return type (we handle only scalar types and pointer types that
15189 aren't wider than the DWARF expression evaluation stack. */
15190
15191 static bool
15192 is_handled_procedure_type (tree type)
15193 {
15194 return ((INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type)
15195 || TREE_CODE (type) == OFFSET_TYPE
15196 || TREE_CODE (type) == POINTER_TYPE)
15197 && int_size_in_bytes (type) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
15198 }
15199
15200 /* Helper for resolve_args_picking. Stop when coming across VISITED nodes. */
15201
15202 static bool
15203 resolve_args_picking_1 (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, unsigned initial_frame_offset,
15204 struct dwarf_procedure_info *dpi,
15205 hash_set<dw_loc_descr_ref> &visited)
15206 {
15207 /* The "frame_offset" identifier is already used to name a macro... */
15208 unsigned frame_offset_ = initial_frame_offset;
15209 dw_loc_descr_ref l;
15210
15211 for (l = loc; l != NULL;)
15212 {
15213 /* If we already met this node, there is nothing to compute anymore. */
15214 if (visited.add (l))
15215 {
15216 #if ENABLE_CHECKING
15217 /* Make sure that the stack size is consistent wherever the execution
15218 flow comes from. */
15219 gcc_assert ((unsigned) l->dw_loc_frame_offset == frame_offset_);
15220 #endif
15221 break;
15222 }
15223 #if ENABLE_CHECKING
15224 l->dw_loc_frame_offset = frame_offset_;
15225 #endif
15226
15227 /* If needed, relocate the picking offset with respect to the frame
15228 offset. */
15229 if (l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_pick && l->frame_offset_rel)
15230 {
15231 /* frame_offset_ is the size of the current stack frame, including
15232 incoming arguments. Besides, the arguments are pushed
15233 right-to-left. Thus, in order to access the Nth argument from
15234 this operation node, the picking has to skip temporaries *plus*
15235 one stack slot per argument (0 for the first one, 1 for the second
15236 one, etc.).
15237
15238 The targetted argument number (N) is already set as the operand,
15239 and the number of temporaries can be computed with:
15240 frame_offsets_ - dpi->args_count */
15241 l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned += frame_offset_ - dpi->args_count;
15242
15243 /* DW_OP_pick handles only offsets from 0 to 255 (inclusive)... */
15244 if (l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned > 255)
15245 return false;
15246 }
15247
15248 /* Update frame_offset according to the effect the current operation has
15249 on the stack. */
15250 switch (l->dw_loc_opc)
15251 {
15252 case DW_OP_deref:
15253 case DW_OP_swap:
15254 case DW_OP_rot:
15255 case DW_OP_abs:
15256 case DW_OP_not:
15257 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
15258 case DW_OP_skip:
15259 case DW_OP_reg0:
15260 case DW_OP_reg1:
15261 case DW_OP_reg2:
15262 case DW_OP_reg3:
15263 case DW_OP_reg4:
15264 case DW_OP_reg5:
15265 case DW_OP_reg6:
15266 case DW_OP_reg7:
15267 case DW_OP_reg8:
15268 case DW_OP_reg9:
15269 case DW_OP_reg10:
15270 case DW_OP_reg11:
15271 case DW_OP_reg12:
15272 case DW_OP_reg13:
15273 case DW_OP_reg14:
15274 case DW_OP_reg15:
15275 case DW_OP_reg16:
15276 case DW_OP_reg17:
15277 case DW_OP_reg18:
15278 case DW_OP_reg19:
15279 case DW_OP_reg20:
15280 case DW_OP_reg21:
15281 case DW_OP_reg22:
15282 case DW_OP_reg23:
15283 case DW_OP_reg24:
15284 case DW_OP_reg25:
15285 case DW_OP_reg26:
15286 case DW_OP_reg27:
15287 case DW_OP_reg28:
15288 case DW_OP_reg29:
15289 case DW_OP_reg30:
15290 case DW_OP_reg31:
15291 case DW_OP_bregx:
15292 case DW_OP_piece:
15293 case DW_OP_deref_size:
15294 case DW_OP_nop:
15295 case DW_OP_form_tls_address:
15296 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
15297 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
15298 case DW_OP_stack_value:
15299 break;
15300
15301 case DW_OP_addr:
15302 case DW_OP_const1u:
15303 case DW_OP_const1s:
15304 case DW_OP_const2u:
15305 case DW_OP_const2s:
15306 case DW_OP_const4u:
15307 case DW_OP_const4s:
15308 case DW_OP_const8u:
15309 case DW_OP_const8s:
15310 case DW_OP_constu:
15311 case DW_OP_consts:
15312 case DW_OP_dup:
15313 case DW_OP_over:
15314 case DW_OP_pick:
15315 case DW_OP_lit0:
15316 case DW_OP_lit1:
15317 case DW_OP_lit2:
15318 case DW_OP_lit3:
15319 case DW_OP_lit4:
15320 case DW_OP_lit5:
15321 case DW_OP_lit6:
15322 case DW_OP_lit7:
15323 case DW_OP_lit8:
15324 case DW_OP_lit9:
15325 case DW_OP_lit10:
15326 case DW_OP_lit11:
15327 case DW_OP_lit12:
15328 case DW_OP_lit13:
15329 case DW_OP_lit14:
15330 case DW_OP_lit15:
15331 case DW_OP_lit16:
15332 case DW_OP_lit17:
15333 case DW_OP_lit18:
15334 case DW_OP_lit19:
15335 case DW_OP_lit20:
15336 case DW_OP_lit21:
15337 case DW_OP_lit22:
15338 case DW_OP_lit23:
15339 case DW_OP_lit24:
15340 case DW_OP_lit25:
15341 case DW_OP_lit26:
15342 case DW_OP_lit27:
15343 case DW_OP_lit28:
15344 case DW_OP_lit29:
15345 case DW_OP_lit30:
15346 case DW_OP_lit31:
15347 case DW_OP_breg0:
15348 case DW_OP_breg1:
15349 case DW_OP_breg2:
15350 case DW_OP_breg3:
15351 case DW_OP_breg4:
15352 case DW_OP_breg5:
15353 case DW_OP_breg6:
15354 case DW_OP_breg7:
15355 case DW_OP_breg8:
15356 case DW_OP_breg9:
15357 case DW_OP_breg10:
15358 case DW_OP_breg11:
15359 case DW_OP_breg12:
15360 case DW_OP_breg13:
15361 case DW_OP_breg14:
15362 case DW_OP_breg15:
15363 case DW_OP_breg16:
15364 case DW_OP_breg17:
15365 case DW_OP_breg18:
15366 case DW_OP_breg19:
15367 case DW_OP_breg20:
15368 case DW_OP_breg21:
15369 case DW_OP_breg22:
15370 case DW_OP_breg23:
15371 case DW_OP_breg24:
15372 case DW_OP_breg25:
15373 case DW_OP_breg26:
15374 case DW_OP_breg27:
15375 case DW_OP_breg28:
15376 case DW_OP_breg29:
15377 case DW_OP_breg30:
15378 case DW_OP_breg31:
15379 case DW_OP_fbreg:
15380 case DW_OP_push_object_address:
15381 case DW_OP_call_frame_cfa:
15382 ++frame_offset_;
15383 break;
15384
15385 case DW_OP_drop:
15386 case DW_OP_xderef:
15387 case DW_OP_and:
15388 case DW_OP_div:
15389 case DW_OP_minus:
15390 case DW_OP_mod:
15391 case DW_OP_mul:
15392 case DW_OP_neg:
15393 case DW_OP_or:
15394 case DW_OP_plus:
15395 case DW_OP_shl:
15396 case DW_OP_shr:
15397 case DW_OP_shra:
15398 case DW_OP_xor:
15399 case DW_OP_bra:
15400 case DW_OP_eq:
15401 case DW_OP_ge:
15402 case DW_OP_gt:
15403 case DW_OP_le:
15404 case DW_OP_lt:
15405 case DW_OP_ne:
15406 case DW_OP_regx:
15407 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
15408 --frame_offset_;
15409 break;
15410
15411 case DW_OP_call2:
15412 case DW_OP_call4:
15413 case DW_OP_call_ref:
15414 {
15415 dw_die_ref dwarf_proc = l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die;
15416 int *stack_usage = dwarf_proc_stack_usage_map->get (dwarf_proc);
15417
15418 if (stack_usage == NULL)
15419 return false;
15420 frame_offset += *stack_usage;
15421 break;
15422 }
15423
15424 case DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address:
15425 case DW_OP_GNU_uninit:
15426 case DW_OP_GNU_encoded_addr:
15427 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
15428 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
15429 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
15430 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
15431 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
15432 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
15433 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
15434 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
15435 /* loc_list_from_tree will probably not output these operations for
15436 size functions, so assume they will not appear here. */
15437 /* Fall through... */
15438
15439 default:
15440 gcc_unreachable ();
15441 }
15442
15443 /* Now, follow the control flow (except subroutine calls). */
15444 switch (l->dw_loc_opc)
15445 {
15446 case DW_OP_bra:
15447 if (!resolve_args_picking_1 (l->dw_loc_next, frame_offset_, dpi,
15448 visited))
15449 return false;
15450 /* Fall through... */
15451
15452 case DW_OP_skip:
15453 l = l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc;
15454 break;
15455
15456 case DW_OP_stack_value:
15457 return true;
15458
15459 default:
15460 l = l->dw_loc_next;
15461 break;
15462 }
15463 }
15464
15465 return true;
15466 }
15467
15468 /* Make a DFS over operations reachable through LOC (i.e. follow branch
15469 operations) in order to resolve the operand of DW_OP_pick operations that
15470 target DWARF procedure arguments (DPI). Stop at already visited nodes.
15471 INITIAL_FRAME_OFFSET is the frame offset *before* LOC is executed. Return
15472 if all relocations were successful. */
15473
15474 static bool
15475 resolve_args_picking (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, unsigned initial_frame_offset,
15476 struct dwarf_procedure_info *dpi)
15477 {
15478 hash_set<dw_loc_descr_ref> visited;
15479
15480 return resolve_args_picking_1 (loc, initial_frame_offset, dpi, visited);
15481 }
15482
15483 /* Try to generate a DWARF procedure that computes the same result as FNDECL.
15484 Return NULL if it is not possible. */
15485
15486 static dw_die_ref
15487 function_to_dwarf_procedure (tree fndecl)
15488 {
15489 struct loc_descr_context ctx;
15490 struct dwarf_procedure_info dpi;
15491 dw_die_ref dwarf_proc_die;
15492 tree tree_body = DECL_SAVED_TREE (fndecl);
15493 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_body, epilogue;
15494
15495 tree cursor;
15496 unsigned i;
15497
15498 /* Do not generate multiple DWARF procedures for the same function
15499 declaration. */
15500 dwarf_proc_die = lookup_decl_die (fndecl);
15501 if (dwarf_proc_die != NULL)
15502 return dwarf_proc_die;
15503
15504 /* DWARF procedures are available starting with the DWARFv3 standard, but
15505 it's the DWARFv4 standard that introduces the DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure
15506 DIE. */
15507 if (dwarf_version < 3 && dwarf_strict)
15508 return NULL;
15509
15510 /* We handle only functions for which we still have a body, that return a
15511 supported type and that takes arguments with supported types. Note that
15512 there is no point translating functions that return nothing. */
15513 if (tree_body == NULL_TREE
15514 || DECL_RESULT (fndecl) == NULL_TREE
15515 || !is_handled_procedure_type (TREE_TYPE (DECL_RESULT (fndecl))))
15516 return NULL;
15517
15518 for (cursor = DECL_ARGUMENTS (fndecl);
15519 cursor != NULL_TREE;
15520 cursor = TREE_CHAIN (cursor))
15521 if (!is_handled_procedure_type (TREE_TYPE (cursor)))
15522 return NULL;
15523
15524 /* Match only "expr" in: RETURN_EXPR (MODIFY_EXPR (RESULT_DECL, expr)). */
15525 if (TREE_CODE (tree_body) != RETURN_EXPR)
15526 return NULL;
15527 tree_body = TREE_OPERAND (tree_body, 0);
15528 if (TREE_CODE (tree_body) != MODIFY_EXPR
15529 || TREE_OPERAND (tree_body, 0) != DECL_RESULT (fndecl))
15530 return NULL;
15531 tree_body = TREE_OPERAND (tree_body, 1);
15532
15533 /* Try to translate the body expression itself. Note that this will probably
15534 cause an infinite recursion if its call graph has a cycle. This is very
15535 unlikely for size functions, however, so don't bother with such things at
15536 the moment. */
15537 ctx.context_type = NULL_TREE;
15538 ctx.base_decl = NULL_TREE;
15539 ctx.dpi = &dpi;
15540 dpi.fndecl = fndecl;
15541 dpi.args_count = list_length (DECL_ARGUMENTS (fndecl));
15542 loc_body = loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree_body, 0, &ctx);
15543 if (!loc_body)
15544 return NULL;
15545
15546 /* After evaluating all operands in "loc_body", we should still have on the
15547 stack all arguments plus the desired function result (top of the stack).
15548 Generate code in order to keep only the result in our stack frame. */
15549 epilogue = NULL;
15550 for (i = 0; i < dpi.args_count; ++i)
15551 {
15552 dw_loc_descr_ref op_couple = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0);
15553 op_couple->dw_loc_next = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
15554 op_couple->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_next = epilogue;
15555 epilogue = op_couple;
15556 }
15557 add_loc_descr (&loc_body, epilogue);
15558 if (!resolve_args_picking (loc_body, dpi.args_count, &dpi))
15559 return NULL;
15560
15561 /* Trailing nops from loc_descriptor_from_tree (if any) cannot be removed
15562 because they are considered useful. Now there is an epilogue, they are
15563 not anymore, so give it another try. */
15564 loc_descr_without_nops (loc_body);
15565
15566 /* fndecl may be used both as a regular DW_TAG_subprogram DIE and as
15567 a DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure, so we may have a conflict, here. It's unlikely,
15568 though, given that size functions do not come from source, so they should
15569 not have a dedicated DW_TAG_subprogram DIE. */
15570 dwarf_proc_die
15571 = new_dwarf_proc_die (loc_body, fndecl,
15572 get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (fndecl)));
15573
15574 /* The called DWARF procedure consumes one stack slot per argument and
15575 returns one stack slot. */
15576 dwarf_proc_stack_usage_map->put (dwarf_proc_die, 1 - dpi.args_count);
15577
15578 return dwarf_proc_die;
15579 }
15580
15581
15582 /* Generate Dwarf location list representing LOC.
15583 If WANT_ADDRESS is false, expression computing LOC will be computed
15584 If WANT_ADDRESS is 1, expression computing address of LOC will be returned
15585 if WANT_ADDRESS is 2, expression computing address useable in location
15586 will be returned (i.e. DW_OP_reg can be used
15587 to refer to register values).
15588
15589 CONTEXT provides information to customize the location descriptions
15590 generation. Its context_type field specifies what type is implicitly
15591 referenced by DW_OP_push_object_address. If it is NULL_TREE, this operation
15592 will not be generated.
15593
15594 Its DPI field determines whether we are generating a DWARF expression for a
15595 DWARF procedure, so PARM_DECL references are processed specifically.
15596
15597 If CONTEXT is NULL, the behavior is the same as if context_type, base_decl
15598 and dpi fields were null. */
15599
15600 static dw_loc_list_ref
15601 loc_list_from_tree_1 (tree loc, int want_address,
15602 const struct loc_descr_context *context)
15603 {
15604 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = NULL, ret1 = NULL;
15605 dw_loc_list_ref list_ret = NULL, list_ret1 = NULL;
15606 int have_address = 0;
15607 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
15608
15609 /* ??? Most of the time we do not take proper care for sign/zero
15610 extending the values properly. Hopefully this won't be a real
15611 problem... */
15612
15613 if (context != NULL
15614 && context->base_decl == loc
15615 && want_address == 0)
15616 {
15617 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
15618 return new_loc_list (new_loc_descr (DW_OP_push_object_address, 0, 0),
15619 NULL, NULL, NULL);
15620 else
15621 return NULL;
15622 }
15623
15624 switch (TREE_CODE (loc))
15625 {
15626 case ERROR_MARK:
15627 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "ERROR_MARK");
15628 return 0;
15629
15630 case PLACEHOLDER_EXPR:
15631 /* This case involves extracting fields from an object to determine the
15632 position of other fields. It is supposed to appear only as the first
15633 operand of COMPONENT_REF nodes and to reference precisely the type
15634 that the context allows. */
15635 if (context != NULL
15636 && TREE_TYPE (loc) == context->context_type
15637 && want_address >= 1)
15638 {
15639 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
15640 {
15641 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_push_object_address, 0, 0);
15642 have_address = 1;
15643 break;
15644 }
15645 else
15646 return NULL;
15647 }
15648 else
15649 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
15650 "PLACEHOLDER_EXPR for an unexpected type");
15651 break;
15652
15653 case CALL_EXPR:
15654 {
15655 const int nargs = call_expr_nargs (loc);
15656 tree callee = get_callee_fndecl (loc);
15657 int i;
15658 dw_die_ref dwarf_proc;
15659
15660 if (callee == NULL_TREE)
15661 goto call_expansion_failed;
15662
15663 /* We handle only functions that return an integer. */
15664 if (!is_handled_procedure_type (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (callee))))
15665 goto call_expansion_failed;
15666
15667 dwarf_proc = function_to_dwarf_procedure (callee);
15668 if (dwarf_proc == NULL)
15669 goto call_expansion_failed;
15670
15671 /* Evaluate arguments right-to-left so that the first argument will
15672 be the top-most one on the stack. */
15673 for (i = nargs - 1; i >= 0; --i)
15674 {
15675 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descr
15676 = loc_descriptor_from_tree (CALL_EXPR_ARG (loc, i), 0,
15677 context);
15678
15679 if (loc_descr == NULL)
15680 goto call_expansion_failed;
15681
15682 add_loc_descr (&ret, loc_descr);
15683 }
15684
15685 ret1 = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_call4, 0, 0);
15686 ret1->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
15687 ret1->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = dwarf_proc;
15688 ret1->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
15689 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
15690 break;
15691
15692 call_expansion_failed:
15693 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "CALL_EXPR");
15694 /* There are no opcodes for these operations. */
15695 return 0;
15696 }
15697
15698 case PREINCREMENT_EXPR:
15699 case PREDECREMENT_EXPR:
15700 case POSTINCREMENT_EXPR:
15701 case POSTDECREMENT_EXPR:
15702 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "PRE/POST INDCREMENT/DECREMENT");
15703 /* There are no opcodes for these operations. */
15704 return 0;
15705
15706 case ADDR_EXPR:
15707 /* If we already want an address, see if there is INDIRECT_REF inside
15708 e.g. for &this->field. */
15709 if (want_address)
15710 {
15711 list_ret = loc_list_for_address_of_addr_expr_of_indirect_ref
15712 (loc, want_address == 2, context);
15713 if (list_ret)
15714 have_address = 1;
15715 else if (decl_address_ip_invariant_p (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))
15716 && (ret = cst_pool_loc_descr (loc)))
15717 have_address = 1;
15718 }
15719 /* Otherwise, process the argument and look for the address. */
15720 if (!list_ret && !ret)
15721 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 1, context);
15722 else
15723 {
15724 if (want_address)
15725 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "need address of ADDR_EXPR");
15726 return NULL;
15727 }
15728 break;
15729
15730 case VAR_DECL:
15731 if (DECL_THREAD_LOCAL_P (loc))
15732 {
15733 rtx rtl;
15734 enum dwarf_location_atom tls_op;
15735 enum dtprel_bool dtprel = dtprel_false;
15736
15737 if (targetm.have_tls)
15738 {
15739 /* If this is not defined, we have no way to emit the
15740 data. */
15741 if (!targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
15742 return 0;
15743
15744 /* The way DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address is specified, we
15745 can only look up addresses of objects in the current
15746 module. We used DW_OP_addr as first op, but that's
15747 wrong, because DW_OP_addr is relocated by the debug
15748 info consumer, while DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address
15749 operand shouldn't be. */
15750 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (loc) && !targetm.binds_local_p (loc))
15751 return 0;
15752 dtprel = dtprel_true;
15753 tls_op = DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address;
15754 }
15755 else
15756 {
15757 if (!targetm.emutls.debug_form_tls_address
15758 || !(dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
15759 return 0;
15760 /* We stuffed the control variable into the DECL_VALUE_EXPR
15761 to signal (via DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P) that the decl should
15762 no longer appear in gimple code. We used the control
15763 variable in specific so that we could pick it up here. */
15764 loc = DECL_VALUE_EXPR (loc);
15765 tls_op = DW_OP_form_tls_address;
15766 }
15767
15768 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
15769 if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
15770 return 0;
15771
15772 if (!MEM_P (rtl))
15773 return 0;
15774 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
15775 if (! CONSTANT_P (rtl))
15776 return 0;
15777
15778 ret = new_addr_loc_descr (rtl, dtprel);
15779 ret1 = new_loc_descr (tls_op, 0, 0);
15780 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
15781
15782 have_address = 1;
15783 break;
15784 }
15785 /* FALLTHRU */
15786
15787 case PARM_DECL:
15788 if (context != NULL && context->dpi != NULL
15789 && DECL_CONTEXT (loc) == context->dpi->fndecl)
15790 {
15791 /* We are generating code for a DWARF procedure and we want to access
15792 one of its arguments: find the appropriate argument offset and let
15793 the resolve_args_picking pass compute the offset that complies
15794 with the stack frame size. */
15795 unsigned i = 0;
15796 tree cursor;
15797
15798 for (cursor = DECL_ARGUMENTS (context->dpi->fndecl);
15799 cursor != NULL_TREE && cursor != loc;
15800 cursor = TREE_CHAIN (cursor), ++i)
15801 ;
15802 /* If we are translating a DWARF procedure, all referenced parameters
15803 must belong to the current function. */
15804 gcc_assert (cursor != NULL_TREE);
15805
15806 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_pick, i, 0);
15807 ret->frame_offset_rel = 1;
15808 break;
15809 }
15810 /* FALLTHRU */
15811
15812 case RESULT_DECL:
15813 if (DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (loc))
15814 return loc_list_from_tree_1 (DECL_VALUE_EXPR (loc),
15815 want_address, context);
15816 /* FALLTHRU */
15817
15818 case FUNCTION_DECL:
15819 {
15820 rtx rtl;
15821 var_loc_list *loc_list = lookup_decl_loc (loc);
15822
15823 if (loc_list && loc_list->first)
15824 {
15825 list_ret = dw_loc_list (loc_list, loc, want_address);
15826 have_address = want_address != 0;
15827 break;
15828 }
15829 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
15830 if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
15831 {
15832 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "DECL has no RTL");
15833 return 0;
15834 }
15835 else if (CONST_INT_P (rtl))
15836 {
15837 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (rtl);
15838 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
15839 val &= GET_MODE_MASK (DECL_MODE (loc));
15840 ret = int_loc_descriptor (val);
15841 }
15842 else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
15843 {
15844 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "CONST_STRING");
15845 return 0;
15846 }
15847 else if (CONSTANT_P (rtl) && const_ok_for_output (rtl))
15848 ret = new_addr_loc_descr (rtl, dtprel_false);
15849 else
15850 {
15851 machine_mode mode, mem_mode;
15852
15853 /* Certain constructs can only be represented at top-level. */
15854 if (want_address == 2)
15855 {
15856 ret = loc_descriptor (rtl, VOIDmode,
15857 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15858 have_address = 1;
15859 }
15860 else
15861 {
15862 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
15863 mem_mode = VOIDmode;
15864 if (MEM_P (rtl))
15865 {
15866 mem_mode = mode;
15867 mode = get_address_mode (rtl);
15868 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
15869 have_address = 1;
15870 }
15871 ret = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, mem_mode,
15872 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15873 }
15874 if (!ret)
15875 expansion_failed (loc, rtl,
15876 "failed to produce loc descriptor for rtl");
15877 }
15878 }
15879 break;
15880
15881 case MEM_REF:
15882 if (!integer_zerop (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)))
15883 {
15884 have_address = 1;
15885 goto do_plus;
15886 }
15887 /* Fallthru. */
15888 case INDIRECT_REF:
15889 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
15890 have_address = 1;
15891 break;
15892
15893 case TARGET_MEM_REF:
15894 case SSA_NAME:
15895 case DEBUG_EXPR_DECL:
15896 return NULL;
15897
15898 case COMPOUND_EXPR:
15899 return loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), want_address,
15900 context);
15901
15902 CASE_CONVERT:
15903 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
15904 case SAVE_EXPR:
15905 case MODIFY_EXPR:
15906 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
15907 return loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), want_address,
15908 context);
15909
15910 case COMPONENT_REF:
15911 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
15912 case ARRAY_REF:
15913 case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
15914 case REALPART_EXPR:
15915 case IMAGPART_EXPR:
15916 {
15917 tree obj, offset;
15918 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos, bytepos;
15919 machine_mode mode;
15920 int unsignedp, reversep, volatilep = 0;
15921
15922 obj = get_inner_reference (loc, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode,
15923 &unsignedp, &reversep, &volatilep, false);
15924
15925 gcc_assert (obj != loc);
15926
15927 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (obj,
15928 want_address == 2
15929 && !bitpos && !offset ? 2 : 1,
15930 context);
15931 /* TODO: We can extract value of the small expression via shifting even
15932 for nonzero bitpos. */
15933 if (list_ret == 0)
15934 return 0;
15935 if (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0 || bitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0)
15936 {
15937 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
15938 "bitfield access");
15939 return 0;
15940 }
15941
15942 if (offset != NULL_TREE)
15943 {
15944 /* Variable offset. */
15945 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree_1 (offset, 0, context);
15946 if (list_ret1 == 0)
15947 return 0;
15948 add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
15949 if (!list_ret)
15950 return 0;
15951 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
15952 }
15953
15954 bytepos = bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
15955 if (bytepos > 0)
15956 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bytepos, 0));
15957 else if (bytepos < 0)
15958 loc_list_plus_const (list_ret, bytepos);
15959
15960 have_address = 1;
15961 break;
15962 }
15963
15964 case INTEGER_CST:
15965 if ((want_address || !tree_fits_shwi_p (loc))
15966 && (ret = cst_pool_loc_descr (loc)))
15967 have_address = 1;
15968 else if (want_address == 2
15969 && tree_fits_shwi_p (loc)
15970 && (ret = address_of_int_loc_descriptor
15971 (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)),
15972 tree_to_shwi (loc))))
15973 have_address = 1;
15974 else if (tree_fits_shwi_p (loc))
15975 ret = int_loc_descriptor (tree_to_shwi (loc));
15976 else if (tree_fits_uhwi_p (loc))
15977 ret = uint_loc_descriptor (tree_to_uhwi (loc));
15978 else
15979 {
15980 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
15981 "Integer operand is not host integer");
15982 return 0;
15983 }
15984 break;
15985
15986 case CONSTRUCTOR:
15987 case REAL_CST:
15988 case STRING_CST:
15989 case COMPLEX_CST:
15990 if ((ret = cst_pool_loc_descr (loc)))
15991 have_address = 1;
15992 else
15993 /* We can construct small constants here using int_loc_descriptor. */
15994 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
15995 "constructor or constant not in constant pool");
15996 break;
15997
15998 case TRUTH_AND_EXPR:
15999 case TRUTH_ANDIF_EXPR:
16000 case BIT_AND_EXPR:
16001 op = DW_OP_and;
16002 goto do_binop;
16003
16004 case TRUTH_XOR_EXPR:
16005 case BIT_XOR_EXPR:
16006 op = DW_OP_xor;
16007 goto do_binop;
16008
16009 case TRUTH_OR_EXPR:
16010 case TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR:
16011 case BIT_IOR_EXPR:
16012 op = DW_OP_or;
16013 goto do_binop;
16014
16015 case FLOOR_DIV_EXPR:
16016 case CEIL_DIV_EXPR:
16017 case ROUND_DIV_EXPR:
16018 case TRUNC_DIV_EXPR:
16019 case EXACT_DIV_EXPR:
16020 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
16021 return 0;
16022 op = DW_OP_div;
16023 goto do_binop;
16024
16025 case MINUS_EXPR:
16026 op = DW_OP_minus;
16027 goto do_binop;
16028
16029 case FLOOR_MOD_EXPR:
16030 case CEIL_MOD_EXPR:
16031 case ROUND_MOD_EXPR:
16032 case TRUNC_MOD_EXPR:
16033 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
16034 {
16035 op = DW_OP_mod;
16036 goto do_binop;
16037 }
16038 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
16039 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0, context);
16040 if (list_ret == 0 || list_ret1 == 0)
16041 return 0;
16042
16043 add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
16044 if (list_ret == 0)
16045 return 0;
16046 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
16047 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
16048 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_div, 0, 0));
16049 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_mul, 0, 0));
16050 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
16051 break;
16052
16053 case MULT_EXPR:
16054 op = DW_OP_mul;
16055 goto do_binop;
16056
16057 case LSHIFT_EXPR:
16058 op = DW_OP_shl;
16059 goto do_binop;
16060
16061 case RSHIFT_EXPR:
16062 op = (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)) ? DW_OP_shr : DW_OP_shra);
16063 goto do_binop;
16064
16065 case POINTER_PLUS_EXPR:
16066 case PLUS_EXPR:
16067 do_plus:
16068 if (tree_fits_shwi_p (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)))
16069 {
16070 /* Big unsigned numbers can fit in HOST_WIDE_INT but it may be
16071 smarter to encode their opposite. The DW_OP_plus_uconst operation
16072 takes 1 + X bytes, X being the size of the ULEB128 addend. On the
16073 other hand, a "<push literal>; DW_OP_minus" pattern takes 1 + Y
16074 bytes, Y being the size of the operation that pushes the opposite
16075 of the addend. So let's choose the smallest representation. */
16076 const tree tree_addend = TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1);
16077 offset_int wi_addend;
16078 HOST_WIDE_INT shwi_addend;
16079 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_naddend;
16080
16081 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
16082 if (list_ret == 0)
16083 return 0;
16084
16085 /* Try to get the literal to push. It is the opposite of the addend,
16086 so as we rely on wrapping during DWARF evaluation, first decode
16087 the literal as a "DWARF-sized" signed number. */
16088 wi_addend = wi::to_offset (tree_addend);
16089 wi_addend = wi::sext (wi_addend, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 8);
16090 shwi_addend = wi_addend.to_shwi ();
16091 loc_naddend = (shwi_addend != INTTYPE_MINIMUM (HOST_WIDE_INT))
16092 ? int_loc_descriptor (-shwi_addend)
16093 : NULL;
16094
16095 if (loc_naddend != NULL
16096 && ((unsigned) size_of_uleb128 (shwi_addend)
16097 > size_of_loc_descr (loc_naddend)))
16098 {
16099 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, loc_naddend);
16100 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
16101 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
16102 }
16103 else
16104 {
16105 for (dw_loc_descr_ref loc_cur = loc_naddend; loc_cur != NULL; )
16106 {
16107 loc_naddend = loc_cur;
16108 loc_cur = loc_cur->dw_loc_next;
16109 ggc_free (loc_naddend);
16110 }
16111 loc_list_plus_const (list_ret, wi_addend.to_shwi ());
16112 }
16113 break;
16114 }
16115
16116 op = DW_OP_plus;
16117 goto do_binop;
16118
16119 case LE_EXPR:
16120 op = DW_OP_le;
16121 goto do_comp_binop;
16122
16123 case GE_EXPR:
16124 op = DW_OP_ge;
16125 goto do_comp_binop;
16126
16127 case LT_EXPR:
16128 op = DW_OP_lt;
16129 goto do_comp_binop;
16130
16131 case GT_EXPR:
16132 op = DW_OP_gt;
16133 goto do_comp_binop;
16134
16135 do_comp_binop:
16136 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
16137 {
16138 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
16139 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0, context);
16140 list_ret = loc_list_from_uint_comparison (list_ret, list_ret1,
16141 TREE_CODE (loc));
16142 break;
16143 }
16144 else
16145 goto do_binop;
16146
16147 case EQ_EXPR:
16148 op = DW_OP_eq;
16149 goto do_binop;
16150
16151 case NE_EXPR:
16152 op = DW_OP_ne;
16153 goto do_binop;
16154
16155 do_binop:
16156 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
16157 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0, context);
16158 if (list_ret == 0 || list_ret1 == 0)
16159 return 0;
16160
16161 add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
16162 if (list_ret == 0)
16163 return 0;
16164 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
16165 break;
16166
16167 case TRUTH_NOT_EXPR:
16168 case BIT_NOT_EXPR:
16169 op = DW_OP_not;
16170 goto do_unop;
16171
16172 case ABS_EXPR:
16173 op = DW_OP_abs;
16174 goto do_unop;
16175
16176 case NEGATE_EXPR:
16177 op = DW_OP_neg;
16178 goto do_unop;
16179
16180 do_unop:
16181 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
16182 if (list_ret == 0)
16183 return 0;
16184
16185 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
16186 break;
16187
16188 case MIN_EXPR:
16189 case MAX_EXPR:
16190 {
16191 const enum tree_code code =
16192 TREE_CODE (loc) == MIN_EXPR ? GT_EXPR : LT_EXPR;
16193
16194 loc = build3 (COND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (loc),
16195 build2 (code, integer_type_node,
16196 TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)),
16197 TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0));
16198 }
16199
16200 /* ... fall through ... */
16201
16202 case COND_EXPR:
16203 {
16204 dw_loc_descr_ref lhs
16205 = loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0, context);
16206 dw_loc_list_ref rhs
16207 = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 2), 0, context);
16208 dw_loc_descr_ref bra_node, jump_node, tmp;
16209
16210 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0, context);
16211 if (list_ret == 0 || lhs == 0 || rhs == 0)
16212 return 0;
16213
16214 bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
16215 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, bra_node);
16216
16217 add_loc_list (&list_ret, rhs);
16218 jump_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
16219 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, jump_node);
16220
16221 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, lhs);
16222 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
16223 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = lhs;
16224
16225 /* ??? Need a node to point the skip at. Use a nop. */
16226 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_nop, 0, 0);
16227 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, tmp);
16228 jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
16229 jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = tmp;
16230 }
16231 break;
16232
16233 case FIX_TRUNC_EXPR:
16234 return 0;
16235
16236 default:
16237 /* Leave front-end specific codes as simply unknown. This comes
16238 up, for instance, with the C STMT_EXPR. */
16239 if ((unsigned int) TREE_CODE (loc)
16240 >= (unsigned int) LAST_AND_UNUSED_TREE_CODE)
16241 {
16242 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
16243 "language specific tree node");
16244 return 0;
16245 }
16246
16247 /* Otherwise this is a generic code; we should just lists all of
16248 these explicitly. We forgot one. */
16249 if (flag_checking)
16250 gcc_unreachable ();
16251
16252 /* In a release build, we want to degrade gracefully: better to
16253 generate incomplete debugging information than to crash. */
16254 return NULL;
16255 }
16256
16257 if (!ret && !list_ret)
16258 return 0;
16259
16260 if (want_address == 2 && !have_address
16261 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
16262 {
16263 if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
16264 {
16265 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
16266 "DWARF address size mismatch");
16267 return 0;
16268 }
16269 if (ret)
16270 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
16271 else
16272 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
16273 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
16274 have_address = 1;
16275 }
16276 /* Show if we can't fill the request for an address. */
16277 if (want_address && !have_address)
16278 {
16279 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
16280 "Want address and only have value");
16281 return 0;
16282 }
16283
16284 gcc_assert (!ret || !list_ret);
16285
16286 /* If we've got an address and don't want one, dereference. */
16287 if (!want_address && have_address)
16288 {
16289 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc));
16290
16291 if (size > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE || size == -1)
16292 {
16293 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
16294 "DWARF address size mismatch");
16295 return 0;
16296 }
16297 else if (size == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
16298 op = DW_OP_deref;
16299 else
16300 op = DW_OP_deref_size;
16301
16302 if (ret)
16303 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
16304 else
16305 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
16306 }
16307 if (ret)
16308 list_ret = new_loc_list (ret, NULL, NULL, NULL);
16309
16310 return list_ret;
16311 }
16312
16313 /* Likewise, but strip useless DW_OP_nop operations in the resulting
16314 expressions. */
16315
16316 static dw_loc_list_ref
16317 loc_list_from_tree (tree loc, int want_address,
16318 const struct loc_descr_context *context)
16319 {
16320 dw_loc_list_ref result = loc_list_from_tree_1 (loc, want_address, context);
16321
16322 for (dw_loc_list_ref loc_cur = result;
16323 loc_cur != NULL; loc_cur =
16324 loc_cur->dw_loc_next)
16325 loc_descr_without_nops (loc_cur->expr);
16326 return result;
16327 }
16328
16329 /* Same as above but return only single location expression. */
16330 static dw_loc_descr_ref
16331 loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree loc, int want_address,
16332 const struct loc_descr_context *context)
16333 {
16334 dw_loc_list_ref ret = loc_list_from_tree (loc, want_address, context);
16335 if (!ret)
16336 return NULL;
16337 if (ret->dw_loc_next)
16338 {
16339 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
16340 "Location list where only loc descriptor needed");
16341 return NULL;
16342 }
16343 return ret->expr;
16344 }
16345
16346 /* Given a value, round it up to the lowest multiple of `boundary'
16347 which is not less than the value itself. */
16348
16349 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
16350 ceiling (HOST_WIDE_INT value, unsigned int boundary)
16351 {
16352 return (((value + boundary - 1) / boundary) * boundary);
16353 }
16354
16355 /* Given a pointer to what is assumed to be a FIELD_DECL node, return a
16356 pointer to the declared type for the relevant field variable, or return
16357 `integer_type_node' if the given node turns out to be an
16358 ERROR_MARK node. */
16359
16360 static inline tree
16361 field_type (const_tree decl)
16362 {
16363 tree type;
16364
16365 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
16366 return integer_type_node;
16367
16368 type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
16369 if (type == NULL_TREE)
16370 type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
16371
16372 return type;
16373 }
16374
16375 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, return the alignment in bits for
16376 it, or else return BITS_PER_WORD if the node actually turns out to
16377 be an ERROR_MARK node. */
16378
16379 static inline unsigned
16380 simple_type_align_in_bits (const_tree type)
16381 {
16382 return (TREE_CODE (type) != ERROR_MARK) ? TYPE_ALIGN (type) : BITS_PER_WORD;
16383 }
16384
16385 static inline unsigned
16386 simple_decl_align_in_bits (const_tree decl)
16387 {
16388 return (TREE_CODE (decl) != ERROR_MARK) ? DECL_ALIGN (decl) : BITS_PER_WORD;
16389 }
16390
16391 /* Return the result of rounding T up to ALIGN. */
16392
16393 static inline offset_int
16394 round_up_to_align (const offset_int &t, unsigned int align)
16395 {
16396 return wi::udiv_trunc (t + align - 1, align) * align;
16397 }
16398
16399 /* Compute the size of TYPE in bytes. If possible, return NULL and store the
16400 size as an integer constant in CST_SIZE. Otherwise, if possible, return a
16401 DWARF expression that computes the size. Return NULL and set CST_SIZE to -1
16402 if we fail to return the size in one of these two forms. */
16403
16404 static dw_loc_descr_ref
16405 type_byte_size (const_tree type, HOST_WIDE_INT *cst_size)
16406 {
16407 tree tree_size;
16408 struct loc_descr_context ctx;
16409
16410 /* Return a constant integer in priority, if possible. */
16411 *cst_size = int_size_in_bytes (type);
16412 if (*cst_size != -1)
16413 return NULL;
16414
16415 ctx.context_type = const_cast<tree> (type);
16416 ctx.base_decl = NULL_TREE;
16417 ctx.dpi = NULL;
16418
16419 type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
16420 tree_size = TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (type);
16421 return ((tree_size != NULL_TREE)
16422 ? loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree_size, 0, &ctx)
16423 : NULL);
16424 }
16425
16426 /* Helper structure for RECORD_TYPE processing. */
16427 struct vlr_context
16428 {
16429 /* Root RECORD_TYPE. It is needed to generate data member location
16430 descriptions in variable-length records (VLR), but also to cope with
16431 variants, which are composed of nested structures multiplexed with
16432 QUAL_UNION_TYPE nodes. Each time such a structure is passed to a
16433 function processing a FIELD_DECL, it is required to be non null. */
16434 tree struct_type;
16435 /* When generating a variant part in a RECORD_TYPE (i.e. a nested
16436 QUAL_UNION_TYPE), this holds an expression that computes the offset for
16437 this variant part as part of the root record (in storage units). For
16438 regular records, it must be NULL_TREE. */
16439 tree variant_part_offset;
16440 };
16441
16442 /* Given a pointer to a FIELD_DECL, compute the byte offset of the lowest
16443 addressed byte of the "containing object" for the given FIELD_DECL. If
16444 possible, return a native constant through CST_OFFSET (in which case NULL is
16445 returned); otherwise return a DWARF expression that computes the offset.
16446
16447 Set *CST_OFFSET to 0 and return NULL if we are unable to determine what
16448 that offset is, either because the argument turns out to be a pointer to an
16449 ERROR_MARK node, or because the offset expression is too complex for us.
16450
16451 CTX is required: see the comment for VLR_CONTEXT. */
16452
16453 static dw_loc_descr_ref
16454 field_byte_offset (const_tree decl, struct vlr_context *ctx,
16455 HOST_WIDE_INT *cst_offset)
16456 {
16457 offset_int object_offset_in_bits;
16458 offset_int object_offset_in_bytes;
16459 offset_int bitpos_int;
16460 bool is_byte_offset_cst, is_bit_offset_cst;
16461 tree tree_result;
16462 dw_loc_list_ref loc_result;
16463
16464 *cst_offset = 0;
16465
16466 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
16467 return NULL;
16468 else
16469 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL);
16470
16471 is_bit_offset_cst = TREE_CODE (DECL_FIELD_BIT_OFFSET (decl)) != INTEGER_CST;
16472 is_byte_offset_cst = TREE_CODE (DECL_FIELD_OFFSET (decl)) != INTEGER_CST;
16473
16474 /* We cannot handle variable bit offsets at the moment, so abort if it's the
16475 case. */
16476 if (is_bit_offset_cst)
16477 return NULL;
16478
16479 #ifdef PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
16480 /* We used to handle only constant offsets in all cases. Now, we handle
16481 properly dynamic byte offsets only when PCC bitfield type doesn't
16482 matter. */
16483 if (PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS && is_byte_offset_cst && is_bit_offset_cst)
16484 {
16485 tree type;
16486 tree field_size_tree;
16487 offset_int deepest_bitpos;
16488 offset_int field_size_in_bits;
16489 unsigned int type_align_in_bits;
16490 unsigned int decl_align_in_bits;
16491 offset_int type_size_in_bits;
16492
16493 bitpos_int = wi::to_offset (bit_position (decl));
16494 type = field_type (decl);
16495 type_size_in_bits = offset_int_type_size_in_bits (type);
16496 type_align_in_bits = simple_type_align_in_bits (type);
16497
16498 field_size_tree = DECL_SIZE (decl);
16499
16500 /* The size could be unspecified if there was an error, or for
16501 a flexible array member. */
16502 if (!field_size_tree)
16503 field_size_tree = bitsize_zero_node;
16504
16505 /* If the size of the field is not constant, use the type size. */
16506 if (TREE_CODE (field_size_tree) == INTEGER_CST)
16507 field_size_in_bits = wi::to_offset (field_size_tree);
16508 else
16509 field_size_in_bits = type_size_in_bits;
16510
16511 decl_align_in_bits = simple_decl_align_in_bits (decl);
16512
16513 /* The GCC front-end doesn't make any attempt to keep track of the
16514 starting bit offset (relative to the start of the containing
16515 structure type) of the hypothetical "containing object" for a
16516 bit-field. Thus, when computing the byte offset value for the
16517 start of the "containing object" of a bit-field, we must deduce
16518 this information on our own. This can be rather tricky to do in
16519 some cases. For example, handling the following structure type
16520 definition when compiling for an i386/i486 target (which only
16521 aligns long long's to 32-bit boundaries) can be very tricky:
16522
16523 struct S { int field1; long long field2:31; };
16524
16525 Fortunately, there is a simple rule-of-thumb which can be used
16526 in such cases. When compiling for an i386/i486, GCC will
16527 allocate 8 bytes for the structure shown above. It decides to
16528 do this based upon one simple rule for bit-field allocation.
16529 GCC allocates each "containing object" for each bit-field at
16530 the first (i.e. lowest addressed) legitimate alignment boundary
16531 (based upon the required minimum alignment for the declared
16532 type of the field) which it can possibly use, subject to the
16533 condition that there is still enough available space remaining
16534 in the containing object (when allocated at the selected point)
16535 to fully accommodate all of the bits of the bit-field itself.
16536
16537 This simple rule makes it obvious why GCC allocates 8 bytes for
16538 each object of the structure type shown above. When looking
16539 for a place to allocate the "containing object" for `field2',
16540 the compiler simply tries to allocate a 64-bit "containing
16541 object" at each successive 32-bit boundary (starting at zero)
16542 until it finds a place to allocate that 64- bit field such that
16543 at least 31 contiguous (and previously unallocated) bits remain
16544 within that selected 64 bit field. (As it turns out, for the
16545 example above, the compiler finds it is OK to allocate the
16546 "containing object" 64-bit field at bit-offset zero within the
16547 structure type.)
16548
16549 Here we attempt to work backwards from the limited set of facts
16550 we're given, and we try to deduce from those facts, where GCC
16551 must have believed that the containing object started (within
16552 the structure type). The value we deduce is then used (by the
16553 callers of this routine) to generate DW_AT_location and
16554 DW_AT_bit_offset attributes for fields (both bit-fields and, in
16555 the case of DW_AT_location, regular fields as well). */
16556
16557 /* Figure out the bit-distance from the start of the structure to
16558 the "deepest" bit of the bit-field. */
16559 deepest_bitpos = bitpos_int + field_size_in_bits;
16560
16561 /* This is the tricky part. Use some fancy footwork to deduce
16562 where the lowest addressed bit of the containing object must
16563 be. */
16564 object_offset_in_bits = deepest_bitpos - type_size_in_bits;
16565
16566 /* Round up to type_align by default. This works best for
16567 bitfields. */
16568 object_offset_in_bits
16569 = round_up_to_align (object_offset_in_bits, type_align_in_bits);
16570
16571 if (wi::gtu_p (object_offset_in_bits, bitpos_int))
16572 {
16573 object_offset_in_bits = deepest_bitpos - type_size_in_bits;
16574
16575 /* Round up to decl_align instead. */
16576 object_offset_in_bits
16577 = round_up_to_align (object_offset_in_bits, decl_align_in_bits);
16578 }
16579 }
16580 #endif /* PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS */
16581
16582 tree_result = byte_position (decl);
16583 if (ctx->variant_part_offset != NULL_TREE)
16584 tree_result = fold (build2 (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (tree_result),
16585 ctx->variant_part_offset, tree_result));
16586
16587 /* If the byte offset is a constant, it's simplier to handle a native
16588 constant rather than a DWARF expression. */
16589 if (TREE_CODE (tree_result) == INTEGER_CST)
16590 {
16591 *cst_offset = wi::to_offset (tree_result).to_shwi ();
16592 return NULL;
16593 }
16594 struct loc_descr_context loc_ctx = {
16595 ctx->struct_type, /* context_type */
16596 NULL_TREE, /* base_decl */
16597 NULL /* dpi */
16598 };
16599 loc_result = loc_list_from_tree (tree_result, 0, &loc_ctx);
16600
16601 /* We want a DWARF expression: abort if we only have a location list with
16602 multiple elements. */
16603 if (!loc_result || !single_element_loc_list_p (loc_result))
16604 return NULL;
16605 else
16606 return loc_result->expr;
16607 }
16608 \f
16609 /* The following routines define various Dwarf attributes and any data
16610 associated with them. */
16611
16612 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE.
16613
16614 This emits location attributes suitable for whole variables and
16615 whole parameters. Note that the location attributes for struct fields are
16616 generated by the routine `data_member_location_attribute' below. */
16617
16618 static inline void
16619 add_AT_location_description (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
16620 dw_loc_list_ref descr)
16621 {
16622 if (descr == 0)
16623 return;
16624 if (single_element_loc_list_p (descr))
16625 add_AT_loc (die, attr_kind, descr->expr);
16626 else
16627 add_AT_loc_list (die, attr_kind, descr);
16628 }
16629
16630 /* Add DW_AT_accessibility attribute to DIE if needed. */
16631
16632 static void
16633 add_accessibility_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
16634 {
16635 /* In DWARF3+ the default is DW_ACCESS_private only in DW_TAG_class_type
16636 children, otherwise the default is DW_ACCESS_public. In DWARF2
16637 the default has always been DW_ACCESS_public. */
16638 if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
16639 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
16640 else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
16641 {
16642 if (dwarf_version == 2
16643 || die->die_parent == NULL
16644 || die->die_parent->die_tag != DW_TAG_class_type)
16645 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
16646 }
16647 else if (dwarf_version > 2
16648 && die->die_parent
16649 && die->die_parent->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type)
16650 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_public);
16651 }
16652
16653 /* Attach the specialized form of location attribute used for data members of
16654 struct and union types. In the special case of a FIELD_DECL node which
16655 represents a bit-field, the "offset" part of this special location
16656 descriptor must indicate the distance in bytes from the lowest-addressed
16657 byte of the containing struct or union type to the lowest-addressed byte of
16658 the "containing object" for the bit-field. (See the `field_byte_offset'
16659 function above).
16660
16661 For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
16662 (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives. The
16663 type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
16664 declared type of the individual bit-field itself (for GCC anyway... the
16665 DWARF spec doesn't actually mandate this). Note that it is the size (in
16666 bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object" which will be given in the
16667 DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field. (See the
16668 `byte_size_attribute' function below.) It is also used when calculating the
16669 value of the DW_AT_bit_offset attribute. (See the `bit_offset_attribute'
16670 function below.)
16671
16672 CTX is required: see the comment for VLR_CONTEXT. */
16673
16674 static void
16675 add_data_member_location_attribute (dw_die_ref die,
16676 tree decl,
16677 struct vlr_context *ctx)
16678 {
16679 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
16680 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descr = 0;
16681
16682 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TREE_BINFO)
16683 {
16684 /* We're working on the TAG_inheritance for a base class. */
16685 if (BINFO_VIRTUAL_P (decl) && is_cxx ())
16686 {
16687 /* For C++ virtual bases we can't just use BINFO_OFFSET, as they
16688 aren't at a fixed offset from all (sub)objects of the same
16689 type. We need to extract the appropriate offset from our
16690 vtable. The following dwarf expression means
16691
16692 BaseAddr = ObAddr + *((*ObAddr) - Offset)
16693
16694 This is specific to the V3 ABI, of course. */
16695
16696 dw_loc_descr_ref tmp;
16697
16698 /* Make a copy of the object address. */
16699 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0);
16700 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
16701
16702 /* Extract the vtable address. */
16703 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
16704 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
16705
16706 /* Calculate the address of the offset. */
16707 offset = tree_to_shwi (BINFO_VPTR_FIELD (decl));
16708 gcc_assert (offset < 0);
16709
16710 tmp = int_loc_descriptor (-offset);
16711 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
16712 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0);
16713 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
16714
16715 /* Extract the offset. */
16716 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
16717 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
16718
16719 /* Add it to the object address. */
16720 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0);
16721 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
16722 }
16723 else
16724 offset = tree_to_shwi (BINFO_OFFSET (decl));
16725 }
16726 else
16727 {
16728 loc_descr = field_byte_offset (decl, ctx, &offset);
16729
16730 /* If loc_descr is available then we know the field offset is dynamic.
16731 However, GDB does not handle dynamic field offsets very well at the
16732 moment. */
16733 if (loc_descr != NULL && gnat_encodings != DWARF_GNAT_ENCODINGS_MINIMAL)
16734 {
16735 loc_descr = NULL;
16736 offset = 0;
16737 }
16738
16739 /* Data member location evalutation starts with the base address on the
16740 stack. Compute the field offset and add it to this base address. */
16741 else if (loc_descr != NULL)
16742 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
16743 }
16744
16745 if (! loc_descr)
16746 {
16747 if (dwarf_version > 2)
16748 {
16749 /* Don't need to output a location expression, just the constant. */
16750 if (offset < 0)
16751 add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, offset);
16752 else
16753 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, offset);
16754 return;
16755 }
16756 else
16757 {
16758 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
16759
16760 /* The DWARF2 standard says that we should assume that the structure
16761 address is already on the stack, so we can specify a structure
16762 field address by using DW_OP_plus_uconst. */
16763 op = DW_OP_plus_uconst;
16764 loc_descr = new_loc_descr (op, offset, 0);
16765 }
16766 }
16767
16768 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, loc_descr);
16769 }
16770
16771 /* Writes integer values to dw_vec_const array. */
16772
16773 static void
16774 insert_int (HOST_WIDE_INT val, unsigned int size, unsigned char *dest)
16775 {
16776 while (size != 0)
16777 {
16778 *dest++ = val & 0xff;
16779 val >>= 8;
16780 --size;
16781 }
16782 }
16783
16784 /* Reads integers from dw_vec_const array. Inverse of insert_int. */
16785
16786 static HOST_WIDE_INT
16787 extract_int (const unsigned char *src, unsigned int size)
16788 {
16789 HOST_WIDE_INT val = 0;
16790
16791 src += size;
16792 while (size != 0)
16793 {
16794 val <<= 8;
16795 val |= *--src & 0xff;
16796 --size;
16797 }
16798 return val;
16799 }
16800
16801 /* Writes wide_int values to dw_vec_const array. */
16802
16803 static void
16804 insert_wide_int (const wide_int &val, unsigned char *dest, int elt_size)
16805 {
16806 int i;
16807
16808 if (elt_size <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT/BITS_PER_UNIT)
16809 {
16810 insert_int ((HOST_WIDE_INT) val.elt (0), elt_size, dest);
16811 return;
16812 }
16813
16814 /* We'd have to extend this code to support odd sizes. */
16815 gcc_assert (elt_size % (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0);
16816
16817 int n = elt_size / (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / BITS_PER_UNIT);
16818
16819 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
16820 for (i = n - 1; i >= 0; i--)
16821 {
16822 insert_int ((HOST_WIDE_INT) val.elt (i), sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT), dest);
16823 dest += sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT);
16824 }
16825 else
16826 for (i = 0; i < n; i++)
16827 {
16828 insert_int ((HOST_WIDE_INT) val.elt (i), sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT), dest);
16829 dest += sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT);
16830 }
16831 }
16832
16833 /* Writes floating point values to dw_vec_const array. */
16834
16835 static void
16836 insert_float (const_rtx rtl, unsigned char *array)
16837 {
16838 long val[4];
16839 int i;
16840
16841 real_to_target (val, CONST_DOUBLE_REAL_VALUE (rtl), GET_MODE (rtl));
16842
16843 /* real_to_target puts 32-bit pieces in each long. Pack them. */
16844 for (i = 0; i < GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) / 4; i++)
16845 {
16846 insert_int (val[i], 4, array);
16847 array += 4;
16848 }
16849 }
16850
16851 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute for a variable or a parameter which
16852 does not have a "location" either in memory or in a register. These
16853 things can arise in GNU C when a constant is passed as an actual parameter
16854 to an inlined function. They can also arise in C++ where declared
16855 constants do not necessarily get memory "homes". */
16856
16857 static bool
16858 add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, rtx rtl)
16859 {
16860 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
16861 {
16862 case CONST_INT:
16863 {
16864 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (rtl);
16865
16866 if (val < 0)
16867 add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_const_value, val);
16868 else
16869 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_const_value, (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) val);
16870 }
16871 return true;
16872
16873 case CONST_WIDE_INT:
16874 {
16875 wide_int w1 = std::make_pair (rtl, MAX_MODE_INT);
16876 unsigned int prec = MIN (wi::min_precision (w1, UNSIGNED),
16877 (unsigned int)CONST_WIDE_INT_NUNITS (rtl) * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT);
16878 wide_int w = wi::zext (w1, prec);
16879 add_AT_wide (die, DW_AT_const_value, w);
16880 }
16881 return true;
16882
16883 case CONST_DOUBLE:
16884 /* Note that a CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either an integer or a
16885 floating-point constant. A CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever the
16886 constant requires more than one word in order to be adequately
16887 represented. */
16888 {
16889 machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
16890
16891 if (TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT == 0 && !SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (mode))
16892 add_AT_double (die, DW_AT_const_value,
16893 CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (rtl), CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (rtl));
16894 else
16895 {
16896 unsigned int length = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
16897 unsigned char *array = ggc_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (length);
16898
16899 insert_float (rtl, array);
16900 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, length / 4, 4, array);
16901 }
16902 }
16903 return true;
16904
16905 case CONST_VECTOR:
16906 {
16907 machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
16908 unsigned int elt_size = GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode);
16909 unsigned int length = CONST_VECTOR_NUNITS (rtl);
16910 unsigned char *array
16911 = ggc_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (length * elt_size);
16912 unsigned int i;
16913 unsigned char *p;
16914 machine_mode imode = GET_MODE_INNER (mode);
16915
16916 switch (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode))
16917 {
16918 case MODE_VECTOR_INT:
16919 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
16920 {
16921 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
16922 insert_wide_int (std::make_pair (elt, imode), p, elt_size);
16923 }
16924 break;
16925
16926 case MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT:
16927 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
16928 {
16929 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
16930 insert_float (elt, p);
16931 }
16932 break;
16933
16934 default:
16935 gcc_unreachable ();
16936 }
16937
16938 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, length, elt_size, array);
16939 }
16940 return true;
16941
16942 case CONST_STRING:
16943 if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
16944 {
16945 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result;
16946 resolve_one_addr (&rtl);
16947 rtl_addr:
16948 loc_result = new_addr_loc_descr (rtl, dtprel_false);
16949 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
16950 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_location, loc_result);
16951 vec_safe_push (used_rtx_array, rtl);
16952 return true;
16953 }
16954 return false;
16955
16956 case CONST:
16957 if (CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
16958 return add_const_value_attribute (die, XEXP (rtl, 0));
16959 /* FALLTHROUGH */
16960 case SYMBOL_REF:
16961 if (!const_ok_for_output (rtl))
16962 return false;
16963 case LABEL_REF:
16964 if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
16965 goto rtl_addr;
16966 return false;
16967
16968 case PLUS:
16969 /* In cases where an inlined instance of an inline function is passed
16970 the address of an `auto' variable (which is local to the caller) we
16971 can get a situation where the DECL_RTL of the artificial local
16972 variable (for the inlining) which acts as a stand-in for the
16973 corresponding formal parameter (of the inline function) will look
16974 like (plus:SI (reg:SI FRAME_PTR) (const_int ...)). This is not
16975 exactly a compile-time constant expression, but it isn't the address
16976 of the (artificial) local variable either. Rather, it represents the
16977 *value* which the artificial local variable always has during its
16978 lifetime. We currently have no way to represent such quasi-constant
16979 values in Dwarf, so for now we just punt and generate nothing. */
16980 return false;
16981
16982 case HIGH:
16983 case CONST_FIXED:
16984 return false;
16985
16986 case MEM:
16987 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == CONST_STRING
16988 && MEM_READONLY_P (rtl)
16989 && GET_MODE (rtl) == BLKmode)
16990 {
16991 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_const_value, XSTR (XEXP (rtl, 0), 0));
16992 return true;
16993 }
16994 return false;
16995
16996 default:
16997 /* No other kinds of rtx should be possible here. */
16998 gcc_unreachable ();
16999 }
17000 return false;
17001 }
17002
17003 /* Determine whether the evaluation of EXPR references any variables
17004 or functions which aren't otherwise used (and therefore may not be
17005 output). */
17006 static tree
17007 reference_to_unused (tree * tp, int * walk_subtrees,
17008 void * data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
17009 {
17010 if (! EXPR_P (*tp) && ! CONSTANT_CLASS_P (*tp))
17011 *walk_subtrees = 0;
17012
17013 if (DECL_P (*tp) && ! TREE_PUBLIC (*tp) && ! TREE_USED (*tp)
17014 && ! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (*tp))
17015 return *tp;
17016 /* ??? The C++ FE emits debug information for using decls, so
17017 putting gcc_unreachable here falls over. See PR31899. For now
17018 be conservative. */
17019 else if (!symtab->global_info_ready
17020 && (TREE_CODE (*tp) == VAR_DECL || TREE_CODE (*tp) == FUNCTION_DECL))
17021 return *tp;
17022 else if (TREE_CODE (*tp) == VAR_DECL)
17023 {
17024 varpool_node *node = varpool_node::get (*tp);
17025 if (!node || !node->definition)
17026 return *tp;
17027 }
17028 else if (TREE_CODE (*tp) == FUNCTION_DECL
17029 && (!DECL_EXTERNAL (*tp) || DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (*tp)))
17030 {
17031 /* The call graph machinery must have finished analyzing,
17032 optimizing and gimplifying the CU by now.
17033 So if *TP has no call graph node associated
17034 to it, it means *TP will not be emitted. */
17035 if (!cgraph_node::get (*tp))
17036 return *tp;
17037 }
17038 else if (TREE_CODE (*tp) == STRING_CST && !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (*tp))
17039 return *tp;
17040
17041 return NULL_TREE;
17042 }
17043
17044 /* Generate an RTL constant from a decl initializer INIT with decl type TYPE,
17045 for use in a later add_const_value_attribute call. */
17046
17047 static rtx
17048 rtl_for_decl_init (tree init, tree type)
17049 {
17050 rtx rtl = NULL_RTX;
17051
17052 STRIP_NOPS (init);
17053
17054 /* If a variable is initialized with a string constant without embedded
17055 zeros, build CONST_STRING. */
17056 if (TREE_CODE (init) == STRING_CST && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
17057 {
17058 tree enttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
17059 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
17060 machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (enttype);
17061
17062 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 1
17063 && domain
17064 && integer_zerop (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain))
17065 && compare_tree_int (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain),
17066 TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init) - 1) == 0
17067 && ((size_t) TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init)
17068 == strlen (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)) + 1))
17069 {
17070 rtl = gen_rtx_CONST_STRING (VOIDmode,
17071 ggc_strdup (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)));
17072 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, rtl);
17073 MEM_READONLY_P (rtl) = 1;
17074 }
17075 }
17076 /* Other aggregates, and complex values, could be represented using
17077 CONCAT: FIXME! */
17078 else if (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (type)
17079 || (TREE_CODE (init) == VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR
17080 && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0))))
17081 || TREE_CODE (type) == COMPLEX_TYPE)
17082 ;
17083 /* Vectors only work if their mode is supported by the target.
17084 FIXME: generic vectors ought to work too. */
17085 else if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE
17086 && !VECTOR_MODE_P (TYPE_MODE (type)))
17087 ;
17088 /* If the initializer is something that we know will expand into an
17089 immediate RTL constant, expand it now. We must be careful not to
17090 reference variables which won't be output. */
17091 else if (initializer_constant_valid_p (init, type)
17092 && ! walk_tree (&init, reference_to_unused, NULL, NULL))
17093 {
17094 /* Convert vector CONSTRUCTOR initializers to VECTOR_CST if
17095 possible. */
17096 if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
17097 switch (TREE_CODE (init))
17098 {
17099 case VECTOR_CST:
17100 break;
17101 case CONSTRUCTOR:
17102 if (TREE_CONSTANT (init))
17103 {
17104 vec<constructor_elt, va_gc> *elts = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init);
17105 bool constant_p = true;
17106 tree value;
17107 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT ix;
17108
17109 /* Even when ctor is constant, it might contain non-*_CST
17110 elements (e.g. { 1.0/0.0 - 1.0/0.0, 0.0 }) and those don't
17111 belong into VECTOR_CST nodes. */
17112 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_VALUE (elts, ix, value)
17113 if (!CONSTANT_CLASS_P (value))
17114 {
17115 constant_p = false;
17116 break;
17117 }
17118
17119 if (constant_p)
17120 {
17121 init = build_vector_from_ctor (type, elts);
17122 break;
17123 }
17124 }
17125 /* FALLTHRU */
17126
17127 default:
17128 return NULL;
17129 }
17130
17131 rtl = expand_expr (init, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_INITIALIZER);
17132
17133 /* If expand_expr returns a MEM, it wasn't immediate. */
17134 gcc_assert (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl));
17135 }
17136
17137 return rtl;
17138 }
17139
17140 /* Generate RTL for the variable DECL to represent its location. */
17141
17142 static rtx
17143 rtl_for_decl_location (tree decl)
17144 {
17145 rtx rtl;
17146
17147 /* Here we have to decide where we are going to say the parameter "lives"
17148 (as far as the debugger is concerned). We only have a couple of
17149 choices. GCC provides us with DECL_RTL and with DECL_INCOMING_RTL.
17150
17151 DECL_RTL normally indicates where the parameter lives during most of the
17152 activation of the function. If optimization is enabled however, this
17153 could be either NULL or else a pseudo-reg. Both of those cases indicate
17154 that the parameter doesn't really live anywhere (as far as the code
17155 generation parts of GCC are concerned) during most of the function's
17156 activation. That will happen (for example) if the parameter is never
17157 referenced within the function.
17158
17159 We could just generate a location descriptor here for all non-NULL
17160 non-pseudo values of DECL_RTL and ignore all of the rest, but we can be
17161 a little nicer than that if we also consider DECL_INCOMING_RTL in cases
17162 where DECL_RTL is NULL or is a pseudo-reg.
17163
17164 Note however that we can only get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL as
17165 a backup substitute for DECL_RTL in certain limited cases. In cases
17166 where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) indicates the same type as TREE_TYPE (decl),
17167 we can be sure that the parameter was passed using the same type as it is
17168 declared to have within the function, and that its DECL_INCOMING_RTL
17169 points us to a place where a value of that type is passed.
17170
17171 In cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) and TREE_TYPE (decl) are different,
17172 we cannot (in general) use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a substitute for DECL_RTL
17173 because in these cases DECL_INCOMING_RTL points us to a value of some
17174 type which is *different* from the type of the parameter itself. Thus,
17175 if we tried to use DECL_INCOMING_RTL to generate a location attribute in
17176 such cases, the debugger would end up (for example) trying to fetch a
17177 `float' from a place which actually contains the first part of a
17178 `double'. That would lead to really incorrect and confusing
17179 output at debug-time.
17180
17181 So, in general, we *do not* use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a backup for DECL_RTL
17182 in cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) != TREE_TYPE (decl). There
17183 are a couple of exceptions however. On little-endian machines we can
17184 get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL even when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
17185 not the same as TREE_TYPE (decl), but only when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
17186 an integral type that is smaller than TREE_TYPE (decl). These cases arise
17187 when (on a little-endian machine) a non-prototyped function has a
17188 parameter declared to be of type `short' or `char'. In such cases,
17189 TREE_TYPE (decl) will be `short' or `char', DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) will
17190 be `int', and DECL_INCOMING_RTL will point to the lowest-order byte of the
17191 passed `int' value. If the debugger then uses that address to fetch
17192 a `short' or a `char' (on a little-endian machine) the result will be
17193 the correct data, so we allow for such exceptional cases below.
17194
17195 Note that our goal here is to describe the place where the given formal
17196 parameter lives during most of the function's activation (i.e. between the
17197 end of the prologue and the start of the epilogue). We'll do that as best
17198 as we can. Note however that if the given formal parameter is modified
17199 sometime during the execution of the function, then a stack backtrace (at
17200 debug-time) will show the function as having been called with the *new*
17201 value rather than the value which was originally passed in. This happens
17202 rarely enough that it is not a major problem, but it *is* a problem, and
17203 I'd like to fix it.
17204
17205 A future version of dwarf2out.c may generate two additional attributes for
17206 any given DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE which will describe the "passed
17207 type" and the "passed location" for the given formal parameter in addition
17208 to the attributes we now generate to indicate the "declared type" and the
17209 "active location" for each parameter. This additional set of attributes
17210 could be used by debuggers for stack backtraces. Separately, note that
17211 sometimes DECL_RTL can be NULL and DECL_INCOMING_RTL can be NULL also.
17212 This happens (for example) for inlined-instances of inline function formal
17213 parameters which are never referenced. This really shouldn't be
17214 happening. All PARM_DECL nodes should get valid non-NULL
17215 DECL_INCOMING_RTL values. FIXME. */
17216
17217 /* Use DECL_RTL as the "location" unless we find something better. */
17218 rtl = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl);
17219
17220 /* When generating abstract instances, ignore everything except
17221 constants, symbols living in memory, and symbols living in
17222 fixed registers. */
17223 if (! reload_completed)
17224 {
17225 if (rtl
17226 && (CONSTANT_P (rtl)
17227 || (MEM_P (rtl)
17228 && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
17229 || (REG_P (rtl)
17230 && TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
17231 && TREE_STATIC (decl))))
17232 {
17233 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
17234 return rtl;
17235 }
17236 rtl = NULL_RTX;
17237 }
17238 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL)
17239 {
17240 if (rtl == NULL_RTX
17241 || is_pseudo_reg (rtl)
17242 || (MEM_P (rtl)
17243 && is_pseudo_reg (XEXP (rtl, 0))
17244 && DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl)
17245 && MEM_P (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
17246 && GET_MODE (rtl) == GET_MODE (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))))
17247 {
17248 tree declared_type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
17249 tree passed_type = DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl);
17250 machine_mode dmode = TYPE_MODE (declared_type);
17251 machine_mode pmode = TYPE_MODE (passed_type);
17252
17253 /* This decl represents a formal parameter which was optimized out.
17254 Note that DECL_INCOMING_RTL may be NULL in here, but we handle
17255 all cases where (rtl == NULL_RTX) just below. */
17256 if (dmode == pmode)
17257 rtl = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
17258 else if ((rtl == NULL_RTX || is_pseudo_reg (rtl))
17259 && SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (dmode)
17260 && GET_MODE_SIZE (dmode) <= GET_MODE_SIZE (pmode)
17261 && DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
17262 {
17263 rtx inc = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
17264 if (REG_P (inc))
17265 rtl = inc;
17266 else if (MEM_P (inc))
17267 {
17268 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
17269 rtl = adjust_address_nv (inc, dmode,
17270 GET_MODE_SIZE (pmode)
17271 - GET_MODE_SIZE (dmode));
17272 else
17273 rtl = inc;
17274 }
17275 }
17276 }
17277
17278 /* If the parm was passed in registers, but lives on the stack, then
17279 make a big endian correction if the mode of the type of the
17280 parameter is not the same as the mode of the rtl. */
17281 /* ??? This is the same series of checks that are made in dbxout.c before
17282 we reach the big endian correction code there. It isn't clear if all
17283 of these checks are necessary here, but keeping them all is the safe
17284 thing to do. */
17285 else if (MEM_P (rtl)
17286 && XEXP (rtl, 0) != const0_rtx
17287 && ! CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
17288 /* Not passed in memory. */
17289 && !MEM_P (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
17290 /* Not passed by invisible reference. */
17291 && (!REG_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
17292 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
17293 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
17294 #if !HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
17295 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
17296 #endif
17297 )
17298 /* Big endian correction check. */
17299 && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
17300 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) != GET_MODE (rtl)
17301 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
17302 < UNITS_PER_WORD))
17303 {
17304 machine_mode addr_mode = get_address_mode (rtl);
17305 int offset = (UNITS_PER_WORD
17306 - GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))));
17307
17308 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
17309 plus_constant (addr_mode, XEXP (rtl, 0), offset));
17310 }
17311 }
17312 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
17313 && rtl
17314 && MEM_P (rtl)
17315 && GET_MODE (rtl) != TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))
17316 && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
17317 {
17318 machine_mode addr_mode = get_address_mode (rtl);
17319 int rsize = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl));
17320 int dsize = GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)));
17321
17322 /* If a variable is declared "register" yet is smaller than
17323 a register, then if we store the variable to memory, it
17324 looks like we're storing a register-sized value, when in
17325 fact we are not. We need to adjust the offset of the
17326 storage location to reflect the actual value's bytes,
17327 else gdb will not be able to display it. */
17328 if (rsize > dsize)
17329 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
17330 plus_constant (addr_mode, XEXP (rtl, 0),
17331 rsize - dsize));
17332 }
17333
17334 /* A variable with no DECL_RTL but a DECL_INITIAL is a compile-time constant,
17335 and will have been substituted directly into all expressions that use it.
17336 C does not have such a concept, but C++ and other languages do. */
17337 if (!rtl && TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
17338 rtl = rtl_for_decl_init (DECL_INITIAL (decl), TREE_TYPE (decl));
17339
17340 if (rtl)
17341 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
17342
17343 /* If we don't look past the constant pool, we risk emitting a
17344 reference to a constant pool entry that isn't referenced from
17345 code, and thus is not emitted. */
17346 if (rtl)
17347 rtl = avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl);
17348
17349 /* Try harder to get a rtl. If this symbol ends up not being emitted
17350 in the current CU, resolve_addr will remove the expression referencing
17351 it. */
17352 if (rtl == NULL_RTX
17353 && TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
17354 && !DECL_EXTERNAL (decl)
17355 && TREE_STATIC (decl)
17356 && DECL_NAME (decl)
17357 && !DECL_HARD_REGISTER (decl)
17358 && DECL_MODE (decl) != VOIDmode)
17359 {
17360 rtl = make_decl_rtl_for_debug (decl);
17361 if (!MEM_P (rtl)
17362 || GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != SYMBOL_REF
17363 || SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != decl)
17364 rtl = NULL_RTX;
17365 }
17366
17367 return rtl;
17368 }
17369
17370 /* Check whether decl is a Fortran COMMON symbol. If not, NULL_TREE is
17371 returned. If so, the decl for the COMMON block is returned, and the
17372 value is the offset into the common block for the symbol. */
17373
17374 static tree
17375 fortran_common (tree decl, HOST_WIDE_INT *value)
17376 {
17377 tree val_expr, cvar;
17378 machine_mode mode;
17379 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos;
17380 tree offset;
17381 int unsignedp, reversep, volatilep = 0;
17382
17383 /* If the decl isn't a VAR_DECL, or if it isn't static, or if
17384 it does not have a value (the offset into the common area), or if it
17385 is thread local (as opposed to global) then it isn't common, and shouldn't
17386 be handled as such. */
17387 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != VAR_DECL
17388 || !TREE_STATIC (decl)
17389 || !DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (decl)
17390 || !is_fortran ())
17391 return NULL_TREE;
17392
17393 val_expr = DECL_VALUE_EXPR (decl);
17394 if (TREE_CODE (val_expr) != COMPONENT_REF)
17395 return NULL_TREE;
17396
17397 cvar = get_inner_reference (val_expr, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode,
17398 &unsignedp, &reversep, &volatilep, true);
17399
17400 if (cvar == NULL_TREE
17401 || TREE_CODE (cvar) != VAR_DECL
17402 || DECL_ARTIFICIAL (cvar)
17403 || !TREE_PUBLIC (cvar))
17404 return NULL_TREE;
17405
17406 *value = 0;
17407 if (offset != NULL)
17408 {
17409 if (!tree_fits_shwi_p (offset))
17410 return NULL_TREE;
17411 *value = tree_to_shwi (offset);
17412 }
17413 if (bitpos != 0)
17414 *value += bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
17415
17416 return cvar;
17417 }
17418
17419 /* Generate *either* a DW_AT_location attribute or else a DW_AT_const_value
17420 data attribute for a variable or a parameter. We generate the
17421 DW_AT_const_value attribute only in those cases where the given variable
17422 or parameter does not have a true "location" either in memory or in a
17423 register. This can happen (for example) when a constant is passed as an
17424 actual argument in a call to an inline function. (It's possible that
17425 these things can crop up in other ways also.) Note that one type of
17426 constant value which can be passed into an inlined function is a constant
17427 pointer. This can happen for example if an actual argument in an inlined
17428 function call evaluates to a compile-time constant address.
17429
17430 CACHE_P is true if it is worth caching the location list for DECL,
17431 so that future calls can reuse it rather than regenerate it from scratch.
17432 This is true for BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VARS in inlined subroutines,
17433 since we will need to refer to them each time the function is inlined. */
17434
17435 static bool
17436 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl, bool cache_p)
17437 {
17438 rtx rtl;
17439 dw_loc_list_ref list;
17440 var_loc_list *loc_list;
17441 cached_dw_loc_list *cache;
17442
17443 if (early_dwarf)
17444 return false;
17445
17446 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
17447 return false;
17448
17449 if (get_AT (die, DW_AT_location)
17450 || get_AT (die, DW_AT_const_value))
17451 return true;
17452
17453 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL
17454 || TREE_CODE (decl) == RESULT_DECL);
17455
17456 /* Try to get some constant RTL for this decl, and use that as the value of
17457 the location. */
17458
17459 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (decl);
17460 if (rtl && (CONSTANT_P (rtl) || GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
17461 && add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl))
17462 return true;
17463
17464 /* See if we have single element location list that is equivalent to
17465 a constant value. That way we are better to use add_const_value_attribute
17466 rather than expanding constant value equivalent. */
17467 loc_list = lookup_decl_loc (decl);
17468 if (loc_list
17469 && loc_list->first
17470 && loc_list->first->next == NULL
17471 && NOTE_P (loc_list->first->loc)
17472 && NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (loc_list->first->loc)
17473 && NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc_list->first->loc))
17474 {
17475 struct var_loc_node *node;
17476
17477 node = loc_list->first;
17478 rtl = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node->loc);
17479 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == EXPR_LIST)
17480 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
17481 if ((CONSTANT_P (rtl) || GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
17482 && add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl))
17483 return true;
17484 }
17485 /* If this decl is from BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VARS, we might need its
17486 list several times. See if we've already cached the contents. */
17487 list = NULL;
17488 if (loc_list == NULL || cached_dw_loc_list_table == NULL)
17489 cache_p = false;
17490 if (cache_p)
17491 {
17492 cache = cached_dw_loc_list_table->find_with_hash (decl, DECL_UID (decl));
17493 if (cache)
17494 list = cache->loc_list;
17495 }
17496 if (list == NULL)
17497 {
17498 list = loc_list_from_tree (decl, decl_by_reference_p (decl) ? 0 : 2,
17499 NULL);
17500 /* It is usually worth caching this result if the decl is from
17501 BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VARS and if the list has at least two elements. */
17502 if (cache_p && list && list->dw_loc_next)
17503 {
17504 cached_dw_loc_list **slot
17505 = cached_dw_loc_list_table->find_slot_with_hash (decl,
17506 DECL_UID (decl),
17507 INSERT);
17508 cache = ggc_cleared_alloc<cached_dw_loc_list> ();
17509 cache->decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
17510 cache->loc_list = list;
17511 *slot = cache;
17512 }
17513 }
17514 if (list)
17515 {
17516 add_AT_location_description (die, DW_AT_location, list);
17517 return true;
17518 }
17519 /* None of that worked, so it must not really have a location;
17520 try adding a constant value attribute from the DECL_INITIAL. */
17521 return tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (die, decl);
17522 }
17523
17524 /* Helper function for tree_add_const_value_attribute. Natively encode
17525 initializer INIT into an array. Return true if successful. */
17526
17527 static bool
17528 native_encode_initializer (tree init, unsigned char *array, int size)
17529 {
17530 tree type;
17531
17532 if (init == NULL_TREE)
17533 return false;
17534
17535 STRIP_NOPS (init);
17536 switch (TREE_CODE (init))
17537 {
17538 case STRING_CST:
17539 type = TREE_TYPE (init);
17540 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
17541 {
17542 tree enttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
17543 machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (enttype);
17544
17545 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT || GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) != 1)
17546 return false;
17547 if (int_size_in_bytes (type) != size)
17548 return false;
17549 if (size > TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init))
17550 {
17551 memcpy (array, TREE_STRING_POINTER (init),
17552 TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init));
17553 memset (array + TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init),
17554 '\0', size - TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init));
17555 }
17556 else
17557 memcpy (array, TREE_STRING_POINTER (init), size);
17558 return true;
17559 }
17560 return false;
17561 case CONSTRUCTOR:
17562 type = TREE_TYPE (init);
17563 if (int_size_in_bytes (type) != size)
17564 return false;
17565 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
17566 {
17567 HOST_WIDE_INT min_index;
17568 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT cnt;
17569 int curpos = 0, fieldsize;
17570 constructor_elt *ce;
17571
17572 if (TYPE_DOMAIN (type) == NULL_TREE
17573 || !tree_fits_shwi_p (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type))))
17574 return false;
17575
17576 fieldsize = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (type));
17577 if (fieldsize <= 0)
17578 return false;
17579
17580 min_index = tree_to_shwi (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type)));
17581 memset (array, '\0', size);
17582 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init), cnt, ce)
17583 {
17584 tree val = ce->value;
17585 tree index = ce->index;
17586 int pos = curpos;
17587 if (index && TREE_CODE (index) == RANGE_EXPR)
17588 pos = (tree_to_shwi (TREE_OPERAND (index, 0)) - min_index)
17589 * fieldsize;
17590 else if (index)
17591 pos = (tree_to_shwi (index) - min_index) * fieldsize;
17592
17593 if (val)
17594 {
17595 STRIP_NOPS (val);
17596 if (!native_encode_initializer (val, array + pos, fieldsize))
17597 return false;
17598 }
17599 curpos = pos + fieldsize;
17600 if (index && TREE_CODE (index) == RANGE_EXPR)
17601 {
17602 int count = tree_to_shwi (TREE_OPERAND (index, 1))
17603 - tree_to_shwi (TREE_OPERAND (index, 0));
17604 while (count-- > 0)
17605 {
17606 if (val)
17607 memcpy (array + curpos, array + pos, fieldsize);
17608 curpos += fieldsize;
17609 }
17610 }
17611 gcc_assert (curpos <= size);
17612 }
17613 return true;
17614 }
17615 else if (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
17616 || TREE_CODE (type) == UNION_TYPE)
17617 {
17618 tree field = NULL_TREE;
17619 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT cnt;
17620 constructor_elt *ce;
17621
17622 if (int_size_in_bytes (type) != size)
17623 return false;
17624
17625 if (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE)
17626 field = TYPE_FIELDS (type);
17627
17628 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init), cnt, ce)
17629 {
17630 tree val = ce->value;
17631 int pos, fieldsize;
17632
17633 if (ce->index != 0)
17634 field = ce->index;
17635
17636 if (val)
17637 STRIP_NOPS (val);
17638
17639 if (field == NULL_TREE || DECL_BIT_FIELD (field))
17640 return false;
17641
17642 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (field)) == ARRAY_TYPE
17643 && TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (field))
17644 && ! TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (field))))
17645 return false;
17646 else if (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (field) == NULL_TREE
17647 || !tree_fits_shwi_p (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (field)))
17648 return false;
17649 fieldsize = tree_to_shwi (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (field));
17650 pos = int_byte_position (field);
17651 gcc_assert (pos + fieldsize <= size);
17652 if (val
17653 && !native_encode_initializer (val, array + pos, fieldsize))
17654 return false;
17655 }
17656 return true;
17657 }
17658 return false;
17659 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
17660 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
17661 return native_encode_initializer (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0), array, size);
17662 default:
17663 return native_encode_expr (init, array, size) == size;
17664 }
17665 }
17666
17667 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute to DIE. The value of the
17668 attribute is the const value T. */
17669
17670 static bool
17671 tree_add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree t)
17672 {
17673 tree init;
17674 tree type = TREE_TYPE (t);
17675 rtx rtl;
17676
17677 if (!t || !TREE_TYPE (t) || TREE_TYPE (t) == error_mark_node)
17678 return false;
17679
17680 init = t;
17681 gcc_assert (!DECL_P (init));
17682
17683 rtl = rtl_for_decl_init (init, type);
17684 if (rtl)
17685 return add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl);
17686 /* If the host and target are sane, try harder. */
17687 else if (CHAR_BIT == 8 && BITS_PER_UNIT == 8
17688 && initializer_constant_valid_p (init, type))
17689 {
17690 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (init));
17691 if (size > 0 && (int) size == size)
17692 {
17693 unsigned char *array = ggc_cleared_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (size);
17694
17695 if (native_encode_initializer (init, array, size))
17696 {
17697 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, size, 1, array);
17698 return true;
17699 }
17700 ggc_free (array);
17701 }
17702 }
17703 return false;
17704 }
17705
17706 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute to VAR_DIE. The value of the
17707 attribute is the const value of T, where T is an integral constant
17708 variable with static storage duration
17709 (so it can't be a PARM_DECL or a RESULT_DECL). */
17710
17711 static bool
17712 tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (dw_die_ref var_die, tree decl)
17713 {
17714
17715 if (!decl
17716 || (TREE_CODE (decl) != VAR_DECL
17717 && TREE_CODE (decl) != CONST_DECL)
17718 || (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
17719 && !TREE_STATIC (decl)))
17720 return false;
17721
17722 if (TREE_READONLY (decl)
17723 && ! TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl)
17724 && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
17725 /* OK */;
17726 else
17727 return false;
17728
17729 /* Don't add DW_AT_const_value if abstract origin already has one. */
17730 if (get_AT (var_die, DW_AT_const_value))
17731 return false;
17732
17733 return tree_add_const_value_attribute (var_die, DECL_INITIAL (decl));
17734 }
17735
17736 /* Convert the CFI instructions for the current function into a
17737 location list. This is used for DW_AT_frame_base when we targeting
17738 a dwarf2 consumer that does not support the dwarf3
17739 DW_OP_call_frame_cfa. OFFSET is a constant to be added to all CFA
17740 expressions. */
17741
17742 static dw_loc_list_ref
17743 convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list (HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
17744 {
17745 int ix;
17746 dw_fde_ref fde;
17747 dw_loc_list_ref list, *list_tail;
17748 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
17749 dw_cfa_location last_cfa, next_cfa;
17750 const char *start_label, *last_label, *section;
17751 dw_cfa_location remember;
17752
17753 fde = cfun->fde;
17754 gcc_assert (fde != NULL);
17755
17756 section = secname_for_decl (current_function_decl);
17757 list_tail = &list;
17758 list = NULL;
17759
17760 memset (&next_cfa, 0, sizeof (next_cfa));
17761 next_cfa.reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
17762 remember = next_cfa;
17763
17764 start_label = fde->dw_fde_begin;
17765
17766 /* ??? Bald assumption that the CIE opcode list does not contain
17767 advance opcodes. */
17768 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*cie_cfi_vec, ix, cfi)
17769 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, &next_cfa, &remember);
17770
17771 last_cfa = next_cfa;
17772 last_label = start_label;
17773
17774 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin && fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi_index == 0)
17775 {
17776 /* If the first partition contained no CFI adjustments, the
17777 CIE opcodes apply to the whole first partition. */
17778 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
17779 fde->dw_fde_begin, fde->dw_fde_end, section);
17780 list_tail =&(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
17781 start_label = last_label = fde->dw_fde_second_begin;
17782 }
17783
17784 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (fde->dw_fde_cfi, ix, cfi)
17785 {
17786 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
17787 {
17788 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
17789 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
17790 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
17791 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
17792 if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
17793 {
17794 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
17795 start_label, last_label, section);
17796
17797 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
17798 last_cfa = next_cfa;
17799 start_label = last_label;
17800 }
17801 last_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
17802 break;
17803
17804 case DW_CFA_advance_loc:
17805 /* The encoding is complex enough that we should never emit this. */
17806 gcc_unreachable ();
17807
17808 default:
17809 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, &next_cfa, &remember);
17810 break;
17811 }
17812 if (ix + 1 == fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi_index)
17813 {
17814 if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
17815 {
17816 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
17817 start_label, last_label, section);
17818
17819 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
17820 last_cfa = next_cfa;
17821 start_label = last_label;
17822 }
17823 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
17824 start_label, fde->dw_fde_end, section);
17825 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
17826 start_label = last_label = fde->dw_fde_second_begin;
17827 }
17828 }
17829
17830 if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
17831 {
17832 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
17833 start_label, last_label, section);
17834 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
17835 start_label = last_label;
17836 }
17837
17838 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&next_cfa, offset),
17839 start_label,
17840 fde->dw_fde_second_begin
17841 ? fde->dw_fde_second_end : fde->dw_fde_end,
17842 section);
17843
17844 if (list && list->dw_loc_next)
17845 gen_llsym (list);
17846
17847 return list;
17848 }
17849
17850 /* Compute a displacement from the "steady-state frame pointer" to the
17851 frame base (often the same as the CFA), and store it in
17852 frame_pointer_fb_offset. OFFSET is added to the displacement
17853 before the latter is negated. */
17854
17855 static void
17856 compute_frame_pointer_to_fb_displacement (HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
17857 {
17858 rtx reg, elim;
17859
17860 #ifdef FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
17861 reg = frame_pointer_rtx;
17862 offset += FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
17863 #else
17864 reg = arg_pointer_rtx;
17865 offset += ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
17866 #endif
17867
17868 elim = (ira_use_lra_p
17869 ? lra_eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX)
17870 : eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX));
17871 if (GET_CODE (elim) == PLUS)
17872 {
17873 offset += INTVAL (XEXP (elim, 1));
17874 elim = XEXP (elim, 0);
17875 }
17876
17877 frame_pointer_fb_offset = -offset;
17878
17879 /* ??? AVR doesn't set up valid eliminations when there is no stack frame
17880 in which to eliminate. This is because it's stack pointer isn't
17881 directly accessible as a register within the ISA. To work around
17882 this, assume that while we cannot provide a proper value for
17883 frame_pointer_fb_offset, we won't need one either. */
17884 frame_pointer_fb_offset_valid
17885 = ((SUPPORTS_STACK_ALIGNMENT
17886 && (elim == hard_frame_pointer_rtx
17887 || elim == stack_pointer_rtx))
17888 || elim == (frame_pointer_needed
17889 ? hard_frame_pointer_rtx
17890 : stack_pointer_rtx));
17891 }
17892
17893 /* Generate a DW_AT_name attribute given some string value to be included as
17894 the value of the attribute. */
17895
17896 static void
17897 add_name_attribute (dw_die_ref die, const char *name_string)
17898 {
17899 if (name_string != NULL && *name_string != 0)
17900 {
17901 if (demangle_name_func)
17902 name_string = (*demangle_name_func) (name_string);
17903
17904 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name, name_string);
17905 }
17906 }
17907
17908 /* Retrieve the descriptive type of TYPE, if any, make sure it has a
17909 DIE and attach a DW_AT_GNAT_descriptive_type attribute to the DIE
17910 of TYPE accordingly.
17911
17912 ??? This is a temporary measure until after we're able to generate
17913 regular DWARF for the complex Ada type system. */
17914
17915 static void
17916 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree type,
17917 dw_die_ref context_die)
17918 {
17919 tree dtype;
17920 dw_die_ref dtype_die;
17921
17922 if (!lang_hooks.types.descriptive_type)
17923 return;
17924
17925 dtype = lang_hooks.types.descriptive_type (type);
17926 if (!dtype)
17927 return;
17928
17929 dtype_die = lookup_type_die (dtype);
17930 if (!dtype_die)
17931 {
17932 gen_type_die (dtype, context_die);
17933 dtype_die = lookup_type_die (dtype);
17934 gcc_assert (dtype_die);
17935 }
17936
17937 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_GNAT_descriptive_type, dtype_die);
17938 }
17939
17940 /* Retrieve the comp_dir string suitable for use with DW_AT_comp_dir. */
17941
17942 static const char *
17943 comp_dir_string (void)
17944 {
17945 const char *wd;
17946 char *wd1;
17947 static const char *cached_wd = NULL;
17948
17949 if (cached_wd != NULL)
17950 return cached_wd;
17951
17952 wd = get_src_pwd ();
17953 if (wd == NULL)
17954 return NULL;
17955
17956 if (DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR)
17957 {
17958 int wdlen;
17959
17960 wdlen = strlen (wd);
17961 wd1 = ggc_vec_alloc<char> (wdlen + 2);
17962 strcpy (wd1, wd);
17963 wd1 [wdlen] = DIR_SEPARATOR;
17964 wd1 [wdlen + 1] = 0;
17965 wd = wd1;
17966 }
17967
17968 cached_wd = remap_debug_filename (wd);
17969 return cached_wd;
17970 }
17971
17972 /* Generate a DW_AT_comp_dir attribute for DIE. */
17973
17974 static void
17975 add_comp_dir_attribute (dw_die_ref die)
17976 {
17977 const char * wd = comp_dir_string ();
17978 if (wd != NULL)
17979 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_comp_dir, wd);
17980 }
17981
17982 /* Given a tree node VALUE describing a scalar attribute ATTR (i.e. a bound, a
17983 pointer computation, ...), output a representation for that bound according
17984 to the accepted FORMS (see enum dw_scalar_form) and add it to DIE. See
17985 loc_list_from_tree for the meaning of CONTEXT. */
17986
17987 static void
17988 add_scalar_info (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr, tree value,
17989 int forms, const struct loc_descr_context *context)
17990 {
17991 dw_die_ref ctx, decl_die;
17992 dw_loc_list_ref list;
17993
17994 bool strip_conversions = true;
17995
17996 while (strip_conversions)
17997 switch (TREE_CODE (value))
17998 {
17999 case ERROR_MARK:
18000 case SAVE_EXPR:
18001 return;
18002
18003 CASE_CONVERT:
18004 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
18005 value = TREE_OPERAND (value, 0);
18006 break;
18007
18008 default:
18009 strip_conversions = false;
18010 break;
18011 }
18012
18013 /* If possible and permitted, output the attribute as a constant. */
18014 if ((forms & dw_scalar_form_constant) != 0
18015 && TREE_CODE (value) == INTEGER_CST)
18016 {
18017 unsigned int prec = simple_type_size_in_bits (TREE_TYPE (value));
18018
18019 /* If HOST_WIDE_INT is big enough then represent the bound as
18020 a constant value. We need to choose a form based on
18021 whether the type is signed or unsigned. We cannot just
18022 call add_AT_unsigned if the value itself is positive
18023 (add_AT_unsigned might add the unsigned value encoded as
18024 DW_FORM_data[1248]). Some DWARF consumers will lookup the
18025 bounds type and then sign extend any unsigned values found
18026 for signed types. This is needed only for
18027 DW_AT_{lower,upper}_bound, since for most other attributes,
18028 consumers will treat DW_FORM_data[1248] as unsigned values,
18029 regardless of the underlying type. */
18030 if (prec <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
18031 || tree_fits_uhwi_p (value))
18032 {
18033 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (value)))
18034 add_AT_unsigned (die, attr, TREE_INT_CST_LOW (value));
18035 else
18036 add_AT_int (die, attr, TREE_INT_CST_LOW (value));
18037 }
18038 else
18039 /* Otherwise represent the bound as an unsigned value with
18040 the precision of its type. The precision and signedness
18041 of the type will be necessary to re-interpret it
18042 unambiguously. */
18043 add_AT_wide (die, attr, value);
18044 return;
18045 }
18046
18047 /* Otherwise, if it's possible and permitted too, output a reference to
18048 another DIE. */
18049 if ((forms & dw_scalar_form_reference) != 0)
18050 {
18051 tree decl = NULL_TREE;
18052
18053 /* Some type attributes reference an outer type. For instance, the upper
18054 bound of an array may reference an embedding record (this happens in
18055 Ada). */
18056 if (TREE_CODE (value) == COMPONENT_REF
18057 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (value, 0)) == PLACEHOLDER_EXPR
18058 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (value, 1)) == FIELD_DECL)
18059 decl = TREE_OPERAND (value, 1);
18060
18061 else if (TREE_CODE (value) == VAR_DECL
18062 || TREE_CODE (value) == PARM_DECL
18063 || TREE_CODE (value) == RESULT_DECL)
18064 decl = value;
18065
18066 if (decl != NULL_TREE)
18067 {
18068 dw_die_ref decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
18069
18070 /* ??? Can this happen, or should the variable have been bound
18071 first? Probably it can, since I imagine that we try to create
18072 the types of parameters in the order in which they exist in
18073 the list, and won't have created a forward reference to a
18074 later parameter. */
18075 if (decl_die != NULL)
18076 {
18077 add_AT_die_ref (die, attr, decl_die);
18078 return;
18079 }
18080 }
18081 }
18082
18083 /* Last chance: try to create a stack operation procedure to evaluate the
18084 value. Do nothing if even that is not possible or permitted. */
18085 if ((forms & dw_scalar_form_exprloc) == 0)
18086 return;
18087
18088 list = loc_list_from_tree (value, 2, context);
18089 if (list == NULL || single_element_loc_list_p (list))
18090 {
18091 /* If this attribute is not a reference nor constant, it is
18092 a DWARF expression rather than location description. For that
18093 loc_list_from_tree (value, 0, &context) is needed. */
18094 dw_loc_list_ref list2 = loc_list_from_tree (value, 0, context);
18095 if (list2 && single_element_loc_list_p (list2))
18096 {
18097 add_AT_loc (die, attr, list2->expr);
18098 return;
18099 }
18100 }
18101
18102 /* If that failed to give a single element location list, fall back to
18103 outputting this as a reference... still if permitted. */
18104 if (list == NULL || (forms & dw_scalar_form_reference) == 0)
18105 return;
18106
18107 if (current_function_decl == 0)
18108 ctx = comp_unit_die ();
18109 else
18110 ctx = lookup_decl_die (current_function_decl);
18111
18112 decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, ctx, value);
18113 add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
18114 add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (value), TYPE_QUAL_CONST, ctx);
18115 add_AT_location_description (decl_die, DW_AT_location, list);
18116 add_AT_die_ref (die, attr, decl_die);
18117 }
18118
18119 /* Return the default for DW_AT_lower_bound, or -1 if there is not any
18120 default. */
18121
18122 static int
18123 lower_bound_default (void)
18124 {
18125 switch (get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language))
18126 {
18127 case DW_LANG_C:
18128 case DW_LANG_C89:
18129 case DW_LANG_C99:
18130 case DW_LANG_C11:
18131 case DW_LANG_C_plus_plus:
18132 case DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_11:
18133 case DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_14:
18134 case DW_LANG_ObjC:
18135 case DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus:
18136 case DW_LANG_Java:
18137 return 0;
18138 case DW_LANG_Fortran77:
18139 case DW_LANG_Fortran90:
18140 case DW_LANG_Fortran95:
18141 case DW_LANG_Fortran03:
18142 case DW_LANG_Fortran08:
18143 return 1;
18144 case DW_LANG_UPC:
18145 case DW_LANG_D:
18146 case DW_LANG_Python:
18147 return dwarf_version >= 4 ? 0 : -1;
18148 case DW_LANG_Ada95:
18149 case DW_LANG_Ada83:
18150 case DW_LANG_Cobol74:
18151 case DW_LANG_Cobol85:
18152 case DW_LANG_Pascal83:
18153 case DW_LANG_Modula2:
18154 case DW_LANG_PLI:
18155 return dwarf_version >= 4 ? 1 : -1;
18156 default:
18157 return -1;
18158 }
18159 }
18160
18161 /* Given a tree node describing an array bound (either lower or upper) output
18162 a representation for that bound. */
18163
18164 static void
18165 add_bound_info (dw_die_ref subrange_die, enum dwarf_attribute bound_attr,
18166 tree bound, const struct loc_descr_context *context)
18167 {
18168 int dflt;
18169
18170 while (1)
18171 switch (TREE_CODE (bound))
18172 {
18173 /* Strip all conversions. */
18174 CASE_CONVERT:
18175 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
18176 bound = TREE_OPERAND (bound, 0);
18177 break;
18178
18179 /* All fixed-bounds are represented by INTEGER_CST nodes. Lower bounds
18180 are even omitted when they are the default. */
18181 case INTEGER_CST:
18182 /* If the value for this bound is the default one, we can even omit the
18183 attribute. */
18184 if (bound_attr == DW_AT_lower_bound
18185 && tree_fits_shwi_p (bound)
18186 && (dflt = lower_bound_default ()) != -1
18187 && tree_to_shwi (bound) == dflt)
18188 return;
18189
18190 /* FALLTHRU */
18191
18192 default:
18193 /* Because of the complex interaction there can be with other GNAT
18194 encodings, GDB isn't ready yet to handle proper DWARF description
18195 for self-referencial subrange bounds: let GNAT encodings do the
18196 magic in such a case. */
18197 if (gnat_encodings != DWARF_GNAT_ENCODINGS_MINIMAL
18198 && contains_placeholder_p (bound))
18199 return;
18200
18201 add_scalar_info (subrange_die, bound_attr, bound,
18202 dw_scalar_form_constant
18203 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
18204 | dw_scalar_form_reference,
18205 context);
18206 return;
18207 }
18208 }
18209
18210 /* Add subscript info to TYPE_DIE, describing an array TYPE, collapsing
18211 possibly nested array subscripts in a flat sequence if COLLAPSE_P is true.
18212 Note that the block of subscript information for an array type also
18213 includes information about the element type of the given array type.
18214
18215 This function reuses previously set type and bound information if
18216 available. */
18217
18218 static void
18219 add_subscript_info (dw_die_ref type_die, tree type, bool collapse_p)
18220 {
18221 unsigned dimension_number;
18222 tree lower, upper;
18223 dw_die_ref child = type_die->die_child;
18224
18225 for (dimension_number = 0;
18226 TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE && (dimension_number == 0 || collapse_p);
18227 type = TREE_TYPE (type), dimension_number++)
18228 {
18229 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
18230
18231 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type) && is_fortran () && dimension_number > 0)
18232 break;
18233
18234 /* Arrays come in three flavors: Unspecified bounds, fixed bounds,
18235 and (in GNU C only) variable bounds. Handle all three forms
18236 here. */
18237
18238 /* Find and reuse a previously generated DW_TAG_subrange_type if
18239 available.
18240
18241 For multi-dimensional arrays, as we iterate through the
18242 various dimensions in the enclosing for loop above, we also
18243 iterate through the DIE children and pick at each
18244 DW_TAG_subrange_type previously generated (if available).
18245 Each child DW_TAG_subrange_type DIE describes the range of
18246 the current dimension. At this point we should have as many
18247 DW_TAG_subrange_type's as we have dimensions in the
18248 array. */
18249 dw_die_ref subrange_die = NULL;
18250 if (child)
18251 while (1)
18252 {
18253 child = child->die_sib;
18254 if (child->die_tag == DW_TAG_subrange_type)
18255 subrange_die = child;
18256 if (child == type_die->die_child)
18257 {
18258 /* If we wrapped around, stop looking next time. */
18259 child = NULL;
18260 break;
18261 }
18262 if (child->die_tag == DW_TAG_subrange_type)
18263 break;
18264 }
18265 if (!subrange_die)
18266 subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, type_die, NULL);
18267
18268 if (domain)
18269 {
18270 /* We have an array type with specified bounds. */
18271 lower = TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain);
18272 upper = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain);
18273
18274 /* Define the index type. */
18275 if (TREE_TYPE (domain)
18276 && !get_AT (subrange_die, DW_AT_type))
18277 {
18278 /* ??? This is probably an Ada unnamed subrange type. Ignore the
18279 TREE_TYPE field. We can't emit debug info for this
18280 because it is an unnamed integral type. */
18281 if (TREE_CODE (domain) == INTEGER_TYPE
18282 && TYPE_NAME (domain) == NULL_TREE
18283 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == INTEGER_TYPE
18284 && TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == NULL_TREE)
18285 ;
18286 else
18287 add_type_attribute (subrange_die, TREE_TYPE (domain),
18288 TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, type_die);
18289 }
18290
18291 /* ??? If upper is NULL, the array has unspecified length,
18292 but it does have a lower bound. This happens with Fortran
18293 dimension arr(N:*)
18294 Since the debugger is definitely going to need to know N
18295 to produce useful results, go ahead and output the lower
18296 bound solo, and hope the debugger can cope. */
18297
18298 if (!get_AT (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound))
18299 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, lower, NULL);
18300 if (upper && !get_AT (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound))
18301 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound, upper, NULL);
18302 }
18303
18304 /* Otherwise we have an array type with an unspecified length. The
18305 DWARF-2 spec does not say how to handle this; let's just leave out the
18306 bounds. */
18307 }
18308 }
18309
18310 /* Add a DW_AT_byte_size attribute to DIE with TREE_NODE's size. */
18311
18312 static void
18313 add_byte_size_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree tree_node)
18314 {
18315 dw_die_ref decl_die;
18316 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
18317 dw_loc_descr_ref size_expr = NULL;
18318
18319 switch (TREE_CODE (tree_node))
18320 {
18321 case ERROR_MARK:
18322 size = 0;
18323 break;
18324 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
18325 case RECORD_TYPE:
18326 case UNION_TYPE:
18327 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
18328 if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (tree_node)) == VAR_DECL
18329 && (decl_die = lookup_decl_die (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (tree_node))))
18330 {
18331 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_byte_size, decl_die);
18332 return;
18333 }
18334 size_expr = type_byte_size (tree_node, &size);
18335 break;
18336 case FIELD_DECL:
18337 /* For a data member of a struct or union, the DW_AT_byte_size is
18338 generally given as the number of bytes normally allocated for an
18339 object of the *declared* type of the member itself. This is true
18340 even for bit-fields. */
18341 size = int_size_in_bytes (field_type (tree_node));
18342 break;
18343 default:
18344 gcc_unreachable ();
18345 }
18346
18347 /* Support for dynamically-sized objects was introduced by DWARFv3.
18348 At the moment, GDB does not handle variable byte sizes very well,
18349 though. */
18350 if ((dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
18351 && gnat_encodings == DWARF_GNAT_ENCODINGS_MINIMAL
18352 && size_expr != NULL)
18353 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_byte_size, size_expr);
18354
18355 /* Note that `size' might be -1 when we get to this point. If it is, that
18356 indicates that the byte size of the entity in question is variable and
18357 that we could not generate a DWARF expression that computes it. */
18358 if (size >= 0)
18359 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_byte_size, size);
18360 }
18361
18362 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit-field, output an attribute
18363 which specifies the distance in bits from the highest order bit of the
18364 "containing object" for the bit-field to the highest order bit of the
18365 bit-field itself.
18366
18367 For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
18368 (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives. The
18369 type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
18370 declared type of the individual bit-field itself. The determination of the
18371 exact location of the "containing object" for a bit-field is rather
18372 complicated. It's handled by the `field_byte_offset' function (above).
18373
18374 CTX is required: see the comment for VLR_CONTEXT.
18375
18376 Note that it is the size (in bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object"
18377 which will be given in the DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field.
18378 (See `byte_size_attribute' above). */
18379
18380 static inline void
18381 add_bit_offset_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl, struct vlr_context *ctx)
18382 {
18383 HOST_WIDE_INT object_offset_in_bytes;
18384 tree original_type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
18385 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos_int;
18386 HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_object_bit_offset;
18387 HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_field_bit_offset;
18388 HOST_WIDE_INT bit_offset;
18389
18390 field_byte_offset (decl, ctx, &object_offset_in_bytes);
18391
18392 /* Must be a field and a bit field. */
18393 gcc_assert (original_type && TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL);
18394
18395 /* We can't yet handle bit-fields whose offsets are variable, so if we
18396 encounter such things, just return without generating any attribute
18397 whatsoever. Likewise for variable or too large size. */
18398 if (! tree_fits_shwi_p (bit_position (decl))
18399 || ! tree_fits_uhwi_p (DECL_SIZE (decl)))
18400 return;
18401
18402 bitpos_int = int_bit_position (decl);
18403
18404 /* Note that the bit offset is always the distance (in bits) from the
18405 highest-order bit of the "containing object" to the highest-order bit of
18406 the bit-field itself. Since the "high-order end" of any object or field
18407 is different on big-endian and little-endian machines, the computation
18408 below must take account of these differences. */
18409 highest_order_object_bit_offset = object_offset_in_bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT;
18410 highest_order_field_bit_offset = bitpos_int;
18411
18412 if (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
18413 {
18414 highest_order_field_bit_offset += tree_to_shwi (DECL_SIZE (decl));
18415 highest_order_object_bit_offset +=
18416 simple_type_size_in_bits (original_type);
18417 }
18418
18419 bit_offset
18420 = (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
18421 ? highest_order_object_bit_offset - highest_order_field_bit_offset
18422 : highest_order_field_bit_offset - highest_order_object_bit_offset);
18423
18424 if (bit_offset < 0)
18425 add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_bit_offset, bit_offset);
18426 else
18427 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_offset, (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) bit_offset);
18428 }
18429
18430 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit field, output an attribute
18431 which specifies the length in bits of the given field. */
18432
18433 static inline void
18434 add_bit_size_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
18435 {
18436 /* Must be a field and a bit field. */
18437 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL
18438 && DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl));
18439
18440 if (tree_fits_uhwi_p (DECL_SIZE (decl)))
18441 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_size, tree_to_uhwi (DECL_SIZE (decl)));
18442 }
18443
18444 /* If the compiled language is ANSI C, then add a 'prototyped'
18445 attribute, if arg types are given for the parameters of a function. */
18446
18447 static inline void
18448 add_prototyped_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree func_type)
18449 {
18450 switch (get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language))
18451 {
18452 case DW_LANG_C:
18453 case DW_LANG_C89:
18454 case DW_LANG_C99:
18455 case DW_LANG_C11:
18456 case DW_LANG_ObjC:
18457 if (prototype_p (func_type))
18458 add_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_prototyped, 1);
18459 break;
18460 default:
18461 break;
18462 }
18463 }
18464
18465 /* Add an 'abstract_origin' attribute below a given DIE. The DIE is found
18466 by looking in either the type declaration or object declaration
18467 equate table. */
18468
18469 static inline dw_die_ref
18470 add_abstract_origin_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree origin)
18471 {
18472 dw_die_ref origin_die = NULL;
18473
18474 if (TREE_CODE (origin) != FUNCTION_DECL)
18475 {
18476 /* We may have gotten separated from the block for the inlined
18477 function, if we're in an exception handler or some such; make
18478 sure that the abstract function has been written out.
18479
18480 Doing this for nested functions is wrong, however; functions are
18481 distinct units, and our context might not even be inline. */
18482 tree fn = origin;
18483
18484 if (TYPE_P (fn))
18485 fn = TYPE_STUB_DECL (fn);
18486
18487 fn = decl_function_context (fn);
18488 if (fn)
18489 dwarf2out_abstract_function (fn);
18490 }
18491
18492 if (DECL_P (origin))
18493 origin_die = lookup_decl_die (origin);
18494 else if (TYPE_P (origin))
18495 origin_die = lookup_type_die (origin);
18496
18497 /* XXX: Functions that are never lowered don't always have correct block
18498 trees (in the case of java, they simply have no block tree, in some other
18499 languages). For these functions, there is nothing we can really do to
18500 output correct debug info for inlined functions in all cases. Rather
18501 than die, we'll just produce deficient debug info now, in that we will
18502 have variables without a proper abstract origin. In the future, when all
18503 functions are lowered, we should re-add a gcc_assert (origin_die)
18504 here. */
18505
18506 if (origin_die)
18507 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin, origin_die);
18508 return origin_die;
18509 }
18510
18511 /* We do not currently support the pure_virtual attribute. */
18512
18513 static inline void
18514 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree func_decl)
18515 {
18516 if (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl))
18517 {
18518 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
18519
18520 if (tree_fits_shwi_p (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl)))
18521 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_vtable_elem_location,
18522 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_constu,
18523 tree_to_shwi (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl)),
18524 0));
18525
18526 /* GNU extension: Record what type this method came from originally. */
18527 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
18528 && DECL_CONTEXT (func_decl))
18529 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_containing_type,
18530 lookup_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (func_decl)));
18531 }
18532 }
18533 \f
18534 /* Add a DW_AT_linkage_name or DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name attribute for the
18535 given decl. This used to be a vendor extension until after DWARF 4
18536 standardized it. */
18537
18538 static void
18539 add_linkage_attr (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
18540 {
18541 const char *name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl));
18542
18543 /* Mimic what assemble_name_raw does with a leading '*'. */
18544 if (name[0] == '*')
18545 name = &name[1];
18546
18547 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
18548 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_linkage_name, name);
18549 else
18550 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name, name);
18551 }
18552
18553 /* Add source coordinate attributes for the given decl. */
18554
18555 static void
18556 add_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
18557 {
18558 expanded_location s;
18559
18560 if (LOCATION_LOCUS (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl)) == UNKNOWN_LOCATION)
18561 return;
18562 s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
18563 add_AT_file (die, DW_AT_decl_file, lookup_filename (s.file));
18564 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
18565 }
18566
18567 /* Add DW_AT_{,MIPS_}linkage_name attribute for the given decl. */
18568
18569 static void
18570 add_linkage_name (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
18571 {
18572 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_NONE
18573 && (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL)
18574 && TREE_PUBLIC (decl)
18575 && !(TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && DECL_REGISTER (decl))
18576 && die->die_tag != DW_TAG_member)
18577 {
18578 /* Defer until we have an assembler name set. */
18579 if (!DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME_SET_P (decl))
18580 {
18581 limbo_die_node *asm_name;
18582
18583 asm_name = ggc_cleared_alloc<limbo_die_node> ();
18584 asm_name->die = die;
18585 asm_name->created_for = decl;
18586 asm_name->next = deferred_asm_name;
18587 deferred_asm_name = asm_name;
18588 }
18589 else if (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl) != DECL_NAME (decl))
18590 add_linkage_attr (die, decl);
18591 }
18592 }
18593
18594 /* Add a DW_AT_name attribute and source coordinate attribute for the
18595 given decl, but only if it actually has a name. */
18596
18597 static void
18598 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
18599 {
18600 tree decl_name;
18601
18602 decl_name = DECL_NAME (decl);
18603 if (decl_name != NULL && IDENTIFIER_POINTER (decl_name) != NULL)
18604 {
18605 const char *name = dwarf2_name (decl, 0);
18606 if (name)
18607 add_name_attribute (die, name);
18608 if (! DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
18609 add_src_coords_attributes (die, decl);
18610
18611 add_linkage_name (die, decl);
18612 }
18613
18614 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
18615 /* Get the function's name, as described by its RTL. This may be different
18616 from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file. */
18617 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL && TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
18618 {
18619 add_AT_addr (die, DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address,
18620 XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0), false);
18621 vec_safe_push (used_rtx_array, XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0));
18622 }
18623 #endif /* VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO */
18624 }
18625
18626 /* Add VALUE as a DW_AT_discr_value attribute to DIE. */
18627
18628 static void
18629 add_discr_value (dw_die_ref die, dw_discr_value *value)
18630 {
18631 dw_attr_node attr;
18632
18633 attr.dw_attr = DW_AT_discr_value;
18634 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_discr_value;
18635 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
18636 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_value.pos = value->pos;
18637 if (value->pos)
18638 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_value.v.uval = value->v.uval;
18639 else
18640 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_value.v.sval = value->v.sval;
18641 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
18642 }
18643
18644 /* Add DISCR_LIST as a DW_AT_discr_list to DIE. */
18645
18646 static void
18647 add_discr_list (dw_die_ref die, dw_discr_list_ref discr_list)
18648 {
18649 dw_attr_node attr;
18650
18651 attr.dw_attr = DW_AT_discr_list;
18652 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_discr_list;
18653 attr.dw_attr_val.val_entry = NULL;
18654 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_list = discr_list;
18655 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
18656 }
18657
18658 static inline dw_discr_list_ref
18659 AT_discr_list (dw_attr_node *attr)
18660 {
18661 return attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_discr_list;
18662 }
18663
18664 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
18665 /* Output the debug main pointer die for VMS */
18666
18667 void
18668 dwarf2out_vms_debug_main_pointer (void)
18669 {
18670 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
18671 dw_die_ref die;
18672
18673 /* Allocate the VMS debug main subprogram die. */
18674 die = ggc_cleared_alloc<die_node> ();
18675 die->die_tag = DW_TAG_subprogram;
18676 add_name_attribute (die, VMS_DEBUG_MAIN_POINTER);
18677 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, PROLOGUE_END_LABEL,
18678 current_function_funcdef_no);
18679 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_entry_pc, label);
18680
18681 /* Make it the first child of comp_unit_die (). */
18682 die->die_parent = comp_unit_die ();
18683 if (comp_unit_die ()->die_child)
18684 {
18685 die->die_sib = comp_unit_die ()->die_child->die_sib;
18686 comp_unit_die ()->die_child->die_sib = die;
18687 }
18688 else
18689 {
18690 die->die_sib = die;
18691 comp_unit_die ()->die_child = die;
18692 }
18693 }
18694 #endif /* VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO */
18695
18696 /* Push a new declaration scope. */
18697
18698 static void
18699 push_decl_scope (tree scope)
18700 {
18701 vec_safe_push (decl_scope_table, scope);
18702 }
18703
18704 /* Pop a declaration scope. */
18705
18706 static inline void
18707 pop_decl_scope (void)
18708 {
18709 decl_scope_table->pop ();
18710 }
18711
18712 /* walk_tree helper function for uses_local_type, below. */
18713
18714 static tree
18715 uses_local_type_r (tree *tp, int *walk_subtrees, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
18716 {
18717 if (!TYPE_P (*tp))
18718 *walk_subtrees = 0;
18719 else
18720 {
18721 tree name = TYPE_NAME (*tp);
18722 if (name && DECL_P (name) && decl_function_context (name))
18723 return *tp;
18724 }
18725 return NULL_TREE;
18726 }
18727
18728 /* If TYPE involves a function-local type (including a local typedef to a
18729 non-local type), returns that type; otherwise returns NULL_TREE. */
18730
18731 static tree
18732 uses_local_type (tree type)
18733 {
18734 tree used = walk_tree_without_duplicates (&type, uses_local_type_r, NULL);
18735 return used;
18736 }
18737
18738 /* Return the DIE for the scope that immediately contains this type.
18739 Non-named types that do not involve a function-local type get global
18740 scope. Named types nested in namespaces or other types get their
18741 containing scope. All other types (i.e. function-local named types) get
18742 the current active scope. */
18743
18744 static dw_die_ref
18745 scope_die_for (tree t, dw_die_ref context_die)
18746 {
18747 dw_die_ref scope_die = NULL;
18748 tree containing_scope;
18749
18750 /* Non-types always go in the current scope. */
18751 gcc_assert (TYPE_P (t));
18752
18753 /* Use the scope of the typedef, rather than the scope of the type
18754 it refers to. */
18755 if (TYPE_NAME (t) && DECL_P (TYPE_NAME (t)))
18756 containing_scope = DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (t));
18757 else
18758 containing_scope = TYPE_CONTEXT (t);
18759
18760 /* Use the containing namespace if there is one. */
18761 if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
18762 {
18763 if (context_die == lookup_decl_die (containing_scope))
18764 /* OK */;
18765 else if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
18766 context_die = get_context_die (containing_scope);
18767 else
18768 containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
18769 }
18770
18771 /* Ignore function type "scopes" from the C frontend. They mean that
18772 a tagged type is local to a parmlist of a function declarator, but
18773 that isn't useful to DWARF. */
18774 if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == FUNCTION_TYPE)
18775 containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
18776
18777 if (SCOPE_FILE_SCOPE_P (containing_scope))
18778 {
18779 /* If T uses a local type keep it local as well, to avoid references
18780 to function-local DIEs from outside the function. */
18781 if (current_function_decl && uses_local_type (t))
18782 scope_die = context_die;
18783 else
18784 scope_die = comp_unit_die ();
18785 }
18786 else if (TYPE_P (containing_scope))
18787 {
18788 /* For types, we can just look up the appropriate DIE. */
18789 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
18790 scope_die = get_context_die (containing_scope);
18791 else
18792 {
18793 scope_die = lookup_type_die_strip_naming_typedef (containing_scope);
18794 if (scope_die == NULL)
18795 scope_die = comp_unit_die ();
18796 }
18797 }
18798 else
18799 scope_die = context_die;
18800
18801 return scope_die;
18802 }
18803
18804 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is internal to a function. */
18805
18806 static inline int
18807 local_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
18808 {
18809 for (; context_die; context_die = context_die->die_parent)
18810 if (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine
18811 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
18812 return 1;
18813
18814 return 0;
18815 }
18816
18817 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is a class. */
18818
18819 static inline int
18820 class_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
18821 {
18822 return (context_die
18823 && (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_structure_type
18824 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type
18825 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_interface_type
18826 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_union_type));
18827 }
18828
18829 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is a class or namespace, for deciding
18830 whether or not to treat a DIE in this context as a declaration. */
18831
18832 static inline int
18833 class_or_namespace_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
18834 {
18835 return (class_scope_p (context_die)
18836 || (context_die && context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace));
18837 }
18838
18839 /* Many forms of DIEs require a "type description" attribute. This
18840 routine locates the proper "type descriptor" die for the type given
18841 by 'type' plus any additional qualifiers given by 'cv_quals', and
18842 adds a DW_AT_type attribute below the given die. */
18843
18844 static void
18845 add_type_attribute (dw_die_ref object_die, tree type, int cv_quals,
18846 dw_die_ref context_die)
18847 {
18848 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
18849 dw_die_ref type_die = NULL;
18850
18851 /* ??? If this type is an unnamed subrange type of an integral, floating-point
18852 or fixed-point type, use the inner type. This is because we have no
18853 support for unnamed types in base_type_die. This can happen if this is
18854 an Ada subrange type. Correct solution is emit a subrange type die. */
18855 if ((code == INTEGER_TYPE || code == REAL_TYPE || code == FIXED_POINT_TYPE)
18856 && TREE_TYPE (type) != 0 && TYPE_NAME (type) == 0)
18857 type = TREE_TYPE (type), code = TREE_CODE (type);
18858
18859 if (code == ERROR_MARK
18860 /* Handle a special case. For functions whose return type is void, we
18861 generate *no* type attribute. (Note that no object may have type
18862 `void', so this only applies to function return types). */
18863 || code == VOID_TYPE)
18864 return;
18865
18866 type_die = modified_type_die (type,
18867 cv_quals | TYPE_QUALS_NO_ADDR_SPACE (type),
18868 context_die);
18869
18870 if (type_die != NULL)
18871 add_AT_die_ref (object_die, DW_AT_type, type_die);
18872 }
18873
18874 /* Given an object die, add the calling convention attribute for the
18875 function call type. */
18876 static void
18877 add_calling_convention_attribute (dw_die_ref subr_die, tree decl)
18878 {
18879 enum dwarf_calling_convention value = DW_CC_normal;
18880
18881 value = ((enum dwarf_calling_convention)
18882 targetm.dwarf_calling_convention (TREE_TYPE (decl)));
18883
18884 if (is_fortran ()
18885 && !strcmp (IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl)), "MAIN__"))
18886 {
18887 /* DWARF 2 doesn't provide a way to identify a program's source-level
18888 entry point. DW_AT_calling_convention attributes are only meant
18889 to describe functions' calling conventions. However, lacking a
18890 better way to signal the Fortran main program, we used this for
18891 a long time, following existing custom. Now, DWARF 4 has
18892 DW_AT_main_subprogram, which we add below, but some tools still
18893 rely on the old way, which we thus keep. */
18894 value = DW_CC_program;
18895
18896 if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
18897 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_main_subprogram, 1);
18898 }
18899
18900 /* Only add the attribute if the backend requests it, and
18901 is not DW_CC_normal. */
18902 if (value && (value != DW_CC_normal))
18903 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_calling_convention, value);
18904 }
18905
18906 /* Given a tree pointer to a struct, class, union, or enum type node, return
18907 a pointer to the (string) tag name for the given type, or zero if the type
18908 was declared without a tag. */
18909
18910 static const char *
18911 type_tag (const_tree type)
18912 {
18913 const char *name = 0;
18914
18915 if (TYPE_NAME (type) != 0)
18916 {
18917 tree t = 0;
18918
18919 /* Find the IDENTIFIER_NODE for the type name. */
18920 if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == IDENTIFIER_NODE
18921 && !TYPE_NAMELESS (type))
18922 t = TYPE_NAME (type);
18923
18924 /* The g++ front end makes the TYPE_NAME of *each* tagged type point to
18925 a TYPE_DECL node, regardless of whether or not a `typedef' was
18926 involved. */
18927 else if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
18928 && ! DECL_IGNORED_P (TYPE_NAME (type)))
18929 {
18930 /* We want to be extra verbose. Don't call dwarf_name if
18931 DECL_NAME isn't set. The default hook for decl_printable_name
18932 doesn't like that, and in this context it's correct to return
18933 0, instead of "<anonymous>" or the like. */
18934 if (DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type))
18935 && !DECL_NAMELESS (TYPE_NAME (type)))
18936 name = lang_hooks.dwarf_name (TYPE_NAME (type), 2);
18937 }
18938
18939 /* Now get the name as a string, or invent one. */
18940 if (!name && t != 0)
18941 name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (t);
18942 }
18943
18944 return (name == 0 || *name == '\0') ? 0 : name;
18945 }
18946
18947 /* Return the type associated with a data member, make a special check
18948 for bit field types. */
18949
18950 static inline tree
18951 member_declared_type (const_tree member)
18952 {
18953 return (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member)
18954 ? DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member) : TREE_TYPE (member));
18955 }
18956
18957 /* Get the decl's label, as described by its RTL. This may be different
18958 from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file. */
18959
18960 #if 0
18961 static const char *
18962 decl_start_label (tree decl)
18963 {
18964 rtx x;
18965 const char *fnname;
18966
18967 x = DECL_RTL (decl);
18968 gcc_assert (MEM_P (x));
18969
18970 x = XEXP (x, 0);
18971 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF);
18972
18973 fnname = XSTR (x, 0);
18974 return fnname;
18975 }
18976 #endif
18977 \f
18978 /* For variable-length arrays that have been previously generated, but
18979 may be incomplete due to missing subscript info, fill the subscript
18980 info. Return TRUE if this is one of those cases. */
18981 static bool
18982 fill_variable_array_bounds (tree type)
18983 {
18984 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type)
18985 && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
18986 && variably_modified_type_p (type, NULL))
18987 {
18988 dw_die_ref array_die = lookup_type_die (type);
18989 if (!array_die)
18990 return false;
18991 add_subscript_info (array_die, type, !is_ada ());
18992 return true;
18993 }
18994 return false;
18995 }
18996
18997 /* These routines generate the internal representation of the DIE's for
18998 the compilation unit. Debugging information is collected by walking
18999 the declaration trees passed in from dwarf2out_decl(). */
19000
19001 static void
19002 gen_array_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
19003 {
19004 dw_die_ref array_die;
19005
19006 /* GNU compilers represent multidimensional array types as sequences of one
19007 dimensional array types whose element types are themselves array types.
19008 We sometimes squish that down to a single array_type DIE with multiple
19009 subscripts in the Dwarf debugging info. The draft Dwarf specification
19010 say that we are allowed to do this kind of compression in C, because
19011 there is no difference between an array of arrays and a multidimensional
19012 array. We don't do this for Ada to remain as close as possible to the
19013 actual representation, which is especially important against the language
19014 flexibilty wrt arrays of variable size. */
19015
19016 bool collapse_nested_arrays = !is_ada ();
19017
19018 if (fill_variable_array_bounds (type))
19019 return;
19020
19021 dw_die_ref scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
19022 tree element_type;
19023
19024 /* Emit DW_TAG_string_type for Fortran character types (with kind 1 only, as
19025 DW_TAG_string_type doesn't have DW_AT_type attribute). */
19026 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type)
19027 && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
19028 && is_fortran ()
19029 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == TYPE_MODE (char_type_node))
19030 {
19031 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
19032
19033 array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_string_type, scope_die, type);
19034 add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
19035 equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
19036 size = int_size_in_bytes (type);
19037 if (size >= 0)
19038 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_byte_size, size);
19039 else if (TYPE_DOMAIN (type) != NULL_TREE
19040 && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type)) != NULL_TREE
19041 && DECL_P (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type))))
19042 {
19043 tree szdecl = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type));
19044 dw_loc_list_ref loc = loc_list_from_tree (szdecl, 2, NULL);
19045
19046 size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (szdecl));
19047 if (loc && size > 0)
19048 {
19049 add_AT_location_description (array_die, DW_AT_string_length, loc);
19050 if (size != DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
19051 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_byte_size, size);
19052 }
19053 }
19054 return;
19055 }
19056
19057 array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_array_type, scope_die, type);
19058 add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
19059 equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
19060
19061 if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
19062 add_AT_flag (array_die, DW_AT_GNU_vector, 1);
19063
19064 /* For Fortran multidimensional arrays use DW_ORD_col_major ordering. */
19065 if (is_fortran ()
19066 && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
19067 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == ARRAY_TYPE
19068 && !TYPE_STRING_FLAG (TREE_TYPE (type)))
19069 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_col_major);
19070
19071 #if 0
19072 /* We default the array ordering. SDB will probably do
19073 the right things even if DW_AT_ordering is not present. It's not even
19074 an issue until we start to get into multidimensional arrays anyway. If
19075 SDB is ever caught doing the Wrong Thing for multi-dimensional arrays,
19076 then we'll have to put the DW_AT_ordering attribute back in. (But if
19077 and when we find out that we need to put these in, we will only do so
19078 for multidimensional arrays. */
19079 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_row_major);
19080 #endif
19081
19082 if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
19083 {
19084 /* For VECTOR_TYPEs we use an array die with appropriate bounds. */
19085 dw_die_ref subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, array_die, NULL);
19086 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, size_zero_node, NULL);
19087 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound,
19088 size_int (TYPE_VECTOR_SUBPARTS (type) - 1), NULL);
19089 }
19090 else
19091 add_subscript_info (array_die, type, collapse_nested_arrays);
19092
19093 /* Add representation of the type of the elements of this array type and
19094 emit the corresponding DIE if we haven't done it already. */
19095 element_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
19096 if (collapse_nested_arrays)
19097 while (TREE_CODE (element_type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
19098 {
19099 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (element_type) && is_fortran ())
19100 break;
19101 element_type = TREE_TYPE (element_type);
19102 }
19103
19104 add_type_attribute (array_die, element_type, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, context_die);
19105
19106 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (array_die, type, context_die);
19107 if (TYPE_ARTIFICIAL (type))
19108 add_AT_flag (array_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
19109
19110 if (get_AT (array_die, DW_AT_name))
19111 add_pubtype (type, array_die);
19112 }
19113
19114 /* This routine generates DIE for array with hidden descriptor, details
19115 are filled into *info by a langhook. */
19116
19117 static void
19118 gen_descr_array_type_die (tree type, struct array_descr_info *info,
19119 dw_die_ref context_die)
19120 {
19121 const dw_die_ref scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
19122 const dw_die_ref array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_array_type, scope_die, type);
19123 const struct loc_descr_context context = { type, info->base_decl, NULL };
19124 int dim;
19125
19126 add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
19127 equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
19128
19129 if (info->ndimensions > 1)
19130 switch (info->ordering)
19131 {
19132 case array_descr_ordering_row_major:
19133 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_row_major);
19134 break;
19135 case array_descr_ordering_column_major:
19136 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_col_major);
19137 break;
19138 default:
19139 break;
19140 }
19141
19142 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
19143 {
19144 if (info->data_location)
19145 add_scalar_info (array_die, DW_AT_data_location, info->data_location,
19146 dw_scalar_form_exprloc, &context);
19147 if (info->associated)
19148 add_scalar_info (array_die, DW_AT_associated, info->associated,
19149 dw_scalar_form_constant
19150 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
19151 | dw_scalar_form_reference, &context);
19152 if (info->allocated)
19153 add_scalar_info (array_die, DW_AT_allocated, info->allocated,
19154 dw_scalar_form_constant
19155 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
19156 | dw_scalar_form_reference, &context);
19157 if (info->stride)
19158 {
19159 const enum dwarf_attribute attr
19160 = (info->stride_in_bits) ? DW_AT_bit_stride : DW_AT_byte_stride;
19161 const int forms
19162 = (info->stride_in_bits)
19163 ? dw_scalar_form_constant
19164 : (dw_scalar_form_constant
19165 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
19166 | dw_scalar_form_reference);
19167
19168 add_scalar_info (array_die, attr, info->stride, forms, &context);
19169 }
19170 }
19171
19172 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (array_die, type, context_die);
19173
19174 for (dim = 0; dim < info->ndimensions; dim++)
19175 {
19176 dw_die_ref subrange_die
19177 = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, array_die, NULL);
19178
19179 if (info->dimen[dim].bounds_type)
19180 add_type_attribute (subrange_die,
19181 info->dimen[dim].bounds_type, 0,
19182 context_die);
19183 if (info->dimen[dim].lower_bound)
19184 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound,
19185 info->dimen[dim].lower_bound, &context);
19186 if (info->dimen[dim].upper_bound)
19187 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound,
19188 info->dimen[dim].upper_bound, &context);
19189 if ((dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict) && info->dimen[dim].stride)
19190 add_scalar_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_byte_stride,
19191 info->dimen[dim].stride,
19192 dw_scalar_form_constant
19193 | dw_scalar_form_exprloc
19194 | dw_scalar_form_reference,
19195 &context);
19196 }
19197
19198 gen_type_die (info->element_type, context_die);
19199 add_type_attribute (array_die, info->element_type, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED,
19200 context_die);
19201
19202 if (get_AT (array_die, DW_AT_name))
19203 add_pubtype (type, array_die);
19204 }
19205
19206 #if 0
19207 static void
19208 gen_entry_point_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
19209 {
19210 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
19211 dw_die_ref decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_entry_point, context_die, decl);
19212
19213 if (origin != NULL)
19214 add_abstract_origin_attribute (decl_die, origin);
19215 else
19216 {
19217 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
19218 add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
19219 TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, context_die);
19220 }
19221
19222 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl))
19223 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die);
19224 else
19225 add_AT_lbl_id (decl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, decl_start_label (decl));
19226 }
19227 #endif
19228
19229 /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
19230 emit full debugging info for them. */
19231
19232 static void
19233 retry_incomplete_types (void)
19234 {
19235 int i;
19236
19237 for (i = vec_safe_length (incomplete_types) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
19238 if (should_emit_struct_debug ((*incomplete_types)[i], DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE))
19239 gen_type_die ((*incomplete_types)[i], comp_unit_die ());
19240 }
19241
19242 /* Determine what tag to use for a record type. */
19243
19244 static enum dwarf_tag
19245 record_type_tag (tree type)
19246 {
19247 if (! lang_hooks.types.classify_record)
19248 return DW_TAG_structure_type;
19249
19250 switch (lang_hooks.types.classify_record (type))
19251 {
19252 case RECORD_IS_STRUCT:
19253 return DW_TAG_structure_type;
19254
19255 case RECORD_IS_CLASS:
19256 return DW_TAG_class_type;
19257
19258 case RECORD_IS_INTERFACE:
19259 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
19260 return DW_TAG_interface_type;
19261 return DW_TAG_structure_type;
19262
19263 default:
19264 gcc_unreachable ();
19265 }
19266 }
19267
19268 /* Generate a DIE to represent an enumeration type. Note that these DIEs
19269 include all of the information about the enumeration values also. Each
19270 enumerated type name/value is listed as a child of the enumerated type
19271 DIE. */
19272
19273 static dw_die_ref
19274 gen_enumeration_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
19275 {
19276 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
19277
19278 if (type_die == NULL)
19279 {
19280 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumeration_type,
19281 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
19282 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
19283 add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
19284 if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
19285 {
19286 if (ENUM_IS_SCOPED (type))
19287 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_enum_class, 1);
19288 if (ENUM_IS_OPAQUE (type))
19289 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
19290 }
19291 }
19292 else if (! TYPE_SIZE (type))
19293 return type_die;
19294 else
19295 remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
19296
19297 /* Handle a GNU C/C++ extension, i.e. incomplete enum types. If the
19298 given enum type is incomplete, do not generate the DW_AT_byte_size
19299 attribute or the DW_AT_element_list attribute. */
19300 if (TYPE_SIZE (type))
19301 {
19302 tree link;
19303
19304 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
19305 add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
19306 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
19307 {
19308 tree underlying = lang_hooks.types.enum_underlying_base_type (type);
19309 add_type_attribute (type_die, underlying, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED,
19310 context_die);
19311 }
19312 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
19313 {
19314 add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
19315 add_accessibility_attribute (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
19316 }
19317
19318 /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
19319 inline function, then it may not have a parent. Fix this now. */
19320 if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
19321 add_child_die (scope_die_for (type, context_die), type_die);
19322
19323 for (link = TYPE_VALUES (type);
19324 link != NULL; link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
19325 {
19326 dw_die_ref enum_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumerator, type_die, link);
19327 tree value = TREE_VALUE (link);
19328
19329 add_name_attribute (enum_die,
19330 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (TREE_PURPOSE (link)));
19331
19332 if (TREE_CODE (value) == CONST_DECL)
19333 value = DECL_INITIAL (value);
19334
19335 if (simple_type_size_in_bits (TREE_TYPE (value))
19336 <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT || tree_fits_shwi_p (value))
19337 {
19338 /* For constant forms created by add_AT_unsigned DWARF
19339 consumers (GDB, elfutils, etc.) always zero extend
19340 the value. Only when the actual value is negative
19341 do we need to use add_AT_int to generate a constant
19342 form that can represent negative values. */
19343 HOST_WIDE_INT val = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (value);
19344 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (value)) || val >= 0)
19345 add_AT_unsigned (enum_die, DW_AT_const_value,
19346 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) val);
19347 else
19348 add_AT_int (enum_die, DW_AT_const_value, val);
19349 }
19350 else
19351 /* Enumeration constants may be wider than HOST_WIDE_INT. Handle
19352 that here. TODO: This should be re-worked to use correct
19353 signed/unsigned double tags for all cases. */
19354 add_AT_wide (enum_die, DW_AT_const_value, value);
19355 }
19356
19357 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (type_die, type, context_die);
19358 if (TYPE_ARTIFICIAL (type))
19359 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
19360 }
19361 else
19362 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
19363
19364 add_pubtype (type, type_die);
19365
19366 return type_die;
19367 }
19368
19369 /* Generate a DIE to represent either a real live formal parameter decl or to
19370 represent just the type of some formal parameter position in some function
19371 type.
19372
19373 Note that this routine is a bit unusual because its argument may be a
19374 ..._DECL node (i.e. either a PARM_DECL or perhaps a VAR_DECL which
19375 represents an inlining of some PARM_DECL) or else some sort of a ..._TYPE
19376 node. If it's the former then this function is being called to output a
19377 DIE to represent a formal parameter object (or some inlining thereof). If
19378 it's the latter, then this function is only being called to output a
19379 DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE to stand as a placeholder for some formal
19380 argument type of some subprogram type.
19381 If EMIT_NAME_P is true, name and source coordinate attributes
19382 are emitted. */
19383
19384 static dw_die_ref
19385 gen_formal_parameter_die (tree node, tree origin, bool emit_name_p,
19386 dw_die_ref context_die)
19387 {
19388 tree node_or_origin = node ? node : origin;
19389 tree ultimate_origin;
19390 dw_die_ref parm_die = NULL;
19391
19392 if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (node_or_origin)) == tcc_declaration)
19393 {
19394 parm_die = lookup_decl_die (node);
19395
19396 /* If the contexts differ, we may not be talking about the same
19397 thing. */
19398 if (parm_die && parm_die->die_parent != context_die)
19399 {
19400 if (!DECL_ABSTRACT_P (node))
19401 {
19402 /* This can happen when creating an inlined instance, in
19403 which case we need to create a new DIE that will get
19404 annotated with DW_AT_abstract_origin. */
19405 parm_die = NULL;
19406 }
19407 else
19408 {
19409 /* FIXME: Reuse DIE even with a differing context.
19410
19411 This can happen when calling
19412 dwarf2out_abstract_function to build debug info for
19413 the abstract instance of a function for which we have
19414 already generated a DIE in
19415 dwarf2out_early_global_decl.
19416
19417 Once we remove dwarf2out_abstract_function, we should
19418 have a call to gcc_unreachable here. */
19419 }
19420 }
19421
19422 if (parm_die && parm_die->die_parent == NULL)
19423 {
19424 /* Check that parm_die already has the right attributes that
19425 we would have added below. If any attributes are
19426 missing, fall through to add them. */
19427 if (! DECL_ABSTRACT_P (node_or_origin)
19428 && !get_AT (parm_die, DW_AT_location)
19429 && !get_AT (parm_die, DW_AT_const_value))
19430 /* We are missing location info, and are about to add it. */
19431 ;
19432 else
19433 {
19434 add_child_die (context_die, parm_die);
19435 return parm_die;
19436 }
19437 }
19438 }
19439
19440 /* If we have a previously generated DIE, use it, unless this is an
19441 concrete instance (origin != NULL), in which case we need a new
19442 DIE with a corresponding DW_AT_abstract_origin. */
19443 bool reusing_die;
19444 if (parm_die && origin == NULL)
19445 reusing_die = true;
19446 else
19447 {
19448 parm_die = new_die (DW_TAG_formal_parameter, context_die, node);
19449 reusing_die = false;
19450 }
19451
19452 switch (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (node_or_origin)))
19453 {
19454 case tcc_declaration:
19455 ultimate_origin = decl_ultimate_origin (node_or_origin);
19456 if (node || ultimate_origin)
19457 origin = ultimate_origin;
19458
19459 if (reusing_die)
19460 goto add_location;
19461
19462 if (origin != NULL)
19463 add_abstract_origin_attribute (parm_die, origin);
19464 else if (emit_name_p)
19465 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (parm_die, node);
19466 if (origin == NULL
19467 || (! DECL_ABSTRACT_P (node_or_origin)
19468 && variably_modified_type_p (TREE_TYPE (node_or_origin),
19469 decl_function_context
19470 (node_or_origin))))
19471 {
19472 tree type = TREE_TYPE (node_or_origin);
19473 if (decl_by_reference_p (node_or_origin))
19474 add_type_attribute (parm_die, TREE_TYPE (type),
19475 TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, context_die);
19476 else
19477 add_type_attribute (parm_die, type,
19478 decl_quals (node_or_origin),
19479 context_die);
19480 }
19481 if (origin == NULL && DECL_ARTIFICIAL (node))
19482 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
19483 add_location:
19484 if (node && node != origin)
19485 equate_decl_number_to_die (node, parm_die);
19486 if (! DECL_ABSTRACT_P (node_or_origin))
19487 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (parm_die, node_or_origin,
19488 node == NULL);
19489
19490 break;
19491
19492 case tcc_type:
19493 /* We were called with some kind of a ..._TYPE node. */
19494 add_type_attribute (parm_die, node_or_origin, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED,
19495 context_die);
19496 break;
19497
19498 default:
19499 gcc_unreachable ();
19500 }
19501
19502 return parm_die;
19503 }
19504
19505 /* Generate and return a DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack. Also generate
19506 children DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIEs representing the arguments of the
19507 parameter pack.
19508
19509 PARM_PACK must be a function parameter pack.
19510 PACK_ARG is the first argument of the parameter pack. Its TREE_CHAIN
19511 must point to the subsequent arguments of the function PACK_ARG belongs to.
19512 SUBR_DIE is the DIE of the function PACK_ARG belongs to.
19513 If NEXT_ARG is non NULL, *NEXT_ARG is set to the function argument
19514 following the last one for which a DIE was generated. */
19515
19516 static dw_die_ref
19517 gen_formal_parameter_pack_die (tree parm_pack,
19518 tree pack_arg,
19519 dw_die_ref subr_die,
19520 tree *next_arg)
19521 {
19522 tree arg;
19523 dw_die_ref parm_pack_die;
19524
19525 gcc_assert (parm_pack
19526 && lang_hooks.function_parameter_pack_p (parm_pack)
19527 && subr_die);
19528
19529 parm_pack_die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack, subr_die, parm_pack);
19530 add_src_coords_attributes (parm_pack_die, parm_pack);
19531
19532 for (arg = pack_arg; arg; arg = DECL_CHAIN (arg))
19533 {
19534 if (! lang_hooks.decls.function_parm_expanded_from_pack_p (arg,
19535 parm_pack))
19536 break;
19537 gen_formal_parameter_die (arg, NULL,
19538 false /* Don't emit name attribute. */,
19539 parm_pack_die);
19540 }
19541 if (next_arg)
19542 *next_arg = arg;
19543 return parm_pack_die;
19544 }
19545
19546 /* Generate a special type of DIE used as a stand-in for a trailing ellipsis
19547 at the end of an (ANSI prototyped) formal parameters list. */
19548
19549 static void
19550 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (tree decl_or_type, dw_die_ref context_die)
19551 {
19552 new_die (DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters, context_die, decl_or_type);
19553 }
19554
19555 /* Generate a list of nameless DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIEs (and perhaps a
19556 DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE) to represent the types of the formal
19557 parameters as specified in some function type specification (except for
19558 those which appear as part of a function *definition*). */
19559
19560 static void
19561 gen_formal_types_die (tree function_or_method_type, dw_die_ref context_die)
19562 {
19563 tree link;
19564 tree formal_type = NULL;
19565 tree first_parm_type;
19566 tree arg;
19567
19568 if (TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == FUNCTION_DECL)
19569 {
19570 arg = DECL_ARGUMENTS (function_or_method_type);
19571 function_or_method_type = TREE_TYPE (function_or_method_type);
19572 }
19573 else
19574 arg = NULL_TREE;
19575
19576 first_parm_type = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
19577
19578 /* Make our first pass over the list of formal parameter types and output a
19579 DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE for each one. */
19580 for (link = first_parm_type; link; )
19581 {
19582 dw_die_ref parm_die;
19583
19584 formal_type = TREE_VALUE (link);
19585 if (formal_type == void_type_node)
19586 break;
19587
19588 /* Output a (nameless) DIE to represent the formal parameter itself. */
19589 if (!POINTER_BOUNDS_TYPE_P (formal_type))
19590 {
19591 parm_die = gen_formal_parameter_die (formal_type, NULL,
19592 true /* Emit name attribute. */,
19593 context_die);
19594 if (TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == METHOD_TYPE
19595 && link == first_parm_type)
19596 {
19597 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
19598 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
19599 add_AT_die_ref (context_die, DW_AT_object_pointer, parm_die);
19600 }
19601 else if (arg && DECL_ARTIFICIAL (arg))
19602 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
19603 }
19604
19605 link = TREE_CHAIN (link);
19606 if (arg)
19607 arg = DECL_CHAIN (arg);
19608 }
19609
19610 /* If this function type has an ellipsis, add a
19611 DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE to the end of the parameter list. */
19612 if (formal_type != void_type_node)
19613 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (function_or_method_type, context_die);
19614
19615 /* Make our second (and final) pass over the list of formal parameter types
19616 and output DIEs to represent those types (as necessary). */
19617 for (link = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
19618 link && TREE_VALUE (link);
19619 link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
19620 gen_type_die (TREE_VALUE (link), context_die);
19621 }
19622
19623 /* We want to generate the DIE for TYPE so that we can generate the
19624 die for MEMBER, which has been defined; we will need to refer back
19625 to the member declaration nested within TYPE. If we're trying to
19626 generate minimal debug info for TYPE, processing TYPE won't do the
19627 trick; we need to attach the member declaration by hand. */
19628
19629 static void
19630 gen_type_die_for_member (tree type, tree member, dw_die_ref context_die)
19631 {
19632 gen_type_die (type, context_die);
19633
19634 /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
19635 emitted the member decl for this function. Emit it now. */
19636 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
19637 && TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))
19638 && ! lookup_decl_die (member))
19639 {
19640 dw_die_ref type_die;
19641 gcc_assert (!decl_ultimate_origin (member));
19642
19643 push_decl_scope (type);
19644 type_die = lookup_type_die_strip_naming_typedef (type);
19645 if (TREE_CODE (member) == FUNCTION_DECL)
19646 gen_subprogram_die (member, type_die);
19647 else if (TREE_CODE (member) == FIELD_DECL)
19648 {
19649 /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle
19650 C++ anonymous unions and structs. */
19651 if (DECL_NAME (member) != NULL_TREE
19652 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member)) == UNION_TYPE
19653 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member)) == RECORD_TYPE)
19654 {
19655 struct vlr_context vlr_ctx = {
19656 DECL_CONTEXT (member), /* struct_type */
19657 NULL_TREE /* variant_part_offset */
19658 };
19659 gen_type_die (member_declared_type (member), type_die);
19660 gen_field_die (member, &vlr_ctx, type_die);
19661 }
19662 }
19663 else
19664 gen_variable_die (member, NULL_TREE, type_die);
19665
19666 pop_decl_scope ();
19667 }
19668 }
19669 \f
19670 /* Forward declare these functions, because they are mutually recursive
19671 with their set_block_* pairing functions. */
19672 static void set_decl_origin_self (tree);
19673 static void set_decl_abstract_flags (tree, vec<tree> &);
19674
19675 /* Given a pointer to some BLOCK node, if the BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for the
19676 given BLOCK node is NULL, set the BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for the node so
19677 that it points to the node itself, thus indicating that the node is its
19678 own (abstract) origin. Additionally, if the BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for
19679 the given node is NULL, recursively descend the decl/block tree which
19680 it is the root of, and for each other ..._DECL or BLOCK node contained
19681 therein whose DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGINs or BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGINs are also
19682 still NULL, set *their* DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN or BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN
19683 values to point to themselves. */
19684
19685 static void
19686 set_block_origin_self (tree stmt)
19687 {
19688 if (BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (stmt) == NULL_TREE)
19689 {
19690 BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (stmt) = stmt;
19691
19692 {
19693 tree local_decl;
19694
19695 for (local_decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt);
19696 local_decl != NULL_TREE;
19697 local_decl = DECL_CHAIN (local_decl))
19698 /* Do not recurse on nested functions since the inlining status
19699 of parent and child can be different as per the DWARF spec. */
19700 if (TREE_CODE (local_decl) != FUNCTION_DECL
19701 && !DECL_EXTERNAL (local_decl))
19702 set_decl_origin_self (local_decl);
19703 }
19704
19705 {
19706 tree subblock;
19707
19708 for (subblock = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt);
19709 subblock != NULL_TREE;
19710 subblock = BLOCK_CHAIN (subblock))
19711 set_block_origin_self (subblock); /* Recurse. */
19712 }
19713 }
19714 }
19715
19716 /* Given a pointer to some ..._DECL node, if the DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for
19717 the given ..._DECL node is NULL, set the DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for the
19718 node to so that it points to the node itself, thus indicating that the
19719 node represents its own (abstract) origin. Additionally, if the
19720 DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for the given node is NULL, recursively descend
19721 the decl/block tree of which the given node is the root of, and for
19722 each other ..._DECL or BLOCK node contained therein whose
19723 DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGINs or BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGINs are also still NULL,
19724 set *their* DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN or BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN values to
19725 point to themselves. */
19726
19727 static void
19728 set_decl_origin_self (tree decl)
19729 {
19730 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == NULL_TREE)
19731 {
19732 DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) = decl;
19733 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL)
19734 {
19735 tree arg;
19736
19737 for (arg = DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl); arg; arg = DECL_CHAIN (arg))
19738 DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (arg) = arg;
19739 if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) != NULL_TREE
19740 && DECL_INITIAL (decl) != error_mark_node)
19741 set_block_origin_self (DECL_INITIAL (decl));
19742 }
19743 }
19744 }
19745 \f
19746 /* Given a pointer to some BLOCK node, set the BLOCK_ABSTRACT flag to 1
19747 and if it wasn't 1 before, push it to abstract_vec vector.
19748 For all local decls and all local sub-blocks (recursively) do it
19749 too. */
19750
19751 static void
19752 set_block_abstract_flags (tree stmt, vec<tree> &abstract_vec)
19753 {
19754 tree local_decl;
19755 tree subblock;
19756 unsigned int i;
19757
19758 if (!BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
19759 {
19760 abstract_vec.safe_push (stmt);
19761 BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt) = 1;
19762 }
19763
19764 for (local_decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt);
19765 local_decl != NULL_TREE;
19766 local_decl = DECL_CHAIN (local_decl))
19767 if (! DECL_EXTERNAL (local_decl))
19768 set_decl_abstract_flags (local_decl, abstract_vec);
19769
19770 for (i = 0; i < BLOCK_NUM_NONLOCALIZED_VARS (stmt); i++)
19771 {
19772 local_decl = BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VAR (stmt, i);
19773 if ((TREE_CODE (local_decl) == VAR_DECL && !TREE_STATIC (local_decl))
19774 || TREE_CODE (local_decl) == PARM_DECL)
19775 set_decl_abstract_flags (local_decl, abstract_vec);
19776 }
19777
19778 for (subblock = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt);
19779 subblock != NULL_TREE;
19780 subblock = BLOCK_CHAIN (subblock))
19781 set_block_abstract_flags (subblock, abstract_vec);
19782 }
19783
19784 /* Given a pointer to some ..._DECL node, set DECL_ABSTRACT_P flag on it
19785 to 1 and if it wasn't 1 before, push to abstract_vec vector.
19786 In the case where the decl is a FUNCTION_DECL also set the abstract
19787 flags for all of the parameters, local vars, local
19788 blocks and sub-blocks (recursively). */
19789
19790 static void
19791 set_decl_abstract_flags (tree decl, vec<tree> &abstract_vec)
19792 {
19793 if (!DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl))
19794 {
19795 abstract_vec.safe_push (decl);
19796 DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl) = 1;
19797 }
19798
19799 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL)
19800 {
19801 tree arg;
19802
19803 for (arg = DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl); arg; arg = DECL_CHAIN (arg))
19804 if (!DECL_ABSTRACT_P (arg))
19805 {
19806 abstract_vec.safe_push (arg);
19807 DECL_ABSTRACT_P (arg) = 1;
19808 }
19809 if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) != NULL_TREE
19810 && DECL_INITIAL (decl) != error_mark_node)
19811 set_block_abstract_flags (DECL_INITIAL (decl), abstract_vec);
19812 }
19813 }
19814
19815 /* Generate the DWARF2 info for the "abstract" instance of a function which we
19816 may later generate inlined and/or out-of-line instances of.
19817
19818 FIXME: In the early-dwarf world, this function, and most of the
19819 DECL_ABSTRACT code should be obsoleted. The early DIE _is_
19820 the abstract instance. All we would need to do is annotate
19821 the early DIE with the appropriate DW_AT_inline in late
19822 dwarf (perhaps in gen_inlined_subroutine_die).
19823
19824 However, we can't do this yet, because LTO streaming of DIEs
19825 has not been implemented yet. */
19826
19827 static void
19828 dwarf2out_abstract_function (tree decl)
19829 {
19830 dw_die_ref old_die;
19831 tree save_fn;
19832 tree context;
19833 hash_table<decl_loc_hasher> *old_decl_loc_table;
19834 hash_table<dw_loc_list_hasher> *old_cached_dw_loc_list_table;
19835 int old_call_site_count, old_tail_call_site_count;
19836 struct call_arg_loc_node *old_call_arg_locations;
19837
19838 /* Make sure we have the actual abstract inline, not a clone. */
19839 decl = DECL_ORIGIN (decl);
19840
19841 old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
19842 if (old_die && get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
19843 /* We've already generated the abstract instance. */
19844 return;
19845
19846 /* We can be called while recursively when seeing block defining inlined subroutine
19847 DIE. Be sure to not clobber the outer location table nor use it or we would
19848 get locations in abstract instantces. */
19849 old_decl_loc_table = decl_loc_table;
19850 decl_loc_table = NULL;
19851 old_cached_dw_loc_list_table = cached_dw_loc_list_table;
19852 cached_dw_loc_list_table = NULL;
19853 old_call_arg_locations = call_arg_locations;
19854 call_arg_locations = NULL;
19855 old_call_site_count = call_site_count;
19856 call_site_count = -1;
19857 old_tail_call_site_count = tail_call_site_count;
19858 tail_call_site_count = -1;
19859
19860 /* Be sure we've emitted the in-class declaration DIE (if any) first, so
19861 we don't get confused by DECL_ABSTRACT_P. */
19862 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
19863 {
19864 context = decl_class_context (decl);
19865 if (context)
19866 gen_type_die_for_member
19867 (context, decl, decl_function_context (decl) ? NULL : comp_unit_die ());
19868 }
19869
19870 /* Pretend we've just finished compiling this function. */
19871 save_fn = current_function_decl;
19872 current_function_decl = decl;
19873
19874 auto_vec<tree, 64> abstract_vec;
19875 set_decl_abstract_flags (decl, abstract_vec);
19876 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
19877 unsigned int i;
19878 tree t;
19879 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (abstract_vec, i, t)
19880 if (TREE_CODE (t) == BLOCK)
19881 BLOCK_ABSTRACT (t) = 0;
19882 else
19883 DECL_ABSTRACT_P (t) = 0;
19884
19885 current_function_decl = save_fn;
19886 decl_loc_table = old_decl_loc_table;
19887 cached_dw_loc_list_table = old_cached_dw_loc_list_table;
19888 call_arg_locations = old_call_arg_locations;
19889 call_site_count = old_call_site_count;
19890 tail_call_site_count = old_tail_call_site_count;
19891 }
19892
19893 /* Helper function of premark_used_types() which gets called through
19894 htab_traverse.
19895
19896 Marks the DIE of a given type in *SLOT as perennial, so it never gets
19897 marked as unused by prune_unused_types. */
19898
19899 bool
19900 premark_used_types_helper (tree const &type, void *)
19901 {
19902 dw_die_ref die;
19903
19904 die = lookup_type_die (type);
19905 if (die != NULL)
19906 die->die_perennial_p = 1;
19907 return true;
19908 }
19909
19910 /* Helper function of premark_types_used_by_global_vars which gets called
19911 through htab_traverse.
19912
19913 Marks the DIE of a given type in *SLOT as perennial, so it never gets
19914 marked as unused by prune_unused_types. The DIE of the type is marked
19915 only if the global variable using the type will actually be emitted. */
19916
19917 int
19918 premark_types_used_by_global_vars_helper (types_used_by_vars_entry **slot,
19919 void *)
19920 {
19921 struct types_used_by_vars_entry *entry;
19922 dw_die_ref die;
19923
19924 entry = (struct types_used_by_vars_entry *) *slot;
19925 gcc_assert (entry->type != NULL
19926 && entry->var_decl != NULL);
19927 die = lookup_type_die (entry->type);
19928 if (die)
19929 {
19930 /* Ask cgraph if the global variable really is to be emitted.
19931 If yes, then we'll keep the DIE of ENTRY->TYPE. */
19932 varpool_node *node = varpool_node::get (entry->var_decl);
19933 if (node && node->definition)
19934 {
19935 die->die_perennial_p = 1;
19936 /* Keep the parent DIEs as well. */
19937 while ((die = die->die_parent) && die->die_perennial_p == 0)
19938 die->die_perennial_p = 1;
19939 }
19940 }
19941 return 1;
19942 }
19943
19944 /* Mark all members of used_types_hash as perennial. */
19945
19946 static void
19947 premark_used_types (struct function *fun)
19948 {
19949 if (fun && fun->used_types_hash)
19950 fun->used_types_hash->traverse<void *, premark_used_types_helper> (NULL);
19951 }
19952
19953 /* Mark all members of types_used_by_vars_entry as perennial. */
19954
19955 static void
19956 premark_types_used_by_global_vars (void)
19957 {
19958 if (types_used_by_vars_hash)
19959 types_used_by_vars_hash
19960 ->traverse<void *, premark_types_used_by_global_vars_helper> (NULL);
19961 }
19962
19963 /* Generate a DW_TAG_GNU_call_site DIE in function DECL under SUBR_DIE
19964 for CA_LOC call arg loc node. */
19965
19966 static dw_die_ref
19967 gen_call_site_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref subr_die,
19968 struct call_arg_loc_node *ca_loc)
19969 {
19970 dw_die_ref stmt_die = NULL, die;
19971 tree block = ca_loc->block;
19972
19973 while (block
19974 && block != DECL_INITIAL (decl)
19975 && TREE_CODE (block) == BLOCK)
19976 {
19977 stmt_die = BLOCK_DIE (block);
19978 if (stmt_die)
19979 break;
19980 block = BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (block);
19981 }
19982 if (stmt_die == NULL)
19983 stmt_die = subr_die;
19984 die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_call_site, stmt_die, NULL_TREE);
19985 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_low_pc, ca_loc->label);
19986 if (ca_loc->tail_call_p)
19987 add_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_GNU_tail_call, 1);
19988 if (ca_loc->symbol_ref)
19989 {
19990 dw_die_ref tdie = lookup_decl_die (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (ca_loc->symbol_ref));
19991 if (tdie)
19992 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin, tdie);
19993 else
19994 add_AT_addr (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin, ca_loc->symbol_ref, false);
19995 }
19996 return die;
19997 }
19998
19999 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared function (either file-scope or
20000 block-local). */
20001
20002 static void
20003 gen_subprogram_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
20004 {
20005 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
20006 dw_die_ref subr_die;
20007 dw_die_ref old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
20008
20009 /* This function gets called multiple times for different stages of
20010 the debug process. For example, for func() in this code:
20011
20012 namespace S
20013 {
20014 void func() { ... }
20015 }
20016
20017 ...we get called 4 times. Twice in early debug and twice in
20018 late debug:
20019
20020 Early debug
20021 -----------
20022
20023 1. Once while generating func() within the namespace. This is
20024 the declaration. The declaration bit below is set, as the
20025 context is the namespace.
20026
20027 A new DIE will be generated with DW_AT_declaration set.
20028
20029 2. Once for func() itself. This is the specification. The
20030 declaration bit below is clear as the context is the CU.
20031
20032 We will use the cached DIE from (1) to create a new DIE with
20033 DW_AT_specification pointing to the declaration in (1).
20034
20035 Late debug via rest_of_handle_final()
20036 -------------------------------------
20037
20038 3. Once generating func() within the namespace. This is also the
20039 declaration, as in (1), but this time we will early exit below
20040 as we have a cached DIE and a declaration needs no additional
20041 annotations (no locations), as the source declaration line
20042 info is enough.
20043
20044 4. Once for func() itself. As in (2), this is the specification,
20045 but this time we will re-use the cached DIE, and just annotate
20046 it with the location information that should now be available.
20047
20048 For something without namespaces, but with abstract instances, we
20049 are also called a multiple times:
20050
20051 class Base
20052 {
20053 public:
20054 Base (); // constructor declaration (1)
20055 };
20056
20057 Base::Base () { } // constructor specification (2)
20058
20059 Early debug
20060 -----------
20061
20062 1. Once for the Base() constructor by virtue of it being a
20063 member of the Base class. This is done via
20064 rest_of_type_compilation.
20065
20066 This is a declaration, so a new DIE will be created with
20067 DW_AT_declaration.
20068
20069 2. Once for the Base() constructor definition, but this time
20070 while generating the abstract instance of the base
20071 constructor (__base_ctor) which is being generated via early
20072 debug of reachable functions.
20073
20074 Even though we have a cached version of the declaration (1),
20075 we will create a DW_AT_specification of the declaration DIE
20076 in (1).
20077
20078 3. Once for the __base_ctor itself, but this time, we generate
20079 an DW_AT_abstract_origin version of the DW_AT_specification in
20080 (2).
20081
20082 Late debug via rest_of_handle_final
20083 -----------------------------------
20084
20085 4. One final time for the __base_ctor (which will have a cached
20086 DIE with DW_AT_abstract_origin created in (3). This time,
20087 we will just annotate the location information now
20088 available.
20089 */
20090 int declaration = (current_function_decl != decl
20091 || class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die));
20092
20093 premark_used_types (DECL_STRUCT_FUNCTION (decl));
20094
20095 /* Now that the C++ front end lazily declares artificial member fns, we
20096 might need to retrofit the declaration into its class. */
20097 if (!declaration && !origin && !old_die
20098 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl) && TYPE_P (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
20099 && !class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die)
20100 && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
20101 old_die = force_decl_die (decl);
20102
20103 /* An inlined instance, tag a new DIE with DW_AT_abstract_origin. */
20104 if (origin != NULL)
20105 {
20106 gcc_assert (!declaration || local_scope_p (context_die));
20107
20108 /* Fixup die_parent for the abstract instance of a nested
20109 inline function. */
20110 if (old_die && old_die->die_parent == NULL)
20111 add_child_die (context_die, old_die);
20112
20113 if (old_die && get_AT_ref (old_die, DW_AT_abstract_origin))
20114 {
20115 /* If we have a DW_AT_abstract_origin we have a working
20116 cached version. */
20117 subr_die = old_die;
20118 }
20119 else
20120 {
20121 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
20122 add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, origin);
20123 /* This is where the actual code for a cloned function is.
20124 Let's emit linkage name attribute for it. This helps
20125 debuggers to e.g, set breakpoints into
20126 constructors/destructors when the user asks "break
20127 K::K". */
20128 add_linkage_name (subr_die, decl);
20129 }
20130 }
20131 /* A cached copy, possibly from early dwarf generation. Reuse as
20132 much as possible. */
20133 else if (old_die)
20134 {
20135 /* A declaration that has been previously dumped needs no
20136 additional information. */
20137 if (declaration)
20138 return;
20139
20140 if (!get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration)
20141 /* We can have a normal definition following an inline one in the
20142 case of redefinition of GNU C extern inlines.
20143 It seems reasonable to use AT_specification in this case. */
20144 && !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
20145 {
20146 /* Detect and ignore this case, where we are trying to output
20147 something we have already output. */
20148 if (get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_low_pc)
20149 || get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_ranges))
20150 return;
20151
20152 /* If we have no location information, this must be a
20153 partially generated DIE from early dwarf generation.
20154 Fall through and generate it. */
20155 }
20156
20157 /* If the definition comes from the same place as the declaration,
20158 maybe use the old DIE. We always want the DIE for this function
20159 that has the *_pc attributes to be under comp_unit_die so the
20160 debugger can find it. We also need to do this for abstract
20161 instances of inlines, since the spec requires the out-of-line copy
20162 to have the same parent. For local class methods, this doesn't
20163 apply; we just use the old DIE. */
20164 expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
20165 struct dwarf_file_data * file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
20166 if ((is_cu_die (old_die->die_parent)
20167 /* This condition fixes the inconsistency/ICE with the
20168 following Fortran test (or some derivative thereof) while
20169 building libgfortran:
20170
20171 module some_m
20172 contains
20173 logical function funky (FLAG)
20174 funky = .true.
20175 end function
20176 end module
20177 */
20178 || (old_die->die_parent
20179 && old_die->die_parent->die_tag == DW_TAG_module)
20180 || context_die == NULL)
20181 && (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
20182 || (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) == file_index
20183 && (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line)
20184 == (unsigned) s.line))))
20185 {
20186 subr_die = old_die;
20187
20188 /* Clear out the declaration attribute, but leave the
20189 parameters so they can be augmented with location
20190 information later. Unless this was a declaration, in
20191 which case, wipe out the nameless parameters and recreate
20192 them further down. */
20193 if (remove_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration))
20194 {
20195
20196 remove_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_object_pointer);
20197 remove_child_TAG (subr_die, DW_TAG_formal_parameter);
20198 }
20199 }
20200 /* Make a specification pointing to the previously built
20201 declaration. */
20202 else
20203 {
20204 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
20205 add_AT_specification (subr_die, old_die);
20206 add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
20207 if (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
20208 add_AT_file (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
20209 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line) != (unsigned) s.line)
20210 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
20211
20212 /* If the prototype had an 'auto' or 'decltype(auto)' return type,
20213 emit the real type on the definition die. */
20214 if (is_cxx() && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
20215 {
20216 dw_die_ref die = get_AT_ref (old_die, DW_AT_type);
20217 if (die == auto_die || die == decltype_auto_die)
20218 add_type_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
20219 TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, context_die);
20220 }
20221 }
20222 }
20223 /* Create a fresh DIE for anything else. */
20224 else
20225 {
20226 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
20227
20228 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
20229 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
20230
20231 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (subr_die, decl);
20232 add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
20233 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
20234 {
20235 add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (decl));
20236 add_type_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
20237 TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, context_die);
20238 }
20239
20240 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (subr_die, decl);
20241 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
20242 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
20243
20244 if (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl) && (dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict))
20245 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_noreturn, 1);
20246
20247 add_accessibility_attribute (subr_die, decl);
20248 }
20249
20250 /* Unless we have an existing non-declaration DIE, equate the new
20251 DIE. */
20252 if (!old_die || is_declaration_die (old_die))
20253 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
20254
20255 if (declaration)
20256 {
20257 if (!old_die || !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
20258 {
20259 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
20260
20261 /* If this is an explicit function declaration then generate
20262 a DW_AT_explicit attribute. */
20263 if (lang_hooks.decls.function_decl_explicit_p (decl)
20264 && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
20265 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_explicit, 1);
20266
20267 /* If this is a C++11 deleted special function member then generate
20268 a DW_AT_GNU_deleted attribute. */
20269 if (lang_hooks.decls.function_decl_deleted_p (decl)
20270 && (! dwarf_strict))
20271 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_GNU_deleted, 1);
20272 }
20273 }
20274 /* Tag abstract instances with DW_AT_inline. */
20275 else if (DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl))
20276 {
20277 if (DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (decl))
20278 {
20279 if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl))
20280 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_inlined);
20281 else
20282 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_not_inlined);
20283 }
20284 else
20285 {
20286 if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl))
20287 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_inlined);
20288 else
20289 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_not_inlined);
20290 }
20291
20292 if (DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (decl)
20293 && lookup_attribute ("artificial", DECL_ATTRIBUTES (decl)))
20294 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
20295 }
20296 /* For non DECL_EXTERNALs, if range information is available, fill
20297 the DIE with it. */
20298 else if (!DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) && !early_dwarf)
20299 {
20300 HOST_WIDE_INT cfa_fb_offset;
20301
20302 struct function *fun = DECL_STRUCT_FUNCTION (decl);
20303
20304 if (!flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
20305 {
20306 dw_fde_ref fde = fun->fde;
20307 if (fde->dw_fde_begin)
20308 {
20309 /* We have already generated the labels. */
20310 add_AT_low_high_pc (subr_die, fde->dw_fde_begin,
20311 fde->dw_fde_end, false);
20312 }
20313 else
20314 {
20315 /* Create start/end labels and add the range. */
20316 char label_id_low[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
20317 char label_id_high[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
20318 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id_low, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
20319 current_function_funcdef_no);
20320 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id_high, FUNC_END_LABEL,
20321 current_function_funcdef_no);
20322 add_AT_low_high_pc (subr_die, label_id_low, label_id_high,
20323 false);
20324 }
20325
20326 #if VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
20327 /* HP OpenVMS Industry Standard 64: DWARF Extensions
20328 Section 2.3 Prologue and Epilogue Attributes:
20329 When a breakpoint is set on entry to a function, it is generally
20330 desirable for execution to be suspended, not on the very first
20331 instruction of the function, but rather at a point after the
20332 function's frame has been set up, after any language defined local
20333 declaration processing has been completed, and before execution of
20334 the first statement of the function begins. Debuggers generally
20335 cannot properly determine where this point is. Similarly for a
20336 breakpoint set on exit from a function. The prologue and epilogue
20337 attributes allow a compiler to communicate the location(s) to use. */
20338
20339 {
20340 if (fde->dw_fde_vms_end_prologue)
20341 add_AT_vms_delta (subr_die, DW_AT_HP_prologue,
20342 fde->dw_fde_begin, fde->dw_fde_vms_end_prologue);
20343
20344 if (fde->dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue)
20345 add_AT_vms_delta (subr_die, DW_AT_HP_epilogue,
20346 fde->dw_fde_begin, fde->dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue);
20347 }
20348 #endif
20349
20350 }
20351 else
20352 {
20353 /* Generate pubnames entries for the split function code ranges. */
20354 dw_fde_ref fde = fun->fde;
20355
20356 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin)
20357 {
20358 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
20359 {
20360 /* We should use ranges for non-contiguous code section
20361 addresses. Use the actual code range for the initial
20362 section, since the HOT/COLD labels might precede an
20363 alignment offset. */
20364 bool range_list_added = false;
20365 add_ranges_by_labels (subr_die, fde->dw_fde_begin,
20366 fde->dw_fde_end, &range_list_added,
20367 false);
20368 add_ranges_by_labels (subr_die, fde->dw_fde_second_begin,
20369 fde->dw_fde_second_end,
20370 &range_list_added, false);
20371 if (range_list_added)
20372 add_ranges (NULL);
20373 }
20374 else
20375 {
20376 /* There is no real support in DW2 for this .. so we make
20377 a work-around. First, emit the pub name for the segment
20378 containing the function label. Then make and emit a
20379 simplified subprogram DIE for the second segment with the
20380 name pre-fixed by __hot/cold_sect_of_. We use the same
20381 linkage name for the second die so that gdb will find both
20382 sections when given "b foo". */
20383 const char *name = NULL;
20384 tree decl_name = DECL_NAME (decl);
20385 dw_die_ref seg_die;
20386
20387 /* Do the 'primary' section. */
20388 add_AT_low_high_pc (subr_die, fde->dw_fde_begin,
20389 fde->dw_fde_end, false);
20390
20391 /* Build a minimal DIE for the secondary section. */
20392 seg_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram,
20393 subr_die->die_parent, decl);
20394
20395 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
20396 add_AT_flag (seg_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
20397
20398 if (decl_name != NULL
20399 && IDENTIFIER_POINTER (decl_name) != NULL)
20400 {
20401 name = dwarf2_name (decl, 1);
20402 if (! DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
20403 add_src_coords_attributes (seg_die, decl);
20404
20405 add_linkage_name (seg_die, decl);
20406 }
20407 gcc_assert (name != NULL);
20408 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (seg_die, decl);
20409 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
20410 add_AT_flag (seg_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
20411
20412 name = concat ("__second_sect_of_", name, NULL);
20413 add_AT_low_high_pc (seg_die, fde->dw_fde_second_begin,
20414 fde->dw_fde_second_end, false);
20415 add_name_attribute (seg_die, name);
20416 if (want_pubnames ())
20417 add_pubname_string (name, seg_die);
20418 }
20419 }
20420 else
20421 add_AT_low_high_pc (subr_die, fde->dw_fde_begin, fde->dw_fde_end,
20422 false);
20423 }
20424
20425 cfa_fb_offset = CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (decl);
20426
20427 /* We define the "frame base" as the function's CFA. This is more
20428 convenient for several reasons: (1) It's stable across the prologue
20429 and epilogue, which makes it better than just a frame pointer,
20430 (2) With dwarf3, there exists a one-byte encoding that allows us
20431 to reference the .debug_frame data by proxy, but failing that,
20432 (3) We can at least reuse the code inspection and interpretation
20433 code that determines the CFA position at various points in the
20434 function. */
20435 if (dwarf_version >= 3 && targetm.debug_unwind_info () == UI_DWARF2)
20436 {
20437 dw_loc_descr_ref op = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_call_frame_cfa, 0, 0);
20438 add_AT_loc (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, op);
20439 }
20440 else
20441 {
20442 dw_loc_list_ref list = convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list (cfa_fb_offset);
20443 if (list->dw_loc_next)
20444 add_AT_loc_list (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, list);
20445 else
20446 add_AT_loc (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, list->expr);
20447 }
20448
20449 /* Compute a displacement from the "steady-state frame pointer" to
20450 the CFA. The former is what all stack slots and argument slots
20451 will reference in the rtl; the latter is what we've told the
20452 debugger about. We'll need to adjust all frame_base references
20453 by this displacement. */
20454 compute_frame_pointer_to_fb_displacement (cfa_fb_offset);
20455
20456 if (fun->static_chain_decl)
20457 {
20458 /* DWARF requires here a location expression that computes the
20459 address of the enclosing subprogram's frame base. The machinery
20460 in tree-nested.c is supposed to store this specific address in the
20461 last field of the FRAME record. */
20462 const tree frame_type
20463 = TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (fun->static_chain_decl));
20464 const tree fb_decl = tree_last (TYPE_FIELDS (frame_type));
20465
20466 tree fb_expr
20467 = build1 (INDIRECT_REF, frame_type, fun->static_chain_decl);
20468 fb_expr = build3 (COMPONENT_REF, TREE_TYPE (fb_decl),
20469 fb_expr, fb_decl, NULL_TREE);
20470
20471 add_AT_location_description (subr_die, DW_AT_static_link,
20472 loc_list_from_tree (fb_expr, 0, NULL));
20473 }
20474 }
20475
20476 /* Generate child dies for template paramaters. */
20477 if (early_dwarf && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
20478 gen_generic_params_dies (decl);
20479
20480 /* Now output descriptions of the arguments for this function. This gets
20481 (unnecessarily?) complex because of the fact that the DECL_ARGUMENT list
20482 for a FUNCTION_DECL doesn't indicate cases where there was a trailing
20483 `...' at the end of the formal parameter list. In order to find out if
20484 there was a trailing ellipsis or not, we must instead look at the type
20485 associated with the FUNCTION_DECL. This will be a node of type
20486 FUNCTION_TYPE. If the chain of type nodes hanging off of this
20487 FUNCTION_TYPE node ends with a void_type_node then there should *not* be
20488 an ellipsis at the end. */
20489
20490 /* In the case where we are describing a mere function declaration, all we
20491 need to do here (and all we *can* do here) is to describe the *types* of
20492 its formal parameters. */
20493 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
20494 ;
20495 else if (declaration)
20496 gen_formal_types_die (decl, subr_die);
20497 else
20498 {
20499 /* Generate DIEs to represent all known formal parameters. */
20500 tree parm = DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl);
20501 tree generic_decl = early_dwarf
20502 ? lang_hooks.decls.get_generic_function_decl (decl) : NULL;
20503 tree generic_decl_parm = generic_decl
20504 ? DECL_ARGUMENTS (generic_decl)
20505 : NULL;
20506
20507 /* Now we want to walk the list of parameters of the function and
20508 emit their relevant DIEs.
20509
20510 We consider the case of DECL being an instance of a generic function
20511 as well as it being a normal function.
20512
20513 If DECL is an instance of a generic function we walk the
20514 parameters of the generic function declaration _and_ the parameters of
20515 DECL itself. This is useful because we want to emit specific DIEs for
20516 function parameter packs and those are declared as part of the
20517 generic function declaration. In that particular case,
20518 the parameter pack yields a DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack DIE.
20519 That DIE has children DIEs representing the set of arguments
20520 of the pack. Note that the set of pack arguments can be empty.
20521 In that case, the DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack DIE will not have any
20522 children DIE.
20523
20524 Otherwise, we just consider the parameters of DECL. */
20525 while (generic_decl_parm || parm)
20526 {
20527 if (generic_decl_parm
20528 && lang_hooks.function_parameter_pack_p (generic_decl_parm))
20529 gen_formal_parameter_pack_die (generic_decl_parm,
20530 parm, subr_die,
20531 &parm);
20532 else if (parm && !POINTER_BOUNDS_P (parm))
20533 {
20534 dw_die_ref parm_die = gen_decl_die (parm, NULL, NULL, subr_die);
20535
20536 if (parm == DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl)
20537 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == METHOD_TYPE
20538 && parm_die
20539 && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
20540 add_AT_die_ref (subr_die, DW_AT_object_pointer, parm_die);
20541
20542 parm = DECL_CHAIN (parm);
20543 }
20544 else if (parm)
20545 parm = DECL_CHAIN (parm);
20546
20547 if (generic_decl_parm)
20548 generic_decl_parm = DECL_CHAIN (generic_decl_parm);
20549 }
20550
20551 /* Decide whether we need an unspecified_parameters DIE at the end.
20552 There are 2 more cases to do this for: 1) the ansi ... declaration -
20553 this is detectable when the end of the arg list is not a
20554 void_type_node 2) an unprototyped function declaration (not a
20555 definition). This just means that we have no info about the
20556 parameters at all. */
20557 if (prototype_p (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
20558 {
20559 /* This is the prototyped case, check for.... */
20560 if (stdarg_p (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
20561 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
20562 }
20563 else if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE)
20564 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
20565 }
20566
20567 if (subr_die != old_die)
20568 /* Add the calling convention attribute if requested. */
20569 add_calling_convention_attribute (subr_die, decl);
20570
20571 /* Output Dwarf info for all of the stuff within the body of the function
20572 (if it has one - it may be just a declaration).
20573
20574 OUTER_SCOPE is a pointer to the outermost BLOCK node created to represent
20575 a function. This BLOCK actually represents the outermost binding contour
20576 for the function, i.e. the contour in which the function's formal
20577 parameters and labels get declared. Curiously, it appears that the front
20578 end doesn't actually put the PARM_DECL nodes for the current function onto
20579 the BLOCK_VARS list for this outer scope, but are strung off of the
20580 DECL_ARGUMENTS list for the function instead.
20581
20582 The BLOCK_VARS list for the `outer_scope' does provide us with a list of
20583 the LABEL_DECL nodes for the function however, and we output DWARF info
20584 for those in decls_for_scope. Just within the `outer_scope' there will be
20585 a BLOCK node representing the function's outermost pair of curly braces,
20586 and any blocks used for the base and member initializers of a C++
20587 constructor function. */
20588 tree outer_scope = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
20589 if (! declaration && outer_scope && TREE_CODE (outer_scope) != ERROR_MARK)
20590 {
20591 int call_site_note_count = 0;
20592 int tail_call_site_note_count = 0;
20593
20594 /* Emit a DW_TAG_variable DIE for a named return value. */
20595 if (DECL_NAME (DECL_RESULT (decl)))
20596 gen_decl_die (DECL_RESULT (decl), NULL, NULL, subr_die);
20597
20598 /* The first time through decls_for_scope we will generate the
20599 DIEs for the locals. The second time, we fill in the
20600 location info. */
20601 decls_for_scope (outer_scope, subr_die);
20602
20603 if (call_arg_locations && !dwarf_strict)
20604 {
20605 struct call_arg_loc_node *ca_loc;
20606 for (ca_loc = call_arg_locations; ca_loc; ca_loc = ca_loc->next)
20607 {
20608 dw_die_ref die = NULL;
20609 rtx tloc = NULL_RTX, tlocc = NULL_RTX;
20610 rtx arg, next_arg;
20611
20612 for (arg = (ca_loc->call_arg_loc_note != NULL_RTX
20613 ? NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (ca_loc->call_arg_loc_note)
20614 : NULL_RTX);
20615 arg; arg = next_arg)
20616 {
20617 dw_loc_descr_ref reg, val;
20618 machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 1));
20619 dw_die_ref cdie, tdie = NULL;
20620
20621 next_arg = XEXP (arg, 1);
20622 if (REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0))
20623 && next_arg
20624 && MEM_P (XEXP (XEXP (next_arg, 0), 0))
20625 && REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (next_arg, 0), 0), 0))
20626 && REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0))
20627 == REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (next_arg, 0), 0), 0)))
20628 next_arg = XEXP (next_arg, 1);
20629 if (mode == VOIDmode)
20630 {
20631 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0));
20632 if (mode == VOIDmode)
20633 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (arg, 0));
20634 }
20635 if (mode == VOIDmode || mode == BLKmode)
20636 continue;
20637 /* Get dynamic information about call target only if we
20638 have no static information: we cannot generate both
20639 DW_AT_abstract_origin and DW_AT_GNU_call_site_target
20640 attributes. */
20641 if (ca_loc->symbol_ref == NULL_RTX)
20642 {
20643 if (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0) == pc_rtx)
20644 {
20645 tloc = XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 1);
20646 continue;
20647 }
20648 else if (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0)) == CLOBBER
20649 && XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0), 0) == pc_rtx)
20650 {
20651 tlocc = XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 1);
20652 continue;
20653 }
20654 }
20655 reg = NULL;
20656 if (REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0)))
20657 reg = reg_loc_descriptor (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0),
20658 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
20659 else if (MEM_P (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0)))
20660 {
20661 rtx mem = XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0);
20662 reg = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (mem, 0),
20663 get_address_mode (mem),
20664 GET_MODE (mem),
20665 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
20666 }
20667 else if (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0))
20668 == DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF)
20669 {
20670 tree tdecl
20671 = DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF_DECL (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0));
20672 tdie = lookup_decl_die (tdecl);
20673 if (tdie == NULL)
20674 continue;
20675 }
20676 else
20677 continue;
20678 if (reg == NULL
20679 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0))
20680 != DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF)
20681 continue;
20682 val = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 1), mode,
20683 VOIDmode,
20684 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
20685 if (val == NULL)
20686 continue;
20687 if (die == NULL)
20688 die = gen_call_site_die (decl, subr_die, ca_loc);
20689 cdie = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_call_site_parameter, die,
20690 NULL_TREE);
20691 if (reg != NULL)
20692 add_AT_loc (cdie, DW_AT_location, reg);
20693 else if (tdie != NULL)
20694 add_AT_die_ref (cdie, DW_AT_abstract_origin, tdie);
20695 add_AT_loc (cdie, DW_AT_GNU_call_site_value, val);
20696 if (next_arg != XEXP (arg, 1))
20697 {
20698 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 1), 0), 1));
20699 if (mode == VOIDmode)
20700 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 1), 0), 0));
20701 val = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 1),
20702 0), 1),
20703 mode, VOIDmode,
20704 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
20705 if (val != NULL)
20706 add_AT_loc (cdie, DW_AT_GNU_call_site_data_value, val);
20707 }
20708 }
20709 if (die == NULL
20710 && (ca_loc->symbol_ref || tloc))
20711 die = gen_call_site_die (decl, subr_die, ca_loc);
20712 if (die != NULL && (tloc != NULL_RTX || tlocc != NULL_RTX))
20713 {
20714 dw_loc_descr_ref tval = NULL;
20715
20716 if (tloc != NULL_RTX)
20717 tval = mem_loc_descriptor (tloc,
20718 GET_MODE (tloc) == VOIDmode
20719 ? Pmode : GET_MODE (tloc),
20720 VOIDmode,
20721 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
20722 if (tval)
20723 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_GNU_call_site_target, tval);
20724 else if (tlocc != NULL_RTX)
20725 {
20726 tval = mem_loc_descriptor (tlocc,
20727 GET_MODE (tlocc) == VOIDmode
20728 ? Pmode : GET_MODE (tlocc),
20729 VOIDmode,
20730 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
20731 if (tval)
20732 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_GNU_call_site_target_clobbered,
20733 tval);
20734 }
20735 }
20736 if (die != NULL)
20737 {
20738 call_site_note_count++;
20739 if (ca_loc->tail_call_p)
20740 tail_call_site_note_count++;
20741 }
20742 }
20743 }
20744 call_arg_locations = NULL;
20745 call_arg_loc_last = NULL;
20746 if (tail_call_site_count >= 0
20747 && tail_call_site_count == tail_call_site_note_count
20748 && !dwarf_strict)
20749 {
20750 if (call_site_count >= 0
20751 && call_site_count == call_site_note_count)
20752 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_GNU_all_call_sites, 1);
20753 else
20754 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_GNU_all_tail_call_sites, 1);
20755 }
20756 call_site_count = -1;
20757 tail_call_site_count = -1;
20758 }
20759 }
20760
20761 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a die_struct). */
20762
20763 hashval_t
20764 block_die_hasher::hash (die_struct *d)
20765 {
20766 return (hashval_t) d->decl_id ^ htab_hash_pointer (d->die_parent);
20767 }
20768
20769 /* Return nonzero if decl_id and die_parent of die_struct X is the same
20770 as decl_id and die_parent of die_struct Y. */
20771
20772 bool
20773 block_die_hasher::equal (die_struct *x, die_struct *y)
20774 {
20775 return x->decl_id == y->decl_id && x->die_parent == y->die_parent;
20776 }
20777
20778 /* Return TRUE if DECL, which may have been previously generated as
20779 OLD_DIE, is a candidate for a DW_AT_specification. DECLARATION is
20780 true if decl (or its origin) is either an extern declaration or a
20781 class/namespace scoped declaration.
20782
20783 The declare_in_namespace support causes us to get two DIEs for one
20784 variable, both of which are declarations. We want to avoid
20785 considering one to be a specification, so we must test for
20786 DECLARATION and DW_AT_declaration. */
20787 static inline bool
20788 decl_will_get_specification_p (dw_die_ref old_die, tree decl, bool declaration)
20789 {
20790 return (old_die && TREE_STATIC (decl) && !declaration
20791 && get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration) == 1);
20792 }
20793
20794 /* Return true if DECL is a local static. */
20795
20796 static inline bool
20797 local_function_static (tree decl)
20798 {
20799 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL);
20800 return TREE_STATIC (decl)
20801 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl)
20802 && TREE_CODE (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)) == FUNCTION_DECL;
20803 }
20804
20805 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared data object.
20806 Either DECL or ORIGIN must be non-null. */
20807
20808 static void
20809 gen_variable_die (tree decl, tree origin, dw_die_ref context_die)
20810 {
20811 HOST_WIDE_INT off = 0;
20812 tree com_decl;
20813 tree decl_or_origin = decl ? decl : origin;
20814 tree ultimate_origin;
20815 dw_die_ref var_die;
20816 dw_die_ref old_die = decl ? lookup_decl_die (decl) : NULL;
20817 dw_die_ref origin_die = NULL;
20818 bool declaration = (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl_or_origin)
20819 || class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die));
20820 bool specialization_p = false;
20821
20822 ultimate_origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl_or_origin);
20823 if (decl || ultimate_origin)
20824 origin = ultimate_origin;
20825 com_decl = fortran_common (decl_or_origin, &off);
20826
20827 /* Symbol in common gets emitted as a child of the common block, in the form
20828 of a data member. */
20829 if (com_decl)
20830 {
20831 dw_die_ref com_die;
20832 dw_loc_list_ref loc;
20833 die_node com_die_arg;
20834
20835 var_die = lookup_decl_die (decl_or_origin);
20836 if (var_die)
20837 {
20838 if (get_AT (var_die, DW_AT_location) == NULL)
20839 {
20840 loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, off ? 1 : 2, NULL);
20841 if (loc)
20842 {
20843 if (off)
20844 {
20845 /* Optimize the common case. */
20846 if (single_element_loc_list_p (loc)
20847 && loc->expr->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr
20848 && loc->expr->dw_loc_next == NULL
20849 && GET_CODE (loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr)
20850 == SYMBOL_REF)
20851 {
20852 rtx x = loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr;
20853 loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr
20854 = plus_constant (GET_MODE (x), x , off);
20855 }
20856 else
20857 loc_list_plus_const (loc, off);
20858 }
20859 add_AT_location_description (var_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
20860 remove_AT (var_die, DW_AT_declaration);
20861 }
20862 }
20863 return;
20864 }
20865
20866 if (common_block_die_table == NULL)
20867 common_block_die_table = hash_table<block_die_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
20868
20869 com_die_arg.decl_id = DECL_UID (com_decl);
20870 com_die_arg.die_parent = context_die;
20871 com_die = common_block_die_table->find (&com_die_arg);
20872 loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, 2, NULL);
20873 if (com_die == NULL)
20874 {
20875 const char *cnam
20876 = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (com_decl));
20877 die_node **slot;
20878
20879 com_die = new_die (DW_TAG_common_block, context_die, decl);
20880 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (com_die, com_decl);
20881 if (loc)
20882 {
20883 add_AT_location_description (com_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
20884 /* Avoid sharing the same loc descriptor between
20885 DW_TAG_common_block and DW_TAG_variable. */
20886 loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, 2, NULL);
20887 }
20888 else if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
20889 add_AT_flag (com_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
20890 if (want_pubnames ())
20891 add_pubname_string (cnam, com_die); /* ??? needed? */
20892 com_die->decl_id = DECL_UID (com_decl);
20893 slot = common_block_die_table->find_slot (com_die, INSERT);
20894 *slot = com_die;
20895 }
20896 else if (get_AT (com_die, DW_AT_location) == NULL && loc)
20897 {
20898 add_AT_location_description (com_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
20899 loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, 2, NULL);
20900 remove_AT (com_die, DW_AT_declaration);
20901 }
20902 var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, com_die, decl);
20903 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (var_die, decl);
20904 add_type_attribute (var_die, TREE_TYPE (decl), decl_quals (decl),
20905 context_die);
20906 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
20907 if (loc)
20908 {
20909 if (off)
20910 {
20911 /* Optimize the common case. */
20912 if (single_element_loc_list_p (loc)
20913 && loc->expr->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr
20914 && loc->expr->dw_loc_next == NULL
20915 && GET_CODE (loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr) == SYMBOL_REF)
20916 {
20917 rtx x = loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr;
20918 loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr
20919 = plus_constant (GET_MODE (x), x, off);
20920 }
20921 else
20922 loc_list_plus_const (loc, off);
20923 }
20924 add_AT_location_description (var_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
20925 }
20926 else if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
20927 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
20928 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, var_die);
20929 return;
20930 }
20931
20932 if (old_die)
20933 {
20934 if (declaration)
20935 {
20936 /* A declaration that has been previously dumped, needs no
20937 further annotations, since it doesn't need location on
20938 the second pass. */
20939 return;
20940 }
20941 else if (decl_will_get_specification_p (old_die, decl, declaration)
20942 && !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_specification))
20943 {
20944 /* Fall-thru so we can make a new variable die along with a
20945 DW_AT_specification. */
20946 }
20947 else if (origin && old_die->die_parent != context_die)
20948 {
20949 /* If we will be creating an inlined instance, we need a
20950 new DIE that will get annotated with
20951 DW_AT_abstract_origin. Clear things so we can get a
20952 new DIE. */
20953 gcc_assert (!DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl));
20954 old_die = NULL;
20955 }
20956 else
20957 {
20958 /* If a DIE was dumped early, it still needs location info.
20959 Skip to where we fill the location bits. */
20960 var_die = old_die;
20961 goto gen_variable_die_location;
20962 }
20963 }
20964
20965 /* For static data members, the declaration in the class is supposed
20966 to have DW_TAG_member tag; the specification should still be
20967 DW_TAG_variable referencing the DW_TAG_member DIE. */
20968 if (declaration && class_scope_p (context_die))
20969 var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_member, context_die, decl);
20970 else
20971 var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, context_die, decl);
20972
20973 if (origin != NULL)
20974 origin_die = add_abstract_origin_attribute (var_die, origin);
20975
20976 /* Loop unrolling can create multiple blocks that refer to the same
20977 static variable, so we must test for the DW_AT_declaration flag.
20978
20979 ??? Loop unrolling/reorder_blocks should perhaps be rewritten to
20980 copy decls and set the DECL_ABSTRACT_P flag on them instead of
20981 sharing them.
20982
20983 ??? Duplicated blocks have been rewritten to use .debug_ranges. */
20984 else if (decl_will_get_specification_p (old_die, decl, declaration))
20985 {
20986 /* This is a definition of a C++ class level static. */
20987 add_AT_specification (var_die, old_die);
20988 specialization_p = true;
20989 if (DECL_NAME (decl))
20990 {
20991 expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
20992 struct dwarf_file_data * file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
20993
20994 if (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
20995 add_AT_file (var_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
20996
20997 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line) != (unsigned) s.line)
20998 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
20999
21000 if (old_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_member)
21001 add_linkage_name (var_die, decl);
21002 }
21003 }
21004 else
21005 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (var_die, decl);
21006
21007 if ((origin == NULL && !specialization_p)
21008 || (origin != NULL
21009 && !DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl_or_origin)
21010 && variably_modified_type_p (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin),
21011 decl_function_context
21012 (decl_or_origin))))
21013 {
21014 tree type = TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin);
21015
21016 if (decl_by_reference_p (decl_or_origin))
21017 add_type_attribute (var_die, TREE_TYPE (type), TYPE_UNQUALIFIED,
21018 context_die);
21019 else
21020 add_type_attribute (var_die, type, decl_quals (decl_or_origin),
21021 context_die);
21022 }
21023
21024 if (origin == NULL && !specialization_p)
21025 {
21026 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
21027 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
21028
21029 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
21030 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
21031
21032 add_accessibility_attribute (var_die, decl);
21033 }
21034
21035 if (declaration)
21036 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
21037
21038 if (decl && (DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl)
21039 || !old_die || is_declaration_die (old_die)))
21040 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, var_die);
21041
21042 gen_variable_die_location:
21043 if (! declaration
21044 && (! DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl_or_origin)
21045 /* Local static vars are shared between all clones/inlines,
21046 so emit DW_AT_location on the abstract DIE if DECL_RTL is
21047 already set. */
21048 || (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == VAR_DECL
21049 && TREE_STATIC (decl_or_origin)
21050 && DECL_RTL_SET_P (decl_or_origin)))
21051 /* When abstract origin already has DW_AT_location attribute, no need
21052 to add it again. */
21053 && (origin_die == NULL || get_AT (origin_die, DW_AT_location) == NULL))
21054 {
21055 if (early_dwarf)
21056 add_pubname (decl_or_origin, var_die);
21057 else
21058 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (var_die, decl_or_origin,
21059 decl == NULL);
21060 }
21061 else
21062 tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (var_die, decl_or_origin);
21063 }
21064
21065 /* Generate a DIE to represent a named constant. */
21066
21067 static void
21068 gen_const_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
21069 {
21070 dw_die_ref const_die;
21071 tree type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
21072
21073 const_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
21074 if (const_die)
21075 return;
21076
21077 const_die = new_die (DW_TAG_constant, context_die, decl);
21078 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, const_die);
21079 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (const_die, decl);
21080 add_type_attribute (const_die, type, TYPE_QUAL_CONST, context_die);
21081 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
21082 add_AT_flag (const_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
21083 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
21084 add_AT_flag (const_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
21085 tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (const_die, decl);
21086 }
21087
21088 /* Generate a DIE to represent a label identifier. */
21089
21090 static void
21091 gen_label_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
21092 {
21093 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
21094 dw_die_ref lbl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
21095 rtx insn;
21096 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
21097
21098 if (!lbl_die)
21099 {
21100 lbl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_label, context_die, decl);
21101 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, lbl_die);
21102
21103 if (origin != NULL)
21104 add_abstract_origin_attribute (lbl_die, origin);
21105 else
21106 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (lbl_die, decl);
21107 }
21108
21109 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl))
21110 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, lbl_die);
21111 else
21112 {
21113 insn = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl);
21114
21115 /* Deleted labels are programmer specified labels which have been
21116 eliminated because of various optimizations. We still emit them
21117 here so that it is possible to put breakpoints on them. */
21118 if (insn
21119 && (LABEL_P (insn)
21120 || ((NOTE_P (insn)
21121 && NOTE_KIND (insn) == NOTE_INSN_DELETED_LABEL))))
21122 {
21123 /* When optimization is enabled (via -O) some parts of the compiler
21124 (e.g. jump.c and cse.c) may try to delete CODE_LABEL insns which
21125 represent source-level labels which were explicitly declared by
21126 the user. This really shouldn't be happening though, so catch
21127 it if it ever does happen. */
21128 gcc_assert (!as_a<rtx_insn *> (insn)->deleted ());
21129
21130 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "L", CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn));
21131 add_AT_lbl_id (lbl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
21132 }
21133 else if (insn
21134 && NOTE_P (insn)
21135 && NOTE_KIND (insn) == NOTE_INSN_DELETED_DEBUG_LABEL
21136 && CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn) != -1)
21137 {
21138 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LDL", CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn));
21139 add_AT_lbl_id (lbl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
21140 }
21141 }
21142 }
21143
21144 /* A helper function for gen_inlined_subroutine_die. Add source coordinate
21145 attributes to the DIE for a block STMT, to describe where the inlined
21146 function was called from. This is similar to add_src_coords_attributes. */
21147
21148 static inline void
21149 add_call_src_coords_attributes (tree stmt, dw_die_ref die)
21150 {
21151 expanded_location s = expand_location (BLOCK_SOURCE_LOCATION (stmt));
21152
21153 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
21154 {
21155 add_AT_file (die, DW_AT_call_file, lookup_filename (s.file));
21156 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_call_line, s.line);
21157 }
21158 }
21159
21160
21161 /* A helper function for gen_lexical_block_die and gen_inlined_subroutine_die.
21162 Add low_pc and high_pc attributes to the DIE for a block STMT. */
21163
21164 static inline void
21165 add_high_low_attributes (tree stmt, dw_die_ref die)
21166 {
21167 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
21168
21169 if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt)
21170 && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
21171 {
21172 tree chain, superblock = NULL_TREE;
21173 dw_die_ref pdie;
21174 dw_attr_node *attr = NULL;
21175
21176 if (inlined_function_outer_scope_p (stmt))
21177 {
21178 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL,
21179 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
21180 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_entry_pc, label);
21181 }
21182
21183 /* Optimize duplicate .debug_ranges lists or even tails of
21184 lists. If this BLOCK has same ranges as its supercontext,
21185 lookup DW_AT_ranges attribute in the supercontext (and
21186 recursively so), verify that the ranges_table contains the
21187 right values and use it instead of adding a new .debug_range. */
21188 for (chain = stmt, pdie = die;
21189 BLOCK_SAME_RANGE (chain);
21190 chain = BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (chain))
21191 {
21192 dw_attr_node *new_attr;
21193
21194 pdie = pdie->die_parent;
21195 if (pdie == NULL)
21196 break;
21197 if (BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (chain) == NULL_TREE)
21198 break;
21199 new_attr = get_AT (pdie, DW_AT_ranges);
21200 if (new_attr == NULL
21201 || new_attr->dw_attr_val.val_class != dw_val_class_range_list)
21202 break;
21203 attr = new_attr;
21204 superblock = BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (chain);
21205 }
21206 if (attr != NULL
21207 && (ranges_table[attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset
21208 / 2 / DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE].num
21209 == BLOCK_NUMBER (superblock))
21210 && BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (superblock))
21211 {
21212 unsigned long off = attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset
21213 / 2 / DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
21214 unsigned long supercnt = 0, thiscnt = 0;
21215 for (chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (superblock);
21216 chain; chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (chain))
21217 {
21218 ++supercnt;
21219 gcc_checking_assert (ranges_table[off + supercnt].num
21220 == BLOCK_NUMBER (chain));
21221 }
21222 gcc_checking_assert (ranges_table[off + supercnt + 1].num == 0);
21223 for (chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt);
21224 chain; chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (chain))
21225 ++thiscnt;
21226 gcc_assert (supercnt >= thiscnt);
21227 add_AT_range_list (die, DW_AT_ranges,
21228 ((off + supercnt - thiscnt)
21229 * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE),
21230 false);
21231 return;
21232 }
21233
21234 add_AT_range_list (die, DW_AT_ranges, add_ranges (stmt), false);
21235
21236 chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt);
21237 do
21238 {
21239 add_ranges (chain);
21240 chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (chain);
21241 }
21242 while (chain);
21243 add_ranges (NULL);
21244 }
21245 else
21246 {
21247 char label_high[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
21248 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL,
21249 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
21250 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_high, BLOCK_END_LABEL,
21251 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
21252 add_AT_low_high_pc (die, label, label_high, false);
21253 }
21254 }
21255
21256 /* Generate a DIE for a lexical block. */
21257
21258 static void
21259 gen_lexical_block_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die)
21260 {
21261 dw_die_ref old_die = BLOCK_DIE (stmt);
21262 dw_die_ref stmt_die = NULL;
21263 if (!old_die)
21264 {
21265 stmt_die = new_die (DW_TAG_lexical_block, context_die, stmt);
21266 BLOCK_DIE (stmt) = stmt_die;
21267 }
21268
21269 if (BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
21270 {
21271 if (old_die)
21272 {
21273 /* This must have been generated early and it won't even
21274 need location information since it's a DW_AT_inline
21275 function. */
21276 if (flag_checking)
21277 for (dw_die_ref c = context_die; c; c = c->die_parent)
21278 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine
21279 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
21280 {
21281 gcc_assert (get_AT (c, DW_AT_inline));
21282 break;
21283 }
21284 return;
21285 }
21286 }
21287 else if (BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (stmt))
21288 {
21289 /* If this is an inlined instance, create a new lexical die for
21290 anything below to attach DW_AT_abstract_origin to. */
21291 if (old_die)
21292 {
21293 stmt_die = new_die (DW_TAG_lexical_block, context_die, stmt);
21294 BLOCK_DIE (stmt) = stmt_die;
21295 old_die = NULL;
21296 }
21297 }
21298
21299 if (old_die)
21300 stmt_die = old_die;
21301
21302 /* A non abstract block whose blocks have already been reordered
21303 should have the instruction range for this block. If so, set the
21304 high/low attributes. */
21305 if (!early_dwarf && !BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt) && TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt))
21306 {
21307 gcc_assert (stmt_die);
21308 add_high_low_attributes (stmt, stmt_die);
21309 }
21310
21311 decls_for_scope (stmt, stmt_die);
21312 }
21313
21314 /* Generate a DIE for an inlined subprogram. */
21315
21316 static void
21317 gen_inlined_subroutine_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die)
21318 {
21319 tree decl;
21320
21321 /* The instance of function that is effectively being inlined shall not
21322 be abstract. */
21323 gcc_assert (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt));
21324
21325 decl = block_ultimate_origin (stmt);
21326
21327 /* Make sure any inlined functions are known to be inlineable. */
21328 gcc_checking_assert (DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl)
21329 || cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl));
21330
21331 /* Emit info for the abstract instance first, if we haven't yet. We
21332 must emit this even if the block is abstract, otherwise when we
21333 emit the block below (or elsewhere), we may end up trying to emit
21334 a die whose origin die hasn't been emitted, and crashing. */
21335 dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl);
21336
21337 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
21338 {
21339 dw_die_ref subr_die
21340 = new_die (DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine, context_die, stmt);
21341
21342 if (call_arg_locations)
21343 BLOCK_DIE (stmt) = subr_die;
21344 add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, decl);
21345 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt))
21346 add_high_low_attributes (stmt, subr_die);
21347 add_call_src_coords_attributes (stmt, subr_die);
21348
21349 decls_for_scope (stmt, subr_die);
21350 }
21351 }
21352
21353 /* Generate a DIE for a field in a record, or structure. CTX is required: see
21354 the comment for VLR_CONTEXT. */
21355
21356 static void
21357 gen_field_die (tree decl, struct vlr_context *ctx, dw_die_ref context_die)
21358 {
21359 dw_die_ref decl_die;
21360
21361 if (TREE_TYPE (decl) == error_mark_node)
21362 return;
21363
21364 decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_member, context_die, decl);
21365 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
21366 add_type_attribute (decl_die, member_declared_type (decl),
21367 decl_quals (decl), context_die);
21368
21369 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl))
21370 {
21371 add_byte_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
21372 add_bit_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
21373 add_bit_offset_attribute (decl_die, decl, ctx);
21374 }
21375
21376 /* If we have a variant part offset, then we are supposed to process a member
21377 of a QUAL_UNION_TYPE, which is how we represent variant parts in
21378 trees. */
21379 gcc_assert (ctx->variant_part_offset == NULL_TREE
21380 || TREE_CODE (DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (decl)) != QUAL_UNION_TYPE);
21381 if (TREE_CODE (DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (decl)) != UNION_TYPE)
21382 add_data_member_location_attribute (decl_die, decl, ctx);
21383
21384 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
21385 add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
21386
21387 add_accessibility_attribute (decl_die, decl);
21388
21389 /* Equate decl number to die, so that we can look up this decl later on. */
21390 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die);
21391 }
21392
21393 #if 0
21394 /* Don't generate either pointer_type DIEs or reference_type DIEs here.
21395 Use modified_type_die instead.
21396 We keep this code here just in case these types of DIEs may be needed to
21397 represent certain things in other languages (e.g. Pascal) someday. */
21398
21399 static void
21400 gen_pointer_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
21401 {
21402 dw_die_ref ptr_die
21403 = new_die (DW_TAG_pointer_type, scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
21404
21405 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ptr_die);
21406 add_type_attribute (ptr_die, TREE_TYPE (type), TYPE_UNQUALIFIED,
21407 context_die);
21408 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size, PTR_SIZE);
21409 }
21410
21411 /* Don't generate either pointer_type DIEs or reference_type DIEs here.
21412 Use modified_type_die instead.
21413 We keep this code here just in case these types of DIEs may be needed to
21414 represent certain things in other languages (e.g. Pascal) someday. */
21415
21416 static void
21417 gen_reference_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
21418 {
21419 dw_die_ref ref_die, scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
21420
21421 if (TYPE_REF_IS_RVALUE (type) && dwarf_version >= 4)
21422 ref_die = new_die (DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type, scope_die, type);
21423 else
21424 ref_die = new_die (DW_TAG_reference_type, scope_die, type);
21425
21426 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ref_die);
21427 add_type_attribute (ref_die, TREE_TYPE (type), TYPE_UNQUALIFIED,
21428 context_die);
21429 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size, PTR_SIZE);
21430 }
21431 #endif
21432
21433 /* Generate a DIE for a pointer to a member type. */
21434
21435 static void
21436 gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
21437 {
21438 dw_die_ref ptr_die
21439 = new_die (DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type,
21440 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
21441
21442 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ptr_die);
21443 add_AT_die_ref (ptr_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
21444 lookup_type_die (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type)));
21445 add_type_attribute (ptr_die, TREE_TYPE (type), TYPE_UNQUALIFIED,
21446 context_die);
21447 }
21448
21449 static char *producer_string;
21450
21451 /* Return a heap allocated producer string including command line options
21452 if -grecord-gcc-switches. */
21453
21454 static char *
21455 gen_producer_string (void)
21456 {
21457 size_t j;
21458 auto_vec<const char *> switches;
21459 const char *language_string = lang_hooks.name;
21460 char *producer, *tail;
21461 const char *p;
21462 size_t len = dwarf_record_gcc_switches ? 0 : 3;
21463 size_t plen = strlen (language_string) + 1 + strlen (version_string);
21464
21465 for (j = 1; dwarf_record_gcc_switches && j < save_decoded_options_count; j++)
21466 switch (save_decoded_options[j].opt_index)
21467 {
21468 case OPT_o:
21469 case OPT_d:
21470 case OPT_dumpbase:
21471 case OPT_dumpdir:
21472 case OPT_auxbase:
21473 case OPT_auxbase_strip:
21474 case OPT_quiet:
21475 case OPT_version:
21476 case OPT_v:
21477 case OPT_w:
21478 case OPT_L:
21479 case OPT_D:
21480 case OPT_I:
21481 case OPT_U:
21482 case OPT_SPECIAL_unknown:
21483 case OPT_SPECIAL_ignore:
21484 case OPT_SPECIAL_program_name:
21485 case OPT_SPECIAL_input_file:
21486 case OPT_grecord_gcc_switches:
21487 case OPT_gno_record_gcc_switches:
21488 case OPT__output_pch_:
21489 case OPT_fdiagnostics_show_location_:
21490 case OPT_fdiagnostics_show_option:
21491 case OPT_fdiagnostics_show_caret:
21492 case OPT_fdiagnostics_color_:
21493 case OPT_fverbose_asm:
21494 case OPT____:
21495 case OPT__sysroot_:
21496 case OPT_nostdinc:
21497 case OPT_nostdinc__:
21498 case OPT_fpreprocessed:
21499 case OPT_fltrans_output_list_:
21500 case OPT_fresolution_:
21501 case OPT_fdebug_prefix_map_:
21502 /* Ignore these. */
21503 continue;
21504 default:
21505 if (cl_options[save_decoded_options[j].opt_index].flags
21506 & CL_NO_DWARF_RECORD)
21507 continue;
21508 gcc_checking_assert (save_decoded_options[j].canonical_option[0][0]
21509 == '-');
21510 switch (save_decoded_options[j].canonical_option[0][1])
21511 {
21512 case 'M':
21513 case 'i':
21514 case 'W':
21515 continue;
21516 case 'f':
21517 if (strncmp (save_decoded_options[j].canonical_option[0] + 2,
21518 "dump", 4) == 0)
21519 continue;
21520 break;
21521 default:
21522 break;
21523 }
21524 switches.safe_push (save_decoded_options[j].orig_option_with_args_text);
21525 len += strlen (save_decoded_options[j].orig_option_with_args_text) + 1;
21526 break;
21527 }
21528
21529 producer = XNEWVEC (char, plen + 1 + len + 1);
21530 tail = producer;
21531 sprintf (tail, "%s %s", language_string, version_string);
21532 tail += plen;
21533
21534 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (switches, j, p)
21535 {
21536 len = strlen (p);
21537 *tail = ' ';
21538 memcpy (tail + 1, p, len);
21539 tail += len + 1;
21540 }
21541
21542 *tail = '\0';
21543 return producer;
21544 }
21545
21546 /* Given a C and/or C++ language/version string return the "highest".
21547 C++ is assumed to be "higher" than C in this case. Used for merging
21548 LTO translation unit languages. */
21549 static const char *
21550 highest_c_language (const char *lang1, const char *lang2)
21551 {
21552 if (strcmp ("GNU C++14", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C++14", lang2) == 0)
21553 return "GNU C++14";
21554 if (strcmp ("GNU C++11", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C++11", lang2) == 0)
21555 return "GNU C++11";
21556 if (strcmp ("GNU C++98", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C++98", lang2) == 0)
21557 return "GNU C++98";
21558
21559 if (strcmp ("GNU C11", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C11", lang2) == 0)
21560 return "GNU C11";
21561 if (strcmp ("GNU C99", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C99", lang2) == 0)
21562 return "GNU C99";
21563 if (strcmp ("GNU C89", lang1) == 0 || strcmp ("GNU C89", lang2) == 0)
21564 return "GNU C89";
21565
21566 gcc_unreachable ();
21567 }
21568
21569
21570 /* Generate the DIE for the compilation unit. */
21571
21572 static dw_die_ref
21573 gen_compile_unit_die (const char *filename)
21574 {
21575 dw_die_ref die;
21576 const char *language_string = lang_hooks.name;
21577 int language;
21578
21579 die = new_die (DW_TAG_compile_unit, NULL, NULL);
21580
21581 if (filename)
21582 {
21583 add_name_attribute (die, filename);
21584 /* Don't add cwd for <built-in>. */
21585 if (!IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH (filename) && filename[0] != '<')
21586 add_comp_dir_attribute (die);
21587 }
21588
21589 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_producer, producer_string ? producer_string : "");
21590
21591 /* If our producer is LTO try to figure out a common language to use
21592 from the global list of translation units. */
21593 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU GIMPLE") == 0)
21594 {
21595 unsigned i;
21596 tree t;
21597 const char *common_lang = NULL;
21598
21599 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (all_translation_units, i, t)
21600 {
21601 if (!TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (t))
21602 continue;
21603 if (!common_lang)
21604 common_lang = TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (t);
21605 else if (strcmp (common_lang, TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (t)) == 0)
21606 ;
21607 else if (strncmp (common_lang, "GNU C", 5) == 0
21608 && strncmp (TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (t), "GNU C", 5) == 0)
21609 /* Mixing C and C++ is ok, use C++ in that case. */
21610 common_lang = highest_c_language (common_lang,
21611 TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (t));
21612 else
21613 {
21614 /* Fall back to C. */
21615 common_lang = NULL;
21616 break;
21617 }
21618 }
21619
21620 if (common_lang)
21621 language_string = common_lang;
21622 }
21623
21624 language = DW_LANG_C;
21625 if (strncmp (language_string, "GNU C", 5) == 0
21626 && ISDIGIT (language_string[5]))
21627 {
21628 language = DW_LANG_C89;
21629 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
21630 {
21631 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C89") != 0)
21632 language = DW_LANG_C99;
21633
21634 if (dwarf_version >= 5 /* || !dwarf_strict */)
21635 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C11") == 0)
21636 language = DW_LANG_C11;
21637 }
21638 }
21639 else if (strncmp (language_string, "GNU C++", 7) == 0)
21640 {
21641 language = DW_LANG_C_plus_plus;
21642 if (dwarf_version >= 5 /* || !dwarf_strict */)
21643 {
21644 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C++11") == 0)
21645 language = DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_11;
21646 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C++14") == 0)
21647 language = DW_LANG_C_plus_plus_14;
21648 }
21649 }
21650 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU F77") == 0)
21651 language = DW_LANG_Fortran77;
21652 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Pascal") == 0)
21653 language = DW_LANG_Pascal83;
21654 else if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
21655 {
21656 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Ada") == 0)
21657 language = DW_LANG_Ada95;
21658 else if (strncmp (language_string, "GNU Fortran", 11) == 0)
21659 {
21660 language = DW_LANG_Fortran95;
21661 if (dwarf_version >= 5 /* || !dwarf_strict */)
21662 {
21663 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Fortran2003") == 0)
21664 language = DW_LANG_Fortran03;
21665 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Fortran2008") == 0)
21666 language = DW_LANG_Fortran08;
21667 }
21668 }
21669 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Java") == 0)
21670 language = DW_LANG_Java;
21671 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Objective-C") == 0)
21672 language = DW_LANG_ObjC;
21673 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Objective-C++") == 0)
21674 language = DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus;
21675 else if (dwarf_version >= 5 || !dwarf_strict)
21676 {
21677 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Go") == 0)
21678 language = DW_LANG_Go;
21679 }
21680 }
21681 /* Use a degraded Fortran setting in strict DWARF2 so is_fortran works. */
21682 else if (strncmp (language_string, "GNU Fortran", 11) == 0)
21683 language = DW_LANG_Fortran90;
21684
21685 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_language, language);
21686
21687 switch (language)
21688 {
21689 case DW_LANG_Fortran77:
21690 case DW_LANG_Fortran90:
21691 case DW_LANG_Fortran95:
21692 case DW_LANG_Fortran03:
21693 case DW_LANG_Fortran08:
21694 /* Fortran has case insensitive identifiers and the front-end
21695 lowercases everything. */
21696 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_identifier_case, DW_ID_down_case);
21697 break;
21698 default:
21699 /* The default DW_ID_case_sensitive doesn't need to be specified. */
21700 break;
21701 }
21702 return die;
21703 }
21704
21705 /* Generate the DIE for a base class. */
21706
21707 static void
21708 gen_inheritance_die (tree binfo, tree access, tree type,
21709 dw_die_ref context_die)
21710 {
21711 dw_die_ref die = new_die (DW_TAG_inheritance, context_die, binfo);
21712 struct vlr_context ctx = { type, NULL };
21713
21714 add_type_attribute (die, BINFO_TYPE (binfo), TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, context_die);
21715 add_data_member_location_attribute (die, binfo, &ctx);
21716
21717 if (BINFO_VIRTUAL_P (binfo))
21718 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
21719
21720 /* In DWARF3+ the default is DW_ACCESS_private only in DW_TAG_class_type
21721 children, otherwise the default is DW_ACCESS_public. In DWARF2
21722 the default has always been DW_ACCESS_private. */
21723 if (access == access_public_node)
21724 {
21725 if (dwarf_version == 2
21726 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type)
21727 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_public);
21728 }
21729 else if (access == access_protected_node)
21730 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
21731 else if (dwarf_version > 2
21732 && context_die->die_tag != DW_TAG_class_type)
21733 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
21734 }
21735
21736 /* Return whether DECL is a FIELD_DECL that represents the variant part of a
21737 structure. */
21738 static bool
21739 is_variant_part (tree decl)
21740 {
21741 return (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL
21742 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == QUAL_UNION_TYPE);
21743 }
21744
21745 /* Check that OPERAND is a reference to a field in STRUCT_TYPE. If it is,
21746 return the FIELD_DECL. Return NULL_TREE otherwise. */
21747
21748 static tree
21749 analyze_discr_in_predicate (tree operand, tree struct_type)
21750 {
21751 bool continue_stripping = true;
21752 while (continue_stripping)
21753 switch (TREE_CODE (operand))
21754 {
21755 CASE_CONVERT:
21756 operand = TREE_OPERAND (operand, 0);
21757 break;
21758 default:
21759 continue_stripping = false;
21760 break;
21761 }
21762
21763 /* Match field access to members of struct_type only. */
21764 if (TREE_CODE (operand) == COMPONENT_REF
21765 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (operand, 0)) == PLACEHOLDER_EXPR
21766 && TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (operand, 0)) == struct_type
21767 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (operand, 1)) == FIELD_DECL)
21768 return TREE_OPERAND (operand, 1);
21769 else
21770 return NULL_TREE;
21771 }
21772
21773 /* Check that SRC is a constant integer that can be represented as a native
21774 integer constant (either signed or unsigned). If so, store it into DEST and
21775 return true. Return false otherwise. */
21776
21777 static bool
21778 get_discr_value (tree src, dw_discr_value *dest)
21779 {
21780 bool is_unsigned = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (src));
21781
21782 if (TREE_CODE (src) != INTEGER_CST
21783 || !(is_unsigned ? tree_fits_uhwi_p (src) : tree_fits_shwi_p (src)))
21784 return false;
21785
21786 dest->pos = is_unsigned;
21787 if (is_unsigned)
21788 dest->v.uval = tree_to_uhwi (src);
21789 else
21790 dest->v.sval = tree_to_shwi (src);
21791
21792 return true;
21793 }
21794
21795 /* Try to extract synthetic properties out of VARIANT_PART_DECL, which is a
21796 FIELD_DECL in STRUCT_TYPE that represents a variant part. If unsuccessful,
21797 store NULL_TREE in DISCR_DECL. Otherwise:
21798
21799 - store the discriminant field in STRUCT_TYPE that controls the variant
21800 part to *DISCR_DECL
21801
21802 - put in *DISCR_LISTS_P an array where for each variant, the item
21803 represents the corresponding matching list of discriminant values.
21804
21805 - put in *DISCR_LISTS_LENGTH the number of variants, which is the size of
21806 the above array.
21807
21808 Note that when the array is allocated (i.e. when the analysis is
21809 successful), it is up to the caller to free the array. */
21810
21811 static void
21812 analyze_variants_discr (tree variant_part_decl,
21813 tree struct_type,
21814 tree *discr_decl,
21815 dw_discr_list_ref **discr_lists_p,
21816 unsigned *discr_lists_length)
21817 {
21818 tree variant_part_type = TREE_TYPE (variant_part_decl);
21819 tree variant;
21820 dw_discr_list_ref *discr_lists;
21821 unsigned i;
21822
21823 /* Compute how many variants there are in this variant part. */
21824 *discr_lists_length = 0;
21825 for (variant = TYPE_FIELDS (variant_part_type);
21826 variant != NULL_TREE;
21827 variant = DECL_CHAIN (variant))
21828 ++*discr_lists_length;
21829
21830 *discr_decl = NULL_TREE;
21831 *discr_lists_p
21832 = (dw_discr_list_ref *) xcalloc (*discr_lists_length,
21833 sizeof (**discr_lists_p));
21834 discr_lists = *discr_lists_p;
21835
21836 /* And then analyze all variants to extract discriminant information for all
21837 of them. This analysis is conservative: as soon as we detect something we
21838 do not support, abort everything and pretend we found nothing. */
21839 for (variant = TYPE_FIELDS (variant_part_type), i = 0;
21840 variant != NULL_TREE;
21841 variant = DECL_CHAIN (variant), ++i)
21842 {
21843 tree match_expr = DECL_QUALIFIER (variant);
21844
21845 /* Now, try to analyze the predicate and deduce a discriminant for
21846 it. */
21847 if (match_expr == boolean_true_node)
21848 /* Typically happens for the default variant: it matches all cases that
21849 previous variants rejected. Don't output any matching value for
21850 this one. */
21851 continue;
21852
21853 /* The following loop tries to iterate over each discriminant
21854 possibility: single values or ranges. */
21855 while (match_expr != NULL_TREE)
21856 {
21857 tree next_round_match_expr;
21858 tree candidate_discr = NULL_TREE;
21859 dw_discr_list_ref new_node = NULL;
21860
21861 /* Possibilities are matched one after the other by nested
21862 TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR expressions. Process the current possibility and
21863 continue with the rest at next iteration. */
21864 if (TREE_CODE (match_expr) == TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR)
21865 {
21866 next_round_match_expr = TREE_OPERAND (match_expr, 0);
21867 match_expr = TREE_OPERAND (match_expr, 1);
21868 }
21869 else
21870 next_round_match_expr = NULL_TREE;
21871
21872 if (match_expr == boolean_false_node)
21873 /* This sub-expression matches nothing: just wait for the next
21874 one. */
21875 ;
21876
21877 else if (TREE_CODE (match_expr) == EQ_EXPR)
21878 {
21879 /* We are matching: <discr_field> == <integer_cst>
21880 This sub-expression matches a single value. */
21881 tree integer_cst = TREE_OPERAND (match_expr, 1);
21882
21883 candidate_discr
21884 = analyze_discr_in_predicate (TREE_OPERAND (match_expr, 0),
21885 struct_type);
21886
21887 new_node = ggc_cleared_alloc<dw_discr_list_node> ();
21888 if (!get_discr_value (integer_cst,
21889 &new_node->dw_discr_lower_bound))
21890 goto abort;
21891 new_node->dw_discr_range = false;
21892 }
21893
21894 else if (TREE_CODE (match_expr) == TRUTH_ANDIF_EXPR)
21895 {
21896 /* We are matching:
21897 <discr_field> > <integer_cst>
21898 && <discr_field> < <integer_cst>.
21899 This sub-expression matches the range of values between the
21900 two matched integer constants. Note that comparisons can be
21901 inclusive or exclusive. */
21902 tree candidate_discr_1, candidate_discr_2;
21903 tree lower_cst, upper_cst;
21904 bool lower_cst_included, upper_cst_included;
21905 tree lower_op = TREE_OPERAND (match_expr, 0);
21906 tree upper_op = TREE_OPERAND (match_expr, 1);
21907
21908 /* When the comparison is exclusive, the integer constant is not
21909 the discriminant range bound we are looking for: we will have
21910 to increment or decrement it. */
21911 if (TREE_CODE (lower_op) == GE_EXPR)
21912 lower_cst_included = true;
21913 else if (TREE_CODE (lower_op) == GT_EXPR)
21914 lower_cst_included = false;
21915 else
21916 goto abort;
21917
21918 if (TREE_CODE (upper_op) == LE_EXPR)
21919 upper_cst_included = true;
21920 else if (TREE_CODE (upper_op) == LT_EXPR)
21921 upper_cst_included = false;
21922 else
21923 goto abort;
21924
21925 /* Extract the discriminant from the first operand and check it
21926 is consistant with the same analysis in the second
21927 operand. */
21928 candidate_discr_1
21929 = analyze_discr_in_predicate (TREE_OPERAND (lower_op, 0),
21930 struct_type);
21931 candidate_discr_2
21932 = analyze_discr_in_predicate (TREE_OPERAND (upper_op, 0),
21933 struct_type);
21934 if (candidate_discr_1 == candidate_discr_2)
21935 candidate_discr = candidate_discr_1;
21936 else
21937 goto abort;
21938
21939 /* Extract bounds from both. */
21940 new_node = ggc_cleared_alloc<dw_discr_list_node> ();
21941 lower_cst = TREE_OPERAND (lower_op, 1);
21942 upper_cst = TREE_OPERAND (upper_op, 1);
21943
21944 if (!lower_cst_included)
21945 lower_cst
21946 = fold (build2 (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (lower_cst),
21947 lower_cst,
21948 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (lower_cst), 1)));
21949 if (!upper_cst_included)
21950 upper_cst
21951 = fold (build2 (MINUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (upper_cst),
21952 upper_cst,
21953 build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (upper_cst), 1)));
21954
21955 if (!get_discr_value (lower_cst,
21956 &new_node->dw_discr_lower_bound)
21957 || !get_discr_value (upper_cst,
21958 &new_node->dw_discr_upper_bound))
21959 goto abort;
21960
21961 new_node->dw_discr_range = true;
21962 }
21963
21964 else
21965 /* Unsupported sub-expression: we cannot determine the set of
21966 matching discriminant values. Abort everything. */
21967 goto abort;
21968
21969 /* If the discriminant info is not consistant with what we saw so
21970 far, consider the analysis failed and abort everything. */
21971 if (candidate_discr == NULL_TREE
21972 || (*discr_decl != NULL_TREE && candidate_discr != *discr_decl))
21973 goto abort;
21974 else
21975 *discr_decl = candidate_discr;
21976
21977 if (new_node != NULL)
21978 {
21979 new_node->dw_discr_next = discr_lists[i];
21980 discr_lists[i] = new_node;
21981 }
21982 match_expr = next_round_match_expr;
21983 }
21984 }
21985
21986 /* If we reach this point, we could match everything we were interested
21987 in. */
21988 return;
21989
21990 abort:
21991 /* Clean all data structure and return no result. */
21992 free (*discr_lists_p);
21993 *discr_lists_p = NULL;
21994 *discr_decl = NULL_TREE;
21995 }
21996
21997 /* Generate a DIE to represent VARIANT_PART_DECL, a variant part that is part
21998 of STRUCT_TYPE, a record type. This new DIE is emitted as the next child
21999 under CONTEXT_DIE.
22000
22001 Variant parts are supposed to be implemented as a FIELD_DECL whose type is a
22002 QUAL_UNION_TYPE: this is the VARIANT_PART_DECL parameter. The members for
22003 this type, which are record types, represent the available variants and each
22004 has a DECL_QUALIFIER attribute. The discriminant and the discriminant
22005 values are inferred from these attributes.
22006
22007 In trees, the offsets for the fields inside these sub-records are relative
22008 to the variant part itself, whereas the corresponding DIEs should have
22009 offset attributes that are relative to the embedding record base address.
22010 This is why the caller must provide a VARIANT_PART_OFFSET expression: it
22011 must be an expression that computes the offset of the variant part to
22012 describe in DWARF. */
22013
22014 static void
22015 gen_variant_part (tree variant_part_decl, struct vlr_context *vlr_ctx,
22016 dw_die_ref context_die)
22017 {
22018 const tree variant_part_type = TREE_TYPE (variant_part_decl);
22019 tree variant_part_offset = vlr_ctx->variant_part_offset;
22020 struct loc_descr_context ctx = {
22021 vlr_ctx->struct_type, /* context_type */
22022 NULL_TREE, /* base_decl */
22023 NULL /* dpi */
22024 };
22025
22026 /* The FIELD_DECL node in STRUCT_TYPE that acts as the discriminant, or
22027 NULL_TREE if there is no such field. */
22028 tree discr_decl = NULL_TREE;
22029 dw_discr_list_ref *discr_lists;
22030 unsigned discr_lists_length = 0;
22031 unsigned i;
22032
22033 dw_die_ref dwarf_proc_die = NULL;
22034 dw_die_ref variant_part_die
22035 = new_die (DW_TAG_variant_part, context_die, variant_part_type);
22036
22037 equate_decl_number_to_die (variant_part_decl, variant_part_die);
22038
22039 analyze_variants_discr (variant_part_decl, vlr_ctx->struct_type,
22040 &discr_decl, &discr_lists, &discr_lists_length);
22041
22042 if (discr_decl != NULL_TREE)
22043 {
22044 dw_die_ref discr_die = lookup_decl_die (discr_decl);
22045
22046 if (discr_die)
22047 add_AT_die_ref (variant_part_die, DW_AT_discr, discr_die);
22048 else
22049 /* We have no DIE for the discriminant, so just discard all
22050 discrimimant information in the output. */
22051 discr_decl = NULL_TREE;
22052 }
22053
22054 /* If the offset for this variant part is more complex than a constant,
22055 create a DWARF procedure for it so that we will not have to generate DWARF
22056 expressions for it for each member. */
22057 if (TREE_CODE (variant_part_offset) != INTEGER_CST
22058 && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
22059 {
22060 const tree dwarf_proc_fndecl
22061 = build_decl (UNKNOWN_LOCATION, FUNCTION_DECL, NULL_TREE,
22062 build_function_type (TREE_TYPE (variant_part_offset),
22063 NULL_TREE));
22064 const tree dwarf_proc_call = build_call_expr (dwarf_proc_fndecl, 0);
22065 const dw_loc_descr_ref dwarf_proc_body
22066 = loc_descriptor_from_tree (variant_part_offset, 0, &ctx);
22067
22068 dwarf_proc_die = new_dwarf_proc_die (dwarf_proc_body,
22069 dwarf_proc_fndecl, context_die);
22070 if (dwarf_proc_die != NULL)
22071 variant_part_offset = dwarf_proc_call;
22072 }
22073
22074 /* Output DIEs for all variants. */
22075 i = 0;
22076 for (tree variant = TYPE_FIELDS (variant_part_type);
22077 variant != NULL_TREE;
22078 variant = DECL_CHAIN (variant), ++i)
22079 {
22080 tree variant_type = TREE_TYPE (variant);
22081 dw_die_ref variant_die;
22082
22083 /* All variants (i.e. members of a variant part) are supposed to be
22084 encoded as structures. Sub-variant parts are QUAL_UNION_TYPE fields
22085 under these records. */
22086 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (variant_type) == RECORD_TYPE);
22087
22088 variant_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variant, variant_part_die, variant_type);
22089 equate_decl_number_to_die (variant, variant_die);
22090
22091 /* Output discriminant values this variant matches, if any. */
22092 if (discr_decl == NULL || discr_lists[i] == NULL)
22093 /* In the case we have discriminant information at all, this is
22094 probably the default variant: as the standard says, don't
22095 output any discriminant value/list attribute. */
22096 ;
22097 else if (discr_lists[i]->dw_discr_next == NULL
22098 && !discr_lists[i]->dw_discr_range)
22099 /* If there is only one accepted value, don't bother outputting a
22100 list. */
22101 add_discr_value (variant_die, &discr_lists[i]->dw_discr_lower_bound);
22102 else
22103 add_discr_list (variant_die, discr_lists[i]);
22104
22105 for (tree member = TYPE_FIELDS (variant_type);
22106 member != NULL_TREE;
22107 member = DECL_CHAIN (member))
22108 {
22109 struct vlr_context vlr_sub_ctx = {
22110 vlr_ctx->struct_type, /* struct_type */
22111 NULL /* variant_part_offset */
22112 };
22113 if (is_variant_part (member))
22114 {
22115 /* All offsets for fields inside variant parts are relative to
22116 the top-level embedding RECORD_TYPE's base address. On the
22117 other hand, offsets in GCC's types are relative to the
22118 nested-most variant part. So we have to sum offsets each time
22119 we recurse. */
22120
22121 vlr_sub_ctx.variant_part_offset
22122 = fold (build2 (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (variant_part_offset),
22123 variant_part_offset, byte_position (member)));
22124 gen_variant_part (member, &vlr_sub_ctx, variant_die);
22125 }
22126 else
22127 {
22128 vlr_sub_ctx.variant_part_offset = variant_part_offset;
22129 gen_decl_die (member, NULL, &vlr_sub_ctx, variant_die);
22130 }
22131 }
22132 }
22133
22134 free (discr_lists);
22135 }
22136
22137 /* Generate a DIE for a class member. */
22138
22139 static void
22140 gen_member_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
22141 {
22142 tree member;
22143 tree binfo = TYPE_BINFO (type);
22144 dw_die_ref child;
22145
22146 /* If this is not an incomplete type, output descriptions of each of its
22147 members. Note that as we output the DIEs necessary to represent the
22148 members of this record or union type, we will also be trying to output
22149 DIEs to represent the *types* of those members. However the `type'
22150 function (above) will specifically avoid generating type DIEs for member
22151 types *within* the list of member DIEs for this (containing) type except
22152 for those types (of members) which are explicitly marked as also being
22153 members of this (containing) type themselves. The g++ front- end can
22154 force any given type to be treated as a member of some other (containing)
22155 type by setting the TYPE_CONTEXT of the given (member) type to point to
22156 the TREE node representing the appropriate (containing) type. */
22157
22158 /* First output info about the base classes. */
22159 if (binfo)
22160 {
22161 vec<tree, va_gc> *accesses = BINFO_BASE_ACCESSES (binfo);
22162 int i;
22163 tree base;
22164
22165 for (i = 0; BINFO_BASE_ITERATE (binfo, i, base); i++)
22166 gen_inheritance_die (base,
22167 (accesses ? (*accesses)[i] : access_public_node),
22168 type,
22169 context_die);
22170 }
22171
22172 /* Now output info about the data members and type members. */
22173 for (member = TYPE_FIELDS (type); member; member = DECL_CHAIN (member))
22174 {
22175 struct vlr_context vlr_ctx = { type, NULL_TREE };
22176
22177 /* If we thought we were generating minimal debug info for TYPE
22178 and then changed our minds, some of the member declarations
22179 may have already been defined. Don't define them again, but
22180 do put them in the right order. */
22181
22182 child = lookup_decl_die (member);
22183 if (child)
22184 splice_child_die (context_die, child);
22185
22186 /* Do not generate standard DWARF for variant parts if we are generating
22187 the corresponding GNAT encodings: DIEs generated for both would
22188 conflict in our mappings. */
22189 else if (is_variant_part (member)
22190 && gnat_encodings == DWARF_GNAT_ENCODINGS_MINIMAL)
22191 {
22192 vlr_ctx.variant_part_offset = byte_position (member);
22193 gen_variant_part (member, &vlr_ctx, context_die);
22194 }
22195 else
22196 {
22197 vlr_ctx.variant_part_offset = NULL_TREE;
22198 gen_decl_die (member, NULL, &vlr_ctx, context_die);
22199 }
22200 }
22201
22202 /* We do not keep type methods in type variants. */
22203 gcc_assert (TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type) == type);
22204 /* Now output info about the function members (if any). */
22205 if (TYPE_METHODS (type) != error_mark_node)
22206 for (member = TYPE_METHODS (type); member; member = DECL_CHAIN (member))
22207 {
22208 /* Don't include clones in the member list. */
22209 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (member))
22210 continue;
22211 /* Nor constructors for anonymous classes. */
22212 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (member)
22213 && dwarf2_name (member, 0) == NULL)
22214 continue;
22215
22216 child = lookup_decl_die (member);
22217 if (child)
22218 splice_child_die (context_die, child);
22219 else
22220 gen_decl_die (member, NULL, NULL, context_die);
22221 }
22222 }
22223
22224 /* Generate a DIE for a structure or union type. If TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG
22225 is set, we pretend that the type was never defined, so we only get the
22226 member DIEs needed by later specification DIEs. */
22227
22228 static void
22229 gen_struct_or_union_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die,
22230 enum debug_info_usage usage)
22231 {
22232 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
22233 {
22234 /* Fill in the bound of variable-length fields in late dwarf if
22235 still incomplete. */
22236 if (!early_dwarf && variably_modified_type_p (type, NULL))
22237 for (tree member = TYPE_FIELDS (type);
22238 member;
22239 member = DECL_CHAIN (member))
22240 fill_variable_array_bounds (TREE_TYPE (member));
22241 return;
22242 }
22243
22244 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
22245 dw_die_ref scope_die = 0;
22246 int nested = 0;
22247 int complete = (TYPE_SIZE (type)
22248 && (! TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
22249 || ! TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))));
22250 int ns_decl = (context_die && context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace);
22251 complete = complete && should_emit_struct_debug (type, usage);
22252
22253 if (type_die && ! complete)
22254 return;
22255
22256 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type) != NULL_TREE
22257 && (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
22258 || TREE_CODE (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)) == NAMESPACE_DECL))
22259 nested = 1;
22260
22261 scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
22262
22263 /* Generate child dies for template paramaters. */
22264 if (!type_die && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
22265 schedule_generic_params_dies_gen (type);
22266
22267 if (! type_die || (nested && is_cu_die (scope_die)))
22268 /* First occurrence of type or toplevel definition of nested class. */
22269 {
22270 dw_die_ref old_die = type_die;
22271
22272 type_die = new_die (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
22273 ? record_type_tag (type) : DW_TAG_union_type,
22274 scope_die, type);
22275 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
22276 if (old_die)
22277 add_AT_specification (type_die, old_die);
22278 else
22279 add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
22280 }
22281 else
22282 remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
22283
22284 /* If this type has been completed, then give it a byte_size attribute and
22285 then give a list of members. */
22286 if (complete && !ns_decl)
22287 {
22288 /* Prevent infinite recursion in cases where the type of some member of
22289 this type is expressed in terms of this type itself. */
22290 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
22291 add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
22292 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
22293 {
22294 add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
22295 add_accessibility_attribute (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
22296 }
22297
22298 /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
22299 inline function, then it may not have a parent. Fix this now. */
22300 if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
22301 add_child_die (scope_die, type_die);
22302
22303 push_decl_scope (type);
22304 gen_member_die (type, type_die);
22305 pop_decl_scope ();
22306
22307 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (type_die, type, context_die);
22308 if (TYPE_ARTIFICIAL (type))
22309 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
22310
22311 /* GNU extension: Record what type our vtable lives in. */
22312 if (TYPE_VFIELD (type))
22313 {
22314 tree vtype = DECL_FCONTEXT (TYPE_VFIELD (type));
22315
22316 gen_type_die (vtype, context_die);
22317 add_AT_die_ref (type_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
22318 lookup_type_die (vtype));
22319 }
22320 }
22321 else
22322 {
22323 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
22324
22325 /* We don't need to do this for function-local types. */
22326 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
22327 && ! decl_function_context (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)))
22328 vec_safe_push (incomplete_types, type);
22329 }
22330
22331 if (get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_name))
22332 add_pubtype (type, type_die);
22333 }
22334
22335 /* Generate a DIE for a subroutine _type_. */
22336
22337 static void
22338 gen_subroutine_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
22339 {
22340 tree return_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
22341 dw_die_ref subr_die
22342 = new_die (DW_TAG_subroutine_type,
22343 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
22344
22345 equate_type_number_to_die (type, subr_die);
22346 add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, type);
22347 add_type_attribute (subr_die, return_type, TYPE_UNQUALIFIED, context_die);
22348 gen_formal_types_die (type, subr_die);
22349
22350 if (get_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_name))
22351 add_pubtype (type, subr_die);
22352 }
22353
22354 /* Generate a DIE for a type definition. */
22355
22356 static void
22357 gen_typedef_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
22358 {
22359 dw_die_ref type_die;
22360 tree origin;
22361
22362 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
22363 {
22364 if (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl))
22365 fill_variable_array_bounds (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl));
22366 return;
22367 }
22368
22369 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl) = 1;
22370 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_typedef, context_die, decl);
22371 origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
22372 if (origin != NULL)
22373 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, origin);
22374 else
22375 {
22376 tree type;
22377
22378 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (type_die, decl);
22379 if (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl))
22380 {
22381 type = DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl);
22382
22383 if (type == error_mark_node)
22384 return;
22385
22386 gcc_assert (type != TREE_TYPE (decl));
22387 equate_type_number_to_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), type_die);
22388 }
22389 else
22390 {
22391 type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
22392
22393 if (type == error_mark_node)
22394 return;
22395
22396 if (is_naming_typedef_decl (TYPE_NAME (type)))
22397 {
22398 /* Here, we are in the case of decl being a typedef naming
22399 an anonymous type, e.g:
22400 typedef struct {...} foo;
22401 In that case TREE_TYPE (decl) is not a typedef variant
22402 type and TYPE_NAME of the anonymous type is set to the
22403 TYPE_DECL of the typedef. This construct is emitted by
22404 the C++ FE.
22405
22406 TYPE is the anonymous struct named by the typedef
22407 DECL. As we need the DW_AT_type attribute of the
22408 DW_TAG_typedef to point to the DIE of TYPE, let's
22409 generate that DIE right away. add_type_attribute
22410 called below will then pick (via lookup_type_die) that
22411 anonymous struct DIE. */
22412 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
22413 gen_tagged_type_die (type, context_die, DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
22414
22415 /* This is a GNU Extension. We are adding a
22416 DW_AT_linkage_name attribute to the DIE of the
22417 anonymous struct TYPE. The value of that attribute
22418 is the name of the typedef decl naming the anonymous
22419 struct. This greatly eases the work of consumers of
22420 this debug info. */
22421 add_linkage_attr (lookup_type_die (type), decl);
22422 }
22423 }
22424
22425 add_type_attribute (type_die, type, decl_quals (decl), context_die);
22426
22427 if (is_naming_typedef_decl (decl))
22428 /* We want that all subsequent calls to lookup_type_die with
22429 TYPE in argument yield the DW_TAG_typedef we have just
22430 created. */
22431 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
22432
22433 add_accessibility_attribute (type_die, decl);
22434 }
22435
22436 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl))
22437 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, type_die);
22438
22439 if (get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_name))
22440 add_pubtype (decl, type_die);
22441 }
22442
22443 /* Generate a DIE for a struct, class, enum or union type. */
22444
22445 static void
22446 gen_tagged_type_die (tree type,
22447 dw_die_ref context_die,
22448 enum debug_info_usage usage)
22449 {
22450 int need_pop;
22451
22452 if (type == NULL_TREE
22453 || !is_tagged_type (type))
22454 return;
22455
22456 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
22457 need_pop = 0;
22458 /* If this is a nested type whose containing class hasn't been written
22459 out yet, writing it out will cover this one, too. This does not apply
22460 to instantiations of member class templates; they need to be added to
22461 the containing class as they are generated. FIXME: This hurts the
22462 idea of combining type decls from multiple TUs, since we can't predict
22463 what set of template instantiations we'll get. */
22464 else if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)
22465 && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
22466 && ! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)))
22467 {
22468 gen_type_die_with_usage (TYPE_CONTEXT (type), context_die, usage);
22469
22470 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
22471 return;
22472
22473 /* If that failed, attach ourselves to the stub. */
22474 push_decl_scope (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
22475 context_die = lookup_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
22476 need_pop = 1;
22477 }
22478 else if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type) != NULL_TREE
22479 && (TREE_CODE (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)) == FUNCTION_DECL))
22480 {
22481 /* If this type is local to a function that hasn't been written
22482 out yet, use a NULL context for now; it will be fixed up in
22483 decls_for_scope. */
22484 context_die = lookup_decl_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
22485 /* A declaration DIE doesn't count; nested types need to go in the
22486 specification. */
22487 if (context_die && is_declaration_die (context_die))
22488 context_die = NULL;
22489 need_pop = 0;
22490 }
22491 else
22492 {
22493 context_die = declare_in_namespace (type, context_die);
22494 need_pop = 0;
22495 }
22496
22497 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE)
22498 {
22499 /* This might have been written out by the call to
22500 declare_in_namespace. */
22501 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
22502 gen_enumeration_type_die (type, context_die);
22503 }
22504 else
22505 gen_struct_or_union_type_die (type, context_die, usage);
22506
22507 if (need_pop)
22508 pop_decl_scope ();
22509
22510 /* Don't set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN on an incomplete struct; we want to fix
22511 it up if it is ever completed. gen_*_type_die will set it for us
22512 when appropriate. */
22513 }
22514
22515 /* Generate a type description DIE. */
22516
22517 static void
22518 gen_type_die_with_usage (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die,
22519 enum debug_info_usage usage)
22520 {
22521 struct array_descr_info info;
22522
22523 if (type == NULL_TREE || type == error_mark_node)
22524 return;
22525
22526 if (flag_checking && type)
22527 verify_type (type);
22528
22529 if (TYPE_NAME (type) != NULL_TREE
22530 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
22531 && is_redundant_typedef (TYPE_NAME (type))
22532 && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type)))
22533 /* The DECL of this type is a typedef we don't want to emit debug
22534 info for but we want debug info for its underlying typedef.
22535 This can happen for e.g, the injected-class-name of a C++
22536 type. */
22537 type = DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type));
22538
22539 /* If TYPE is a typedef type variant, let's generate debug info
22540 for the parent typedef which TYPE is a type of. */
22541 if (typedef_variant_p (type))
22542 {
22543 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
22544 return;
22545
22546 /* Prevent broken recursion; we can't hand off to the same type. */
22547 gcc_assert (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type)) != type);
22548
22549 /* Give typedefs the right scope. */
22550 context_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
22551
22552 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
22553
22554 gen_decl_die (TYPE_NAME (type), NULL, NULL, context_die);
22555 return;
22556 }
22557
22558 /* If type is an anonymous tagged type named by a typedef, let's
22559 generate debug info for the typedef. */
22560 if (is_naming_typedef_decl (TYPE_NAME (type)))
22561 {
22562 /* Use the DIE of the containing namespace as the parent DIE of
22563 the type description DIE we want to generate. */
22564 if (DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (type))
22565 && TREE_CODE (DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (type))) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
22566 context_die = get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (type)));
22567
22568 gen_decl_die (TYPE_NAME (type), NULL, NULL, context_die);
22569 return;
22570 }
22571
22572 /* We are going to output a DIE to represent the unqualified version
22573 of this type (i.e. without any const or volatile qualifiers) so
22574 get the main variant (i.e. the unqualified version) of this type
22575 now. (Vectors and arrays are special because the debugging info is in the
22576 cloned type itself). */
22577 if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE
22578 && TREE_CODE (type) != ARRAY_TYPE)
22579 type = type_main_variant (type);
22580
22581 /* If this is an array type with hidden descriptor, handle it first. */
22582 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type)
22583 && lang_hooks.types.get_array_descr_info)
22584 {
22585 memset (&info, 0, sizeof (info));
22586 if (lang_hooks.types.get_array_descr_info (type, &info))
22587 {
22588 /* Fortran sometimes emits array types with no dimension. */
22589 gcc_assert (info.ndimensions >= 0
22590 && (info.ndimensions
22591 <= DWARF2OUT_ARRAY_DESCR_INFO_MAX_DIMEN));
22592 gen_descr_array_type_die (type, &info, context_die);
22593 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
22594 return;
22595 }
22596 }
22597
22598 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
22599 {
22600 /* Variable-length types may be incomplete even if
22601 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN. For such types, fall through to
22602 gen_array_type_die() and possibly fill in
22603 DW_AT_{upper,lower}_bound attributes. */
22604 if ((TREE_CODE (type) != ARRAY_TYPE
22605 && TREE_CODE (type) != RECORD_TYPE
22606 && TREE_CODE (type) != UNION_TYPE
22607 && TREE_CODE (type) != QUAL_UNION_TYPE)
22608 || !variably_modified_type_p (type, NULL))
22609 return;
22610 }
22611
22612 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
22613 {
22614 case ERROR_MARK:
22615 break;
22616
22617 case POINTER_TYPE:
22618 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
22619 /* We must set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN in case this is a recursive type. This
22620 ensures that the gen_type_die recursion will terminate even if the
22621 type is recursive. Recursive types are possible in Ada. */
22622 /* ??? We could perhaps do this for all types before the switch
22623 statement. */
22624 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
22625
22626 /* For these types, all that is required is that we output a DIE (or a
22627 set of DIEs) to represent the "basis" type. */
22628 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
22629 DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
22630 break;
22631
22632 case OFFSET_TYPE:
22633 /* This code is used for C++ pointer-to-data-member types.
22634 Output a description of the relevant class type. */
22635 gen_type_die_with_usage (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type), context_die,
22636 DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
22637
22638 /* Output a description of the type of the object pointed to. */
22639 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
22640 DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
22641
22642 /* Now output a DIE to represent this pointer-to-data-member type
22643 itself. */
22644 gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (type, context_die);
22645 break;
22646
22647 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
22648 /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already). */
22649 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
22650 DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
22651 gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
22652 break;
22653
22654 case METHOD_TYPE:
22655 /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already). */
22656 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
22657 DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
22658 gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
22659 break;
22660
22661 case ARRAY_TYPE:
22662 case VECTOR_TYPE:
22663 gen_array_type_die (type, context_die);
22664 break;
22665
22666 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
22667 case RECORD_TYPE:
22668 case UNION_TYPE:
22669 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
22670 gen_tagged_type_die (type, context_die, usage);
22671 return;
22672
22673 case VOID_TYPE:
22674 case INTEGER_TYPE:
22675 case REAL_TYPE:
22676 case FIXED_POINT_TYPE:
22677 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
22678 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
22679 case POINTER_BOUNDS_TYPE:
22680 /* No DIEs needed for fundamental types. */
22681 break;
22682
22683 case NULLPTR_TYPE:
22684 case LANG_TYPE:
22685 /* Just use DW_TAG_unspecified_type. */
22686 {
22687 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
22688 if (type_die == NULL)
22689 {
22690 tree name = TYPE_IDENTIFIER (type);
22691 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_unspecified_type, comp_unit_die (),
22692 type);
22693 add_name_attribute (type_die, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
22694 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
22695 }
22696 }
22697 break;
22698
22699 default:
22700 if (is_cxx_auto (type))
22701 {
22702 tree name = TYPE_IDENTIFIER (type);
22703 dw_die_ref *die = (name == get_identifier ("auto")
22704 ? &auto_die : &decltype_auto_die);
22705 if (!*die)
22706 {
22707 *die = new_die (DW_TAG_unspecified_type,
22708 comp_unit_die (), NULL_TREE);
22709 add_name_attribute (*die, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
22710 }
22711 equate_type_number_to_die (type, *die);
22712 break;
22713 }
22714 gcc_unreachable ();
22715 }
22716
22717 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
22718 }
22719
22720 static void
22721 gen_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
22722 {
22723 if (type != error_mark_node)
22724 {
22725 gen_type_die_with_usage (type, context_die, DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
22726 if (flag_checking)
22727 {
22728 dw_die_ref die = lookup_type_die (type);
22729 if (die)
22730 check_die (die);
22731 }
22732 }
22733 }
22734
22735 /* Generate a DW_TAG_lexical_block DIE followed by DIEs to represent all of the
22736 things which are local to the given block. */
22737
22738 static void
22739 gen_block_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die)
22740 {
22741 int must_output_die = 0;
22742 bool inlined_func;
22743
22744 /* Ignore blocks that are NULL. */
22745 if (stmt == NULL_TREE)
22746 return;
22747
22748 inlined_func = inlined_function_outer_scope_p (stmt);
22749
22750 /* If the block is one fragment of a non-contiguous block, do not
22751 process the variables, since they will have been done by the
22752 origin block. Do process subblocks. */
22753 if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_ORIGIN (stmt))
22754 {
22755 tree sub;
22756
22757 for (sub = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt); sub; sub = BLOCK_CHAIN (sub))
22758 gen_block_die (sub, context_die);
22759
22760 return;
22761 }
22762
22763 /* Determine if we need to output any Dwarf DIEs at all to represent this
22764 block. */
22765 if (inlined_func)
22766 /* The outer scopes for inlinings *must* always be represented. We
22767 generate DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIEs for them. (See below.) */
22768 must_output_die = 1;
22769 else
22770 {
22771 /* Determine if this block directly contains any "significant"
22772 local declarations which we will need to output DIEs for. */
22773 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
22774 /* We are not in terse mode so *any* local declaration counts
22775 as being a "significant" one. */
22776 must_output_die = ((BLOCK_VARS (stmt) != NULL
22777 || BLOCK_NUM_NONLOCALIZED_VARS (stmt))
22778 && (TREE_USED (stmt)
22779 || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt)
22780 || BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt)));
22781 else if ((TREE_USED (stmt)
22782 || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt)
22783 || BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
22784 && !dwarf2out_ignore_block (stmt))
22785 must_output_die = 1;
22786 }
22787
22788 /* It would be a waste of space to generate a Dwarf DW_TAG_lexical_block
22789 DIE for any block which contains no significant local declarations at
22790 all. Rather, in such cases we just call `decls_for_scope' so that any
22791 needed Dwarf info for any sub-blocks will get properly generated. Note
22792 that in terse mode, our definition of what constitutes a "significant"
22793 local declaration gets restricted to include only inlined function
22794 instances and local (nested) function definitions. */
22795 if (must_output_die)
22796 {
22797 if (inlined_func)
22798 {
22799 /* If STMT block is abstract, that means we have been called
22800 indirectly from dwarf2out_abstract_function.
22801 That function rightfully marks the descendent blocks (of
22802 the abstract function it is dealing with) as being abstract,
22803 precisely to prevent us from emitting any
22804 DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIE as a descendent
22805 of an abstract function instance. So in that case, we should
22806 not call gen_inlined_subroutine_die.
22807
22808 Later though, when cgraph asks dwarf2out to emit info
22809 for the concrete instance of the function decl into which
22810 the concrete instance of STMT got inlined, the later will lead
22811 to the generation of a DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIE. */
22812 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
22813 gen_inlined_subroutine_die (stmt, context_die);
22814 }
22815 else
22816 gen_lexical_block_die (stmt, context_die);
22817 }
22818 else
22819 decls_for_scope (stmt, context_die);
22820 }
22821
22822 /* Process variable DECL (or variable with origin ORIGIN) within
22823 block STMT and add it to CONTEXT_DIE. */
22824 static void
22825 process_scope_var (tree stmt, tree decl, tree origin, dw_die_ref context_die)
22826 {
22827 dw_die_ref die;
22828 tree decl_or_origin = decl ? decl : origin;
22829
22830 if (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == FUNCTION_DECL)
22831 die = lookup_decl_die (decl_or_origin);
22832 else if (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == TYPE_DECL
22833 && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl_or_origin))
22834 die = lookup_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin));
22835 else
22836 die = NULL;
22837
22838 if (die != NULL && die->die_parent == NULL)
22839 add_child_die (context_die, die);
22840 else if (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == IMPORTED_DECL)
22841 {
22842 if (early_dwarf)
22843 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (decl_or_origin, DECL_NAME (decl_or_origin),
22844 stmt, context_die);
22845 }
22846 else
22847 gen_decl_die (decl, origin, NULL, context_die);
22848 }
22849
22850 /* Generate all of the decls declared within a given scope and (recursively)
22851 all of its sub-blocks. */
22852
22853 static void
22854 decls_for_scope (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die)
22855 {
22856 tree decl;
22857 unsigned int i;
22858 tree subblocks;
22859
22860 /* Ignore NULL blocks. */
22861 if (stmt == NULL_TREE)
22862 return;
22863
22864 /* Output the DIEs to represent all of the data objects and typedefs
22865 declared directly within this block but not within any nested
22866 sub-blocks. Also, nested function and tag DIEs have been
22867 generated with a parent of NULL; fix that up now. We don't
22868 have to do this if we're at -g1. */
22869 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
22870 {
22871 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt); decl != NULL; decl = DECL_CHAIN (decl))
22872 process_scope_var (stmt, decl, NULL_TREE, context_die);
22873 for (i = 0; i < BLOCK_NUM_NONLOCALIZED_VARS (stmt); i++)
22874 process_scope_var (stmt, NULL, BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VAR (stmt, i),
22875 context_die);
22876 }
22877
22878 /* Even if we're at -g1, we need to process the subblocks in order to get
22879 inlined call information. */
22880
22881 /* Output the DIEs to represent all sub-blocks (and the items declared
22882 therein) of this block. */
22883 for (subblocks = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt);
22884 subblocks != NULL;
22885 subblocks = BLOCK_CHAIN (subblocks))
22886 gen_block_die (subblocks, context_die);
22887 }
22888
22889 /* Is this a typedef we can avoid emitting? */
22890
22891 bool
22892 is_redundant_typedef (const_tree decl)
22893 {
22894 if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl))
22895 return true;
22896
22897 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
22898 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl)
22899 && is_tagged_type (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
22900 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))) == TYPE_DECL
22901 && DECL_NAME (decl) == DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))))
22902 /* Also ignore the artificial member typedef for the class name. */
22903 return true;
22904
22905 return false;
22906 }
22907
22908 /* Return TRUE if TYPE is a typedef that names a type for linkage
22909 purposes. This kind of typedefs is produced by the C++ FE for
22910 constructs like:
22911
22912 typedef struct {...} foo;
22913
22914 In that case, there is no typedef variant type produced for foo.
22915 Rather, the TREE_TYPE of the TYPE_DECL of foo is the anonymous
22916 struct type. */
22917
22918 static bool
22919 is_naming_typedef_decl (const_tree decl)
22920 {
22921 if (decl == NULL_TREE
22922 || TREE_CODE (decl) != TYPE_DECL
22923 || !is_tagged_type (TREE_TYPE (decl))
22924 || DECL_IS_BUILTIN (decl)
22925 || is_redundant_typedef (decl)
22926 /* It looks like Ada produces TYPE_DECLs that are very similar
22927 to C++ naming typedefs but that have different
22928 semantics. Let's be specific to c++ for now. */
22929 || !is_cxx ())
22930 return FALSE;
22931
22932 return (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl) == NULL_TREE
22933 && TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == decl
22934 && (TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl))
22935 != TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (decl))));
22936 }
22937
22938 /* Looks up the DIE for a context. */
22939
22940 static inline dw_die_ref
22941 lookup_context_die (tree context)
22942 {
22943 if (context)
22944 {
22945 /* Find die that represents this context. */
22946 if (TYPE_P (context))
22947 {
22948 context = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (context);
22949 dw_die_ref ctx = lookup_type_die (context);
22950 if (!ctx)
22951 return NULL;
22952 return strip_naming_typedef (context, ctx);
22953 }
22954 else
22955 return lookup_decl_die (context);
22956 }
22957 return comp_unit_die ();
22958 }
22959
22960 /* Returns the DIE for a context. */
22961
22962 static inline dw_die_ref
22963 get_context_die (tree context)
22964 {
22965 if (context)
22966 {
22967 /* Find die that represents this context. */
22968 if (TYPE_P (context))
22969 {
22970 context = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (context);
22971 return strip_naming_typedef (context, force_type_die (context));
22972 }
22973 else
22974 return force_decl_die (context);
22975 }
22976 return comp_unit_die ();
22977 }
22978
22979 /* Returns the DIE for decl. A DIE will always be returned. */
22980
22981 static dw_die_ref
22982 force_decl_die (tree decl)
22983 {
22984 dw_die_ref decl_die;
22985 unsigned saved_external_flag;
22986 tree save_fn = NULL_TREE;
22987 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
22988 if (!decl_die)
22989 {
22990 dw_die_ref context_die = get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
22991
22992 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
22993 if (decl_die)
22994 return decl_die;
22995
22996 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
22997 {
22998 case FUNCTION_DECL:
22999 /* Clear current_function_decl, so that gen_subprogram_die thinks
23000 that this is a declaration. At this point, we just want to force
23001 declaration die. */
23002 save_fn = current_function_decl;
23003 current_function_decl = NULL_TREE;
23004 gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die);
23005 current_function_decl = save_fn;
23006 break;
23007
23008 case VAR_DECL:
23009 /* Set external flag to force declaration die. Restore it after
23010 gen_decl_die() call. */
23011 saved_external_flag = DECL_EXTERNAL (decl);
23012 DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = 1;
23013 gen_decl_die (decl, NULL, NULL, context_die);
23014 DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = saved_external_flag;
23015 break;
23016
23017 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
23018 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
23019 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
23020 else
23021 /* DWARF2 has neither DW_TAG_module, nor DW_TAG_namespace. */
23022 decl_die = comp_unit_die ();
23023 break;
23024
23025 case TRANSLATION_UNIT_DECL:
23026 decl_die = comp_unit_die ();
23027 break;
23028
23029 default:
23030 gcc_unreachable ();
23031 }
23032
23033 /* We should be able to find the DIE now. */
23034 if (!decl_die)
23035 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
23036 gcc_assert (decl_die);
23037 }
23038
23039 return decl_die;
23040 }
23041
23042 /* Returns the DIE for TYPE, that must not be a base type. A DIE is
23043 always returned. */
23044
23045 static dw_die_ref
23046 force_type_die (tree type)
23047 {
23048 dw_die_ref type_die;
23049
23050 type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
23051 if (!type_die)
23052 {
23053 dw_die_ref context_die = get_context_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
23054
23055 type_die = modified_type_die (type, TYPE_QUALS_NO_ADDR_SPACE (type),
23056 context_die);
23057 gcc_assert (type_die);
23058 }
23059 return type_die;
23060 }
23061
23062 /* Force out any required namespaces to be able to output DECL,
23063 and return the new context_die for it, if it's changed. */
23064
23065 static dw_die_ref
23066 setup_namespace_context (tree thing, dw_die_ref context_die)
23067 {
23068 tree context = (DECL_P (thing)
23069 ? DECL_CONTEXT (thing) : TYPE_CONTEXT (thing));
23070 if (context && TREE_CODE (context) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
23071 /* Force out the namespace. */
23072 context_die = force_decl_die (context);
23073
23074 return context_die;
23075 }
23076
23077 /* Emit a declaration DIE for THING (which is either a DECL or a tagged
23078 type) within its namespace, if appropriate.
23079
23080 For compatibility with older debuggers, namespace DIEs only contain
23081 declarations; all definitions are emitted at CU scope, with
23082 DW_AT_specification pointing to the declaration (like with class
23083 members). */
23084
23085 static dw_die_ref
23086 declare_in_namespace (tree thing, dw_die_ref context_die)
23087 {
23088 dw_die_ref ns_context;
23089
23090 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
23091 return context_die;
23092
23093 /* External declarations in the local scope only need to be emitted
23094 once, not once in the namespace and once in the scope.
23095
23096 This avoids declaring the `extern' below in the
23097 namespace DIE as well as in the innermost scope:
23098
23099 namespace S
23100 {
23101 int i=5;
23102 int foo()
23103 {
23104 int i=8;
23105 extern int i;
23106 return i;
23107 }
23108 }
23109 */
23110 if (DECL_P (thing) && DECL_EXTERNAL (thing) && local_scope_p (context_die))
23111 return context_die;
23112
23113 /* If this decl is from an inlined function, then don't try to emit it in its
23114 namespace, as we will get confused. It would have already been emitted
23115 when the abstract instance of the inline function was emitted anyways. */
23116 if (DECL_P (thing) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (thing))
23117 return context_die;
23118
23119 ns_context = setup_namespace_context (thing, context_die);
23120
23121 if (ns_context != context_die)
23122 {
23123 if (is_fortran ())
23124 return ns_context;
23125 if (DECL_P (thing))
23126 gen_decl_die (thing, NULL, NULL, ns_context);
23127 else
23128 gen_type_die (thing, ns_context);
23129 }
23130 return context_die;
23131 }
23132
23133 /* Generate a DIE for a namespace or namespace alias. */
23134
23135 static void
23136 gen_namespace_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
23137 {
23138 dw_die_ref namespace_die;
23139
23140 /* Namespace aliases have a DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN of the namespace
23141 they are an alias of. */
23142 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == NULL)
23143 {
23144 /* Output a real namespace or module. */
23145 context_die = setup_namespace_context (decl, comp_unit_die ());
23146 namespace_die = new_die (is_fortran ()
23147 ? DW_TAG_module : DW_TAG_namespace,
23148 context_die, decl);
23149 /* For Fortran modules defined in different CU don't add src coords. */
23150 if (namespace_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_module && DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
23151 {
23152 const char *name = dwarf2_name (decl, 0);
23153 if (name)
23154 add_name_attribute (namespace_die, name);
23155 }
23156 else
23157 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (namespace_die, decl);
23158 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
23159 add_AT_flag (namespace_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
23160 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, namespace_die);
23161 }
23162 else
23163 {
23164 /* Output a namespace alias. */
23165
23166 /* Force out the namespace we are an alias of, if necessary. */
23167 dw_die_ref origin_die
23168 = force_decl_die (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl));
23169
23170 if (DECL_FILE_SCOPE_P (decl)
23171 || TREE_CODE (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
23172 context_die = setup_namespace_context (decl, comp_unit_die ());
23173 /* Now create the namespace alias DIE. */
23174 namespace_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_declaration, context_die, decl);
23175 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (namespace_die, decl);
23176 add_AT_die_ref (namespace_die, DW_AT_import, origin_die);
23177 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, namespace_die);
23178 }
23179 /* Bypass dwarf2_name's check for DECL_NAMELESS. */
23180 if (want_pubnames ())
23181 add_pubname_string (lang_hooks.dwarf_name (decl, 1), namespace_die);
23182 }
23183
23184 /* Generate Dwarf debug information for a decl described by DECL.
23185 The return value is currently only meaningful for PARM_DECLs,
23186 for all other decls it returns NULL.
23187
23188 If DECL is a FIELD_DECL, CTX is required: see the comment for VLR_CONTEXT.
23189 It can be NULL otherwise. */
23190
23191 static dw_die_ref
23192 gen_decl_die (tree decl, tree origin, struct vlr_context *ctx,
23193 dw_die_ref context_die)
23194 {
23195 tree decl_or_origin = decl ? decl : origin;
23196 tree class_origin = NULL, ultimate_origin;
23197
23198 if (DECL_P (decl_or_origin) && DECL_IGNORED_P (decl_or_origin))
23199 return NULL;
23200
23201 /* Ignore pointer bounds decls. */
23202 if (DECL_P (decl_or_origin)
23203 && TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin)
23204 && POINTER_BOUNDS_P (decl_or_origin))
23205 return NULL;
23206
23207 switch (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin))
23208 {
23209 case ERROR_MARK:
23210 break;
23211
23212 case CONST_DECL:
23213 if (!is_fortran () && !is_ada ())
23214 {
23215 /* The individual enumerators of an enum type get output when we output
23216 the Dwarf representation of the relevant enum type itself. */
23217 break;
23218 }
23219
23220 /* Emit its type. */
23221 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
23222
23223 /* And its containing namespace. */
23224 context_die = declare_in_namespace (decl, context_die);
23225
23226 gen_const_die (decl, context_die);
23227 break;
23228
23229 case FUNCTION_DECL:
23230 /* Don't output any DIEs to represent mere function declarations,
23231 unless they are class members or explicit block externs. */
23232 if (DECL_INITIAL (decl_or_origin) == NULL_TREE
23233 && DECL_FILE_SCOPE_P (decl_or_origin)
23234 && (current_function_decl == NULL_TREE
23235 || DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl_or_origin)))
23236 break;
23237
23238 #if 0
23239 /* FIXME */
23240 /* This doesn't work because the C frontend sets DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN
23241 on local redeclarations of global functions. That seems broken. */
23242 if (current_function_decl != decl)
23243 /* This is only a declaration. */;
23244 #endif
23245
23246 /* If we're emitting a clone, emit info for the abstract instance. */
23247 if (origin || DECL_ORIGIN (decl) != decl)
23248 dwarf2out_abstract_function (origin
23249 ? DECL_ORIGIN (origin)
23250 : DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl));
23251
23252 /* If we're emitting an out-of-line copy of an inline function,
23253 emit info for the abstract instance and set up to refer to it. */
23254 else if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl)
23255 && ! DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl)
23256 && ! class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die)
23257 /* dwarf2out_abstract_function won't emit a die if this is just
23258 a declaration. We must avoid setting DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN in
23259 that case, because that works only if we have a die. */
23260 && DECL_INITIAL (decl) != NULL_TREE)
23261 {
23262 dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl);
23263 set_decl_origin_self (decl);
23264 }
23265
23266 /* Otherwise we're emitting the primary DIE for this decl. */
23267 else if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
23268 {
23269 /* Before we describe the FUNCTION_DECL itself, make sure that we
23270 have its containing type. */
23271 if (!origin)
23272 origin = decl_class_context (decl);
23273 if (origin != NULL_TREE)
23274 gen_type_die (origin, context_die);
23275
23276 /* And its return type. */
23277 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)), context_die);
23278
23279 /* And its virtual context. */
23280 if (DECL_VINDEX (decl) != NULL_TREE)
23281 gen_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl), context_die);
23282
23283 /* Make sure we have a member DIE for decl. */
23284 if (origin != NULL_TREE)
23285 gen_type_die_for_member (origin, decl, context_die);
23286
23287 /* And its containing namespace. */
23288 context_die = declare_in_namespace (decl, context_die);
23289 }
23290
23291 /* Now output a DIE to represent the function itself. */
23292 if (decl)
23293 gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die);
23294 break;
23295
23296 case TYPE_DECL:
23297 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
23298 actual typedefs. */
23299 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
23300 break;
23301
23302 /* In the special case of a TYPE_DECL node representing the declaration
23303 of some type tag, if the given TYPE_DECL is marked as having been
23304 instantiated from some other (original) TYPE_DECL node (e.g. one which
23305 was generated within the original definition of an inline function) we
23306 used to generate a special (abbreviated) DW_TAG_structure_type,
23307 DW_TAG_union_type, or DW_TAG_enumeration_type DIE here. But nothing
23308 should be actually referencing those DIEs, as variable DIEs with that
23309 type would be emitted already in the abstract origin, so it was always
23310 removed during unused type prunning. Don't add anything in this
23311 case. */
23312 if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl) && decl_ultimate_origin (decl) != NULL_TREE)
23313 break;
23314
23315 if (is_redundant_typedef (decl))
23316 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
23317 else
23318 /* Output a DIE to represent the typedef itself. */
23319 gen_typedef_die (decl, context_die);
23320 break;
23321
23322 case LABEL_DECL:
23323 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
23324 gen_label_die (decl, context_die);
23325 break;
23326
23327 case VAR_DECL:
23328 case RESULT_DECL:
23329 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
23330 variable declarations or definitions. */
23331 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
23332 break;
23333
23334 /* Output any DIEs that are needed to specify the type of this data
23335 object. */
23336 if (decl_by_reference_p (decl_or_origin))
23337 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin)), context_die);
23338 else
23339 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin), context_die);
23340
23341 /* And its containing type. */
23342 class_origin = decl_class_context (decl_or_origin);
23343 if (class_origin != NULL_TREE)
23344 gen_type_die_for_member (class_origin, decl_or_origin, context_die);
23345
23346 /* And its containing namespace. */
23347 context_die = declare_in_namespace (decl_or_origin, context_die);
23348
23349 /* Now output the DIE to represent the data object itself. This gets
23350 complicated because of the possibility that the VAR_DECL really
23351 represents an inlined instance of a formal parameter for an inline
23352 function. */
23353 ultimate_origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl_or_origin);
23354 if (ultimate_origin != NULL_TREE
23355 && TREE_CODE (ultimate_origin) == PARM_DECL)
23356 gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, origin,
23357 true /* Emit name attribute. */,
23358 context_die);
23359 else
23360 gen_variable_die (decl, origin, context_die);
23361 break;
23362
23363 case FIELD_DECL:
23364 gcc_assert (ctx != NULL && ctx->struct_type != NULL);
23365 /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle C++
23366 anonymous unions and structs. */
23367 if (DECL_NAME (decl) != NULL_TREE
23368 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == UNION_TYPE
23369 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == RECORD_TYPE)
23370 {
23371 gen_type_die (member_declared_type (decl), context_die);
23372 gen_field_die (decl, ctx, context_die);
23373 }
23374 break;
23375
23376 case PARM_DECL:
23377 if (DECL_BY_REFERENCE (decl_or_origin))
23378 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin)), context_die);
23379 else
23380 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin), context_die);
23381 return gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, origin,
23382 true /* Emit name attribute. */,
23383 context_die);
23384
23385 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
23386 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
23387 gen_namespace_die (decl, context_die);
23388 break;
23389
23390 case IMPORTED_DECL:
23391 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (decl, DECL_NAME (decl),
23392 DECL_CONTEXT (decl), context_die);
23393 break;
23394
23395 case NAMELIST_DECL:
23396 gen_namelist_decl (DECL_NAME (decl), context_die,
23397 NAMELIST_DECL_ASSOCIATED_DECL (decl));
23398 break;
23399
23400 default:
23401 /* Probably some frontend-internal decl. Assume we don't care. */
23402 gcc_assert ((int)TREE_CODE (decl) > NUM_TREE_CODES);
23403 break;
23404 }
23405
23406 return NULL;
23407 }
23408 \f
23409 /* Output initial debug information for global DECL. Called at the
23410 end of the parsing process.
23411
23412 This is the initial debug generation process. As such, the DIEs
23413 generated may be incomplete. A later debug generation pass
23414 (dwarf2out_late_global_decl) will augment the information generated
23415 in this pass (e.g., with complete location info). */
23416
23417 static void
23418 dwarf2out_early_global_decl (tree decl)
23419 {
23420 set_early_dwarf s;
23421
23422 /* gen_decl_die() will set DECL_ABSTRACT because
23423 cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p() returns true. This is in
23424 turn will cause DW_AT_inline attributes to be set.
23425
23426 This happens because at early dwarf generation, there is no
23427 cgraph information, causing cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p()
23428 to return true. Trick cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p()
23429 while we generate dwarf early. */
23430 bool save = symtab->global_info_ready;
23431 symtab->global_info_ready = true;
23432
23433 /* We don't handle TYPE_DECLs. If required, they'll be reached via
23434 other DECLs and they can point to template types or other things
23435 that dwarf2out can't handle when done via dwarf2out_decl. */
23436 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != TYPE_DECL
23437 && TREE_CODE (decl) != PARM_DECL)
23438 {
23439 tree save_fndecl = current_function_decl;
23440 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL)
23441 {
23442 /* No cfun means the symbol has no body, so there's nothing
23443 to emit. */
23444 if (!DECL_STRUCT_FUNCTION (decl))
23445 goto early_decl_exit;
23446
23447 current_function_decl = decl;
23448 }
23449 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
23450 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL)
23451 current_function_decl = save_fndecl;
23452 }
23453 early_decl_exit:
23454 symtab->global_info_ready = save;
23455 }
23456
23457 /* Output debug information for global decl DECL. Called from
23458 toplev.c after compilation proper has finished. */
23459
23460 static void
23461 dwarf2out_late_global_decl (tree decl)
23462 {
23463 /* We have to generate early debug late for LTO. */
23464 if (in_lto_p)
23465 dwarf2out_early_global_decl (decl);
23466
23467 /* Fill-in any location information we were unable to determine
23468 on the first pass. */
23469 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
23470 && !POINTER_BOUNDS_P (decl))
23471 {
23472 dw_die_ref die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
23473 if (die)
23474 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (die, decl, false);
23475 }
23476 }
23477
23478 /* Output debug information for type decl DECL. Called from toplev.c
23479 and from language front ends (to record built-in types). */
23480 static void
23481 dwarf2out_type_decl (tree decl, int local)
23482 {
23483 if (!local)
23484 {
23485 set_early_dwarf s;
23486 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
23487 }
23488 }
23489
23490 /* Output debug information for imported module or decl DECL.
23491 NAME is non-NULL name in the lexical block if the decl has been renamed.
23492 LEXICAL_BLOCK is the lexical block (which TREE_CODE is a BLOCK)
23493 that DECL belongs to.
23494 LEXICAL_BLOCK_DIE is the DIE of LEXICAL_BLOCK. */
23495 static void
23496 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (tree decl,
23497 tree name,
23498 tree lexical_block,
23499 dw_die_ref lexical_block_die)
23500 {
23501 expanded_location xloc;
23502 dw_die_ref imported_die = NULL;
23503 dw_die_ref at_import_die;
23504
23505 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == IMPORTED_DECL)
23506 {
23507 xloc = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
23508 decl = IMPORTED_DECL_ASSOCIATED_DECL (decl);
23509 gcc_assert (decl);
23510 }
23511 else
23512 xloc = expand_location (input_location);
23513
23514 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == CONST_DECL)
23515 {
23516 at_import_die = force_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
23517 /* For namespace N { typedef void T; } using N::T; base_type_die
23518 returns NULL, but DW_TAG_imported_declaration requires
23519 the DW_AT_import tag. Force creation of DW_TAG_typedef. */
23520 if (!at_import_die)
23521 {
23522 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL);
23523 gen_typedef_die (decl, get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)));
23524 at_import_die = lookup_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
23525 gcc_assert (at_import_die);
23526 }
23527 }
23528 else
23529 {
23530 at_import_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
23531 if (!at_import_die)
23532 {
23533 /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
23534 emitted the member decl for this field. Emit it now. */
23535 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL)
23536 {
23537 tree type = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
23538
23539 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)
23540 && TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
23541 && !should_emit_struct_debug (TYPE_CONTEXT (type),
23542 DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE))
23543 return;
23544 gen_type_die_for_member (type, decl,
23545 get_context_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)));
23546 }
23547 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == NAMELIST_DECL)
23548 at_import_die = gen_namelist_decl (DECL_NAME (decl),
23549 get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)),
23550 NULL_TREE);
23551 else
23552 at_import_die = force_decl_die (decl);
23553 }
23554 }
23555
23556 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
23557 {
23558 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
23559 imported_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_module,
23560 lexical_block_die,
23561 lexical_block);
23562 else
23563 return;
23564 }
23565 else
23566 imported_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_declaration,
23567 lexical_block_die,
23568 lexical_block);
23569
23570 add_AT_file (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_file, lookup_filename (xloc.file));
23571 add_AT_unsigned (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_line, xloc.line);
23572 if (name)
23573 add_AT_string (imported_die, DW_AT_name,
23574 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
23575 add_AT_die_ref (imported_die, DW_AT_import, at_import_die);
23576 }
23577
23578 /* Output debug information for imported module or decl DECL.
23579 NAME is non-NULL name in context if the decl has been renamed.
23580 CHILD is true if decl is one of the renamed decls as part of
23581 importing whole module. */
23582
23583 static void
23584 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl (tree decl, tree name, tree context,
23585 bool child)
23586 {
23587 /* dw_die_ref at_import_die; */
23588 dw_die_ref scope_die;
23589
23590 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
23591 return;
23592
23593 gcc_assert (decl);
23594
23595 set_early_dwarf s;
23596
23597 /* To emit DW_TAG_imported_module or DW_TAG_imported_decl, we need two DIEs.
23598 We need decl DIE for reference and scope die. First, get DIE for the decl
23599 itself. */
23600
23601 /* Get the scope die for decl context. Use comp_unit_die for global module
23602 or decl. If die is not found for non globals, force new die. */
23603 if (context
23604 && TYPE_P (context)
23605 && !should_emit_struct_debug (context, DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE))
23606 return;
23607
23608 if (!(dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
23609 return;
23610
23611 scope_die = get_context_die (context);
23612
23613 if (child)
23614 {
23615 gcc_assert (scope_die->die_child);
23616 gcc_assert (scope_die->die_child->die_tag == DW_TAG_imported_module);
23617 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) != NAMESPACE_DECL);
23618 scope_die = scope_die->die_child;
23619 }
23620
23621 /* OK, now we have DIEs for decl as well as scope. Emit imported die. */
23622 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (decl, name, context, scope_die);
23623 }
23624
23625 /* Output debug information for namelists. */
23626
23627 static dw_die_ref
23628 gen_namelist_decl (tree name, dw_die_ref scope_die, tree item_decls)
23629 {
23630 dw_die_ref nml_die, nml_item_die, nml_item_ref_die;
23631 tree value;
23632 unsigned i;
23633
23634 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
23635 return NULL;
23636
23637 gcc_assert (scope_die != NULL);
23638 nml_die = new_die (DW_TAG_namelist, scope_die, NULL);
23639 add_AT_string (nml_die, DW_AT_name, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
23640
23641 /* If there are no item_decls, we have a nondefining namelist, e.g.
23642 with USE association; hence, set DW_AT_declaration. */
23643 if (item_decls == NULL_TREE)
23644 {
23645 add_AT_flag (nml_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
23646 return nml_die;
23647 }
23648
23649 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_VALUE (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (item_decls), i, value)
23650 {
23651 nml_item_ref_die = lookup_decl_die (value);
23652 if (!nml_item_ref_die)
23653 nml_item_ref_die = force_decl_die (value);
23654
23655 nml_item_die = new_die (DW_TAG_namelist_item, nml_die, NULL);
23656 add_AT_die_ref (nml_item_die, DW_AT_namelist_items, nml_item_ref_die);
23657 }
23658 return nml_die;
23659 }
23660
23661
23662 /* Write the debugging output for DECL and return the DIE. */
23663
23664 static void
23665 dwarf2out_decl (tree decl)
23666 {
23667 dw_die_ref context_die = comp_unit_die ();
23668
23669 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
23670 {
23671 case ERROR_MARK:
23672 return;
23673
23674 case FUNCTION_DECL:
23675 /* What we would really like to do here is to filter out all mere
23676 file-scope declarations of file-scope functions which are never
23677 referenced later within this translation unit (and keep all of ones
23678 that *are* referenced later on) but we aren't clairvoyant, so we have
23679 no idea which functions will be referenced in the future (i.e. later
23680 on within the current translation unit). So here we just ignore all
23681 file-scope function declarations which are not also definitions. If
23682 and when the debugger needs to know something about these functions,
23683 it will have to hunt around and find the DWARF information associated
23684 with the definition of the function.
23685
23686 We can't just check DECL_EXTERNAL to find out which FUNCTION_DECL
23687 nodes represent definitions and which ones represent mere
23688 declarations. We have to check DECL_INITIAL instead. That's because
23689 the C front-end supports some weird semantics for "extern inline"
23690 function definitions. These can get inlined within the current
23691 translation unit (and thus, we need to generate Dwarf info for their
23692 abstract instances so that the Dwarf info for the concrete inlined
23693 instances can have something to refer to) but the compiler never
23694 generates any out-of-lines instances of such things (despite the fact
23695 that they *are* definitions).
23696
23697 The important point is that the C front-end marks these "extern
23698 inline" functions as DECL_EXTERNAL, but we need to generate DWARF for
23699 them anyway. Note that the C++ front-end also plays some similar games
23700 for inline function definitions appearing within include files which
23701 also contain `#pragma interface' pragmas.
23702
23703 If we are called from dwarf2out_abstract_function output a DIE
23704 anyway. We can end up here this way with early inlining and LTO
23705 where the inlined function is output in a different LTRANS unit
23706 or not at all. */
23707 if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE
23708 && ! DECL_ABSTRACT_P (decl))
23709 return;
23710
23711 /* If we're a nested function, initially use a parent of NULL; if we're
23712 a plain function, this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope. If
23713 we're a method, it will be ignored, since we already have a DIE. */
23714 if (decl_function_context (decl)
23715 /* But if we're in terse mode, we don't care about scope. */
23716 && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
23717 context_die = NULL;
23718 break;
23719
23720 case VAR_DECL:
23721 /* For local statics lookup proper context die. */
23722 if (local_function_static (decl))
23723 context_die = lookup_decl_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
23724
23725 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
23726 variable declarations or definitions. */
23727 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
23728 return;
23729 break;
23730
23731 case CONST_DECL:
23732 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
23733 return;
23734 if (!is_fortran () && !is_ada ())
23735 return;
23736 if (TREE_STATIC (decl) && decl_function_context (decl))
23737 context_die = lookup_decl_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
23738 break;
23739
23740 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
23741 case IMPORTED_DECL:
23742 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
23743 return;
23744 if (lookup_decl_die (decl) != NULL)
23745 return;
23746 break;
23747
23748 case TYPE_DECL:
23749 /* Don't emit stubs for types unless they are needed by other DIEs. */
23750 if (TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (decl))
23751 return;
23752
23753 /* Don't bother trying to generate any DIEs to represent any of the
23754 normal built-in types for the language we are compiling. */
23755 if (DECL_IS_BUILTIN (decl))
23756 return;
23757
23758 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs for types. */
23759 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
23760 return;
23761
23762 /* If we're a function-scope tag, initially use a parent of NULL;
23763 this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope. */
23764 if (decl_function_context (decl))
23765 context_die = NULL;
23766
23767 break;
23768
23769 case NAMELIST_DECL:
23770 break;
23771
23772 default:
23773 return;
23774 }
23775
23776 gen_decl_die (decl, NULL, NULL, context_die);
23777
23778 if (flag_checking)
23779 {
23780 dw_die_ref die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
23781 if (die)
23782 check_die (die);
23783 }
23784 }
23785
23786 /* Write the debugging output for DECL. */
23787
23788 static void
23789 dwarf2out_function_decl (tree decl)
23790 {
23791 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
23792 call_arg_locations = NULL;
23793 call_arg_loc_last = NULL;
23794 call_site_count = -1;
23795 tail_call_site_count = -1;
23796 decl_loc_table->empty ();
23797 cached_dw_loc_list_table->empty ();
23798 }
23799
23800 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of the generated code for
23801 a lexical block. */
23802
23803 static void
23804 dwarf2out_begin_block (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
23805 unsigned int blocknum)
23806 {
23807 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
23808 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, blocknum);
23809 }
23810
23811 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the end of the generated code for a
23812 lexical block. */
23813
23814 static void
23815 dwarf2out_end_block (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, unsigned int blocknum)
23816 {
23817 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
23818 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_END_LABEL, blocknum);
23819 }
23820
23821 /* Returns nonzero if it is appropriate not to emit any debugging
23822 information for BLOCK, because it doesn't contain any instructions.
23823
23824 Don't allow this for blocks with nested functions or local classes
23825 as we would end up with orphans, and in the presence of scheduling
23826 we may end up calling them anyway. */
23827
23828 static bool
23829 dwarf2out_ignore_block (const_tree block)
23830 {
23831 tree decl;
23832 unsigned int i;
23833
23834 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (block); decl; decl = DECL_CHAIN (decl))
23835 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
23836 || (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl)))
23837 return 0;
23838 for (i = 0; i < BLOCK_NUM_NONLOCALIZED_VARS (block); i++)
23839 {
23840 decl = BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VAR (block, i);
23841 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
23842 || (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl)))
23843 return 0;
23844 }
23845
23846 return 1;
23847 }
23848
23849 /* Hash table routines for file_hash. */
23850
23851 bool
23852 dwarf_file_hasher::equal (dwarf_file_data *p1, const char *p2)
23853 {
23854 return filename_cmp (p1->filename, p2) == 0;
23855 }
23856
23857 hashval_t
23858 dwarf_file_hasher::hash (dwarf_file_data *p)
23859 {
23860 return htab_hash_string (p->filename);
23861 }
23862
23863 /* Lookup FILE_NAME (in the list of filenames that we know about here in
23864 dwarf2out.c) and return its "index". The index of each (known) filename is
23865 just a unique number which is associated with only that one filename. We
23866 need such numbers for the sake of generating labels (in the .debug_sfnames
23867 section) and references to those files numbers (in the .debug_srcinfo
23868 and .debug_macinfo sections). If the filename given as an argument is not
23869 found in our current list, add it to the list and assign it the next
23870 available unique index number. */
23871
23872 static struct dwarf_file_data *
23873 lookup_filename (const char *file_name)
23874 {
23875 struct dwarf_file_data * created;
23876
23877 if (!file_name)
23878 return NULL;
23879
23880 dwarf_file_data **slot
23881 = file_table->find_slot_with_hash (file_name, htab_hash_string (file_name),
23882 INSERT);
23883 if (*slot)
23884 return *slot;
23885
23886 created = ggc_alloc<dwarf_file_data> ();
23887 created->filename = file_name;
23888 created->emitted_number = 0;
23889 *slot = created;
23890 return created;
23891 }
23892
23893 /* If the assembler will construct the file table, then translate the compiler
23894 internal file table number into the assembler file table number, and emit
23895 a .file directive if we haven't already emitted one yet. The file table
23896 numbers are different because we prune debug info for unused variables and
23897 types, which may include filenames. */
23898
23899 static int
23900 maybe_emit_file (struct dwarf_file_data * fd)
23901 {
23902 if (! fd->emitted_number)
23903 {
23904 if (last_emitted_file)
23905 fd->emitted_number = last_emitted_file->emitted_number + 1;
23906 else
23907 fd->emitted_number = 1;
23908 last_emitted_file = fd;
23909
23910 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
23911 {
23912 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.file %u ", fd->emitted_number);
23913 output_quoted_string (asm_out_file,
23914 remap_debug_filename (fd->filename));
23915 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
23916 }
23917 }
23918
23919 return fd->emitted_number;
23920 }
23921
23922 /* Schedule generation of a DW_AT_const_value attribute to DIE.
23923 That generation should happen after function debug info has been
23924 generated. The value of the attribute is the constant value of ARG. */
23925
23926 static void
23927 append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table (dw_die_ref die, tree arg)
23928 {
23929 die_arg_entry entry;
23930
23931 if (!die || !arg)
23932 return;
23933
23934 gcc_assert (early_dwarf);
23935
23936 if (!tmpl_value_parm_die_table)
23937 vec_alloc (tmpl_value_parm_die_table, 32);
23938
23939 entry.die = die;
23940 entry.arg = arg;
23941 vec_safe_push (tmpl_value_parm_die_table, entry);
23942 }
23943
23944 /* Return TRUE if T is an instance of generic type, FALSE
23945 otherwise. */
23946
23947 static bool
23948 generic_type_p (tree t)
23949 {
23950 if (t == NULL_TREE || !TYPE_P (t))
23951 return false;
23952 return lang_hooks.get_innermost_generic_parms (t) != NULL_TREE;
23953 }
23954
23955 /* Schedule the generation of the generic parameter dies for the
23956 instance of generic type T. The proper generation itself is later
23957 done by gen_scheduled_generic_parms_dies. */
23958
23959 static void
23960 schedule_generic_params_dies_gen (tree t)
23961 {
23962 if (!generic_type_p (t))
23963 return;
23964
23965 gcc_assert (early_dwarf);
23966
23967 if (!generic_type_instances)
23968 vec_alloc (generic_type_instances, 256);
23969
23970 vec_safe_push (generic_type_instances, t);
23971 }
23972
23973 /* Add a DW_AT_const_value attribute to DIEs that were scheduled
23974 by append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table. This function must
23975 be called after function DIEs have been generated. */
23976
23977 static void
23978 gen_remaining_tmpl_value_param_die_attribute (void)
23979 {
23980 if (tmpl_value_parm_die_table)
23981 {
23982 unsigned i, j;
23983 die_arg_entry *e;
23984
23985 /* We do this in two phases - first get the cases we can
23986 handle during early-finish, preserving those we cannot
23987 (containing symbolic constants where we don't yet know
23988 whether we are going to output the referenced symbols).
23989 For those we try again at late-finish. */
23990 j = 0;
23991 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*tmpl_value_parm_die_table, i, e)
23992 {
23993 if (!tree_add_const_value_attribute (e->die, e->arg))
23994 (*tmpl_value_parm_die_table)[j++] = *e;
23995 }
23996 tmpl_value_parm_die_table->truncate (j);
23997 }
23998 }
23999
24000 /* Generate generic parameters DIEs for instances of generic types
24001 that have been previously scheduled by
24002 schedule_generic_params_dies_gen. This function must be called
24003 after all the types of the CU have been laid out. */
24004
24005 static void
24006 gen_scheduled_generic_parms_dies (void)
24007 {
24008 unsigned i;
24009 tree t;
24010
24011 if (!generic_type_instances)
24012 return;
24013
24014 /* We end up "recursing" into schedule_generic_params_dies_gen, so
24015 pretend this generation is part of "early dwarf" as well. */
24016 set_early_dwarf s;
24017
24018 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*generic_type_instances, i, t)
24019 if (COMPLETE_TYPE_P (t))
24020 gen_generic_params_dies (t);
24021
24022 generic_type_instances = NULL;
24023 }
24024
24025
24026 /* Replace DW_AT_name for the decl with name. */
24027
24028 static void
24029 dwarf2out_set_name (tree decl, tree name)
24030 {
24031 dw_die_ref die;
24032 dw_attr_node *attr;
24033 const char *dname;
24034
24035 die = TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (decl);
24036 if (!die)
24037 return;
24038
24039 dname = dwarf2_name (name, 0);
24040 if (!dname)
24041 return;
24042
24043 attr = get_AT (die, DW_AT_name);
24044 if (attr)
24045 {
24046 struct indirect_string_node *node;
24047
24048 node = find_AT_string (dname);
24049 /* replace the string. */
24050 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
24051 }
24052
24053 else
24054 add_name_attribute (die, dname);
24055 }
24056
24057 /* True if before or during processing of the first function being emitted. */
24058 static bool in_first_function_p = true;
24059 /* True if loc_note during dwarf2out_var_location call might still be
24060 before first real instruction at address equal to .Ltext0. */
24061 static bool maybe_at_text_label_p = true;
24062 /* One above highest N where .LVLN label might be equal to .Ltext0 label. */
24063 static unsigned int first_loclabel_num_not_at_text_label;
24064
24065 /* Called by the final INSN scan whenever we see a var location. We
24066 use it to drop labels in the right places, and throw the location in
24067 our lookup table. */
24068
24069 static void
24070 dwarf2out_var_location (rtx_insn *loc_note)
24071 {
24072 char loclabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES + 2];
24073 struct var_loc_node *newloc;
24074 rtx_insn *next_real, *next_note;
24075 rtx_insn *call_insn = NULL;
24076 static const char *last_label;
24077 static const char *last_postcall_label;
24078 static bool last_in_cold_section_p;
24079 static rtx_insn *expected_next_loc_note;
24080 tree decl;
24081 bool var_loc_p;
24082
24083 if (!NOTE_P (loc_note))
24084 {
24085 if (CALL_P (loc_note))
24086 {
24087 call_site_count++;
24088 if (SIBLING_CALL_P (loc_note))
24089 tail_call_site_count++;
24090 if (optimize == 0 && !flag_var_tracking)
24091 {
24092 /* When the var-tracking pass is not running, there is no note
24093 for indirect calls whose target is compile-time known. In this
24094 case, process such calls specifically so that we generate call
24095 sites for them anyway. */
24096 rtx x = PATTERN (loc_note);
24097 if (GET_CODE (x) == PARALLEL)
24098 x = XVECEXP (x, 0, 0);
24099 if (GET_CODE (x) == SET)
24100 x = SET_SRC (x);
24101 if (GET_CODE (x) == CALL)
24102 x = XEXP (x, 0);
24103 if (!MEM_P (x)
24104 || GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) != SYMBOL_REF
24105 || !SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (x, 0))
24106 || (TREE_CODE (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (x, 0)))
24107 != FUNCTION_DECL))
24108 {
24109 call_insn = loc_note;
24110 loc_note = NULL;
24111 var_loc_p = false;
24112
24113 next_real = next_real_insn (call_insn);
24114 next_note = NULL;
24115 cached_next_real_insn = NULL;
24116 goto create_label;
24117 }
24118 }
24119 }
24120 return;
24121 }
24122
24123 var_loc_p = NOTE_KIND (loc_note) == NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION;
24124 if (var_loc_p && !DECL_P (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc_note)))
24125 return;
24126
24127 /* Optimize processing a large consecutive sequence of location
24128 notes so we don't spend too much time in next_real_insn. If the
24129 next insn is another location note, remember the next_real_insn
24130 calculation for next time. */
24131 next_real = cached_next_real_insn;
24132 if (next_real)
24133 {
24134 if (expected_next_loc_note != loc_note)
24135 next_real = NULL;
24136 }
24137
24138 next_note = NEXT_INSN (loc_note);
24139 if (! next_note
24140 || next_note->deleted ()
24141 || ! NOTE_P (next_note)
24142 || (NOTE_KIND (next_note) != NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION
24143 && NOTE_KIND (next_note) != NOTE_INSN_CALL_ARG_LOCATION))
24144 next_note = NULL;
24145
24146 if (! next_real)
24147 next_real = next_real_insn (loc_note);
24148
24149 if (next_note)
24150 {
24151 expected_next_loc_note = next_note;
24152 cached_next_real_insn = next_real;
24153 }
24154 else
24155 cached_next_real_insn = NULL;
24156
24157 /* If there are no instructions which would be affected by this note,
24158 don't do anything. */
24159 if (var_loc_p
24160 && next_real == NULL_RTX
24161 && !NOTE_DURING_CALL_P (loc_note))
24162 return;
24163
24164 create_label:
24165
24166 if (next_real == NULL_RTX)
24167 next_real = get_last_insn ();
24168
24169 /* If there were any real insns between note we processed last time
24170 and this note (or if it is the first note), clear
24171 last_{,postcall_}label so that they are not reused this time. */
24172 if (last_var_location_insn == NULL_RTX
24173 || last_var_location_insn != next_real
24174 || last_in_cold_section_p != in_cold_section_p)
24175 {
24176 last_label = NULL;
24177 last_postcall_label = NULL;
24178 }
24179
24180 if (var_loc_p)
24181 {
24182 decl = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc_note);
24183 newloc = add_var_loc_to_decl (decl, loc_note,
24184 NOTE_DURING_CALL_P (loc_note)
24185 ? last_postcall_label : last_label);
24186 if (newloc == NULL)
24187 return;
24188 }
24189 else
24190 {
24191 decl = NULL_TREE;
24192 newloc = NULL;
24193 }
24194
24195 /* If there were no real insns between note we processed last time
24196 and this note, use the label we emitted last time. Otherwise
24197 create a new label and emit it. */
24198 if (last_label == NULL)
24199 {
24200 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loclabel, "LVL", loclabel_num);
24201 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, "LVL", loclabel_num);
24202 loclabel_num++;
24203 last_label = ggc_strdup (loclabel);
24204 /* See if loclabel might be equal to .Ltext0. If yes,
24205 bump first_loclabel_num_not_at_text_label. */
24206 if (!have_multiple_function_sections
24207 && in_first_function_p
24208 && maybe_at_text_label_p)
24209 {
24210 static rtx_insn *last_start;
24211 rtx_insn *insn;
24212 for (insn = loc_note; insn; insn = previous_insn (insn))
24213 if (insn == last_start)
24214 break;
24215 else if (!NONDEBUG_INSN_P (insn))
24216 continue;
24217 else
24218 {
24219 rtx body = PATTERN (insn);
24220 if (GET_CODE (body) == USE || GET_CODE (body) == CLOBBER)
24221 continue;
24222 /* Inline asm could occupy zero bytes. */
24223 else if (GET_CODE (body) == ASM_INPUT
24224 || asm_noperands (body) >= 0)
24225 continue;
24226 #ifdef HAVE_attr_length
24227 else if (get_attr_min_length (insn) == 0)
24228 continue;
24229 #endif
24230 else
24231 {
24232 /* Assume insn has non-zero length. */
24233 maybe_at_text_label_p = false;
24234 break;
24235 }
24236 }
24237 if (maybe_at_text_label_p)
24238 {
24239 last_start = loc_note;
24240 first_loclabel_num_not_at_text_label = loclabel_num;
24241 }
24242 }
24243 }
24244
24245 gcc_assert ((loc_note == NULL_RTX && call_insn != NULL_RTX)
24246 || (loc_note != NULL_RTX && call_insn == NULL_RTX));
24247
24248 if (!var_loc_p)
24249 {
24250 struct call_arg_loc_node *ca_loc
24251 = ggc_cleared_alloc<call_arg_loc_node> ();
24252 rtx_insn *prev
24253 = loc_note != NULL_RTX ? prev_real_insn (loc_note) : call_insn;
24254
24255 ca_loc->call_arg_loc_note = loc_note;
24256 ca_loc->next = NULL;
24257 ca_loc->label = last_label;
24258 gcc_assert (prev
24259 && (CALL_P (prev)
24260 || (NONJUMP_INSN_P (prev)
24261 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (prev)) == SEQUENCE
24262 && CALL_P (XVECEXP (PATTERN (prev), 0, 0)))));
24263 if (!CALL_P (prev))
24264 prev = as_a <rtx_sequence *> (PATTERN (prev))->insn (0);
24265 ca_loc->tail_call_p = SIBLING_CALL_P (prev);
24266
24267 /* Look for a SYMBOL_REF in the "prev" instruction. */
24268 rtx x = get_call_rtx_from (PATTERN (prev));
24269 if (x)
24270 {
24271 /* Try to get the call symbol, if any. */
24272 if (MEM_P (XEXP (x, 0)))
24273 x = XEXP (x, 0);
24274 /* First, look for a memory access to a symbol_ref. */
24275 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == SYMBOL_REF
24276 && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (x, 0))
24277 && TREE_CODE (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (x, 0))) == FUNCTION_DECL)
24278 ca_loc->symbol_ref = XEXP (x, 0);
24279 /* Otherwise, look at a compile-time known user-level function
24280 declaration. */
24281 else if (MEM_P (x)
24282 && MEM_EXPR (x)
24283 && TREE_CODE (MEM_EXPR (x)) == FUNCTION_DECL)
24284 ca_loc->symbol_ref = XEXP (DECL_RTL (MEM_EXPR (x)), 0);
24285 }
24286
24287 ca_loc->block = insn_scope (prev);
24288 if (call_arg_locations)
24289 call_arg_loc_last->next = ca_loc;
24290 else
24291 call_arg_locations = ca_loc;
24292 call_arg_loc_last = ca_loc;
24293 }
24294 else if (loc_note != NULL_RTX && !NOTE_DURING_CALL_P (loc_note))
24295 newloc->label = last_label;
24296 else
24297 {
24298 if (!last_postcall_label)
24299 {
24300 sprintf (loclabel, "%s-1", last_label);
24301 last_postcall_label = ggc_strdup (loclabel);
24302 }
24303 newloc->label = last_postcall_label;
24304 }
24305
24306 last_var_location_insn = next_real;
24307 last_in_cold_section_p = in_cold_section_p;
24308 }
24309
24310 /* Called from finalize_size_functions for size functions so that their body
24311 can be encoded in the debug info to describe the layout of variable-length
24312 structures. */
24313
24314 static void
24315 dwarf2out_size_function (tree decl)
24316 {
24317 function_to_dwarf_procedure (decl);
24318 }
24319
24320 /* Note in one location list that text section has changed. */
24321
24322 int
24323 var_location_switch_text_section_1 (var_loc_list **slot, void *)
24324 {
24325 var_loc_list *list = *slot;
24326 if (list->first)
24327 list->last_before_switch
24328 = list->last->next ? list->last->next : list->last;
24329 return 1;
24330 }
24331
24332 /* Note in all location lists that text section has changed. */
24333
24334 static void
24335 var_location_switch_text_section (void)
24336 {
24337 if (decl_loc_table == NULL)
24338 return;
24339
24340 decl_loc_table->traverse<void *, var_location_switch_text_section_1> (NULL);
24341 }
24342
24343 /* Create a new line number table. */
24344
24345 static dw_line_info_table *
24346 new_line_info_table (void)
24347 {
24348 dw_line_info_table *table;
24349
24350 table = ggc_cleared_alloc<dw_line_info_table> ();
24351 table->file_num = 1;
24352 table->line_num = 1;
24353 table->is_stmt = DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START;
24354
24355 return table;
24356 }
24357
24358 /* Lookup the "current" table into which we emit line info, so
24359 that we don't have to do it for every source line. */
24360
24361 static void
24362 set_cur_line_info_table (section *sec)
24363 {
24364 dw_line_info_table *table;
24365
24366 if (sec == text_section)
24367 table = text_section_line_info;
24368 else if (sec == cold_text_section)
24369 {
24370 table = cold_text_section_line_info;
24371 if (!table)
24372 {
24373 cold_text_section_line_info = table = new_line_info_table ();
24374 table->end_label = cold_end_label;
24375 }
24376 }
24377 else
24378 {
24379 const char *end_label;
24380
24381 if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
24382 {
24383 if (in_cold_section_p)
24384 end_label = crtl->subsections.cold_section_end_label;
24385 else
24386 end_label = crtl->subsections.hot_section_end_label;
24387 }
24388 else
24389 {
24390 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
24391 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_END_LABEL,
24392 current_function_funcdef_no);
24393 end_label = ggc_strdup (label);
24394 }
24395
24396 table = new_line_info_table ();
24397 table->end_label = end_label;
24398
24399 vec_safe_push (separate_line_info, table);
24400 }
24401
24402 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
24403 table->is_stmt = (cur_line_info_table
24404 ? cur_line_info_table->is_stmt
24405 : DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START);
24406 cur_line_info_table = table;
24407 }
24408
24409
24410 /* We need to reset the locations at the beginning of each
24411 function. We can't do this in the end_function hook, because the
24412 declarations that use the locations won't have been output when
24413 that hook is called. Also compute have_multiple_function_sections here. */
24414
24415 static void
24416 dwarf2out_begin_function (tree fun)
24417 {
24418 section *sec = function_section (fun);
24419
24420 if (sec != text_section)
24421 have_multiple_function_sections = true;
24422
24423 if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition && !cold_text_section)
24424 {
24425 gcc_assert (current_function_decl == fun);
24426 cold_text_section = unlikely_text_section ();
24427 switch_to_section (cold_text_section);
24428 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, cold_text_section_label);
24429 switch_to_section (sec);
24430 }
24431
24432 dwarf2out_note_section_used ();
24433 call_site_count = 0;
24434 tail_call_site_count = 0;
24435
24436 set_cur_line_info_table (sec);
24437 }
24438
24439 /* Helper function of dwarf2out_end_function, called only after emitting
24440 the very first function into assembly. Check if some .debug_loc range
24441 might end with a .LVL* label that could be equal to .Ltext0.
24442 In that case we must force using absolute addresses in .debug_loc ranges,
24443 because this range could be .LVLN-.Ltext0 .. .LVLM-.Ltext0 for
24444 .LVLN == .LVLM == .Ltext0, thus 0 .. 0, which is a .debug_loc
24445 list terminator.
24446 Set have_multiple_function_sections to true in that case and
24447 terminate htab traversal. */
24448
24449 int
24450 find_empty_loc_ranges_at_text_label (var_loc_list **slot, int)
24451 {
24452 var_loc_list *entry = *slot;
24453 struct var_loc_node *node;
24454
24455 node = entry->first;
24456 if (node && node->next && node->next->label)
24457 {
24458 unsigned int i;
24459 const char *label = node->next->label;
24460 char loclabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
24461
24462 for (i = 0; i < first_loclabel_num_not_at_text_label; i++)
24463 {
24464 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loclabel, "LVL", i);
24465 if (strcmp (label, loclabel) == 0)
24466 {
24467 have_multiple_function_sections = true;
24468 return 0;
24469 }
24470 }
24471 }
24472 return 1;
24473 }
24474
24475 /* Hook called after emitting a function into assembly.
24476 This does something only for the very first function emitted. */
24477
24478 static void
24479 dwarf2out_end_function (unsigned int)
24480 {
24481 if (in_first_function_p
24482 && !have_multiple_function_sections
24483 && first_loclabel_num_not_at_text_label
24484 && decl_loc_table)
24485 decl_loc_table->traverse<int, find_empty_loc_ranges_at_text_label> (0);
24486 in_first_function_p = false;
24487 maybe_at_text_label_p = false;
24488 }
24489
24490 /* Temporary holder for dwarf2out_register_main_translation_unit. Used to let
24491 front-ends register a translation unit even before dwarf2out_init is
24492 called. */
24493 static tree main_translation_unit = NULL_TREE;
24494
24495 /* Hook called by front-ends after they built their main translation unit.
24496 Associate comp_unit_die to UNIT. */
24497
24498 static void
24499 dwarf2out_register_main_translation_unit (tree unit)
24500 {
24501 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (unit) == TRANSLATION_UNIT_DECL
24502 && main_translation_unit == NULL_TREE);
24503 main_translation_unit = unit;
24504 /* If dwarf2out_init has not been called yet, it will perform the association
24505 itself looking at main_translation_unit. */
24506 if (decl_die_table != NULL)
24507 equate_decl_number_to_die (unit, comp_unit_die ());
24508 }
24509
24510 /* Add OPCODE+VAL as an entry at the end of the opcode array in TABLE. */
24511
24512 static void
24513 push_dw_line_info_entry (dw_line_info_table *table,
24514 enum dw_line_info_opcode opcode, unsigned int val)
24515 {
24516 dw_line_info_entry e;
24517 e.opcode = opcode;
24518 e.val = val;
24519 vec_safe_push (table->entries, e);
24520 }
24521
24522 /* Output a label to mark the beginning of a source code line entry
24523 and record information relating to this source line, in
24524 'line_info_table' for later output of the .debug_line section. */
24525 /* ??? The discriminator parameter ought to be unsigned. */
24526
24527 static void
24528 dwarf2out_source_line (unsigned int line, const char *filename,
24529 int discriminator, bool is_stmt)
24530 {
24531 unsigned int file_num;
24532 dw_line_info_table *table;
24533
24534 if (debug_info_level < DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE || line == 0)
24535 return;
24536
24537 /* The discriminator column was added in dwarf4. Simplify the below
24538 by simply removing it if we're not supposed to output it. */
24539 if (dwarf_version < 4 && dwarf_strict)
24540 discriminator = 0;
24541
24542 table = cur_line_info_table;
24543 file_num = maybe_emit_file (lookup_filename (filename));
24544
24545 /* ??? TODO: Elide duplicate line number entries. Traditionally,
24546 the debugger has used the second (possibly duplicate) line number
24547 at the beginning of the function to mark the end of the prologue.
24548 We could eliminate any other duplicates within the function. For
24549 Dwarf3, we ought to include the DW_LNS_set_prologue_end mark in
24550 that second line number entry. */
24551 /* Recall that this end-of-prologue indication is *not* the same thing
24552 as the end_prologue debug hook. The NOTE_INSN_PROLOGUE_END note,
24553 to which the hook corresponds, follows the last insn that was
24554 emitted by gen_prologue. What we need is to precede the first insn
24555 that had been emitted after NOTE_INSN_FUNCTION_BEG, i.e. the first
24556 insn that corresponds to something the user wrote. These may be
24557 very different locations once scheduling is enabled. */
24558
24559 if (0 && file_num == table->file_num
24560 && line == table->line_num
24561 && discriminator == table->discrim_num
24562 && is_stmt == table->is_stmt)
24563 return;
24564
24565 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
24566
24567 /* If requested, emit something human-readable. */
24568 if (flag_debug_asm)
24569 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t%s %s:%d\n", ASM_COMMENT_START, filename, line);
24570
24571 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
24572 {
24573 /* Emit the .loc directive understood by GNU as. */
24574 /* "\t.loc %u %u 0 is_stmt %u discriminator %u",
24575 file_num, line, is_stmt, discriminator */
24576 fputs ("\t.loc ", asm_out_file);
24577 fprint_ul (asm_out_file, file_num);
24578 putc (' ', asm_out_file);
24579 fprint_ul (asm_out_file, line);
24580 putc (' ', asm_out_file);
24581 putc ('0', asm_out_file);
24582
24583 if (is_stmt != table->is_stmt)
24584 {
24585 fputs (" is_stmt ", asm_out_file);
24586 putc (is_stmt ? '1' : '0', asm_out_file);
24587 }
24588 if (SUPPORTS_DISCRIMINATOR && discriminator != 0)
24589 {
24590 gcc_assert (discriminator > 0);
24591 fputs (" discriminator ", asm_out_file);
24592 fprint_ul (asm_out_file, (unsigned long) discriminator);
24593 }
24594 putc ('\n', asm_out_file);
24595 }
24596 else
24597 {
24598 unsigned int label_num = ++line_info_label_num;
24599
24600 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, LINE_CODE_LABEL, label_num);
24601
24602 push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_set_address, label_num);
24603 if (file_num != table->file_num)
24604 push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_set_file, file_num);
24605 if (discriminator != table->discrim_num)
24606 push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_set_discriminator, discriminator);
24607 if (is_stmt != table->is_stmt)
24608 push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_negate_stmt, 0);
24609 push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_set_line, line);
24610 }
24611
24612 table->file_num = file_num;
24613 table->line_num = line;
24614 table->discrim_num = discriminator;
24615 table->is_stmt = is_stmt;
24616 table->in_use = true;
24617 }
24618
24619 /* Record the beginning of a new source file. */
24620
24621 static void
24622 dwarf2out_start_source_file (unsigned int lineno, const char *filename)
24623 {
24624 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
24625 {
24626 /* Record the beginning of the file for break_out_includes. */
24627 dw_die_ref bincl_die;
24628
24629 bincl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL, comp_unit_die (), NULL);
24630 add_AT_string (bincl_die, DW_AT_name, remap_debug_filename (filename));
24631 }
24632
24633 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
24634 {
24635 macinfo_entry e;
24636 e.code = DW_MACINFO_start_file;
24637 e.lineno = lineno;
24638 e.info = ggc_strdup (filename);
24639 vec_safe_push (macinfo_table, e);
24640 }
24641 }
24642
24643 /* Record the end of a source file. */
24644
24645 static void
24646 dwarf2out_end_source_file (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
24647 {
24648 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
24649 /* Record the end of the file for break_out_includes. */
24650 new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL, comp_unit_die (), NULL);
24651
24652 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
24653 {
24654 macinfo_entry e;
24655 e.code = DW_MACINFO_end_file;
24656 e.lineno = lineno;
24657 e.info = NULL;
24658 vec_safe_push (macinfo_table, e);
24659 }
24660 }
24661
24662 /* Called from debug_define in toplev.c. The `buffer' parameter contains
24663 the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
24664 initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part. */
24665
24666 static void
24667 dwarf2out_define (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
24668 const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
24669 {
24670 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
24671 {
24672 macinfo_entry e;
24673 /* Insert a dummy first entry to be able to optimize the whole
24674 predefined macro block using DW_MACRO_GNU_transparent_include. */
24675 if (macinfo_table->is_empty () && lineno <= 1)
24676 {
24677 e.code = 0;
24678 e.lineno = 0;
24679 e.info = NULL;
24680 vec_safe_push (macinfo_table, e);
24681 }
24682 e.code = DW_MACINFO_define;
24683 e.lineno = lineno;
24684 e.info = ggc_strdup (buffer);
24685 vec_safe_push (macinfo_table, e);
24686 }
24687 }
24688
24689 /* Called from debug_undef in toplev.c. The `buffer' parameter contains
24690 the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
24691 initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part. */
24692
24693 static void
24694 dwarf2out_undef (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
24695 const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
24696 {
24697 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
24698 {
24699 macinfo_entry e;
24700 /* Insert a dummy first entry to be able to optimize the whole
24701 predefined macro block using DW_MACRO_GNU_transparent_include. */
24702 if (macinfo_table->is_empty () && lineno <= 1)
24703 {
24704 e.code = 0;
24705 e.lineno = 0;
24706 e.info = NULL;
24707 vec_safe_push (macinfo_table, e);
24708 }
24709 e.code = DW_MACINFO_undef;
24710 e.lineno = lineno;
24711 e.info = ggc_strdup (buffer);
24712 vec_safe_push (macinfo_table, e);
24713 }
24714 }
24715
24716 /* Helpers to manipulate hash table of CUs. */
24717
24718 struct macinfo_entry_hasher : nofree_ptr_hash <macinfo_entry>
24719 {
24720 static inline hashval_t hash (const macinfo_entry *);
24721 static inline bool equal (const macinfo_entry *, const macinfo_entry *);
24722 };
24723
24724 inline hashval_t
24725 macinfo_entry_hasher::hash (const macinfo_entry *entry)
24726 {
24727 return htab_hash_string (entry->info);
24728 }
24729
24730 inline bool
24731 macinfo_entry_hasher::equal (const macinfo_entry *entry1,
24732 const macinfo_entry *entry2)
24733 {
24734 return !strcmp (entry1->info, entry2->info);
24735 }
24736
24737 typedef hash_table<macinfo_entry_hasher> macinfo_hash_type;
24738
24739 /* Output a single .debug_macinfo entry. */
24740
24741 static void
24742 output_macinfo_op (macinfo_entry *ref)
24743 {
24744 int file_num;
24745 size_t len;
24746 struct indirect_string_node *node;
24747 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
24748 struct dwarf_file_data *fd;
24749
24750 switch (ref->code)
24751 {
24752 case DW_MACINFO_start_file:
24753 fd = lookup_filename (ref->info);
24754 file_num = maybe_emit_file (fd);
24755 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_start_file, "Start new file");
24756 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ref->lineno,
24757 "Included from line number %lu",
24758 (unsigned long) ref->lineno);
24759 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (file_num, "file %s", ref->info);
24760 break;
24761 case DW_MACINFO_end_file:
24762 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_end_file, "End file");
24763 break;
24764 case DW_MACINFO_define:
24765 case DW_MACINFO_undef:
24766 len = strlen (ref->info) + 1;
24767 if (!dwarf_strict
24768 && len > DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
24769 && !DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET
24770 && (debug_str_section->common.flags & SECTION_MERGE) != 0)
24771 {
24772 ref->code = ref->code == DW_MACINFO_define
24773 ? DW_MACRO_GNU_define_indirect
24774 : DW_MACRO_GNU_undef_indirect;
24775 output_macinfo_op (ref);
24776 return;
24777 }
24778 dw2_asm_output_data (1, ref->code,
24779 ref->code == DW_MACINFO_define
24780 ? "Define macro" : "Undefine macro");
24781 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ref->lineno, "At line number %lu",
24782 (unsigned long) ref->lineno);
24783 dw2_asm_output_nstring (ref->info, -1, "The macro");
24784 break;
24785 case DW_MACRO_GNU_define_indirect:
24786 case DW_MACRO_GNU_undef_indirect:
24787 node = find_AT_string (ref->info);
24788 gcc_assert (node
24789 && ((node->form == DW_FORM_strp)
24790 || (node->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index)));
24791 dw2_asm_output_data (1, ref->code,
24792 ref->code == DW_MACRO_GNU_define_indirect
24793 ? "Define macro indirect"
24794 : "Undefine macro indirect");
24795 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ref->lineno, "At line number %lu",
24796 (unsigned long) ref->lineno);
24797 if (node->form == DW_FORM_strp)
24798 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, node->label,
24799 debug_str_section, "The macro: \"%s\"",
24800 ref->info);
24801 else
24802 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (node->index, "The macro: \"%s\"",
24803 ref->info);
24804 break;
24805 case DW_MACRO_GNU_transparent_include:
24806 dw2_asm_output_data (1, ref->code, "Transparent include");
24807 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label,
24808 DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION_LABEL, ref->lineno);
24809 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, label, NULL, NULL);
24810 break;
24811 default:
24812 fprintf (asm_out_file, "%s unrecognized macinfo code %lu\n",
24813 ASM_COMMENT_START, (unsigned long) ref->code);
24814 break;
24815 }
24816 }
24817
24818 /* Attempt to make a sequence of define/undef macinfo ops shareable with
24819 other compilation unit .debug_macinfo sections. IDX is the first
24820 index of a define/undef, return the number of ops that should be
24821 emitted in a comdat .debug_macinfo section and emit
24822 a DW_MACRO_GNU_transparent_include entry referencing it.
24823 If the define/undef entry should be emitted normally, return 0. */
24824
24825 static unsigned
24826 optimize_macinfo_range (unsigned int idx, vec<macinfo_entry, va_gc> *files,
24827 macinfo_hash_type **macinfo_htab)
24828 {
24829 macinfo_entry *first, *second, *cur, *inc;
24830 char linebuf[sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT) * 3 + 1];
24831 unsigned char checksum[16];
24832 struct md5_ctx ctx;
24833 char *grp_name, *tail;
24834 const char *base;
24835 unsigned int i, count, encoded_filename_len, linebuf_len;
24836 macinfo_entry **slot;
24837
24838 first = &(*macinfo_table)[idx];
24839 second = &(*macinfo_table)[idx + 1];
24840
24841 /* Optimize only if there are at least two consecutive define/undef ops,
24842 and either all of them are before first DW_MACINFO_start_file
24843 with lineno {0,1} (i.e. predefined macro block), or all of them are
24844 in some included header file. */
24845 if (second->code != DW_MACINFO_define && second->code != DW_MACINFO_undef)
24846 return 0;
24847 if (vec_safe_is_empty (files))
24848 {
24849 if (first->lineno > 1 || second->lineno > 1)
24850 return 0;
24851 }
24852 else if (first->lineno == 0)
24853 return 0;
24854
24855 /* Find the last define/undef entry that can be grouped together
24856 with first and at the same time compute md5 checksum of their
24857 codes, linenumbers and strings. */
24858 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
24859 for (i = idx; macinfo_table->iterate (i, &cur); i++)
24860 if (cur->code != DW_MACINFO_define && cur->code != DW_MACINFO_undef)
24861 break;
24862 else if (vec_safe_is_empty (files) && cur->lineno > 1)
24863 break;
24864 else
24865 {
24866 unsigned char code = cur->code;
24867 md5_process_bytes (&code, 1, &ctx);
24868 checksum_uleb128 (cur->lineno, &ctx);
24869 md5_process_bytes (cur->info, strlen (cur->info) + 1, &ctx);
24870 }
24871 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
24872 count = i - idx;
24873
24874 /* From the containing include filename (if any) pick up just
24875 usable characters from its basename. */
24876 if (vec_safe_is_empty (files))
24877 base = "";
24878 else
24879 base = lbasename (files->last ().info);
24880 for (encoded_filename_len = 0, i = 0; base[i]; i++)
24881 if (ISIDNUM (base[i]) || base[i] == '.')
24882 encoded_filename_len++;
24883 /* Count . at the end. */
24884 if (encoded_filename_len)
24885 encoded_filename_len++;
24886
24887 sprintf (linebuf, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED, first->lineno);
24888 linebuf_len = strlen (linebuf);
24889
24890 /* The group name format is: wmN.[<encoded filename>.]<lineno>.<md5sum> */
24891 grp_name = XALLOCAVEC (char, 4 + encoded_filename_len + linebuf_len + 1
24892 + 16 * 2 + 1);
24893 memcpy (grp_name, DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? "wm4." : "wm8.", 4);
24894 tail = grp_name + 4;
24895 if (encoded_filename_len)
24896 {
24897 for (i = 0; base[i]; i++)
24898 if (ISIDNUM (base[i]) || base[i] == '.')
24899 *tail++ = base[i];
24900 *tail++ = '.';
24901 }
24902 memcpy (tail, linebuf, linebuf_len);
24903 tail += linebuf_len;
24904 *tail++ = '.';
24905 for (i = 0; i < 16; i++)
24906 sprintf (tail + i * 2, "%02x", checksum[i] & 0xff);
24907
24908 /* Construct a macinfo_entry for DW_MACRO_GNU_transparent_include
24909 in the empty vector entry before the first define/undef. */
24910 inc = &(*macinfo_table)[idx - 1];
24911 inc->code = DW_MACRO_GNU_transparent_include;
24912 inc->lineno = 0;
24913 inc->info = ggc_strdup (grp_name);
24914 if (!*macinfo_htab)
24915 *macinfo_htab = new macinfo_hash_type (10);
24916 /* Avoid emitting duplicates. */
24917 slot = (*macinfo_htab)->find_slot (inc, INSERT);
24918 if (*slot != NULL)
24919 {
24920 inc->code = 0;
24921 inc->info = NULL;
24922 /* If such an entry has been used before, just emit
24923 a DW_MACRO_GNU_transparent_include op. */
24924 inc = *slot;
24925 output_macinfo_op (inc);
24926 /* And clear all macinfo_entry in the range to avoid emitting them
24927 in the second pass. */
24928 for (i = idx; macinfo_table->iterate (i, &cur) && i < idx + count; i++)
24929 {
24930 cur->code = 0;
24931 cur->info = NULL;
24932 }
24933 }
24934 else
24935 {
24936 *slot = inc;
24937 inc->lineno = (*macinfo_htab)->elements ();
24938 output_macinfo_op (inc);
24939 }
24940 return count;
24941 }
24942
24943 /* Save any strings needed by the macinfo table in the debug str
24944 table. All strings must be collected into the table by the time
24945 index_string is called. */
24946
24947 static void
24948 save_macinfo_strings (void)
24949 {
24950 unsigned len;
24951 unsigned i;
24952 macinfo_entry *ref;
24953
24954 for (i = 0; macinfo_table && macinfo_table->iterate (i, &ref); i++)
24955 {
24956 switch (ref->code)
24957 {
24958 /* Match the logic in output_macinfo_op to decide on
24959 indirect strings. */
24960 case DW_MACINFO_define:
24961 case DW_MACINFO_undef:
24962 len = strlen (ref->info) + 1;
24963 if (!dwarf_strict
24964 && len > DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
24965 && !DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET
24966 && (debug_str_section->common.flags & SECTION_MERGE) != 0)
24967 set_indirect_string (find_AT_string (ref->info));
24968 break;
24969 case DW_MACRO_GNU_define_indirect:
24970 case DW_MACRO_GNU_undef_indirect:
24971 set_indirect_string (find_AT_string (ref->info));
24972 break;
24973 default:
24974 break;
24975 }
24976 }
24977 }
24978
24979 /* Output macinfo section(s). */
24980
24981 static void
24982 output_macinfo (void)
24983 {
24984 unsigned i;
24985 unsigned long length = vec_safe_length (macinfo_table);
24986 macinfo_entry *ref;
24987 vec<macinfo_entry, va_gc> *files = NULL;
24988 macinfo_hash_type *macinfo_htab = NULL;
24989
24990 if (! length)
24991 return;
24992
24993 /* output_macinfo* uses these interchangeably. */
24994 gcc_assert ((int) DW_MACINFO_define == (int) DW_MACRO_GNU_define
24995 && (int) DW_MACINFO_undef == (int) DW_MACRO_GNU_undef
24996 && (int) DW_MACINFO_start_file == (int) DW_MACRO_GNU_start_file
24997 && (int) DW_MACINFO_end_file == (int) DW_MACRO_GNU_end_file);
24998
24999 /* For .debug_macro emit the section header. */
25000 if (!dwarf_strict)
25001 {
25002 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 4, "DWARF macro version number");
25003 if (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8)
25004 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 3, "Flags: 64-bit, lineptr present");
25005 else
25006 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 2, "Flags: 32-bit, lineptr present");
25007 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
25008 (!dwarf_split_debug_info ? debug_line_section_label
25009 : debug_skeleton_line_section_label),
25010 debug_line_section, NULL);
25011 }
25012
25013 /* In the first loop, it emits the primary .debug_macinfo section
25014 and after each emitted op the macinfo_entry is cleared.
25015 If a longer range of define/undef ops can be optimized using
25016 DW_MACRO_GNU_transparent_include, the
25017 DW_MACRO_GNU_transparent_include op is emitted and kept in
25018 the vector before the first define/undef in the range and the
25019 whole range of define/undef ops is not emitted and kept. */
25020 for (i = 0; macinfo_table->iterate (i, &ref); i++)
25021 {
25022 switch (ref->code)
25023 {
25024 case DW_MACINFO_start_file:
25025 vec_safe_push (files, *ref);
25026 break;
25027 case DW_MACINFO_end_file:
25028 if (!vec_safe_is_empty (files))
25029 files->pop ();
25030 break;
25031 case DW_MACINFO_define:
25032 case DW_MACINFO_undef:
25033 if (!dwarf_strict
25034 && HAVE_COMDAT_GROUP
25035 && vec_safe_length (files) != 1
25036 && i > 0
25037 && i + 1 < length
25038 && (*macinfo_table)[i - 1].code == 0)
25039 {
25040 unsigned count = optimize_macinfo_range (i, files, &macinfo_htab);
25041 if (count)
25042 {
25043 i += count - 1;
25044 continue;
25045 }
25046 }
25047 break;
25048 case 0:
25049 /* A dummy entry may be inserted at the beginning to be able
25050 to optimize the whole block of predefined macros. */
25051 if (i == 0)
25052 continue;
25053 default:
25054 break;
25055 }
25056 output_macinfo_op (ref);
25057 ref->info = NULL;
25058 ref->code = 0;
25059 }
25060
25061 if (!macinfo_htab)
25062 return;
25063
25064 delete macinfo_htab;
25065 macinfo_htab = NULL;
25066
25067 /* If any DW_MACRO_GNU_transparent_include were used, on those
25068 DW_MACRO_GNU_transparent_include entries terminate the
25069 current chain and switch to a new comdat .debug_macinfo
25070 section and emit the define/undef entries within it. */
25071 for (i = 0; macinfo_table->iterate (i, &ref); i++)
25072 switch (ref->code)
25073 {
25074 case 0:
25075 continue;
25076 case DW_MACRO_GNU_transparent_include:
25077 {
25078 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
25079 tree comdat_key = get_identifier (ref->info);
25080 /* Terminate the previous .debug_macinfo section. */
25081 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End compilation unit");
25082 targetm.asm_out.named_section (DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION,
25083 SECTION_DEBUG
25084 | SECTION_LINKONCE,
25085 comdat_key);
25086 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label,
25087 DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION_LABEL,
25088 ref->lineno);
25089 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
25090 ref->code = 0;
25091 ref->info = NULL;
25092 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 4, "DWARF macro version number");
25093 if (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8)
25094 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 1, "Flags: 64-bit");
25095 else
25096 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Flags: 32-bit");
25097 }
25098 break;
25099 case DW_MACINFO_define:
25100 case DW_MACINFO_undef:
25101 output_macinfo_op (ref);
25102 ref->code = 0;
25103 ref->info = NULL;
25104 break;
25105 default:
25106 gcc_unreachable ();
25107 }
25108 }
25109
25110 /* Set up for Dwarf output at the start of compilation. */
25111
25112 static void
25113 dwarf2out_init (const char *filename ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
25114 {
25115 /* This option is currently broken, see (PR53118 and PR46102). */
25116 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups
25117 && strstr (lang_hooks.name, "C++"))
25118 {
25119 warning (0, "-feliminate-dwarf2-dups is broken for C++, ignoring");
25120 flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups = 0;
25121 }
25122
25123 /* Allocate the file_table. */
25124 file_table = hash_table<dwarf_file_hasher>::create_ggc (50);
25125
25126 #ifndef DWARF2_LINENO_DEBUGGING_INFO
25127 /* Allocate the decl_die_table. */
25128 decl_die_table = hash_table<decl_die_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
25129
25130 /* Allocate the decl_loc_table. */
25131 decl_loc_table = hash_table<decl_loc_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
25132
25133 /* Allocate the cached_dw_loc_list_table. */
25134 cached_dw_loc_list_table = hash_table<dw_loc_list_hasher>::create_ggc (10);
25135
25136 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the decl_scope_table. */
25137 vec_alloc (decl_scope_table, 256);
25138
25139 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the abbrev_die_table. */
25140 abbrev_die_table = ggc_cleared_vec_alloc<dw_die_ref>
25141 (ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT);
25142 abbrev_die_table_allocated = ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
25143 /* Zero-th entry is allocated, but unused. */
25144 abbrev_die_table_in_use = 1;
25145
25146 /* Allocate the dwarf_proc_stack_usage_map. */
25147 dwarf_proc_stack_usage_map = new hash_map<dw_die_ref, int>;
25148
25149 /* Allocate the pubtypes and pubnames vectors. */
25150 vec_alloc (pubname_table, 32);
25151 vec_alloc (pubtype_table, 32);
25152
25153 vec_alloc (incomplete_types, 64);
25154
25155 vec_alloc (used_rtx_array, 32);
25156
25157 if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
25158 {
25159 debug_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_INFO_SECTION,
25160 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
25161 debug_abbrev_section = get_section (DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION,
25162 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
25163 debug_loc_section = get_section (DEBUG_LOC_SECTION,
25164 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
25165 }
25166 else
25167 {
25168 debug_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_DWO_INFO_SECTION,
25169 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
25170 debug_abbrev_section = get_section (DEBUG_DWO_ABBREV_SECTION,
25171 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
25172 NULL);
25173 debug_addr_section = get_section (DEBUG_ADDR_SECTION,
25174 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
25175 debug_skeleton_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_INFO_SECTION,
25176 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
25177 debug_skeleton_abbrev_section = get_section (DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION,
25178 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
25179 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_skeleton_abbrev_section_label,
25180 DEBUG_SKELETON_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
25181
25182 /* Somewhat confusing detail: The skeleton_[abbrev|info] sections stay in
25183 the main .o, but the skeleton_line goes into the split off dwo. */
25184 debug_skeleton_line_section
25185 = get_section (DEBUG_DWO_LINE_SECTION,
25186 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
25187 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_skeleton_line_section_label,
25188 DEBUG_SKELETON_LINE_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
25189 debug_str_offsets_section = get_section (DEBUG_STR_OFFSETS_SECTION,
25190 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE,
25191 NULL);
25192 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_skeleton_info_section_label,
25193 DEBUG_SKELETON_INFO_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
25194 debug_loc_section = get_section (DEBUG_DWO_LOC_SECTION,
25195 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_EXCLUDE, NULL);
25196 debug_str_dwo_section = get_section (DEBUG_STR_DWO_SECTION,
25197 DEBUG_STR_DWO_SECTION_FLAGS, NULL);
25198 }
25199 debug_aranges_section = get_section (DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION,
25200 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
25201 debug_macinfo_section = get_section (dwarf_strict
25202 ? DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION
25203 : DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION,
25204 DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION_FLAGS, NULL);
25205 debug_line_section = get_section (DEBUG_LINE_SECTION,
25206 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
25207 debug_pubnames_section = get_section (DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION,
25208 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
25209 debug_pubtypes_section = get_section (DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION,
25210 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
25211 debug_str_section = get_section (DEBUG_STR_SECTION,
25212 DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS, NULL);
25213 debug_ranges_section = get_section (DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION,
25214 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
25215 debug_frame_section = get_section (DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION,
25216 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
25217
25218 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_end_label, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
25219 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (abbrev_section_label,
25220 DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
25221 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_section_label, TEXT_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
25222 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (cold_text_section_label,
25223 COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
25224 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (cold_end_label, COLD_END_LABEL, 0);
25225
25226 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_info_section_label,
25227 DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
25228 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_line_section_label,
25229 DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
25230 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (ranges_section_label,
25231 DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
25232 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_addr_section_label,
25233 DEBUG_ADDR_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
25234 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (macinfo_section_label,
25235 dwarf_strict
25236 ? DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL
25237 : DEBUG_MACRO_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
25238 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loc_section_label, DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
25239
25240 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
25241 vec_alloc (macinfo_table, 64);
25242
25243 switch_to_section (text_section);
25244 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, text_section_label);
25245 #endif
25246
25247 /* Make sure the line number table for .text always exists. */
25248 text_section_line_info = new_line_info_table ();
25249 text_section_line_info->end_label = text_end_label;
25250
25251 #ifdef DWARF2_LINENO_DEBUGGING_INFO
25252 cur_line_info_table = text_section_line_info;
25253 #endif
25254
25255 /* If front-ends already registered a main translation unit but we were not
25256 ready to perform the association, do this now. */
25257 if (main_translation_unit != NULL_TREE)
25258 equate_decl_number_to_die (main_translation_unit, comp_unit_die ());
25259 }
25260
25261 /* Called before compile () starts outputtting functions, variables
25262 and toplevel asms into assembly. */
25263
25264 static void
25265 dwarf2out_assembly_start (void)
25266 {
25267 if (HAVE_GAS_CFI_SECTIONS_DIRECTIVE
25268 && dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ()
25269 && (!(flag_unwind_tables || flag_exceptions)
25270 || targetm_common.except_unwind_info (&global_options) != UI_DWARF2))
25271 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_sections\t.debug_frame\n");
25272 }
25273
25274 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
25275 htab_traverse. Assign a string its index. All strings must be
25276 collected into the table by the time index_string is called,
25277 because the indexing code relies on htab_traverse to traverse nodes
25278 in the same order for each run. */
25279
25280 int
25281 index_string (indirect_string_node **h, unsigned int *index)
25282 {
25283 indirect_string_node *node = *h;
25284
25285 find_string_form (node);
25286 if (node->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index && node->refcount > 0)
25287 {
25288 gcc_assert (node->index == NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED);
25289 node->index = *index;
25290 *index += 1;
25291 }
25292 return 1;
25293 }
25294
25295 /* A helper function for output_indirect_strings called through
25296 htab_traverse. Output the offset to a string and update the
25297 current offset. */
25298
25299 int
25300 output_index_string_offset (indirect_string_node **h, unsigned int *offset)
25301 {
25302 indirect_string_node *node = *h;
25303
25304 if (node->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index && node->refcount > 0)
25305 {
25306 /* Assert that this node has been assigned an index. */
25307 gcc_assert (node->index != NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED
25308 && node->index != NOT_INDEXED);
25309 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, *offset,
25310 "indexed string 0x%x: %s", node->index, node->str);
25311 *offset += strlen (node->str) + 1;
25312 }
25313 return 1;
25314 }
25315
25316 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
25317 htab_traverse. Output the indexed string. */
25318
25319 int
25320 output_index_string (indirect_string_node **h, unsigned int *cur_idx)
25321 {
25322 struct indirect_string_node *node = *h;
25323
25324 if (node->form == DW_FORM_GNU_str_index && node->refcount > 0)
25325 {
25326 /* Assert that the strings are output in the same order as their
25327 indexes were assigned. */
25328 gcc_assert (*cur_idx == node->index);
25329 assemble_string (node->str, strlen (node->str) + 1);
25330 *cur_idx += 1;
25331 }
25332 return 1;
25333 }
25334
25335 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
25336 htab_traverse. Emit one queued .debug_str string. */
25337
25338 int
25339 output_indirect_string (indirect_string_node **h, void *)
25340 {
25341 struct indirect_string_node *node = *h;
25342
25343 node->form = find_string_form (node);
25344 if (node->form == DW_FORM_strp && node->refcount > 0)
25345 {
25346 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, node->label);
25347 assemble_string (node->str, strlen (node->str) + 1);
25348 }
25349
25350 return 1;
25351 }
25352
25353 /* Output the indexed string table. */
25354
25355 static void
25356 output_indirect_strings (void)
25357 {
25358 switch_to_section (debug_str_section);
25359 if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
25360 debug_str_hash->traverse<void *, output_indirect_string> (NULL);
25361 else
25362 {
25363 unsigned int offset = 0;
25364 unsigned int cur_idx = 0;
25365
25366 skeleton_debug_str_hash->traverse<void *, output_indirect_string> (NULL);
25367
25368 switch_to_section (debug_str_offsets_section);
25369 debug_str_hash->traverse_noresize
25370 <unsigned int *, output_index_string_offset> (&offset);
25371 switch_to_section (debug_str_dwo_section);
25372 debug_str_hash->traverse_noresize<unsigned int *, output_index_string>
25373 (&cur_idx);
25374 }
25375 }
25376
25377 /* Callback for htab_traverse to assign an index to an entry in the
25378 table, and to write that entry to the .debug_addr section. */
25379
25380 int
25381 output_addr_table_entry (addr_table_entry **slot, unsigned int *cur_index)
25382 {
25383 addr_table_entry *entry = *slot;
25384
25385 if (entry->refcount == 0)
25386 {
25387 gcc_assert (entry->index == NO_INDEX_ASSIGNED
25388 || entry->index == NOT_INDEXED);
25389 return 1;
25390 }
25391
25392 gcc_assert (entry->index == *cur_index);
25393 (*cur_index)++;
25394
25395 switch (entry->kind)
25396 {
25397 case ate_kind_rtx:
25398 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, entry->addr.rtl,
25399 "0x%x", entry->index);
25400 break;
25401 case ate_kind_rtx_dtprel:
25402 gcc_assert (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel);
25403 targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file,
25404 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
25405 entry->addr.rtl);
25406 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
25407 break;
25408 case ate_kind_label:
25409 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, entry->addr.label,
25410 "0x%x", entry->index);
25411 break;
25412 default:
25413 gcc_unreachable ();
25414 }
25415 return 1;
25416 }
25417
25418 /* Produce the .debug_addr section. */
25419
25420 static void
25421 output_addr_table (void)
25422 {
25423 unsigned int index = 0;
25424 if (addr_index_table == NULL || addr_index_table->size () == 0)
25425 return;
25426
25427 switch_to_section (debug_addr_section);
25428 addr_index_table
25429 ->traverse_noresize<unsigned int *, output_addr_table_entry> (&index);
25430 }
25431
25432 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
25433 /* Verify that all marks are clear. */
25434
25435 static void
25436 verify_marks_clear (dw_die_ref die)
25437 {
25438 dw_die_ref c;
25439
25440 gcc_assert (! die->die_mark);
25441 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, verify_marks_clear (c));
25442 }
25443 #endif /* ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING */
25444
25445 /* Clear the marks for a die and its children.
25446 Be cool if the mark isn't set. */
25447
25448 static void
25449 prune_unmark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
25450 {
25451 dw_die_ref c;
25452
25453 if (die->die_mark)
25454 die->die_mark = 0;
25455 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unmark_dies (c));
25456 }
25457
25458 /* Given LOC that is referenced by a DIE we're marking as used, find all
25459 referenced DWARF procedures it references and mark them as used. */
25460
25461 static void
25462 prune_unused_types_walk_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
25463 {
25464 for (; loc != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
25465 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
25466 {
25467 case DW_OP_call2:
25468 case DW_OP_call4:
25469 case DW_OP_call_ref:
25470 prune_unused_types_mark (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die, 1);
25471 break;
25472 default:
25473 break;
25474 }
25475 }
25476
25477 /* Given DIE that we're marking as used, find any other dies
25478 it references as attributes and mark them as used. */
25479
25480 static void
25481 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (dw_die_ref die)
25482 {
25483 dw_attr_node *a;
25484 unsigned ix;
25485
25486 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
25487 {
25488 switch (AT_class (a))
25489 {
25490 /* Make sure DWARF procedures referenced by location descriptions will
25491 get emitted. */
25492 case dw_val_class_loc:
25493 prune_unused_types_walk_loc_descr (AT_loc (a));
25494 break;
25495 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
25496 for (dw_loc_list_ref list = AT_loc_list (a);
25497 list != NULL;
25498 list = list->dw_loc_next)
25499 prune_unused_types_walk_loc_descr (list->expr);
25500 break;
25501
25502 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
25503 /* A reference to another DIE.
25504 Make sure that it will get emitted.
25505 If it was broken out into a comdat group, don't follow it. */
25506 if (! AT_ref (a)->comdat_type_p
25507 || a->dw_attr == DW_AT_specification)
25508 prune_unused_types_mark (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die, 1);
25509 break;
25510
25511 case dw_val_class_str:
25512 /* Set the string's refcount to 0 so that prune_unused_types_mark
25513 accounts properly for it. */
25514 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount = 0;
25515 break;
25516
25517 default:
25518 break;
25519 }
25520 }
25521 }
25522
25523 /* Mark the generic parameters and arguments children DIEs of DIE. */
25524
25525 static void
25526 prune_unused_types_mark_generic_parms_dies (dw_die_ref die)
25527 {
25528 dw_die_ref c;
25529
25530 if (die == NULL || die->die_child == NULL)
25531 return;
25532 c = die->die_child;
25533 do
25534 {
25535 if (is_template_parameter (c))
25536 prune_unused_types_mark (c, 1);
25537 c = c->die_sib;
25538 } while (c && c != die->die_child);
25539 }
25540
25541 /* Mark DIE as being used. If DOKIDS is true, then walk down
25542 to DIE's children. */
25543
25544 static void
25545 prune_unused_types_mark (dw_die_ref die, int dokids)
25546 {
25547 dw_die_ref c;
25548
25549 if (die->die_mark == 0)
25550 {
25551 /* We haven't done this node yet. Mark it as used. */
25552 die->die_mark = 1;
25553 /* If this is the DIE of a generic type instantiation,
25554 mark the children DIEs that describe its generic parms and
25555 args. */
25556 prune_unused_types_mark_generic_parms_dies (die);
25557
25558 /* We also have to mark its parents as used.
25559 (But we don't want to mark our parent's kids due to this,
25560 unless it is a class.) */
25561 if (die->die_parent)
25562 prune_unused_types_mark (die->die_parent,
25563 class_scope_p (die->die_parent));
25564
25565 /* Mark any referenced nodes. */
25566 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (die);
25567
25568 /* If this node is a specification,
25569 also mark the definition, if it exists. */
25570 if (get_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_declaration) && die->die_definition)
25571 prune_unused_types_mark (die->die_definition, 1);
25572 }
25573
25574 if (dokids && die->die_mark != 2)
25575 {
25576 /* We need to walk the children, but haven't done so yet.
25577 Remember that we've walked the kids. */
25578 die->die_mark = 2;
25579
25580 /* If this is an array type, we need to make sure our
25581 kids get marked, even if they're types. If we're
25582 breaking out types into comdat sections, do this
25583 for all type definitions. */
25584 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_array_type
25585 || (use_debug_types
25586 && is_type_die (die) && ! is_declaration_die (die)))
25587 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_mark (c, 1));
25588 else
25589 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk (c));
25590 }
25591 }
25592
25593 /* For local classes, look if any static member functions were emitted
25594 and if so, mark them. */
25595
25596 static void
25597 prune_unused_types_walk_local_classes (dw_die_ref die)
25598 {
25599 dw_die_ref c;
25600
25601 if (die->die_mark == 2)
25602 return;
25603
25604 switch (die->die_tag)
25605 {
25606 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
25607 case DW_TAG_union_type:
25608 case DW_TAG_class_type:
25609 break;
25610
25611 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
25612 if (!get_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_declaration)
25613 || die->die_definition != NULL)
25614 prune_unused_types_mark (die, 1);
25615 return;
25616
25617 default:
25618 return;
25619 }
25620
25621 /* Mark children. */
25622 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk_local_classes (c));
25623 }
25624
25625 /* Walk the tree DIE and mark types that we actually use. */
25626
25627 static void
25628 prune_unused_types_walk (dw_die_ref die)
25629 {
25630 dw_die_ref c;
25631
25632 /* Don't do anything if this node is already marked and
25633 children have been marked as well. */
25634 if (die->die_mark == 2)
25635 return;
25636
25637 switch (die->die_tag)
25638 {
25639 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
25640 case DW_TAG_union_type:
25641 case DW_TAG_class_type:
25642 if (die->die_perennial_p)
25643 break;
25644
25645 for (c = die->die_parent; c; c = c->die_parent)
25646 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
25647 break;
25648
25649 /* Finding used static member functions inside of classes
25650 is needed just for local classes, because for other classes
25651 static member function DIEs with DW_AT_specification
25652 are emitted outside of the DW_TAG_*_type. If we ever change
25653 it, we'd need to call this even for non-local classes. */
25654 if (c)
25655 prune_unused_types_walk_local_classes (die);
25656
25657 /* It's a type node --- don't mark it. */
25658 return;
25659
25660 case DW_TAG_const_type:
25661 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
25662 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
25663 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
25664 case DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type:
25665 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
25666 case DW_TAG_typedef:
25667 case DW_TAG_array_type:
25668 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
25669 case DW_TAG_friend:
25670 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
25671 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
25672 case DW_TAG_string_type:
25673 case DW_TAG_set_type:
25674 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
25675 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
25676 case DW_TAG_file_type:
25677 /* Type nodes are useful only when other DIEs reference them --- don't
25678 mark them. */
25679 /* FALLTHROUGH */
25680
25681 case DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure:
25682 /* Likewise for DWARF procedures. */
25683
25684 if (die->die_perennial_p)
25685 break;
25686
25687 return;
25688
25689 default:
25690 /* Mark everything else. */
25691 break;
25692 }
25693
25694 if (die->die_mark == 0)
25695 {
25696 die->die_mark = 1;
25697
25698 /* Now, mark any dies referenced from here. */
25699 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (die);
25700 }
25701
25702 die->die_mark = 2;
25703
25704 /* Mark children. */
25705 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk (c));
25706 }
25707
25708 /* Increment the string counts on strings referred to from DIE's
25709 attributes. */
25710
25711 static void
25712 prune_unused_types_update_strings (dw_die_ref die)
25713 {
25714 dw_attr_node *a;
25715 unsigned ix;
25716
25717 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
25718 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
25719 {
25720 struct indirect_string_node *s = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str;
25721 s->refcount++;
25722 /* Avoid unnecessarily putting strings that are used less than
25723 twice in the hash table. */
25724 if (s->refcount
25725 == ((DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS & SECTION_MERGE) ? 1 : 2))
25726 {
25727 indirect_string_node **slot
25728 = debug_str_hash->find_slot_with_hash (s->str,
25729 htab_hash_string (s->str),
25730 INSERT);
25731 gcc_assert (*slot == NULL);
25732 *slot = s;
25733 }
25734 }
25735 }
25736
25737 /* Remove from the tree DIE any dies that aren't marked. */
25738
25739 static void
25740 prune_unused_types_prune (dw_die_ref die)
25741 {
25742 dw_die_ref c;
25743
25744 gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
25745 prune_unused_types_update_strings (die);
25746
25747 if (! die->die_child)
25748 return;
25749
25750 c = die->die_child;
25751 do {
25752 dw_die_ref prev = c;
25753 for (c = c->die_sib; ! c->die_mark; c = c->die_sib)
25754 if (c == die->die_child)
25755 {
25756 /* No marked children between 'prev' and the end of the list. */
25757 if (prev == c)
25758 /* No marked children at all. */
25759 die->die_child = NULL;
25760 else
25761 {
25762 prev->die_sib = c->die_sib;
25763 die->die_child = prev;
25764 }
25765 return;
25766 }
25767
25768 if (c != prev->die_sib)
25769 prev->die_sib = c;
25770 prune_unused_types_prune (c);
25771 } while (c != die->die_child);
25772 }
25773
25774 /* Remove dies representing declarations that we never use. */
25775
25776 static void
25777 prune_unused_types (void)
25778 {
25779 unsigned int i;
25780 limbo_die_node *node;
25781 comdat_type_node *ctnode;
25782 pubname_entry *pub;
25783 dw_die_ref base_type;
25784
25785 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
25786 /* All the marks should already be clear. */
25787 verify_marks_clear (comp_unit_die ());
25788 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
25789 verify_marks_clear (node->die);
25790 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
25791 verify_marks_clear (ctnode->root_die);
25792 #endif /* ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING */
25793
25794 /* Mark types that are used in global variables. */
25795 premark_types_used_by_global_vars ();
25796
25797 /* Set the mark on nodes that are actually used. */
25798 prune_unused_types_walk (comp_unit_die ());
25799 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
25800 prune_unused_types_walk (node->die);
25801 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
25802 {
25803 prune_unused_types_walk (ctnode->root_die);
25804 prune_unused_types_mark (ctnode->type_die, 1);
25805 }
25806
25807 /* Also set the mark on nodes referenced from the pubname_table. Enumerators
25808 are unusual in that they are pubnames that are the children of pubtypes.
25809 They should only be marked via their parent DW_TAG_enumeration_type die,
25810 not as roots in themselves. */
25811 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*pubname_table, i, pub)
25812 if (pub->die->die_tag != DW_TAG_enumerator)
25813 prune_unused_types_mark (pub->die, 1);
25814 for (i = 0; base_types.iterate (i, &base_type); i++)
25815 prune_unused_types_mark (base_type, 1);
25816
25817 if (debug_str_hash)
25818 debug_str_hash->empty ();
25819 if (skeleton_debug_str_hash)
25820 skeleton_debug_str_hash->empty ();
25821 prune_unused_types_prune (comp_unit_die ());
25822 for (limbo_die_node **pnode = &limbo_die_list; *pnode; )
25823 {
25824 node = *pnode;
25825 if (!node->die->die_mark)
25826 *pnode = node->next;
25827 else
25828 {
25829 prune_unused_types_prune (node->die);
25830 pnode = &node->next;
25831 }
25832 }
25833 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
25834 prune_unused_types_prune (ctnode->root_die);
25835
25836 /* Leave the marks clear. */
25837 prune_unmark_dies (comp_unit_die ());
25838 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
25839 prune_unmark_dies (node->die);
25840 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
25841 prune_unmark_dies (ctnode->root_die);
25842 }
25843
25844 /* Set the parameter to true if there are any relative pathnames in
25845 the file table. */
25846 int
25847 file_table_relative_p (dwarf_file_data **slot, bool *p)
25848 {
25849 struct dwarf_file_data *d = *slot;
25850 if (!IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH (d->filename))
25851 {
25852 *p = true;
25853 return 0;
25854 }
25855 return 1;
25856 }
25857
25858 /* Helpers to manipulate hash table of comdat type units. */
25859
25860 struct comdat_type_hasher : nofree_ptr_hash <comdat_type_node>
25861 {
25862 static inline hashval_t hash (const comdat_type_node *);
25863 static inline bool equal (const comdat_type_node *, const comdat_type_node *);
25864 };
25865
25866 inline hashval_t
25867 comdat_type_hasher::hash (const comdat_type_node *type_node)
25868 {
25869 hashval_t h;
25870 memcpy (&h, type_node->signature, sizeof (h));
25871 return h;
25872 }
25873
25874 inline bool
25875 comdat_type_hasher::equal (const comdat_type_node *type_node_1,
25876 const comdat_type_node *type_node_2)
25877 {
25878 return (! memcmp (type_node_1->signature, type_node_2->signature,
25879 DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE));
25880 }
25881
25882 /* Move a DW_AT_{,MIPS_}linkage_name attribute just added to dw_die_ref
25883 to the location it would have been added, should we know its
25884 DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME when we added other attributes. This will
25885 probably improve compactness of debug info, removing equivalent
25886 abbrevs, and hide any differences caused by deferring the
25887 computation of the assembler name, triggered by e.g. PCH. */
25888
25889 static inline void
25890 move_linkage_attr (dw_die_ref die)
25891 {
25892 unsigned ix = vec_safe_length (die->die_attr);
25893 dw_attr_node linkage = (*die->die_attr)[ix - 1];
25894
25895 gcc_assert (linkage.dw_attr == DW_AT_linkage_name
25896 || linkage.dw_attr == DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name);
25897
25898 while (--ix > 0)
25899 {
25900 dw_attr_node *prev = &(*die->die_attr)[ix - 1];
25901
25902 if (prev->dw_attr == DW_AT_decl_line || prev->dw_attr == DW_AT_name)
25903 break;
25904 }
25905
25906 if (ix != vec_safe_length (die->die_attr) - 1)
25907 {
25908 die->die_attr->pop ();
25909 die->die_attr->quick_insert (ix, linkage);
25910 }
25911 }
25912
25913 /* Helper function for resolve_addr, mark DW_TAG_base_type nodes
25914 referenced from typed stack ops and count how often they are used. */
25915
25916 static void
25917 mark_base_types (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
25918 {
25919 dw_die_ref base_type = NULL;
25920
25921 for (; loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
25922 {
25923 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
25924 {
25925 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
25926 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
25927 base_type = loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die;
25928 break;
25929 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
25930 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
25931 if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
25932 continue;
25933 /* FALLTHRU */
25934 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
25935 base_type = loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die;
25936 break;
25937 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
25938 mark_base_types (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc);
25939 continue;
25940 default:
25941 continue;
25942 }
25943 gcc_assert (base_type->die_parent == comp_unit_die ());
25944 if (base_type->die_mark)
25945 base_type->die_mark++;
25946 else
25947 {
25948 base_types.safe_push (base_type);
25949 base_type->die_mark = 1;
25950 }
25951 }
25952 }
25953
25954 /* Comparison function for sorting marked base types. */
25955
25956 static int
25957 base_type_cmp (const void *x, const void *y)
25958 {
25959 dw_die_ref dx = *(const dw_die_ref *) x;
25960 dw_die_ref dy = *(const dw_die_ref *) y;
25961 unsigned int byte_size1, byte_size2;
25962 unsigned int encoding1, encoding2;
25963 if (dx->die_mark > dy->die_mark)
25964 return -1;
25965 if (dx->die_mark < dy->die_mark)
25966 return 1;
25967 byte_size1 = get_AT_unsigned (dx, DW_AT_byte_size);
25968 byte_size2 = get_AT_unsigned (dy, DW_AT_byte_size);
25969 if (byte_size1 < byte_size2)
25970 return 1;
25971 if (byte_size1 > byte_size2)
25972 return -1;
25973 encoding1 = get_AT_unsigned (dx, DW_AT_encoding);
25974 encoding2 = get_AT_unsigned (dy, DW_AT_encoding);
25975 if (encoding1 < encoding2)
25976 return 1;
25977 if (encoding1 > encoding2)
25978 return -1;
25979 return 0;
25980 }
25981
25982 /* Move base types marked by mark_base_types as early as possible
25983 in the CU, sorted by decreasing usage count both to make the
25984 uleb128 references as small as possible and to make sure they
25985 will have die_offset already computed by calc_die_sizes when
25986 sizes of typed stack loc ops is computed. */
25987
25988 static void
25989 move_marked_base_types (void)
25990 {
25991 unsigned int i;
25992 dw_die_ref base_type, die, c;
25993
25994 if (base_types.is_empty ())
25995 return;
25996
25997 /* Sort by decreasing usage count, they will be added again in that
25998 order later on. */
25999 base_types.qsort (base_type_cmp);
26000 die = comp_unit_die ();
26001 c = die->die_child;
26002 do
26003 {
26004 dw_die_ref prev = c;
26005 c = c->die_sib;
26006 while (c->die_mark)
26007 {
26008 remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
26009 /* As base types got marked, there must be at least
26010 one node other than DW_TAG_base_type. */
26011 gcc_assert (c != c->die_sib);
26012 c = c->die_sib;
26013 }
26014 }
26015 while (c != die->die_child);
26016 gcc_assert (die->die_child);
26017 c = die->die_child;
26018 for (i = 0; base_types.iterate (i, &base_type); i++)
26019 {
26020 base_type->die_mark = 0;
26021 base_type->die_sib = c->die_sib;
26022 c->die_sib = base_type;
26023 c = base_type;
26024 }
26025 }
26026
26027 /* Helper function for resolve_addr, attempt to resolve
26028 one CONST_STRING, return true if successful. Similarly verify that
26029 SYMBOL_REFs refer to variables emitted in the current CU. */
26030
26031 static bool
26032 resolve_one_addr (rtx *addr)
26033 {
26034 rtx rtl = *addr;
26035
26036 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
26037 {
26038 size_t len = strlen (XSTR (rtl, 0)) + 1;
26039 tree t = build_string (len, XSTR (rtl, 0));
26040 tree tlen = size_int (len - 1);
26041 TREE_TYPE (t)
26042 = build_array_type (char_type_node, build_index_type (tlen));
26043 rtl = lookup_constant_def (t);
26044 if (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl))
26045 return false;
26046 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
26047 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF
26048 && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl)
26049 && !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl)))
26050 return false;
26051 vec_safe_push (used_rtx_array, rtl);
26052 *addr = rtl;
26053 return true;
26054 }
26055
26056 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF
26057 && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl))
26058 {
26059 if (TREE_CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (rtl))
26060 {
26061 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (DECL_INITIAL (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl))))
26062 return false;
26063 }
26064 else if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl)))
26065 return false;
26066 }
26067
26068 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST)
26069 {
26070 subrtx_ptr_iterator::array_type array;
26071 FOR_EACH_SUBRTX_PTR (iter, array, &XEXP (rtl, 0), ALL)
26072 if (!resolve_one_addr (*iter))
26073 return false;
26074 }
26075
26076 return true;
26077 }
26078
26079 /* For STRING_CST, return SYMBOL_REF of its constant pool entry,
26080 if possible, and create DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure that can be referenced
26081 from DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer if the string hasn't been seen yet. */
26082
26083 static rtx
26084 string_cst_pool_decl (tree t)
26085 {
26086 rtx rtl = output_constant_def (t, 1);
26087 unsigned char *array;
26088 dw_loc_descr_ref l;
26089 tree decl;
26090 size_t len;
26091 dw_die_ref ref;
26092
26093 if (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl))
26094 return NULL_RTX;
26095 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
26096 if (GET_CODE (rtl) != SYMBOL_REF
26097 || SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl) == NULL_TREE)
26098 return NULL_RTX;
26099
26100 decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl);
26101 if (!lookup_decl_die (decl))
26102 {
26103 len = TREE_STRING_LENGTH (t);
26104 vec_safe_push (used_rtx_array, rtl);
26105 ref = new_die (DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure, comp_unit_die (), decl);
26106 array = ggc_vec_alloc<unsigned char> (len);
26107 memcpy (array, TREE_STRING_POINTER (t), len);
26108 l = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value, len, 0);
26109 l->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
26110 l->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length = len;
26111 l->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size = 1;
26112 l->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.array = array;
26113 add_AT_loc (ref, DW_AT_location, l);
26114 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, ref);
26115 }
26116 return rtl;
26117 }
26118
26119 /* Helper function of resolve_addr_in_expr. LOC is
26120 a DW_OP_addr followed by DW_OP_stack_value, either at the start
26121 of exprloc or after DW_OP_{,bit_}piece, and val_addr can't be
26122 resolved. Replace it (both DW_OP_addr and DW_OP_stack_value)
26123 with DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer if possible
26124 and return true, if unsuccessful, return false. */
26125
26126 static bool
26127 optimize_one_addr_into_implicit_ptr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
26128 {
26129 rtx rtl = loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr;
26130 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
26131 dw_die_ref ref = NULL;
26132 tree decl;
26133
26134 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST
26135 && GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == PLUS
26136 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (XEXP (rtl, 0), 1)))
26137 {
26138 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (rtl, 0), 1));
26139 rtl = XEXP (XEXP (rtl, 0), 0);
26140 }
26141 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
26142 {
26143 size_t len = strlen (XSTR (rtl, 0)) + 1;
26144 tree t = build_string (len, XSTR (rtl, 0));
26145 tree tlen = size_int (len - 1);
26146
26147 TREE_TYPE (t)
26148 = build_array_type (char_type_node, build_index_type (tlen));
26149 rtl = string_cst_pool_decl (t);
26150 if (!rtl)
26151 return false;
26152 }
26153 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl))
26154 {
26155 decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl);
26156 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && !DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
26157 {
26158 ref = lookup_decl_die (decl);
26159 if (ref && (get_AT (ref, DW_AT_location)
26160 || get_AT (ref, DW_AT_const_value)))
26161 {
26162 loc->dw_loc_opc = DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer;
26163 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
26164 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry = NULL;
26165 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
26166 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
26167 loc->dw_loc_next = loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_next;
26168 loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int = offset;
26169 return true;
26170 }
26171 }
26172 }
26173 return false;
26174 }
26175
26176 /* Helper function for resolve_addr, handle one location
26177 expression, return false if at least one CONST_STRING or SYMBOL_REF in
26178 the location list couldn't be resolved. */
26179
26180 static bool
26181 resolve_addr_in_expr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
26182 {
26183 dw_loc_descr_ref keep = NULL;
26184 for (dw_loc_descr_ref prev = NULL; loc; prev = loc, loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
26185 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
26186 {
26187 case DW_OP_addr:
26188 if (!resolve_one_addr (&loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr))
26189 {
26190 if ((prev == NULL
26191 || prev->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_piece
26192 || prev->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bit_piece)
26193 && loc->dw_loc_next
26194 && loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_stack_value
26195 && !dwarf_strict
26196 && optimize_one_addr_into_implicit_ptr (loc))
26197 break;
26198 return false;
26199 }
26200 break;
26201 case DW_OP_GNU_addr_index:
26202 case DW_OP_GNU_const_index:
26203 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_addr_index
26204 || (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_const_index && loc->dtprel))
26205 {
26206 rtx rtl = loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry->addr.rtl;
26207 if (!resolve_one_addr (&rtl))
26208 return false;
26209 remove_addr_table_entry (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry);
26210 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_entry =
26211 add_addr_table_entry (rtl, ate_kind_rtx);
26212 }
26213 break;
26214 case DW_OP_const4u:
26215 case DW_OP_const8u:
26216 if (loc->dtprel
26217 && !resolve_one_addr (&loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr))
26218 return false;
26219 break;
26220 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
26221 if (size_of_loc_descr (loc)
26222 > size_of_int_loc_descriptor (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned)
26223 + 1
26224 && loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned > 0)
26225 {
26226 dw_loc_descr_ref repl
26227 = int_loc_descriptor (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
26228 add_loc_descr (&repl, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
26229 add_loc_descr (&repl, loc->dw_loc_next);
26230 *loc = *repl;
26231 }
26232 break;
26233 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
26234 if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class == dw_val_class_addr
26235 && !resolve_one_addr (&loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_addr))
26236 return false;
26237 break;
26238 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
26239 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
26240 if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_decl_ref)
26241 {
26242 dw_die_ref ref
26243 = lookup_decl_die (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref);
26244 if (ref == NULL)
26245 return false;
26246 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
26247 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
26248 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
26249 }
26250 break;
26251 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
26252 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
26253 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
26254 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
26255 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
26256 while (loc->dw_loc_next
26257 && loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_convert)
26258 {
26259 dw_die_ref base1, base2;
26260 unsigned enc1, enc2, size1, size2;
26261 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_regval_type
26262 || loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_deref_type)
26263 base1 = loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die;
26264 else if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class
26265 == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
26266 break;
26267 else
26268 base1 = loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die;
26269 if (loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class
26270 == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
26271 break;
26272 base2 = loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die;
26273 gcc_assert (base1->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type
26274 && base2->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type);
26275 enc1 = get_AT_unsigned (base1, DW_AT_encoding);
26276 enc2 = get_AT_unsigned (base2, DW_AT_encoding);
26277 size1 = get_AT_unsigned (base1, DW_AT_byte_size);
26278 size2 = get_AT_unsigned (base2, DW_AT_byte_size);
26279 if (size1 == size2
26280 && (((enc1 == DW_ATE_unsigned || enc1 == DW_ATE_signed)
26281 && (enc2 == DW_ATE_unsigned || enc2 == DW_ATE_signed)
26282 && loc != keep)
26283 || enc1 == enc2))
26284 {
26285 /* Optimize away next DW_OP_GNU_convert after
26286 adjusting LOC's base type die reference. */
26287 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_regval_type
26288 || loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_deref_type)
26289 loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die = base2;
26290 else
26291 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = base2;
26292 loc->dw_loc_next = loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_next;
26293 continue;
26294 }
26295 /* Don't change integer DW_OP_GNU_convert after e.g. floating
26296 point typed stack entry. */
26297 else if (enc1 != DW_ATE_unsigned && enc1 != DW_ATE_signed)
26298 keep = loc->dw_loc_next;
26299 break;
26300 }
26301 break;
26302 default:
26303 break;
26304 }
26305 return true;
26306 }
26307
26308 /* Helper function of resolve_addr. DIE had DW_AT_location of
26309 DW_OP_addr alone, which referred to DECL in DW_OP_addr's operand
26310 and DW_OP_addr couldn't be resolved. resolve_addr has already
26311 removed the DW_AT_location attribute. This function attempts to
26312 add a new DW_AT_location attribute with DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer
26313 to it or DW_AT_const_value attribute, if possible. */
26314
26315 static void
26316 optimize_location_into_implicit_ptr (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
26317 {
26318 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != VAR_DECL
26319 || lookup_decl_die (decl) != die
26320 || DECL_EXTERNAL (decl)
26321 || !TREE_STATIC (decl)
26322 || DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE
26323 || DECL_P (DECL_INITIAL (decl))
26324 || get_AT (die, DW_AT_const_value))
26325 return;
26326
26327 tree init = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
26328 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
26329 /* For variables that have been optimized away and thus
26330 don't have a memory location, see if we can emit
26331 DW_AT_const_value instead. */
26332 if (tree_add_const_value_attribute (die, init))
26333 return;
26334 if (dwarf_strict)
26335 return;
26336 /* If init is ADDR_EXPR or POINTER_PLUS_EXPR of ADDR_EXPR,
26337 and ADDR_EXPR refers to a decl that has DW_AT_location or
26338 DW_AT_const_value (but isn't addressable, otherwise
26339 resolving the original DW_OP_addr wouldn't fail), see if
26340 we can add DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer. */
26341 STRIP_NOPS (init);
26342 if (TREE_CODE (init) == POINTER_PLUS_EXPR
26343 && tree_fits_shwi_p (TREE_OPERAND (init, 1)))
26344 {
26345 offset = tree_to_shwi (TREE_OPERAND (init, 1));
26346 init = TREE_OPERAND (init, 0);
26347 STRIP_NOPS (init);
26348 }
26349 if (TREE_CODE (init) != ADDR_EXPR)
26350 return;
26351 if ((TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0)) == STRING_CST
26352 && !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0)))
26353 || (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0)) == VAR_DECL
26354 && !DECL_EXTERNAL (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0))
26355 && TREE_OPERAND (init, 0) != decl))
26356 {
26357 dw_die_ref ref;
26358 dw_loc_descr_ref l;
26359
26360 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0)) == STRING_CST)
26361 {
26362 rtx rtl = string_cst_pool_decl (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0));
26363 if (!rtl)
26364 return;
26365 decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl);
26366 }
26367 else
26368 decl = TREE_OPERAND (init, 0);
26369 ref = lookup_decl_die (decl);
26370 if (ref == NULL
26371 || (!get_AT (ref, DW_AT_location)
26372 && !get_AT (ref, DW_AT_const_value)))
26373 return;
26374 l = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer, 0, offset);
26375 l->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
26376 l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
26377 l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
26378 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_location, l);
26379 }
26380 }
26381
26382 /* Resolve DW_OP_addr and DW_AT_const_value CONST_STRING arguments to
26383 an address in .rodata section if the string literal is emitted there,
26384 or remove the containing location list or replace DW_AT_const_value
26385 with DW_AT_location and empty location expression, if it isn't found
26386 in .rodata. Similarly for SYMBOL_REFs, keep only those that refer
26387 to something that has been emitted in the current CU. */
26388
26389 static void
26390 resolve_addr (dw_die_ref die)
26391 {
26392 dw_die_ref c;
26393 dw_attr_node *a;
26394 dw_loc_list_ref *curr, *start, loc;
26395 unsigned ix;
26396
26397 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
26398 switch (AT_class (a))
26399 {
26400 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
26401 start = curr = AT_loc_list_ptr (a);
26402 loc = *curr;
26403 gcc_assert (loc);
26404 /* The same list can be referenced more than once. See if we have
26405 already recorded the result from a previous pass. */
26406 if (loc->replaced)
26407 *curr = loc->dw_loc_next;
26408 else if (!loc->resolved_addr)
26409 {
26410 /* As things stand, we do not expect or allow one die to
26411 reference a suffix of another die's location list chain.
26412 References must be identical or completely separate.
26413 There is therefore no need to cache the result of this
26414 pass on any list other than the first; doing so
26415 would lead to unnecessary writes. */
26416 while (*curr)
26417 {
26418 gcc_assert (!(*curr)->replaced && !(*curr)->resolved_addr);
26419 if (!resolve_addr_in_expr ((*curr)->expr))
26420 {
26421 dw_loc_list_ref next = (*curr)->dw_loc_next;
26422 dw_loc_descr_ref l = (*curr)->expr;
26423
26424 if (next && (*curr)->ll_symbol)
26425 {
26426 gcc_assert (!next->ll_symbol);
26427 next->ll_symbol = (*curr)->ll_symbol;
26428 }
26429 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
26430 remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (l);
26431 *curr = next;
26432 }
26433 else
26434 {
26435 mark_base_types ((*curr)->expr);
26436 curr = &(*curr)->dw_loc_next;
26437 }
26438 }
26439 if (loc == *start)
26440 loc->resolved_addr = 1;
26441 else
26442 {
26443 loc->replaced = 1;
26444 loc->dw_loc_next = *start;
26445 }
26446 }
26447 if (!*start)
26448 {
26449 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
26450 ix--;
26451 }
26452 break;
26453 case dw_val_class_loc:
26454 {
26455 dw_loc_descr_ref l = AT_loc (a);
26456 /* For -gdwarf-2 don't attempt to optimize
26457 DW_AT_data_member_location containing
26458 DW_OP_plus_uconst - older consumers might
26459 rely on it being that op instead of a more complex,
26460 but shorter, location description. */
26461 if ((dwarf_version > 2
26462 || a->dw_attr != DW_AT_data_member_location
26463 || l == NULL
26464 || l->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_plus_uconst
26465 || l->dw_loc_next != NULL)
26466 && !resolve_addr_in_expr (l))
26467 {
26468 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
26469 remove_loc_list_addr_table_entries (l);
26470 if (l != NULL
26471 && l->dw_loc_next == NULL
26472 && l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr
26473 && GET_CODE (l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr) == SYMBOL_REF
26474 && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr)
26475 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_location)
26476 {
26477 tree decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (l->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr);
26478 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
26479 ix--;
26480 optimize_location_into_implicit_ptr (die, decl);
26481 break;
26482 }
26483 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
26484 ix--;
26485 }
26486 else
26487 mark_base_types (l);
26488 }
26489 break;
26490 case dw_val_class_addr:
26491 if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_const_value
26492 && !resolve_one_addr (&a->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr))
26493 {
26494 if (AT_index (a) != NOT_INDEXED)
26495 remove_addr_table_entry (a->dw_attr_val.val_entry);
26496 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
26497 ix--;
26498 }
26499 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_call_site
26500 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_abstract_origin)
26501 {
26502 tree tdecl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr);
26503 dw_die_ref tdie = lookup_decl_die (tdecl);
26504 dw_die_ref cdie;
26505 if (tdie == NULL
26506 && DECL_EXTERNAL (tdecl)
26507 && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (tdecl) == NULL_TREE
26508 && (cdie = lookup_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (tdecl))))
26509 {
26510 /* Creating a full DIE for tdecl is overly expensive and
26511 at this point even wrong when in the LTO phase
26512 as it can end up generating new type DIEs we didn't
26513 output and thus optimize_external_refs will crash. */
26514 tdie = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, cdie, NULL_TREE);
26515 add_AT_flag (tdie, DW_AT_external, 1);
26516 add_AT_flag (tdie, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
26517 add_linkage_attr (tdie, tdecl);
26518 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (tdie, tdecl);
26519 equate_decl_number_to_die (tdecl, tdie);
26520 }
26521 if (tdie)
26522 {
26523 a->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
26524 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = tdie;
26525 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
26526 }
26527 else
26528 {
26529 if (AT_index (a) != NOT_INDEXED)
26530 remove_addr_table_entry (a->dw_attr_val.val_entry);
26531 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
26532 ix--;
26533 }
26534 }
26535 break;
26536 default:
26537 break;
26538 }
26539
26540 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, resolve_addr (c));
26541 }
26542 \f
26543 /* Helper routines for optimize_location_lists.
26544 This pass tries to share identical local lists in .debug_loc
26545 section. */
26546
26547 /* Iteratively hash operands of LOC opcode into HSTATE. */
26548
26549 static void
26550 hash_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, inchash::hash &hstate)
26551 {
26552 dw_val_ref val1 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1;
26553 dw_val_ref val2 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2;
26554
26555 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
26556 {
26557 case DW_OP_const4u:
26558 case DW_OP_const8u:
26559 if (loc->dtprel)
26560 goto hash_addr;
26561 /* FALLTHRU */
26562 case DW_OP_const1u:
26563 case DW_OP_const1s:
26564 case DW_OP_const2u:
26565 case DW_OP_const2s:
26566 case DW_OP_const4s:
26567 case DW_OP_const8s:
26568 case DW_OP_constu:
26569 case DW_OP_consts:
26570 case DW_OP_pick:
26571 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
26572 case DW_OP_breg0:
26573 case DW_OP_breg1:
26574 case DW_OP_breg2:
26575 case DW_OP_breg3:
26576 case DW_OP_breg4:
26577 case DW_OP_breg5:
26578 case DW_OP_breg6:
26579 case DW_OP_breg7:
26580 case DW_OP_breg8:
26581 case DW_OP_breg9:
26582 case DW_OP_breg10:
26583 case DW_OP_breg11:
26584 case DW_OP_breg12:
26585 case DW_OP_breg13:
26586 case DW_OP_breg14:
26587 case DW_OP_breg15:
26588 case DW_OP_breg16:
26589 case DW_OP_breg17:
26590 case DW_OP_breg18:
26591 case DW_OP_breg19:
26592 case DW_OP_breg20:
26593 case DW_OP_breg21:
26594 case DW_OP_breg22:
26595 case DW_OP_breg23:
26596 case DW_OP_breg24:
26597 case DW_OP_breg25:
26598 case DW_OP_breg26:
26599 case DW_OP_breg27:
26600 case DW_OP_breg28:
26601 case DW_OP_breg29:
26602 case DW_OP_breg30:
26603 case DW_OP_breg31:
26604 case DW_OP_regx:
26605 case DW_OP_fbreg:
26606 case DW_OP_piece:
26607 case DW_OP_deref_size:
26608 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
26609 hstate.add_object (val1->v.val_int);
26610 break;
26611 case DW_OP_skip:
26612 case DW_OP_bra:
26613 {
26614 int offset;
26615
26616 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
26617 offset = val1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr - (loc->dw_loc_addr + 3);
26618 hstate.add_object (offset);
26619 }
26620 break;
26621 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
26622 hstate.add_object (val1->v.val_unsigned);
26623 switch (val2->val_class)
26624 {
26625 case dw_val_class_const:
26626 hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_int);
26627 break;
26628 case dw_val_class_vec:
26629 {
26630 unsigned int elt_size = val2->v.val_vec.elt_size;
26631 unsigned int len = val2->v.val_vec.length;
26632
26633 hstate.add_int (elt_size);
26634 hstate.add_int (len);
26635 hstate.add (val2->v.val_vec.array, len * elt_size);
26636 }
26637 break;
26638 case dw_val_class_const_double:
26639 hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_double.low);
26640 hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_double.high);
26641 break;
26642 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
26643 hstate.add (val2->v.val_wide->get_val (),
26644 get_full_len (*val2->v.val_wide)
26645 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR);
26646 break;
26647 case dw_val_class_addr:
26648 inchash::add_rtx (val2->v.val_addr, hstate);
26649 break;
26650 default:
26651 gcc_unreachable ();
26652 }
26653 break;
26654 case DW_OP_bregx:
26655 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
26656 hstate.add_object (val1->v.val_int);
26657 hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_int);
26658 break;
26659 case DW_OP_addr:
26660 hash_addr:
26661 if (loc->dtprel)
26662 {
26663 unsigned char dtprel = 0xd1;
26664 hstate.add_object (dtprel);
26665 }
26666 inchash::add_rtx (val1->v.val_addr, hstate);
26667 break;
26668 case DW_OP_GNU_addr_index:
26669 case DW_OP_GNU_const_index:
26670 {
26671 if (loc->dtprel)
26672 {
26673 unsigned char dtprel = 0xd1;
26674 hstate.add_object (dtprel);
26675 }
26676 inchash::add_rtx (val1->val_entry->addr.rtl, hstate);
26677 }
26678 break;
26679 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
26680 hstate.add_int (val2->v.val_int);
26681 break;
26682 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
26683 hstate.add_object (val1->v.val_loc);
26684 break;
26685 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
26686 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
26687 {
26688 unsigned int byte_size
26689 = get_AT_unsigned (val2->v.val_die_ref.die, DW_AT_byte_size);
26690 unsigned int encoding
26691 = get_AT_unsigned (val2->v.val_die_ref.die, DW_AT_encoding);
26692 hstate.add_object (val1->v.val_int);
26693 hstate.add_object (byte_size);
26694 hstate.add_object (encoding);
26695 }
26696 break;
26697 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
26698 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
26699 if (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
26700 {
26701 hstate.add_object (val1->v.val_unsigned);
26702 break;
26703 }
26704 /* FALLTHRU */
26705 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
26706 {
26707 unsigned int byte_size
26708 = get_AT_unsigned (val1->v.val_die_ref.die, DW_AT_byte_size);
26709 unsigned int encoding
26710 = get_AT_unsigned (val1->v.val_die_ref.die, DW_AT_encoding);
26711 hstate.add_object (byte_size);
26712 hstate.add_object (encoding);
26713 if (loc->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_GNU_const_type)
26714 break;
26715 hstate.add_object (val2->val_class);
26716 switch (val2->val_class)
26717 {
26718 case dw_val_class_const:
26719 hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_int);
26720 break;
26721 case dw_val_class_vec:
26722 {
26723 unsigned int elt_size = val2->v.val_vec.elt_size;
26724 unsigned int len = val2->v.val_vec.length;
26725
26726 hstate.add_object (elt_size);
26727 hstate.add_object (len);
26728 hstate.add (val2->v.val_vec.array, len * elt_size);
26729 }
26730 break;
26731 case dw_val_class_const_double:
26732 hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_double.low);
26733 hstate.add_object (val2->v.val_double.high);
26734 break;
26735 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
26736 hstate.add (val2->v.val_wide->get_val (),
26737 get_full_len (*val2->v.val_wide)
26738 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR);
26739 break;
26740 default:
26741 gcc_unreachable ();
26742 }
26743 }
26744 break;
26745
26746 default:
26747 /* Other codes have no operands. */
26748 break;
26749 }
26750 }
26751
26752 /* Iteratively hash the whole DWARF location expression LOC into HSTATE. */
26753
26754 static inline void
26755 hash_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, inchash::hash &hstate)
26756 {
26757 dw_loc_descr_ref l;
26758 bool sizes_computed = false;
26759 /* Compute sizes, so that DW_OP_skip/DW_OP_bra can be checksummed. */
26760 size_of_locs (loc);
26761
26762 for (l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
26763 {
26764 enum dwarf_location_atom opc = l->dw_loc_opc;
26765 hstate.add_object (opc);
26766 if ((opc == DW_OP_skip || opc == DW_OP_bra) && !sizes_computed)
26767 {
26768 size_of_locs (loc);
26769 sizes_computed = true;
26770 }
26771 hash_loc_operands (l, hstate);
26772 }
26773 }
26774
26775 /* Compute hash of the whole location list LIST_HEAD. */
26776
26777 static inline void
26778 hash_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref list_head)
26779 {
26780 dw_loc_list_ref curr = list_head;
26781 inchash::hash hstate;
26782
26783 for (curr = list_head; curr != NULL; curr = curr->dw_loc_next)
26784 {
26785 hstate.add (curr->begin, strlen (curr->begin) + 1);
26786 hstate.add (curr->end, strlen (curr->end) + 1);
26787 if (curr->section)
26788 hstate.add (curr->section, strlen (curr->section) + 1);
26789 hash_locs (curr->expr, hstate);
26790 }
26791 list_head->hash = hstate.end ();
26792 }
26793
26794 /* Return true if X and Y opcodes have the same operands. */
26795
26796 static inline bool
26797 compare_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref x, dw_loc_descr_ref y)
26798 {
26799 dw_val_ref valx1 = &x->dw_loc_oprnd1;
26800 dw_val_ref valx2 = &x->dw_loc_oprnd2;
26801 dw_val_ref valy1 = &y->dw_loc_oprnd1;
26802 dw_val_ref valy2 = &y->dw_loc_oprnd2;
26803
26804 switch (x->dw_loc_opc)
26805 {
26806 case DW_OP_const4u:
26807 case DW_OP_const8u:
26808 if (x->dtprel)
26809 goto hash_addr;
26810 /* FALLTHRU */
26811 case DW_OP_const1u:
26812 case DW_OP_const1s:
26813 case DW_OP_const2u:
26814 case DW_OP_const2s:
26815 case DW_OP_const4s:
26816 case DW_OP_const8s:
26817 case DW_OP_constu:
26818 case DW_OP_consts:
26819 case DW_OP_pick:
26820 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
26821 case DW_OP_breg0:
26822 case DW_OP_breg1:
26823 case DW_OP_breg2:
26824 case DW_OP_breg3:
26825 case DW_OP_breg4:
26826 case DW_OP_breg5:
26827 case DW_OP_breg6:
26828 case DW_OP_breg7:
26829 case DW_OP_breg8:
26830 case DW_OP_breg9:
26831 case DW_OP_breg10:
26832 case DW_OP_breg11:
26833 case DW_OP_breg12:
26834 case DW_OP_breg13:
26835 case DW_OP_breg14:
26836 case DW_OP_breg15:
26837 case DW_OP_breg16:
26838 case DW_OP_breg17:
26839 case DW_OP_breg18:
26840 case DW_OP_breg19:
26841 case DW_OP_breg20:
26842 case DW_OP_breg21:
26843 case DW_OP_breg22:
26844 case DW_OP_breg23:
26845 case DW_OP_breg24:
26846 case DW_OP_breg25:
26847 case DW_OP_breg26:
26848 case DW_OP_breg27:
26849 case DW_OP_breg28:
26850 case DW_OP_breg29:
26851 case DW_OP_breg30:
26852 case DW_OP_breg31:
26853 case DW_OP_regx:
26854 case DW_OP_fbreg:
26855 case DW_OP_piece:
26856 case DW_OP_deref_size:
26857 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
26858 return valx1->v.val_int == valy1->v.val_int;
26859 case DW_OP_skip:
26860 case DW_OP_bra:
26861 /* If splitting debug info, the use of DW_OP_GNU_addr_index
26862 can cause irrelevant differences in dw_loc_addr. */
26863 gcc_assert (valx1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc
26864 && valy1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc
26865 && (dwarf_split_debug_info
26866 || x->dw_loc_addr == y->dw_loc_addr));
26867 return valx1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr == valy1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr;
26868 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
26869 if (valx1->v.val_unsigned != valy1->v.val_unsigned
26870 || valx2->val_class != valy2->val_class)
26871 return false;
26872 switch (valx2->val_class)
26873 {
26874 case dw_val_class_const:
26875 return valx2->v.val_int == valy2->v.val_int;
26876 case dw_val_class_vec:
26877 return valx2->v.val_vec.elt_size == valy2->v.val_vec.elt_size
26878 && valx2->v.val_vec.length == valy2->v.val_vec.length
26879 && memcmp (valx2->v.val_vec.array, valy2->v.val_vec.array,
26880 valx2->v.val_vec.elt_size
26881 * valx2->v.val_vec.length) == 0;
26882 case dw_val_class_const_double:
26883 return valx2->v.val_double.low == valy2->v.val_double.low
26884 && valx2->v.val_double.high == valy2->v.val_double.high;
26885 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
26886 return *valx2->v.val_wide == *valy2->v.val_wide;
26887 case dw_val_class_addr:
26888 return rtx_equal_p (valx2->v.val_addr, valy2->v.val_addr);
26889 default:
26890 gcc_unreachable ();
26891 }
26892 case DW_OP_bregx:
26893 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
26894 return valx1->v.val_int == valy1->v.val_int
26895 && valx2->v.val_int == valy2->v.val_int;
26896 case DW_OP_addr:
26897 hash_addr:
26898 return rtx_equal_p (valx1->v.val_addr, valy1->v.val_addr);
26899 case DW_OP_GNU_addr_index:
26900 case DW_OP_GNU_const_index:
26901 {
26902 rtx ax1 = valx1->val_entry->addr.rtl;
26903 rtx ay1 = valy1->val_entry->addr.rtl;
26904 return rtx_equal_p (ax1, ay1);
26905 }
26906 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
26907 return valx1->val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref
26908 && valx1->val_class == valy1->val_class
26909 && valx1->v.val_die_ref.die == valy1->v.val_die_ref.die
26910 && valx2->v.val_int == valy2->v.val_int;
26911 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
26912 return compare_loc_operands (valx1->v.val_loc, valy1->v.val_loc);
26913 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
26914 if (valx1->v.val_die_ref.die != valy1->v.val_die_ref.die
26915 || valx2->val_class != valy2->val_class)
26916 return false;
26917 switch (valx2->val_class)
26918 {
26919 case dw_val_class_const:
26920 return valx2->v.val_int == valy2->v.val_int;
26921 case dw_val_class_vec:
26922 return valx2->v.val_vec.elt_size == valy2->v.val_vec.elt_size
26923 && valx2->v.val_vec.length == valy2->v.val_vec.length
26924 && memcmp (valx2->v.val_vec.array, valy2->v.val_vec.array,
26925 valx2->v.val_vec.elt_size
26926 * valx2->v.val_vec.length) == 0;
26927 case dw_val_class_const_double:
26928 return valx2->v.val_double.low == valy2->v.val_double.low
26929 && valx2->v.val_double.high == valy2->v.val_double.high;
26930 case dw_val_class_wide_int:
26931 return *valx2->v.val_wide == *valy2->v.val_wide;
26932 default:
26933 gcc_unreachable ();
26934 }
26935 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
26936 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
26937 return valx1->v.val_int == valy1->v.val_int
26938 && valx2->v.val_die_ref.die == valy2->v.val_die_ref.die;
26939 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
26940 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
26941 if (valx1->val_class != valy1->val_class)
26942 return false;
26943 if (valx1->val_class == dw_val_class_unsigned_const)
26944 return valx1->v.val_unsigned == valy1->v.val_unsigned;
26945 return valx1->v.val_die_ref.die == valy1->v.val_die_ref.die;
26946 case DW_OP_GNU_parameter_ref:
26947 return valx1->val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref
26948 && valx1->val_class == valy1->val_class
26949 && valx1->v.val_die_ref.die == valy1->v.val_die_ref.die;
26950 default:
26951 /* Other codes have no operands. */
26952 return true;
26953 }
26954 }
26955
26956 /* Return true if DWARF location expressions X and Y are the same. */
26957
26958 static inline bool
26959 compare_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref x, dw_loc_descr_ref y)
26960 {
26961 for (; x != NULL && y != NULL; x = x->dw_loc_next, y = y->dw_loc_next)
26962 if (x->dw_loc_opc != y->dw_loc_opc
26963 || x->dtprel != y->dtprel
26964 || !compare_loc_operands (x, y))
26965 break;
26966 return x == NULL && y == NULL;
26967 }
26968
26969 /* Hashtable helpers. */
26970
26971 struct loc_list_hasher : nofree_ptr_hash <dw_loc_list_struct>
26972 {
26973 static inline hashval_t hash (const dw_loc_list_struct *);
26974 static inline bool equal (const dw_loc_list_struct *,
26975 const dw_loc_list_struct *);
26976 };
26977
26978 /* Return precomputed hash of location list X. */
26979
26980 inline hashval_t
26981 loc_list_hasher::hash (const dw_loc_list_struct *x)
26982 {
26983 return x->hash;
26984 }
26985
26986 /* Return true if location lists A and B are the same. */
26987
26988 inline bool
26989 loc_list_hasher::equal (const dw_loc_list_struct *a,
26990 const dw_loc_list_struct *b)
26991 {
26992 if (a == b)
26993 return 1;
26994 if (a->hash != b->hash)
26995 return 0;
26996 for (; a != NULL && b != NULL; a = a->dw_loc_next, b = b->dw_loc_next)
26997 if (strcmp (a->begin, b->begin) != 0
26998 || strcmp (a->end, b->end) != 0
26999 || (a->section == NULL) != (b->section == NULL)
27000 || (a->section && strcmp (a->section, b->section) != 0)
27001 || !compare_locs (a->expr, b->expr))
27002 break;
27003 return a == NULL && b == NULL;
27004 }
27005
27006 typedef hash_table<loc_list_hasher> loc_list_hash_type;
27007
27008
27009 /* Recursively optimize location lists referenced from DIE
27010 children and share them whenever possible. */
27011
27012 static void
27013 optimize_location_lists_1 (dw_die_ref die, loc_list_hash_type *htab)
27014 {
27015 dw_die_ref c;
27016 dw_attr_node *a;
27017 unsigned ix;
27018 dw_loc_list_struct **slot;
27019
27020 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
27021 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
27022 {
27023 dw_loc_list_ref list = AT_loc_list (a);
27024 /* TODO: perform some optimizations here, before hashing
27025 it and storing into the hash table. */
27026 hash_loc_list (list);
27027 slot = htab->find_slot_with_hash (list, list->hash, INSERT);
27028 if (*slot == NULL)
27029 *slot = list;
27030 else
27031 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list = *slot;
27032 }
27033
27034 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, optimize_location_lists_1 (c, htab));
27035 }
27036
27037
27038 /* Recursively assign each location list a unique index into the debug_addr
27039 section. */
27040
27041 static void
27042 index_location_lists (dw_die_ref die)
27043 {
27044 dw_die_ref c;
27045 dw_attr_node *a;
27046 unsigned ix;
27047
27048 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (die->die_attr, ix, a)
27049 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
27050 {
27051 dw_loc_list_ref list = AT_loc_list (a);
27052 dw_loc_list_ref curr;
27053 for (curr = list; curr != NULL; curr = curr->dw_loc_next)
27054 {
27055 /* Don't index an entry that has already been indexed
27056 or won't be output. */
27057 if (curr->begin_entry != NULL
27058 || (strcmp (curr->begin, curr->end) == 0 && !curr->force))
27059 continue;
27060
27061 curr->begin_entry
27062 = add_addr_table_entry (xstrdup (curr->begin),
27063 ate_kind_label);
27064 }
27065 }
27066
27067 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, index_location_lists (c));
27068 }
27069
27070 /* Optimize location lists referenced from DIE
27071 children and share them whenever possible. */
27072
27073 static void
27074 optimize_location_lists (dw_die_ref die)
27075 {
27076 loc_list_hash_type htab (500);
27077 optimize_location_lists_1 (die, &htab);
27078 }
27079 \f
27080 /* Traverse the limbo die list, and add parent/child links. The only
27081 dies without parents that should be here are concrete instances of
27082 inline functions, and the comp_unit_die. We can ignore the comp_unit_die.
27083 For concrete instances, we can get the parent die from the abstract
27084 instance. */
27085
27086 static void
27087 flush_limbo_die_list (void)
27088 {
27089 limbo_die_node *node, *next_node;
27090
27091 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = next_node)
27092 {
27093 dw_die_ref die = node->die;
27094 next_node = node->next;
27095
27096 if (die->die_parent == NULL)
27097 {
27098 dw_die_ref origin = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin);
27099
27100 if (origin && origin->die_parent)
27101 add_child_die (origin->die_parent, die);
27102 else if (is_cu_die (die))
27103 ;
27104 else if (seen_error ())
27105 /* It's OK to be confused by errors in the input. */
27106 add_child_die (comp_unit_die (), die);
27107 else
27108 {
27109 /* In certain situations, the lexical block containing a
27110 nested function can be optimized away, which results
27111 in the nested function die being orphaned. Likewise
27112 with the return type of that nested function. Force
27113 this to be a child of the containing function.
27114
27115 It may happen that even the containing function got fully
27116 inlined and optimized out. In that case we are lost and
27117 assign the empty child. This should not be big issue as
27118 the function is likely unreachable too. */
27119 gcc_assert (node->created_for);
27120
27121 if (DECL_P (node->created_for))
27122 origin = get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (node->created_for));
27123 else if (TYPE_P (node->created_for))
27124 origin = scope_die_for (node->created_for, comp_unit_die ());
27125 else
27126 origin = comp_unit_die ();
27127
27128 add_child_die (origin, die);
27129 }
27130 }
27131 }
27132
27133 limbo_die_list = NULL;
27134 }
27135
27136 /* Output stuff that dwarf requires at the end of every file,
27137 and generate the DWARF-2 debugging info. */
27138
27139 static void
27140 dwarf2out_finish (const char *filename)
27141 {
27142 comdat_type_node *ctnode;
27143 dw_die_ref main_comp_unit_die;
27144
27145 /* Flush out any latecomers to the limbo party. */
27146 flush_limbo_die_list ();
27147
27148 /* We shouldn't have any symbols with delayed asm names for
27149 DIEs generated after early finish. */
27150 gcc_assert (deferred_asm_name == NULL);
27151
27152 /* PCH might result in DW_AT_producer string being restored from the
27153 header compilation, so always fill it with empty string initially
27154 and overwrite only here. */
27155 dw_attr_node *producer = get_AT (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_producer);
27156 producer_string = gen_producer_string ();
27157 producer->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount--;
27158 producer->dw_attr_val.v.val_str = find_AT_string (producer_string);
27159
27160 gen_remaining_tmpl_value_param_die_attribute ();
27161
27162 /* Add the name for the main input file now. We delayed this from
27163 dwarf2out_init to avoid complications with PCH.
27164 For LTO produced units use a fixed artificial name to avoid
27165 leaking tempfile names into the dwarf. */
27166 if (!in_lto_p)
27167 add_name_attribute (comp_unit_die (), remap_debug_filename (filename));
27168 else
27169 add_name_attribute (comp_unit_die (), "<artificial>");
27170 if (!IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH (filename) || targetm.force_at_comp_dir)
27171 add_comp_dir_attribute (comp_unit_die ());
27172 else if (get_AT (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_comp_dir) == NULL)
27173 {
27174 bool p = false;
27175 file_table->traverse<bool *, file_table_relative_p> (&p);
27176 if (p)
27177 add_comp_dir_attribute (comp_unit_die ());
27178 }
27179
27180 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
27181 {
27182 dw_die_ref die = comp_unit_die (), c;
27183 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, gcc_assert (! c->die_mark));
27184 }
27185 #endif
27186 resolve_addr (comp_unit_die ());
27187 move_marked_base_types ();
27188
27189 /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
27190 emit full debugging info for them. */
27191 retry_incomplete_types ();
27192
27193 if (flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types)
27194 prune_unused_types ();
27195
27196 /* Generate separate COMDAT sections for type DIEs. */
27197 if (use_debug_types)
27198 {
27199 break_out_comdat_types (comp_unit_die ());
27200
27201 /* Each new type_unit DIE was added to the limbo die list when created.
27202 Since these have all been added to comdat_type_list, clear the
27203 limbo die list. */
27204 limbo_die_list = NULL;
27205
27206 /* For each new comdat type unit, copy declarations for incomplete
27207 types to make the new unit self-contained (i.e., no direct
27208 references to the main compile unit). */
27209 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
27210 copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (ctnode->root_die);
27211 copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (comp_unit_die ());
27212
27213 /* In the process of copying declarations from one unit to another,
27214 we may have left some declarations behind that are no longer
27215 referenced. Prune them. */
27216 prune_unused_types ();
27217 }
27218
27219 /* Generate separate CUs for each of the include files we've seen.
27220 They will go into limbo_die_list. */
27221 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
27222 break_out_includes (comp_unit_die ());
27223
27224 /* Traverse the DIE's and add sibling attributes to those DIE's that
27225 have children. */
27226 add_sibling_attributes (comp_unit_die ());
27227 limbo_die_node *node;
27228 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
27229 add_sibling_attributes (node->die);
27230 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
27231 add_sibling_attributes (ctnode->root_die);
27232
27233 /* When splitting DWARF info, we put some attributes in the
27234 skeleton compile_unit DIE that remains in the .o, while
27235 most attributes go in the DWO compile_unit_die. */
27236 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
27237 main_comp_unit_die = gen_compile_unit_die (NULL);
27238 else
27239 main_comp_unit_die = comp_unit_die ();
27240
27241 /* Output a terminator label for the .text section. */
27242 switch_to_section (text_section);
27243 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
27244 if (cold_text_section)
27245 {
27246 switch_to_section (cold_text_section);
27247 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, COLD_END_LABEL, 0);
27248 }
27249
27250 /* We can only use the low/high_pc attributes if all of the code was
27251 in .text. */
27252 if (!have_multiple_function_sections
27253 || (dwarf_version < 3 && dwarf_strict))
27254 {
27255 /* Don't add if the CU has no associated code. */
27256 if (text_section_used)
27257 add_AT_low_high_pc (main_comp_unit_die, text_section_label,
27258 text_end_label, true);
27259 }
27260 else
27261 {
27262 unsigned fde_idx;
27263 dw_fde_ref fde;
27264 bool range_list_added = false;
27265
27266 if (text_section_used)
27267 add_ranges_by_labels (main_comp_unit_die, text_section_label,
27268 text_end_label, &range_list_added, true);
27269 if (cold_text_section_used)
27270 add_ranges_by_labels (main_comp_unit_die, cold_text_section_label,
27271 cold_end_label, &range_list_added, true);
27272
27273 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (*fde_vec, fde_idx, fde)
27274 {
27275 if (DECL_IGNORED_P (fde->decl))
27276 continue;
27277 if (!fde->in_std_section)
27278 add_ranges_by_labels (main_comp_unit_die, fde->dw_fde_begin,
27279 fde->dw_fde_end, &range_list_added,
27280 true);
27281 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin && !fde->second_in_std_section)
27282 add_ranges_by_labels (main_comp_unit_die, fde->dw_fde_second_begin,
27283 fde->dw_fde_second_end, &range_list_added,
27284 true);
27285 }
27286
27287 if (range_list_added)
27288 {
27289 /* We need to give .debug_loc and .debug_ranges an appropriate
27290 "base address". Use zero so that these addresses become
27291 absolute. Historically, we've emitted the unexpected
27292 DW_AT_entry_pc instead of DW_AT_low_pc for this purpose.
27293 Emit both to give time for other tools to adapt. */
27294 add_AT_addr (main_comp_unit_die, DW_AT_low_pc, const0_rtx, true);
27295 if (! dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 4)
27296 add_AT_addr (main_comp_unit_die, DW_AT_entry_pc, const0_rtx, true);
27297
27298 add_ranges (NULL);
27299 }
27300 }
27301
27302 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
27303 add_AT_lineptr (main_comp_unit_die, DW_AT_stmt_list,
27304 debug_line_section_label);
27305
27306 if (have_macinfo)
27307 add_AT_macptr (comp_unit_die (),
27308 dwarf_strict ? DW_AT_macro_info : DW_AT_GNU_macros,
27309 macinfo_section_label);
27310
27311 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
27312 {
27313 /* optimize_location_lists calculates the size of the lists,
27314 so index them first, and assign indices to the entries.
27315 Although optimize_location_lists will remove entries from
27316 the table, it only does so for duplicates, and therefore
27317 only reduces ref_counts to 1. */
27318 index_location_lists (comp_unit_die ());
27319
27320 if (addr_index_table != NULL)
27321 {
27322 unsigned int index = 0;
27323 addr_index_table
27324 ->traverse_noresize<unsigned int *, index_addr_table_entry>
27325 (&index);
27326 }
27327 }
27328
27329 if (have_location_lists)
27330 optimize_location_lists (comp_unit_die ());
27331
27332 save_macinfo_strings ();
27333
27334 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
27335 {
27336 unsigned int index = 0;
27337
27338 /* Add attributes common to skeleton compile_units and
27339 type_units. Because these attributes include strings, it
27340 must be done before freezing the string table. Top-level
27341 skeleton die attrs are added when the skeleton type unit is
27342 created, so ensure it is created by this point. */
27343 add_top_level_skeleton_die_attrs (main_comp_unit_die);
27344 debug_str_hash->traverse_noresize<unsigned int *, index_string> (&index);
27345 }
27346
27347 /* Output all of the compilation units. We put the main one last so that
27348 the offsets are available to output_pubnames. */
27349 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
27350 output_comp_unit (node->die, 0);
27351
27352 hash_table<comdat_type_hasher> comdat_type_table (100);
27353 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
27354 {
27355 comdat_type_node **slot = comdat_type_table.find_slot (ctnode, INSERT);
27356
27357 /* Don't output duplicate types. */
27358 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
27359 continue;
27360
27361 /* Add a pointer to the line table for the main compilation unit
27362 so that the debugger can make sense of DW_AT_decl_file
27363 attributes. */
27364 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
27365 add_AT_lineptr (ctnode->root_die, DW_AT_stmt_list,
27366 (!dwarf_split_debug_info
27367 ? debug_line_section_label
27368 : debug_skeleton_line_section_label));
27369
27370 output_comdat_type_unit (ctnode);
27371 *slot = ctnode;
27372 }
27373
27374 /* The AT_pubnames attribute needs to go in all skeleton dies, including
27375 both the main_cu and all skeleton TUs. Making this call unconditional
27376 would end up either adding a second copy of the AT_pubnames attribute, or
27377 requiring a special case in add_top_level_skeleton_die_attrs. */
27378 if (!dwarf_split_debug_info)
27379 add_AT_pubnames (comp_unit_die ());
27380
27381 if (dwarf_split_debug_info)
27382 {
27383 int mark;
27384 unsigned char checksum[16];
27385 struct md5_ctx ctx;
27386
27387 /* Compute a checksum of the comp_unit to use as the dwo_id. */
27388 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
27389 mark = 0;
27390 die_checksum (comp_unit_die (), &ctx, &mark);
27391 unmark_all_dies (comp_unit_die ());
27392 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
27393
27394 /* Use the first 8 bytes of the checksum as the dwo_id,
27395 and add it to both comp-unit DIEs. */
27396 add_AT_data8 (main_comp_unit_die, DW_AT_GNU_dwo_id, checksum);
27397 add_AT_data8 (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_GNU_dwo_id, checksum);
27398
27399 /* Add the base offset of the ranges table to the skeleton
27400 comp-unit DIE. */
27401 if (ranges_table_in_use)
27402 add_AT_lineptr (main_comp_unit_die, DW_AT_GNU_ranges_base,
27403 ranges_section_label);
27404
27405 switch_to_section (debug_addr_section);
27406 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_addr_section_label);
27407 output_addr_table ();
27408 }
27409
27410 /* Output the main compilation unit if non-empty or if .debug_macinfo
27411 or .debug_macro will be emitted. */
27412 output_comp_unit (comp_unit_die (), have_macinfo);
27413
27414 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && info_section_emitted)
27415 output_skeleton_debug_sections (main_comp_unit_die);
27416
27417 /* Output the abbreviation table. */
27418 if (abbrev_die_table_in_use != 1)
27419 {
27420 switch_to_section (debug_abbrev_section);
27421 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, abbrev_section_label);
27422 output_abbrev_section ();
27423 }
27424
27425 /* Output location list section if necessary. */
27426 if (have_location_lists)
27427 {
27428 /* Output the location lists info. */
27429 switch_to_section (debug_loc_section);
27430 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, loc_section_label);
27431 output_location_lists (comp_unit_die ());
27432 }
27433
27434 output_pubtables ();
27435
27436 /* Output the address range information if a CU (.debug_info section)
27437 was emitted. We output an empty table even if we had no functions
27438 to put in it. This because the consumer has no way to tell the
27439 difference between an empty table that we omitted and failure to
27440 generate a table that would have contained data. */
27441 if (info_section_emitted)
27442 {
27443 switch_to_section (debug_aranges_section);
27444 output_aranges ();
27445 }
27446
27447 /* Output ranges section if necessary. */
27448 if (ranges_table_in_use)
27449 {
27450 switch_to_section (debug_ranges_section);
27451 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, ranges_section_label);
27452 output_ranges ();
27453 }
27454
27455 /* Have to end the macro section. */
27456 if (have_macinfo)
27457 {
27458 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
27459 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, macinfo_section_label);
27460 output_macinfo ();
27461 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End compilation unit");
27462 }
27463
27464 /* Output the source line correspondence table. We must do this
27465 even if there is no line information. Otherwise, on an empty
27466 translation unit, we will generate a present, but empty,
27467 .debug_info section. IRIX 6.5 `nm' will then complain when
27468 examining the file. This is done late so that any filenames
27469 used by the debug_info section are marked as 'used'. */
27470 switch_to_section (debug_line_section);
27471 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_line_section_label);
27472 if (! DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
27473 output_line_info (false);
27474
27475 if (dwarf_split_debug_info && info_section_emitted)
27476 {
27477 switch_to_section (debug_skeleton_line_section);
27478 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_skeleton_line_section_label);
27479 output_line_info (true);
27480 }
27481
27482 /* If we emitted any indirect strings, output the string table too. */
27483 if (debug_str_hash || skeleton_debug_str_hash)
27484 output_indirect_strings ();
27485 }
27486
27487 /* Perform any cleanups needed after the early debug generation pass
27488 has run. */
27489
27490 static void
27491 dwarf2out_early_finish (void)
27492 {
27493 limbo_die_node *node;
27494
27495 /* Add DW_AT_linkage_name for all deferred DIEs. */
27496 for (node = deferred_asm_name; node; node = node->next)
27497 {
27498 tree decl = node->created_for;
27499 if (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl) != DECL_NAME (decl)
27500 /* A missing DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME can be a constant DIE that
27501 ended up in deferred_asm_name before we knew it was
27502 constant and never written to disk. */
27503 && DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl))
27504 {
27505 add_linkage_attr (node->die, decl);
27506 move_linkage_attr (node->die);
27507 }
27508 }
27509 deferred_asm_name = NULL;
27510
27511 /* The point here is to flush out the limbo list so that it is empty
27512 and we don't need to stream it for LTO. */
27513 flush_limbo_die_list ();
27514
27515 gen_scheduled_generic_parms_dies ();
27516 gen_remaining_tmpl_value_param_die_attribute ();
27517 }
27518
27519 /* Reset all state within dwarf2out.c so that we can rerun the compiler
27520 within the same process. For use by toplev::finalize. */
27521
27522 void
27523 dwarf2out_c_finalize (void)
27524 {
27525 last_var_location_insn = NULL;
27526 cached_next_real_insn = NULL;
27527 used_rtx_array = NULL;
27528 incomplete_types = NULL;
27529 decl_scope_table = NULL;
27530 debug_info_section = NULL;
27531 debug_skeleton_info_section = NULL;
27532 debug_abbrev_section = NULL;
27533 debug_skeleton_abbrev_section = NULL;
27534 debug_aranges_section = NULL;
27535 debug_addr_section = NULL;
27536 debug_macinfo_section = NULL;
27537 debug_line_section = NULL;
27538 debug_skeleton_line_section = NULL;
27539 debug_loc_section = NULL;
27540 debug_pubnames_section = NULL;
27541 debug_pubtypes_section = NULL;
27542 debug_str_section = NULL;
27543 debug_str_dwo_section = NULL;
27544 debug_str_offsets_section = NULL;
27545 debug_ranges_section = NULL;
27546 debug_frame_section = NULL;
27547 fde_vec = NULL;
27548 debug_str_hash = NULL;
27549 skeleton_debug_str_hash = NULL;
27550 dw2_string_counter = 0;
27551 have_multiple_function_sections = false;
27552 text_section_used = false;
27553 cold_text_section_used = false;
27554 cold_text_section = NULL;
27555 current_unit_personality = NULL;
27556
27557 next_die_offset = 0;
27558 single_comp_unit_die = NULL;
27559 comdat_type_list = NULL;
27560 limbo_die_list = NULL;
27561 file_table = NULL;
27562 decl_die_table = NULL;
27563 common_block_die_table = NULL;
27564 decl_loc_table = NULL;
27565 call_arg_locations = NULL;
27566 call_arg_loc_last = NULL;
27567 call_site_count = -1;
27568 tail_call_site_count = -1;
27569 cached_dw_loc_list_table = NULL;
27570 abbrev_die_table = NULL;
27571 abbrev_die_table_allocated = 0;
27572 abbrev_die_table_in_use = 0;
27573 delete dwarf_proc_stack_usage_map;
27574 dwarf_proc_stack_usage_map = NULL;
27575 line_info_label_num = 0;
27576 cur_line_info_table = NULL;
27577 text_section_line_info = NULL;
27578 cold_text_section_line_info = NULL;
27579 separate_line_info = NULL;
27580 info_section_emitted = false;
27581 pubname_table = NULL;
27582 pubtype_table = NULL;
27583 macinfo_table = NULL;
27584 ranges_table = NULL;
27585 ranges_table_allocated = 0;
27586 ranges_table_in_use = 0;
27587 ranges_by_label = 0;
27588 ranges_by_label_allocated = 0;
27589 ranges_by_label_in_use = 0;
27590 have_location_lists = false;
27591 loclabel_num = 0;
27592 poc_label_num = 0;
27593 last_emitted_file = NULL;
27594 label_num = 0;
27595 tmpl_value_parm_die_table = NULL;
27596 generic_type_instances = NULL;
27597 frame_pointer_fb_offset = 0;
27598 frame_pointer_fb_offset_valid = false;
27599 base_types.release ();
27600 XDELETEVEC (producer_string);
27601 producer_string = NULL;
27602 }
27603
27604 #include "gt-dwarf2out.h"